ASA Configuration Guide 7-2
ASA Configuration Guide 7-2
ASA Configuration Guide 7-2
Configuration Guide
For the Cisco ASA 5500 Series and Cisco PIX 500 Series
Corporate Headquarters
Cisco Systems, Inc.
170 West Tasman Drive
San Jose, CA 95134-1706
USA
http://www.cisco.com
Tel: 408 526-4000
800 553-NETS (6387)
Fax: 408 526-4100
THE SOFTWARE LICENSE AND LIMITED WARRANTY FOR THE ACCOMPANYING PRODUCT ARE SET FORTH IN THE INFORMATION PACKET THAT
SHIPPED WITH THE PRODUCT AND ARE INCORPORATED HEREIN BY THIS REFERENCE. IF YOU ARE UNABLE TO LOCATE THE SOFTWARE LICENSE
OR LIMITED WARRANTY, CONTACT YOUR CISCO REPRESENTATIVE FOR A COPY.
The Cisco implementation of TCP header compression is an adaptation of a program developed by the University of California, Berkeley (UCB) as part of UCB’s public
domain version of the UNIX operating system. All rights reserved. Copyright © 1981, Regents of the University of California.
NOTWITHSTANDING ANY OTHER WARRANTY HEREIN, ALL DOCUMENT FILES AND SOFTWARE OF THESE SUPPLIERS ARE PROVIDED “AS IS” WITH
ALL FAULTS. CISCO AND THE ABOVE-NAMED SUPPLIERS DISCLAIM ALL WARRANTIES, EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, WITHOUT
LIMITATION, THOSE OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OR ARISING FROM A COURSE OF
DEALING, USAGE, OR TRADE PRACTICE.
IN NO EVENT SHALL CISCO OR ITS SUPPLIERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, CONSEQUENTIAL, OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, INCLUDING,
WITHOUT LIMITATION, LOST PROFITS OR LOSS OR DAMAGE TO DATA ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THIS MANUAL, EVEN IF CISCO
OR ITS SUPPLIERS HAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
CCSP, CCVP, the Cisco Square Bridge logo, Follow Me Browsing, and StackWise are trademarks of Cisco Systems, Inc.; Changing the Way We Work, Live, Play, and Learn, and
iQuick Study are service marks of Cisco Systems, Inc.; and Access Registrar, Aironet, BPX, Catalyst, CCDA, CCDP, CCIE, CCIP, CCNA, CCNP, Cisco, the Cisco Certified
Internetwork Expert logo, Cisco IOS, Cisco Press, Cisco Systems, Cisco Systems Capital, the Cisco Systems logo, Cisco Unity, Enterprise/Solver, EtherChannel, EtherFast,
EtherSwitch, Fast Step, FormShare, GigaDrive, GigaStack, HomeLink, Internet Quotient, IOS, IP/TV, iQ Expertise, the iQ logo, iQ Net Readiness Scorecard, LightStream,
Linksys, MeetingPlace, MGX, the Networkers logo, Networking Academy, Network Registrar, Packet, PIX, Post-Routing, Pre-Routing, ProConnect, RateMUX, ScriptShare,
SlideCast, SMARTnet, The Fastest Way to Increase Your Internet Quotient, and TransPath are registered trademarks of Cisco Systems, Inc. and/or its affiliates in the United States
and certain other countries.
All other trademarks mentioned in this document or Website are the property of their respective owners. The use of the word partner does not imply a partnership relationship
between Cisco and any other company. (0601R)
Audience xxxiii
CHAPTER 4 Configuring Switch Ports and VLAN Interfaces for the Cisco ASA 5505 Adaptive Security
Appliance 4-1
Interface Overview 4-1
Understanding ASA 5505 Ports and Interfaces 4-2
Maximum Active VLAN Interfaces for Your License 4-2
Default Interface Configuration 4-3
VLAN MAC Addresses 4-4
Power Over Ethernet 4-4
Monitoring Traffic Using SPAN 4-4
Security Level Overview 4-5
Configuring VLAN Interfaces 4-5
Allowing Communication Between VLAN Interfaces on the Same Security Level 4-13
IP Addresses Used for Access Lists When You Use NAT 16-3
Using MAC Addresses to Exempt Traffic from Authentication and Authorization 19-13
Overview 24-1
Configuring an Instant Messaging Inspection Policy Map for Additional Inspection Control 25-48
Configuring ISAKMP Policy and Enabling ISAKMP on the Outside Interface 32-3
Creating a Crypto Map Entry to Use the Dynamic Crypto Map 32-7
Configuring ISAKMP Policy and Enabling ISAKMP on the Outside Interface 36-2
Example 15: ASA 5505 Security Plus License with Failover and Dual-ISP Backup B-36
Example 15: Primary Unit Configuration B-36
Example 15: Secondary Unit Configuration B-38
GLOSSARY
INDEX
This preface introduce the Cisco Security Appliance Command Line Configuration Guide, and includes
the following sections:
• Document Objectives, page xxxiii
• Audience, page xxxiii
• Related Documentation, page xxxiv
• Document Organization, page xxxiv
• Document Conventions, page xxxvii
• Obtaining Documentation, page xxxviii
• Documentation Feedback, page xxxviii
• Cisco Product Security Overview, page xxxix
• Obtaining Technical Assistance, page xl
• Obtaining Additional Publications and Information, page xli
Document Objectives
The purpose of this guide is to help you configure the security appliance using the command-line
interface. This guide does not cover every feature, but describes only the most common configuration
scenarios.
You can also configure and monitor the security appliance by using ASDM, a web-based GUI
application. ASDM includes configuration wizards to guide you through some common configuration
scenarios, and online Help for less common scenarios. For more information, see:
http://www.cisco.com/univercd/cc/td/doc/product/netsec/secmgmt/asdm/index.htm
This guide applies to the Cisco PIX 500 series security appliances (PIX 515E, PIX 525, and PIX 535)
and the Cisco ASA 5500 series security appliances (ASA 5505, ASA 5510, ASA 5520, ASA 5540, and
ASA 5550). Throughout this guide, the term “security appliance” applies generically to all supported
models, unless specified otherwise. The PIX 501, PIX 506E, and PIX 520 security appliances are not
supported.
Audience
This guide is for network managers who perform any of the following tasks:
Related Documentation
For more information, refer to the following documentation:
• Cisco PIX Security Appliance Release Notes
• Cisco ASDM Release Notes
• Cisco PIX 515E Quick Start Guide
• Guide for Cisco PIX 6.2 and 6.3 Users Upgrading to Cisco PIX Software Version 7.0
• Migrating to ASA for VPN 3000 Series Concentrator Administrators
• Cisco Security Appliance Command Reference
• Cisco ASA 5500 Series Adaptive Security Appliance Getting Started Guide
• Cisco ASA 5500 Series Release Notes
• Cisco Security Appliance Logging Configuration and System Log Messages
• Cisco Secure Desktop Configuration Guide for Cisco ASA 5500 Series Administrators
Document Organization
This guide includes the chapters and appendixes described in Table 1.
Chapter/Appendix Definition
Part 1: Getting Started and General Information
Chapter 1, “Introduction to the Provides a high-level overview of the security appliance.
Security Appliance”
Chapter 2, “Getting Started” Describes how to access the command-line interface, configure the firewall mode, and
work with the configuration.
Chapter 3, “Enabling Multiple Describes how to use security contexts and enable multiple context mode.
Context Mode”
Chapter 4, “Configuring Switch Describes how to configure switch ports and VLAN interfaces for the ASA 5505 adaptive
Ports and VLAN Interfaces for security appliance.
the Cisco ASA 5505 Adaptive
Security Appliance”
Chapter 5, “Configuring Describes how to configure Ethernet settings for physical interfaces and add subinterfaces.
Ethernet Settings and
Subinterfaces”
Chapter 6, “Adding and Describes how to configure multiple security contexts on the security appliance.
Managing Security Contexts”
Chapter/Appendix Definition
Chapter 7, “Configuring Describes how to configure each interface and subinterface for a name, security, level, and
Interface Parameters” IP address.
Chapter 8, “Configuring Basic Describes how to configure basic settings that are typically required for a functioning
Settings” configuration.
Chapter 9, “Configuring IP Describes how to configure IP routing.
Routing”
Chapter 10, “Configuring Describes how to configure the DHCP server and DHCP relay.
DHCP, DDNS, and WCCP
Services”
Chapter 11, “Configuring Describes how to configure multicast routing.
Multicast Routing”
Chapter 12, “Configuring IPv6” Describes how to enable and configure IPv6.
Chapter 13, “Configuring AAA Describes how to configure AAA servers and the local database.
Servers and the Local Database”
Chapter 14, “Configuring Describes the failover feature, which lets you configure two security appliances so that one
Failover” will take over operation if the other one fails.
Part 2: Configuring the Firewall
Chapter 15, “Firewall Mode Describes in detail the two operation modes of the security appliance, routed and
Overview” transparent mode, and how data is handled differently with each mode.
Chapter 16, “Identifying Traffic Describes how to identify traffic with access lists.
with Access Lists”
Chapter 17, “Applying NAT” Describes how address translation is performed.
Chapter 18, “Permitting or Describes how to control network access through the security appliance using access lists.
Denying Network Access”
Chapter 19, “Applying AAA for Describes how to enable AAA for network access.
Network Access”
Chapter 20, “Applying Filtering Describes ways to filter web traffic to reduce security risks or prevent inappropriate use.
Services”
Chapter 21, “Using Modular Describes how to use the Modular Policy Framework to create security policies for TCP,
Policy Framework” general connection settings, inspection, and QoS.
Chapter 22, “Managing AIP Describes how to configure the security appliance to send traffic to an AIP SSM or a CSC
SSM and CSC SSM” SSM, how to check the status of an SSM, and how to update the software image on an
intelligent SSM.
Chapter 23, “Preventing Describes how to configure protection features to intercept and respond to network attacks.
Network Attacks”
Chapter 24, “Applying QoS Describes how to configure the network to provide better service to selected network
Policies” traffic over various technologies, including Frame Relay, Asynchronous Transfer Mode
(ATM), Ethernet and 802.1 networks, SONET, and IP routed networks.
Chapter 25, “Configuring Describes how to use and configure application inspection.
Application Layer Protocol
Inspection”
Chapter/Appendix Definition
Chapter 26, “Configuring Describes how to enable ARP inspection and how to customize bridging operations.
ARP Inspection and Bridging
Parameters”
Part 3: Configuring VPN
Chapter 27, “Configuring IPSec Describes how to configure ISAKMP and IPSec tunneling to build and manage VPN
and ISAKMP” “tunnels,” or secure connections between remote users and a private corporate network.
Chapter 28, “Configuring L2TP Describes how to configure IPSec over L2TP on the security appliance.
over IPSec”
Chapter 29, “Setting General Describes miscellaneous VPN configuration procedures.
IPSec VPN Parameters”
Chapter 30, “Configuring Describes how to configure VPN tunnel groups, group policies, and users.
Tunnel Groups, Group Policies,
and Users”
Chapter 31, “Configuring IP Describes how to configure IP addresses in your private network addressing scheme, which
Addresses for VPNs” let the client function as a tunnel endpoint.
Chapter 32, “Configuring Describes how to configure a remote access VPN connection.
Remote Access IPSec VPNs”
Chapter 33, “Configuring Describes how to configure Network Admission Control (NAC).
Network Admission Control”
Chapter 34, “Configuring Easy Describes how to configure Easy VPN on the ASA 5505 adaptive security appliance.
VPN Services on the ASA 5505”
Chapter 35, “Configuring the Describes how to configure the PPPoE client provided with the security appliance.
PPPoE Client”
Chapter 36, “Configuring Describes how to build a LAN-to-LAN VPN connection.
LAN-to-LAN IPSec VPNs”
Chapter 37, “Configuring Describes how to establish a secure, remote-access VPN tunnel to a security appliance
WebVPN” using a web browser.
Chapter 38, “Configuring SSL Describes how to install and configure the SSL VPN Client.
VPN Client”
Chapter 39, “Configuring Describes how to configure a digital certificates, which contains information that identifies
Certificates” a user or device. Such information can include a name, serial number, company,
department, or IP address. A digital certificate also contains a copy of the public key for
the user or device.
Part 4: System Administration
Chapter 40, “Managing System Describes how to access the security appliance for system management through Telnet,
Access” SSH, and HTTPS.
Chapter 41, “Managing Describes how to enter license keys and download software and configurations files.
Software, Licenses, and
Configurations”
Chapter 42, “Monitoring the Describes how to monitor the security appliance.
Security Appliance”
Chapter/Appendix Definition
Chapter 43, “Troubleshooting Describes how to troubleshoot the security appliance.
the Security Appliance”
Part 4: Reference
Appendix A, “Feature Licenses Describes the feature licenses and specifications.
and Specifications”
Appendix B, “Sample Describes a number of common ways to implement the security appliance.
Configurations”
Appendix C, “Using the Describes how to use the CLI to configure the the security appliance.
Command-Line Interface”
Appendix D, “Addresses, Provides a quick reference for IP addresses, protocols, and applications.
Protocols, and Ports”
Appendix E, “Configuring an Provides information about configuring LDAP and RADIUS authorization servers.
External Server for
Authorization and
Authentication”
“Glossary” Provides a handy reference for commonly-used terms and acronyms.
“Index” Provides an index for the guide.
Document Conventions
Command descriptions use these conventions:
• Braces ({ }) indicate a required choice.
• Square brackets ([ ]) indicate optional elements.
• Vertical bars ( | ) separate alternative, mutually exclusive elements.
• Boldface indicates commands and keywords that are entered literally as shown.
• Italics indicate arguments for which you supply values.
Examples use these conventions:
• Examples depict screen displays and the command line in screen font.
• Information you need to enter in examples is shown in boldface screen font.
• Variables for which you must supply a value are shown in italic screen font.
Note Means reader take note. Notes contain helpful suggestions or references to material not covered in the
manual.
Obtaining Documentation
Cisco documentation and additional literature are available on Cisco.com. Cisco also provides several
ways to obtain technical assistance and other technical resources. These sections explain how to obtain
technical information from Cisco Systems.
Cisco.com
You can access the most current Cisco documentation at this URL:
http://www.cisco.com/techsupport
You can access the Cisco website at this URL:
http://www.cisco.com
You can access international Cisco websites at this URL:
http://www.cisco.com/public/countries_languages.shtml
Ordering Documentation
Registered Cisco.com users may order Cisco documentation at the Product Documentation Store in the
Cisco Marketplace at this URL:
http://www.cisco.com/go/marketplace/
Nonregistered Cisco.com users can order technical documentation from 8:00 a.m. to 5:00 p.m.
(0800 to 1700) PDT by calling 1 866 463-3487 in the United States and Canada, or elsewhere by
calling 011 408 519-5055. You can also order documentation by e-mail at
[email protected] or by fax at 1 408 519-5001 in the United States and Canada,
or elsewhere at 011 408 519-5001.
Documentation Feedback
You can rate and provide feedback about Cisco technical documents by completing the online feedback
form that appears with the technical documents on Cisco.com.
You can submit comments about Cisco documentation by using the response card (if present) behind the
front cover of your document or by writing to the following address:
Cisco Systems
Attn: Customer Document Ordering
170 West Tasman Drive
San Jose, CA 95134-9883
We appreciate your comments.
Tip We encourage you to use Pretty Good Privacy (PGP) or a compatible product (for example, GnuPG) to
encrypt any sensitive information that you send to Cisco. PSIRT can work with information that has been
encrypted with PGP versions 2.x through 9.x.
Never use a revoked or an expired encryption key. The correct public key to use in your correspondence
with PSIRT is the one linked in the Contact Summary section of the Security Vulnerability Policy page
at this URL:
http://www.cisco.com/en/US/products/products_security_vulnerability_policy.html
The link on this page has the current PGP key ID in use.
If you do not have or use PGP, contact PSIRT at the aforementioned e-mail addresses or phone numbers
before sending any sensitive material to find other means of encrypting the data.
Note Use the Cisco Product Identification (CPI) tool to locate your product serial number before submitting
a web or phone request for service. You can access the CPI tool from the Cisco Technical Support &
Documentation website by clicking the Tools & Resources link under Documentation & Tools. Choose
Cisco Product Identification Tool from the Alphabetical Index drop-down list, or click the Cisco
Product Identification Tool link under Alerts & RMAs. The CPI tool offers three search options: by
product ID or model name; by tree view; or for certain products, by copying and pasting show command
output. Search results show an illustration of your product with the serial number label location
highlighted. Locate the serial number label on your product and record the information before placing a
service call.
• Cisco Marketplace provides a variety of Cisco books, reference guides, documentation, and logo
merchandise. Visit Cisco Marketplace, the company store, at this URL:
http://www.cisco.com/go/marketplace/
• Cisco Press publishes a wide range of general networking, training and certification titles. Both new
and experienced users will benefit from these publications. For current Cisco Press titles and other
information, go to Cisco Press at this URL:
http://www.ciscopress.com
• Packet magazine is the Cisco Systems technical user magazine for maximizing Internet and
networking investments. Each quarter, Packet delivers coverage of the latest industry trends,
technology breakthroughs, and Cisco products and solutions, as well as network deployment and
troubleshooting tips, configuration examples, customer case studies, certification and training
information, and links to scores of in-depth online resources. You can access Packet magazine at
this URL:
http://www.cisco.com/packet
• iQ Magazine is the quarterly publication from Cisco Systems designed to help growing companies
learn how they can use technology to increase revenue, streamline their business, and expand
services. The publication identifies the challenges facing these companies and the technologies to
help solve them, using real-world case studies and business strategies to help readers make sound
technology investment decisions. You can access iQ Magazine at this URL:
http://www.cisco.com/go/iqmagazine
or view the digital edition at this URL:
http://ciscoiq.texterity.com/ciscoiq/sample/
• Internet Protocol Journal is a quarterly journal published by Cisco Systems for engineering
professionals involved in designing, developing, and operating public and private internets and
intranets. You can access the Internet Protocol Journal at this URL:
http://www.cisco.com/ipj
• Networking products offered by Cisco Systems, as well as customer support services, can be
obtained at this URL:
http://www.cisco.com/en/US/products/index.html
• Networking Professionals Connection is an interactive website for networking professionals to share
questions, suggestions, and information about networking products and technologies with Cisco
experts and other networking professionals. Join a discussion at this URL:
http://www.cisco.com/discuss/networking
• World-class networking training is available from Cisco. You can view current offerings at
this URL:
http://www.cisco.com/en/US/learning/index.html
The security appliance combines advanced stateful firewall and VPN concentrator functionality in one
device, and for some models, an integrated intrusion prevention module called the AIP SSM or an
integrated content security and control module called the CSC SSM. The security appliance includes
many advanced features, such as multiple security contexts (similar to virtualized firewalls), transparent
(Layer 2) firewall or routed (Layer 3) firewall operation, advanced inspection engines, IPSec and
WebVPN support, and many more features. See Appendix A, “Feature Licenses and Specifications,” for
a list of supported platforms and features. For a list of new features, see the Cisco ASA 5500 Series
Release Notes or the Cisco PIX Security Appliance Release Notes.
Note The Cisco PIX 501 and PIX 506E security appliances are not supported.
Applying NAT
Some of the benefits of NAT include the following:
• You can use private addresses on your inside networks. Private addresses are not routable on the
Internet.
• NAT hides the local addresses from other networks, so attackers cannot learn the real address of a
host.
• NAT can resolve IP routing problems by supporting overlapping IP addresses.
Sending Traffic to the Advanced Inspection and Prevention Security Services Module
If your model supports the AIP SSM for intrusion prevention, then you can send traffic to the AIP SSM
for inspection.
Sending Traffic to the Content Security and Control Security Services Module
If your model supports it, the CSC SSM provides protection against viruses, spyware, spam, and other
unwanted traffic. It accomplishes this by scanning the FTP, HTTP, POP3, and SMTP traffic that you
configure the adaptive security appliance to send to it.
In routed mode, the security appliance is considered to be a router hop in the network.
In transparent mode, the security appliance acts like a “bump in the wire,” or a “stealth firewall,” and is
not considered a router hop. The security appliance connects to the same network on its inside and
outside interfaces.
You might use a transparent firewall to simplify your network configuration. Transparent mode is also
useful if you want the firewall to be invisible to attackers. You can also use a transparent firewall for
traffic that would otherwise be blocked in routed mode. For example, a transparent firewall can allow
multicast streams using an EtherType access list.
Note The session management path and the fast path make up the “accelerated security path.”
Some packets that require Layer 7 inspection (the packet payload must be inspected or altered) are
passed on to the control plane path. Layer 7 inspection engines are required for protocols that have
two or more channels: a data channel, which uses well-known port numbers, and a control channel,
which uses different port numbers for each session. These protocols include FTP, H.323, and SNMP.
• Is this an established connection?
If the connection is already established, the security appliance does not need to re-check packets;
most matching packets can go through the fast path in both directions. The fast path is responsible
for the following tasks:
– IP checksum verification
– Session lookup
– TCP sequence number check
– NAT translations based on existing sessions
– Layer 3 and Layer 4 header adjustments
For UDP or other connectionless protocols, the security appliance creates connection state
information so that it can also use the fast path.
Data packets for protocols that require Layer 7 inspection can also go through the fast path.
Some established session packets must continue to go through the session management path or the
control plane path. Packets that go through the session management path include HTTP packets that
require inspection or content filtering. Packets that go through the control plane path include the
control packets for protocols that require Layer 7 inspection.
Note You can run all your contexts in routed mode or transparent mode; you cannot run some contexts in one
mode and others in another.
This chapter describes how to access the command-line interface, configure the firewall mode, and work
with the configuration. This chapter includes the following sections:
• Getting Started with Your Platform Model, page 2-1
• Factory Default Configurations, page 2-1
• Accessing the Command-Line Interface, page 2-4
• Setting Transparent or Routed Firewall Mode, page 2-5
• Working with the Configuration, page 2-6
The factory default configuration is available only for routed firewall mode and single context mode.
See Chapter 3, “Enabling Multiple Context Mode,” for more information about multiple context mode.
See the “Setting Transparent or Routed Firewall Mode” section on page 2-5 for more information about
routed and transparent firewall mode.
This section includes the following topics:
• Restoring the Factory Default Configuration, page 2-2
• ASA 5505 Default Configuration, page 2-2
• ASA 5510 and Higher Default Configuration, page 2-3
• PIX 515/515E Default Configuration, page 2-4
If you specify the ip_address, then you set the inside or management interface IP address, depending on
your model, instead of using the default IP address of 198.168.1.1. The http command uses the subnet
you specify. Similarly, the dhcpd address command range consists of addresses within the subnet that
you specify.
After you restore the factory default configuration, save it to internal Flash memory using the write
memory command. The write memory command saves the running configuration to the default location
for the startup configuration, even if you previously configured the boot config command to set a
different location; when the configuration was cleared, this path was also cleared.
Note This command also clears the boot system command, if present, along with the rest of the configuration.
The boot system command lets you boot from a specific image, including an image on the external Flash
memory card. The next time you reload the security appliance after restoring the factory configuration,
it boots from the first image in internal Flash memory; if you do not have an image in internal Flash
memory, the security appliance does not boot.
To configure additional settings that are useful for a full configuration, see the setup command.
• The DHCP server is enabled on the security appliance, so a PC connecting to the VLAN 1 interface
receives an address between 192.168.1.2 and 192.168.1.254.
• The HTTP server is enabled for ASDM and is accessible to users on the 192.168.1.0 network.
The configuration consists of the following commands:
interface Ethernet 0/0
switchport access vlan 2
no shutdown
interface Ethernet 0/1
switchport access vlan 1
no shutdown
interface Ethernet 0/2
switchport access vlan 1
no shutdown
interface Ethernet 0/3
switchport access vlan 1
no shutdown
interface Ethernet 0/4
switchport access vlan 1
no shutdown
interface Ethernet 0/5
switchport access vlan 1
no shutdown
interface Ethernet 0/6
switchport access vlan 1
no shutdown
interface Ethernet 0/7
switchport access vlan 1
no shutdown
interface vlan2
nameif outside
no shutdown
ip address dhcp setroute
interface vlan1
nameif inside
ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0
security-level 100
no shutdown
global (outside) 1 interface
nat (inside) 1 0 0
http server enable
http 192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0 inside
dhcpd address 192.168.1.2-192.168.1.254 inside
dhcpd auto_config outside
dhcpd enable inside
logging asdm informational
Note If you want to use ASDM to configure the security appliance instead of the command-line interface, you
can connect to the default management address of 192.168.1.1 (if your security appliance includes a
factory default configuration. See the “Factory Default Configurations” section on page 2-1.). On the
ASA 5510 and higher adaptive security appliances, the interface to which you connect with ASDM is
Management 0/0. For the ASA 5505 adaptive security appliance, the switch port to which you connect
with ASDM is any port, except for Ethernet 0/0. For the PIX 515/515E security appliance, the interface
to which you connect with ASDM is Ethernet 1. If you do not have a factory default configuration, follow
the steps in this section to access the command-line interface. You can then configure the minimum
parameters to access ASDM by entering the setup command.
Step 1 Connect a PC to the console port using the provided console cable, and connect to the console using a
terminal emulator set for 9600 baud, 8 data bits, no parity, 1 stop bit, no flow control.
See the hardware guide that came with your security appliance for more information about the console
cable.
Step 2 Press the Enter key to see the following prompt:
hostname>
This prompt indicates that you are in user EXEC mode.
Step 3 To access privileged EXEC mode, enter the following command:
hostname> enable
To exit global configuration mode, enter the exit, quit, or end command.
When you change modes, the security appliance clears the configuration because many commands are
not supported for both modes. If you already have a populated configuration, be sure to back up your
configuration before changing the mode; you can use this backup for reference when creating your new
configuration. See the “Backing Up Configuration Files” section on page 41-8. For multiple context
mode, the system configuration is erased. This action removes any contexts from running. If you then
re-add a context that has an existing configuration that was created for the wrong mode, the context
configuration will not work correctly. Be sure to recreate your context configurations for the correct
mode before you re-add them, or add new contexts with new paths for the new configurations.
If you download a text configuration to the security appliance that changes the mode with the
firewall transparent command, be sure to put the command at the top of the configuration; the security
appliance changes the mode as soon as it reads the command and then continues reading the
configuration you downloaded. If the command is later in the configuration, the security appliance clears
all the preceding lines in the configuration. See the “Downloading Software or Configuration Files to
Flash Memory” section on page 41-3 for information about downloading text files.
• To set the mode to transparent, enter the following command in the system execution space:
hostname(config)# firewall transparent
This command also appears in each context configuration for informational purposes only; you
cannot enter this command in a context.
• To set the mode to routed, enter the following command in the system execution space:
hostname(config)# no firewall transparent
Note The copy running-config startup-config command is equivalent to the write memory command.
To save the system or context configuration, enter the following command within the system or context:
hostname# write memory
Note The copy running-config startup-config command is equivalent to the write memory command.
For multiple context mode, context startup configurations can reside on external servers. In this case, the
security appliance saves the configuration back to the server you identified in the context URL, except
for an HTTP or HTTPS URL, which do not let you save the configuration to the server.
To save all context configurations at the same time, as well as the system configuration, enter the
following command in the system execution space:
hostname# write memory all [/noconfirm]
If you do not enter the /noconfirm keyword, you see the following prompt:
Are you sure [Y/N]:
After you enter Y, the security appliance saves the system configuration and each context. Context
startup configurations can reside on external servers. In this case, the security appliance saves the
configuration back to the server you identified in the context URL, except for an HTTP or HTTPS URL,
which do not let you save the configuration to the server.
After the security appliance saves each context, the following message appears:
‘Saving context ‘b’ ... ( 1/3 contexts saved ) ’
Sometimes, a context is not saved because of an error. See the following information for errors:
• For contexts that are not saved because of low memory, the following message appears:
The context 'context a' could not be saved due to Unavailability of resources
• For contexts that are not saved because the remote destination is unreachable, the following message
appears:
The context 'context a' could not be saved due to non-reachability of destination
• For contexts that are not saved because the context is locked, the following message appears:
Unable to save the configuration for the following contexts as these contexts are
locked.
context ‘a’ , context ‘x’ , context ‘z’ .
A context is only locked if another user is already saving the configuration or in the process of
deleting the context.
• For contexts that are not saved because the startup configuration is read-only (for example, on an
HTTP server), the following message report is printed at the end of all other messages:
Unable to save the configuration for the following contexts as these contexts have
read-only config-urls:
context ‘a’ , context ‘b’ , context ‘c’ .
• For contexts that are not saved because of bad sectors in the Flash memory, the following message
appears:
The context 'context a' could not be saved due to Unknown errors
A merge adds any new commands from the new configuration to the running configuration. If the
configurations are the same, no changes occur. If commands conflict or if commands affect the
running of the context, then the effect of the merge depends on the command. You might get errors,
or you might have unexpected results.
• To load the startup configuration and discard the running configuration, restart the security
appliance by entering the following command:
hostname# reload
Alternatively, you can use the following commands to load the startup configuration and discard the
running configuration without requiring a reboot:
hostname/contexta(config)# clear configure all
hostname/contexta(config)# copy startup-config running-config
• To view the running configuration of a specific command, enter the following command:
hostname# show running-config command
This command clears all the current configuration for the specified configuration command. If you
only want to clear the configuration for a specific version of the command, you can enter a value for
level2configurationcommand.
For example, to clear the configuration for all aaa commands, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# clear configure aaa
To clear the configuration for only aaa authentication commands, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# clear configure aaa authentication
• To disable the specific parameters or options of a command, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# no configurationcommand [level2configurationcommand] qualifier
In this case, you use the no command to remove the specific configuration identified by qualifier.
For example, to remove a specific nat command, enter enough of the command to identify it
uniquely as follows:
hostname(config)# no nat (inside) 1
Note In multiple context mode, if you enter clear configure all from the system configuration, you
also remove all contexts and stop them from running.
In most cases, commands described in this guide are preceded by a CLI prompt. The prompt in the
following example is “hostname(config)#”:
hostname(config)# context a
In the text configuration file you are not prompted to enter commands, so the prompt is omitted as
follows:
context a
For additional information about formatting the file, see Appendix C, “Using the Command-Line
Interface.”
This chapter describes how to use security contexts and enable multiple context mode. This chapter
includes the following sections:
• Security Context Overview, page 3-1
• Enabling or Disabling Multiple Context Mode, page 3-10
Unsupported Features
Multiple context mode does not support the following features:
• Dynamic routing protocols
Security contexts support only static routes. You cannot enable OSPF or RIP in multiple context
mode.
• VPN
• Multicast
Context Configurations
The security appliance includes a configuration for each context that identifies the security policy,
interfaces, and almost all the options you can configure on a standalone device. You can store context
configurations on the internal Flash memory or the external Flash memory card, or you can download
them from a TFTP, FTP, or HTTP(S) server.
System Configuration
The system administrator adds and manages contexts by configuring each context configuration location,
allocated interfaces, and other context operating parameters in the system configuration, which, like a
single mode configuration, is the startup configuration. The system configuration identifies basic
settings for the security appliance. The system configuration does not include any network interfaces or
network settings for itself; rather, when the system needs to access network resources (such as
downloading the contexts from the server), it uses one of the contexts that is designated as the admin
context. The system configuration does include a specialized failover interface for failover traffic only.
Note If the destination MAC address is a multicast or broadcast MAC address, the packet is duplicated and
delivered to each context.
Unique Interfaces
If only one context is associated with the ingress interface, the security appliance classifies the packet
into that context. In transparent firewall mode, unique interfaces for contexts are required, so this method
is used to classify packets at all times.
If multiple contexts share an interface, then the classifier uses the interface MAC address. The security
appliance lets you assign a different MAC address in each context to the same shared interface, whether
it is a shared physical interface or a shared subinterface. By default, shared interfaces do not have unique
MAC addresses; the interface uses the physical interface burned-in MAC address in every context. An
upstream router cannot route directly to a context without unique MAC addresses. You can set the MAC
addresses manually when you configure each interface (see the “Configuring the Interface” section on
page 7-2), or you can automatically generate MAC addresses (see the “Automatically Assigning MAC
Addresses to Context Interfaces” section on page 6-11).
NAT Configuration
If you do not have unique MAC addresses, then the classifier intercepts the packet and performs a
destination IP address lookup. All other fields are ignored; only the destination IP address is used. To
use the destination address for classification, the classifier must have knowledge about the subnets
located behind each security context. The classifier relies on the NAT configuration to determine the
subnets in each context. The classifier matches the destination IP address to either a static command or
a global command. In the case of the global command, the classifier does not need a matching nat
command or an active NAT session to classify the packet. Whether the packet can communicate with the
destination IP address after classification depends on how you configure NAT and NAT control.
For example, the classifier gains knowledge about subnets 10.10.10.0, 10.20.10.0 and 10.30.10.0 when
the context administrators configure static commands in each context:
• Context A:
• Context B:
static (inside,shared) 10.20.10.0 10.20.10.0 netmask 255.255.255.0
• Context C:
static (inside,shared) 10.30.10.0 10.30.10.0 netmask 255.255.255.0
Note For management traffic destined for an interface, the interface IP address is used for classification.
Classification Examples
Figure 3-2 shows multiple contexts sharing an outside interface. The classifier assigns the packet to
Context B because Context B includes the MAC address to which the router sends the packet.
Figure 3-1 Packet Classification with a Shared Interface using MAC Addresses
Internet
Packet Destination:
209.165.201.1 via MAC 000C.F142.4CDC
GE 0/0.1 (Shared Interface)
Classifier
153367
Host Host Host
209.165.202.129 209.165.200.225 209.165.201.1
Figure 3-2 shows multiple contexts sharing an outside interface without MAC addresses assigned. The
classifier assigns the packet to Context B because Context B includes the address translation that
matches the destination address.
Internet
Packet Destination:
209.165.201.3
GE 0/0.1 (Shared Interface)
Classifier
Admin
Context Context A Context B
Note that all new incoming traffic must be classified, even from inside networks. Figure 3-3 shows a host
on the Context B inside network accessing the Internet. The classifier assigns the packet to Context B
because the ingress interface is Gigabit Ethernet 0/1.3, which is assigned to Context B.
Note If you share an inside interface and do not use unique MAC addresses, the classifier imposes some major
restrictions. The classifier relies on the address translation configuration to classify the packet within a
context, and you must translate the destination addresses of the traffic. Because you do not usually
perform NAT on outside addresses, sending packets from inside to outside on a shared interface is not
always possible; the outside network is large, (the Web, for example), and addresses are not predictable
for an outside NAT configuration. If you share an inside interface, we suggest you use unique MAC
addresses.
Internet
GE 0/0.1
Admin
Context Context A Context B
Classifier
For transparent firewalls, you must use unique interfaces. Figure 3-4 shows a host on the Context B
inside network accessing the Internet. The classifier assigns the packet to Context B because the ingress
interface is Gigabit Ethernet 1/0.3, which is assigned to Context B.
Internet
Classifier
GE 0/0.2
GE 0/0.1 GE 0/0.3
Admin
Context Context A Context B
Note Cascading contexts requires that you configure unique MAC addresses for each context interface.
Because of the limitations of classifying packets on shared interfaces without MAC addresses, we do not
recommend using cascading contexts without unique MAC addresses.
Figure 3-5 shows a gateway context with two contexts behind the gateway.
Internet
GE 0/0.2
Outside
Gateway
Context
Inside
GE 0/0.1
(Shared Interface)
Outside Outside
Admin Context A
Context
GE 1/1.8 GE 1/1.43
153366
Inside Inside
username “admin.” The admin context does not have any command authorization configuration, but all
other contexts include command authorization. For convenience, each context configuration includes a
user “admin” with maximum privileges. When you change from the admin context to context A, your
username is altered, so you must log in again as “admin” by entering the login command. When you
change to context B, you must again enter the login command to log in as “admin.”
The system execution space does not support any AAA commands, but you can configure its own enable
password, as well as usernames in the local database to provide individual logins.
Step 1 To copy the backup version of your original running configuration to the current startup configuration,
enter the following command in the system execution space:
hostname(config)# copy flash:old_running.cfg startup-config
Step 2 To set the mode to single mode, enter the following command in the system execution space:
hostname(config)# mode single
This chapter describes how to configure the switch ports and VLAN interfaces of the ASA 5505 adaptive
security appliance.
Note To configure interfaces of other models, see Chapter 5, “Configuring Ethernet Settings and
Subinterfaces,” and Chapter 7, “Configuring Interface Parameters.”
Interface Overview
This section describes the ports and interfaces of the ASA 5505 adaptive security appliance, and includes
the following topics:
• Understanding ASA 5505 Ports and Interfaces, page 4-2
• Maximum Active VLAN Interfaces for Your License, page 4-2
• Default Interface Configuration, page 4-3
• VLAN MAC Addresses, page 4-4
• Power Over Ethernet, page 4-4
• Security Level Overview, page 4-5
Note Subinterfaces are not available for the ASA 5505 adaptive security appliance.
Figure 4-1 ASA 5505 Adaptive Security Appliance with Base License
Internet
ASA 5505
with Base License Home
153364
Business
With the Security Plus license, you can configure three VLAN interfaces for normal traffic, one VLAN
interface for failover, and one VLAN interface as a backup link to your ISP. This backup interface does
not pass through traffic unless the route through the primary interface fails.
Note The ASA 5505 adaptive security appliance supports Active/Standby failover, but not Stateful failover.
Figure 4-2 ASA 5505 Adaptive Security Appliance with Security Plus License
Backup ISP
Primary ISP
Failover Link
153365
Inside
Note If you are using failover, do not use this procedure to name interfaces that you are reserving for failover
communications. See Chapter 14, “Configuring Failover,” to configure the failover link.
If you change the security level of an interface, and you do not want to wait for existing connections to
time out before the new security information is used, you can clear the connections using the
clear local-host command.
To remove this VLAN interface and all associated configuration, enter the no interface vlan command.
Because this interface also includes the interface name configuration, and the name is used in other
commands, those commands are also removed.
Step 2 (Optional) For the Base license, allow this interface to be the third VLAN by limiting it from initiating
contact to one other VLAN using the following command:
hostname(config-if)# no forward interface vlan number
Where number specifies the VLAN ID to which this VLAN interface cannot initiate traffic.
With the Base license, you can only configure a third VLAN if you use this command to limit it.
For example, you have one VLAN assigned to the outside for Internet access, one VLAN assigned to an
inside business network, and a third VLAN assigned to your home network. The home network does not
need to access the business network, so you can use the no forward interface command on the home
VLAN; the business network can access the home network, but the home network cannot access the
business network.
If you already have two VLAN interfaces configured with a nameif command, be sure to enter the no
forward interface command before the nameif command on the third interface; the adaptive security
appliance does not allow three fully functioning VLAN interfaces with the Base license on the ASA 5505
adaptive security appliance.
Note If you upgrade to the Security Plus license, you can remove this command and achieve full
functionality for this interface. If you leave this command in place, this interface continues to be
limited even after upgrading.
Step 3 (Optional) For the Security Plus license, allow the use of a fourth VLAN by specifying a VLAN as a
backup ISP link to this interface by using the following command:
hostname(config-if)# backup interface vlan number
You can configure up to five VLANs with the Security Plus license. You can configure three VLAN
interfaces for normal traffic, one VLAN interface for failover, and one VLAN interface as a backup link
to your ISP. The backup link to the ISP must be identified by the backup interface command. The
backup interface does not pass through traffic unless the default route through the primary interface fails.
To ensure that traffic can pass over the backup interface in case the primary fails, be sure to configure
default routes on both the primary and backup interfaces so that the backup interface can be used when
the primary fails. For example, you can configure two default routes: one for the primary interface with
a lower administrative distance, and one for the backup interface with a higher distance. To configure
dual ISP support, see the “Configuring Static Route Tracking” section on page 9-3.
Step 4 To name the interface, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# nameif name
The name is a text string up to 48 characters, and is not case-sensitive. You can change the name by
reentering this command with a new value. Do not enter the no form, because that command causes all
commands that refer to that name to be deleted.
Step 5 To set the security level, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# security-level number
Note To set an IPv6 address, see the “Configuring IPv6 on an Interface” section on page 12-3.
To set the management IP address for transparent firewall mode, see the “Setting the
Management IP Address for a Transparent Firewall” section on page 8-5. In transparent mode,
you do not set the IP address for each interface, but rather for the whole adaptive security
appliance or context.
For failover, you must set the IP address an standby address manually; DHCP and PPPoE are not
supported.
The standby keyword and address is used for failover. See Chapter 14, “Configuring Failover,” for
more information.
• To obtain an IP address from a DHCP server, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# ip address dhcp [setroute]
Reenter this command to reset the DHCP lease and request a new lease.
If you do not enable the interface using the no shutdown command before you enter the ip address
dhcp command, some DHCP requests might not be sent.
• To obtain an IP address from a PPPoE server, see Chapter 35, “Configuring the PPPoE Client.”
Step 7 (Optional) To assign a private MAC address to this interface, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# mac-address mac_address [standby mac_address]
By default in routed mode, all VLANs use the same MAC address. In transparent mode, the VLANs use
unique MAC addresses. You might want to set unique VLANs or change the generated VLANs if your
switch requires it, or for access control purposes.
Step 8 (Optional) To set an interface to management-only mode, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# management-only
If this VLAN is your third VLAN, and you do not want to allow through traffic, you can limit
to-the-adaptive security appliance traffic using this command.
Step 9 By default, VLAN interfaces are enabled. To enable the interface, if it is not already enabled, enter the
following command:
hostname(config-if)# no shutdown
The following example configures five VLAN interfaces. The fourth backup-isp interface only allows
through traffic when the primary interface is down. The fifth faillink VLAN interface is for failover.
hostname(config)# interface vlan 100
hostname(config-if)# nameif outside
hostname(config-if)# security-level 0
hostname(config-if)# ip address 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.0
hostname(config-if)# backup interface vlan 400
hostname(config-if)# no shutdown
The following example configures three VLAN interfaces for the Base license. The third home interface
cannot forward traffic to the business interface.
hostname(config)# interface vlan 100
hostname(config-if)# nameif outside
hostname(config-if)# security-level 0
hostname(config-if)# ip address dhcp
hostname(config-if)# no shutdown
Caution The ASA 5505 adaptive security appliance does not support Spanning Tree Protocol for loop detection
in the network. Therefore you must ensure that any connection with the adaptive security appliance does
not end up in a network loop.
Step 1 To specify the switch port you want to configure, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# interface ethernet0/port
Step 2 To assign this switch port to a VLAN, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# switchport access vlan number
You might want to prevent switch ports from communicating with each other if the devices on those
switch ports are primarily accessed from other VLANs, you do not need to allow intra-VLAN access,
and you want to isolate the devices from each other in case of infection or other security breach. For
example, if you have a DMZ that hosts three web servers, you can isolate the web servers from each other
if you apply the switchport protected command to each switch port. The inside and outside networks
can both communicate with all three web servers, and vice versa, but the web servers cannot
communicate with each other.
Step 4 (Optional) To set the speed, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# speed {auto | 10 | 100}
The auto setting is the default. If you set the speed to anything other than auto on PoE ports Ethernet
0/6 or 0/7, then Cisco IP phones and Cisco wireless access points that do not support IEEE 802.3af will
not be detected and supplied with power.
Step 5 (Optional) To set the duplex, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# duplex {auto | full | half}
The auto setting is the default. If you set the duplex to anything other than auto on PoE ports Ethernet
0/6 or 0/7, then Cisco IP phones and Cisco wireless access points that do not support IEEE 802.3af will
not be detected and supplied with power.
Step 6 To enable the switch port, if it is not already enabled, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# no shutdown
The following example configures five VLAN interfaces. The fourth backup-isp interface only allows
through traffic when the primary interface is down. The fifth faillink VLAN interface is for failover.
hostname(config)# interface vlan 100
hostname(config-if)# nameif outside
hostname(config-if)# security-level 0
hostname(config-if)# ip address 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.0
hostname(config-if)# backup interface vlan 400
hostname(config-if)# no shutdown
Note You might assign multiple switch ports to the primary or backup VLANs if the Internet access device
includes Layer 2 redundancy.
Step 1 To specify the switch port you want to configure, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# interface ethernet0/port
Where number1, 2, or 3 identifies up to three VLAN IDs, separated by spaces, that you can assign to the
trunk port. The VLAN ID is between 1 and 1001.
This switch port cannot pass traffic until you assign at least one VLAN to it. Trunk ports do not support
untagged packets; there is no native VLAN support, and the adaptive security appliance drops all packets
that do not contain a tag specified in this command.
Step 3 To make this switch port a trunk port, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# switchport mode trunk
To restore this port to access mode, enter the switchport mode access command.
Step 4 (Optional) To prevent the switch port from communicating with other protected switch ports on the same
VLAN, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# switchport protected
You might want to prevent switch ports from communicating with each other if the devices on those
switch ports are primarily accessed from other VLANs, you do not need to allow intra-VLAN access,
and you want to isolate the devices from each other in case of infection or other security breach. For
example, if you have a DMZ that hosts three web servers, you can isolate the web servers from each other
if you apply the switchport protected command to each switch port. The inside and outside networks
can both communicate with all three web servers, and vice versa, but the web servers cannot
communicate with each other.
Step 5 (Optional) To set the speed, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# speed {auto | 10 | 100}
The following example configures three VLAN interfaces. The third home interface cannot forward
traffic to the business interface. The home and business VLANs are assigned to a trunk port on Ethernet
0/1.
hostname(config)# interface vlan 100
hostname(config-if)# nameif outside
hostname(config-if)# security-level 0
hostname(config-if)# ip address dhcp
hostname(config-if)# no shutdown
Note If you enable NAT control, you do not need to configure NAT between same security level interfaces.
See the “NAT and Same Security Level Interfaces” section on page 17-12 for more information on NAT
and same security level interfaces.
If you enable same security interface communication, you can still configure interfaces at different
security levels as usual.
To enable interfaces on the same security level so that they can communicate with each other, enter the
following command:
hostname(config)# same-security-traffic permit inter-interface
This chapter describes how to configure and enable physical Ethernet interfaces and how to add
subinterfaces. If you have both fiber and copper Ethernet ports (for example, on the 4GE SSM for the
ASA 5510 and higher series adaptive security appliance), this chapter describes how to configure the
inteface media type.
In single context mode, complete the procedures in this chapter and then continue your interface
configuration in Chapter 7, “Configuring Interface Parameters.” In multiple context mode, complete the
procedures in this chapter in the system execution space, then assign interfaces and subinterfaces to
contexts according to Chapter 6, “Adding and Managing Security Contexts,” and finally configure the
interface parameters within each context according to Chapter 7, “Configuring Interface Parameters.”
Note To configure interfaces for the ASA 5505 adaptive security appliance, see Chapter 4, “Configuring
Switch Ports and VLAN Interfaces for the Cisco ASA 5505 Adaptive Security Appliance.”
phase. Either the speed or duplex must be set to auto-negotiate to enable Auto-MDI/MDIX for the
interface. If you explicitly set both the speed and duplex to a fixed value, thus disabling auto-negotiation
for both settings, then Auto-MDI/MDIX is also disabled.
To enable the interface, or to set a specific speed and duplex, perform the following steps:
Step 1 To specify the interface you want to configure, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# interface physical_interface
The physical_interface ID includes the type, slot, and port number as type[slot/]port.
The physical interface types include the following:
• ethernet
• gigabitethernet
For the PIX 500 series security appliance, enter the type followed by the port number, for example,
ethernet0.
For the ASA 5500 series adaptive security appliance, enter the type followed by slot/port, for example,
gigabitethernet0/1. Interfaces that are built into the chassis are assigned to slot 0, while interfaces on
the 4GE SSM are assigned to slot 1.
The ASA 5500 series adaptive security appliance also includes the following type:
• management
The management interface is a Fast Ethernet interface designed for management traffic only, and is
specified as management0/0. You can, however, use it for through traffic if desired (see the
management-only command). In transparent firewall mode, you can use the management interface
in addition to the two interfaces allowed for through traffic. You can also add subinterfaces to the
management interface to provide management in each security context for multiple context mode.
Step 2 (Optional) To set the speed, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# speed {auto | 10 | 100 | 1000 | nonegotiate}
The auto setting is the default. The speed nonegotiate command disables link negotiation.
Step 3 (Optional) To set the duplex, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# duplex {auto | full | half}
To disable the interface, enter the shutdown command. If you enter the shutdown command for a
physical interface, you also shut down all subinterfaces. If you shut down an interface in the system
execution space, then that interface is shut down in all contexts that share it.
physical interface or subinterface to a context, the interfaces are enabled by default in the context.
However, before traffic can pass through the context interface, you must also enable the interface in the
system configuration according to this procedure.
By default, the connectors used on the 4GE SSM or for built-in interfaces in slot 1 on the ASA 5550
adaptive security appliance are the RJ-45 connectors. To use the fiber SFP connectors, you must set the
media type to SFP. The fiber interface has a fixed speed and does not support duplex, but you can set the
interface to negotiate link parameters (the default) or not to negotiate.
To enable the interface, set the media type, or to set negotiation settings, perform the following steps:
Step 1 To specify the interface you want to configure, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# interface gigabitethernet 1/port
The 4GE SSM interfaces are assigned to slot 1, as shown in the interface ID in the syntax (the interfaces
built into the chassis are assigned to slot 0).
Step 2 To set the media type to SFP, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# media-type sfp
For fiber Gigabit Ethernet interfaces, the default is no speed nonegotiate, which sets the speed to 1000
Mbps and enables link negotiation for flow-control parameters and remote fault information. The speed
nonegotiate command disables link negotiation.
Step 4 To enable the interface, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# no shutdown
To disable the interface, enter the shutdown command. If you enter the shutdown command for a
physical interface, you also shut down all subinterfaces. If you shut down an interface in the system
execution space, then that interface is shut down in all contexts that share it.
Note If you use subinterfaces, you typically do not also want the physical interface to pass traffic, because the
physical interface passes untagged packets. Because the physical interface must be enabled for the
subinterface to pass traffic, ensure that the physical interface does not pass traffic by leaving out the
nameif command. If you want to let the physical interface pass untagged packets, you can configure the
nameif command as usual. See the “Configuring Interface Parameters” section on page 7-1 for more
information about completing the interface configuration.
To add a subinterface and assign a VLAN to it, perform the following steps:
See the “Configuring and Enabling RJ-45 Interfaces” section for a description of the physical interface
ID.
The subinterface ID is an integer between 1 and 4294967293.
For example, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# interface gigabitethernet0/1.100
Step 2 To specify the VLAN for the subinterface, enter the following command:
hostname(config-subif)# vlan vlan_id
The vlan_id is an integer between 1 and 4094. Some VLAN IDs might be reserved on connected
switches, so check the switch documentation for more information.
You can only assign a single VLAN to a subinterface, and not to the physical interface. Each subinterface
must have a VLAN ID before it can pass traffic. To change a VLAN ID, you do not need to remove the
old VLAN ID with the no option; you can enter the vlan command with a different VLAN ID, and the
security appliance changes the old ID.
Step 3 To enable the subinterface, enter the following command:
hostname(config-subif)# no shutdown
To disable the interface, enter the shutdown command. If you shut down an interface in the system
execution space, then that interface is shut down in all contexts that share it.
This chapter describes how to configure multiple security contexts on the security appliance, and
includes the following sections:
• Configuring Resource Management, page 6-1
• Configuring a Security Context, page 6-7
• Automatically Assigning MAC Addresses to Context Interfaces, page 6-11
• Changing Between Contexts and the System Execution Space, page 6-11
• Managing Security Contexts, page 6-12
For information about how contexts work and how to enable multiple context mode, see Chapter 3,
“Enabling Multiple Context Mode.”
Resource Limits
When you create a class, the security appliance does not set aside a portion of the resources for each
context assigned to the class; rather, the security appliance sets the maximum limit for a context. If you
oversubscribe resources, or allow some resources to be unlimited, a few contexts can “use up” those
resources, potentially affecting service to other contexts.
You can set the limit for individual resources, as a percentage (if there is a hard system limit) or as an
absolute value.
You can oversubscribe the security appliance by assigning more than 100 percent of a resource across
all contexts. For example, you can set the Bronze class to limit connections to 20 percent per context,
and then assign 10 contexts to the class for a total of 200 percent. If contexts concurrently use more than
the system limit, then each context gets less than the 20 percent you intended. (See Figure 6-1.)
104895
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Contexts in Class
If you assign an absolute value to a resource across all contexts that exceeds the practical limit of the
security appliance, then the performance of the security appliance might be impaired.
The security appliance lets you assign unlimited access to one or more resources in a class, instead of a
percentage or absolute number. When a resource is unlimited, contexts can use as much of the resource
as the system has available or that is practically available. For example, Context A, B, and C are in the
Silver Class, which limits each class member to 1 percent of the connections, for a total of 3 percent; but
the three contexts are currently only using 2 percent combined. Gold Class has unlimited access to
connections. The contexts in the Gold Class can use more than the 97 percent of “unassigned”
connections; they can also use the 1 percent of connections not currently in use by Context A, B, and C,
even if that means that Context A, B, and C are unable to reach their 3 percent combined limit. (See
Figure 6-2.) Setting unlimited access is similar to oversubscribing the security appliance, except that you
have less control over how much you oversubscribe the system.
50% 43%
5%
Maximum connections
allowed.
4%
Connections in use.
3%
Connections denied
2% because system limit
was reached.
1%
153211
A B C 1 2 3
Contexts Silver Class Contexts Gold Class
Default Class
All contexts belong to the default class if they are not assigned to another class; you do not have to
actively assign a context to the default class.
If a context belongs to a class other than the default class, those class settings always override the default
class settings. However, if the other class has any settings that are not defined, then the member context
uses the default class for those limits. For example, if you create a class with a 2 percent limit for all
concurrent connections, but no other limits, then all other limits are inherited from the default class.
Conversely, if you create a class with a limit for all resources, the class uses no settings from the default
class.
By default, the default class provides unlimited access to resources for all contexts, except for the
following limits, which are by default set to the maximum allowed per context:
• Telnet sessions—5 sessions.
• SSH sessions—5 sessions.
• IPSec sessions—5 sessions.
• MAC addresses—65,535 entries.
Figure 6-3 shows the relationship between the default class and other classes. Contexts A and C belong
to classes with some limits set; other limits are inherited from the default class. Context B inherits no
limits from default because all limits are set in its class, the Gold class. Context D was not assigned to
a class, and is by default a member of the default class.
Context C
104689
Context B
Class Members
To use the settings of a class, assign the context to the class when you define the context. All contexts
belong to the default class if they are not assigned to another class; you do not have to actively assign a
context to default. You can only assign a context to one resource class. The exception to this rule is that
limits that are undefined in the member class are inherited from the default class; so in effect, a context
could be a member of default plus another class.
Configuring a Class
To configure a class in the system configuration, perform the following steps. You can change the value
of a particular resource limit by reentering the command with a new value.
Step 1 To specify the class name and enter the class configuration mode, enter the following command in the
system execution space:
hostname(config)# class name
The name is a string up to 20 characters long. To set the limits for the default class, enter default for the
name.
Step 2 To set the resource limits, see the following options:
• To set all resource limits (shown in Table 6-1) to be unlimited, enter the following command:
hostname(config-resmgmt)# limit-resource all 0
For example, you might want to create a class that includes the admin context that has no limitations.
The default class has all resources set to unlimited by default.
• To set a particular resource limit, enter the following command:
hostname(config-resmgmt)# limit-resource [rate] resource_name number[%]
For this particular resource, the limit overrides the limit set for all. Enter the rate argument to set
the rate per second for certain resources. For resources that do not have a system limit, you cannot
set the percentage (%) between 1 and 100; you can only set an absolute value. See Table 6-1 for
resources for which you can set the rate per second and which to not have a system limit.
Table 6-1 lists the resource types and the limits. See also the show resource types command.
Minimum and
Rate or Maximum Number
Resource Name Concurrent per Context System Limit1 Description
mac-addresses Concurrent N/A 65,535 For transparent firewall mode, the number of
MAC addresses allowed in the MAC address
table.
conns Concurrent N/A Concurrent connections: TCP or UDP connections between any two
or Rate See the “Supported hosts, including connections between one
Platforms and Feature host and multiple other hosts.
Licenses” section on
page A-1 for the
connection limit for your
platform.
Rate: N/A
inspects Rate N/A N/A Application inspections.
hosts Concurrent N/A N/A Hosts that can connect through the security
appliance.
asdm Concurrent 1 minimum 32 ASDM management sessions.
5 maximum Note ASDM sessions use two HTTPS
connections: one for monitoring that
is always present, and one for making
configuration changes that is present
only when you make changes. For
example, the system limit of 32
ASDM sessions represents a limit of
64 HTTPS sessions.
ssh Concurrent 1 minimum 100 SSH sessions.
5 maximum
syslogs Rate N/A N/A System log messages.
telnet Concurrent 1 minimum 100 Telnet sessions.
5 maximum
xlates Concurrent N/A N/A Address translations.
1. If this column value is N/A, then you cannot set a percentage of the resource because there is no hard system limit for the resource.
For example, to set the default class limit for conns to 10 percent instead of unlimited, enter the
following commands:
hostname(config)# class default
hostname(config-class)# limit-resource conns 10%
Note If you do not have an admin context (for example, if you clear the configuration) then you must first
specify the admin context name by entering the following command:
Although this context name does not exist yet in your configuration, you can subsequently enter the
context name command to match the specified name to continue the admin context configuration.
To add or change a context in the system configuration, perform the following steps:
Step 1 To add or modify a context, enter the following command in the system execution space:
hostname(config)# context name
The name is a string up to 32 characters long. This name is case sensitive, so you can have two contexts
named “customerA” and “CustomerA,” for example. You can use letters, digits, or hyphens, but you
cannot start or end the name with a hyphen.
“System” or “Null” (in upper or lower case letters) are reserved names, and cannot be used.
Step 2 (Optional) To add a description for this context, enter the following command:
hostname(config-ctx)# description text
Step 3 To specify the interfaces you can use in the context, enter the command appropriate for a physical
interface or for one or more subinterfaces.
• To allocate a physical interface, enter the following command:
hostname(config-ctx)# allocate-interface physical_interface [map_name]
[visible | invisible]
You can enter these commands multiple times to specify different ranges. If you remove an allocation
with the no form of this command, then any context commands that include this interface are removed
from the running configuration.
Transparent firewall mode allows only two interfaces to pass through traffic; however, on the ASA
adaptive security appliance, you can use the dedicated management interface, Management 0/0, (either
the physical interface or a subinterface) as a third interface for management traffic.
Note The management interface for transparent mode does not flood a packet out the interface when that
packet is not in the MAC address table.
You can assign the same interfaces to multiple contexts in routed mode, if desired. Transparent mode
does not allow shared interfaces.
The map_name is an alphanumeric alias for the interface that can be used within the context instead of
the interface ID. If you do not specify a mapped name, the interface ID is used within the context. For
security purposes, you might not want the context administrator to know which interfaces are being used
by the context.
A mapped name must start with a letter, end with a letter or digit, and have as interior characters only
letters, digits, or an underscore. For example, you can use the following names:
int0
inta
int_0
Step 4 To identify the URL from which the system downloads the context configuration, enter the following
command:
hostname(config-ctx)# config-url url
When you add a context URL, the system immediately loads the context so that it is running, if the
configuration is available.
Note Enter the allocate-interface command(s) before you enter the config-url command. The security
appliance must assign interfaces to the context before it loads the context configuration; the context
configuration might include commands that refer to interfaces (interface, nat, global...). If you enter the
config-url command first, the security appliance loads the context configuration immediately. If the
context contains any commands that refer to interfaces, those commands fail.
You can then change to the context, configure it at the CLI, and enter the write memory command
to write the file to Flash memory.
Note The admin context file must be stored on the internal Flash memory.
• ftp://[user[:password]@]server[:port]/[path/]filename[;type=xx]
The type can be one of the following keywords:
– ap—ASCII passive mode
– an—ASCII normal mode
– ip—(Default) Binary passive mode
– in—Binary normal mode
The server must be accessible from the admin context. The filename does not require a file
extension, although we recommend using “.cfg”. If the configuration file is not available, you see
the following message:
WARNING: Could not fetch the URL ftp://url
INFO: Creating context with default config
You can then change to the context, configure it at the CLI, and enter the write memory command
to write the file to the FTP server.
• http[s]://[user[:password]@]server[:port]/[path/]filename
The server must be accessible from the admin context. The filename does not require a file
extension, although we recommend using “.cfg”. If the configuration file is not available, you see
the following message:
WARNING: Could not fetch the URL http://url
INFO: Creating context with default config
If you change to the context and configure the context at the CLI, you cannot save changes back to
HTTP or HTTPS servers using the write memory command. You can, however, use the copy tftp
command to copy the running configuration to a TFTP server.
• tftp://[user[:password]@]server[:port]/[path/]filename[;int=interface_name]
The server must be accessible from the admin context. Specify the interface name if you want to
override the route to the server address. The filename does not require a file extension, although we
recommend using “.cfg”. If the configuration file is not available, you see the following message:
WARNING: Could not fetch the URL tftp://url
INFO: Creating context with default config
You can then change to the context, configure it at the CLI, and enter the write memory command
to write the file to the TFTP server.
To change the URL, reenter the config-url command with a new URL.
See the “Changing the Security Context URL” section on page 6-13 for more information about
changing the URL.
For example, enter the following command:
hostname(config-ctx)# config-url ftp://joe:[email protected]/configlets/test.cfg
Step 5 (Optional) To assign the context to a resource class, enter the following command:
hostname(config-ctx)# member class_name
If you do not specify a class, the context belongs to the default class. You can only assign a context to
one resource class.
For example, to assign the context to the gold class, enter the following command:
hostname(config-ctx)# member gold
Step 6 To view context information, see the show context command in the Cisco Security Appliance Command
Reference.
The following example sets the admin context to be “administrator,” creates a context called
“administrator” on the internal Flash memory, and then adds two contexts from an FTP server:
hostname(config)# admin-context administrator
hostname(config)# context administrator
hostname(config-ctx)# allocate-interface gigabitethernet0/0.1
hostname(config-ctx)# allocate-interface gigabitethernet0/1.1
hostname(config-ctx)# config-url flash:/admin.cfg
For use with failover, the security appliance generates both an active and standby MAC address for each
interface. If the active unit fails over and the standby unit becomes active, the new active unit starts using
the active MAC addresses to minimize network disruption.
When you assign an interface to a context, the new MAC address is generated immediately. If you enable
this command after you create context interfaces, then MAC addresses are generated for all interfaces
immediately after you enter the command. If you use the no mac-address auto command, the MAC
address for each interface reverts to the default MAC address. For example, subinterfaces of
GigabitEthernet 0/1 revert to using the MAC address of GigabitEthernet 0/1.
The MAC address is generated using the following format:
• Active unit MAC address: 12_slot.port_subid.contextid.
• Standby unit MAC address: 02_slot.port_subid.contextid.
For platforms with no interface slots, the slot is always 0. The port is the interface port. The subid is an
internal ID for the subinterface, which is not viewable. The contextid is an internal ID for the context,
viewable with the show context detail command. For example, the interface GigabitEthernet 0/1.200 in
the context with the ID 1 has the following generated MAC addresses, where the internal ID for
subinterface 200 is 31:
• Active: 1200.0131.0001
• Standby: 0200.0131.0001
In the rare circumstance that the generated MAC address conflicts with another private MAC address in
your network, you can manually set the MAC address for the interface within the context. See the
“Configuring the Interface” section on page 7-2 to manually set the MAC address.
depends on your location. When you are in the system execution space, the running configuration
consists only of the system configuration; when you are in a context, the running configuration consists
only of that context. For example, you cannot view all running configurations (system plus all contexts)
by entering the show running-config command. Only the current configuration displays.
To change between the system execution space and a context, or between contexts, see the following
commands:
• To change to a context, enter the following command:
hostname# changeto context name
Note If you use failover, there is a delay between when you remove the context on the active unit and when
the context is removed on the standby unit. You might see an error message indicating that the number
of interfaces on the active and standby units are not consistent; this error is temporary and can be
ignored.
Any remote management sessions, such as Telnet, SSH, or HTTPS, that are connected to the admin
context are terminated. You must reconnect to the new admin context.
Note A few system commands, including ntp server, identify an interface name that belongs to the admin
context. If you change the admin context, and that interface name does not exist in the new admin
context, be sure to update any system commands that refer to the interface.
Step 1 If you do not want to merge the configuration, change to the context and clear its configuration by
entering the following commands. If you want to perform a merge, skip to Step 2.
hostname# changeto context name
hostname/name# configure terminal
hostname/name(config)# clear configure all
Step 2 If required, change to the system execution space by entering the following command:
hostname/name(config)# changeto system
Step 3 To enter the context configuration mode for the context you want to change, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# context name
Step 1 To change to the context that you want to reload, enter the following command:
hostname# changeto context name
The security appliance copies the configuration from the URL specified in the system configuration. You
cannot change the URL from within a context.
The detail option shows additional information. See the following sample displays below for more
information.
If you want to show information for a particular context, specify the name.
The count option shows the total number of contexts.
The following is sample output from the show context command. The following sample display shows
three contexts:
hostname# show context
Field Description
Context Name Lists all context names. The context name with the asterisk (*) is the admin context.
Interfaces The interfaces assigned to the context.
URL The URL from which the security appliance loads the context configuration.
The following is sample output from the show context detail command:
hostname# show context detail
Context "admin", has been created, but initial ACL rules not complete
Config URL: disk0:/admin.cfg
Real Interfaces: Management0/0
Mapped Interfaces: Management0/0
Flags: 0x00000013, ID: 1
Context "ctx", has been created, but initial ACL rules not complete
Config URL: ctx.cfg
Real Interfaces: GigabitEthernet0/0.10, GigabitEthernet0/1.20,
GigabitEthernet0/2.30
Mapped Interfaces: int1, int2, int3
Flags: 0x00000011, ID: 2
See the Cisco Security Appliance Command Reference for more information about the detail output.
The following is sample output from the show context count command:
hostname# show context count
Total active contexts: 2
This command shows the resource allocation, but does not show the actual resources being used. See the
“Viewing Resource Usage” section on page 6-19 for more information about actual resource usage.
The detail argument shows additional information. See the following sample displays for more
information.
The following sample display shows the total allocation of each resource as an absolute value and as a
percentage of the available system resources:
hostname# show resource allocation
Resource Total % of Avail
Conns [rate] 35000 N/A
Inspects [rate] 35000 N/A
Syslogs [rate] 10500 N/A
Conns 305000 30.50%
Hosts 78842 N/A
SSH 35 35.00%
Telnet 35 35.00%
Xlates 91749 N/A
All unlimited
Field Description
Resource The name of the resource that you can limit.
Total The total amount of the resource that is allocated across all contexts. The amount
is an absolute number of concurrent instances or instances per second. If you
specified a percentage in the class definition, the security appliance converts the
percentage to an absolute number for this display.
% of Avail The percentage of the total system resources that is allocated across all contexts, if
the resource has a hard system limit. If a resource does not have a system limit, this
column shows N/A.
The following is sample output from the show resource allocation detail command:
hostname# show resource allocation detail
Resource Origin:
A Value was derived from the resource 'all'
C Value set in the definition of this class
D Value set in default class
Resource Class Mmbrs Origin Limit Total Total %
Conns [rate] default all CA unlimited
gold 1 C 34000 34000 N/A
silver 1 CA 17000 17000 N/A
bronze 0 CA 8500
All Contexts: 3 51000 N/A
silver 1 CA 10 10 10.00%
bronze 0 CA 5
All Contexts: 3 20 20.00%
Field Description
Resource The name of the resource that you can limit.
Class The name of each class, including the default class.
The All contexts field shows the total values across all classes.
Mmbrs The number of contexts assigned to each class.
Origin The origin of the resource limit, as follows:
• A—You set this limit with the all option, instead of as an individual resource.
• C—This limit is derived from the member class.
• D—This limit was not defined in the member class, but was derived from the
default class. For a context assigned to the default class, the value will be “C”
instead of “D.”
The security appliance can combine “A” with “C” or “D.”
Limit The limit of the resource per context, as an absolute number. If you specified a
percentage in the class definition, the security appliance converts the percentage to
an absolute number for this display.
Total The total amount of the resource that is allocated across all contexts in the class.
The amount is an absolute number of concurrent instances or instances per second.
If the resource is unlimited, this display is blank.
% of Avail The percentage of the total system resources that is allocated across all contexts in
the class. If the resource is unlimited, this display is blank. If the resource does not
have a system limit, then this column shows N/A.
The following is sample output from the show resource usage context command, which shows the
resource usage for the admin context:
hostname# show resource usage context admin
The following is sample output from the show resource usage summary command, which shows the
resource usage for all contexts and all resources. This sample shows the limits for 6 contexts.
hostname# show resource usage summary
The following is sample output from the show resource usage summary command, which shows the
limits for 25 contexts. Because the context limit for Telnet and SSH connections is 5 per context, then
the combined limit is 125. The system limit is only 100, so the system limit is shown.
hostname# show resource usage summary
The following is sample output from the show resource usage system command, which shows the
resource usage for all contexts, but it shows the system limit instead of the combined context limits. The
counter all 0 option is used to show resources that are not currently in use. The Denied statistics indicate
how many times the resource was denied due to the system limit, if available.
hostname# show resource usage system counter all 0
Context:admin
PERFMON STATS: Current Average
Xlates 0/s 0/s
The following is sample output from the show resource usage detail command that shows the amount
of resources being used by TCP Intercept for individual contexts. (Sample text in italics shows the TCP
intercept information.)
hostname(config)# show resource usage detail
Resource Current Peak Limit Denied Context
memory 843732 847288 unlimited 0 admin
chunk:channels 14 15 unlimited 0 admin
chunk:fixup 15 15 unlimited 0 admin
chunk:hole 1 1 unlimited 0 admin
chunk:ip-users 10 10 unlimited 0 admin
chunk:list-elem 21 21 unlimited 0 admin
chunk:list-hdr 3 4 unlimited 0 admin
chunk:route 2 2 unlimited 0 admin
chunk:static 1 1 unlimited 0 admin
tcp-intercepts 328787 803610 unlimited 0 admin
np-statics 3 3 unlimited 0 admin
statics 1 1 unlimited 0 admin
ace-rules 1 1 unlimited 0 admin
console-access-rul 2 2 unlimited 0 admin
fixup-rules 14 15 unlimited 0 admin
memory 959872 960000 unlimited 0 c1
chunk:channels 15 16 unlimited 0 c1
chunk:dbgtrace 1 1 unlimited 0 c1
chunk:fixup 15 15 unlimited 0 c1
chunk:global 1 1 unlimited 0 c1
chunk:hole 2 2 unlimited 0 c1
chunk:ip-users 10 10 unlimited 0 c1
chunk:udp-ctrl-blk 1 1 unlimited 0 c1
chunk:list-elem 24 24 unlimited 0 c1
chunk:list-hdr 5 6 unlimited 0 c1
chunk:nat 1 1 unlimited 0 c1
chunk:route 2 2 unlimited 0 c1
chunk:static 1 1 unlimited 0 c1
tcp-intercept-rate 16056 16254 unlimited 0 c1
globals 1 1 unlimited 0 c1
np-statics 3 3 unlimited 0 c1
statics 1 1 unlimited 0 c1
nats 1 1 unlimited 0 c1
ace-rules 2 2 unlimited 0 c1
console-access-rul 2 2 unlimited 0 c1
fixup-rules 14 15 unlimited 0 c1
memory 232695716 232020648 unlimited 0 system
chunk:channels 17 20 unlimited 0 system
chunk:dbgtrace 3 3 unlimited 0 system
chunk:fixup 15 15 unlimited 0 system
chunk:ip-users 4 4 unlimited 0 system
chunk:list-elem 1014 1014 unlimited 0 system
chunk:list-hdr 1 1 unlimited 0 system
chunk:route 1 1 unlimited 0 system
The following sample output shows the resources being used by TCP intercept for the entire system.
(Sample text in italics shows the TCP intercept information.)
hostname(config)# show resource usage summary detail
Resource Current Peak Limit Denied Context
memory 238421312 238434336 unlimited 0 Summary
chunk:channels 46 48 unlimited 0 Summary
chunk:dbgtrace 4 4 unlimited 0 Summary
chunk:fixup 45 45 unlimited 0 Summary
chunk:global 1 1 unlimited 0 Summary
chunk:hole 3 3 unlimited 0 Summary
chunk:ip-users 24 24 unlimited 0 Summary
chunk:udp-ctrl-blk 1 1 unlimited 0 Summary
chunk:list-elem 1059 1059 unlimited 0 Summary
chunk:list-hdr 10 11 unlimited 0 Summary
chunk:nat 1 1 unlimited 0 Summary
chunk:route 5 5 unlimited 0 Summary
chunk:static 2 2 unlimited 0 Summary
block:16384 510 885 unlimited 0 Summary
block:2048 32 35 unlimited 0 Summary
tcp-intercept-rate 341306 811579 unlimited 0 Summary
globals 1 1 unlimited 0 Summary
np-statics 6 6 unlimited 0 Summary
statics 2 2 N/A 0 Summary
nats 1 1 N/A 0 Summary
ace-rules 3 3 N/A 0 Summary
console-access-rul 4 4 N/A 0 Summary
fixup-rules 43 44 N/A 0 Summary
This chapter describes how to configure each interface and subinterface for a name, security level, and
IP address. For single context mode, the procedures in this chapter continue the interface configuration
started in Chapter 5, “Configuring Ethernet Settings and Subinterfaces.” For multiple context mode, the
procedures in Chapter 5, “Configuring Ethernet Settings and Subinterfaces,” are performed in the
system execution space, while the procedures in this chapter are performed within each security context.
Note To configure interfaces for the ASA 5505 adaptive security appliance, see Chapter 4, “Configuring
Switch Ports and VLAN Interfaces for the Cisco ASA 5505 Adaptive Security Appliance.”
• Filtering—HTTP(S) and FTP filtering applies only for outbound connections (from a higher level
to a lower level).
For same security interfaces, you can filter traffic in either direction.
• NAT control—When you enable NAT control, you must configure NAT for hosts on a higher security
interface (inside) when they access hosts on a lower security interface (outside).
Without NAT control, or for same security interfaces, you can choose to use NAT between any
interface, or you can choose not to use NAT. Keep in mind that configuring NAT for an outside
interface might require a special keyword.
• established command—This command allows return connections from a lower security host to a
higher security host if there is already an established connection from the higher level host to the
lower level host.
For same security interfaces, you can configure established commands for both directions.
Note If you are using failover, do not use this procedure to name interfaces that you are reserving for failover
and Stateful Failover communications. See Chapter 14, “Configuring Failover.” to configure the failover
and state links.
Note If you change the security level of an interface, and you do not want to wait for existing connections to
time out before the new security information is used, you can clear the connections using the
clear local-host command.
Step 1 To specify the interface you want to configure, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# interface {physical_interface[.subinterface] | mapped_name}
The physical_interface ID includes the type, slot, and port number as type[slot/]port.
The physical interface types include the following:
• ethernet
• gigabitethernet
For the PIX 500 series security appliance, enter the type followed by the port number, for example,
ethernet0.
For the ASA 5500 series adaptive security appliance, enter the type followed by slot/port, for example,
gigabitethernet0/1. Interfaces that are built into the chassis are assigned to slot 0, while interfaces on
the 4GE SSM are assigned to slot 1. For the ASA 5550 adaptive security appliance, for maximum
throughput, be sure to balance your traffic over the two interface slots; for example, assign the inside
interface to slot 1 and the outside interface to slot 0.
The ASA 5510 and higher adaptive security appliance also includes the following type:
• management
The management interface is a Fast Ethernet interface designed for management traffic only, and is
specified as management0/0. You can, however, use it for through traffic if desired (see the
management-only command). In transparent firewall mode, you can use the management interface
in addition to the two interfaces allowed for through traffic. You can also add subinterfaces to the
management interface to provide management in each security context for multiple context mode.
Append the subinterface ID to the physical interface ID separated by a period (.).
In multiple context mode, enter the mapped name if one was assigned using the allocate-interface
command.
For example, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# interface gigabitethernet0/1.1
The name is a text string up to 48 characters, and is not case-sensitive. You can change the name by
reentering this command with a new value. Do not enter the no form, because that command causes all
commands that refer to that name to be deleted.
Step 3 To set the security level, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# security-level number
The ASA 5510 and higher adaptive security appliance includes a dedicated management interface called
Management 0/0, which is meant to support traffic to the security appliance. However, you can configure
any interface to be a management-only interface using the management-only command. Also, for
Management 0/0, you can disable management-only mode so the interface can pass through traffic just
like any other interface.
Note Transparent firewall mode allows only two interfaces to pass through traffic; however, on the
The ASA 5510 and higher adaptive security appliance, you can use the Management 0/0
interface (either the physical interface or a subinterface) as a third interface for management
traffic. The mode is not configurable in this case and must always be management-only.
The standby keyword and address is used for failover. See Chapter 14, “Configuring Failover,” for
more information.
• To obtain an IP address from a DHCP server, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# ip address dhcp [setroute]
Reenter this command to reset the DHCP lease and request a new lease.
If you do not enable the interface using the no shutdown command before you enter the ip address
dhcp command, some DHCP requests might not be sent.
• To obtain an IP address from a PPPoE server, see Chapter 35, “Configuring the PPPoE Client.”
Step 6 (Optional) To assign a private MAC address to this interface, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# mac-address mac_address [standby mac_address]
The mac_address is in H.H.H format, where H is a 16-bit hexadecimal digit. For example, the
MAC address 00-0C-F1-42-4C-DE would be entered as 000C.F142.4CDE.
By default, the physical interface uses the burned-in MAC address, and all subinterfaces of a physical
interface use the same burned-in MAC address.
For use with failover, set the standby MAC address. If the active unit fails over and the standby unit
becomes active, the new active unit starts using the active MAC addresses to minimize network
disruption, while the old active unit uses the standby address.
In multiple context mode, if you share an interface between contexts, you can assign a unique MAC
address to the interface in each context. This feature lets the security appliance easily classify packets
into the appropriate context. Using a shared interface without unique MAC addresses is possible, but has
some limitations. See the “How the Security Appliance Classifies Packets” section on page 3-3 for more
information. You can assign each MAC address manually, or you can automatically generate MAC
addresses for shared interfaces in contexts. See the “Automatically Assigning MAC Addresses to
Context Interfaces” section on page 6-11 to automatically generate MAC addresses. If you automatically
generate MAC addresses, you can use the mac-address command to override the generated address.
For single context mode, or for interfaces that are not shared in multiple context mode, you might want
to assign unique MAC addresses to subinterfaces. For example, your service provider might perform
access control based on the MAC address.
Step 7 To enable the interface, if it is not already enabled, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# no shutdown
To disable the interface, enter the shutdown command. If you enter the shutdown command for a
physical interface, you also shut down all subinterfaces. If you shut down an interface in the system
execution space, then that interface is shut down in all contexts that share it, even though the context
configurations show the interface as enabled.
The following example configures parameters for the physical interface in single mode:
hostname(config)# interface gigabitethernet0/1
hostname(config-if)# speed 1000
hostname(config-if)# duplex full
hostname(config-if)# nameif inside
hostname(config-if)# security-level 100
hostname(config-if)# ip address 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.0
hostname(config-if)# no shutdown
The following example configures interface parameters in multiple context mode for the system
configuration, and allocates the gigabitethernet 0/1.1 subinterface to contextA:
hostname(config)# interface gigabitethernet0/1
hostname(config-if)# speed 1000
hostname(config-if)# duplex full
hostname(config-if)# no shutdown
hostname(config-if)# interface gigabitethernet0/1.1
hostname(config-subif)# vlan 101
hostname(config-subif)# no shutdown
hostname(config-subif)# context contextA
hostname(config-ctx)# ...
hostname(config-ctx)# allocate-interface gigabitethernet0/1.1
The following example configures parameters in multiple context mode for the context configuration:
hostname/contextA(config)# interface gigabitethernet0/1.1
hostname/contextA(config-if)# nameif inside
hostname/contextA(config-if)# security-level 100
hostname/contextA(config-if)# ip address 10.1.2.1 255.255.255.0
hostname/contextA(config-if)# mac-address 030C.F142.4CDE standby 040C.F142.4CDE
hostname/contextA(config-if)# no shutdown
Note If you enable NAT control, you do not need to configure NAT between same security level interfaces.
See the “NAT and Same Security Level Interfaces” section on page 17-12 for more information on NAT
and same security level interfaces.
If you enable same security interface communication, you can still configure interfaces at different
security levels as usual.
To enable interfaces on the same security level so that they can communicate with each other, enter the
following command:
hostname(config)# same-security-traffic permit inter-interface
This chapter describes how to configure basic settings on your security appliance that are typically
required for a functioning configuration. This chapter includes the following sections:
• Changing the Login Password, page 8-1
• Changing the Enable Password, page 8-1
• Setting the Hostname, page 8-2
• Setting the Domain Name, page 8-2
• Setting the Date and Time, page 8-2
• Setting the Management IP Address for a Transparent Firewall, page 8-5
You can enter passwd or password. The password is a case-sensitive password of up to 16 alphanumeric
and special characters. You can use any character in the password except a question mark or a space.
The password is saved in the configuration in encrypted form, so you cannot view the original password
after you enter it. Use the no password command to restore the password to the default setting.
The password is a case-sensitive password of up to 16 alphanumeric and special characters. You can use
any character in the password except a question mark or a space.
This command changes the password for the highest privilege level. If you configure local command
authorization, you can set enable passwords for each privilege level from 0 to 15.
The password is saved in the configuration in encrypted form, so you cannot view the original password
after you enter it. Enter the enable password command without a password to set the password to the
default, which is blank.
This name can be up to 63 characters. A hostname must start and end with a letter or digit, and have as
interior characters only letters, digits, or a hyphen.
This name appears in the command line prompt. For example:
hostname(config)# hostname farscape
farscape(config)#
For example, to set the domain as example.com, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# domain-name example.com
Note In multiple context mode, set the time in the system configuration only.
Setting the Time Zone and Daylight Saving Time Date Range
By default, the time zone is UTC and the daylight saving time date range is from 2:00 a.m. on the first
Sunday in April to 2:00 a.m. on the last Sunday in October. To change the time zone and daylight saving
time date range, perform the following steps:
Step 1 To set the time zone, enter the following command in global configuration mode:
hostname(config)# clock timezone zone [-]hours [minutes]
Where zone specifies the time zone as a string, for example, PST for Pacific Standard Time.
The [-]hours value sets the number of hours of offset from UTC. For example, PST is -8 hours.
The minutes value sets the number of minutes of offset from UTC.
Step 2 To change the date range for daylight saving time from the default, enter one of the following commands.
The default recurring date range is from 2:00 a.m. on the first Sunday in April to 2:00 a.m. on the last
Sunday in October.
• To set the start and end dates for daylight saving time as a specific date in a specific year, enter the
following command:
hostname(config)# clock summer-time zone date {day month | month day} year hh:mm {day
month | month day} year hh:mm [offset]
If you use this command, you need to reset the dates every year.
The zone value specifies the time zone as a string, for example, PDT for Pacific Daylight Time.
The day value sets the day of the month, from 1 to 31. You can enter the day and month as April 1
or as 1 April, for example, depending on your standard date format.
The month value sets the month as a string. You can enter the day and month as April 1 or as 1 April,
for example, depending on your standard date format.
The year value sets the year using four digits, for example, 2004. The year range is 1993 to 2035.
The hh:mm value sets the hour and minutes in 24-hour time.
The offset value sets the number of minutes to change the time for daylight saving time. By default,
the value is 60 minutes.
• To specify the start and end dates for daylight saving time, in the form of a day and time of the
month, and not a specific date in a year, enter the following command.
hostname(config)# clock summer-time zone recurring [week weekday month hh:mm week
weekday month hh:mm] [offset]
This command lets you set a recurring date range that you do not need to alter yearly.
The zone value specifies the time zone as a string, for example, PDT for Pacific Daylight Time.
The week value specifies the week of the month as an integer between 1 and 4 or as the words first
or last. For example, if the day might fall in the partial fifth week, then specify last.
The weekday value specifies the day of the week: Monday, Tuesday, Wednesday, and so on.
The month value sets the month as a string.
The hh:mm value sets the hour and minutes in 24-hour time.
The offset value sets the number of minutes to change the time for daylight saving time. By default,
the value is 60 minutes.
Step 1 To configure authentication with an NTP server, perform the following steps:
a. To enable authentication, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# ntp authenticate
b. To specify an authentication key ID to be a trusted key, which is required for authentication with an
NTP server, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# ntp trusted-key key_id
Where the key_id is between 1 and 4294967295. You can enter multiple trusted keys for use with
multiple servers.
c. To set a key to authenticate with an NTP server, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# ntp authentication-key key_id md5 key
Where key_id is the ID you set in Step 1b using the ntp trusted-key command, and key is a string
up to 32 characters in length.
Step 2 To identify an NTP server, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# ntp server ip_address [key key_id] [source interface_name] [prefer]
Where the key_id is the ID you set in Step 1b using the ntp trusted-key command.
The source interface_name identifies the outgoing interface for NTP packets if you do not want to use
the default interface in the routing table. Because the system does not include any interfaces in multiple
context mode, specify an interface name defined in the admin context.
The prefer keyword sets this NTP server as the preferred server if multiple servers have similar
accuracy. NTP uses an algorithm to determine which server is the most accurate and synchronizes to that
one. If servers are of similar accuracy, then the prefer keyword specifies which of those servers to use.
However, if a server is significantly more accurate than the preferred one, the security appliance uses the
more accurate one. For example, the security appliance uses a server of stratum 2 over a server of
stratum 3 that is preferred.
You can identify multiple servers; the security appliance uses the most accurate server.
Where hh:mm:ss sets the hour, minutes, and seconds in 24-hour time. For example, set 20:54:00 for 8:54
pm.
The day value sets the day of the month, from 1 to 31. You can enter the day and month as april 1 or as
1 april, for example, depending on your standard date format.
The month value sets the month. Depending on your standard date format, you can enter the day and
month as april 1 or as 1 april.
The year value sets the year using four digits, for example, 2004. The year range is 1993 to 2035.
The default time zone is UTC. If you change the time zone after you enter the clock set command using
the clock timezone command, the time automatically adjusts to the new time zone.
This command sets the time in the hardware chip, and does not save the time in the configuration file.
This time endures reboots. Unlike the other clock commands, this command is a privileged EXEC
command. To reset the clock, you need to set a new time for the clock set command.
This address must be on the same subnet as the upstream and downstream routers. You cannot set the
subnet to a host subnet (255.255.255.255). This address must be IPv4; the transparent firewall does not
support IPv6.
The standby keyword and address is used for failover. See Chapter 14, “Configuring Failover,” for more
information.
This chapter describes how to configure IP routing on the security appliance. This chapter includes the
following sections:
• Configuring Static and Default Routes, page 9-1
• Defining Route Maps, page 9-6
• Configuring OSPF, page 9-7
• Configuring RIP, page 9-19
• The Routing Table, page 9-22
The dest_ip and mask is the IP address for the destination network and the gateway_ip is the address of
the next-hop router.The addresses you specify for the static route are the addresses that are in the packet
before entering the security appliance and performing NAT.
The distance is the administrative distance for the route. The default is 1 if you do not specify a value.
Administrative distance is a parameter used to compare routes among different routing protocols. The
default administrative distance for static routes is 1, giving it precedence over routes discovered by
dynamic routing protocols but not directly connect routes. The default administrative distance for routes
discovered by OSPF is 110. If a static route has the same administrative distance as a dynamic route, the
static routes take precedence. Connected routes always take precedence over static or dynamically
discovered routes.
Static routes remain in the routing table even if the specified gateway becomes unavailable. If the
specified gateway becomes unavailable, you need to remove the static route from the routing table
manually. However, static routes are removed from the routing table if the specified interface goes down.
They are reinstated when the interface comes back up.
Note If you create a static route with an administrative distance greater than the administrative distance of the
routing protocol running on the security appliance, then a route to the specified destination discovered
by the routing protocol takes precedence over the static route. The static route is used only if the
dynamically discovered route is removed from the routing table.
The following example creates a static route that sends all traffic destined for 10.1.1.0/24 to the router
(10.1.2.45) connected to the inside interface:
hostname(config)# route inside 10.1.1.0 255.255.255.0 10.1.2.45 1
You can define up to three equal cost routes to the same destination per interface. ECMP is not supported
across multiple interfaces. With ECMP, the traffic is not necessarily divided evenly between the routes;
traffic is distributed among the specified gateways based on an algorithm that hashes the source and
destination IP addresses.
The following example shows static routes that are equal cost routes that direct traffic to three different
gateways on the outside interface. The security appliance distributes the traffic among the specified
gateways.
hostname(config)# route outside 10.10.10.0 255.255.255.0 192.168.1.1
hostname(config)# route outside 10.10.10.0 255.255.255.0 192.168.1.2
hostname(config)# route outside 10.10.10.0 255.255.255.0 192.168.1.3
Tip You can enter 0 0 instead of 0.0.0.0 0.0.0.0 for the destination network address and mask, for example:
hostname(config)# route outside 0 0 192.168.1 1
The following example shows a security appliance configured with three equal cost default routes and a
default route for tunneled traffic. Unencrypted traffic received by the security appliance for which there
is no static or learned route is distributed among the gateways with the IP addresses 192.168.2.1,
192.168.2.2, 192.168.2.3. Encrypted traffic receive by the security appliance for which there is no static
or learned route is passed to the gateway with the IP address 192.168.2.4.
hostname(config)# route outside 0 0 192.168.2.1
hostname(config)# route outside 0 0 192.168.2.2
hostname(config)# route outside 0 0 192.168.2.3
hostname(config)# route outside 0 0 192.168.2.4 tunneled
The security appliance does this by associating a static route with a monitoring target that you define. It
monitors the target using ICMP echo requests. If an echo reply is not received within a specified time
period, the object is considered down and the associated route is removed from the routing table. A
previously configured backup route is used in place of the removed route.
When selecting a monitoring target, you need to make sure it can respond to ICMP echo requests. The
target can be any network object that you choose, but you should consider using:
• the ISP gateway (for dual ISP support) address
• the next hop gateway address (if you are concerned about the availability of the gateway)
• a server on the target network, such as a AAA server, that the security appliance needs to
communicate with
• a persistent network object on the destination network (a desktop or notebook computer that may be
shut down at night is not a good choice)
You can configure static route tracking for statically defined routes or default routes obtained through
DHCP or PPPoE. You can only enable PPPoE clients on multiple interface with route tracking.
To configure static route tracking, perform the following steps:
If you are configuring a new monitoring process, you are taken to SLA monitor configuration mode.
If you are changing the monitoring parameters for an unscheduled monitoring process that already
has a type defined, you are taken directly to the SLA protocol configuration mode.
b. Specify the monitoring protocol. If you are changing the monitoring parameters for an unscheduled
monitoring process that already has a type defined, you are taken directly to SLA protocol
configuration mode and cannot change this setting.
hostname(config-sla-monitor)# type echo protocol ipIcmpEcho target_ip interface
if_name
The target_ip is the IP address of the network object whose availability the tracking process
monitors. While this object is available, the tracking process route is installed in the routing table.
When this object becomes unavailable, the tracking process removed the route and the backup route
is used in its place.
c. Schedule the monitoring process:
hostname(config)# sla monitor schedule sla_id [life {forever | seconds}] [start-time
{hh:mm[:ss] [month day | day month] | pending | now | after hh:mm:ss}] [ageout
seconds] [recurring]
Typically, you will use sla monitor schedule sla_id life forever start-time now for the monitoring
schedule, and allow the monitoring configuration determine how often the testing occurs. However,
you can schedule this monitoring process to begin in the future and to only occur at specified times.
Step 2 Associate a tracked static route with the SLA monitoring process by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# track track_id rtr sla_id reachability
The track_id is a tracking number you assign with this command. The sla_id is the ID number of the
SLA process you defined in Step 1.
Step 3 Define the static route to be installed in the routing table while the tracked object is reachable using one
of the following options:
You cannot use the tunneled option with the route command with static route tracking.
• To track a default route obtained through DHCP, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# interface phy_if
hostname(config-if)# dhcp client route track track_id
hostname(config-if)# ip addresss dhcp setroute
hostname(config-if)# exit
Note You must use the setroute argument with the ip address dhcp command to obtain the
default route using DHCP.
• To track a default route obtained through PPPoE, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# interface phy_if
hostname(config-if)# pppoe client route track track_id
hostname(config-if)# ip addresss pppoe setroute
hostname(config-if)# exit
Note You must use the setroute argument with the ip address pppoe command to obtain the
default route using PPPoE.
Step 4 Define the backup route to use when the tracked object is unavailable using one of the following options.
The administrative distance of the backup route must be greater than the administrative distance of the
tracked route. If it is not, the backup route will be installed in the routing table instead of the tracked
route.
• To use a static route, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# route if_name dest_ip mask gateway_ip [admin_distance]
The static route must have the same destination and mask as the tracked route. If you are tracking a
default route obtained through DHCP or PPPoE, then the address and mask would be 0.0.0.0 0.0.0.0.
• To use a default route obtained through DHCP, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# interface phy_if
hostname(config-if)# dhcp client route track track_id
hostname(config-if)# dhcp client route distance admin_distance
hostname(config-if)# ip addresss dhcp setroute
hostname(config-if)# exit
You must use the setroute argument with the ip address dhcp command to obtain the default route
using DHCP. Make sure the administrative distance is greater than the administrative distance of the
tracked route.
• To use a default route obtained through PPPoE, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# interface phy_if
hostname(config-if)# pppoe client route track track_id
hostname(config-if)# pppoe client route distance admin_distance
hostname(config-if)# ip addresss pppoe setroute
hostname(config-if)# exit
You must use the setroute argument with the ip address pppoe command to obtain the default route
using PPPoE. Make sure the administrative distance is greater than the administrative distance of
the tracked route.
Route map entries are read in order. You can identify the order using the sequence_number option, or
the security appliance uses the order in which you add the entries.
Step 2 Enter one or more match commands:
• To match any routes that have a destination network that matches a standard ACL, enter the
following command:
hostname(config-route-map)# match ip address acl_id [acl_id] [...]
If you specify more than one ACL, then the route can match any of the ACLs.
• To match any routes that have a specified metric, enter the following command:
hostname(config-route-map)# match metric metric_value
If you specify more than one ACL, then the route can match any of the ACLs.
• To match any routes with the specified next hop interface, enter the following command:
hostname(config-route-map)# match interface if_name
If you specify more than one interface, then the route can match either interface.
• To match any routes that have been advertised by routers that match a standard ACL, enter the
following command:
hostname(config-route-map)# match ip route-source acl_id [acl_id] [...]
If you specify more than one ACL, then the route can match any of the ACLs.
• To match the route type, enter the following command:
hostname(config-route-map)# match route-type {internal | external [type-1 | type-2]}
If a route matches the match commands, then the following set commands determine the action to
perform on the route before redistributing it.
• To set the metric, enter the following command:
hostname(config-route-map)# set metric metric_value
The following example shows how to redistribute routes with a hop count equal to 1 into OSPF. The
security appliance redistributes these routes as external LSAs with a metric of 5, metric type of Type 1,
and a tag equal to 1.
hostname(config)# route-map 1-to-2 permit
hostname(config-route-map)# match metric 1
hostname(config-route-map)# set metric 5
hostname(config-route-map)# set metric-type type-1
Configuring OSPF
This section describes how to configure OSPF. This section includes the following topics:
• OSPF Overview, page 9-8
• Enabling OSPF, page 9-8
• Redistributing Routes Into OSPF, page 9-9
• Configuring OSPF Interface Parameters, page 9-10
• Configuring OSPF Area Parameters, page 9-12
• Configuring OSPF NSSA, page 9-13
• Defining Static OSPF Neighbors, page 9-15
• Configuring Route Summarization Between OSPF Areas, page 9-14
• Configuring Route Summarization When Redistributing Routes into OSPF, page 9-14
• Generating a Default Route, page 9-16
• Configuring Route Calculation Timers, page 9-16
• Logging Neighbors Going Up or Down, page 9-17
• Displaying OSPF Update Packet Pacing, page 9-17
• Monitoring OSPF, page 9-18
• Restarting the OSPF Process, page 9-18
OSPF Overview
OSPF uses a link-state algorithm to build and calculate the shortest path to all known destinations. Each
router in an OSPF area contains an identical link-state database, which is a list of each of the router
usable interfaces and reachable neighbors.
The advantages of OSPF over RIP include the following:
• OSPF link-state database updates are sent less frequently than RIP updates, and the link-state
database is updated instantly rather than gradually as stale information is timed out.
• Routing decisions are based on cost, which is an indication of the overhead required to send packets
across a certain interface. The security appliance calculates the cost of an interface based on link
bandwidth rather than the number of hops to the destination. The cost can be configured to specify
preferred paths.
The disadvantage of shortest path first algorithms is that they require a lot of CPU cycles and memory.
The security appliance can run two processes of OSPF protocol simultaneously, on different sets of
interfaces. You might want to run two processes if you have interfaces that use the same IP addresses
(NAT allows these interfaces to coexist, but OSPF does not allow overlapping addresses). Or you might
want to run one process on the inside, and another on the outside, and redistribute a subset of routes
between the two processes. Similarly, you might need to segregate private addresses from public
addresses.
Redistribution between the two OSPF processes is supported. Static and connected routes configured on
OSPF-enabled interfaces on the security appliance can also be redistributed into the OSPF process. You
cannot enable RIP on the security appliance if OSPF is enabled. Redistribution between RIP and OSPF
is not supported.
The security appliance supports the following OSPF features:
• Support of intra-area, interarea, and external (Type I and Type II) routes.
• Support of a virtual link.
• OSPF LSA flooding.
• Authentication to OSPF packets (both password and MD5 authentication).
• Support for configuring the security appliance as a designated router or a designated backup router.
The security appliance also can be set up as an ABR; however, the ability to configure the security
appliance as an ASBR is limited to default information only (for example, injecting a default route).
• Support for stub areas and not-so-stubby-areas.
• Area boundary router type-3 LSA filtering.
• Advertisement of static and global address translations.
Enabling OSPF
To enable OSPF, you need to create an OSPF routing process, specify the range of IP addresses
associated with the routing process, then assign area IDs associated with that range of IP addresses.
To enable OSPF, perform the following steps:
This command enters the router configuration mode for this OSPF process.
The process_id is an internally used identifier for this routing process. It can be any positive integer. This
ID does not have to match the ID on any other device; it is for internal use only. You can use a maximum
of two processes.
Step 2 To define the IP addresses on which OSPF runs and to define the area ID for that interface, enter the
following command:
hostname(config-router)# network ip_address mask area area_id
Step 1 (Optional) Create a route-map to further define which routes from the specified routing protocol are
redistributed in to the OSPF routing process. See the “Defining Route Maps” section on page 9-6.
Step 2 If you have not already done so, enter the router configuration mode for the OSPF process you want to
redistribute into by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# router ospf process_id
Step 3 To specify the routes you want to redistribute, enter the following command:
hostname(config-router)# redistribute {ospf process_id
[match {internal | external 1 | external 2}] | static | connected | rip}
[metric metric-value] [metric-type {type-1 | type-2}] [tag tag_value] [subnets] [route-map
map_name]
The ospf process_id, static, connected, and rip keywords specify from where you want to redistribute
routes.
You can either use the options in this command to match and set route properties, or you can use a route
map. The tag and subnets options do not have equivalents in the route-map command. If you use both
a route map and options in the redistribute command, then they must match.
The following example shows route redistribution from OSPF process 1 into OSPF process 2 by
matching routes with a metric equal to 1. The security appliance redistributes these routes as external
LSAs with a metric of 5, metric type of Type 1, and a tag equal to 1.
hostname(config)# route-map 1-to-2 permit
hostname(config-route-map)# match metric 1
hostname(config-route-map)# set metric 5
hostname(config-route-map)# set metric-type type-1
The following example shows the specified OSPF process routes being redistributed into OSPF
process 109. The OSPF metric is remapped to 100.
hostname(config)# router ospf 109
hostname(config-router)# redistribute ospf 108 metric 100 subnets
The following example shows route redistribution where the link-state cost is specified as 5 and the
metric type is set to external, indicating that it has lower priority than internal metrics.
hostname(config)# router ospf 1
hostname(config-router)# redistribute ospf 2 metric 5 metric-type external
Step 1 To enter the interface configuration mode, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# interface interface_name
• To assign a password to be used by neighboring OSPF routers on a network segment that is using
the OSPF simple password authentication, enter the following command:
hostname(config-interface)# ospf authentication-key key
The value must be the same for all nodes on the network.
• To specify the length of time between the hello packets that the security appliance sends on an OSPF
interface, enter the following command:
hostname(config-interface)# ospf hello-interval seconds
The value must be the same for all nodes on the network.
• To enable OSPF MD5 authentication, enter the following command:
hostname(config-interface)# ospf message-digest-key key_id md5 key
The seconds must be greater than the expected round-trip delay between any two routers on the
attached network. The range is from 1 to 65535 seconds. The default is 5 seconds.
• To set the estimated number of seconds required to send a link-state update packet on an OSPF
interface, enter the following command:
hostname(config-interface)# ospf transmit-delay seconds
Step 1 If you have not already done so, enter the router configuration mode for the OSPF process you want to
configure by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# router ospf process_id
• To enable MD5 authentication for an OSPF area, enter the following command:
hostname(config-router)# area area-id authentication message-digest
• To assign a specific cost to the default summary route used for the stub area, enter the following
command:
hostname(config-router)# area area-id default-cost cost
The following example shows how to configure the OSPF area parameters:
hostname(config)# router ospf 2
hostname(config-router)# area 0 authentication
hostname(config-router)# area 0 authentication message-digest
hostname(config-router)# area 17 stub
hostname(config-router)# area 17 default-cost 20
Step 1 If you have not already done so, enter the router configuration mode for the OSPF process you want to
configure by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# router ospf process_id
This command helps reduce the size of the routing table. Using this command for OSPF causes an
OSPF ASBR to advertise one external route as an aggregate for all redistributed routes that are
covered by the address.
Step 1 If you have not already done so, enter the router configuration mode for the OSPF process you want to
configure by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# router ospf process_id
The following example shows how to configure route summarization between OSPF areas:
hostname(config)# router ospf 1
hostname(config-router)# area 17 range 12.1.0.0 255.255.0.0
To configure the software advertisement on one summary route for all redistributed routes covered by a
network address and mask, perform the following steps:
Step 1 If you have not already done so, enter the router configuration mode for the OSPF process you want to
configure by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# router ospf process_id
The following example shows how to configure route summarization. The summary address 10.1.0.0
includes address 10.1.1.0, 10.1.2.0, 10.1.3.0, and so on. Only the address 10.1.0.0 is advertised in an
external link-state advertisement:
hostname(config)# router ospf 1
hostname(config-router)# summary-address 10.1.0.0 255.255.0.0
Step 1 Create a static route to the OSPF neighbor. See the “Configuring Static and Default Routes” section on
page 9-1 for more information about creating static routes.
Step 2 Define the OSPF neighbor by performing the following tasks:
a. Enter router configuration mode for the OSPF process. Enter the following command:
hostname(config)# router ospf pid
The addr argument is the IP address of the OSPF neighbor. The if_name is the interface used to
communicate with the neighbor. If the OSPF neighbor is not on the same network as any of the
directly-connected interfaces, you must specify the interface.
Step 1 If you have not already done so, enter the router configuration mode for the OSPF process you want to
configure by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# router ospf process_id
Step 2 To force the autonomous system boundary router to generate a default route, enter the following
command:
hostname(config-router)# default-information originate [always] [metric metric-value]
[metric-type {1 | 2}] [route-map map-name]
Step 1 If you have not already done so, enter the router configuration mode for the OSPF process you want to
configure by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# router ospf process_id
Step 2 To configure the route calculation time, enter the following command:
hostname(config-router)# timers spf spf-delay spf-holdtime
The spf-delay is the delay time (in seconds) between when OSPF receives a topology change and when
it starts an SPF calculation. It can be an integer from 0 to 65535. The default time is 5 seconds. A value
of 0 means that there is no delay; that is, the SPF calculation is started immediately.
The spf-holdtime is the minimum time (in seconds) between two consecutive SPF calculations. It can be
an integer from 0 to 65535. The default time is 10 seconds. A value of 0 means that there is no delay;
that is, two SPF calculations can be done, one immediately after the other.
Step 1 If you have not already done so, enter the router configuration mode for the OSPF process you want to
configure by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# router ospf process_id
Step 2 To configure logging for neighbors going up or down, enter the following command:
hostname(config-router)# log-adj-changes [detail]
Note Logging must be enabled for the the neighbor up/down messages to be sent.
Monitoring OSPF
You can display specific statistics such as the contents of IP routing tables, caches, and databases. You
can use the information provided to determine resource utilization and solve network problems. You can
also display information about node reachability and discover the routing path that your device packets
are taking through the network.
To display various OSPF routing statistics, perform one of the following tasks, as needed:
• To display general information about OSPF routing processes, enter the following command:
hostname# show ospf [process-id [area-id]]
• To display the internal OSPF routing table entries to the ABR and ASBR, enter the following
command:
hostname# show ospf border-routers
• To display lists of information related to the OSPF database for a specific router, enter the following
command:
hostname# show ospf [process-id [area-id]] database
• To display a list of LSAs waiting to be flooded over an interface (to observe OSPF packet pacing),
enter the following command:
hostname# show ospf flood-list if-name
• To display OSPF neighbor information on a per-interface basis, enter the following command:
hostname# show ospf neighbor [interface-name] [neighbor-id] [detail]
• To display a list of all LSAs requested by a router, enter the following command:
hostname# show ospf request-list neighbor if_name
• To display a list of all LSAs waiting to be resent, enter the following command:
hostname# show ospf retransmission-list neighbor if_name
• To display a list of all summary address redistribution information configured under an OSPF
process, enter the following command:
hostname# show ospf [process-id] summary-address
Configuring RIP
Devices that support RIP send routing-update messages at regular intervals and when the network
topology changes. These RIP packets contain information about the networks that the devices can reach,
as well as the number of routers or gateways that a packet must travel through to reach the destination
address. RIP generates more traffic than OSPF, but is easier to configure.
RIP has advantages over static routes because the initial configuration is simple, and you do not need to
update the configuration when the topology changes. The disadvantage to RIP is that there is more
network and processing overhead than static routing.
The security appliance supports RIP Version 1 and RIP Version 2.
This section describes how to configure RIP. This section includes the following topics:
• Enabling and Configuring RIP, page 9-19
• Redistributing Routes into the RIP Routing Process, page 9-20
• Configuring RIP Send/Receive Version on an Interface, page 9-21
• Enabling RIP Authentication, page 9-21
• Monitoring RIP, page 9-22
Step 1 Start the RIP routing process by entering the following command in global configuration mode:
hostname(config): router rip
You enter router configuration mode for the RIP routing process.
Step 2 Specify the interfaces that will participate in the RIP routing process. Enter the following command for
each interface that will participate in the RIP routing process:
hostname(config-router): network network_address
If an interface belongs to a network defined by this command, the interface will participate in the RIP
routing process. If an interface does not belong to a network defined by this command, it will not send
or receive RIP updates.
Step 3 (Optional) Specify the version of RIP used by the security appliance by entering the following command:
hostname(config-router): version [1 | 2]
Step 5 (Optional) To specify an interface to operate in passive mode, enter the following command:
hostname(config-router): passive-interface [default | if_name]
Using the default keyword causes all interfaces to operate in passive mode. Specifying an interface name
sets only that interface to passive RIP mode. In passive mode, RIP routing updates are accepted by but
not sent out of the specified interface. You can enter this command for each interface you want to set to
passive mode.
Step 6 (Optional) Disable automatic route summarization by entering the following command:
hostname(config-router): no auto-summarize
RIP Version 1 always uses automatic route summarization; you cannot disable it for RIP Version 1. RIP
Version 2 uses route summarization by default; you can disable it using this command.
Step 7 (Optional) To filter the networks received in updates, perform the following steps:
a. Create a standard access list permitting the networks you want the RIP process to allow in the
routing table and denying the networks you want the RIP process to discard.
b. Enter the following command to apply the filter. You can specify an interface to apply the filter to
only those updates received by that interface.
hostname(config-router): distribute-list acl in [interface if_name]
You can enter this command for each interface you want to apply a filter to. If you do not specify an
interface name, the filter is applied to all RIP updates.
Step 8 (Optional) To filter the networks sent in updates, perform the following steps:
a. Create a standard access list permitting the networks you want the RIP process to advertise and
denying the networks you do not want the RIP process to advertise.
b. Enter the following command to apply the filter. You can specify an interface to apply the filter to
only those updates sent by that interface.
hostname(config-router): distribute-list acl out [interface if_name]
You can enter this command for each interface you want to apply a filter to. If you do not specify an
interface name, the filter is applied to all RIP updates.
Step 1 (Optional) Create a route-map to further define which routes from the specified routing protocol are
redistributed in to the RIP routing process. See the “Defining Route Maps” section on page 9-6 for more
information about creating a route map.
Step 2 Choose one of the following options to redistribute the selected route type into the RIP routing process.
• To redistribute connected routes into the RIP routing process, enter the following command:
hostname(config-router): redistribute connected [metric {metric_value | transparent}]
[route-map map_name]
• To redistribute static routes into the RIP routing process, enter the following command:
• To redistribute routes from an OSPF routing process into the RIP routing process, enter the
following command:
hostname(config-router): redistribute ospf pid [match {internal | external [1 | 2] |
nssa-external [1 | 2]}] [metric {metric_value | transparent}] [route-map map_name]
Step 1 (Optional) To specify the version of RIP advertisements sent from an interface, perform the following
steps:
a. Enter interface configuration mode for the interface you are configuring by entering the following
command:
hostname(config)# interface phy_if
b. Specify the version of RIP to use when sending RIP updates out of the interface by entering the
following command:
hostname(config-if)# rip send version {[1] [2]}
Step 2 (Optional) To specify the version of RIP advertisements permitted to be received by an interface,
perform the following steps:
a. Enter interface configuration mode for the interface you are configuring by entering the following
command:
hostname(config)# interface phy_if
b. Specify the version of RIP to allow when receiving RIP updates on the interface by entering the
following command:
hostname(config-if)# rip receive version {[1] [2]}
RIP updates received on the interface that do not match the allowed version are dropped.
Step 1 Enter interface configuration mode for the interface you are configuring by entering the following
command:
hostname(config)# interface phy_if
Step 2 (Optional) Set the authentication mode by entering the following command. By default, text
authentication is used. MD5 authentication is recommended.
hostname(config-if)# rip authentication mode {text | md5}
Step 3 Enable authentication and configure the authentication key by entering the following command:
hostname(config-if)# rip authentication key key key_id key-id
Monitoring RIP
To display various RIP routing statistics, perform one of the following tasks, as needed:
• To display the contents of the RIP routing database, enter the following command:
hostname# show rip database
• To display the RIP commands in the running configuration, enter the following command:
hostname# show running-config router rip
Use the following debug commands only to troubleshoot specific problems or during troubleshooting
sessions with Cisco TAC. Debugging output is assigned high priority in the CPU process and can render
the system unusable. It is best to use debug commands during periods of lower network traffic and fewer
users. Debugging during these periods decreases the likelihood that increased debug command
processing overhead will affect system performance.
• To display RIP processing events, enter the following command:
hostname# debug rip events
On the ASA 5505 adaptive security appliance, the following route is also shown. It is the internal
loopback interface, which is used by the VPN Hardware Client feature for individual user authentication.
C 127.1.0.0 255.255.0.0 is directly connected, _internal_loopback
Each routing protocol is prioritized using an administrative distance value. Table 9-1 shows the default
administrative distance values for the routing protocols supported by the security appliance.
The smaller the administrative distance value, the more preference is given to the protocol. For example,
if the security appliance receives a route to a certain network from both an OSPF routing process (default
administrative distance - 110) and a RIP routing process (default administrative distance - 100), the
security appliance chooses the OSPF route because OSPF has a higher preference. This means the router
adds the OSPF version of the route to the routing table.
In the above example, if the source of the OSPF-derived route was lost (for example, due to a power
shutdown), the security appliance would then use the RIP-derived route until the OSPF-derived route
reappears.
The administrative distance is a local setting. For example, if you use the distance-ospf command to
change the administrative distance of routes obtained through OSPF, that change would only affect the
routing table for the security appliance the command was entered on. The administrative distance is not
advertised in routing updates.
Administrative distance does not affect the routing process. The OSPF and RIP routing processes only
advertise the routes that have been discovered by the routing process or redistributed into the routing
process. For example, the RIP routing process advertises RIP routes, even if routes discovered by the
OSPF routing process are used in the security appliance routing table.
Backup Routes
A backup route is registered when the initial attempt to install the route in the routing table fails because
another route was installed instead. If the route that was installed in the routing table fails, the routing
table maintenance process calls each routing protocol process that has registered a backup route and
requests them to reinstall the route in the routing table. If there are multiple protocols with registered
backup routes for the failed route, the preferred route is chosen based on administrative distance.
Because of this process, you can create “floating” static routes that are installed in the routing table when
the route discovered by a dynamic routing protocol fails. A floating static route is simply a static route
configured with a greater administrative distance than the dynamic routing protocols running on the
security appliance. When the corresponding route discover by a dynamic routing process fails, the static
route is installed in the routing table.
• If the destination matches a single entry in the routing table, the packet is forwarded through the
interface associated with that route.
• If the destination matches more than one entry in the routing table, and the entries all have the same
network prefix length, the packets for that destination are distributed among the interfaces
associated with that route.
• If the destination matches more than one entry in the routing table, and the entries have different
network prefix lengths, then the packet is forwarded out of the interface associated with the route
that has the longer network prefix length.
For example, a packet destined for 192.168.32.1 arrives on an interface of a security appliance with the
following routes in the routing table:
hostname# show route
....
R 192.168.32.0/24 [120/4] via 10.1.1.2
O 192.168.32.0/19 [110/229840] via 10.1.1.3
....
In this case, a packet destined to 192.168.32.1 is directed toward 10.1.1.2, because 192.168.32.1 falls
within the 192.168.32.0/24 network. It also falls within the other route in the routing table, but the
192.168.32.0/24 has the longest prefix within the routing table (24 bits verses 19 bits). Longer prefixes
are always preferred over shorter ones when forwarding a packet.
This chapter describes how to configure the DHCP server, dynamic DNS (DDNS) update methods, and
WCCP on the security appliance. DHCP provides network configuration parameters, such as IP
addresses, to DHCP clients. The security appliance can provide a DHCP server or DHCP relay services
to DHCP clients attached to security appliance interfaces. The DHCP server provides network
configuration parameters directly to DHCP clients. DHCP relay passes DHCP requests received on one
interface to an external DHCP server located behind a different interface.
DDNS update integrates DNS with DHCP. The two protocols are complementary: DHCP centralizes and
automates IP address allocation; DDNS update automatically records the association between assigned
addresses and hostnames at pre-defined intervals. DDNS allows frequently changing address-hostname
associations to be updated frequently. Mobile hosts, for example, can then move freely on a network
without user or administrator intervention. DDNS provides the necessary dynamic updating and
synchronizing of the name to address and address to name mappings on the DNS server.
WCCP specifies interactions between one or more routers, Layer 3 switches, or security appliances and
one or more web caches. The feature transparently redirects selected types of traffic to a group of web
cache engines to optimize resource usage and lower response times.
This chapter includes the following sections:
• Configuring a DHCP Server, page 10-1
• Configuring DHCP Relay Services, page 10-5
• Configuring Dynamic DNS, page 10-6
• Configuring Web Cache Services Using WCCP, page 10-9
Note The security appliance DHCP server does not support BOOTP requests.
In multiple context mode, you cannot enable the DHCP server or DHCP relay on an interface that is used
by more than one context.
You can configure a DHCP server on each interface of the security appliance. Each interface can have
its own pool of addresses to draw from. However the other DHCP settings, such as DNS servers, domain
name, options, ping timeout, and WINS servers, are configured globally and used by the DHCP server
on all interfaces.
You cannot configure a DHCP client or DHCP Relay services on an interface on which the server is
enabled. Additionally, DHCP clients must be directly connected to the interface on which the server is
enabled.
To enable the DHCP server on a given security appliance interface, perform the following steps:
Step 1 Create a DHCP address pool. Enter the following command to define the address pool:
hostname(config)# dhcpd address ip_address-ip_address interface_name
The security appliance assigns a client one of the addresses from this pool to use for a given length of time.
These addresses are the local, untranslated addresses for the directly connected network.
The address pool must be on the same subnet as the security appliance interface.
Step 2 (Optional) To specify the IP address(es) of the DNS server(s) the client will use, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# dhcpd dns dns1 [dns2]
This lease equals the amount of time (in seconds) the client can use its allocated IP address before the
lease expires. Enter a value between 0 to 1,048,575. The default value is 3600 seconds.
Step 5 (Optional) To configure the domain name the client uses, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# dhcpd domain domain_name
Step 6 (Optional) To configure the DHCP ping timeout value, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# dhcpd ping_timeout milliseconds
To avoid address conflicts, the security appliance sends two ICMP ping packets to an address before
assigning that address to a DHCP client. This command specifies the timeout value for those packets.
Step 7 (Transparent Firewall Mode) Define a default gateway. To define the default gateway that is sent to
DHCP clients, enter the following command.
hostname(config)# dhcpd option 3 ip gateway_ip
If you do not use the DHCP option 3 to define the default gateway, DHCP clients use the IP address of
the management interface. The management interface does not route traffic.
Step 8 To enable the DHCP daemon within the security appliance to listen for DHCP client requests on the
enabled interface, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# dhcpd enable interface_name
For example, to assign the range 10.0.1.101 to 10.0.1.110 to hosts connected to the inside interface, enter
the following commands:
hostname(config)# dhcpd address 10.0.1.101-10.0.1.110 inside
hostname(config)# dhcpd dns 209.165.201.2 209.165.202.129
hostname(config)# dhcpd wins 209.165.201.5
hostname(config)# dhcpd lease 3000
hostname(config)# dhcpd domain example.com
hostname(config)# dhcpd enable inside
• To configure a DHCP option that returns a text string, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# dhcpd option code ascii text
• To configure a DHCP option that returns a hexadecimal value, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# dhcpd option code hex value
Note The security appliance does not verify that the option type and value that you provide match the expected
type and value for the option code as defined in RFC 2132. For example, you can enter the dhcpd option
46 ascii hello command and the security appliance accepts the configuration although option 46 is
defined in RFC 2132 as expecting a single-digit, hexadecimal value. For more information about the
option codes and their associated types and expected values, refer to RFC 2132.
Table 10-1 shows the DHCP options that are not supported by the dhcpd option command.
Specific options, DHCP option 3, 66, and 150, are used to configure Cisco IP Phones. See the “Using
Cisco IP Phones with a DHCP Server” section on page 10-4 topic for more information about
configuring those options.
• To provide information for DHCP requests that include an option number as specified in RFC-2132,
enter the following command:
hostname(config)# dhcpd option number value
• To provide the IP address or name of a TFTP server for option 66, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# dhcpd option 66 ascii server_name
• To provide the IP address or names of one or two TFTP servers for option 150, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# dhcpd option 150 ip server_ip1 [server_ip2]
The server_ip1 is the IP address or name of the primary TFTP server while server_ip2 is the
IP address or name of the secondary TFTP server. A maximum of two TFTP servers can be
identified using option 150.
• To set the default route, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# dhcpd option 3 ip router_ip1
Note DHCP Relay services are not available in transparent firewall mode. A security appliance in transparent
firewall mode only allows ARP traffic through; all other traffic requires an access list. To allow DHCP
requests and replies through the security appliance in transparent mode, you need to configure two
access lists, one that allows DCHP requests from the inside interface to the outside, and one that allows
the replies from the server in the other direction.
Step 1 To set the IP address of a DHCP server on a different interface from the DHCP client, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# dhcprelay server ip_address if_name
Step 3 (Optional) To set the number of seconds allowed for relay address negotiation, enter the following
command:
Step 4 (Optional) To change the first default router address in the packet sent from the DHCP server to the
address of the security appliance interface, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# dhcprelay setroute interface_name
This action allows the client to set its default route to point to the security appliance even if the DHCP
server specifies a different router.
If there is no default router option in the packet, the security appliance adds one containing the interface
address.
The following example enables the security appliance to forward DHCP requests from clients connected
to the inside interface to a DHCP server on the outside interface:
hostname(config)# dhcprelay server 201.168.200.4
hostname(config)# dhcprelay enable inside
hostname(config)# dhcprelay setroute inside
• Example 4: Client Asks Server To Perform Both Updates; Server Configured to Update PTR RR
Only; Honors Client Request and Updates Both A and PTR RR, page 10-8
• Example 5: Client Updates A RR; Server Updates PTR RR, page 10-9
Example 1: Client Updates Both A and PTR RRs for Static IP Addresses
The following example configures the client to request that it update both A and PTR resource records
for static IP addresses. To configure this example, perform the following steps:
Step 1 To define a DDNS update method called ddns-2 that requests that the client update both the A and PTR
RRs, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# ddns update method ddns-2
hostname(DDNS-update-method)# ddns both
Step 2 To associate the method ddns-2 with the eth1 interface, enter the following commands:
hostname(DDNS-update-method)# interface eth1
hostname(config-if)# ddns update ddns-2
hostname(config-if)# ddns update hostname asa.example.com
Step 3 To configure a static IP address for eth1, enter the following commands:
hostname(config-if)# ip address 10.0.0.40 255.255.255.0
Example 2: Client Updates Both A and PTR RRs; DHCP Server Honors Client
Update Request; FQDN Provided Through Configuration
The following example configures 1) the DHCP client to request that it update both the A and PTR RRs,
and 2) the DHCP server to honor the requests. To configure this example, perform the following steps:
Step 1 To configure the DHCP client to request that the DHCP server perform no updates, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# dhcp-client update dns server none
Step 2 To create a DDNS update method named ddns-2 on the DHCP client that requests that the client perform
both A and PTR updates, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# ddns update method ddns-2
hostname(DDNS-update-method)# ddns both
Step 3 To associate the method named ddns-2 with the security appliance interface named Ethernet0, and enable
DHCP on the interface, enter the following commands:
hostname(DDNS-update-method)# interface Ethernet0
hostname(if-config)# ddns update ddns-2
hostname(if-config)# ddns update hostname asa.example.com
hostname(if-config)# ip address dhcp
Example 3: Client Includes FQDN Option Instructing Server Not to Update Either
RR; Server Overrides Client and Updates Both RRs.
The following example configures the DHCP client to include the FQDN option instructing the DHCP
server not to update either the A or PTR updates. The example also configures the server to override the
client request. As a result, the client backs off without performing any updates.
To configure this scenario, perform the following steps:
Step 1 To configure the update method named ddns-2 to request that it make both A and PTR RR updates, enter
the following commands:
hostname(config)# ddns update method ddns-2
hostname(DDNS-update-method)# ddns both
Step 2 To assign the DDNS update method named ddns-2 on interface Ethernet0 and provide the client
hostname (asa), enter the following commands:
hostname(DDNS-update-method)# interface Ethernet0
hostname(if-config)# ddns update ddns-2
hostname(if-config)# ddns update hostname asa.example.com
Step 3 To enable the DHCP client feature on the interface, enter the following commands:
hostname(if-config)# dhcp client update dns server none
hostname(if-config)# ip address dhcp
Step 4 To configure the DHCP server to override the client update requests, enter the following command:
hostname(if-config)# dhcpd update dns both override
Step 1 To configure the DHCP client on interface Ethernet0, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# interface Ethernet0
hostname(config-if)# dhcp client update dns both
hostname(config-if)# ddns update hostname asa
Step 1 To define the DDNS update method named ddns-2, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# ddns update method ddns-2
hostname(DDNS-update-method)# ddns
Step 2 To configure the DHCP client for interface Ethernet0 and assign the update method to the interface, enter
the following commands:
hostname(DDNS-update-method)# interface Ethernet0
hostname(config-if)# dhcp client update dns
hostname(config-if)# ddns update ddns-2
hostname(config-if)# ddns update hostname asa
The following WCCPv2 features are not supported with the security appliance:
• Multiple routers in a service group is not supported. Multiple Cache Engines in a service group is
still supported.
• Multicast WCCP is not supported.
• The Layer 2 redirect method is not supported; only GRE encapsulation is supported.
• WCCP source address spoofing.
The standard service is web-cache, which intercepts TCP port 80 (HTTP) traffic and redirects that traffic
to the cache engines, but you can identify a service number if desired between 0 and 254. For example,
to transparently redirect native FTP traffic to a cache engine, use WCCP service 60. You can enter this
command multiple times for each service group you want to enable.
The redirect-list access_list argument controls traffic redirected to this service group.
The group-list access_list argument determines which web cache IP addresses are allowed to participate
in the service group.
The password password argument specifies MD5 authentication for messages received from the service
group. Messages that are not accepted by the authentication are discarded.
Step 2 To enable WCCP redirection on an interface, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# wccp interface interface_name {web-cache | service_number} redirect in
The standard service is web-cache, which intercepts TCP port 80 (HTTP) traffic and redirects that traffic
to the cache engines, but you can identify a service number if desired between 0 and 254. For example,
to transparently redirect native FTP traffic to a cache engine, use WCCP service 60. You can enter this
command multiple times for each service group you want to participate in.
For example, to enable the standard web-cache service and redirect HTTP traffic that enters the inside
interface to a web cache, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# wccp web-cache
hostname(config)# wccp interface inside web-cache redirect in
This chapter describes how to configure multicast routing. This section includes the following topics:
• Multicast Routing Overview, page 11-13
• Enabling Multicast Routing, page 11-14
• Configuring IGMP Features, page 11-14
• Configuring Stub Multicast Routing, page 11-17
• Configuring a Static Multicast Route, page 11-17
• Configuring PIM Features, page 11-18
• For More Information about Multicast Routing, page 11-22
Note If the security appliance is the PIM RP, use the untranslated outside address of the security appliance as
the RP address.
The number of entries in the multicast routing tables are limited by the amount of RAM on the system.
Table 11-1 lists the maximum number of entries for specific multicast tables based on the amount of
RAM on the security appliance. Once these limits are reached, any new entries are discarded.
Note Only the no igmp command appears in the interface configuration when you use the show run
command. If the multicast-routing command appears in the device configuration, then IGMP is
automatically enabled on all interfaces.
This section describes how to configure optional IGMP setting on a per-interface basis. This section
includes the following topics:
• Disabling IGMP on an Interface, page 11-15
• Configuring Group Membership, page 11-15
• Configuring a Statically Joined Group, page 11-15
• Controlling Access to Multicast Groups, page 11-15
• Limiting the Number of IGMP States on an Interface, page 11-16
• Modifying the Query Interval and Query Timeout, page 11-16
• Changing the Query Response Time, page 11-17
• Changing the IGMP Version, page 11-17
Step 1 Create an access list for the multicast traffic. You can create more than one entry for a single access list.
You can use extended or standard access lists.
• To create a standard access list, enter the following command:
The ip_addr argument is the IP address of the multicast group being permitted or denied.
• To create an extended access list, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# access-list name extended [permit | deny] protocol src_ip_addr
src_mask dst_ip_addr dst_mask
The dst_ip_addr argument is the IP address of the multicast group being permitted or denied.
Step 2 Apply the access list to an interface by entering the following command:
hostname(config-if)# igmp access-group acl
Valid values range from 0 to 500, with 500 being the default value. Setting this value to 0 prevents
learned groups from being added, but manually defined memberships (using the igmp join-group and
igmp static-group commands) are still permitted. The no form of this command restores the default
value.
If the security appliance does not hear a query message on an interface for the specified timeout value
(by default, 255 seconds), then the security appliance becomes the designated router and starts sending
the query messages. To change this timeout value, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# igmp query-timeout seconds
Note The igmp query-timeout and igmp query-interval commands require IGMP Version 2.
Note Stub Multicast Routing and PIM are not supported concurrently.
To configure a static multicast route for PIM, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# mroute src_ip src_mask input_if_name [distance]
To configure a static multicast route for a stub area, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# mroute src_ip src_mask input_if_name [dense output_if_name] [distance]
Note The dense output_if_name keyword and argument pair is only supported for stub multicast routing.
Note PIM is not supported with PAT. The PIM protocol does not use ports and PAT only works with protocols
that use ports.
This section describes how to configure optional PIM settings. This section includes the following
topics:
• Disabling PIM on an Interface, page 11-18
• Configuring a Static Rendezvous Point Address, page 11-19
• Configuring the Designated Router Priority, page 11-19
• Filtering PIM Register Messages, page 11-19
• Configuring PIM Message Intervals, page 11-20
• Configuring a Multicast Boundary, page 11-20
• Filtering PIM Neighbors, page 11-20
• Supporting Mixed Bidirctional/Sparse-Mode PIM Networks, page 11-21
Note The security appliance does not support Auto-RP or PIM BSR; you must use the pim rp-address
command to specify the RP address.
You can configure the security appliance to serve as RP to more than one group. The group range
specified in the access list determines the PIM RP group mapping. If an access list is not specified, then
the RP for the group is applied to the entire multicast group range (224.0.0.0/4).
To configure the address of the PIM PR, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# pim rp-address ip_address [acl] [bidir]
The ip_address argument is the unicast IP address of the router to be a PIM RP. The acl argument is the
name or number of a standard access list that defines which multicast groups the RP should be used with.
Do not use a host ACL with this command. Excluding the bidir keyword causes the groups to operate
in PIM sparse mode.
Note The security appliance always advertises the bidir capability in the PIM hello messages regardless of the
actual bidir configuration.
Valid values for the seconds argument range from 1 to 3600 seconds.
Every 60 seconds, the security appliance sends PIM join/prune messages. To change this value, enter the
following command:
hostname(config-if)# pim join-prune-interval seconds
Valid values for the seconds argument range from 10 to 600 seconds.
A standard ACL defines the range of addresses affected. When a boundary is set up, no multicast data
packets are allowed to flow across the boundary from either direction. The boundary allows the same
multicast group address to be reused in different administrative domains.
You can configure the filter-autorp keyword to examine and filter Auto-RP discovery and
announcement messages at the administratively scoped boundary. Any Auto-RP group range
announcements from the Auto-RP packets that are denied by the boundary access control list (ACL) are
removed. An Auto-RP group range announcement is permitted and passed by the boundary only if all
addresses in the Auto-RP group range are permitted by the boundary ACL. If any address is not
permitted, the entire group range is filtered and removed from the Auto-RP message before the Auto-RP
message is forwarded.
Step 1 Use the access-list command to define a standard access list defines the routers you want to participate
in PIM.
For example the following access list, when used with the pim neighbor-filter command, prevents the
10.1.1.1 router from becoming a PIM neighbor:
hostname(config)# access-list pim_nbr deny 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.255
Step 2 Use the pim neighbor-filter command on an interface to filter the neighbor routers.
For example, the following commands prevent the 10.1.1.1 router from becoming a PIM neighbor on
interface GigabitEthernet0/3:
hostname(config)# interface GigabitEthernet0/3
hostname(config-if)# pim neighbor-filter pim_nbr
Step 1 Use the access-list command to define a standard access list that permits the routers you want to
participate in the DF election and denies all others.
For example, the following access list permits the routers at 10.1.1.1 and 10.2.2.2 to participate in the
DF election and denies all others:
hostname(config)# access-list pim_bidir permit 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.255
hostname(config)# access-list pim_bidir permit 10.1.1.2 255.255.255.255
hostname(config)# access-list pim_bidir deny any
This chapter describes how to enable and configure IPv6 on the security appliance. IPv6 is available in
Routed firewall mode only.
This chapter includes the following sections:
• IPv6-enabled Commands, page 12-1
• Configuring IPv6, page 12-2
• Verifying the IPv6 Configuration, page 12-11
For an sample IPv6 configuration, see Appendix B, “Sample Configurations.”
IPv6-enabled Commands
The following security appliance commands can accept and display IPv6 addresses:
• capture
• configure
• copy
• http
• name
• object-group
• ping
• show conn
• show local-host
• show tcpstat
• ssh
• telnet
• tftp-server
• who
• write
Note Failover does not support IPv6. The ipv6 address command does not support setting standby addresses
for failover configurations. The failover interface ip command does not support using IPv6 addresses
on the failover and Stateful Failover interfaces.
When entering IPv6 addresses in commands that support them, simply enter the IPv6 address using
standard IPv6 notation, for example ping fe80::2e0:b6ff:fe01:3b7a. The security appliance correctly
recognizes and processes the IPv6 address. However, you must enclose the IPv6 address in square
brackets ([ ]) in the following situations:
• You need to specify a port number with the address, for example
[fe80::2e0:b6ff:fe01:3b7a]:8080 .
• The command uses a colon as a separator, such as the write net and config net commands, for
example configure net [fe80::2e0:b6ff:fe01:3b7a]:/tftp/config/pixconfig.
The following commands were modified to work for IPv6:
• debug
• fragment
• ip verify
• mtu
• icmp (entered as ipv6 icmp)
The following inspection engines support IPv6:
• FTP
• HTTP
• ICMP
• SMTP
• TCP
• UDP
Configuring IPv6
This section contains the following topics:
• Configuring IPv6 on an Interface, page 12-3
• Configuring a Dual IP Stack on an Interface, page 12-4
• Enforcing the Use of Modified EUI-64 Interface IDs in IPv6 Addresses, page 12-4
• Configuring IPv6 Duplicate Address Detection, page 12-4
• Configuring IPv6 Default and Static Routes, page 12-5
• Configuring IPv6 Access Lists, page 12-6
• Configuring IPv6 Neighbor Discovery, page 12-7
• Configuring a Static IPv6 Neighbor, page 12-11
Note The security appliance does not support IPv6 anycast addresses.
Step 1 Enter interface configuration mode for the interface on which you are configuring the IPv6 addresses:
hostname(config)# interface if
Step 2 Configure an IPv6 address on the interface. You can assign several IPv6 addresses to an interface, such
as an IPv6 link-local, site-local, and global address. However, at a minimum, you must configure a
link-local address.
There are several methods for configuring IPv6 addresses. Pick the method that suits your needs from
the following:
• The simplest method is to enable stateless autoconfiguration on the interface. Enabling stateless
autoconfiguration on the interface configures IPv6 addresses based on prefixes received in Router
Advertisement messages. A link-local address, based on the Modified EUI-64 interface ID, is
automatically generated for the interface when stateless autoconfiguration is enabled. To enable
stateless autoconfiguration, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# ipv6 address autoconfig
• If you only need to configure a link-local address on the interface and are not going to assign any
other IPv6 addresses to the interface, you have the option of manually defining the link-local address
or generating one based on the interface MAC address (Modified EUI-64 format):
– Enter the following command to manually specify the link-local address:
hostname(config-if)# ipv6 address ipv6-address link-local
– Enter the following command to enable IPv6 on the interface and automatically generate the
link-local address using the Modified EUI-64 interface ID based on the interface MAC address:
hostname(config-if)# ipv6 enable
Note You do not need to use the ipv6 enable command if you enter any other ipv6 address
commands on an interface; IPv6 support is automatically enabled as soon as you assign an
IPv6 address to the interface.
• Assign a site-local or global address to the interface. When you assign a site-local or global address,
a link-local address is automatically created. Enter the following command to add a global or
site-local address to the interface. Use the optional eui-64 keyword to use the Modified EUI-64
interface ID in the low order 64 bits of the address.
hostname(config-if)# ipv6 address ipv6-address [eui-64]
Step 3 (Optional) Suppress Router Advertisement messages on an interface. By default, Router Advertisement
messages are automatically sent in response to router solicitation messages. You may want to disable
these messages on any interface for which you do not want the security appliance to supply the IPv6
prefix (for example, the outside interface).
Enter the following command to suppress Router Advertisement messages on an interface:
hostname(config-if)# ipv6 nd suppress-ra
The if_name argument is the name of the interface, as specified by the namif command, on which you
are enabling the address format enforcement.
When this command is enabled on an interface, the source addresses of IPv6 packets received on that
interface are verified against the source MAC addresses to ensure that the interface identifiers use the
Modified EUI-64 format. If the IPv6 packets do not use the Modified EUI-64 format for the interface
identifier, the packets are dropped and the following system log message is generated:
%PIX|ASA-3-325003: EUI-64 source address check failed.
The address format verification is only performed when a flow is created. Packets from an existing flow
are not checked. Additionally, the address verification can only be performed for hosts on the local link.
Packets received from hosts behind a router will fail the address format verification, and be dropped,
because their source MAC address will be the router MAC address and not the host MAC address.
Duplicate address detection is suspended on interfaces that are administratively down. While an
interface is administratively down, the unicast IPv6 addresses assigned to the interface are set to a
pending state. An interface returning to an administratively up state restarts duplicate address detection
for all of the unicast IPv6 addresses on the interface.
When a duplicate address is identified, the state of the address is set to DUPLICATE, the address is not
used, and the following error message is generated:
%PIX|ASA-4-325002: Duplicate address ipv6_address/MAC_address on interface
If the duplicate address is the link-local address of the interface, the processing of IPv6 packets is
disabled on the interface. If the duplicate address is a global address, the address is not used. However,
all configuration commands associated with the duplicate address remain as configured while the state
of the address is set to DUPLICATE.
If the link-local address for an interface changes, duplicate address detection is performed on the new
link-local address and all of the other IPv6 address associated with the interface are regenerated
(duplicate address detection is performed only on the new link-local address).
The security appliance uses neighbor solicitation messages to perform duplicate address detection. By
default, the number of times an interface performs duplicate address detection is 1.
To change the number of duplicate address detection attempts, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# ipv6 nd dad attempts value
The value argument can be any value from 0 to 600. Setting the value argument to 0 disables duplicate
address detection on the interface.
When you configure an interface to send out more than one duplicate address detection attempt, you can
also use the ipv6 nd ns-interval command to configure the interval at which the neighbor solicitation
messages are sent out. By default, they are sent out once every 1000 milliseconds.
To change the neighbor solicitation message interval, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# ipv6 nd ns-interval value
Note Changing this value changes it for all neighbor solicitation messages sent out on the interface, not just
those used for duplicate address detection.
You can add a default route and static routes using the ipv6 route command.
To configure an IPv6 default route and static routes, perform the following steps:
Note The ipv6 route command works like the route command used to define IPv4 static routes.
Step 1 Create an access entry. To create an access list, use the ipv6 access-list command to create entries for
the access list. There are two main forms of this command to choose from, one for creating access list
entries specifically for ICMP traffic, and one to create access list entries for all other types of IP traffic.
• To create an IPv6 access list entry specifically for ICMP traffic, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# ipv6 access-list id [line num] {permit | deny} icmp source
destination [icmp_type]
The following describes the arguments for the ipv6 access-list command:
• id—The name of the access list. Use the same id in each command when you are entering multiple
entries for an access list.
• line num—When adding an entry to an access list, you can specify the line number in the list where
the entry should appear.
• permit | deny—Determines whether the specified traffic is blocked or allowed to pass.
• icmp—Indicates that the access list entry applies to ICMP traffic.
• protocol—Specifies the traffic being controlled by the access list entry. This can be the name (ip,
tcp, or udp) or number (1-254) of an IP protocol. Alternatively, you can specify a protocol object
group using object-group grp_id.
• source and destination—Specifies the source or destination of the traffic. The source or destination
can be an IPv6 prefix, in the format prefix/length, to indicate a range of addresses, the keyword any,
to specify any address, or a specific host designated by host host_ipv6_addr.
• src_port and dst_port—The source and destination port (or service) argument. Enter an operator (lt
for less than, gt for greater than, eq for equal to, neq for not equal to, or range for an inclusive
range) followed by a space and a port number (or two port numbers separated by a space for the
range keyword).
• icmp_type—Specifies the ICMP message type being filtered by the access rule. The value can be a
valid ICMP type number (from 0 to 155) or one of the ICMP type literals as shown in Appendix D,
“Addresses, Protocols, and Ports”. Alternatively, you can specify an ICMP object group using
object-group id.
Step 2 To apply the access list to an interface, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# access-group access_list_name {in | out} interface if_name
132958
A and B can now exchange
packets on this link
Neighbor solicitation messages are also used to verify the reachability of a neighbor after the link-layer
address of a neighbor is identified. When a node wants to verifying the reachability of a neighbor, the
destination address in a neighbor solicitation message is the unicast address of the neighbor.
Neighbor advertisement messages are also sent when there is a change in the link-layer address of a node
on a local link. When there is such a change, the destination address for the neighbor advertisement is
the all-nodes multicast address.
You can configure the neighbor solicitation message interval and neighbor reachable time on a
per-interface basis. See the following topics for more information:
• Configuring the Neighbor Solicitation Message Interval, page 12-8
• Configuring the Neighbor Reachable Time, page 12-8
To configure the interval between IPv6 neighbor solicitation retransmissions on an interface, enter the
following command:
hostname(config-if)# ipv6 nd ns-interval value
Valid values for the value argument range from 1000 to 3600000 milliseconds. The default value is 1000
milliseconds.
This setting is also sent in router advertisement messages.
The neighbor reachable time enables detecting unavailable neighbors. Shorter configured times enable
detecting unavailable neighbors more quickly; however, shorter times consume more IPv6 network
bandwidth and processing resources in all IPv6 network devices. Very short configured times are not
recommended in normal IPv6 operation.
To configure the amount of time that a remote IPv6 node is considered reachable after a reachability
confirmation event has occurred, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# ipv6 nd reachable-time value
Valid values for the value argument range from 0 to 3600000 milliseconds. The default is 0.
This information is also sent in router advertisement messages.
When 0 is used for the value, the reachable time is sent as undetermined. It is up to the receiving devices
to set and track the reachable time value. To see the time used by the security appliance when this value
is set to 0, use the show ipv6 interface command to display information about the IPv6 interface,
including the ND reachable time being used.
Router Router
advertisement advertisement
132917
Data = options, prefix, lifetime, autoconfig flag
You can configure the following settings for router advertisement messages:
• The time interval between periodic router advertisement messages.
• The router lifetime value, which indicates the amount of time IPv6 nodes should consider security
appliance to be the default router.
• The IPv6 network prefixes in use on the link.
• Whether or not an interface transmits router advertisement messages.
Unless otherwise noted, the router advertisement message settings are specific to an interface and are
entered in interface configuration mode. See the following topics for information about changing these
settings:
• Configuring the Router Advertisement Transmission Interval, page 12-10
• Configuring the Router Lifetime Value, page 12-10
• Configuring the IPv6 Prefix, page 12-10
• Suppressing Router Advertisement Messages, page 12-11
By default, router advertisements are sent out every 200 seconds. To change the interval between router
advertisement transmissions on an interface, enter the following command:
ipv6 nd ra-interval [msec] value
Valid values range from 3 to 1800 seconds (or 500 to 1800000 milliseconds if the msec keyword is used).
The interval between transmissions should be less than or equal to the IPv6 router advertisement lifetime
if security appliance is configured as a default router by using the ipv6 nd ra-lifetime command. To
prevent synchronization with other IPv6 nodes, randomly adjust the actual value used to within 20
percent of the desired value.
The router lifetime value specifies how long nodes on the local link should consider security appliance
as the default router on the link.
To configure the router lifetime value in IPv6 router advertisements on an interface, enter the following
command:
hostname(config-if)# ipv6 nd ra-lifetime seconds
Valid values range from 0 to 9000 seconds. The default is 1800 seconds. Entering 0 indicates that
security appliance should not be considered a default router on the selected interface.
Stateless autoconfiguration uses IPv6 prefixes provided in router advertisement messages to create the
global unicast address from the link-local address.
To configure which IPv6 prefixes are included in IPv6 router advertisements, enter the following
command:
hostname(config-if)# ipv6 nd prefix ipv6-prefix/prefix-length
Note For stateless autoconfiguration to work properly, the advertised prefix length in router advertisement
messages must always be 64 bits.
By default, Router Advertisement messages are automatically sent in response to router solicitation
messages. You may want to disable these messages on any interface for which you do not want security
appliance to supply the IPv6 prefix (for example, the outside interface).
To suppress IPv6 router advertisement transmissions on an interface, enter the following command:
hostname(config-if)# ipv6 nd suppress-ra
Entering this command causes the security appliance to appear as a regular IPv6 neighbor on the link
and not as an IPv6 router.
The ipv6_address argument is the link-local IPv6 address of the neighbor, the if_name argument is the
interface through which the neighbor is available, and the mac_address argument is the MAC address of
the neighbor interface.
Note The clear ipv6 neighbors command does not remove static entries from the IPv6 neighbor discovery
cache; it only clears the dynamic entries.
Including the interface name, such as “outside”, displays the settings for the specified interface.
Excluding the name from the command displays the setting for all interfaces that have IPv6 enabled on
them. The output for the command shows the following:
• The name and status of the interface.
• The link-local and global unicast addresses.
Note The show interface command only displays the IPv4 settings for an interface. To see the IPv6
configuration on an interface, you need to use the show ipv6 interface command. The show ipv6
interface command does not display any IPv4 settings for the interface (if both types of addresses are
configured on the interface).
The output from the show ipv6 route command is similar to the IPv4 show route command. It displays
the following information:
• The protocol that derived the route.
• The IPv6 prefix of the remote network.
• The administrative distance and metric for the route.
• The address of the next-hop router.
• The interface through which the next hop router to the specified network is reached.
The following is sample output from the show ipv6 route command:
hostname# show ipv6 route
This chapter describes support for AAA (pronounced “triple A”) and how to configure AAA servers and
the local database.
This chapter contains the following sections:
• AAA Overview, page 13-1
• AAA Server and Local Database Support, page 13-2
• Configuring the Local Database, page 13-10
• Identifying AAA Server Groups and Servers, page 13-12
• Using Certificates and User Login Credentials, page 13-15
• Supporting a Zone Labs Integrity Server, page 13-16
AAA Overview
AAA enables the security appliance to determine who the user is (authentication), what the user can do
(authorization), and what the user did (accounting).
AAA provides an extra level of protection and control for user access than using access lists alone. For
example, you can create an access list allowing all outside users to access Telnet on a server on the DMZ
network. If you want only some users to access the server and you might not always know IP addresses
of these users, you can enable AAA to allow only authenticated and/or authorized users to make it
through the security appliance. (The Telnet server enforces authentication, too; the security appliance
prevents unauthorized users from attempting to access the server.)
You can use authentication alone or with authorization and accounting. Authorization always requires a
user to be authenticated first. You can use accounting alone, or with authentication and authorization.
This section includes the following topics:
• About Authentication, page 13-1
• About Authorization, page 13-2
• About Accounting, page 13-2
About Authentication
Authentication controls access by requiring valid user credentials, which are typically a username and
password. You can configure the security appliance to authenticate the following items:
• All administrative connections to the security appliance including the following sessions:
– Telnet
– SSH
– Serial console
– ASDM (using HTTPS)
– VPN management access
• The enable command
• Network access
• VPN access
About Authorization
Authorization controls access per user after users authenticate. You can configure the security appliance
to authorize the following items:
• Management commands
• Network access
• VPN access
Authorization controls the services and commands available to each authenticated user. Were you not to
enable authorization, authentication alone would provide the same access to services for all
authenticated users.
If you need the control that authorization provides, you can configure a broad authentication rule, and
then have a detailed authorization configuration. For example, you authenticate inside users who attempt
to access any server on the outside network and then limit the outside servers that a particular user can
access using authorization.
The security appliance caches the first 16 authorization requests per user, so if the user accesses the same
services during the current authentication session, the security appliance does not resend the request to
the authorization server.
About Accounting
Accounting tracks traffic that passes through the security appliance, enabling you to have a record of
user activity. If you enable authentication for that traffic, you can account for traffic per user. If you do
not authenticate the traffic, you can account for traffic per IP address. Accounting information includes
when sessions start and stop, username, the number of bytes that pass through the security appliance for
the session, the service used, and the duration of each session.
Summary of Support
Table 13-1 summarizes the support for each AAA service by each AAA server type, including the local
database. For more information about support for a specific AAA server type, refer to the topics
following the table.
Database Type
HTTP
AAA Service Local RADIUS TACACS+ SDI NT Kerberos LDAP Form
Authentication of...
VPN users Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes1
Firewall sessions Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No
2
Administrators Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No
Authorization of...
VPN users Yes Yes No No No No Yes No
3
Firewall sessions No Yes Yes No No No No No
4
Administrators Yes No Yes No No No No No
Accounting of...
VPN connections No Yes Yes No No No No No
Firewall sessions No Yes Yes No No No No No
Administrators No Yes5 Yes No No No No No
1. HTTP Form protocol supports single sign-on authentication for WebVPN users only.
2. SDI is not supported for HTTP administrative access.
3. For firewall sessions, RADIUS authorization is supported with user-specific access lists only, which are received or
specified in a RADIUS authentication response.
4. Local command authorization is supported by privilege level only.
5. Command accounting is available for TACACS+ only.
Authentication Methods
The security appliance supports the following authentication methods with RADIUS:
• PAP—For all connection types.
• CHAP—For L2TP-over-IPSec.
• MS-CHAPv1—For L2TP-over-IPSec.
• MS-CHAPv2—For L2TP-over-IPSec, and for regular IPSec remote access connections when the
password management feature is enabled.
Attribute Support
The security appliance supports the following sets of RADIUS attributes:
• Authentication attributes defined in RFC 2138.
• Accounting attributes defined in RFC 2139.
• RADIUS attributes for tunneled protocol support, defined in RFC 2868.
• Cisco IOS VSAs, identified by RADIUS vendor ID 9.
• Cisco VPN-related VSAs, identified by RADIUS vendor ID 3076.
• Microsoft VSAs, defined in RFC 2548.
NT Server Support
The security appliance supports Microsoft Windows server operating systems that support NTLM
version 1, collectively referred to as NT servers.
Note NT servers have a maximum length of 14 characters for user passwords. Longer passwords are truncated.
This is a limitation of NTLM version 1.
Note The security appliance does not support changing user passwords during tunnel negotiation. To avoid
this situation happening inadvertently, disable password expiration on the Kerberos/Active Directory
server for users connecting to the security appliance.
Note If you do not configure SASL, we strongly recommend that you secure LDAP communications with
SSL. See the ldap-over-ssl command in the Cisco Security Appliance Command Reference.
When user LDAP authentication has succeeded, the LDAP server returns the attributes for the
authenticated user. For VPN authentication, these attributes generally include authorization data which
is applied to the VPN session. Thus, using LDAP accomplishes authentication and authorization in a
single step.
The security appliance supports the following SASL mechanisms, listed in order of increasing strength:
• Digest-MD5 — The security appliance responds to the LDAP server with an MD5 value computed
from the username and password.
• Kerberos — The security appliance responds to the LDAP server by sending the username and realm
using the GSSAPI (Generic Security Services Application Programming Interface) Kerberos
mechanism.
You can configure the security appliance and LDAP server to support any combination of these SASL
mechanisms. If you configure multiple mechanisms, the security appliance retrieves the list of SASL
mechanisms configured on the server and sets the authentication mechanism to the strongest mechanism
configured on both the security appliance and the server. For example, if both the LDAP server and the
security appliance support both mechanisms, the security appliance selects Kerberos, the stronger of the
mechanisms.
The following example configures the security appliance for authentication to an LDAP directory server
named ldap_dir_1 using the digest-MD5 SASL mechanism, and communicating over an SSL-secured
connection:
hostname(config)# aaa-server ldap_dir_1 protocol ldap
hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# aaa-server ldap_dir_1 host 10.1.1.4
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# sasl-mechanism digest-md5
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-over-ssl enable
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)#
The security appliance supports LDAP Version 3. In the current release, it is compatible only with the
Sun Microsystems JAVA System Directory Server (formerly named the Sun ONE Directory Server) and
the Microsoft Active Directory. In later releases, the security appliance will support other OpenLDAP
servers.
By default, the security appliance auto-detects whether it is connected to a Microsoft or a Sun LDAP
directory server. However, if auto-detection fails to determine the LDAP server type, and you know the
server is either a Microsoft or Sun server, you can manually configure the server type. The following
example sets the LDAP directory server ldap_dir_1 to the Sun Microsystems type:
hostname(config)# aaa-server ldap_dir_1 protocol ldap
hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# aaa-server ldap_dir_1 host 10.1.1.4
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# server-type sun
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)#
Note • Sun—The DN configured on the security appliance to access a Sun directory server must be able to
access the default password policy on that server. We recommend using the directory administrator,
or a user with directory administrator privileges, as the DN. Alternatively, you can place an ACI on
the default password policy.
• Microsoft—You must configure LDAP over SSL to enable password management with Microsoft
Active Directory.
After you complete this fundamental configuration work, you can configure additional LDAP
authorization parameters such as a directory password, a starting point for searching a directory, and the
scope of a directory search:
hostname(config)# aaa-server ldap_dir_1 protocol ldap
hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# aaa-server ldap_dir_1 host 10.1.1.4
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-login-dn obscurepassword
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-base-dn starthere
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-scope subtree
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)#
See LDAP commands in the Cisco Security Appliance Command Reference for more information.
Note To use the attribute mapping features correctly, you need to understand the Cisco LDAP attribute names
and values as well as the user-defined attribute names and values.
The following command, entered in global configuration mode, creates an unpopulated LDAP attribute
map table named att_map_1:
hostname(config)# ldap attribute-map att_map_1
hostname(config-ldap-attribute-map)#
The following commands map the user-defined attribute name department to the Cisco attribute name
cVPN3000-IETF-Radius-Class. The second command maps the user-defined attribute value Engineering
to the user-defined attribute department and the Cisco-defined attribute value group1.
hostname(config)# ldap attribute-map att_map_1
hostname(config-ldap-attribute-map)# map-name department cVPN3000-IETF-Radius-Class
hostname(config-ldap-attribute-map)# map-value department Engineering group1
hostname(config-ldap-attribute-map)#
The following commands bind the attribute map att_map_1 to the LDAP server ldap_dir_1:
hostname(config)# aaa-server ldap_dir_1 host 10.1.1.4
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-attribute-map att_map_1
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)#
Note The command to create an attribute map (ldap attribute-map) and the command to bind it to an LDAP
server (ldap-attribute-map) differ only by a hyphen and the mode.
The following commands display or clear all LDAP attribute maps in the running configuration:
hostname# show running-config all ldap attribute-map
hostname(config)# clear configuration ldap attribute-map
hostname(config)#
The names of frequently mapped Cisco LDAP attributes and the type of user-defined attributes they
would commonly be mapped to include:
For a list of Cisco LDAP attribute names and values, see Appendix E, “Configuring an External Server
for Authorization and Authentication”. Alternatively, you can enter “?” within ldap-attribute-map mode
to display the complete list of Cisco LDAP attribute names, as shown in the following example:
hostname(config)# ldap attribute-map att_map_1
hostname(config-ldap-attribute-map)# map-name att_map_1 ?
User Profiles
User profiles contain, at a minimum, a username. Typically, a password is assigned to each username,
although passwords are optional.
The username attributes command lets you enter the username mode. In this mode, you can add other
information to a specific user profile. The information you can add includes VPN-related attributes, such
as a VPN session timeout value.
Fallback Support
The local database can act as a fallback method for several functions. This behavior is designed to help
you prevent accidental lockout from the security appliance.
For users who need fallback support, we recommend that their usernames and passwords in the local
database match their usernames and passwords in the AAA servers. This provides transparent fallback
support. Because the user cannot determine whether a AAA server or the local database is providing the
service, using usernames and passwords on AAA servers that are different than the usernames and
passwords in the local database means that the user cannot be certain which username and password
should be given.
The local database supports the following fallback functions:
• Console and enable password authentication—When you use the aaa authentication console
command, you can add the LOCAL keyword after the AAA server group tag. If the servers in the
group all are unavailable, the security appliance uses the local database to authenticate
administrative access. This can include enable password authentication, too.
• Command authorization—When you use the aaa authorization command command, you can
add the LOCAL keyword after the AAA server group tag. If the TACACS+ servers in the group all
are unavailable, the local database is used to authorize commands based on privilege levels.
• VPN authentication and authorization—VPN authentication and authorization are supported to
enable remote access to the security appliance if AAA servers that normally support these VPN
services are unavailable. The authentication-server-group command, available in tunnel-group
general attributes mode, lets you specify the LOCAL keyword when you are configuring attributes
of a tunnel group. When VPN client of an administrator specifies a tunnel group configured to
fallback to the local database, the VPN tunnel can be established even if the AAA server group is
unavailable, provided that the local database is configured with the necessary attributes.
Caution If you add to the local database users who can gain access to the CLI but who should not be allowed to
enter privileged mode, enable command authorization. (See the “Configuring Local Command
Authorization” section on page 40-8.) Without command authorization, users can access privileged
mode (and all commands) at the CLI using their own password if their privilege level is 2 or greater (2 is
the default). Alternatively, you can use RADIUS or TACACS+ authentication so that the user cannot use
the login command, or you can set all local users to level 1 so you can control who can use the system
enable password to access privileged mode.
To define a user account in the local database, perform the following steps:
Step 1 Create the user account. To do so, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# username name {nopassword | password password [mschap]} [privilege
priv_level]
The only time you would actually enter the encrypted or nt-encrypted keyword at the CLI is if you are
cutting and pasting a configuration to another security appliance and you are using the same password.
Step 2 To configure a local user account with VPN attributes, follow these steps:
a. Enter the following command:
hostname(config)# username username attributes
When you enter a username attributes command, you enter username mode. The commands
available in this mode are as follows:
• group-lock
• password-storage
• vpn-access-hours
• vpn-filter
• vpn-framed-ip-address
• vpn-group-policy
• vpn-idle-timeout
• vpn-session-timeout
• vpn-simultaneous-logins
• vpn-tunnel-protocol
• webvpn
Use these commands as needed to configure the user profile. For more information about these
commands, see the Cisco Security Appliance Command Reference.
b. When you have finished configuring the user profiles, enter exit to return to config mode.
For example, the following command assigns a privilege level of 15 to the admin user account:
hostname(config)# username admin password passw0rd privilege 15
The following commands creates a user account with a password, enters username mode, and specifies
a few VPN attributes:
hostname(config)# username rwilliams password gOgeOus
hostname(config)# username rwilliams attributes
hostname(config-username)# vpn-tunnel-protocol IPSec
hostname(config-username)# vpn-simultaneous-logins 6
hostname(config-username)# exit
Step 1 For each AAA server group you need to create, follow these steps:
a. Identify the server group name and the protocol. To do so, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# aaa-server server_group protocol {kerberos | ldap | nt | radius |
sdi | tacacs+}
For example, to use RADIUS to authenticate network access and TACACS+ to authenticate CLI
access, you need to create at least two server groups, one for RADIUS servers and one for TACACS+
servers.
You can have up to 15 single-mode server groups or 4 multi-mode server groups. Each server group
can have up to 16 servers in single mode or up to 4 servers in multi-mode.
When you enter a aaa-server protocol command, you enter group mode.
b. If you want to specify the maximum number of requests sent to a AAA server in the group before
trying the next server, enter the following command:
Where the depletion keyword reactivates failed servers only after all of the servers in the group are
inactive.
The deadtime minutes argument specifies the amount of time in minutes, between 0 and 1440, that
elapses between the disabling of the last server in the group and the subsequent re-enabling of all
servers. The default is 10 minutes.
The timed keyword reactivates failed servers after 30 seconds of down time.
d. If you want to send accounting messages to all servers in the group (RADIUS or TACACS+ only),
enter the following command:
hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# accounting-mode simultaneous
To restore the default of sending messages only to the active server, enter the accounting-mode
single command.
Step 2 For each AAA server on your network, follow these steps:
a. Identify the server, including the AAA server group it belongs to. To do so, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# aaa-server server_group (interface_name) host server_ip
When you enter a aaa-server host command, you enter host mode.
b. As needed, use host mode commands to further configure the AAA server.
The commands in host mode do not apply to all AAA server types. Table 13-2 lists the available
commands, the server types they apply to, and whether a new AAA server definition has a default
value for that command. Where a command is applicable to the server type you specified and no
default value is provided (indicated by “—”), use the command to specify the value. For more
information about these commands, see the Cisco Security Appliance Command Reference.
Example 13-1 shows commands that add one TACACS+ group with one primary and one backup server,
one RADIUS group with a single server, and an NT domain server.
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# exit
hostname(config)# aaa-server AuthInbound (inside) host 10.1.1.2
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# key TACPlusUauthKey2
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# exit
hostname(config)# aaa-server AuthOutbound protocol radius
hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# exit
hostname(config)# aaa-server AuthOutbound (inside) host 10.1.1.3
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# key RadUauthKey
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# exit
hostname(config)# aaa-server NTAuth protocol nt
hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# exit
hostname(config)# aaa-server NTAuth (inside) host 10.1.1.4
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# nt-auth-domain-controller primary1
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# exit
Example 13-2 shows commands that configure a Kerberos AAA server group named watchdogs, add a
AAA server to the group, and define the Kerberos realm for the server. Because Example 13-2 does not
define a retry interval or the port that the Kerberos server listens to, the security appliance uses the
default values for these two server-specific parameters. Table 13-2 lists the default values for all AAA
server host mode commands.
Note Kerberos realm names use numbers and upper-case letters only. Although the security appliance accepts
lower-case letters for a realm name, it does not translate lower-case letters to upper-case letters. Be sure
to use upper-case letters only.
Using certificates
If user digital certificates are configured, the security appliance first validates the certificate. It does not,
however, use any of the DNs from the certificates as a username for the authentication.
If both authentication and authorization are enabled, the security appliance uses the user login
credentials for both user authentication and authorization.
• Authentication
– Enabled by authentication server group setting
– Uses the username and password as credentials
• Authorization
– Enabled by authorization server group setting
– Uses the username as a credential
If authentication is disabled and authorization is enabled, the security appliance uses the primary DN
field for authorization.
• Authentication
– DISABLED (set to None) by authentication server group setting
– No credentials used
• Authorization
– Enabled by authorization server group setting
– Uses the username value of the certificate primary DN field as a credential
Note If the primary DN field is not present in the certificate, the security appliance uses the secondary DN
field value as the username for the authorization request.
For example, consider a user certificate that contains the following Subject DN fields and values:
Cn=anyuser,OU=sales;O=XYZCorporation;L=boston;S=mass;C=us;[email protected] .
If the Primary DN = EA (E-mail Address) and the Secondary DN = CN (Common Name), then the
username used in the authorization request would be [email protected].
Note The current release of the security appliance supports one Integrity Server at a time even though the user
interfaces support the configuration of up to five Integrity Servers. If the active Server fails, configure
another Integrity Server on the security appliance and then reestablish the client VPN session.
If the connection between the security appliance and the Integrity server fails, the VPN client
connections remain open by default so that the enterprise VPN is not disrupted by the failure of an
Integrity server. However, you may want to close the VPN connections if the Zone Labs Integrity Server
fails. The following commands ensure that the security appliance waits 12 seconds for a response from
either the active or standby Integrity servers before declaring an the Integrity server as failed and closing
the VPN client connections:
hostname(config)# zonelabs-integrity fail-timeout 12
hostname(config)# zonelabs-integrity fail-close
hostname(config)#
The following command returns the configured VPN client connection fail state to the default and
ensures the client connections remain open:
hostname(config)# zonelabs-integrity fail-open
hostname(config)#
The following example commands specify that the Integrity server connects to port 300 (default is port
80) on the security appliance to request the server SSL certificate. While the server SSL certificate is
always authenticated, these commands also specify that the client SSL certificate of the Integrity server
be authenticated.
To set the firewall client type to the Zone Labs Integrity type, use the client-firewall command as
described in the “Configuring Firewall Policies” section on page 30-54. The command arguments that
specify firewall policies are not used when the firewall type is zonelabs-integrity because the Integrity
server determines the policies.
This chapter describes the security appliance failover feature, which lets you configure two security
appliances so that one takes over operation if the other one fails.
Note The ASA 5505 series adaptive security appliance does not support Stateful Failover or Active/Active
failover.
Understanding Failover
The failover configuration requires two identical security appliances connected to each other through a
dedicated failover link and, optionally, a Stateful Failover link. The health of the active interfaces and
units is monitored to determine if specific failover conditions are met. If those conditions are met,
failover occurs.
The security appliance supports two failover configurations, Active/Active failover and Active/Standby
failover. Each failover configuration has its own method for determining and performing failover.
With Active/Active failover, both units can pass network traffic. This lets you configure load balancing
on your network. Active/Active failover is only available on units running in multiple context mode.
With Active/Standby failover, only one unit passes traffic while the other unit waits in a standby state.
Active/Standby failover is available on units running in either single or multiple context mode.
Both failover configurations support stateful or stateless (regular) failover.
Note VPN failover is not supported on units running in multiple context mode. VPN failover available for
Active/Standby failover configurations only.
Hardware Requirements
The two units in a failover configuration must have the same hardware configuration. They must be the
same model, have the same number and types of interfaces, the same amount of Flash memory, and the
same amount of RAM.
Software Requirements
The two units in a failover configuration must be in the operating modes (routed or transparent, single
or multiple context). They have the same major (first number) and minor (second number) software
version. However, you can use different versions of the software during an upgrade process; for example,
you can upgrade one unit from Version 7.0(1) to Version 7.0(2) and have failover remain active. We
recommend upgrading both units to the same version to ensure long-term compatibility.
See “Performing Zero Downtime Upgrades for Failover Pairs” section on page 41-6 for more
information about upgrading the software on a failover pair.
License Requirements
On the PIX 500 series security appliance, at least one of the units must have an unrestricted (UR) license.
The other unit can have a Failover Only (FO) license, a Failover Only Active-Active (FO_AA) license,
or another UR license. Units with a Restricted license cannot be used for failover, and two units with FO
or FO_AA licenses cannot be used together as a failover pair.
The FO and FO_AA licenses are intended to be used solely for units in a failover configuration and not
for units in standalone mode. If a failover unit with one of these licenses is used in standalone mode, the
unit reboots at least once every 24 hours until the unit is returned to failover duty. A unit with an FO or
FO_AA license operates in standalone mode if it is booted without being connected to a failover peer
with a UR license. If the unit with a UR license in a failover pair fails and is removed from the
configuration, the unit with the FO or FO_AA license does not automatically reboot every 24 hours; it
operates uninterrupted unless the it is manually rebooted.
When the unit automatically reboots, the following message displays on the console:
=========================NOTICE=========================
This machine is running in secondary mode without
a connection to an active primary PIX. Please
check your connection to the primary system.
REBOOTING....
========================================================
The ASA 5500 series adaptive security appliance platform does not have this restriction.
Failover Link
The two units in a failover pair constantly communicate over a failover link to determine the operating
status of each unit. The following information is communicated over the failover link:
• The unit state (active or standby).
• Power status (cable-based failover only—available only on the PIX 500 series security appliance).
• Hello messages (keep-alives).
• Network link status.
• MAC address exchange.
• Configuration replication and synchronization.
Caution All information sent over the failover and Stateful Failover links is sent in clear text unless you secure
the communication with a failover key. If the security appliance is used to terminate VPN tunnels, this
information includes any usernames, passwords and preshared keys used for establishing the tunnels.
Transmitting this sensitive data in clear text could pose a significant security risk. We recommend
securing the failover communication with a failover key if you are using the security appliance to
terminate VPN tunnels.
On the PIX 500 series security appliance, the failover link can be either a LAN-based connection or a
dedicated serial Failover cable. On the ASA 5500 series adaptive security appliance, the failover link can
only be a LAN-based connection.
This section includes the following topics:
• LAN-Based Failover Link, page 14-4
• Serial Cable Failover Link (PIX Security Appliance Only), page 14-4
You can use any unused Ethernet interface on the device as the failover link. You cannot specify an
interface that is currently configured with a name. The failover link interface is not configured as a
normal networking interface; it exists only for failover communication. This interface should only be
used for the failover link (and optionally for the Stateful Failover link). You can connect the LAN-based
failover link by using a dedicated switch with no hosts or routers on the link or by using a crossover
Ethernet cable to link the units directly.
Note When using VLANs, use a dedicated VLAN for the failover link. Sharing the failover link VLAN with
any other VLANs can cause intermittent traffic problems and ping and ARP failures. If you use a switch
to connect the failover link, use dedicated interfaces on the switch and security appliance for the failover
link; do not share the interface with subinterfaces carrying regular network traffic.
On systems running in multiple context mode, the failover link resides in the system context. This
interface and the Stateful Failover link, if used, are the only interfaces that you can configure in the
system context. All other interfaces are allocated to and configured from within security contexts.
Note The IP address and MAC address for the failover link do not change at failover.
The serial Failover cable, or “cable-based failover,” is only available on the PIX 500 series security
appliance. If the two units are within six feet of each other, then we recommend that you use the serial
Failover cable.
The cable that connects the two units is a modified RS-232 serial link cable that transfers data at
117,760 bps (115 Kbps). One end of the cable is labeled “Primary”. The unit attached to this end of the
cable automatically becomes the primary unit. The other end of the cable is labeled “Secondary”. The
unit attached to this end of the cable automatically becomes the secondary unit. You cannot override
these designations in the PIX 500 series security appliance software. If you purchased a PIX 500 series
security appliance failover bundle, this cable is included. To order a spare, use part number PIX-FO=.
The benefits of using cable-based failover include:
• The PIX 500 series security appliance can immediately detect a power loss on the peer unit and
differentiate between a power loss from an unplugged cable.
• The standby unit can communicate with the active unit and can receive the entire configuration
without having to be bootstrapped for failover. In LAN-based failover you need to configure the
failover link on the standby unit before it can communicate with the active unit.
• The switch between the two units in LAN-based failover can be another point of hardware failure;
cable-based failover eliminates this potential point of failure.
• You do not have to dedicate an Ethernet interface (and switch) to the failover link.
• The cable determines which unit is primary and which is secondary, eliminating the need to
manually enter that information in the unit configurations.
The disadvantages include:
• Distance limitation—the units cannot be separated by more than 6 feet.
• Slower configuration replication.
Note Enable the PortFast option on Cisco switch ports that connect directly to the security appliance.
If you are using the failover link as the Stateful Failover link, you should use the fastest Ethernet
interface available. If you experience performance problems on that interface, consider dedicating a
separate interface for the Stateful Failover interface.
If you use a data interface as the Stateful Failover link, you receive the following warning when you
specify that interface as the Stateful Failover link:
******* WARNING ***** WARNING ******* WARNING ****** WARNING *********
Sharing Stateful failover interface with regular data interface is not
a recommended configuration due to performance and security concerns.
******* WARNING ***** WARNING ******* WARNING ****** WARNING *********
Sharing a data interface with the Stateful Failover interface can leave you vulnerable to replay attacks.
Additionally, large amounts of Stateful Failover traffic may be sent on the interface, causing
performance problems on that network segment.
Note Using a data interface as the Stateful Failover interface is only supported in single context, routed mode.
In multiple context mode, the Stateful Failover link resides in the system context. This interface and the
failover interface are the only interfaces in the system context. All other interfaces are allocated to and
configured from within security contexts.
Note The IP address and MAC address for the Stateful Failover link does not change at failover unless the
Stateful Failover link is configured on a regular data interface.
Caution All information sent over the failover and Stateful Failover links is sent in clear text unless you secure
the communication with a failover key. If the security appliance is used to terminate VPN tunnels, this
information includes any usernames, passwords and preshared keys used for establishing the tunnels.
Transmitting this sensitive data in clear text could pose a significant security risk. We recommend
securing the failover communication with a failover key if you are using the security appliance to
terminate VPN tunnels.
Active/Standby Failover
This section describes Active/Standby failover and includes the following topics:
• Active/Standby Failover Overview, page 14-6
• Primary/Secondary Status and Active/Standby Status, page 14-6
• Device Initialization and Configuration Synchronization, page 14-7
• Command Replication, page 14-7
• Failover Triggers, page 14-8
• Failover Actions, page 14-9
Active/Standby failover lets you use a standby security appliance to take over the functionality of a failed
unit. When the active unit fails, it changes to the standby state while the standby unit changes to the
active state. The unit that becomes active assumes the IP addresses (or, for transparent firewall, the
management IP address) and MAC addresses of the failed unit and begins passing traffic. The unit that
is now in standby state takes over the standby IP addresses and MAC addresses. Because network
devices see no change in the MAC to IP address pairing, no ARP entries change or time out anywhere
on the network.
Note For multiple context mode, the security appliance can fail over the entire unit (including all contexts)
but cannot fail over individual contexts separately.
The main differences between the two units in a failover pair are related to which unit is active and which
unit is standby, namely which IP addresses to use and which unit actively passes traffic.
However, a few differences exist between the units based on which unit is primary (as specified in the
configuration) and which unit is secondary:
• The primary unit always becomes the active unit if both units start up at the same time (and are of
equal operational health).
• The primary unit MAC addresses are always coupled with the active IP addresses. The exception to
this rule occurs when the secondary unit is active, and cannot obtain the primary unit MAC addresses
over the failover link. In this case, the secondary unit MAC addresses are used.
Configuration synchronization occurs when one or both devices in the failover pair boot. Configurations
are always synchronized from the active unit to the standby unit. When the standby unit completes its
initial startup, it clears its running configuration (except for the failover commands needed to
communicate with the active unit), and the active unit sends its entire configuration to the standby unit.
The active unit is determined by the following:
• If a unit boots and detects a peer already running as active, it becomes the standby unit.
• If a unit boots and does not detect a peer, it becomes the active unit.
• If both units boot simultaneously, then the primary unit becomes the active unit and the secondary
unit becomes the standby unit.
Note If the secondary unit boots without detecting the primary unit, it becomes the active unit. It uses its own
MAC addresses for the active IP addresses. However, when the primary unit becomes available, the
secondary unit changes the MAC addresses to those of the primary unit, which can cause an interruption
in your network traffic. To avoid this, configure the failover pair with virtual MAC addresses. See the
“Configuring Virtual MAC Addresses” section on page 14-26 for more information.
When the replication starts, the security appliance console on the active unit displays the message
“Beginning configuration replication: Sending to mate,” and when it is complete, the security appliance
displays the message “End Configuration Replication to mate.” During replication, commands entered
on the active unit may not replicate properly to the standby unit, and commands entered on the standby
unit may be overwritten by the configuration being replicated from the active unit. Avoid entering
commands on either unit in the failover pair during the configuration replication process. Depending
upon the size of the configuration, replication can take from a few seconds to several minutes.
On the standby unit, the configuration exists only in running memory. To save the configuration to Flash
memory after synchronization:
• For single context mode, enter the write memory command on the active unit. The command is
replicated to the standby unit, which proceeds to write its configuration to Flash memory.
• For multiple context mode, enter the write memory all command on the active unit from the system
execution space. The command is replicated to the standby unit, which proceeds to write its
configuration to Flash memory. Using the all keyword with this command causes the system and all
context configurations to be saved.
Note Startup configurations saved on external servers are accessible from either unit over the network and do
not need to be saved separately for each unit. Alternatively, you can copy the contexts on disk from the
active unit to an external server, and then copy them to disk on the standby unit, where they become
available when the unit reloads.
Command Replication
Command replication always flows from the active unit to the standby unit. As commands are entered
on the active unit, they are sent across the failover link to the standby unit. You do not have to save the
active configuration to Flash memory to replicate the commands.
The following commands are replicated to the standby unit:
• all configuration commands except for the mode, firewall, and failover lan unit commands
• copy running-config startup-config
• delete
• mkdir
• rename
• rmdir
• write memory
The following commands are not replicated to the standby unit:
• all forms of the copy command except for copy running-config startup-config
• all forms of the write command except for write memory
• debug
• failover lan unit
• firewall
• mode
• show
Note Changes made on the standby unit are not replicated to the active unit. If you enter a command on the
standby unit, the security appliance displays the message **** WARNING **** Configuration
Replication is NOT performed from Standby unit to Active unit. Configurations are no
longer synchronized. This message displays even when you enter many commands that do not affect
the configuration.
If you enter the write standby command on the active unit, the standby unit clears its running
configuration (except for the failover commands used to communicate with the active unit), and the
active unit sends its entire configuration to the standby unit.
For multiple context mode, when you enter the write standby command in the system execution space,
all contexts are replicated. If you enter the write standby command within a context, the command
replicates only the context configuration.
Replicated commands are stored in the running configuration. To save the replicated commands to the
Flash memory on the standby unit:
• For single context mode, enter the copy running-config startup-config command on the active unit.
The command is replicated to the standby unit, which proceeds to write its configuration to Flash
memory.
• For multiple context mode, enter the copy running-config startup-config command on the active
unit from the system execution space and within each context on disk. The command is replicated
to the standby unit, which proceeds to write its configuration to Flash memory. Contexts with startup
configurations on external servers are accessible from either unit over the network and do not need
to be saved separately for each unit. Alternatively, you can copy the contexts on disk from the active
unit to an external server, and then copy them to disk on the standby unit.
Failover Triggers
• The no failover active command is entered on the active unit or the failover active command is
entered on the standby unit.
Failover Actions
In Active/Standby failover, failover occurs on a unit basis. Even on systems running in multiple context
mode, you cannot fail over individual or groups of contexts.
Table 14-1 shows the failover action for each failure event. For each failure event, the table shows the
failover policy (failover or no failover), the action taken by the active unit, the action taken by the
standby unit, and any special notes about the failover condition and actions.
Active/Active Failover
This section describes Active/Active failover. This section includes the following topics:
• Active/Active Failover Overview, page 14-10
• Primary/Secondary Status and Active/Standby Status, page 14-10
• Device Initialization and Configuration Synchronization, page 14-11
• Command Replication, page 14-12
Note A failover group failing on a unit does not mean that the unit has failed. The unit may still have another
failover group passing traffic on it.
When creating the failover groups, you should create them on the unit that will have failover group 1 in
the active state.
Note Active/Active failover generates virtual MAC addresses for the interfaces in each failover group. If you
have more than one Active/Active failover pair on the same network, it is possible to have the same
default virtual MAC addresses assigned to the interfaces on one pair as are assigned to the interfaces of
the other pairs because of the way the default virtual MAC addresses are determined. To avoid having
duplicate MAC addresses on your network, make sure you assign each physical interface a virtual active
and standby MAC address.
As in Active/Standby failover, one unit in an Active/Active failover pair is designated the primary unit,
and the other unit the secondary unit. Unlike Active/Standby failover, this designation does not indicate
which unit becomes active when both units start simultaneously. Instead, the primary/secondary
designation does two things:
• Determines which unit provides the running configuration to the pair when they boot
simultaneously.
• Determines on which unit each failover group appears in the active state when the units boot
simultaneously. Each failover group in the configuration is configured with a primary or secondary
unit preference. You can configure both failover groups be in the active state on a single unit in the
pair, with the other unit containing the failover groups in the standby state. However, a more typical
configuration is to assign each failover group a different role preference to make each one active on
a different unit, distributing the traffic across the devices.
Note The security appliance does not provide load balancing services. Load balancing must be
handled by a router passing traffic to the security appliance.
Configuration synchronization occurs when one or both units in a failover pair boot. The configurations
are synchronized as follows:
• When a unit boots while the peer unit is active (with both failover groups active on it), the booting
unit contacts the active unit to obtain the running configuration regardless of the primary or
secondary designation of the booting unit.
• When both units boot simultaneously, the secondary unit obtains the running configuration from the
primary unit.
When the replication starts, the security appliance console on the unit sending the configuration displays
the message “Beginning configuration replication: Sending to mate,” and when it is complete, the
security appliance displays the message “End Configuration Replication to mate.” During replication,
commands entered on the unit sending the configuration may not replicate properly to the peer unit, and
commands entered on the unit receiving the configuration may be overwritten by the configuration being
received. Avoid entering commands on either unit in the failover pair during the configuration
replication process. Depending upon the size of the configuration, replication can take from a few
seconds to several minutes.
On the unit receiving the configuration, the configuration exists only in running memory. To save the
configuration to Flash memory after synchronization enter the write memory all command in the system
execution space on the unit that has failover group 1 in the active state. The command is replicated to
the peer unit, which proceeds to write its configuration to Flash memory. Using the all keyword with this
command causes the system and all context configurations to be saved.
Note Startup configurations saved on external servers are accessible from either unit over the network and do
not need to be saved separately for each unit. Alternatively, you can copy the contexts configuration files
from the disk on the primary unit to an external server, and then copy them to disk on the secondary unit,
where they become available when the unit reloads.
Command Replication
After both units are running, commands are replicated from one unit to the other as follows:
• Commands entered within a security context are replicated from the unit on which the security
context appears in the active state to the peer unit.
Note A context is considered in the active state on a unit if the failover group to which it belongs is
in the active state on that unit.
• Commands entered in the system execution space are replicated from the unit on which failover
group 1 is in the active state to the unit on which failover group 1 is in the standby state.
• Commands entered in the admin context are replicated from the unit on which failover group 1 is in
the active state to the unit on which failover group 1 is in the standby state.
All configuration and file commands (copy, rename, delete, mkdir, rmdir, and so on) are replicated,
with the following exceptions. The show, debug, mode, firewall, and failover lan unit commands are
not replicated.
Failure to enter the commands on the appropriate unit for command replication to occur causes the
configurations to be out of synchronization. Those changes may be lost the next time the initial
configuration synchronization occurs.
The following commands are replicated to the standby unit:
• all configuration commands except for the mode, firewall, and failover lan unit commands
• copy running-config startup-config
• delete
• mkdir
• rename
• rmdir
• write memory
The following commands are not replicated to the standby unit:
• all forms of the copy command except for copy running-config startup-config
• all forms of the write command except for write memory
• debug
• failover lan unit
• firewall
• mode
• show
You can use the write standby command to resynchronize configurations that have become out of sync.
For Active/Active failover, the write standby command behaves as follows:
• If you enter the write standby command in the system execution space, the system configuration
and the configurations for all of the security contexts on the security appliance is written to the peer
unit. This includes configuration information for security contexts that are in the standby state. You
must enter the command in the system execution space on the unit that has failover group 1 in the
active state.
Note If there are security contexts in the active state on the peer unit, the write standby command
causes active connections through those contexts to be terminated. Use the failover active
command on the unit providing the configuration to make sure all contexts are active on that
unit before entering the write standby command.
• If you enter the write standby command in a security context, only the configuration for the security
context is written to the peer unit. You must enter the command in the security context on the unit
where the security context appears in the active state.
Replicated commands are not saved to the Flash memory when replicated to the peer unit. They are
added to the running configuration. To save replicated commands to Flash memory on both units, use
the write memory or copy running-config startup-config command on the unit that you made the
changes on. The command is replicated to the peer unit and cause the configuration to be saved to Flash
memory on the peer unit.
Failover Triggers
In Active/Active failover, failover can be triggered at the unit level if one of the following events occurs:
• The unit has a hardware failure.
• The unit has a power failure.
• The unit has a software failure.
• The no failover active or the failover active command is entered in the system execution space.
Failover is triggered at the failover group level when one of the following events occurs:
• Too many monitored interfaces in the group fail.
• The no failover active group group_id or failover active group group_id command is entered.
You configure the failover threshold for each failover group by specifying the number or percentage of
interfaces within the failover group that must fail before the group fails. Because a failover group can
contain multiple contexts, and each context can contain multiple interfaces, it is possible for all
interfaces in a single context to fail without causing the associated failover group to fail.
See the “Failover Health Monitoring” section on page 14-16 for more information about interface and
unit monitoring.
Failover Actions
In an Active/Active failover configuration, failover occurs on a failover group basis, not a system basis.
For example, if you designate both failover groups as active on the primary unit, and failover group 1
fails, then failover group 2 remains active on the primary unit while failover group 1 becomes active on
the secondary unit.
Note When configuring Active/Active failover, make sure that the combined traffic for both units is within the
capacity of each unit.
Table 14-2 shows the failover action for each failure event. For each failure event, the policy (whether
or not failover occurs), actions for the active failover group, and actions for the standby failover group
are given.
Regular Failover
When a failover occurs, all active connections are dropped. Clients need to reestablish connections when
the new active unit takes over.
Stateful Failover
When Stateful Failover is enabled, the active unit continually passes per-connection state information to
the standby unit. After a failover occurs, the same connection information is available at the new active
unit. Supported end-user applications are not required to reconnect to keep the same communication
session.
The state information passed to the standby unit includes the following:
• NAT translation table.
• TCP connection states.
• UDP connection states.
• The ARP table.
• The Layer 2 bridge table (when running in transparent firewall mode).
• The HTTP connection states (if HTTP replication is enabled).
• The ISAKMP and IPSec SA table.
• GTP PDP connection database.
The information that is not passed to the standby unit when Stateful Failover is enabled includes the
following:
• The HTTP connection table (unless HTTP replication is enabled).
• The user authentication (uauth) table.
• The routing tables.
Note If failover occurs during an active Cisco IP SoftPhone session, the call remains active because the call
session state information is replicated to the standby unit. When the call is terminated, the IP SoftPhone
client loses connection with the Call Manager. This occurs because there is no session information for
the CTIQBE hangup message on the standby unit. When the IP SoftPhone client does not receive a
response back from the Call Manager within a certain time period, it considers the Call Manager
unreachable and unregisters itself.
Note If a failed unit does not recover and you believe it should not be failed, you can reset the state by entering
the failover reset command. If the failover condition persists, however, the unit will fail again.
You can configure the frequency of the hello messages and the hold time before failover occurs. A faster
poll time and shorter hold time speed the detection of unit failures and make failover occur more quickly,
but it can also cause “false” failures due to network congestion delaying the keepalive packets. See
Configuring Unit Health Monitoring, page 14-36 for more information about configuring unit health
monitoring.
Interface Monitoring
You can monitor up to 250 interfaces divided between all contexts. You should monitor important
interfaces, for example, you might configure one context to monitor a shared interface (because the
interface is shared, all contexts benefit from the monitoring).
When a unit does not receive hello messages on a monitored interface for half of the configured hold
time, it runs the following tests:
1. Link Up/Down test—A test of the interface status. If the Link Up/Down test indicates that the
interface is operational, then the security appliance performs network tests. The purpose of these
tests is to generate network traffic to determine which (if either) unit has failed. At the start of each
test, each unit clears its received packet count for its interfaces. At the conclusion of each test, each
unit looks to see if it has received any traffic. If it has, the interface is considered operational. If one
unit receives traffic for a test and the other unit does not, the unit that received no traffic is
considered failed. If neither unit has received traffic, then the next test is used.
2. Network Activity test—A received network activity test. The unit counts all received packets for up
to 5 seconds. If any packets are received at any time during this interval, the interface is considered
operational and testing stops. If no traffic is received, the ARP test begins.
3. ARP test—A reading of the unit ARP cache for the 2 most recently acquired entries. One at a time,
the unit sends ARP requests to these machines, attempting to stimulate network traffic. After each
request, the unit counts all received traffic for up to 5 seconds. If traffic is received, the interface is
considered operational. If no traffic is received, an ARP request is sent to the next machine. If at the
end of the list no traffic has been received, the ping test begins.
4. Broadcast Ping test—A ping test that consists of sending out a broadcast ping request. The unit then
counts all received packets for up to 5 seconds. If any packets are received at any time during this
interval, the interface is considered operational and testing stops.
If all network tests fail for an interface, but this interface on the other unit continues to successfully pass
traffic, then the interface is considered to be failed. If the threshold for failed interfaces is met, then a
failover occurs. If the other unit interface also fails all the network tests, then both interfaces go into the
“Unknown” state and do not count towards the failover limit.
An interface becomes operational again if it receives any traffic. A failed security appliance returns to
standby mode if the interface failure threshold is no longer met.
Note If a failed unit does not recover and you believe it should not be failed, you can reset the state by entering
the failover reset command. If the failover condition persists, however, the unit will fail again.
Table 14-6 shows the minimum, default, and maximum failover times for the ASA 5500 series adaptive
security appliance.
Table 14-6 ASA 5500 series adaptive security appliance failover times.
Configuring Failover
This section describes how to configure failover and includes the following topics:
• Failover Configuration Limitations, page 14-18
• Configuring Active/Standby Failover, page 14-19
• Configuring Active/Active Failover, page 14-26
• Configuring Unit Health Monitoring, page 14-36
• Configuring Failover Communication Authentication/Encryption, page 14-37
• Verifying the Failover Configuration, page 14-38
Prerequisites
Before you begin, verify the following:
• Both units have the same hardware, software configuration, and proper license.
• Both units are in the same mode (single or multiple, transparent or routed).
Step 1 Connect the Failover cable to the PIX 500 series security appliances. Make sure that you attach the end
of the cable marked “Primary” to the unit you use as the primary unit, and that you attach the end of the
cable marked “Secondary” to the other unit.
Step 2 Power on the primary unit.
Step 3 If you have not done so already, configure the active and standby IP addresses for each data interface
(routed mode), for the management IP address (transparent mode), or for the management-only
interface. The standby IP address is used on the security appliance that is currently the standby unit. It
must be in the same subnet as the active IP address.
Note Do not configure an IP address for the Stateful Failover link if you are going to use a dedicated
Stateful Failover interface. You use the failover interface ip command to configure a dedicated
Stateful Failover interface in a later step.
In routed firewall mode and for the management-only interface, this command is entered in interface
configuration mode for each interface. In transparent firewall mode, the command is entered in global
configuration mode.
In multiple context mode, you must configure the interface addresses from within each context. Use the
changeto context command to switch between contexts. The command prompt changes to
hostname/context(config-if)# , where context is the name of the current context. You must enter a
management IP address for each context in transparent firewall multiple context mode.
Step 4 (Optional) To enable Stateful Failover, configure the Stateful Failover link.
Note Stateful Failover is not available on the ASA 5505 series adaptive security appliance.
The if_name argument assigns a logical name to the interface specified by the phy_if argument. The
phy_if argument can be the physical port name, such as Ethernet1, or a previously created
subinterface, such as Ethernet0/2.3. This interface should not be used for any other purpose.
b. Assign an active and standby IP address to the Stateful Failover link:
hostname(config)# failover interface ip if_name ip_addr mask standby ip_addr
Note If the Stateful Failover link uses a data interface, skip this step. You have already defined the
active and standby IP addresses for the interface.
The standby IP address must be in the same subnet as the active IP address. You do not need to
identify the standby IP address subnet mask.
The Stateful Failover link IP address and MAC address do not change at failover unless it uses a data
interface. The active IP address always stays with the primary unit, while the standby IP address
stays with the secondary unit.
c. Enable the interface:
hostname(config)# interface phy_if
hostname(config-if)# no shutdown
Step 6 Power on the secondary unit and enable failover on the unit if it is not already enabled:
hostname(config)# failover
The active unit sends the configuration in running memory to the standby unit. As the configuration
synchronizes, the messages “Beginning configuration replication: sending to mate.” and “End
Configuration Replication to mate” appear on the primary console.
Step 7 Save the configuration to Flash memory on the primary unit. Because the commands entered on the
primary unit are replicated to the secondary unit, the secondary unit also saves its configuration to Flash
memory.
hostname(config)# copy running-config startup-config
Note If you are changing from cable-based failover to LAN-based failover, you can skip any steps, such as
assigning the active and standby IP addresses for each interface, that you completed for the cable-based
failover configuration.
Follow these steps to configure the primary unit in a LAN-based, Active/Standby failover configuration.
These steps provide the minimum configuration needed to enable failover on the primary unit. For
multiple context mode, all steps are performed in the system execution space unless otherwise noted.
To configure the primary unit in an Active/Standby failover pair, perform the following steps:
Step 1 If you have not done so already, configure the active and standby IP addresses for each data interface
(routed mode), for the management IP address (transparent mode), or for the management-only
interface. The standby IP address is used on the security appliance that is currently the standby unit. It
must be in the same subnet as the active IP address.
Note Do not configure an IP address for the Stateful Failover link if you are going to use a dedicated
Stateful Failover interface. You use the failover interface ip command to configure a dedicated
Stateful Failover interface in a later step.
In routed firewall mode and for the management-only interface, this command is entered in interface
configuration mode for each interface. In transparent firewall mode, the command is entered in global
configuration mode.
In multiple context mode, you must configure the interface addresses from within each context. Use the
changeto context command to switch between contexts. The command prompt changes to
hostname/context(config-if)# , where context is the name of the current context. You must enter a
management IP address for each context in transparent firewall multiple context mode.
Step 2 (PIX security appliance only) Enable LAN-based failover:
The if_name argument assigns a name to the interface specified by the phy_if argument. The phy_if
argument can be the physical port name, such as Ethernet1, or a previously created subinterface,
such as Ethernet0/2.3. On the ASA 5505 adaptive security appliance, the phy_if specifies a VLAN.
b. Assign the active and standby IP address to the failover link:
hostname(config)# failover interface ip if_name ip_addr mask standby ip_addr
The standby IP address must be in the same subnet as the active IP address. You do not need to
identify the standby address subnet mask.
The failover link IP address and MAC address do not change at failover. The active IP address for
the failover link always stays with the primary unit, while the standby IP address stays with the
secondary unit.
c. Enable the interface:
hostname(config)# interface phy_if
hostname(config-if)# no shutdown
Step 5 (Optional) To enable Stateful Failover, configure the Stateful Failover link.
Note Stateful Failover is not available on the ASA 5505 series adaptive security appliance.
Note If the Stateful Failover link uses the failover link or a data interface, then you only need to
supply the if_name argument.
The if_name argument assigns a logical name to the interface specified by the phy_if argument. The
phy_if argument can be the physical port name, such as Ethernet1, or a previously created
subinterface, such as Ethernet0/2.3. This interface should not be used for any other purpose (except,
optionally, the failover link).
b. Assign an active and standby IP address to the Stateful Failover link.
Note If the Stateful Failover link uses the failover link or data interface, skip this step. You have
already defined the active and standby IP addresses for the interface.
The standby IP address must be in the same subnet as the active IP address. You do not need to
identify the standby address subnet mask.
The Stateful Failover link IP address and MAC address do not change at failover unless it uses a data
interface. The active IP address always stays with the primary unit, while the standby IP address
stays with the secondary unit.
c. Enable the interface.
Note If the Stateful Failover link uses the failover link or data interface, skip this step. You have
already enabled the interface.
The only configuration required on the secondary unit is for the failover interface. The secondary unit
requires these commands to initially communicate with the primary unit. After the primary unit sends
its configuration to the secondary unit, the only permanent difference between the two configurations is
the failover lan unit command, which identifies each unit as primary or secondary.
For multiple context mode, all steps are performed in the system execution space unless noted otherwise.
To configure the secondary unit, perform the following steps:
Step 2 Define the failover interface. Use the same settings as you used for the primary unit.
a. Specify the interface to be used as the failover interface:
hostname(config)# failover lan interface if_name phy_if
The if_name argument assigns a name to the interface specified by the phy_if argument.
b. Assign the active and standby IP address to the failover link:
hostname(config)# failover interface ip if_name ip_addr mask standby ip_addr
Note Enter this command exactly as you entered it on the primary unit when you configured the
failover interface on the primary unit.
Note This step is optional because by default units are designated as secondary unless previously
configured.
After you enable failover, the active unit sends the configuration in running memory to the standby unit.
As the configuration synchronizes, the messages “Beginning configuration replication: Sending to mate”
and “End Configuration Replication to mate” appear on the active unit console.
Step 5 After the running configuration has completed replication, save the configuration to Flash memory:
hostname(config)# copy running-config startup-config
To allow HTTP connections to be included in the state information replication, you need to enable HTTP
replication. Because HTTP connections are typically short-lived, and because HTTP clients typically
retry failed connection attempts, HTTP connections are not automatically included in the replicated state
information.
Enter the following command in global configuration mode to enable HTTP state replication when
Stateful Failover is enabled:
hostname(config)# failover replication http
By default, monitoring physical interfaces is enabled and monitoring subinterfaces is disabled. You can
monitor up to 250 interfaces on a unit. You can control which interfaces affect your failover policy by
disabling the monitoring of specific interfaces and enabling the monitoring of others. This lets you
exclude interfaces attached to less critical networks from affecting your failover policy.
For units in multiple configuration mode, use the following commands to enable or disable health
monitoring for specific interfaces:
• To disable health monitoring for an interface, enter the following command within a context:
hostname/context(config)# no monitor-interface if_name
• To enable health monitoring for an interface, enter the following command within a context:
hostname/context(config)# monitor-interface if_name
For units in single configuration mode, use the following commands to enable or disable health
monitoring for specific interfaces:
• To disable health monitoring for an interface, enter the following command in global configuration
mode:
hostname(config)# no monitor-interface if_name
• To enable health monitoring for an interface, enter the following command in global configuration
mode:
hostname(config)# monitor-interface if_name
The security appliance sends hello packets out of each data interface to monitor interface health. If the
security appliance does not receive a hello packet from the corresponding interface on the peer unit for
over half of the hold time, then the additional interface testing begins. If a hello packet or a successful
test result is not received within the specified hold time, the interface is marked as failed. Failover occurs
if the number of failed interfaces meets the failover criteria.
Decreasing the poll and hold times enables the security appliance to detect and respond to interface
failures more quickly, but may consume more system resources.
To change the interface poll time, enter the following command in global configuration mode:
hostname(config)# failover polltime interface [msec] time [holdtime time]
Valid values for the poll time are from 1 to 15 seconds or, if the optional msec keyword is used, from
500 to 999 milliseconds. The hold time determines how long it takes from the time a hello packet is
missed to when the interface is marked as failed. Valid values for the hold time are from 5 to 75 seconds.
You cannot enter a hold time that is less than 5 times the poll time.
Note If the interface link is down, interface testing is not conducted and the standby unit could become active
in just one interface polling period if the number of failed interface meets or exceeds the configured
failover criteria.
By default, a single interface failure causes failover. You can specify a specific number of interfaces or
a percentage of monitored interfaces that must fail before a failover occurs.
To change the default failover criteria, enter the following command in global configuration mode:
hostname(config)# failover interface-policy num[%]
When specifying a specific number of interfaces, the num argument can be from 1 to 250. When
specifying a percentage of interfaces, the num argument can be from 1 to 100.
In Active/Standby failover, the MAC addresses for the primary unit are always associated with the active
IP addresses. If the secondary unit boots first and becomes active, it uses the burned-in MAC address for
its interfaces. When the primary unit comes online, the secondary unit obtains the MAC addresses from
the primary unit. The change can disrupt network traffic.
You can configure virtual MAC addresses for each interface to ensure that the secondary unit uses the
correct MAC addresses when it is the active unit, even if it comes online before the primary unit. If you
do not specify virtual MAC addresses the failover pair uses the burned-in NIC addresses as the MAC
addresses.
Note You cannot configure a virtual MAC address for the failover or Stateful Failover links. The MAC and IP
addresses for those links do not change during failover.
Enter the following command on the active unit to configure the virtual MAC addresses for an interface:
hostname(config)# failover mac address phy_if active_mac standby_mac
The phy_if argument is the physical name of the interface, such as Ethernet1. The active_mac and
standby_mac arguments are MAC addresses in H.H.H format, where H is a 16-bit hexadecimal digit. For
example, the MAC address 00-0C-F1-42-4C-DE would be entered as 000C.F142.4CDE.
The active_mac address is associated with the active IP address for the interface, and the standby_mac
is associated with the standby IP address for the interface.
There are multiple ways to configure virtual MAC addresses on the security appliance. When more than
one method has been used to configure virtual MAC addresses, the security appliance uses the following
order of preference to determine which virtual MAC address is assigned to an interface:
1. The mac-address command (in interface configuration mode) address.
2. The failover mac address command address.
3. The mac-address auto command generated address.
4. The burned-in MAC address.
Use the show interface command to display the MAC address used by an interface.
Note Active/Active failover is not available on the ASA 5505 series adaptive security appliance.
Prerequisites
Before you begin, verify the following:
• Both units have the same hardware, software configuration, and proper license.
• Both units are in multiple context mode.
Step 1 Connect the failover cable to the PIX 500 series security appliances. Make sure that you attach the end
of the cable marked “Primary” to the unit you use as the primary unit, and that you attach the end of the
cable marked “Secondary” to the unit you use as the secondary unit.
Step 2 Power on the primary unit.
Step 3 If you have not done so already, configure the active and standby IP addresses for each data interface
(routed mode), for the management IP address (transparent mode), or for the management-only
interface. The standby IP address is used on the security appliance that is currently the standby unit. It
must be in the same subnet as the active IP address.
You must configure the interface addresses from within each context. Use the changeto context
command to switch between contexts. The command prompt changes to
hostname/context(config-if)# , where context is the name of the current context. You must enter a
management IP address for each context in transparent firewall multiple context mode.
Note Do not configure an IP address for the Stateful Failover link if you are going to use a dedicated
Stateful Failover interface. You use the failover interface ip command to configure a dedicated
Stateful Failover interface in a later step.
In routed firewall mode and for the management-only interface, this command is entered in interface
configuration mode for each interface. In transparent firewall mode, the command is entered in global
configuration mode.
Step 4 (Optional) To enable Stateful Failover, configure the Stateful Failover link.
a. Specify the interface to be used as Stateful Failover link:
hostname(config)# failover link if_name phy_if
The if_name argument assigns a logical name to the interface specified by the phy_if argument. The
phy_if argument can be the physical port name, such as Ethernet1, or a previously created
subinterface, such as Ethernet0/2.3. This interface should not be used for any other purpose (except,
optionally, the failover link).
The standby IP address must be in the same subnet as the active IP address. You do not need to
identify the standby IP address subnet mask.
The Stateful Failover link IP address and MAC address do not change at failover except for when
Stateful Failover uses a regular data interface. The active IP address always stays with the primary
unit, while the standby IP address stays with the secondary unit.
c. Enable the interface:
hostname(config)# interface phy_if
hostname(config-if)# no shutdown
Step 5 Configure the failover groups. You can have at most two failover groups. The failover group command
creates the specified failover group if it does not exist and enters the failover group configuration mode.
For each failover group, you need to specify whether the failover group has primary or secondary
preference using the primary or secondary command. You can assign the same preference to both
failover groups. For load balancing configurations, you should assign each failover group a different unit
preference.
The following example assigns failover group 1 a primary preference and failover group 2 a secondary
preference:
hostname(config)# failover group 1
hostname(config-fover-group)# primary
hostname(config-fover-group)# exit
hostname(config)# failover group 2
hostname(config-fover-group)# secondary
hostname(config-fover-group)# exit
Step 6 Assign each user context to a failover group using the join-failover-group command in context
configuration mode.
Any unassigned contexts are automatically assigned to failover group 1. The admin context is always a
member of failover group 1.
Enter the following commands to assign each context to a failover group:
hostname(config)# context context_name
hostname(config-context)# join-failover-group {1 | 2}
hostname(config-context)# exit
Step 8 Power on the secondary unit and enable failover on the unit if it is not already enabled:
hostname(config)# failover
The active unit sends the configuration in running memory to the standby unit. As the configuration
synchronizes, the messages “Beginning configuration replication: Sending to mate” and “End
Configuration Replication to mate” appear on the primary console.
Step 9 Save the configuration to Flash memory on the Primary unit. Because the commands entered on the
primary unit are replicated to the secondary unit, the secondary unit also saves its configuration to Flash
memory.
hostname(config)# copy running-config startup-config
Step 10 If necessary, force any failover group that is active on the primary to the active state on the secondary.
To force a failover group to become active on the secondary unit, issue the following command in the
system execution space on the primary unit:
hostname# no failover active group group_id
The group_id argument specifies the group you want to become active on the secondary unit.
To configure the primary unit in an Active/Active failover configuration, perform the following steps:
Step 1 If you have not done so already, configure the active and standby IP addresses for each data interface
(routed mode), for the management IP address (transparent mode), or for the management-only
interface. The standby IP address is used on the security appliance that is currently the standby unit. It
must be in the same subnet as the active IP address.
You must configure the interface addresses from within each context. Use the changeto context
command to switch between contexts. The command prompt changes to
hostname/context(config-if)# , where context is the name of the current context. In transparent
firewall mode, you must enter a management IP address for each context.
Note Do not configure an IP address for the Stateful Failover link if you are going to use a dedicated
Stateful Failover interface. You use the failover interface ip command to configure a dedicated
Stateful Failover interface in a later step.
In routed firewall mode and for the management-only interface, this command is entered in interface
configuration mode for each interface. In transparent firewall mode, the command is entered in global
configuration mode.
Step 2 Configure the basic failover parameters in the system execution space.
a. (PIX security appliance only) Enable LAN-based failover:
hostname(config)# hostname(config)# failover lan enable
The if_name argument assigns a logical name to the interface specified by the phy_if argument. The
phy_if argument can be the physical port name, such as Ethernet1, or a previously created
subinterface, such as Ethernet0/2.3. On the ASA 5505 adaptive security appliance, the phy_if
specifies a VLAN. This interface should not be used for any other purpose (except, optionally, the
Stateful Failover link).
d. Specify the failover link active and standby IP addresses:
hostname(config)# failover interface ip if_name ip_addr mask standby ip_addr
The standby IP address must be in the same subnet as the active IP address. You do not need to
identify the standby IP address subnet mask. The failover link IP address and MAC address do not
change at failover. The active IP address always stays with the primary unit, while the standby IP
address stays with the secondary unit.
Step 3 (Optional) To enable Stateful Failover, configure the Stateful Failover link:
a. Specify the interface to be used as Stateful Failover link:
hostname(config)# failover link if_name phy_if
The if_name argument assigns a logical name to the interface specified by the phy_if argument. The
phy_if argument can be the physical port name, such as Ethernet1, or a previously created
subinterface, such as Ethernet0/2.3. This interface should not be used for any other purpose (except,
optionally, the failover link).
Note If the Stateful Failover link uses the failover link or a regular data interface, then you only
need to supply the if_name argument.
Note If the Stateful Failover link uses the failover link or a regular data interface, skip this step.
You have already defined the active and standby IP addresses for the interface.
The standby IP address must be in the same subnet as the active IP address. You do not need to
identify the standby address subnet mask.
The state link IP address and MAC address do not change at failover. The active IP address always
stays with the primary unit, while the standby IP address stays with the secondary unit.
c. Enable the interface.
Note If the Stateful Failover link uses the failover link or regular data interface, skip this step. You
have already enabled the interface.
Step 4 Configure the failover groups. You can have at most two failover groups. The failover group command
creates the specified failover group if it does not exist and enters the failover group configuration mode.
For each failover group, specify whether the failover group has primary or secondary preference using
the primary or secondary command. You can assign the same preference to both failover groups. For
load balancing configurations, you should assign each failover group a different unit preference.
The following example assigns failover group 1 a primary preference and failover group 2 a secondary
preference:
hostname(config)# failover group 1
hostname(config-fover-group)# primary
hostname(config-fover-group)# exit
hostname(config)# failover group 2
hostname(config-fover-group)# secondary
hostname(config-fover-group)# exit
Step 5 Assign each user context to a failover group using the join-failover-group command in context
configuration mode.
Any unassigned contexts are automatically assigned to failover group 1. The admin context is always a
member of failover group 1.
Enter the following commands to assign each context to a failover group:
hostname(config)# context context_name
hostname(config-context)# join-failover-group {1 | 2}
hostname(config-context)# exit
When configuring LAN-based Active/Active failover, you need to bootstrap the secondary unit to
recognize the failover link. This allows the secondary unit to communicate with and receive the running
configuration from the primary unit.
To bootstrap the secondary unit in an Active/Active failover configuration, perform the following steps:
Step 2 Define the failover interface. Use the same settings as you used for the primary unit:
a. Specify the interface to be used as the failover interface:
hostname(config)# failover lan interface if_name phy_if
The if_name argument assigns a logical name to the interface specified by the phy_if argument. The
phy_if argument can be the physical port name, such as Ethernet1, or a previously created
subinterface, such as Ethernet0/2.3. On the ASA 5505 adaptive security appliance, the phy_if
specifies a VLAN.
b. Assign the active and standby IP address to the failover link:
hostname(config)# failover interface ip if_name ip_addr mask standby ip_addr
Note Enter this command exactly as you entered it on the primary unit when you configured the
failover interface.
The standby IP address must be in the same subnet as the active IP address. You do not need to
identify the standby address subnet mask.
c. Enable the interface:
hostname(config)# interface phy_if
hostname(config-if)# no shutdown
Note This step is optional because by default units are designated as secondary unless previously
configured otherwise.
After you enable failover, the active unit sends the configuration in running memory to the standby unit.
As the configuration synchronizes, the messages Beginning configuration replication: Sending to
mate and End Configuration Replication to mate appear on the active unit console.
Step 5 After the running configuration has completed replication, enter the following command to save the
configuration to Flash memory:
hostname(config)# copy running-config startup-config
Step 6 If necessary, force any failover group that is active on the primary to the active state on the secondary
unit. To force a failover group to become active on the secondary unit, enter the following command in
the system execution space on the primary unit:
hostname# no failover active group group_id
The group_id argument specifies the group you want to become active on the secondary unit.
Assigning a primary or secondary priority to a failover group specifies which unit the failover group
becomes active on when both units boot simultaneously. However, if one unit boots before the other, then
both failover groups become active on that unit. When the other unit comes online, any failover groups
that have the unit as a priority do not become active on that unit unless manually forced over, a failover
occurs, or the failover group is configured with the preempt command. The preempt command causes
a failover group to become active on the designated unit automatically when that unit becomes available.
Enter the following commands to configure preemption for the specified failover group:
hostname(config)# failover group {1 | 2}
hostname(config-fover-group)# preempt [delay]
You can enter an optional delay value, which specifies the number of seconds the failover group remains
active on the current unit before automatically becoming active on the designated unit.
To allow HTTP connections to be included in the state information, you need to enable HTTP
replication. Because HTTP connections are typically short-lived, and because HTTP clients typically
retry failed connection attempts, HTTP connections are not automatically included in the replicated state
information. You can use the replication http command to cause a failover group to replicate HTTP state
information when Stateful Failover is enabled.
To enable HTTP state replication for a failover group, enter the following command. This command only
affects the failover group in which it was configured. To enable HTTP state replication for both failover
groups, you must enter this command in each group. This command should be entered in the system
execution space.
hostname(config)# failover group {1 | 2}
hostname(config-fover-group)# replication http
You can monitor up to 250 interfaces on a unit. By default, monitoring of physical interfaces is enabled
and the monitoring of subinterfaces is disabled. You can control which interfaces affect your failover
policy by disabling the monitoring of specific interfaces and enabling the monitoring of others. This lets
you exclude interfaces attached to less critical networks from affecting your failover policy.
To disable health monitoring on an interface, enter the following command within a context:
hostname/context(config)# no monitor-interface if_name
To enable health monitoring on an interface, enter the following command within a context:
hostname/context(config)# monitor-interface if_name
The security appliance sends hello packets out of each data interface to monitor interface health. If the
security appliance does not receive a hello packet from the corresponding interface on the peer unit for
over half of the hold time, then the additional interface testing begins. If a hello packet or a successful
test result is not received within the specified hold time, the interface is marked as failed. Failover occurs
if the number of failed interfaces meets the failover criteria.
Decreasing the poll and hold times enables the security appliance to detect and respond to interface
failures more quickly, but may consume more system resources.
To change the default interface poll time, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# failover group {1 | 2}
hostname(config-fover-group)# polltime interface seconds
Valid values for the poll time are from 1 to 15 seconds or, if the optional msec keyword is used, from
500 to 999 milliseconds. The hold time determines how long it takes from the time a hello packet is
missed to when the interface is marked as failed. Valid values for the hold time are from 5 to 75 seconds.
You cannot enter a hold time that is less than 5 times the poll time.
By default, if a single interface fails failover occurs. You can specify a specific number of interfaces or
a percentage of monitored interfaces that must fail before a failover occurs. The failover criteria is
specified on a failover group basis.
To change the default failover criteria for the specified failover group, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# failover group {1 | 2}
hostname(config-fover-group)# interface-policy num[%]
When specifying a specific number of interfaces, the num argument can be from 1 to 250. When
specifying a percentage of interfaces, the num argument can be from 1 to 100.
Active/Active failover uses virtual MAC addresses on all interfaces. If you do not specify the virtual
MAC addresses, then they are computed as follows:
• Active unit default MAC address: 00a0.c9physical_port_number.failover_group_id01.
• Standby unit default MAC address: 00a0.c9physical_port_number.failover_group_id02.
Note If you have more than one Active/Active failover pair on the same network, it is possible to have the
same default virtual MAC addresses assigned to the interfaces on one pair as are assigned to the
interfaces of the other pairs because of the way the default virtual MAC addresses are determined. To
avoid having duplicate MAC addresses on your network, make sure you assign each physical interface
a virtual active and standby MAC address for all failover groups.
You can configure specific active and standby MAC addresses for an interface by entering the following
commands:
hostname(config)# failover group {1 | 2}
hostname(config-fover-group)# mac address phy_if active_mac standby_mac
The phy_if argument is the physical name of the interface, such as Ethernet1. The active_mac and
standby_mac arguments are MAC addresses in H.H.H format, where H is a 16-bit hexadecimal digit. For
example, the MAC address 00-0C-F1-42-4C-DE would be entered as 000C.F142.4CDE.
The active_mac address is associated with the active IP address for the interface, and the standby_mac
is associated with the standby IP address for the interface.
There are multiple ways to configure virtual MAC addresses on the security appliance. When more than
one method has been used to configure virtual MAC addresses, the security appliance uses the following
order of preference to determine which virtual MAC address is assigned to an interface:
1. The mac-address command (in interface configuration mode) address.
2. The failover mac address command address.
When running in Active/Active failover, a unit may receive a return packet for a connection that
originated through its peer unit. Because the security appliance that receives the packet does not have
any connection information for the packet, the packet is dropped. This most commonly occurs when the
two security appliances in an Active/Active failover pair are connected to different service providers and
the outbound connection does not use a NAT address.
You can prevent the return packets from being dropped using the asr-group command on interfaces
where this is likely to occur. When an interface configured with the asr-group command receives a
packet for which it has no session information, it checks the session information for the other interfaces
that are in the same group. If it does not find a match, the packet is dropped. If it finds a match, then one
of the following actions occurs:
• If the incoming traffic originated on a peer unit, some or all of the layer 2 header is rewritten and
the packet is redirected to the other unit. This redirection continues as long as the session is active.
• If the incoming traffic originated on a different interface on the same unit, some or all of the layer
2 header is rewritten and the packet is re-injected into the stream.
Note Using the asr-group command to configure asymmetric routing support is more secure than using the
static command with the nailed option.
Enter the following commands to configure asymmetric routing support. The asr-group command is
only available in the security contexts. Stateful Failover must be enabled for asymmetric routing to
function properly.
hostname/ctx1(config)# interface phy_if
hostname/ctx1(config-if)# asr-group num
Valid values for num range from 1 to 32. You need to enter the command for each interface that
participates in the asymmetric routing group. You can view the number of ASR packets transmitted,
received, or dropped by an interface using the show interface detail command.
Figure 14-1 shows an example of using the asr-group command for asymmetric routing support.
ISP A ISP B
Context A Context B
interface Ethernet4 interface Ethernet2
nameif outside nameif outside
asr-group 1 Failover/State link asr-group 1
Outbound Traffic
132184
Return Traffic Inside
network
Context A is active on one unit and context B is active on the other. Each context has an interface named
“outside”, both of which are configured as part of asr-group 1. The outbound traffic is routed through
the unit where context A is active. However, the return traffic is being routed through the unit where
context B is active. Normally, the return traffic would be dropped because there is no session information
for the traffic on the unit. However, because the interface is configured with an asr-group number, the
unit looks at the session information for any other interfaces with the same asr-group assigned to it. It
finds the session information in the outside interface for context A, which is in the standby state on the
unit, and forwards the return traffic to the unit where context A is active.
The traffic is forwarded though the outside interface of context A on the unit where context A is in the
standby state and returns through the outside interface of context A on the unit where context A is in the
active state. This forwarding continues as needed until the session ends.
You can configure the polling frequency from 1 to 15 seconds or, if the optional msec keyword is used,
from 200 to 999 milliseconds. The hold time determines how long it takes from the time a hello packet
is missed to when failover occurs. The hold time must be at least 3 times the poll time. You can configure
the hold time from 1 to 45 seconds or, if the optional msec keyword is used, from 800 to 990
milliseconds.
Setting the security appliance to use the minimum poll and hold times allows it to detect and respond to
unit failures in under a second, but it also increases system resource usage and can cause false failure
detection in cases where the networks are congested or where the security appliance is running near full
capacity.
Note On the PIX 500 series security appliance, if you are using the dedicated serial failover cable to connect
the units, then communication over the failover link is not encrypted even if a failover key is configured.
The failover key only encrypts LAN-based failover communication.
Caution All information sent over the failover and Stateful Failover links is sent in clear text unless you secure
the communication with a failover key. If the security appliance is used to terminate VPN tunnels, this
information includes any usernames, passwords and preshared keys used for establishing the tunnels.
Transmitting this sensitive data in clear text could pose a significant security risk. We recommend
securing the failover communication with a failover key if you are using the security appliance to
terminate VPN tunnels.
Enter the following command on the active unit of an Active/Standby failover pair or on the unit that has
failover group 1 in the active state of an Active/Active failover pair:
hostname(config)# failover key {secret | hex key}
The secret argument specifies a shared secret that is used to generate the encryption key. It can be from
1 to 63 characters. The characters can be any combination of numbers, letters, or punctuation. The hex
key argument specifies a hexadecimal encryption key. The key must be 32 hexadecimal characters (0-9,
a-f).
Note To prevent the failover key from being replicated to the peer unit in clear text for an existing failover
configuration, disable failover on the active unit (or in the system execution space on the unit that has
failover group 1 in the active state), enter the failover key on both units, and then re-enable failover.
When failover is re-enabled, the failover communication is encrypted with the key.
For new LAN-based failover configurations, the failover key command should be part of the failover
pair bootstrap configuration.
show failover—Active/Standby
The following is sample output from the show failover command for Active/Standby Failover.
Table 14-7 provides descriptions for the information shown.
hostname# show failover
Failover On
Cable status: N/A - LAN-based failover enabled
Failover unit Primary
Failover LAN Interface: fover Ethernet2 (up)
Unit Poll frequency 1 seconds, holdtime 3 seconds
Interface Poll frequency 15 seconds
Interface Policy 1
Monitored Interfaces 2 of 250 maximum
failover replication http
Last Failover at: 22:44:03 UTC Dec 8 2004
This host: Primary - Active
Active time: 13434 (sec)
Interface inside (10.130.9.3): Normal
Interface outside (10.132.9.3): Normal
Other host: Secondary - Standby Ready
Active time: 0 (sec)
Interface inside (10.130.9.4): Normal
Interface outside (10.132.9.4): Normal
In multiple context mode, using the show failover command in a security context displays the failover
information for that context. The information is similar to the information shown when using the
command in single context mode. Instead of showing the active/standby status of the unit, it displays the
active/standby status of the context. Table 14-7 provides descriptions for the information shown.
Failover On
Last Failover at: 04:03:11 UTC Jan 4 2003
This context: Negotiation
Active time: 1222 (sec)
Interface outside (192.168.5.121): Normal
Interface inside (192.168.0.1): Normal
Peer context: Not Detected
Active time: 0 (sec)
Interface outside (192.168.5.131): Normal
Interface inside (192.168.0.11): Normal
Field Options
Failover • On
• Off
Cable status: • Normal—The cable is connected to both units, and they both have
power.
• My side not connected—The serial cable is not connected to this
unit. It is unknown if the cable is connected to the other unit.
• Other side is not connected—The serial cable is connected to this
unit, but not to the other unit.
• Other side powered off—The other unit is turned off.
• N/A—LAN-based failover is enabled.
Failover Unit Primary or Secondary.
Failover LAN Interface Displays the logical and physical name of the failover link.
Field Options
Unit Poll frequency Displays the number of seconds between hello messages sent to the
peer unit and the number of seconds during which the unit must receive
a hello message on the failover link before declaring the peer failed.
Interface Poll frequency n seconds
The number of seconds you set with the failover polltime interface
command. The default is 15 seconds.
Interface Policy Displays the number or percentage of interfaces that must fail to trigger
failover.
Monitored Interfaces Displays the number of interfaces monitored out of the maximum
possible.
failover replication http Displays if HTTP state replication is enabled for Stateful Failover.
Last Failover at: The date and time of the last failover in the following form:
hh:mm:ss UTC DayName Month Day yyyy
UTC (Coordinated Universal Time) is equivalent to GMT (Greenwich
Mean Time).
This host: For each host, the display shows the following information.
Other host:
Primary or Secondary • Active
• Standby
Active time: n (sec)
The amount of time the unit has been active. This time is cumulative,
so the standby unit, if it was active in the past, also shows a value.
slot x Information about the module in the slot or empty.
Interface name (n.n.n.n): For each interface, the display shows the IP address currently being
used on each unit, as well as one of the following conditions:
• Failed—The interface has failed.
• No Link—The interface line protocol is down.
• Normal—The interface is working correctly.
• Link Down—The interface has been administratively shut down.
• Unknown—The security appliance cannot determine the status of
the interface.
• Waiting—Monitoring of the network interface on the other unit has
not yet started.
Stateful Failover Logical The following fields relate to the Stateful Failover feature. If the Link
Update Statistics field shows an interface name, the Stateful Failover statistics are shown.
Field Options
Link • interface_name—The interface used for the Stateful Failover link.
• Unconfigured—You are not using Stateful Failover.
• up—The interface is up and functioning.
• down—The interface is either administratively shutdown or is
physically down.
• failed—The interface has failed and is not passing stateful data.
Stateful Obj For each field type, the following statistics are shown. They are
counters for the number of state information packets sent between the
two units; the fields do not necessarily show active connections through
the unit.
• xmit—Number of transmitted packets to the other unit.
• xerr—Number of errors that occurred while transmitting packets to
the other unit.
• rcv—Number of received packets.
• rerr—Number of errors that occurred while receiving packets from
the other unit.
General Sum of all stateful objects.
sys cmd Logical update system commands; for example, LOGIN and Stay
Alive.
up time Up time, which the active unit passes to the standby unit.
RPC services Remote Procedure Call connection information.
TCP conn TCP connection information.
UDP conn Dynamic UDP connection information.
ARP tbl Dynamic ARP table information.
L2BRIDGE tbl Layer 2 bridge table information (transparent firewall mode only).
Xlate_Timeout Indicates connection translation timeout information.
VPN IKE upd IKE connection information.
VPN IPSEC upd IPSec connection information.
VPN CTCP upd cTCP tunnel connection information.
VPN SDI upd SDI AAA connection information.
VPN DHCP upd Tunneled DHCP connection information.
GTP PDP GTP PDP update information. This information appears only if inspect
GTP is enabled.
GTP PDPMCB GTP PDPMCB update information. This information appears only if
inspect GTP is enabled.
Field Options
Logical Update Queue For each field type, the following statistics are used:
Information • Cur—Current number of packets
• Max—Maximum number of packets
• Total—Total number of packets
Recv Q The status of the receive queue.
Xmit Q The status of the transmit queue.
Show Failover—Active/Active
The following is sample output from the show failover command for Active/Active Failover. Table 14-8
provides descriptions for the information shown.
hostname# show failover
Failover On
Failover unit Primary
Failover LAN Interface: third GigabitEthernet0/2 (up)
Unit Poll frequency 1 seconds, holdtime 15 seconds
Interface Poll frequency 4 seconds
Interface Policy 1
Monitored Interfaces 8 of 250 maximum
failover replication http
Group 1 last failover at: 13:40:18 UTC Dec 9 2004
Group 2 last failover at: 13:40:06 UTC Dec 9 2004
The following is sample output from the show failover group command for Active/Active Failover. The
information displayed is similar to that of the show failover command, but limited to the specified
group. Table 14-8 provides descriptions for the information shown.
Field Options
Failover • On
• Off
Failover Unit Primary or Secondary.
Failover LAN Interface Displays the logical and physical name of the failover link.
Unit Poll frequency Displays the number of seconds between hello messages sent to the
peer unit and the number of seconds during which the unit must receive
a hello message on the failover link before declaring the peer failed.
Interface Poll frequency n seconds
The number of seconds you set with the failover polltime interface
command. The default is 15 seconds.
Interface Policy Displays the number or percentage of interfaces that must fail before
triggering failover.
Monitored Interfaces Displays the number of interfaces monitored out of the maximum
possible.
Group 1 Last Failover at: The date and time of the last failover for each group in the following
form:
Group 2 Last Failover at:
hh:mm:ss UTC DayName Month Day yyyy
UTC (Coordinated Universal Time) is equivalent to GMT (Greenwich
Mean Time).
This host: For each host, the display shows the following information.
Other host:
Role Primary or Secondary
System State • Active or Standby Ready
• Active Time in seconds
Group 1 State • Active or Standby Ready
Group 2 State • Active Time in seconds
slot x Information about the module in the slot or empty.
context Interface name For each interface, the display shows the IP address currently being
(n.n.n.n): used on each unit, as well as one of the following conditions:
• Failed—The interface has failed.
• No link—The interface line protocol is down.
• Normal—The interface is working correctly.
• Link Down—The interface has been administratively shut down.
• Unknown—The security appliance cannot determine the status of
the interface.
• Waiting—Monitoring of the network interface on the other unit has
not yet started.
Field Options
Stateful Failover Logical The following fields relate to the Stateful Failover feature. If the Link
Update Statistics field shows an interface name, the Stateful Failover statistics are shown.
Link • interface_name—The interface used for the Stateful Failover link.
• Unconfigured—You are not using Stateful Failover.
• up—The interface is up and functioning.
• down—The interface is either administratively shutdown or is
physically down.
• failed—The interface has failed and is not passing stateful data.
Stateful Obj For each field type, the following statistics are used. They are counters
for the number of state information packets sent between the two units;
the fields do not necessarily show active connections through the unit.
• xmit—Number of transmitted packets to the other unit
• xerr—Number of errors that occurred while transmitting packets to
the other unit
• rcv—Number of received packets
• rerr—Number of errors that occurred while receiving packets from
the other unit
General Sum of all stateful objects.
sys cmd Logical update system commands; for example, LOGIN and Stay
Alive.
up time Up time, which the active unit passes to the standby unit.
RPC services Remote Procedure Call connection information.
TCP conn TCP connection information.
UDP conn Dynamic UDP connection information.
ARP tbl Dynamic ARP table information.
L2BRIDGE tbl Layer 2 bridge table information (transparent firewall mode only).
Xlate_Timeout Indicates connection translation timeout information.
VPN IKE upd IKE connection information.
VPN IPSEC upd IPSec connection information.
VPN CTCP upd cTCP tunnel connection information.
VPN SDI upd SDI AAA connection information.
VPN DHCP upd Tunneled DHCP connection information.
GTP PDP GTP PDP update information. This information appears only if inspect
GTP is enabled.
GTP PDPMCB GTP PDPMCB update information. This information appears only if
inspect GTP is enabled.
Field Options
Logical Update Queue For each field type, the following statistics are used:
Information • Cur—Current number of packets
• Max—Maximum number of packets
• Total—Total number of packets
Recv Q The status of the receive queue.
Xmit Q The status of the transmit queue.
For example:
hostname/context(config)# show monitor-interface
This host: Primary - Active
Interface outside (192.168.1.2): Normal
Interface inside (10.1.1.91): Normal
Other host: Secondary - Standby
Interface outside (192.168.1.3): Normal
Interface inside (10.1.1.100): Normal
All of the failover commands are displayed. On units running multiple context mode, enter this command
in the system execution space. Entering show running-config all failover displays the failover
commands in the running configuration and includes commands for which you have not changed the
default value.
Step 1 Test that your active unit or failover group is passing traffic as expected by using FTP (for example) to
send a file between hosts on different interfaces.
Step 2 Force a failover to the standby unit by entering the following command:
• For Active/Standby failover, enter the following command on the active unit:
hostname(config)# no failover active
• For Active/Active failover, enter the following command on the unit where the failover group
containing the interface connecting your hosts is active:
Step 3 Use FTP to send another file between the same two hosts.
Step 4 If the test was not successful, enter the show failover command to check the failover status.
Step 5 When you are finished, you can restore the unit or failover group to active status by enter the following
command:
• For Active/Standby failover, enter the following command on the active unit:
hostname(config)# failover active
• For Active/Active failover, enter the following command on the unit where the failover group
containing the interface connecting your hosts is active:
hostname(config)# failover active group group_id
Forcing Failover
To force the standby unit or failover group to become active, enter one of the following commands:
• For Active/Standby failover:
Enter the following command on the standby unit:
hostname# failover active
Or, enter the following command in the system execution space of the unit where the failover group
is in the active state:
hostname# no failover active group group_id
Entering the following command in the system execution space causes all failover groups to become
active:
hostname# failover active
Disabling Failover
To disable failover, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# no failover
Disabling failover on an Active/Standby pair causes the active and standby state of each unit to be
maintained until you restart. For example, the standby unit remains in standby mode so that both units
do not start passing traffic. To make the standby unit active (even with failover disabled), see the
“Forcing Failover” section on page 14-47.
Disabling failover on an Active/Active pair causes the failover groups to remain in the active state on
whichever unit they are currently active on, no matter which unit they are configured to prefer. The no
failover command should be entered in the system execution space.
To restore a failed Active/Active failover group to an unfailed state, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# failover reset group group_id
Restoring a failed unit or group to an unfailed state does not automatically make it active; restored units
or groups remain in the standby state until made active by failover (forced or natural). An exception is a
failover group configured with the preempt command. If previously active, a failover group becomes
active if it is configured with the preempt command and if the unit on which it failed is the preferred
unit.
Monitoring Failover
When a failover occurs, both security appliances send out system messages. This section includes the
following topics:
• Failover System Messages, page 14-48
• Debug Messages, page 14-49
• SNMP, page 14-49
Note During switchover, failover logically shuts down and then bring up interfaces, generating syslog 411001
and 411002 messages. This is normal activity.
Debug Messages
To see debug messages, enter the debug fover command. See the Cisco Security Appliance Command
Reference for more information.
Note Because debugging output is assigned high priority in the CPU process, it can drastically affect system
performance. For this reason, use the debug fover commands only to troubleshoot specific problems or
during troubleshooting sessions with Cisco TAC.
SNMP
To receive SNMP syslog traps for failover, configure the SNMP agent to send SNMP traps to SNMP
management stations, define a syslog host, and compile the Cisco syslog MIB into your SNMP
management station. See the snmp-server and logging commands in the Cisco Security Appliance
Command Reference for more information.
This chapter describes how the firewall works in each firewall mode. To set the firewall mode, see the
“Setting Transparent or Routed Firewall Mode” section on page 2-5.
This chapter includes the following sections:
• Routed Mode Overview, page 15-1
• Transparent Mode Overview, page 15-7
IP Routing Support
The security appliance acts as a router between connected networks, and each interface requires an
IP address on a different subnet. In single context mode, the routed firewall supports OSPF and RIP.
Multiple context mode supports static routes only. We recommend using the advanced routing
capabilities of the upstream and downstream routers instead of relying on the security appliance for
extensive routing needs.
Note NAT control was the default behavior for software versions earlier than Version 7.0. If you upgrade a
security appliance from an earlier version, then the nat-control command is automatically added to your
configuration to maintain the expected behavior.
Web Server
www.example.com
Outside
209.165.201.2
Originating Responding
Packet Packet
Source Addr Translation Dest Addr Translation
10.1.2.27 209.165.201.10 209.165.201.10 10.1.2.27
10.1.2.1
Inside 92405
10.1.2.27
How Data Moves Through the Security Appliance in Routed Firewall Mode
This section describes how data moves through the security appliance in routed firewall mode, and
includes the following topics:
• An Inside User Visits a Web Server, page 15-3
• An Outside User Visits a Web Server on the DMZ, page 15-4
• An Inside User Visits a Web Server on the DMZ, page 15-5
www.example.com
Outside
209.165.201.2
Inside DMZ
92404
The following steps describe how data moves through the security appliance (see Figure 15-2):
1. The user on the inside network requests a web page from www.example.com.
2. The security appliance receives the packet and because it is a new session, the security appliance
verifies that the packet is allowed according to the terms of the security policy (access lists, filters,
AAA).
For multiple context mode, the security appliance first classifies the packet according to either a
unique interface or a unique destination address associated with a context; the destination address
is associated by matching an address translation in a context. In this case, the interface would be
unique; the www.example.com IP address does not have a current address translation in a context.
3. The security appliance translates the local source address (10.1.2.27) to the global address
209.165.201.10, which is on the outside interface subnet.
The global address could be on any subnet, but routing is simplified when it is on the outside
interface subnet.
4. The security appliance then records that a session is established and forwards the packet from the
outside interface.
5. When www.example.com responds to the request, the packet goes through the security appliance,
and because the session is already established, the packet bypasses the many lookups associated
with a new connection. The security appliance performs NAT by translating the global destination
address to the local user address, 10.1.2.27.
6. The security appliance forwards the packet to the inside user.
User
Outside
10.1.2.1 10.1.1.1
Inside DMZ
92406
Web Server
10.1.1.3
The following steps describe how data moves through the security appliance (see Figure 15-3):
1. A user on the outside network requests a web page from the DMZ web server using the global
destination address of 209.165.201.3, which is on the outside interface subnet.
2. The security appliance receives the packet and because it is a new session, the security appliance
verifies that the packet is allowed according to the terms of the security policy (access lists, filters,
AAA).
For multiple context mode, the security appliance first classifies the packet according to either a
unique interface or a unique destination address associated with a context; the destination address
is associated by matching an address translation in a context. In this case, the classifier “knows” that
the DMZ web server address belongs to a certain context because of the server address translation.
3. The security appliance translates the destination address to the local address 10.1.1.3.
4. The security appliance then adds a session entry to the fast path and forwards the packet from the
DMZ interface.
5. When the DMZ web server responds to the request, the packet goes through the security appliance
and because the session is already established, the packet bypasses the many lookups associated
with a new connection. The security appliance performs NAT by translating the local source address
to 209.165.201.3.
6. The security appliance forwards the packet to the outside user.
Outside
209.165.201.2
10.1.2.1 10.1.1.1
Inside DMZ
92403
The following steps describe how data moves through the security appliance (see Figure 15-4):
1. A user on the inside network requests a web page from the DMZ web server using the destination
address of 10.1.1.3.
2. The security appliance receives the packet and because it is a new session, the security appliance
verifies that the packet is allowed according to the terms of the security policy (access lists, filters,
AAA).
For multiple context mode, the security appliance first classifies the packet according to either a
unique interface or a unique destination address associated with a context; the destination address
is associated by matching an address translation in a context. In this case, the interface is unique;
the web server IP address does not have a current address translation.
3. The security appliance then records that a session is established and forwards the packet out of the
DMZ interface.
4. When the DMZ web server responds to the request, the packet goes through the fast path, which lets
the packet bypass the many lookups associated with a new connection.
5. The security appliance forwards the packet to the inside user.
www.example.com
Outside
209.165.201.2
10.1.2.1 10.1.1.1
Inside DMZ
92407
User
10.1.2.27
The following steps describe how data moves through the security appliance (see Figure 15-5):
1. A user on the outside network attempts to reach an inside host (assuming the host has a routable
IP address).
If the inside network uses private addresses, no outside user can reach the inside network without
NAT. The outside user might attempt to reach an inside user by using an existing NAT session.
2. The security appliance receives the packet and because it is a new session, the security appliance
verifies if the packet is allowed according to the security policy (access lists, filters, AAA).
3. The packet is denied, and the security appliance drops the packet and logs the connection attempt.
If the outside user is attempting to attack the inside network, the security appliance employs many
technologies to determine if a packet is valid for an already established session.
Outside
209.165.201.2
10.1.2.1 10.1.1.1
Inside DMZ
92402
The following steps describe how data moves through the security appliance (see Figure 15-6):
1. A user on the DMZ network attempts to reach an inside host. Because the DMZ does not have to
route the traffic on the internet, the private addressing scheme does not prevent routing.
2. The security appliance receives the packet and because it is a new session, the security appliance
verifies if the packet is allowed according to the security policy (access lists, filters, AAA).
3. The packet is denied, and the security appliance drops the packet and logs the connection attempt.
Note The transparent mode security appliance does not pass CDP packets or IPv6 packets, or any packets that
do not have a valid EtherType greater than or equal to 0x600. For example, you cannot pass IS-IS
packets. An exception is made for BPDUs, which are supported.
For example, you can establish routing protocol adjacencies through a transparent firewall; you can
allow OSPF, RIP, EIGRP, or BGP traffic through based on an extended access list. Likewise, protocols
like HSRP or VRRP can pass through the security appliance.
Non-IP traffic (for example AppleTalk, IPX, BPDUs, and MPLS) can be configured to go through using
an EtherType access list.
For features that are not directly supported on the transparent firewall, you can allow traffic to pass
through so that upstream and downstream routers can support the functionality. For example, by using
an extended access list, you can allow DHCP traffic (instead of the unsupported DHCP relay feature) or
multicast traffic such as that created by IP/TV.
Internet
10.1.1.1
Management IP
Network A 10.1.1.2
10.1.1.3
192.168.1.2
Network B
92411
Feature Description
Dynamic DNS —
DHCP relay The transparent firewall can act as a DHCP server, but it does not
support the DHCP relay commands. DHCP relay is not required
because you can allow DHCP traffic to pass through using two
extended access lists: one that allows DCHP requests from the inside
interface to the outside, and one that allows the replies from the server
in the other direction.
Dynamic routing protocols You can, however, add static routes for traffic originating on the
security appliance. You can also allow dynamic routing protocols
through the security appliance using an extended access list.
Feature Description
IPv6 You also cannot allow IPv6 using an EtherType access list.
Multicast You can allow multicast traffic through the security appliance by
allowing it in an extended access list.
NAT NAT is performed on the upstream router.
QoS —
VPN termination for through The transparent firewall supports site-to-site VPN tunnels for
traffic management connections only. It does not terminate VPN connections
for traffic through the security appliance. You can pass VPN traffic
through the security appliance using an extended access list, but it
does not terminate non-management connections. WebVPN is also not
supported.
www.example.com
Internet
209.165.201.2
Management IP
209.165.201.6
209.165.200.230 Host
209.165.201.3
92412
Web Server
209.165.200.225
This section describes how data moves through the security appliance, and includes the following topics:
• An Inside User Visits a Web Server, page 15-13
• An Outside User Visits a Web Server on the Inside Network, page 15-14
• An Outside User Attempts to Access an Inside Host, page 15-15
www.example.com
Internet
209.165.201.2
Management IP
209.165.201.6
92408
Host
209.165.201.3
The following steps describe how data moves through the security appliance (see Figure 15-9):
1. The user on the inside network requests a web page from www.example.com.
2. The security appliance receives the packet and adds the source MAC address to the MAC address
table, if required. Because it is a new session, it verifies that the packet is allowed according to the
terms of the security policy (access lists, filters, AAA).
For multiple context mode, the security appliance first classifies the packet according to a unique
interface.
3. The security appliance records that a session is established.
4. If the destination MAC address is in its table, the security appliance forwards the packet out of the
outside interface. The destination MAC address is that of the upstream router, 209.186.201.2.
If the destination MAC address is not in the security appliance table, the security appliance attempts
to discover the MAC address by sending an ARP request and a ping. The first packet is dropped.
5. The web server responds to the request; because the session is already established, the packet
bypasses the many lookups associated with a new connection.
6. The security appliance forwards the packet to the inside user.
Host
Internet
209.165.201.2
Management IP
209.165.201.6
209.165.201.1
209.165.200.230
92409
Web Server
209.165.200.225
The following steps describe how data moves through the security appliance (see Figure 15-10):
1. A user on the outside network requests a web page from the inside web server.
2. The security appliance receives the packet and adds the source MAC address to the MAC address
table, if required. Because it is a new session, it verifies that the packet is allowed according to the
terms of the security policy (access lists, filters, AAA).
For multiple context mode, the security appliance first classifies the packet according to a unique
interface.
3. The security appliance records that a session is established.
4. If the destination MAC address is in its table, the security appliance forwards the packet out of the
inside interface. The destination MAC address is that of the downstream router, 209.186.201.1.
If the destination MAC address is not in the security appliance table, the security appliance attempts
to discover the MAC address by sending an ARP request and a ping. The first packet is dropped.
5. The web server responds to the request; because the session is already established, the packet
bypasses the many lookups associated with a new connection.
Host
Internet
209.165.201.2
Management IP
209.165.201.6
92410
Host
209.165.201.3
The following steps describe how data moves through the security appliance (see Figure 15-11):
1. A user on the outside network attempts to reach an inside host.
2. The security appliance receives the packet and adds the source MAC address to the MAC address
table, if required. Because it is a new session, it verifies if the packet is allowed according to the
terms of the security policy (access lists, filters, AAA).
For multiple context mode, the security appliance first classifies the packet according to a unique
interface.
3. The packet is denied, and the security appliance drops the packet.
4. If the outside user is attempting to attack the inside network, the security appliance employs many
technologies to determine if a packet is valid for an already established session.
This chapter describes how to identify traffic with access lists. This chapter includes the following
topics:
• Access List Overview, page 16-1
• Adding an Extended Access List, page 16-5
• Adding an EtherType Access List, page 16-8
• Adding a Standard Access List, page 16-10
• Adding a Webtype Access List, page 16-11
• Simplifying Access Lists with Object Grouping, page 16-11
• Adding Remarks to Access Lists, page 16-17
• Scheduling Extended Access List Activation, page 16-18
• Logging Access List Activity, page 16-19
For information about IPv6 access lists, see the “Configuring IPv6 Access Lists” section on page 12-6.
You can disable an ACE by specifying the keyword inactive in the access-list command.
Figure 16-1 IP Addresses in Access Lists: NAT Used for Source Addresses
209.165.200.225
Outside
Inside
Inbound ACL
Permit from 10.1.1.0/24 to 209.165.200.225
10.1.1.0/24
104634
10.1.1.0/24 209.165.201.4:port
PAT
If you want to allow an outside host to access an inside host, you can apply an inbound access list on the
outside interface. You need to specify the translated address of the inside host in the access list because
that address is the address that can be used on the outside network (see Figure 16-2).
Figure 16-2 IP Addresses in Access Lists: NAT used for Destination Addresses
209.165.200.225
ACL
Permit from 209.165.200.225 to 209.165.201.5
Outside
Inside
104636
10.1.1.34 209.165.201.5
Static NAT
If you perform NAT on both interfaces, keep in mind the addresses that are visible to a given interface.
In Figure 16-3, an outside server uses static NAT so that a translated address appears on the inside
network.
Figure 16-3 IP Addresses in Access Lists: NAT used for Source and Destination Addresses
Static NAT
209.165.200.225 10.1.1.56
Outside
Inside
ACL
Permit from 10.1.1.0/24 to 10.1.1.56
10.1.1.0/24 104635
10.1.1.0/24 209.165.201.4:port
PAT
For information about logging options that you can add to the end of the ACE, see the “Logging Access
List Activity” section on page 16-19. For information about time range options, see “Scheduling
Extended Access List Activation” section on page 16-18.
For TCP and UDP connections, you do not need an access list to allow returning traffic, because the
FWSM allows all returning traffic for established, bidirectional connections. For connectionless
protocols such as ICMP, however, the security appliance establishes unidirectional sessions, so you
either need access lists to allow ICMP in both directions (by applying access lists to the source and
destination interfaces), or you need to enable the ICMP inspection engine. The ICMP inspection engine
treats ICMP sessions as bidirectional connections.
You can apply only one access list of each type (extended and EtherType) to each direction of an
interface. You can apply the same access lists on multiple interfaces. See Chapter 18, “Permitting or
Denying Network Access,” for more information about applying an access list to an interface.
Note If you change the access list configuration, and you do not want to wait for existing connections to time
out before the new access list information is used, you can clear the connections using the clear
local-host command.
Note Because these special types of traffic are connectionless, you need to apply an extended access list to
both interfaces, so returning traffic is allowed through.
Table 16-2 lists common traffic types that you can allow through the transparent firewall.
Tip Enter the access list name in upper case letters so the name is easy to see in the configuration. You might
want to name the access list for the interface (for example, INSIDE), or for the purpose for which it is
created (for example, NO_NAT or VPN).
Typically, you identify the ip keyword for the protocol, but other protocols are accepted. For a list of
protocol names, see the “Protocols and Applications” section on page D-11.
Enter the host keyword before the IP address to specify a single address. In this case, do not enter a mask.
Enter the any keyword instead of the address and mask to specify any address.
You can specify the source and destination ports only for the tcp or udp protocols. For a list of permitted
keywords and well-known port assignments, see the “TCP and UDP Ports” section on page D-11. DNS,
Discard, Echo, Ident, NTP, RPC, SUNRPC, and Talk each require one definition for TCP and one for
UDP. TACACS+ requires one definition for port 49 on TCP.
Use an operator to match port numbers used by the source or destination. The permitted operators are
as follows:
• lt—less than
• gt—greater than
• eq—equal to
• neq—not equal to
• range—an inclusive range of values. When you use this operator, specify two port numbers, for
example:
range 100 200
You can specify the ICMP type only for the icmp protocol. Because ICMP is a connectionless protocol,
you either need access lists to allow ICMP in both directions (by applying access lists to the source and
destination interfaces), or you need to enable the ICMP inspection engine (see the “Adding an ICMP
Type Object Group” section on page 16-14). The ICMP inspection engine treats ICMP sessions as
stateful connections. To control ping, specify echo-reply (0) (security appliance to host) or echo (8)
(host to security appliance). See the “Adding an ICMP Type Object Group” section on page 16-14 for a
list of ICMP types.
When you specify a network mask, the method is different from the Cisco IOS software access-list
command. The security appliance uses a network mask (for example, 255.255.255.0 for a Class C mask).
The Cisco IOS mask uses wildcard bits (for example, 0.0.0.255).
To make an ACE inactive, use the inactive keyword. To reenable it, enter the entire ACE without the
inactive keyword. This feature lets you keep a record of an inactive ACE in your configuration to make
reenabling easier.
See the following examples:
The following access list allows all hosts (on the interface to which you apply the access list) to go
through the security appliance:
hostname(config)# access-list ACL_IN extended permit ip any any
The following sample access list prevents hosts on 192.168.1.0/24 from accessing the 209.165.201.0/27
network. All other addresses are permitted.
hostname(config)# access-list ACL_IN extended deny tcp 192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0
209.165.201.0 255.255.255.224
hostname(config)# access-list ACL_IN extended permit ip any any
If you want to restrict access to only some hosts, then enter a limited permit ACE. By default, all other
traffic is denied unless explicitly permitted.
hostname(config)# access-list ACL_IN extended permit ip 192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0
209.165.201.0 255.255.255.224
The following access list restricts all hosts (on the interface to which you apply the access list) from
accessing a website at address 209.165.201.29. All other traffic is allowed.
hostname(config)# access-list ACL_IN extended deny tcp any host 209.165.201.29 eq www
hostname(config)# access-list ACL_IN extended permit ip any any
Supported EtherTypes
An EtherType ACE controls any EtherType identified by a 16-bit hexadecimal number.
EtherType access lists support Ethernet V2 frames.
802.3-formatted frames are not handled by the access list because they use a length field as opposed to
a type field.
BPDUs, which are handled by the access list, are the only exception: they are SNAP-encapsulated, and
the security appliance is designed to specifically handle BPDUs.
The security appliance receives trunk port (Cisco proprietary) BPDUs. Trunk BPDUs have VLAN
information inside the payload, so the security appliance modifies the payload with the outgoing VLAN
if you allow BPDUs.
Note If you use failover, you must allow BPDUs on both interfaces with an EtherType access list to avoid
bridging loops.
IPv6 Unsupported
EtherType ACEs do not allow IPv6 traffic, even if you specify the IPv6 EtherType.
Allowing MPLS
If you allow MPLS, ensure that Label Distribution Protocol and Tag Distribution Protocol TCP
connections are established through the security appliance by configuring both MPLS routers connected
to the security appliance to use the IP address on the security appliance interface as the router-id for LDP
or TDP sessions. (LDP and TDP allow MPLS routers to negotiate the labels (addresses) used to forward
packets.)
On Cisco IOS routers, enter the appropriate command for your protocol, LDP or TDP. The interface is
the interface connected to the security appliance.
hostname(config)# mpls ldp router-id interface force
Or
hostname(config)# tag-switching tdp router-id interface force
The hex_number is any EtherType that can be identified by a 16-bit hexadecimal number greater than or
equal to 0x600. See RFC 1700, “Assigned Numbers,” at http://www.ietf.org/rfc/rfc1700.txt for a list of
EtherTypes.
Note If an EtherType access list is configured to deny all, all ethernet frames are discarded. Only physical
protocol traffic, such as auto-negotiation, is still allowed.
When you enter the access-list command for a given access list name, the ACE is added to the end of
the access list.
Tip Enter the access_list_name in upper case letters so the name is easy to see in the configuration. You
might want to name the access list for the interface (for example, INSIDE), or for the purpose (for
example, MPLS or IPX).
For example, the following sample access list allows common EtherTypes originating on the inside
interface:
hostname(config)# access-list ETHER ethertype permit ipx
hostname(config)# access-list ETHER ethertype permit bpdu
hostname(config)# access-list ETHER ethertype permit mpls-unicast
hostname(config)# access-group ETHER in interface inside
The following access list allows some EtherTypes through the security appliance, but denies IPX:
hostname(config)# access-list ETHER ethertype deny ipx
hostname(config)# access-list ETHER ethertype permit 0x1234
hostname(config)# access-list ETHER ethertype permit bpdu
hostname(config)# access-list ETHER ethertype permit mpls-unicast
hostname(config)# access-group ETHER in interface inside
hostname(config)# access-group ETHER in interface outside
The following access list denies traffic with EtherType 0x1256, but allows all others on both interfaces:
hostname(config)# access-list nonIP ethertype deny 1256
hostname(config)# access-list nonIP ethertype permit any
hostname(config)# access-group ETHER in interface inside
hostname(config)# access-group ETHER in interface outside
For information about logging options that you can add to the end of the ACE, see the “Logging Access
List Activity” section on page 16-19.
After creating these groups, you could use a single ACE to allow trusted hosts to make specific service
requests to a group of public servers.
You can also nest object groups in other object groups.
Note The ACE system limit applies to expanded access lists. If you use object groups in ACEs, the number of
actual ACEs that you enter is fewer, but the number of expanded ACEs is the same as without object
groups. In many cases, object groups create more ACEs than if you added them manually, because
creating ACEs manually leads you to summarize addresses more than an object group does. To view the
number of expanded ACEs in an access list, enter the show access-list access_list_name command.
The protocol is the numeric identifier of the specific IP protocol (1 to 254) or a keyword identifier (for
example, icmp, tcp, or udp). To include all IP protocols, use the keyword ip. For a list of protocols you
can specify, see the “Protocols and Applications” section on page D-11.
For example, to create a protocol group for TCP, UDP, and ICMP, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# object-group protocol tcp_udp_icmp
hostname(config-protocol)# protocol-object tcp
hostname(config-protocol)# protocol-object udp
hostname(config-protocol)# protocol-object icmp
Note A network object group supports IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, depending on the type of access list. For more
information about IPv6 access lists, see “Configuring IPv6 Access Lists” section on page 12-6.
For example, to create network group that includes the IP addresses of three administrators, enter the
following commands:
hostname(config)# object-group network admins
hostname(config-network)# description Administrator Addresses
hostname(config-network)# network-object host 10.1.1.4
hostname(config-network)# network-object host 10.1.1.78
hostname(config-network)# network-object host 10.1.1.34
For a list of permitted keywords and well-known port assignments, see the “Protocols and Applications”
section on page D-11.
For example, to create service groups that include DNS (TCP/UDP), LDAP (TCP), and RADIUS (UDP),
enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# object-group service services1 tcp-udp
hostname(config-service)# description DNS Group
hostname(config-service)# port-object eq domain
See the “ICMP Types” section on page D-15 for a list of ICMP types.
For example, to create an ICMP type group that includes echo-reply and echo (for controlling ping),
enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# object-group icmp-type ping
hostname(config-service)# description Ping Group
hostname(config-icmp-type)# icmp-object echo
hostname(config-icmp-type)# icmp-object echo-reply
Step 1 To add or edit an object group under which you want to nest another object group, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# object-group {{protocol | network | icmp-type} grp_id | service grp_id
{tcp | udp | tcp-udp}}
Step 2 To add the specified group under the object group you specified in Step 1, enter the following command:
hostname(config-group_type)# group-object grp_id
For example, you create network object groups for privileged users from various departments:
hostname(config)# object-group network eng
hostname(config-network)# network-object host 10.1.1.5
hostname(config-network)# network-object host 10.1.1.9
hostname(config-network)# network-object host 10.1.1.89
hostname(config-network)# group-object hr
hostname(config-network)# group-object finance
You only need to specify the admin object group in your ACE as follows:
hostname(config)# access-list ACL_IN extended permit ip object-group admin host
209.165.201.29
You do not have to use object groups for all parameters; for example, you can use an object group for
the source address, but identify the destination address with an address and mask.
The following normal access list that does not use object groups restricts several hosts on the inside
network from accessing several web servers. All other traffic is allowed.
hostname(config)# access-list ACL_IN extended deny tcp host 10.1.1.4 host 209.165.201.29
eq www
hostname(config)# access-list ACL_IN extended deny tcp host 10.1.1.78 host 209.165.201.29
eq www
hostname(config)# access-list ACL_IN extended deny tcp host 10.1.1.89 host 209.165.201.29
eq www
hostname(config)# access-list ACL_IN extended deny tcp host 10.1.1.4 host 209.165.201.16
eq www
hostname(config)# access-list ACL_IN extended deny tcp host 10.1.1.78 host 209.165.201.16
eq www
hostname(config)# access-list ACL_IN extended deny tcp host 10.1.1.89 host 209.165.201.16
eq www
hostname(config)# access-list ACL_IN extended deny tcp host 10.1.1.4 host 209.165.201.78
eq www
hostname(config)# access-list ACL_IN extended deny tcp host 10.1.1.78 host 209.165.201.78
eq www
hostname(config)# access-list ACL_IN extended deny tcp host 10.1.1.89 host 209.165.201.78
eq www
hostname(config)# access-list ACL_IN extended permit ip any any
hostname(config)# access-group ACL_IN in interface inside
If you make two network object groups, one for the inside hosts, and one for the web servers, then the
configuration can be simplified and can be easily modified to add more hosts:
hostname(config)# object-group network denied
hostname(config-network)# network-object host 10.1.1.4
hostname(config-network)# network-object host 10.1.1.78
hostname(config-network)# network-object host 10.1.1.89
If you enter the command without any parameters, the system displays all configured object groups.
The following is sample output from the show object-group command:
hostname# show object-group
object-group network ftp_servers
description: This is a group of FTP servers
network-object host 209.165.201.3
network-object host 209.165.201.4
object-group network TrustedHosts
network-object host 209.165.201.1
network-object 192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0
group-object ftp_servers
Note You cannot remove an object group or make an object group empty if it is used in an access list.
• To remove all object groups of the specified type, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# clear object-group [protocol | network | services | icmp-type]
If you enter the remark before any access-list command, then the remark is the first line in the access list.
If you delete an access list using the no access-list access_list_name command, then all the remarks are
also removed.
The text can be up to 100 characters in length. You can enter leading spaces at the beginning of the text.
Trailing spaces are ignored.
For example, you can add remarks before each ACE, and the remark appears in the access list in this
location. Entering a dash (-) at the beginning of the remark helps set it apart from ACEs.
hostname(config)# access-list OUT remark - this is the inside admin address
hostname(config)# access-list OUT extended permit ip host 209.168.200.3 any
hostname(config)# access-list OUT remark - this is the hr admin address
hostname(config)# access-list OUT extended permit ip host 209.168.200.4 any
Step 2 Specify the time range as either a recurring time range or an absolute time range.
Multiple periodic entries are allowed per time-range command. If a time-range command has both
absolute and periodic values specified, then the periodic commands are evaluated only after the
absolute start time is reached, and are not further evaluated after the absolute end time is reached.
• Recurring time range:
hostname(config-time-range)# periodic days-of-the-week time to [days-of-the-week] time
The time is in the format hh:mm. For example, 8:00 is 8:00 a.m. and 20:00 is 8:00 p.m.
The date is in the format day month year; for example, 1 january 2006.
The following is an example of an absolute time range beginning at 8:00 a.m. on January 1, 2006.
Because no end time and date are specified, the time range is in effect indefinitely.
hostname(config)# time-range for2006
hostname(config-time-range)# absolute start 8:00 1 january 2006
The following is an example of a weekly periodic time range from 8:00 a.m. to 6:00 p.m on weekdays.:
hostname(config)# time-range workinghours
hostname(config-time-range)# periodic weekdays 8:00 to 18:00
See the “Adding an Extended Access List” section on page 16-5 for complete access-list command
syntax.
Note If you also enable logging for the ACE, use the log keyword before the time-range keyword. If you
disable the ACE using the inactive keyword, use the inactive keyword as the last keyword.
The following example binds an access list named “Sales” to a time range named “New_York_Minute.”
hostname(config)# access-list Sales line 1 extended deny tcp host 209.165.200.225 host
209.165.201.1 time-range New_York_Minute
If the security appliance is attacked, the number of system messages for denied packets can be very large.
We recommend that you instead enable logging using system message 106100, which provides statistics
for each ACE and lets you limit the number of system messages produced. Alternatively, you can disable
all logging.
Note Only ACEs in the access list generate logging messages; the implicit deny at the end of the access list
does not generate a message. If you want all denied traffic to generate messages, add the implicit ACE
manually to the end of the access list, as follows.
hostname(config)# access-list TEST deny ip any any log
The log options at the end of the extended access-list command lets you to set the following behavior:
• Enable message 106100 instead of message 106023
• Disable all logging
• Return to the default logging using message 106023
System message 106100 is in the following form:
%ASA|PIX-n-106100: access-list acl_id {permitted | denied} protocol
interface_name/source_address(source_port) -> interface_name/dest_address(dest_port)
hit-cnt number ({first hit | number-second interval})
When you enable logging for message 106100, if a packet matches an ACE, the security appliance
creates a flow entry to track the number of packets received within a specific interval. The security
appliance generates a system message at the first hit and at the end of each interval, identifying the total
number of hits during the interval. At the end of each interval, the security appliance resets the hit count
to 0. If no packets match the ACE during an interval, the security appliance deletes the flow entry.
A flow is defined by the source and destination IP addresses, protocols, and ports. Because the source
port might differ for a new connection between the same two hosts, you might not see the same flow
increment because a new flow was created for the connection. See the “Managing Deny Flows” section
on page 16-21 to limit the number of logging flows.
Permitted packets that belong to established connections do not need to be checked against access lists;
only the initial packet is logged and included in the hit count. For connectionless protocols, such as
ICMP, all packets are logged even if they are permitted, and all denied packets are logged.
See the Cisco Security Appliance Logging Configuration and System Log Messages for detailed
information about this system message.
See the “Adding an Extended Access List” section on page 16-5 and “Adding a Webtype Access List”
section on page 16-11 for complete access-list command syntax.
If you enter the log option without any arguments, you enable system log message 106100 at the default
level (6) and for the default interval (300 seconds). See the following options:
• level—A severity level between 0 and 7. The default is 6.
• interval secs—The time interval in seconds between system messages, from 1 to 600. The default
is 300. This value is also used as the timeout value for deleting an inactive flow.
• disable—Disables all access list logging.
• default—Enables logging to message 106023. This setting is the same as having no log option.
For example, you configure the following access list:
hostname(config)# access-list outside-acl permit ip host 1.1.1.1 any log 7 interval 600
hostname(config)# access-list outside-acl permit ip host 2.2.2.2 any
hostname(config)# access-list outside-acl deny ip any any log 2
hostname(config)# access-group outside-acl in interface outside
When a packet is permitted by the first ACE of outside-acl, the security appliance generates the
following system message:
%ASA|PIX-7-106100: access-list outside-acl permitted tcp outside/1.1.1.1(12345) ->
inside/192.168.1.1(1357) hit-cnt 1 (first hit)
Although 20 additional packets for this connection arrive on the outside interface, the traffic does not
have to be checked against the access list, and the hit count does not increase.
If one more connection by the same host is initiated within the specified 10 minute interval (and the
source and destination ports remain the same), then the hit count is incremented by 1 and the following
message is displayed at the end of the 10 minute interval:
%ASA|PIX-7-106100: access-list outside-acl permitted tcp outside/1.1.1.1(12345)->
inside/192.168.1.1(1357) hit-cnt 2 (600-second interval)
When a packet is denied by the third ACE, the security appliance generates the following system
message:
%ASA|PIX-2-106100: access-list outside-acl denied ip outside/3.3.3.3(12345) ->
inside/192.168.1.1(1357) hit-cnt 1 (first hit)
20 additional attempts within a 5 minute interval (the default) result in the following message at the end
of 5 minutes:
%ASA|PIX-2-106100: access-list outside-acl denied ip outside/3.3.3.3(12345) ->
inside/192.168.1.1(1357) hit-cnt 21 (300-second interval)
To configure the maximum number of deny flows and to set the interval between deny flow alert
messages (106101), enter the following commands:
• To set the maximum number of deny flows permitted per context before the security appliance stops
logging, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# access-list deny-flow-max number
This chapter describes Network Address Translation (NAT). In routed firewall mode, the security
appliance can perform NAT between each network.
Note In transparent firewall mode, the security appliance does not support NAT.
NAT Overview
This section describes how NAT works on the security appliance, and includes the following topics:
• Introduction to NAT, page 17-2
• NAT Control, page 17-3
• NAT Types, page 17-5
• Policy NAT, page 17-9
• NAT and Same Security Level Interfaces, page 17-12
• Order of NAT Commands Used to Match Real Addresses, page 17-13
• Mapped Address Guidelines, page 17-13
• DNS and NAT, page 17-14
Introduction to NAT
Address translation substitutes the real address in a packet with a mapped address that is routable on the
destination network. NAT is comprised of two steps: the process in which a real address is translated into
a mapped address, and then the process to undo translation for returning traffic.
The security appliance translates an address when a NAT rule matches the traffic. If no NAT rule
matches, processing for the packet continues. The exception is when you enable NAT control.
NAT control requires that packets traversing from a higher security interface (inside) to a lower security
interface (outside) match a NAT rule, or else processing for the packet stops. (See the “Security Level
Overview” section on page 7-1 for more information about security levels, and see “NAT Control”
section on page 17-3 for more information about NAT control).
Note In this document, all types of translation are generally referred to as NAT. When discussing NAT, the
terms inside and outside are relative, and represent the security relationship between any two interfaces.
The higher security level is inside and the lower security level is outside; for example, interface 1 is at
60 and interface 2 is at 50, so interface 1 is “inside” and interface 2 is “outside.”
Web Server
www.cisco.com
Outside
209.165.201.2
Originating Responding
Packet Security Packet
Appliance
Translation Undo Translation
10.1.2.27 209.165.201.10 209.165.201.10 10.1.2.27
10.1.2.1
Inside
130023
10.1.2.27
NAT Control
NAT control requires that packets traversing from an inside interface to an outside interface match a NAT
rule; for any host on the inside network to access a host on the outside network, you must configure NAT
to translate the inside host address (see Figure 17-2).
Security
Appliance
10.1.1.1 NAT 209.165.201.1
10.1.2.1 No NAT
132212
Inside Outside
Interfaces at the same security level are not required to use NAT to communicate. However, if you
configure dynamic NAT or PAT on a same security interface, then all traffic from the interface to a same
security interface or an outside interface must match a NAT rule (see Figure 17-3).
Security Security
Appliance Appliance
10.1.1.1 Dyn. NAT 209.165.201.1
10.1.1.1 No NAT 10.1.1.1
10.1.2.1 No NAT
Level 50 Level 50
132215
Level 50 Level 50
or
Outside
Similarly, if you enable outside dynamic NAT or PAT, then all outside traffic must match a NAT rule
when it accesses an inside interface (see Figure 17-4).
Security Security
Appliance Appliance
132213
Outside Inside Outside Inside
Note In multiple context mode, the packet classifier might rely on the NAT configuration to assign packets to
contexts if you do not enable unique MAC addresses for shared interfaces. See the “How the Security
Appliance Classifies Packets” section on page 3-3 for more information about the relationship between
the classifier and NAT.
NAT Types
This section describes the available NAT types. You can implement address translation as dynamic NAT,
Port Address Translation, static NAT, or static PAT or as a mix of these types. You can also configure
rules to bypass NAT, for example, if you enable NAT control but do not want to perform NAT. This
section includes the following topics:
• Dynamic NAT, page 17-5
• PAT, page 17-7
• Static NAT, page 17-7
• Static PAT, page 17-8
• Bypassing NAT when NAT Control is Enabled, page 17-9
Dynamic NAT
Dynamic NAT translates a group of real addresses to a pool of mapped addresses that are routable on the
destination network. The mapped pool can include fewer addresses than the real group. When a host you
want to translate accesses the destination network, the security appliance assigns it an IP address from
the mapped pool. The translation is added only when the real host initiates the connection. The
translation is in place only for the duration of the connection, and a given user does not keep the same
IP address after the translation times out (see the timeout xlate command in the Cisco Security
Appliance Command Reference). Users on the destination network, therefore, cannot reliably initiate a
connection to a host that uses dynamic NAT (even if the connection is allowed by an access list), and the
security appliance rejects any attempt to connect to a real host address directly. See the following “Static
NAT” or “Static PAT” sections for reliable access to hosts.
Note In some cases, a translation is added for a connection (see the show xlate command) even though the
session is denied by the security appliance. This condition occurs with an outbound access list, a
management-only interface, or a backup interface. The translation times out normally.
Figure 17-5 shows a remote host attempting to connect to the real address. The connection is denied
because the security appliance only allows returning connections to the mapped address.
Web Server
www.example.com
Outside
209.165.201.2
10.1.2.27
Security
Appliance
Translation
10.1.2.27 209.165.201.10
10.1.2.1
Inside
132216
10.1.2.27
Figure 17-6 shows a remote host attempting to initiate a connection to a mapped address. This address
is not currently in the translation table, so the security appliance drops the packet.
Web Server
www.example.com
Outside
209.165.201.2
209.165.201.10
Security
Appliance
10.1.2.1
Inside
132217
10.1.2.27
Note For the duration of the translation, a remote host can initiate a connection to the translated host if an
access list allows it. Because the address is unpredictable, a connection to the host is unlikely. However
in this case, you can rely on the security of the access list.
PAT
PAT translates multiple real addresses to a single mapped IP address. Specifically, the security appliance
translates the real address and source port (real socket) to the mapped address and a unique port above
1024 (mapped socket). Each connection requires a separate translation, because the source port differs
for each connection. For example, 10.1.1.1:1025 requires a separate translation from 10.1.1.1:1026.
After the connection expires, the port translation also expires after 30 seconds of inactivity. The timeout
is not configurable. Users on the destination network cannot reliably initiate a connection to a host that
uses PAT (even if the connection is allowed by an access list). Not only can you not predict the real or
mapped port number of the host, but the security appliance does not create a translation at all unless the
translated host is the initiator. See the following “Static NAT” or “Static PAT” sections for reliable access
to hosts.
PAT lets you use a single mapped address, thus conserving routable addresses. You can even use the
security appliance interface IP address as the PAT address. PAT does not work with some multimedia
applications that have a data stream that is different from the control path. See the “When to Use
Application Protocol Inspection” section on page 25-2 for more information about NAT and PAT
support.
Note For the duration of the translation, a remote host can initiate a connection to the translated host if an
access list allows it. Because the port address (both real and mapped) is unpredictable, a connection to
the host is unlikely. However in this case, you can rely on the security of the access list.
Static NAT
Static NAT creates a fixed translation of real address(es) to mapped address(es).With dynamic NAT and
PAT, each host uses a different address or port for each subsequent translation. Because the mapped
address is the same for each consecutive connection with static NAT, and a persistent translation rule
exists, static NAT allows hosts on the destination network to initiate traffic to a translated host (if there
is an access list that allows it).
The main difference between dynamic NAT and a range of addresses for static NAT is that static NAT
allows a remote host to initiate a connection to a translated host (if there is an access list that allows it),
while dynamic NAT does not. You also need an equal number of mapped addresses as real addresses with
static NAT.
Static PAT
Static PAT is the same as static NAT, except it lets you specify the protocol (TCP or UDP) and port for
the real and mapped addresses.
This feature lets you identify the same mapped address across many different static statements, so long
as the port is different for each statement (you cannot use the same mapped address for multiple static
NAT statements).
For applications that require application inspection for secondary channels (FTP, VoIP, etc.), the security
appliance automatically translates the secondary ports.
For example, if you want to provide a single address for remote users to access FTP, HTTP, and SMTP,
but these are all actually different servers on the real network, you can specify static PAT statements for
each server that uses the same mapped IP address, but different ports (see Figure 17-7).
Host
Outside
Undo Translation
209.165.201.3:21 10.1.2.27
Undo Translation
209.165.201.3:25 10.1.2.29
Undo Translation
209.165.201.3:80 10.1.2.28
Inside
HTTP server
10.1.2.28
You can also use static PAT to translate a well-known port to a non-standard port or vice versa. For
example, if your inside web servers use port 8080, you can allow outside users to connect to port 80, and
then undo translation to the original port 8080. Similarly, if you want to provide extra security, you can
tell your web users to connect to non-standard port 6785, and then undo translation to port 80.
Policy NAT
Policy NAT lets you identify real addresses for address translation by specifying the source and
destination addresses in an extended access list. You can also optionally specify the source and
destination ports. Regular NAT can only consider the real addresses. For example, you can use translate
the real address to mapped address A when it accesses server A, but translate the real address to mapped
address B when it accesses server B.
When you specify the ports in policy NAT for applications that require application inspection for
secondary channels (FTP, VoIP, etc.), the security appliance automatically translates the secondary ports.
Note All types of NAT support policy NAT except for NAT exemption. NAT exemption uses an access list to
identify the real addresses, but differs from policy NAT in that the ports are not considered. See the
“Bypassing NAT” section on page 17-28 for other differences. You can accomplish the same result as
NAT exemption using static identity NAT, which does support policy NAT.
Figure 17-8 shows a host on the 10.1.2.0/24 network accessing two different servers. When the host
accesses the server at 209.165.201.11, the real address is translated to 209.165.202.129. When the host
accesses the server at 209.165.200.225, the real address is translated to 209.165.202.130 so that the host
appears to be on the same network as the servers, which can help with routing.
Server 1 Server 2
209.165.201.11 209.165.200.225
209.165.201.0/27 209.165.200.224/27
DMZ
Translation Translation
10.1.2.27 209.165.202.129 10.1.2.27 209.165.202.130
Inside
10.1.2.0/24
Packet Packet
Dest. Address: Dest. Address:
130039
209.165.201.11 209.165.200.225
10.1.2.27
Figure 17-9 shows the use of source and destination ports. The host on the 10.1.2.0/24 network accesses
a single host for both web services and Telnet services. When the host accesses the server for web
services, the real address is translated to 209.165.202.129. When the host accesses the same server for
Telnet services, the real address is translated to 209.165.202.130.
Internet
Translation Translation
10.1.2.27:80 209.165.202.129 10.1.2.27:23 209.165.202.130
Inside
10.1.2.0/24
130040
209.165.201.11:80 209.165.201.11:23
10.1.2.27
For policy static NAT (and for NAT exemption, which also uses an access list to identify traffic), both
translated and remote hosts can originate traffic. For traffic originated on the translated network, the
NAT access list specifies the real addresses and the destination addresses, but for traffic originated on
the remote network, the access list identifies the real addresses and the source addresses of remote hosts
who are allowed to connect to the host using this translation.
Figure 17-10 shows a remote host connecting to a translated host. The translated host has a policy static
NAT translation that translates the real address only for traffic to and from the 209.165.201.0/27
network. A translation does not exist for the 209.165.200.224/27 network, so the translated host cannot
connect to that network, nor can a host on that network connect to the translated host.
209.165.201.11 209.165.200.225
209.165.201.0/27 209.165.200.224/27
DMZ
No Translation
Undo Translation
209.165.202.12910.1.2.27
Inside
10.1.2.0/27
130037
10.1.2.27
Note Policy NAT does not support SQL*Net, but it is supported by regular NAT. See the “When to Use
Application Protocol Inspection” section on page 25-2 for information about NAT support for other
protocols.
Note The security appliance does not support VoIP inspection engines when you configure NAT on same
security interfaces. These inspection engines include Skinny, SIP, and H.323. See the “When to Use
Application Protocol Inspection” section on page 25-2 for supported inspection engines.
DNS Server
1
DNS Query Outside
ftp.cisco.com?
2
DNS Reply
Security
209.165.201.10
Appliance
3
DNS Reply Modification
209.165.201.10 10.1.3.14
Inside
4
DNS Reply
10.1.3.14
User ftp.cisco.com
10.1.3.14
Static Translation
on Outside to:
209.165.201.10
130021
5
FTP Request
10.1.3.14
Figure 17-12 shows a web server and DNS server on the outside. The security appliance has a static
translation for the outside server. In this case, when an inside user requests the address for ftp.cisco.com
from the DNS server, the DNS server responds with the real address, 209.165.20.10. Because you want
inside users to use the mapped address for ftp.cisco.com (10.1.2.56) you need to configure DNS reply
modification for the static translation.
ftp.cisco.com
209.165.201.10
Static Translation on Inside to:
10.1.2.56
DNS Server
FTP Request
1 209.165.201.10
DNS Query Outside
ftp.cisco.com? 6
2
Dest Addr. Translation
DNS Reply 10.1.2.56 209.165.201.10
209.165.201.10 Security
3 Appliance
5
DNS Reply Modification
209.165.201.10 10.1.2.56 FTP Request
10.1.2.56
Inside
4
DNS Reply
10.1.2.56
130022
User
10.1.2.27
Web Server:
www.cisco.com
Outside
Global 1: 209.165.201.3-
209.165.201.10
Translation
10.1.2.27 209.165.201.3
NAT 1: 10.1.2.0/24
Inside
130027
10.1.2.27
You can enter a nat command for each interface using the same NAT ID; they all use the same global
command when traffic exits a given interface. For example, you can configure nat commands for Inside
and DMZ interfaces, both on NAT ID 1. Then you configure a global command on the Outside interface
that is also on ID 1. Traffic from the Inside interface and the DMZ interface share a mapped pool or a
PAT address when exiting the Outside interface (see Figure 17-14).
Web Server:
www.cisco.com
Outside Translation
10.1.1.15 209.165.201.4
Global 1: 209.165.201.3-
209.165.201.10
NAT 1: 10.1.1.0/24
Translation DMZ
10.1.2.27 209.165.201.3 10.1.1.15
NAT 1: 10.1.2.0/24
Inside
130028
10.1.2.27
You can also enter a global command for each interface using the same NAT ID. If you enter a global
command for the Outside and DMZ interfaces on ID 1, then the Inside nat command identifies traffic to
be translated when going to both the Outside and the DMZ interfaces. Similarly, if you also enter a nat
command for the DMZ interface on ID 1, then the global command on the Outside interface is also used
for DMZ traffic. (See Figure 17-15).
Web Server:
www.cisco.com
Outside Translation
10.1.1.15 209.165.201.4
Global 1: 209.165.201.3-
209.165.201.10
Security
Appliance NAT 1: 10.1.1.0/24
Global 1: 10.1.1.23
Translation DMZ
10.1.2.27 209.165.201.3 10.1.1.15
NAT 1: 10.1.2.0/24
Inside
Translation
10.1.2.27 10.1.1.23:2024
130024
10.1.2.27
If you use different NAT IDs, you can identify different sets of real addresses to have different mapped
addresses. For example, on the Inside interface, you can have two nat commands on two different
NAT IDs. On the Outside interface, you configure two global commands for these two IDs. Then, when
traffic from Inside network A exits the Outside interface, the IP addresses are translated to pool A
addresses; while traffic from Inside network B are translated to pool B addresses (see Figure 17-16). If
you use policy NAT, you can specify the same real addresses for multiple nat commands, as long as the
the destination addresses and ports are unique in each access list.
Web Server:
www.cisco.com
Outside
Global 1: 209.165.201.3-
209.165.201.10
Global 2: 209.165.201.11
Security
Appliance Translation
192.168.1.14 209.165.201.11:4567
Inside
10.1.2.27
130025
192.168.1.14
You can enter multiple global commands for one interface using the same NAT ID; the security
appliance uses the dynamic NAT global commands first, in the order they are in the configuration, and
then uses the PAT global commands in order. You might want to enter both a dynamic NAT global
command and a PAT global command if you need to use dynamic NAT for a particular application, but
want to have a backup PAT statement in case all the dynamic NAT addresses are depleted. Similarly, you
might enter two PAT statements if you need more than the approximately 64,000 PAT sessions that a
single PAT mapped statement supports (see Figure 17-17).
Web Server:
www.cisco.com
Translation
10.1.2.27 209.165.201.3 Outside
Global 1: 209.165.201.3-
209.165.201.4
Global 1: 209.165.201.5
Translation
10.1.2.29 209.165.201.5:6096
Translation
10.1.2.28 209.165.201.4
NAT 1: 10.1.2.0/24
Inside
10.1.2.27 10.1.2.29
130026
10.1.2.28
For outside NAT, you need to identify the nat command for outside NAT (the outside keyword). If you
also want to translate the same traffic when it accesses an inside interface (for example, traffic on a DMZ
is translated when accessing the Inside and the Outside interfaces), then you must configure a separate
nat command without the outside option. In this case, you can identify the same addresses in both
statements and use the same NAT ID (see Figure 17-18). Note that for outside NAT (DMZ interface to
Inside interface), the inside host uses a static command to allow outside access, so both the source and
destination addresses are translated.
Outside Translation
10.1.1.15 209.165.201.4
Global 1: 209.165.201.3-
209.165.201.10
Translation
10.1.1.15 10.1.2.30
Inside
Undo Translation
10.1.1.5 10.1.2.27
130038
10.1.2.27
When you specify a group of IP address(es) in a nat command, then you must perform NAT on that group
of addresses when they access any lower or same security level interface; you must apply a global
command with the same NAT ID on each interface, or use a static command. NAT is not required for
that group when it accesses a higher security interface, because to perform NAT from outside to inside,
you must create a separate nat command using the outside keyword. If you do apply outside NAT, then
the NAT requirements preceding come into effect for that group of addresses when they access all higher
security interfaces. Traffic identified by a static command is not affected.
Security
Appliance
10.1.1.1 209.165.201.1
10.1.1.2 209.165.201.2
130032
Inside Outside
Figure 17-20 shows a typical dynamic PAT scenario. Only translated hosts can create a NAT session, and
responding traffic is allowed back. The mapped address defined by the global command is the same for
each translation, but the port is dynamically assigned.
Security
Appliance
10.1.1.1:1025 209.165.201.1:2020
10.1.1.1:1026 209.165.201.1:2021
10.1.1.2:1025 209.165.201.1:2022
130034
Inside Outside
For more information about dynamic NAT, see the “Dynamic NAT” section on page 17-5. For more
information about PAT, see the “PAT” section on page 17-7.
Note If you change the NAT configuration, and you do not want to wait for existing translations to time out
before the new NAT information is used, you can clear the translation table using the clear xlate
command. However, clearing the translation table disconnects all current connections that use
translations.
Step 1 To identify the real addresses that you want to translate, enter one of the following commands:
• Policy NAT:
hostname(config)# nat (real_interface) nat_id access-list acl_name [dns] [outside]
[norandomseq] [[tcp] tcp_max_conns [emb_limit]] [udp udp_max_conns]
You can identify overlapping addresses in other nat commands. For example, you can identify
10.1.1.0 in one command, but 10.1.1.1 in another. The traffic is matched to a policy NAT command
in order, until the first match, or for regular NAT, using the best match.
See the following description about options for this command:
– access-list acl_name—Identify the real addresses and destination addresses using an extended
access list. Create the access list using the access-list command (see the “Adding an Extended
Access List” section on page 16-5). This access list should include only permit ACEs. You can
optionally specify the real and destination ports in the access list using the eq operator. Policy
NAT does not consider the inactive or time-range keywords; all ACEs are considered to be
active for policy NAT configuration.
– nat_id—An integer between 1 and 65535. The NAT ID should match a global command NAT
ID. See the “Dynamic NAT and PAT Implementation” section on page 17-16 for more
information about how NAT IDs are used. 0 is reserved for NAT exemption. (See the
“Configuring NAT Exemption” section on page 17-31 for more information about NAT
exemption.)
– dns—If your nat command includes the address of a host that has an entry in a DNS server, and
the DNS server is on a different interface from a client, then the client and the DNS server need
different addresses for the host; one needs the mapped address and one needs the real address.
This option rewrites the address in the DNS reply to the client. The translated host needs to be
on the same interface as either the client or the DNS server. Typically, hosts that need to allow
access from other interfaces use a static translation, so this option is more likely to be used with
the static command. (See the “DNS and NAT” section on page 17-14 for more information.)
– outside—If this interface is on a lower security level than the interface you identify by the
matching global statement, then you must enter outside to identify the NAT instance as
outside NAT.
– norandomseq, tcp tcp_max_conns, udp udp_max_conns, and emb_limit—These keywords set
connection limits. However, we recommend using a more versatile method for setting
connection limits; see the “Configuring Connection Limits and Timeouts” section on page 23-4.
• Regular NAT:
hostname(config)# nat (real_interface) nat_id real_ip [mask [dns] [outside]
[norandomseq] [[tcp] tcp_max_conns [emb_limit]] [udp udp_max_conns]]
The nat_id is an integer between 1 and 2147483647. The NAT ID must match a global command
NAT ID. See the “Dynamic NAT and PAT Implementation” section on page 17-16 for more
information about how NAT IDs are used. 0 is reserved for identity NAT. See the “Configuring
Identity NAT” section on page 17-28 for more information about identity NAT.
See the preceding policy NAT command for information about other options.
Step 2 To identify the mapped address(es) to which you want to translate the real addresses when they exit a
particular interface, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# global (mapped_interface) nat_id {mapped_ip[-mapped_ip] | interface}
This NAT ID should match a nat command NAT ID. The matching nat command identifies the addresses
that you want to translate when they exit this interface.
You can specify a single address (for PAT) or a range of addresses (for NAT). The range can go across
subnet boundaries if desired. For example, you can specify the following “supernet”:
192.168.1.1-192.168.2.254
For example, to translate the 10.1.1.0/24 network on the inside interface, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# nat (inside) 1 10.1.1.0 255.255.255.0
hostname(config)# global (outside) 1 209.165.201.1-209.165.201.30
To identify a pool of addresses for dynamic NAT as well as a PAT address for when the NAT pool is
exhausted, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# nat (inside) 1 10.1.1.0 255.255.255.0
hostname(config)# global (outside) 1 209.165.201.5
hostname(config)# global (outside) 1 209.165.201.10-209.165.201.20
To translate the lower security dmz network addresses so they appear to be on the same network as the
inside network (10.1.1.0), for example, to simplify routing, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# nat (dmz) 1 10.1.2.0 255.255.255.0 outside dns
hostname(config)# global (inside) 1 10.1.1.45
To identify a single real address with two different destination addresses using policy NAT, enter the
following commands (see Figure 17-8 on page 17-10 for a related figure):
hostname(config)# access-list NET1 permit ip 10.1.2.0 255.255.255.0 209.165.201.0
255.255.255.224
hostname(config)# access-list NET2 permit ip 10.1.2.0 255.255.255.0 209.165.200.224
255.255.255.224
hostname(config)# nat (inside) 1 access-list NET1 tcp 0 2000 udp 10000
hostname(config)# global (outside) 1 209.165.202.129
hostname(config)# nat (inside) 2 access-list NET2 tcp 1000 500 udp 2000
hostname(config)# global (outside) 2 209.165.202.130
To identify a single real address/destination address pair that use different ports using policy NAT, enter
the following commands (see Figure 17-9 on page 17-11 for a related figure):
hostname(config)# access-list WEB permit tcp 10.1.2.0 255.255.255.0 209.165.201.11
255.255.255.255 eq 80
hostname(config)# access-list TELNET permit tcp 10.1.2.0 255.255.255.0 209.165.201.11
255.255.255.255 eq 23
hostname(config)# nat (inside) 1 access-list WEB
hostname(config)# global (outside) 1 209.165.202.129
hostname(config)# nat (inside) 2 access-list TELNET
hostname(config)# global (outside) 2 209.165.202.130
Security
Appliance
10.1.1.1 209.165.201.1
10.1.1.2 209.165.201.2
130035
Inside Outside
You cannot use the same real or mapped address in multiple static commands between the same two
interfaces. Do not use a mapped address in the static command that is also defined in a global command
for the same mapped interface.
For more information about static NAT, see the “Static NAT” section on page 17-7.
Note If you remove a static command, existing connections that use the translation are not affected. To remove
these connections, enter the clear local-host command.
You cannot clear static translations from the translation table with the clear xlate command; you must
remove the static command instead. Only dynamic translations created by the nat and global commands
can be removed with the clear xlate command.
Create the access list using the access-list command (see the “Adding an Extended Access List”
section on page 16-5). This access list should include only permit ACEs. The source subnet mask
used in the access list is also used for the mapped addresses. You can also specify the real and
destination ports in the access list using the eq operator. Policy NAT does not consider the inactive
or time-range keywords; all ACEs are considered to be active for policy NAT configuration. See
the “Policy NAT” section on page 17-9 for more information.
If you specify a network for translation (for example, 10.1.1.0 255.255.255.0), then the security
appliance translates the .0 and .255 addresses. If you want to prevent access to these addresses, be
sure to configure an access list to deny access.
See the “Configuring Dynamic NAT or PAT” section on page 17-22 for information about the other
options.
• To configure regular static NAT, enter the following command:
See the “Configuring Dynamic NAT or PAT” section on page 17-22 for information about the
options.
For example, the following policy static NAT example shows a single real address that is translated to
two mapped addresses depending on the destination address (see Figure 17-8 on page 17-10 for a related
figure):
hostname(config)# access-list NET1 permit ip host 10.1.2.27 209.165.201.0 255.255.255.224
hostname(config)# access-list NET2 permit ip host 10.1.2.27 209.165.200.224
255.255.255.224
hostname(config)# static (inside,outside) 209.165.202.129 access-list NET1
hostname(config)# static (inside,outside) 209.165.202.130 access-list NET2
The following command maps an inside IP address (10.1.1.3) to an outside IP address (209.165.201.12):
hostname(config)# static (inside,outside) 209.165.201.12 10.1.1.3 netmask 255.255.255.255
The following command maps the outside address (209.165.201.15) to an inside address (10.1.1.6):
hostname(config)# static (outside,inside) 10.1.1.6 209.165.201.15 netmask 255.255.255.255
Security
Appliance
10.1.1.1:23 209.165.201.1:23
10.1.1.2:8080 209.165.201.2:80
130044
Inside Outside
For applications that require application inspection for secondary channels (FTP, VoIP, etc.), the security
appliance automatically translates the secondary ports.
You cannot use the same real or mapped address in multiple static statements between the same two
interfaces. Do not use a mapped address in the static command that is also defined in a global command
for the same mapped interface.
For more information about static PAT, see the “Static PAT” section on page 17-8.
Note If you remove a static command, existing connections that use the translation are not affected. To remove
these connections, enter the clear local-host command.
You cannot clear static translations from the translation table with the clear xlate command; you must
remove the static command instead. Only dynamic translations created by the nat and global commands
can be removed with the clear xlate command.
Create the access list using the access-list command (see the “Adding an Extended Access List”
section on page 16-5). The protocol in the access list must match the protocol you set in this
command. For example, if you specify tcp in the static command, then you must specify tcp in the
access list. Specify the port using the eq operator. This access list should include only permit ACEs.
The source subnet mask used in the access list is also used for the mapped addresses. Policy NAT
does not consider the inactive or time-range keywords; all ACEs are considered to be active for
policy NAT configuration.
If you specify a network for translation (for example, 10.1.1.0 255.255.255.0), then the security
appliance translates the .0 and .255 addresses. If you want to prevent access to these addresses, be
sure to configure an access list to deny access.
See the “Configuring Dynamic NAT or PAT” section on page 17-22 for information about the other
options.
• To configure regular static PAT, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# static (real_interface,mapped_interface) {tcp | udp} {mapped_ip |
interface} mapped_port real_ip real_port [netmask mask] [dns] [norandomseq] [[tcp]
tcp_max_conns [emb_limit]] [udp udp_max_conns]
See the “Configuring Dynamic NAT or PAT” section on page 17-22 for information about the
options.
For example, for Telnet traffic initiated from hosts on the 10.1.3.0 network to the security appliance
outside interface (10.1.2.14), you can redirect the traffic to the inside host at 10.1.1.15 by entering the
following commands:
hostname(config)# access-list TELNET permit tcp host 10.1.1.15 eq telnet 10.1.3.0
255.255.255.0 eq telnet
hostname(config)# static (inside,outside) tcp 10.1.2.14 telnet access-list TELNET
For HTTP traffic initiated from hosts on the 10.1.3.0 network to the security appliance outside interface
(10.1.2.14), you can redirect the traffic to the inside host at 10.1.1.15 by entering:
hostname(config)# access-list HTTP permit tcp host 10.1.1.15 eq http 10.1.3.0
255.255.255.0 eq http
hostname(config)# static (inside,outside) tcp 10.1.2.14 http access-list HTTP
To redirect Telnet traffic from the security appliance outside interface (10.1.2.14) to the inside host at
10.1.1.15, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# static (inside,outside) tcp 10.1.2.14 telnet 10.1.1.15 telnet netmask
255.255.255.255
If you want to allow the preceding real Telnet server to initiate connections, though, then you need to
provide additional translation. For example, to translate all other types of traffic, enter the following
commands. The original static command provides translation for Telnet to the server, while the nat and
global commands provide PAT for outbound connections from the server.
hostname(config)# static (inside,outside) tcp 10.1.2.14 telnet 10.1.1.15 telnet netmask
255.255.255.255
hostname(config)# nat (inside) 1 10.1.1.15 255.255.255.255
hostname(config)# global (outside) 1 10.1.2.14
If you also have a separate translation for all inside traffic, and the inside hosts use a different mapped
address from the Telnet server, you can still configure traffic initiated from the Telnet server to use the
same mapped address as the static statement that allows Telnet traffic to the server. You need to create
a more exclusive nat statement just for the Telnet server. Because nat statements are read for the best
match, more exclusive nat statements are matched before general statements. The following example
shows the Telnet static statement, the more exclusive nat statement for initiated traffic from the Telnet
server, and the statement for other inside hosts, which uses a different mapped address.
hostname(config)# static (inside,outside) tcp 10.1.2.14 telnet 10.1.1.15 telnet netmask
255.255.255.255
hostname(config)# nat (inside) 1 10.1.1.15 255.255.255.255
hostname(config)# global (outside) 1 10.1.2.14
hostname(config)# nat (inside) 2 10.1.1.0 255.255.255.0
hostname(config)# global (outside) 2 10.1.2.78
To translate a well-known port (80) to another port (8080), enter the following command:
hostname(config)# static (inside,outside) tcp 10.1.2.45 80 10.1.1.16 8080 netmask
255.255.255.255
Bypassing NAT
This section describes how to bypass NAT. You might want to bypass NAT when you enable NAT control.
You can bypass NAT using identity NAT, static identity NAT, or NAT exemption. See the “Bypassing
NAT when NAT Control is Enabled” section on page 17-9 for more information about these methods.
This section includes the following topics:
• Configuring Identity NAT, page 17-28
• Configuring Static Identity NAT, page 17-29
• Configuring NAT Exemption, page 17-31
Security
Appliance
209.165.201.1 209.165.201.1
209.165.201.2 209.165.201.2
130033
Inside Outside
Note If you change the NAT configuration, and you do not want to wait for existing translations to time out
before the new NAT information is used, you can clear the translation table using the clear xlate
command. However, clearing the translation table disconnects all current connections that use
translations.
See the “Configuring Dynamic NAT or PAT” section on page 17-22 for information about the options.
For example, to use identity NAT for the inside 10.1.1.0/24 network, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# nat (inside) 0 10.1.1.0 255.255.255.0
information about policy NAT). For example, you can use policy static identity NAT for an inside address
when it accesses the outside interface and the destination is server A, but use a normal translation when
accessing the outside server B.
Figure 17-24 shows a typical static identity NAT scenario.
Security
Appliance
209.165.201.1 209.165.201.1
209.165.201.2 209.165.201.2
130036
Inside Outside
Note If you remove a static command, existing connections that use the translation are not affected. To remove
these connections, enter the clear local-host command.
You cannot clear static translations from the translation table with the clear xlate command; you must
remove the static command instead. Only dynamic translations created by the nat and global commands
can be removed with the clear xlate command.
Create the access list using the access-list command (see the “Adding an Extended Access List”
section on page 16-5). This access list should include only permit ACEs. Make sure the source
address in the access list matches the real_ip in this command. Policy NAT does not consider the
inactive or time-range keywords; all ACEs are considered to be active for policy NAT
configuration. See the “Policy NAT” section on page 17-9 for more information.
See the “Configuring Dynamic NAT or PAT” section on page 17-22 for information about the other
options.
• To configure regular static identity NAT, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# static (real_interface,mapped_interface) real_ip real_ip [netmask
mask] [dns] [norandomseq] [[tcp] tcp_max_conns [emb_limit]] [udp udp_max_conns]
The following command uses static identity NAT for an outside address (209.165.201.15) when accessed
by the inside:
hostname(config)# static (outside,inside) 209.165.201.15 209.165.201.15 netmask
255.255.255.255
The following static identity policy NAT example shows a single real address that uses identity NAT
when accessing one destination address, and a translation when accessing another:
hostname(config)# access-list NET1 permit ip host 10.1.2.27 209.165.201.0 255.255.255.224
hostname(config)# access-list NET2 permit ip host 10.1.2.27 209.165.200.224
255.255.255.224
hostname(config)# static (inside,outside) 10.1.2.27 access-list NET1
hostname(config)# static (inside,outside) 209.165.202.130 access-list NET2
Security
Appliance
209.165.201.1 209.165.201.1
209.165.201.2 209.165.201.2
130036
Inside Outside
Note If you remove a NAT exemption configuration, existing connections that use NAT exemption are not
affected. To remove these connections, enter the clear local-host command.
Create the access list using the access-list command (see the “Adding an Extended Access List” section
on page 16-5). This access list can include both permit ACEs and deny ACEs. Do not specify the real
and destination ports in the access list; NAT exemption does not consider the ports. NAT exemption also
does not consider the inactive or time-range keywords; all ACEs are considered to be active for
NAT exemption configuration.
See the “Configuring Dynamic NAT or PAT” section on page 17-22 for information about the other
options.
By default, this command exempts traffic from inside to outside. If you want traffic from outside to
inside to bypass NAT, then add an additional nat command and enter outside to identify the NAT
instance as outside NAT. You might want to use outside NAT exemption if you configure dynamic NAT
for the outside interface and want to exempt other traffic.
For example, to exempt an inside network when accessing any destination address, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# access-list EXEMPT permit ip 10.1.2.0 255.255.255.0 any
hostname(config)# nat (inside) 0 access-list EXEMPT
To use dynamic outside NAT for a DMZ network, and exempt another DMZ network, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# nat (dmz) 1 10.1.2.0 255.255.255.0 outside dns
hostname(config)# global (inside) 1 10.1.1.45
hostname(config)# access-list EXEMPT permit ip 10.1.3.0 255.255.255.0 any
hostname(config)# nat (dmz) 0 access-list EXEMPT
To exempt an inside address when accessing two different destination addresses, enter the following
commands:
hostname(config)# access-list NET1 permit ip 10.1.2.0 255.255.255.0 209.165.201.0
255.255.255.224
hostname(config)# access-list NET1 permit ip 10.1.2.0 255.255.255.0 209.165.200.224
255.255.255.224
hostname(config)# nat (inside) 0 access-list NET1
NAT Examples
This section describes typical scenarios that use NAT solutions, and includes the following topics:
• Overlapping Networks, page 17-33
• Redirecting Ports, page 17-34
Overlapping Networks
In Figure 17-26, the security appliance connects two private networks with overlapping address ranges.
192.168.100.2 192.168.100.2
outside
10.1.1.2 dmz
inside
192.168.100.0/24 192.168.100.0/24
130029
Two networks use an overlapping address space (192.168.100.0/24), but hosts on each network must
communicate (as allowed by access lists). Without NAT, when a host on the inside network tries to access
a host on the overlapping DMZ network, the packet never makes it past the security appliance, which
sees the packet as having a destination address on the inside network. Moreover, if the destination
address is being used by another host on the inside network, that host receives the packet.
To solve this problem, use NAT to provide non-overlapping addresses. If you want to allow access in
both directions, use static NAT for both networks. If you only want to allow the inside interface to access
hosts on the DMZ, then you can use dynamic NAT for the inside addresses, and static NAT for the DMZ
addresses you want to access. This example shows static NAT.
To configure static NAT for these two interfaces, perform the following steps. The 10.1.1.0/24 network
on the DMZ is not translated.
Step 1 Translate 192.168.100.0/24 on the inside to 10.1.2.0 /24 when it accesses the DMZ by entering the
following command:
hostname(config)# static (inside,dmz) 10.1.2.0 192.168.100.0 netmask 255.255.255.0
Step 2 Translate the 192.168.100.0/24 network on the DMZ to 10.1.3.0/24 when it accesses the inside by
entering the following command:
hostname(config)# static (dmz,inside) 10.1.3.0 192.168.100.0 netmask 255.255.255.0
Step 3 Configure the following static routes so that traffic to the dmz network can be routed correctly by the
security appliance:
hostname(config)# route dmz 192.168.100.128 255.255.255.128 10.1.1.2 1
hostname(config)# route dmz 192.168.100.0 255.255.255.128 10.1.1.2 1
The security appliance already has a connected route for the inside network. These static routes allow
the security appliance to send traffic for the 192.168.100.0/24 network out the DMZ interface to the
gateway router at 10.1.1.2. (You need to split the network into two because you cannot create a static
route with the exact same network as a connected route.) Alternatively, you could use a more broad route
for the DMZ traffic, such as a default route.
If host 192.168.100.2 on the DMZ network wants to initiate a connection to host 192.168.100.2 on the
inside network, the following events occur:
1. The DMZ host 192.168.100.2 sends the packet to IP address 10.1.2.2.
2. When the security appliance receives this packet, the security appliance translates the source address
from 192.168.100.2 to 10.1.3.2.
3. Then the security appliance translates the destination address from 10.1.2.2 to 192.168.100.2, and
the packet is forwarded.
Redirecting Ports
Figure 17-27 illustrates a typical network scenario in which the port redirection feature might be useful.
Telnet Server
10.1.1.6
FTP Server
10.1.1.3 10.1.1.1 209.165.201.25
Inside Outside
Web Server
10.1.1.5
Web Server
10.1.1.7
130030
In the configuration described in this section, port redirection occurs for hosts on external networks as
follows:
• Telnet requests to IP address 209.165.201.5 are redirected to 10.1.1.6.
• FTP requests to IP address 209.165.201.5 are redirected to 10.1.1.3.
• HTTP request to security appliance outside IP address 209.165.201.25 are redirected to 10.1.1.5.
• HTTP port 8080 requests to PAT address 209.165.201.15 are redirected to 10.1.1.7 port 80.
To implement this scenario, perform the following steps:
Step 1 Configure PAT for the inside network by entering the following commands:
hostname(config)# nat (inside) 1 0.0.0.0 0.0.0.0 0 0
hostname(config)# global (outside) 1 209.165.201.15
Step 2 Redirect Telnet requests for 209.165.201.5 to 10.1.1.6 by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# static (inside,outside) tcp 209.165.201.5 telnet 10.1.1.6 telnet netmask
255.255.255.255
Step 3 Redirect FTP requests for IP address 209.165.201.5 to 10.1.1.3 by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# static (inside,outside) tcp 209.165.201.5 ftp 10.1.1.3 ftp netmask
255.255.255.255
Step 4 Redirect HTTP requests for the security appliance outside interface address to 10.1.1.5 by entering the
following command:
hostname(config)# static (inside,outside) tcp interface www 10.1.1.5 www netmask
255.255.255.255
Step 5 Redirect HTTP requests on port 8080 for PAT address 209.165.201.15 to 10.1.1.7 port 80 by entering
the following command:
hostname(config)# static (inside,outside) tcp 209.165.201.15 8080 10.1.1.7 www netmask
255.255.255.255
This chapter describes how to control network access through the security appliance using access lists.
To create an extended access lists or an EtherType access list, see Chapter 16, “Identifying Traffic with
Access Lists.”
Note You use ACLs to control network access in both routed and transparent firewall modes. In transparent
mode, you can use both extended ACLs (for Layer 3 traffic) and EtherType ACLs (for Layer 2 traffic).
To access the security appliance interface for management access, you do not also need an access list
allowing the host IP address. You only need to configure management access according to Chapter 40,
“Managing System Access.”
Note “Inbound” and “outbound” refer to the application of an access list on an interface, either to traffic
entering the security appliance on an interface or traffic exiting the security appliance on an interface.
These terms do not refer to the movement of traffic from a lower security interface to a higher security
interface, commonly known as inbound, or from a higher to lower interface, commonly known as
outbound.
You might want to use an outbound access list to simplify your access list configuration. For example,
if you want to allow three inside networks on three different interfaces to access each other, you can
create a simple inbound access list that allows all traffic on each inside interface (see Figure 18-1).
Web Server:
209.165.200.225
Security
appliance Outside
Inside Eng
132211
See the following commands for this example:
hostname(config)# access-list INSIDE extended permit ip any any
hostname(config)# access-group INSIDE in interface inside
Then, if you want to allow only certain hosts on the inside networks to access a web server on the outside
network, you can create a more restrictive access list that allows only the specified hosts and apply it to
the outbound direction of the outside interface (see Figure 18-1). See the “IP Addresses Used for Access
Lists When You Use NAT” section on page 16-3 for information about NAT and IP addresses. The
outbound access list prevents any other hosts from reaching the outside network.
Web Server:
209.165.200.225
Security
appliance Outside
ACL Outbound
Permit HTTP from 209.165.201.4, 209.165.201.6,
and 209.165.201.8 to 209.165.200.225
Deny all others
Inside HR Eng
132210
10.1.2.67 209.165.201.6
Static NAT
You can apply one access list of each type (extended and EtherType) to both directions of the interface.
See the “Inbound and Outbound Access List Overview” section on page 18-1 for more information about
access list directions.
The per-user-override keyword allows dynamic access lists that are downloaded for user authorization
to override the access list assigned to the interface. For example, if the interface access list denies all
traffic from 10.0.0.0, but the dynamic access list permits all traffic from 10.0.0.0, then the dynamic
access list overrides the interface access list for that user. See the “Configuring RADIUS Authorization”
section for more information about per-user access lists. The per-user-override keyword is only
available for inbound access lists.
For connectionless protocols, you need to apply the access list to the source and destination interfaces
if you want traffic to pass in both directions. For example, you can allow BGP in an EtherType access
list in transparent mode, and you need to apply the access list to both interfaces.
The following example illustrates the commands required to enable access to an inside web server with
the IP address 209.165.201.12 (this IP address is the address visible on the outside interface after NAT):
hostname(config)# access-list ACL_OUT extended permit tcp any host 209.165.201.12 eq www
hostname(config)# access-group ACL_OUT in interface outside
For example, the following sample access list allows common EtherTypes originating on the inside
interface:
hostname(config)# access-list ETHER ethertype permit ipx
hostname(config)# access-list ETHER ethertype permit bpdu
hostname(config)# access-list ETHER ethertype permit mpls-unicast
hostname(config)# access-group ETHER in interface inside
The following access list allows some EtherTypes through the security appliance, but denies all others:
hostname(config)# access-list ETHER ethertype permit 0x1234
hostname(config)# access-list ETHER ethertype permit bpdu
hostname(config)# access-list ETHER ethertype permit mpls-unicast
hostname(config)# access-group ETHER in interface inside
hostname(config)# access-group ETHER in interface outside
The following access list denies traffic with EtherType 0x1256 but allows all others on both interfaces:
hostname(config)# access-list nonIP ethertype deny 1256
hostname(config)# access-list nonIP ethertype permit any
hostname(config)# access-group ETHER in interface inside
This chapter describes how to enable AAA (pronounced “triple A”) for network access.
For information about AAA for management access, see the “Configuring AAA for System
Administrators” section on page 40-5.
This chapter contains the following sections:
• AAA Performance, page 19-1
• Configuring Authentication for Network Access, page 19-1
• Configuring Authorization for Network Access, page 19-5
• Configuring Accounting for Network Access, page 19-12
• Using MAC Addresses to Exempt Traffic from Authentication and Authorization, page 19-13
AAA Performance
The security appliance uses “cut-through proxy” to significantly improve performance compared to a
traditional proxy server. The performance of a traditional proxy server suffers because it analyzes every
packet at the application layer of the OSI model. The security appliance cut-through proxy challenges a
user initially at the application layer and then authenticates against standard AAA servers or the local
database. After the security appliance authenticates the user, it shifts the session flow, and all traffic
flows directly and quickly between the source and destination while maintaining session state
information.
Authentication Overview
The security appliance lets you configure network access authentication using AAA servers. This section
includes the following topics:
• One-Time Authentication, page 19-2
• Applications Required to Receive an Authentication Challenge, page 19-2
• Static PAT and HTTP, page 19-3
• Authenticating Directly with the Security Appliance, page 19-3
One-Time Authentication
A user at a given IP address only needs to authenticate one time for all rules and types, until the
authentication session expires. (See the timeout uauth command in the Cisco Security Appliance
Command Reference for timeout values.) For example, if you configure the security appliance to
authenticate Telnet and FTP, and a user first successfully authenticates for Telnet, then as long as the
authentication session exists, the user does not also have to authenticate for FTP.
Note If you use HTTP authentication without using the aaa authentication secure-http-client command, the
username and password are sent from the client to the security appliance in clear text. We recommend
that you use the aaa authentication secure-http-client command whenever you enable HTTP
authentication. For more information about the aaa authentication secure-http-client command, see
the “Enabling Secure Authentication of Web Clients” section on page 19-5.
For FTP, a user has the option of entering the security appliance username followed by an at sign (@)
and then the FTP username (name1@name2). For the password, the user enters the security appliance
password followed by an at sign (@) and then the FTP password (password1@password2). For example,
enter the following text.
name> jamiec@jchrichton
password> letmein@he110
This feature is useful when you have cascaded firewalls that require multiple logins. You can separate
several names and passwords by multiple at signs (@).
Then when users try to access 10.48.66.155 on port 889, the security appliance intercepts the traffic and
enforces HTTP authentication. Users see the HTTP authentication page in their web browsers before the
security appliance allows HTTP connection to complete.
If the local port is different than port 80, as in the following example:
static (inside,outside) tcp 10.48.66.155 889 192.168.123.10 111 netmask 255.255.255.255
Then users do not see the authentication page. Instead, the security appliance sends to the web browser
an error message indicating that the user must be authenticated prior using the requested service.
Alternatively, you can configure virtual Telnet. With virtual Telnet, the user Telnets to a given IP
address configured on the security appliance, and the security appliance provides a Telnet prompt. For
more information about the virtual telnet command, see the Cisco Security Appliance Command
Reference.
Step 1 Using the aaa-server command, identify your AAA servers. If you have already identified your AAA
servers, continue to the next step.
For more information about identifying AAA servers, see the “Identifying AAA Server Groups and
Servers” section on page 13-12.
Step 2 Using the access-list command, create an access list that identifies the source addresses and destination
addresses of traffic you want to authenticate. For steps, see the “Adding an Extended Access List”
section on page 16-5.
The permit ACEs mark matching traffic for authentication, while deny entries exclude matching traffic
from authentication. Be sure to include the destination ports for either HTTP, Telnet, or FTP in the access
list because the user must authenticate with one of these services before other services are allowed
through the security appliance.
Step 3 To configure authentication, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# aaa authentication match acl_name interface_name server_group
Where acl_name is the name of the access list you created in Step 2, interface_name is the name of the
interface as specified with the nameif command, and server_group is the AAA server group you created
in Step 1.
Note You can alternatively use the aaa authentication include command (which identifies traffic within the
command). However, you cannot use both methods in the same configuration. See the Cisco Security
Appliance Command Reference for more information.
Step 4 (Optional) If you are using the local database for network access authentication and you want to limit
the number of consecutive failed login attempts that the security appliance allows any given user
account, use the following command:
hostname(config)# aaa local authentication attempts max-fail number
Tip To clear the lockout status of a specific user or all users, use the clear aaa local user lockout command.
For example, the following commands authenticate all inside HTTP traffic and SMTP traffic:
hostname(config)# aaa-server AuthOutbound protocol tacacs+
hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# exit
hostname(config)# aaa-server AuthOutbound (inside) host 10.1.1.1
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# key TACPlusUauthKey
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# exit
hostname(config)# access-list MAIL_AUTH extended permit tcp any any eq smtp
hostname(config)# access-list MAIL_AUTH extended permit tcp any any eq www
hostname(config)# aaa authentication match MAIL_AUTH inside AuthOutbound
The following commands authenticate Telnet traffic from the outside interface to a particular server
(209.165.201.5):
hostname(config)# aaa-server AuthInbound protocol tacacs+
hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# exit
hostname(config)# aaa-server AuthInbound (inside) host 10.1.1.1
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# key TACPlusUauthKey
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# exit
hostname(config)# access-list TELNET_AUTH extended permit tcp any host 209.165.201.5 eq
telnet
hostname(config)# aaa authentication match TELNET_AUTH outside AuthInbound
Tip Using access lists to identify traffic to be authorized can greatly reduced the number of authorization
commands you must enter. This is because each authorization rule you enter can specify only one source
and destination subnet and service, whereas an access list can include many entries.
Authentication and authorization statements are independent; however, any unauthenticated traffic
matched by an authorization statement will be denied. For authorization to succeed, a user must first
authenticate with the security appliance. Because a user at a given IP address only needs to authenticate
one time for all rules and types, if the authentication session hasn’t expired, authorization can occur even
if the traffic is matched by an authentication statement.
After a user authenticates, the security appliance checks the authorization rules for matching traffic. If
the traffic matches the authorization statement, the security appliance sends the username to the
TACACS+ server. The TACACS+ server responds to the security appliance with a permit or a deny for
that traffic, based on the user profile. The security appliance enforces the authorization rule in the
response.
See the documentation for your TACACS+ server for information about configuring network access
authorizations for a user.
To configure TACACS+ authorization, perform the following steps:
Step 1 Enable authentication. For more information, see the “Enabling Network Access Authentication” section
on page 19-3. If you have already enabled authentication, continue to the next step.
Step 2 Using the access-list command, create an access list that identifies the source addresses and destination
addresses of traffic you want to authorize. For steps, see the “Adding an Extended Access List” section
on page 16-5.
The permit ACEs mark matching traffic for authorization, while deny entries exclude matching traffic
from authorization. The access list you use for authorization matching should contain rules that are equal
to or a subset of the rules in the access list used for authentication matching.
Note If you have configured authentication and want to authorize all the traffic being authenticated,
you can use the same access list you created for use with the aaa authentication match
command.
where acl_name is the name of the access list you created in Step 2, interface_name is the name of the
interface as specified with the nameif command or by default, and server_group is the AAA server group
you created when you enabled authentication.
Note Alternatively, you can use the aaa authorization include command (which identifies traffic
within the command) but you cannot use both methods in the same configuration. See the Cisco
Security Appliance Command Reference for more information.
The following commands authenticate and authorize inside Telnet traffic. Telnet traffic to servers other
than 209.165.201.5 can be authenticated alone, but traffic to 209.165.201.5 requires authorization.
Note If you have used the access-group command to apply access lists to interfaces, be aware of the following
effects of the per-user-override keyword on authorization by user-specific access lists:
• Without the per-user-override keyword, traffic for a user session must be permitted by both the
interface access list and the user-specific access list.
• With the per-user-override keyword, the user-specific access list determines what is permitted.
For more information, see the access-group command entry in the Cisco Security Appliance Command
Reference.
About the Downloadable Access List Feature and Cisco Secure ACS
Downloadable access lists is the most scalable means of using Cisco Secure ACS to provide the
appropriate access lists for each user. It provides the following capabilities:
• Unlimited access list size—Downloadable access lists are sent using as many RADIUS packets as
required to transport the full access list from Cisco Secure ACS to the security appliance.
• Simplified and centralized management of access lists—Downloadable access lists enable you to
write a set of access lists once and apply it to many user or group profiles and distribute it to many
security appliances.
This approach is most useful when you have very large access list sets that you want to apply to more
than one Cisco Secure ACS user or group; however, its ability to simplify Cisco Secure ACS user and
group management makes it useful for access lists of any size.
The security appliance receives downloadable access lists from Cisco Secure ACS using the following
process:
1. The security appliance sends a RADIUS authentication request packet for the user session.
2. If Cisco Secure ACS successfully authenticates the user, Cisco Secure ACS returns a RADIUS
access-accept message that contains the internal name of the applicable downloadable access list.
The Cisco IOS cisco-av-pair RADIUS VSA (vendor 9, attribute 1) contains the following
attribute-value pair to identify the downloadable access list set:
ACS:CiscoSecure-Defined-ACL=acl-set-name
where acl-set-name is the internal name of the downloadable access list, which is a combination of
the name assigned to the access list by the Cisco Secure ACS administrator and the date and time
that the access list was last modified.
3. The security appliance examines the name of the downloadable access list and determines if it has
previously received the named downloadable access list.
– If the security appliance has previously received the named downloadable access list,
communication with Cisco Secure ACS is complete and the security appliance applies the
access list to the user session. Because the name of the downloadable access list includes the
date and time it was last modified, matching the name sent by Cisco Secure ACS to the name of
an access list previous downloaded means that the security appliance has the most recent
version of the downloadable access list.
– If the security appliance has not previously received the named downloadable access list, it may
have an out-of-date version of the access list or it may not have downloaded any version of the
access list. In either case, the security appliance issues a RADIUS authentication request using
the downloadable access list name as the username in the RADIUS request and a null password
attribute. In a cisco-av-pair RADIUS VSA, the request also includes the following
attribute-value pairs:
AAA:service=ip-admission
AAA:event=acl-download
In addition, the security appliance signs the request with the Message-Authenticator attribute
(IETF RADIUS attribute 80).
4. Upon receipt of a RADIUS authentication request that has a username attribute containing the name
of a downloadable access list, Cisco Secure ACS authenticates the request by checking the
Message-Authenticator attribute. If the Message-Authenticator attribute is missing or incorrect,
Cisco Secure ACS ignores the request. The presence of the Message-Authenticator attribute
prevents malicious use of a downloadable access list name to gain unauthorized network access. The
Message-Authenticator attribute and its use are defined in RFC 2869, RADIUS Extensions,
available at http://www.ietf.org.
5. If the access list required is less than approximately 4 KB in length, Cisco Secure ACS responds
with an access-accept message containing the access list. The largest access list that can fit in a
single access-accept message is slightly less than 4 KB because some of the message must be other
required attributes.
Cisco Secure ACS sends the downloadable access list in a cisco-av-pair RADIUS VSA. The access
list is formatted as a series of attribute-value pairs that each contain an ACE and are numbered
serially:
ip:inacl#1=ACE-1
ip:inacl#2=ACE-2
.
.
.
ip:inacl#n=ACE-n
6. If the access list required is more than approximately 4 KB in length, Cisco Secure ACS responds
with an access-challenge message that contains a portion of the access list, formatted as described
above, and an State attribute (IETF RADIUS attribute 24), which contains control data used by
Cisco Secure ACS to track the progress of the download. Cisco Secure ACS fits as many complete
attribute-value pairs into the cisco-av-pair RADIUS VSA as it can without exceeding the maximum
RADIUS message size.
The security appliance stores the portion of the access list received and responds with another
access-request message containing the same attributes as the first request for the downloadable
access list plus a copy of the State attribute received in the access-challenge message.
This repeats until Cisco Secure ACS sends the last of the access list in an access-accept message.
You can configure downloadable access lists on Cisco Secure ACS as a shared profile component and
then assign the access list to a group or to an individual user.
The access list definition consists of one or more security appliance commands that are similar to the
extended access-list command (see the “Adding an Extended Access List” section on page 16-5), except
without the following prefix:
access-list acl_name extended
The following example is a downloadable access list definition on Cisco Secure ACS version 3.3:
+--------------------------------------------+
| Shared profile Components |
| |
| Downloadable IP ACLs Content |
| |
| Name: acs_ten_acl |
| |
| ACL Definitions |
| |
| permit tcp any host 10.0.0.254 |
| permit udp any host 10.0.0.254 |
| permit icmp any host 10.0.0.254 |
For more information about creating downloadable access lists and associating them with users, see the
user guide for your version of Cisco Secure ACS.
On the security appliance, the downloaded access list has the following name:
#ACSACL#-ip-acl_name-number
The acl_name argument is the name that is defined on Cisco Secure ACS (acs_ten_acl in the preceding
example), and number is a unique version ID generated by Cisco Secure ACS.
The downloaded access list on the security appliance consists of the following lines:
access-list #ACSACL#-ip-asa-acs_ten_acl-3b5385f7 permit tcp any host 10.0.0.254
access-list #ACSACL#-ip-asa-acs_ten_acl-3b5385f7 permit udp any host 10.0.0.254
access-list #ACSACL#-ip-asa-acs_ten_acl-3b5385f7 permit icmp any host 10.0.0.254
access-list #ACSACL#-ip-asa-acs_ten_acl-3b5385f7 permit tcp any host 10.0.0.253
access-list #ACSACL#-ip-asa-acs_ten_acl-3b5385f7 permit udp any host 10.0.0.253
access-list #ACSACL#-ip-asa-acs_ten_acl-3b5385f7 permit icmp any host 10.0.0.253
access-list #ACSACL#-ip-asa-acs_ten_acl-3b5385f7 permit tcp any host 10.0.0.252
access-list #ACSACL#-ip-asa-acs_ten_acl-3b5385f7 permit udp any host 10.0.0.252
access-list #ACSACL#-ip-asa-acs_ten_acl-3b5385f7 permit icmp any host 10.0.0.252
access-list #ACSACL#-ip-asa-acs_ten_acl-3b5385f7 permit ip any any
You can configure any RADIUS server that supports Cisco IOS RADIUS VSAs to send user-specific
access lists to the security appliance in a Cisco IOS RADIUS cisco-av-pair VSA (vendor 9, attribute 1).
In the cisco-av-pair VSA, configure one or more ACEs that are similar to the access-list extended
command (see the “Adding an Extended Access List” section on page 16-5), except that you replace the
following command prefix:
access-list acl_name extended
The nnn argument is a number in the range from 0 to 999999999 that identifies the order of the command
statement to be configured on the security appliance. If this parameter is omitted, the sequence value is
0, and the order of the ACEs inside the cisco-av-pair RADIUS VSA is used.
The following example is an access list definition as it should be configured for a cisco-av-pair VSA on
a RADIUS server:
ip:inacl#1=permit tcp 10.1.0.0 255.0.0.0 10.0.0.0 255.0.0.0
ip:inacl#99=deny tcp any any
ip:inacl#2=permit udp 10.1.0.0 255.0.0.0 10.0.0.0 255.0.0.0
ip:inacl#100=deny udp any any
ip:inacl#3=permit icmp 10.1.0.0 255.0.0.0 10.0.0.0 255.0.0.0
For information about making unique per user the access lists that are sent in the cisco-av-pair attribute,
see the documentation for your RADIUS server.
On the security appliance, the downloaded access list name has the following format:
AAA-user-username
The username argument is the name of the user that is being authenticated.
The downloaded access list on the security appliance consists of the following lines. Notice the order
based on the numbers identified on the RADIUS server.
access-list AAA-user-bcham34-79AD4A08 permit tcp 10.1.0.0 255.0.0.0 10.0.0.0 255.0.0.0
access-list AAA-user-bcham34-79AD4A08 permit udp 10.1.0.0 255.0.0.0 10.0.0.0 255.0.0.0
access-list AAA-user-bcham34-79AD4A08 permit icmp 10.1.0.0 255.0.0.0 10.0.0.0 255.0.0.0
access-list AAA-user-bcham34-79AD4A08 deny tcp any any
access-list AAA-user-bcham34-79AD4A08 deny udp any any
Downloaded access lists have two spaces between the word “access-list” and the name. These spaces
serve to differentiate a downloaded access list from a local access list. In this example, “79AD4A08” is
a hash value generated by the security appliance to help determine when access list definitions have
changed on the RADIUS server.
If a RADIUS server provides downloadable access lists to Cisco VPN 3000 Series Concentrators as well
as to the security appliance, you may need the security appliance to convert wildcard netmask
expressions to standard netmask expressions. This is because Cisco VPN 3000 Series Concentrators
support wildcard netmask expressions but the security appliance only supports standard netmask
expressions. Configuring the security appliance to convert wildcard netmask expressions helps minimize
the effects of these differences upon how you configure downloadable access lists on your RADIUS
servers. Translation of wildcard netmask expressions means that downloadable access lists written for
Cisco VPN 3000 Series Concentrators can be used by the security appliance without altering the
configuration of the downloadable access lists on the RADIUS server.
You configure access list netmask conversion on a per server basis, using the acl-netmask-convert
command, available in the AAA-server configuration mode. For more information about configuring a
RADIUS server, see “Identifying AAA Server Groups and Servers” section on page 13-12. For more
information about the acl-netmask-convert command, see the Cisco Security Appliance Command
Reference.
Note In Cisco Secure ACS, the value for filter-id attributes are specified in boxes in the HTML interface,
omitting filter-id= and entering only acl_name.
For information about making unique per user the filter-id attribute value, see the documentation for your
RADIUS server.
See the “Adding an Extended Access List” section on page 16-5 to create an access list on the security
appliance.
Step 1 If you want the security appliance to provide accounting data per user, you must enable authentication.
For more information, see the “Enabling Network Access Authentication” section on page 19-3. If you
want the security appliance to provide accounting data per IP address, enabling authentication is not
necessary and you can continue to the next step.
Step 2 Using the access-list command, create an access list that identifies the source addresses and destination
addresses of traffic you want accounted. For steps, see the “Adding an Extended Access List” section on
page 16-5.
The permit ACEs mark matching traffic for authorization, while deny entries exclude matching traffic
from authorization.
Note If you have configured authentication and want accounting data for all the traffic being
authenticated, you can use the same access list you created for use with the aaa authentication
match command.
Note Alternatively, you can use the aaa accounting include command (which identifies traffic within
the command) but you cannot use both methods in the same configuration. See the Cisco
Security Appliance Command Reference for more information.
The following commands authenticate, authorize, and account for inside Telnet traffic. Telnet traffic to
servers other than 209.165.201.5 can be authenticated alone, but traffic to 209.165.201.5 requires
authorization and accounting.
hostname(config)# aaa-server AuthOutbound protocol tacacs+
hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# exit
hostname(config)# aaa-server AuthOutbound (inside) host 10.1.1.1
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# key TACPlusUauthKey
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# exit
hostname(config)# access-list TELNET_AUTH extended permit tcp any any eq telnet
hostname(config)# access-list SERVER_AUTH extended permit tcp any host 209.165.201.5 eq
telnet
hostname(config)# aaa authentication match TELNET_AUTH inside AuthOutbound
hostname(config)# aaa authorization match SERVER_AUTH inside AuthOutbound
hostname(config)# aaa accounting match SERVER_AUTH inside AuthOutbound
Where the id argument is the hexadecimal number that you assign to the MAC list. To group a set of
MAC addresses, enter the mac-list command as many times as needed with the same ID value. Because
you can only use one MAC list for AAA exemption, be sure that your MAC list includes all the MAC
addresses you want to exempt. You can create multiple MAC lists, but you can only use one at a time.
The order of entries matters, because the packet uses the first entry it matches, as opposed to a best match
scenario. If you have a permit entry, and you want to deny an address that is allowed by the permit entry,
be sure to enter the deny entry before the permit entry.
The mac argument specifies the source MAC address in 12-digit hexadecimal form; that is,
nnnn.nnnn.nnnn.
The macmask argument specifies the portion of the MAC address that should be used for matching. For
example, ffff.ffff.ffff matches the MAC address exactly. ffff.ffff.0000 matches only the first 8 digits.
Step 2 To exempt traffic for the MAC addresses specified in a particular MAC list, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# aaa mac-exempt match id
Where id is the string identifying the MAC list containing the MAC addresses whose traffic is to be
exempt from authentication and authorization. You can only enter one instance of the aaa mac-exempt
command.
The following entry bypasses authentication for all Cisco IP Phones, which have the hardware ID
0003.E3:
hostname(config)# mac-list acd permit 0003.E300.0000 FFFF.FF00.0000
hostname(config)# aaa mac-exempt match acd
The following example bypasses authentication for a a group of MAC addresses except for
00a0.c95d.02b2. Enter the deny statement before the permit statement, because 00a0.c95d.02b2 matches
the permit statement as well, and if it is first, the deny statement will never be matched.
This chapter describes ways to filter web traffic to reduce security risks or prevent inappropriate use.
This chapter contains the following sections:
• Filtering Overview, page 20-1
• Filtering ActiveX Objects, page 20-1
• Filtering Java Applets, page 20-3
• Filtering URLs and FTP Requests with an External Server, page 20-3
• Viewing Filtering Statistics and Configuration, page 20-9
Filtering Overview
This section describes how filtering can provide greater control over traffic passing through the security
appliance. Filtering can be used in two distinct ways:
• Filtering ActiveX objects or Java applets
• Filtering with an external filtering server
Instead of blocking access altogether, you can remove specific undesirable objects from HTTP traffic,
such as ActiveX objects or Java applets, that may pose a security threat in certain situations.
You can also use URL filtering to direct specific traffic to an external filtering server, such an Secure
Computing SmartFilter (formerly N2H2) or Websense filtering server. Long URL, HTTPS, and FTP
filtering can now be enabled using both Websense and Secure Computing SmartFilter for URL filtering.
Filtering servers can block traffic to specific sites or types of sites, as specified by the security policy.
Because URL filtering is CPU-intensive, using an external filtering server ensures that the throughput of
other traffic is not affected. However, depending on the speed of your network and the capacity of your
URL filtering server, the time required for the initial connection may be noticeably slower when filtering
traffic with an external filtering server.
Caution This command also blocks any Java applets, image files, or multimedia objects that are embedded in
object tags .
If the <object> or </object> HTML tags split across network packets or if the code in the tags is longer
than the number of bytes in the MTU, security appliance cannot block the tag.
ActiveX blocking does not occur when users access an IP address referenced by the alias command or
for WebVPN traffic.
To use this command, replace port with the TCP port to which filtering is applied. Typically, this is port
80, but other values are accepted. The http or url literal can be used for port 80. You can specify a range
of ports by using a hyphen between the starting port number and the ending port number.
The local IP address and mask identify one or more internal hosts that are the source of the traffic to be
filtered. The foreign address and mask specify the external destination of the traffic to be filtered.
You can set either address to 0.0.0.0 (or in shortened form, 0) to specify all hosts. You can use 0.0.0.0
for either mask (or in shortened form, 0) to specify all hosts.
The following example specifies that ActiveX objects are blocked on all outbound connections:
hostname(config)# filter activex 80 0 0 0 0
This command specifies that the ActiveX object blocking applies to web traffic on port 80 from any local
host and for connections to any foreign host.
To remove the configuration, use the no form of the command, as in the following example:
hostname(config)# no filter activex 80 0 0 0 0
Note Use the filter activex command to remove Java applets that are embedded in <object> tags.
To remove Java applets in HTTP traffic passing through the firewall, enter the following command in
global configuration mode:
hostname(config)# filter java port[-port] local_ip local_mask foreign_ip foreign_mask
To use this command, replace port with the TCP port to which filtering is applied. Typically, this is port
80, but other values are accepted. The http or url literal can be used for port 80. You can specify a range
of ports by using a hyphen between the starting port number and the ending port number.
The local IP address and mask identify one or more internal hosts that are the source of the traffic to be
filtered. The foreign address and mask specify the external destination of the traffic to be filtered.
You can set either address to 0.0.0.0 (or in shortened form, 0) to specify all hosts. You can use 0.0.0.0
for either mask (or in shortened form, 0) to specify all hosts.
You can set either address to 0.0.0.0 (or in shortened form, 0) to specify all hosts. You can use 0.0.0.0
for either mask (or in shortened form, 0) to specify all hosts.
The following example specifies that Java applets are blocked on all outbound connections:
hostname(config)# filter java 80 0 0 0 0
This command specifies that the Java applet blocking applies to web traffic on port 80 from any local
host and for connections to any foreign host.
The following example blocks downloading of Java applets to a host on a protected network:
hostname(config)# filter java http 192.168.3.3 255.255.255.255 0 0
Note You must add the filtering server before you can configure filtering for HTTP or HTTPS with the filter
command. If you remove the filtering servers from the configuration, then all filter commands are also
removed.
Identify the address of the filtering server using the url-server command:
For Websense:
hostname(config)# url-server (if_name) host local_ip [timeout seconds] [protocol TCP | UDP
version [1|4] [connections num_conns] ]
where <if_name> is the name of the security appliance interface connected to the filtering server (the
default is inside).
For the vendor {secure-computing | n2h2}, you can use ‘secure-computing as a vendor string, however,
‘n2h2’ is acceptable for backward compatibility. When the configuration entries are generated,
‘secure-computing’ is saved as the vendor string.
The host <local_ip> is the IP address of the URL filtering server.
The port <number> is the Secure Computing SmartFilter server port number of the filtering server; the
security appliance also listens for UDP replies on this port.
Note The default port is 4005. This is the default port used by the Secure Computing SmartFilter server to
communicate to the security appliance via TCP or UDP. For information on changing the default port,
please refer to the Filtering by N2H2 Administrator's Guide.
The timeout <seconds> is the number of seconds the security appliance should keep trying to connect
to the filtering server.
The connections <number> is the number of tries to attempt to make a connection between the host and
server.
For example, to identify a single Websense filtering server, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# url-server (perimeter) host 10.0.1.1 protocol TCP version 4
This identifies a Websense filtering server with the IP address 10.0.1.1 on a perimeter interface of the
security appliance.Version 4, which is enabled in this example, is recommended by Websense because it
supports caching.
To identify redundant Secure Computing SmartFilter servers, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# url-server (perimeter) vendor n2h2 host 10.0.1.1
hostname(config)# url-server (perimeter) vendor n2h2 host 10.0.1.2
This identifies two Sentian filtering servers, both on a perimeter interface of the security appliance.
Step 1 To enable buffering of responses for HTTP or FTP requests that are pending a response from the filtering
server, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# url-block block block-buffer-limit
Replace block-buffer with the maximum number of HTTP responses that can be buffered while awaiting
responses from the url-server.
Note Buffering URLs longer than 3072 bytes are not supported.
Step 2 To configure the maximum memory available for buffering pending URLs (and for buffering long
URLs), enter the following command:
hostname(config)# url-block mempool-size memory-pool-size
Replace memory-pool-size with a value from 2 to 10240 for a maximum memory allocation of 2 KB to
10 MB.
Note Requests for cached IP addresses are not passed to the filtering server and are not logged. As a result,
this activity does not appear in any reports. You can accumulate Websense run logs before using the
url-cache command.
Replace size with a value for the cache size within the range 1 to 128 (KB).
Use the dst keyword to cache entries based on the URL destination address. Select this mode if all users
share the same URL filtering policy on the Websense server.
Use the src_dst keyword to cache entries based on both the source address initiating the URL request as
well as the URL destination address. Select this mode if users do not share the same URL filtering policy
on the Websense server.
When the filtering server approves an HTTP connection request, the security appliance allows the reply
from the web server to reach the originating client. If the filtering server denies the request, the security
appliance redirects the user to a block page, indicating that access was denied.
To enable HTTP filtering, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# filter url [http | port[-port] local_ip local_mask foreign_ip
foreign_mask] [allow] [proxy-block]
Replace port with one or more port numbers if a different port than the default port for HTTP (80) is
used. Replace local_ip and local_mask with the IP address and subnet mask of a user or subnetwork
making requests. Replace foreign_ip and foreign_mask with the IP address and subnet mask of a server
or subnetwork responding to requests.
The allow option causes the security appliance to forward HTTP traffic without filtering when the
primary filtering server is unavailable. Use the proxy-block command to drop all requests to proxy
servers.
Replace long-url-size with the maximum size in KB for each long URL being buffered. For Websense,
this is a value from 2 to 4 for a maximum URL size of 2 KB to 4 KB; for Secure Computing, this is a
value between 2 to 3 for a maximum URL size of 2 KB to 3 KB. The default value is 2.
The longurl-truncate option causes the security appliance to send only the hostname or IP address
portion of the URL for evaluation to the filtering server when the URL is longer than the maximum
length permitted. Use the longurl-deny option to deny outbound URL traffic if the URL is longer than
the maximum permitted.
Use the cgi-truncate option to truncate CGI URLs to include only the CGI script location and the script
name without any parameters. Many long HTTP requests are CGI requests. If the parameters list is very
long, waiting and sending the complete CGI request including the parameter list can use up memory
resources and affect firewall performance.
For example, the following commands cause all HTTP requests to be forwarded to the filtering server
except for those from 10.0.2.54.
hostname(config)# filter url http 0 0 0 0
Note Websense and Smartfilter currently support HTTPS; older versions of Secure Computing SmartFilter
(formerly N2H2) did not support HTTPS filtering.
Because HTTPS content is encrypted, the security appliance sends the URL lookup without directory
and filename information. When the filtering server approves an HTTPS connection request, the security
appliance allows the completion of SSL connection negotiation and allows the reply from the web server
to reach the originating client. If the filtering server denies the request, the security appliance prevents
the completion of SSL connection negotiation. The browser displays an error message such as “The Page
or the content cannot be displayed.”
Note The security appliance does not provide an authentication prompt for HTTPS, so a user must
authenticate with the security appliance using HTTP or FTP before accessing HTTPS servers.
Replace port[-port] with a range of port numbers if a different port than the default port for HTTPS (443)
is used.
Replace local_ip and local_mask with the IP address and subnet mask of a user or subnetwork making
requests.
Replace foreign_ip and foreign_mask with the IP address and subnet mask of a server or subnetwork
responding to requests.
The allow option causes the security appliance to forward HTTPS traffic without filtering when the
primary filtering server is unavailable.
Note Websense and Smartfilter currently support FTP; older versions of Secure Computing SmartFilter
(formerly known as N2H2) did not support FTP filtering.
When the filtering server approves an FTP connection request, the security appliance allows the
successful FTP return code to reach originating client. For example, a successful return code is “250:
CWD command successful.” If the filtering server denies the request, alters the FTP return code to show
that the connection was denied. For example, the security appliance changes code 250 to “550 Requested
file is prohibited by URL filtering policy.”
Replace port[-port] with a range of port numbers if a different port than the default port for FTP (21) is
used.
Replace local_ip and local_mask with the IP address and subnet mask of a user or subnetwork making
requests.
Replace foreign_ip and foreign_mask with the IP address and subnet mask of a server or subnetwork
responding to requests.
The allow option causes the security appliance to forward HTTPS traffic without filtering when the
primary filtering server is unavailable.
Use the interact-block option to prevent interactive FTP sessions that do not provide the entire directory
path. An interactive FTP client allows the user to change directories without typing the entire path. For
example, the user might enter cd ./files instead of cd /public/files.
The following is sample output from the show running-config url-server command:
hostname# show running-config url-server
url-server (outside) vendor n2h2 host 128.107.254.202 port 4005 timeout 5 protocol TCP
To show information about the filtering server or to show statistics, enter the following command:
The following is sample output from the show running-config url-server statistics command, which
shows filtering statistics:
hostname# show running-config url-server statistics
Global Statistics:
--------------------
URLs total/allowed/denied 13/3/10
URLs allowed by cache/server 0/3
URLs denied by cache/server 0/10
HTTPSs total/allowed/denied 138/137/1
HTTPSs allowed by cache/server 0/137
HTTPSs denied by cache/server 0/1
Server Statistics:
--------------------
10.125.76.20 UP
Vendor websense
Port 15868
Requests total/allowed/denied 151/140/11
Server timeouts/retries 0/0
Responses received 151
Response time average 60s/300s 0/0
Errors:
-------
RFC noncompliant GET method 0
URL buffer update failure 0
This shows URL filtering performance statistics, along with other performance statistics. The filtering
statistics are shown in the URL Access and URL Server Req rows.
This chapter describes how to use Modular Policy Framework to create security policies for TCP and
general connection settings, inspections, IPS, CSC, and QoS.
This chapter includes the following sections:
• Modular Policy Framework Overview, page 21-1
• Identifying Traffic Using a Layer 3/4 Class Map, page 21-2
• Configuring Special Actions for Application Inspections, page 21-5
• Defining Actions Using a Layer 3/4 Policy Map, page 21-13
• Applying a Layer 3/4 Policy to an Interface Using a Service Policy, page 21-17
• Modular Policy Framework Examples, page 21-17
3. Apply actions to the Layer 3 and 4 traffic. See the “Defining Actions Using a Layer 3/4 Policy Map”
section on page 21-13.
4. Activate the actions on an interface. See the “Applying a Layer 3/4 Policy to an Interface Using a
Service Policy” section on page 21-17.
You can create multiple Layer 3/4 class maps for each Layer 3/4 policy map. You can create the
following types of class maps:
• Creating a Layer 3/4 Class Map for Through Traffic, page 21-3
• Creating a Layer 3/4 Class Map for Management Traffic, page 21-5
Step 1 Create a Layer 3/4 class map by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# class-map class_map_name
hostname(config-cmap)#
Step 3 Define the traffic to include in the class by matching one of the following characteristics. Unless
otherwise specified, you can include only one match command in the class map.
• Any traffic—The class map matches all traffic.
hostname(config-cmap)# match any
• Access list—The class map matches traffic specified by an extended access list. If the security
appliance is operating in transparent firewall mode, you can use an EtherType access list.
hostname(config-cmap)# match access-list access_list_name
For more information about creating access lists, see the “Adding an Extended Access List” section
on page 16-5 or the “Adding an EtherType Access List” section on page 16-8.
For information about creating access lists with NAT, see the “IP Addresses Used for Access Lists
When You Use NAT” section on page 16-3.
• TCP or UDP destination ports—The class map matches a single port or a contiguous range of ports.
hostname(config-cmap)# match port {tcp | udp} {eq port_num | range port_num port_num}
Tip For applications that use multiple, non-contiguous ports, use the match access-list command
and define an ACE to match each port.
For a list of ports you can specify, see the “TCP and UDP Ports” section on page D-11.
For example, enter the following command to match TCP packets on port 80 (HTTP):
hostname(config-cmap)# match tcp eq 80
• Default traffic for inspection—The class map matches the default TCP and UDP ports used by all
applications that the security appliance can inspect.
hostname(config-cmap)# match default-inspection-traffic
See the “Default Inspection Policy” section on page 25-3 for a list of default ports. The security
appliance includes a default global policy that matches the default inspection traffic, and applies
common inspections to the traffic on all interfaces. Not all applications whose ports are included in
the match default-inspection-traffic command are enabled by default in the policy map.
You can specify a match access-list command along with the match default-inspection-traffic
command to narrow the matched traffic. Because the match default-inspection-traffic command
specifies the ports to match, any ports in the access list are ignored.
• DSCP value in an IP header—The class map matches up to eight DSCP values.
hostname(config-cmap)# match dscp value1 [value2] [...] [value8]
• Precedence—The class map matches up to four precedence values, represented by the TOS byte in
the IP header.
hostname(config-cmap)# match precedence value1 [value2] [value3] [value4]
The starting_port specifies an even-numbered UDP destination port between 2000 and 65534. The
range specifies the number of additional UDP ports to match above the starting_port, between 0 and
16383.
• Tunnel group traffic—The class map matches traffic for a tunnel group to which you want to apply
QoS.
hostname(config-cmap)# match tunnel-group name
You can also specify one other match command to refine the traffic match. You can specify any of
the preceding commands, except for the match any, match access-list, or match
default-inspection-traffic commands. Or you can enter the following command to police each
flow:
hostname(config-cmap)# match flow ip destination address
Step 3 Define the traffic to include in the class by matching the TCP or UDP port. You can include only one
match command in the class map.
hostname(config-cmap)# match port {tcp | udp} {eq port_num | range port_num port_num}
For a list of ports you can specify, see the “TCP and UDP Ports” section on page D-11.
For example, enter the following command to match TCP packets on port 10000:
hostname(config-cmap)# match tcp eq 10000
Some traffic matching commands can specify regular expressions to match text inside a packet. Be sure
to create and test the regular expressions before you configure the policy map, either singly or grouped
together in a regular expression class map.
The default inspection policy map configuration includes the following commands, which sets the
maximum message length for DNS packets to be 512 bytes:
policy-map type inspect dns preset_dns_map
parameters
message-length maximum 512
Note There are other default inspection policy maps such as policy-map type inspect esmtp
_default_esmtp_map. These default policy maps are created implicitly by the command inspect
protocol. For example, inspect esmtp implicitly uses the policy map “_default_esmtp_map.” All the
default policy maps can be shown by using the show running-config all policy-map command.
This section describes how to create additional inspection policy maps, and includes the following
topics:
• Creating a Regular Expression, page 21-6
• Creating a Regular Expression Class Map, page 21-8
• Identifying Traffic in an Inspection Class Map, page 21-9
• Defining Actions in an Inspection Policy Map, page 21-10
Step 1 To test a regular expression to make sure it matches what you think it will match, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# test regex input_text regular_expression
Where the input_text argument is a string you want to match using the regular expression, up to 201
characters in length.
The regular_expression argument can be up to 100 characters in length.
Use Ctrl+V to escape all of the special characters in the CLI. For example, to enter a tab in the input
text in the test regex command, you must enter test regex "test[Ctrl+V Tab]" "test\t".
If the regular expression matches the input text, you see the following message:
INFO: Regular expression match succeeded.
If the regular expression does not match the input text, you see the following message:
INFO: Regular expression match failed.
Step 2 To add a regular expression after you tested it, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# regex name regular_expression
The following example creates two regular expressions for use in an inspection policy map:
hostname(config)# regex url_example example\.com
hostname(config)# regex url_example2 example2\.com
Step 1 Create one or more regular expressions according to the “Creating a Regular Expression” section.
Step 4 Identify the regular expressions you want to include by entering the following command for each regular
expression:
hostname(config-cmap)# match regex regex_name
The following example creates two regular expressions, and adds them to a regular expression class map.
Traffic matches the class map if it includes the string “example.com” or “example2.com.”
hostname(config)# regex url_example example\.com
hostname(config)# regex url_example2 example2\.com
hostname(config)# class-map type regex match-any URLs
hostname(config-cmap)# match regex example
hostname(config-cmap)# match regex example2
Where the application is the application you want to inspect. For supported applications, see Chapter 25,
“Configuring Application Layer Protocol Inspection.”
The class_map_name argument is the name of the class map up to 40 characters in length.
The match-all keyword is the default, and specifies that traffic must match all criteria to match the class
map.
The CLI enters class-map configuration mode, where you can enter one or more match commands.
Step 2 (Optional) To add a description to the class map, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# description string
Step 3 Define the traffic to include in the class by entering one or more match commands available for your
application.
To specify traffic that should not match the class map, use the match not command. For example, if the
match not command specifies the string “example.com,” then any traffic that includes “example.com”
does not match the class map.
To see the match commands available for each application, see Chapter 25, “Configuring Application
Layer Protocol Inspection.”
Step 1 To create the HTTP inspection policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# policy-map type inspect application policy_map_name
hostname(config-pmap)#
See the “Configuring Application Inspection” section on page 25-5 for a list of applications that support
inspection policy maps.
The policy_map_name argument is the name of the policy map up to 40 characters in length. All types
of policy maps use the same name space, so you cannot reuse a name already used by another type of
policy map. The CLI enters policy-map configuration mode.
Step 2 To apply actions to matching traffic, perform the following steps:
a. Specify the traffic on which you want to perform actions using one of the following methods:
• Specify the inspection class map that you created in the “Identifying Traffic in an Inspection
Class Map” section on page 21-9 by entering the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# class class_map_name
hostname(config-pmap-c)#
• Specify traffic directly in the policy map using one of the match commands described for each
application in Chapter 25, “Configuring Application Layer Protocol Inspection.” If you use a
match not command, then any traffic that matches the criterion in the match not command does
not have the action applied.
b. Specify the action you want to perform on the matching traffic by entering the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-c)# {[drop [send-protocol-error] |
drop-connection [send-protocol-error]| mask | reset] [log] | rate-limit message_rate}
Not all options are available for each application. Other actions specific to the application might also
be available. See Chapter 25, “Configuring Application Layer Protocol Inspection,” for the exact
options available.
The drop keyword drops all packets that match.
The send-protocol-error keyword sends a protocol error message.
The drop-connection keyword drops the packet and closes the connection.
The mask keyword masks out the matching portion of the packet.
The reset keyword drops the packet, closes the connection, and sends a TCP reset to the server
and/or client.
The log keyword, which you can use alone or with one of the other keywords, sends a system log
message.
The rate-limit message_rate argument limits the rate of messages.
You can specify multiple class or match commands in the policy map.
If a packet matches multiple different match or class commands, then the order in which the security
appliance applies the actions is determined by internal security appliance rules, and not by the order they
are added to the policy map. The internal rules are determined by the application type and the logical
progression of parsing a packet, and are not user-configurable. For example for HTTP traffic, parsing a
Request Method field precedes parsing the Header Host Length field; an action for the Request Method
field occurs before the action for the Header Host Length field. For example, the following match
commands can be entered in any order, but the match request method get command is matched first.
match request header host length gt 100
reset
match request method get
log
If an action drops a packet, then no further actions are performed in the inspection policy map. For
example, if the first action is to reset the connection, then it will never match any further match or class
commands. If the first action is to log the packet, then a second action, such as resetting the connection,
can occur. (You can configure both the reset (or drop-connection, and so on.) and the log action for the
same match or class command, in which case the packet is logged before it is reset for a given match.)
If a packet matches multiple match or class commands that are the same, then they are matched in the
order they appear in the policy map. For example, for a packet with the header length of 1001, it will
match the first command below, and be logged, and then will match the second command and be reset.
If you reverse the order of the two match commands, then the packet will be dropped and the connection
reset before it can match the second match command; it will never be logged.
match request header length gt 100
log
match request header length gt 1000
reset
A class map is determined to be the same type as another class map or match command based on the
lowest priority match command in the class map (the priority is based on the internal rules). If a class
map has the same type of lowest priority match command as another class map, then the class maps are
matched according to the order they are added to the policy map. If the lowest priority command for each
class map is different, then the class map with the higher priority match command is matched first. For
example, the following three class maps contain two types of match commands: match request-cmd
(higher priority) and match filename (lower priority). The ftp3 class map includes both commands, but
it is ranked according to the lowest priority command, match filename. The ftp1 class map includes the
highest priority command, so it is matched first, regardless of the order in the policy map. The ftp3 class
map is ranked as being of the same priority as the ftp2 class map, which also contains the match
filename command. They are matched according to the order in the policy map: ftp3 and then ftp2.
class-map inspect type ftp ftp1
match request-cmd get
class-map inspect type ftp ftp2
match filename regex abc
class-map inspect type ftp ftp3
match request-cmd get
match filename regex abc
Step 3 To configure parameters that affect the inspection engine, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# parameters
hostname(config-pmap-p)#
The CLI enters parameters configuration mode. For the parameters available for each application, see
Chapter 25, “Configuring Application Layer Protocol Inspection.”
The following is an example of an HTTP inspection policy map and the related class maps. This policy
map is activated by the Layer 3/4 policy map, which is enabled by the service policy.
hostname(config)# regex url_example example.com
hostname(config)# regex url_example2 example2.com
hostname(config)# class-map type regex match-any URLs
hostname(config-cmap)# match regex example
hostname(config-cmap)# match regex example2
Note When you use a global policy, all features are unidirectional; features that are normally bidirectional
when applied to a single interface only apply to the ingress of each interface when applied globally.
Because the policy is applied to all interfaces, the policy will be applied in both directions so
bidirectionality in this case is redundant.
For features that are applied unidirectionally, for example QoS priority queue, only traffic that exits the
interface to which you apply the policy map is affected. See Table 21-2 for the directionality of each
feature.
The order in which different types of actions in a policy map are performed is independent of the order
in which the actions appear in the policy map. Actions are performed in the following order:
• TCP normalization, TCP and UDP connection limits and timeouts, and TCP sequence number
randomization
Note When a the security appliance performs a proxy service (such as AAA or CSC) or it modifies
the TCP payload (such as FTP inspection), the TCP normalizer acts in dual mode, where it is
applied before and after the proxy or payload modifying service.
• CSC
• Application inspection
• IPS
• QoS input policing
• QoS output policing
• QoS priority queue
You can only assign one policy map per interface, but you can apply the same policy map to multiple
interfaces.
The policy_map_name argument is the name of the policy map up to 40 characters in length. All types
of policy maps use the same name space, so you cannot reuse a name already used by another type of
policy map. The CLI enters policy-map configuration mode.
Step 2 (Optional) Specify a description for the policy map:
hostname(config-pmap)# description text
Step 3 Specify a previously configured Layer 3/4 class map using the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# class class_map_name
See the “Identifying Traffic Using a Layer 3/4 Class Map” section on page 21-2 to add a class map.
Step 4 Specify one or more actions for this class map.
• IPS. See the “Diverting Traffic to the AIP SSM” section on page 22-2.
• CSC. See the “Diverting Traffic to the CSC SSM” section on page 22-11.
• TCP normalization. See the “Configuring TCP Normalization” section on page 23-1.
• TCP and UDP connection limits and timeouts, and TCP sequence number randomization. See the
“Configuring Connection Limits and Timeouts” section on page 23-4.
• QoS policing and QoS priority. See Chapter 24, “Applying QoS Policies.”
• Application inspection. See Chapter 25, “Configuring Application Layer Protocol Inspection.”
Note If there is no match default_inspection_traffic command in a class map, then at most one
inspect command is allowed to be configured under the class.
Step 5 Repeat Step 3 and Step 4 for each class map you want to include in this policy map.
The following is an example of a policy-map command for connection policy. It limits the number of
connections allowed to the web server 10.1.1.1:
hostname(config)# access-list http-server permit tcp any host 10.1.1.1
hostname(config)# class-map http-server
hostname(config-cmap)# match access-list http-server
The following example shows how traffic matches the first available class map, and will not match any
subsequent class maps that specify actions in the same feature domain:
hostname(config)# class-map telnet_traffic
hostname(config-cmap)# match port tcp eq 23
hostname(config)# class-map ftp_traffic
hostname(config-cmap)# match port tcp eq 21
hostname(config)# class-map tcp_traffic
hostname(config-cmap)# match port tcp range 1 65535
hostname(config)# class-map udp_traffic
hostname(config-cmap)# match port udp range 0 65535
hostname(config)# policy-map global_policy
hostname(config-pmap)# class telnet_traffic
hostname(config-pmap-c)# set connection timeout tcp 0:0:0
hostname(config-pmap-c)# set connection conn-max 100
hostname(config-pmap)# class ftp_traffic
hostname(config-pmap-c)# set connection timeout tcp 0:5:0
hostname(config-pmap-c)# set connection conn-max 50
hostname(config-pmap)# class tcp_traffic
hostname(config-pmap-c)# set connection timeout tcp 2:0:0
hostname(config-pmap-c)# set connection conn-max 2000
When a Telnet connection is initiated, it matches class telnet_traffic. Similarly, if an FTP connection is
initiated, it matches class ftp_traffic. For any TCP connection other than Telnet and FTP, it will match
class tcp_traffic. Even though a Telnet or FTP connection can match class tcp_traffic, the security
appliance does not make this match because they previously matched other classes.
• To create a service policy that applies to all interfaces that do not have a specific policy, enter the
following command:
hostname(config)# service-policy policy_map_name global
By default, the configuration includes a global policy that matches all default application inspection
traffic and applies inspection to the traffic globally. You can only apply one global policy, so if you
want to alter the global policy, you need to either edit the default policy or disable it and apply a new
one.
The default service policy includes the following command:
service-policy global_policy global
For example, the following command enables the inbound_policy policy map on the outside interface:
hostname(config)# service-policy inbound_policy interface outside
The following commands disable the default global policy, and enables a new one called
new_global_policy on all other security appliance interfaces:
hostname(config)# no service-policy global_policy global
hostname(config)# service-policy new_global_policy global
Security
appliance insp.
port 80 police
A port 80
insp.
143356
Host A Host B
inside outside
Security
appliance
port 80
insp.
A port 80 insp.
143414
inside outside
Host A Host B
Server A
Real Address: 192.168.1.2 Security
Mapped Address: 209.165.201.1 appliance insp.
port 80
set conns
Host A
209.165.200.226
port 80
insp. inside outside
143357
Host B Server B
Real Address: 192.168.1.1 209.165.200.227
Mapped Address: 209.165.201.2:port
See the following commands for this example:
hostname(config)# static (inside,outside) 209.165.201.1 192.168.1.2
hostname(config)# nat (inside) 1 192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0
hostname(config)# global (outside) 1 209.165.201.2
hostname(config)# access-list serverA extended permit tcp any host 209.165.201.1 eq 80
hostname(config)# access-list ServerB extended permit tcp any host 209.165.200.227 eq 80
Security
appliance
port 80
insp. inside outside
143416
Host Server
Real IP: 192.168.1.1 209.165.201.1
Mapped IP: 209.165.200.225
The Cisco ASA 5500 series adaptive security appliance supports a variety of SSMs. This chapter
describes how to configure the adaptive security appliance to support an AIP SSM or a CSC SSM,
including how to send traffic to these SSMs.
For information about the 4GE SSM for the ASA 5000 series adaptive security appliance, see Chapter 5,
“Configuring Ethernet Settings and Subinterfaces”.
Note The Cisco PIX 500 series security appliances cannot support SSMs.
Step 2 Create a class map to identify the traffic that should be diverted to the AIP SSM. Use the class-map
command to do so, as follows:
hostname(config)# class-map class_map_name
hostname(config-cmap)#
where class_map_name is the name of the traffic class. When you enter the class-map command, the
CLI enters class map configuration mode.
Step 3 With the access list you created in Step 1, use a match access-list command to identify the traffic to be
scanned:
hostname(config-cmap)# match access-list acl-name
Step 4 Create a policy map or modify an existing policy map that you want to use to send traffic to the AIP
SSM. To do so, use the policy-map command, as follows.
hostname(config-cmap)# policy-map policy_map_name
hostname(config-pmap)#
where policy_map_name is the name of the policy map. The CLI enters the policy map configuration
mode and the prompt changes accordingly.
Step 5 Specify the class map, created in Step 2, that identifies the traffic to be scanned. Use the class command
to do so, as follows.
hostname(config-pmap)# class class_map_name
hostname(config-pmap-c)#
where class_map_name is the name of the class map you created in Step 2. The CLI enters the policy
map class configuration mode and the prompt changes accordingly.
Step 6 Assign the traffic identified by the class map as traffic to be sent to the AIP SSM. Use the ips command
to do so, as follows.
hostname(config-pmap-c)# ips {inline | promiscuous} {fail-close | fail-open}
The inline and promiscuous keywords control the operating mode of the AIP SSM. The fail-close and
fail-open keywords control how the adaptive security appliance treats traffic when the AIP SSM is
unavailable. For more information about the operating modes and failure behavior, see the “About the
AIP SSM” section on page 22-1.
Step 7 Use the service-policy command to apply the policy map globally or to a specific interface, as follows:
hostname(config-pmap-c)# service-policy policy_map_name [global | interface interface_ID]
hostname(config)#
where policy_map_name is the policy map you configured in Step 4. If you want to apply the policy map
to traffic on all the interfaces, use the global keyword. If you want to apply the policy map to traffic on
a specific interface, use the interface interface_ID option, where interface_ID is the name assigned to
the interface with the nameif command.
Only one global policy is allowed. You can override the global policy on an interface by applying a
service policy to that interface. You can only apply one policy map to each interface.
The adaptive security appliance begins diverting traffic to the AIP SSM as specified.
The following example diverts all IP traffic to the AIP SSM in promiscuous mode, and blocks all IP
traffic should the AIP SSM card fail for any reason:
hostname(config)# access-list IPS permit ip any any
hostname(config)# class-map my-ips-class
Note You can either session to the SSM from the adaptive security appliance (by using the session 1
command) or you can connect directly to the SSM using SSH or Telnet on its management interface.
Alternatively, you can use ASDM.
To session to the AIP SSM from the adaptive security appliance, perform the following steps:
Step 1 Enter the session 1 command to session from the ASA 5500 series adaptive security appliance to the AIP
SSM:
hostname# session 1
Opening command session with slot 1.
Connected to slot 1. Escape character sequence is 'CTRL-^X'.
Step 2 Enter the username and password. The default username and password are both cisco.
Note The first time you log in to the AIP SSM you are prompted to change the default password.
Passwords must be at least eight characters long and not a dictionary word.
login: cisco
Password:
Last login: Fri Sep 2 06:21:20 from xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx
***NOTICE***
This product contains cryptographic features and is subject to United States
and local country laws governing import, export, transfer and use. Delivery
of Cisco cryptographic products does not imply third-party authority to import,
export, distribute or use encryption. Importers, exporters, distributors and
users are responsible for compliance with U.S. and local country laws. By using
this product you agree to comply with applicable laws and regulations. If you
are unable to comply with U.S. and local laws, return this product immediately.
A summary of U.S. laws governing Cisco cryptographic products may be found at:
http://www.cisco.com/wwl/export/crypto/tool/stqrg.html
***LICENSE NOTICE***
There is no license key installed on the system.
Please go to http://www.cisco.com/go/license
to obtain a new license or install a license.
AIP SSM#
Note If you see the preceding license notice (which displays only is some versions of software), you can
ignore the message until you need to upgrade the signature files on the AIP SSM. The AIP SSM
continues to operate at the current signature level until a valid license key is installed. You can install
the license key at a later time. The license key does not affect the current functionality of the AIP SSM.
Step 3 Enter the setup command to run the setup utility for initial configuration of the AIP SSM:
AIP SSM# setup
You are now ready to configure the AIP SSM for intrusion prevention. See the following two guides for
AIP SSM configuration information:
• Configuring the Cisco Intrusion Prevention System Sensor Using the Command Line Interface
• Cisco Intrusion Prevention System Command Reference
Note The CSC SSM can scan FTP file transfers only when FTP inspection is enabled on the adaptive security
appliance. By default, FTP inspection is enabled.
Security Appliance
Main System
modular
service
policy
Request sent Request forwarded
inside outside
Reply forwarded Reply sent
Diverted Traffic Server
Client
148386
CSC SSM
You use ASDM for system setup and monitoring of the CSC SSM. For advanced configuration of content
security policies in the CSC SSM software, you access the web-based GUI for the CSC SSM by clicking
links within ASDM. Use of the CSC SSM GUI is explained in the Trend Micro InterScan for Cisco CSC
SSM Administrator Guide.
Note ASDM and the CSC SSM maintain separate passwords. You can configure their passwords to be
identical; however, changing one of these two passwords does not affect the other password.
The connection between the host running ASDM and the adaptive security appliance is made through a
management port on the adaptive security appliance. The connection to the CSC SSM GUI is made
through the SSM management port. Because these two connections are required to manage the CSC
SSM, any host running ASDM must be able to reach the IP address of both the adaptive security
appliance management port and the SSM management port.
Figure 22-2 shows an adaptive security appliance with a CSC SSM that is connected to a dedicated
management network. While use of a dedicated management network is not required, we recommend it.
Of particular interest in Figure 22-2 are the following:
• An HTTP proxy server is connected to the inside network and to the management network. This
enables the CSC SSM to contact the Trend Micro update server.
• The management port of the adaptive security appliance is connected to the management network.
To permit management of the adaptive security appliance and the CSC SSM, hosts running ASDM
must be connected to the management network.
• The management network includes an SMTP server for email notifications for the CSC SSM and a
syslog server that the CSC SSM can send syslog messages to.
192.168.50.38 SSM
management
port
Syslog
148387
Notifications
SMTP Server
CSC SSM cannot suport stateful failover, because the CSC SSM does not maintain connection
information and therefore cannot provide the failover unit with information necessary for stateful
failover. The connections that a CSC SSM is scanning are dropped upon failure of the security appliance
that the CSC SSM is installed in. When the standby adaptive security appliance becomes active, it will
forward the scanned traffic to its CSC SSM and the connections will be reset.
Step 1 If the CSC SSM did not come pre-installed in a Cisco ASA 5500 series adaptive security appliance,
install it and connect a network cable to the management port of the SSM. For assistance with installation
and connecting the SSM, see the Cisco ASA 5500 Series Hardware Installation Guide.
The management port of the CSC SSM must be connected to your network to allow management of
and automatic updates to the CSC SSM software. Additionally, the CSC SSM uses the management
port for email notifications and syslogging.
Step 2 With the CSC SSM, you should have received a Product Authorization Key (PAK). Use the PAK to
register the CSC SSM at the following URL.
http://www.cisco.com/go/license
After you register, you will receive activation keys by email. The activation keys are required before you
can complete Step 6
Step 3 Gather the following information, for use in Step 6.
• Activation keys, received after completing Step 2.
• SSM management port IP address, netmask, and gateway IP address.
Note The SSM management port IP address must be accessible by the hosts used to run ASDM.
The IP addresses for the SSM management port and the adaptive security appliance
management interface can be in different subnets.
Note If you are accessing ASDM for the first time, see the Cisco ASA 5500 Series Adaptive Security
Appliance Getting Started Guide for assistance with the Startup Wizard.
For more information about enabling ASDM access, see the “Allowing HTTPS Access for ASDM”
section on page 40-3.
Step 5 Verify time settings on the adaptive security appliance. Time setting accuracy is important for logging
of security events and for automatic updates of CSC SSM software.
• If you manually control time settings, verify the clock settings, including time zone. Choose
Configuration > Properties > Device Administration > Clock.
• If you are using NTP, verify the NTP configuration. Choose Configuration > Properties > Device
Administration > NTP.
Step 6 In ASDM, run the Content Security setup wizard. To do so, access the ASDM GUI in a supported web
browser and on the Home page, click the Content Security tab. The Content Security setup wizard runs.
For assistance with the Content Security setup wizard, click the Help button.
Note If you are accessing ASDM for the first time, see the Cisco ASA 5500 Series Adaptive Security
Appliance Getting Started Guide for assistance with the Startup Wizard.
Step 7 On the ASA 5500 series adaptive security appliance, identify traffic to divert to the CSC SSM (as
described in the “Diverting Traffic to the CSC SSM” section on page 22-11).
Step 8 (Optional) Review the default content security policies in the CSC SSM GUI. The default content
security policies are suitable for most implementations. Modifying them is advanced configuration that
you should perform only after reading the Trend Micro InterScan for Cisco CSC SSM Administrator
Guide.
You review the content security policies by viewing the enabled features in the CSC SSM GUI. The
availability of features depends on the license level you purchased. By default, all features included in
the license you purchased are enabled.
With a Base License, the features enabled by default are SMTP virus scanning, POP3 virus scanning and
content filtering, webmail virus scanning, HTTP file blocking, FTP virus scanning and file blocking,
logging, and automatic updates.
With a Plus License, the additional features enabled by default are SMTP anti-spam, SMTP content
filtering, POP3 anti-spam, URL blocking, and URL filtering.
To access the CSC SSM GUI, in ASDM choose Configuration > Trend Micro Content Security, and
then select one of the following: Web, Mail, File Transfer, or Updates. The blue links on these panes,
beginning with the word “Configure”, open the CSC SSM GUI.
Security
appliance
192.168.10.0 192.168.30.0
inside outside Internet
192.168.20.0
(dmz)
143800
Web server Mail server
There are many ways you could configure the adaptive security appliance to identify the traffic that you
want to scan. One approach is to define two service policies, one on the inside interface and the other on
the outside interface, each with an access list that matches traffic to be scanned. The following access
list could be used on the policy applied to the inside interface:
access-list csc_out permit tcp 192.168.10.0 255.255.255.0 any eq 21
access-list csc_out deny tcp 192.168.10.0 255.255.255.0 192.168.20.0 255.255.255.0 eq 80
access-list csc_out permit tcp 192.168.10.0 255.255.255.0 any eq 80
access-list csc_out permit tcp 192.168.10.0 255.255.255.0 any eq 110
As previously mentioned, policies applying the csc command to a specific interface are effective on both
ingress and egress traffic, but by specifying 192.168.10.0 as the source network in the csc_out access list
the policy applied to the inside interface matches only connections initiated by the hosts on the inside
network. Notice also that the second ACE of the access list uses the deny keyword. This ACE does not
mean the adaptive security appliance blocks traffic sent from the 192.168.10.0 network to TCP port 80
on the 192.168.20.0 network. It simply exempts the traffic from being matched by the policy map and
thus prevents the adaptive security appliance from sending it to the CSC SSM.
You can use deny statements in an access list to exempt connections with trusted external hosts from
being scanned. For example, to reduce the load on the CSC SSM, you might want to exempt HTTP traffic
to a well known, trusted site. If the web server at such a site had the IP address 209.165.201.7, you could
add the following ACE to the csc_out access list to exclude HTTP connections between the trusted
external web server and inside hosts from being scanned by CSC SSM:
access-list csc_out deny tcp 192.168.10.0 255.255.255.0 209.165.201.7 255.255.255.255 eq 80
The second policy in this example, applied to the outside interface, could use the following access list:
access-list csc_in permit tcp any 192.168.20.0 255.255.255.0 eq 25
This access list matches inbound SMTP connections from any external host to any host on the DMZ
network. The policy applied to the outside interface would therefore ensure that incoming SMTP email
would be diverted to the CSC SSM for scanning. It would not match SMTP connections from hosts on
the inside network to the mail server on the DMZ network because those connections never use the
outside interface.
If the web server on the DMZ network receives files uploaded by HTTP from external hosts, you could
add the following ACE to the csc_in access list to use the CSC SSM to protect the web server from
infected files:
access-list csc_in permit tcp any 192.168.20.0 255.255.255.0 eq 80
For a complete example service policy configuration using the access lists in this section, see
Example 22-1.
Step 1 Create an access list that matches the traffic you want scanned by the CSC SSM. To do so, use the
access-list extended command. Create as many ACEs as needed to match all the traffic. For example, if
you want to specify FTP, HTTP, POP3, and SMTP traffic, you would need four ACEs. For guidance on
identifying the traffic you want to scan, see the “Determining What Traffic to Scan” section on
page 22-9.
Step 2 Create a class map to identify the traffic that should be diverted to the CSC SSM. Use the class-map
command to do so, as follows.
where class_map_name is the name of the traffic class. When you enter the class-map command, the
CLI enters class map configuration mode.
Step 3 With the access list you created in Step 1, use a match access-list command to identify the traffic to be
scanned:
hostname(config-cmap)# match access-list acl-name
Step 4 Create a policy map or modify an existing policy map that you want to use to send traffic to the CSC
SSM. To do so, use the policy-map command, as follows.
hostname(config-cmap)# policy-map policy_map_name
hostname(config-pmap)#
where policy_map_name is the name of the policy map. The CLI enters the policy map configuration
mode and the prompt changes accordingly.
Step 5 Specify the class map, created in Step 2, that identifies the traffic to be scanned. Use the class command
to do so, as follows.
hostname(config-pmap)# class class_map_name
hostname(config-pmap-c)#
where class_map_name is the name of the class map you created in Step 2. The CLI enters the policy
map class configuration mode and the prompt changes accordingly.
Step 6 If you want to enforce a per-client limit for simultaneous connections that the adaptive security appliance
diverts to the CSC SSM, use the set connection command, as follows:
hostname(config-pmap-c)# set connection per-client-max n
where n is the maximum simultaneous connections the adaptive security appliance will allow per client.
This prevents a single client from abusing the services of the CSC SSM or any server protected by the
SSM, including prevention of attempts at DoS attacks on HTTP, FTP, POP3, or SMTP servers that the
CSC SSM protects.
Step 7 Assign the traffic identified by the class map as traffic to be sent to the CSC SSM. Use the csc command
to do so, as follows.
hostname(config-pmap-c)# csc {fail-close | fail-open}
The fail-close and fail-open keywords control how the adaptive security appliance treats traffic when
the CSC SSM is unavailable. For more information about the operating modes and failure behavior, see
the “About the CSC SSM” section on page 22-5.
Step 8 Use the service-policy command to apply the policy map globally or to a specific interface, as follows:
hostname(config-pmap-c)# service-policy policy_map_name [global | interface interface_ID]
hostname(config)#
where policy_map_name is the policy map you configured in Step 4. If you want to apply the policy map
to traffic on all the interfaces, use the global keyword. If you want to apply the policy map to traffic on
a specific interface, use the interface interface_ID option, where interface_ID is the name assigned to
the interface with the nameif command.
Only one global policy is allowed. You can override the global policy on an interface by applying a
service policy to that interface. You can only apply one policy map to each interface.
The adaptive security appliance begins diverting traffic to the CSC SSM as specified.
Example 22-1 is based on the network shown in Figure 22-3. It creates two service policies. The first
policy, csc_out_policy, is applied to the inside interface and uses the csc_out access list to ensure that
all outbound requests for FTP and POP3 are scanned. The csc_out access list also ensures that HTTP
connections from inside to networks on the outside interface are scanned but it includes a deny ACE to
exclude HTTP connections from inside to servers on the DMZ network.
The second policy, csc_in_policy, is applied to the outside interface and uses the csc_in access list to
ensure that requests for SMTP and HTTP originating on the outside interface and destined for the DMZ
network are scanned by the CSC SSM. Scanning HTTP requests protects the web server from HTTP file
uploads.
Example 22-1 Service Policies for a Common CSC SSM Scanning Scenario
Note FTP inspection must be enabled for CSC SSM to scan files transferred by FTP. FTP inspection is enabled
by default.
The argument 1, at the end of the command, is the slot number occupied by the SSM. If you do not know
the slot number, you can omit it and see information about all modules, including the adaptive security
appliance, which is considered to occupy slot 0 (zero).
Use the details keyword to view additional information for the SSM.
The follow example output is from an adaptive security appliance with a CSC SSM installed.
hostname# show module 1 details
Getting details from the Service Module, please wait...
ASA 5500 Series Security Services Module-20
Model: ASA-SSM-20
Hardware version: 1.0
Serial Number: 0
Firmware version: 1.0(10)0
Software version: Trend Micro InterScan Security Module Version 5.0
App. name: Trend Micro InterScan Security Module
App. version: Version 5.0
Data plane Status: Up
Status: Up
HTTP Service: Up
Mail Service: Up
FTP Service: Up
Activated: Yes
Mgmt IP addr: 10.23.62.92
Mgmt web port: 8443
Note If you are upgrading the application on the SSM, the SSM application may support backup of its
configuration. If you do not back up the configuration of the SSM application, it is lost when you transfer
an image onto the SSM. For more information about how your SSM supports backups, see the
documentation for your SSM.
Step 1 Create or modify a recovery configuration for the SSM. To do so, perform the following steps:
a. Determine if there is a recovery configuration for the SSM. To do so, use the show module
command with the recover keyword, as follows.
hostname# show module slot recover
Note When the adaptive security appliance operates in multiple context mode, the configure
keyword is available only in the system context.
If there is a recovery configuration for the SSM, the adaptive security appliance displays it. Examine
the recovery configuration closely to ensure that it is correct, especially the Image URL field. The
following example show a recovery configuration for an SSM in slot 1.
hostname# show module 1 recover
Module 1 recover parameters. . .
Boot Recovery Image: Yes
Image URL: tftp://10.21.18.1/ids-oldimg
Port IP Address: 10.1.2.10
Port Mask : 255.255.255.0
Gateway IP Address: 10.1.2.254
b. If you need to create or modify the recovery configuration, use the hw-module module recover
command with the configure keyword, as follows:
hostname# hw-module module slot recover configure
Note Be sure the TFTP server you specify can transfer files up to 60 MB in size. Also, be sure the
TFTP server can connect to the management port IP address that you specify for the SSM.
After you complete the prompts, the adaptive security appliance is ready to transfer to the SSM the
image that it finds at the URL you specified.
Step 2 Transfer the image from the TFTP server to the SSM and restart the SSM. To do so, use the hw-module
module recover command with the boot keyword, as follows.
hostname# hw-module module slot recover boot
Step 3 Check the progress of the image transfer and SSM restart process. To do so, use the show module
command. For details, see the “Checking SSM Status” section on page 22-13.
When the adaptive security appliance completes the image transfer and restart of the SSM, the SSM is
running the newly transferred image.
Note If your SSM supports configuration backups and you want to restore the configuration of the application
running on the SSM, see the documentation for your SSM for details.
This chapter describes how to prevent network attacks by configuring TCP normalization, limiting TCP
and UDP connections, and many other protection features.
This chapter includes the following sections:
• Configuring TCP Normalization, page 23-1
• Configuring Connection Limits and Timeouts, page 23-4
• Preventing IP Spoofing, page 23-5
• Configuring the Fragment Size, page 23-6
• Blocking Unwanted Connections, page 23-6
• Configuring IP Audit for Basic IPS Support, page 23-7
Step 1 To specify the TCP normalization criteria that you want to look for, create a TCP map by entering the
following command:
hostname(config)# tcp-map tcp-map-name
For each TCP map, you can specify one or more settings.
Step 2 Configure the TCP map criteria by entering commands for one or more of the following options:
• Prevent inconsistent TCP retransmissions:
hostname(config-tcp-map)# check-retransmission
• Allow packets whose data length exceeds the TCP maximum segment size. The default is to drop
these packets, so use this command to allow them.
hostname(config-tcp-map)# exceed-mss {allow | drop}
• Set the maximum number of out-of-order packets that can be queued for a TCP connection:
hostname(config-tcp-map)# queue-limit pkt_num
Where pkt_num specifies the maximum number of out-of-order packets. The range is 0 to 250 and
the default is 0.
• Clear reserved bits in the TCP header, or drop packets with reserved bits set. The default is to allow
reserved bits, so use this command to clear them or drop the packets.
hostname(config-tcp-map)# reserved-bits {allow | clear | drop}
Where allow allows packets with the reserved bits in the TCP header. clear clears the reserved bits
in the TCP header and allows the packet. drop drops the packet with the reserved bits in the TCP
header.
• Drop SYN packets with data. The default is to allow SYN packets with data, so use this command
to drop the packets.
hostname(config-tcp-map)# syn-data {allow | drop}
• Clears the selective-ack, timestamps, or window-scale TCP options, or drops a range of TCP options
by number. The default is to allow packets with specified options, or to clear the options within the
range, so use this command to clear, allow, or drop them.
hostname(config-tcp-map)# tcp-options {selective-ack | timestamp | window-scale}
{allow | clear}
Or:
hostname(config-tcp-map)# tcp-options range lower upper {allow | clear | drop}
Where allow allows packets with the specified option. clear clears the option and allows the packet.
drop drops the packet.
The selective-ack keyword allows or clears the SACK option. The default is to allow the SACK
option.
The timestamp keyword allows or clears the timestamp option. Clearing the timestamp option
disables PAWS and RTT. The default is to allow the timestamp option.
The widow-scale keyword allows or clears the window scale mechanism option. The default is to
allow the window scale mechanism option.
The range keyword specifies a range of options.
The lower argument sets the lower end of the range as 6, 7, or 9 through 255.
The upper argument sets the upper end of the range as 6, 7, or 9 through 255.
• Disable the TTL evasion protection:
hostname(config-tcp-map)# ttl-evasion-protection
Do not enter this command it you want to prevent attacks that attempt to evade security policy.
For example, an attacker can send a packet that passes policy with a very short TTL. When the TTL
goes to zero, a router between the security appliance and the endpoint drops the packet. It is at this
point that the attacker can send a malicious packet with a long TTL that appears to the security
appliance to be a retransmission and is passed. To the endpoint host, however, it is the first packet
that has been received by the attacker. In this case, an attacker is able to succeed without security
preventing the attack.
• Allow the URG pointer:
hostname(config-tcp-map)# urgent-flag {allow | clear}
The URG flag is used to indicate that the packet contains information that is of higher priority than
other data within the stream. The TCP RFC is vague about the exact interpretation of the URG flag,
therefore end systems handle urgent offsets in different ways, which may make the end system
vulnerable to attacks. The default behavior is to clear the URG flag and offset. Use this command
to allow the URB flag.
• Drop a connection that has changed its window size unexpectedly. The default is to allow
connections, so use this command to drop them.
hostname(config-tcp-map)# window-variation {allow | drop}
The window size mechanism allows TCP to advertise a large window and to subsequently advertise
a much smaller window without having accepted too much data. From the TCP specification,
“shrinking the window” is strongly discouraged. When this condition is detected, the connection can
be dropped.
Step 3 To identify the traffic to which you want to apply TCP normalization, add a class map using the
class-map command. See the “Identifying Traffic Using a Layer 3/4 Class Map” section on page 21-2
for more information.
Step 4 To add or edit a policy map that sets the actions to take with the class map traffic, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# policy-map name
Step 5 To identify the class map from Step 1 to which you want to assign an action, enter the following
command:
hostname(config-pmap)# class class_map_name
Step 6 Apply the TCP map to the class map by entering the following command.
hostname(config-pmap-c)# set connection advanced-options tcp-map-name
Step 7 To activate the policy map on one or more interfaces, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# service-policy policymap_name {global | interface interface_name}
Where global applies the policy map to all interfaces, and interface applies the policy to one interface.
Only one global policy is allowed. You can override the global policy on an interface by applying a
service policy to that interface. You can only apply one policy map to each interface.
For example, to allow urgent flag and urgent offset packets for all traffic sent to the range of TCP ports
between the well known FTP data port and the Telnet port, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# tcp-map tmap
hostname(config-tcp-map)# urgent-flag allow
hostname(config-tcp-map)# class-map urg-class
hostname(config-cmap)# match port tcp range ftp-data telnet
hostname(config-cmap)# policy-map pmap
hostname(config-pmap)# class urg-class
hostname(config-pmap-c)# set connection advanced-options tmap
hostname(config-pmap-c)# service-policy pmap global
Note You can also configure maximum connections, maximum embryonic connections, and TCP sequence
randomization in the NAT configuration. If you configure these settings for the same traffic using both
methods, then the security appliance uses the lower limit. For TCP sequence randomization, if it is
disabled using either method, then the security appliance disables TCP sequence randomization.
Step 1 To identify the traffic, add a class map using the class-map command. See the “Identifying Traffic Using
a Layer 3/4 Class Map” section on page 21-2 for more information.
Step 2 To add or edit a policy map that sets the actions to take with the class map traffic, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# policy-map name
Step 3 To identify the class map from Step 1 to which you want to assign an action, enter the following
command:
hostname(config-pmap)# class class_map_name
Step 4 To set maximum connection limits or whether TCP sequence randomization is enabled, enter the
following command:
hostname(config-pmap-c)# set connection {conn-max number | embryonic-conn-max number |
per-client-embryonic-max number | per-client-max number | random-sequence-number {enable |
disable}}. . .
where number is an integer between 0 and 65535. The default is 0, which means no limit on connections.
You can enter this command all on one line (in any order), or you can enter each attribute as a separate
command. The security appliance combines the command into one line in the running configuration.
Step 5 To set the timeout for connections, embryonic connections (half-opened), half-closed connections, and
dead connection detection, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-c)# set connection timeout {tcp <value> [reset]] [half-close <value>]
[embryonic <value>] [dcd [<retry-interval> [max-retries]]]}
where the half-close and tcp values are a time between 0:5:0 and 1192:59:59, in hh:mm:ss format. The
default for half-close is 0:10:0 and the default for tcp is 1:0:0. You can also set these values to 0, which
means the connection never times out.
The embryonic <value> is a time between 0:0:5 and 1192:59:59, in hh:mm:ss format. The default is
0:0:30. You can also set this value to 0, which means the connection never times out.
The dcd <retry-interval> is a time duration in <hh:mm:ss> format to wait between each unresponsive
DCD probe. The minimal value is 1 second, and the maximum value is 24 hours. The default value is 15
seconds.
The dcd <max-retries> is the number of consecutive failed retries before declaring the connection as
dead. The minimum value is 1 and the maximum value is 255, and the default is 5.
You can enter this command all on one line (in any order), or you can enter each attribute as a separate
command. The command is combined onto one line in the running configuration.
Step 6 To activate the policy map on one or more interfaces, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# service-policy policymap_name {global | interface interface_name}
where global applies the policy map to all interfaces, and interface applies the policy to one interface.
Only one global policy is allowed. You can override the global policy on an interface by applying a
service policy to that interface. You can only apply one policy map to each interface.
Preventing IP Spoofing
This section lets you enable Unicast Reverse Path Forwarding on an interface. Unicast RPF guards
against IP spoofing (a packet uses an incorrect source IP address to obscure its true source) by ensuring
that all packets have a source IP address that matches the correct source interface according to the
routing table.
Normally, the security appliance only looks at the destination address when determining where to
forward the packet. Unicast RPF instructs the security appliance to also look at the source address; this
is why it is called Reverse Path Forwarding. For any traffic that you want to allow through the security
appliance, the security appliance routing table must include a route back to the source address. See
RFC 2267 for more information.
For outside traffic, for example, the security appliance can use the default route to satisfy the
Unicast RPF protection. If traffic enters from an outside interface, and the source address is not known
to the routing table, the security appliance uses the default route to correctly identify the outside
interface as the source interface.
If traffic enters the outside interface from an address that is known to the routing table, but is associated
with the inside interface, then the security appliance drops the packet. Similarly, if traffic enters the
inside interface from an unknown source address, the security appliance drops the packet because the
matching route (the default route) indicates the outside interface.
Enter an interface name if you want to prevent fragmentation on a specific interface. By default, this
command applies to all interfaces.
Note If you have an IPS that monitors traffic, such as an AIP SSM, then the IPS can shun connections
automatically.
Step 1 If necessary, view information about the connection by entering the following command:
hostname# show conn
The security appliance shows information about each connection, such as the following:
TCP out 64.101.68.161:4300 in 10.86.194.60:23 idle 0:00:00 bytes 1297 flags UIO
Step 2 To shun connections from the source IP address, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# shun src_ip [dst_ip src_port dest_port [protocol]] [vlan vlan_id]
If you enter only the source IP address, then all future connections are shunned; existing connections
remain active.
To drop an existing connection, as well as blocking future connections from the source IP address, enter
the destination IP address, source and destination ports, and the protocol. By default, the protocol is 0
for IP.
For multiple context mode, you can enter this command in the admin context, and by specifying a
VLAN ID that is assigned to an interface in other contexts, you can shun the connection in other
contexts.
Step 3 To remove the shun, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# no shun src_ip [vlan vlan_id]
Step 1 To define an IP audit policy for informational signatures, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# ip audit name name info [action [alarm] [drop] [reset]]
Where alarm generates a system message showing that a packet matched a signature, drop drops the
packet, and reset drops the packet and closes the connection. If you do not define an action, then the
default action is to generate an alarm.
Step 2 To define an IP audit policy for attack signatures, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# ip audit name name attack [action [alarm] [drop] [reset]]
Where alarm generates a system message showing that a packet matched a signature, drop drops the
packet, and reset drops the packet and closes the connection. If you do not define an action, then the
default action is to generate an alarm.
Step 3 To assign the policy to an interface, enter the following command:
ip audit interface interface_name policy_name
Step 4 To disable signatures, or for more information about signatures, see the ip audit signature command in
the Cisco Security Appliance Command Reference.
This chapter describes how to apply QoS policies, and contains the following sections:
• Overview, page 24-1
• QoS Concepts, page 24-2
• Implementing QoS, page 24-2
• Identifying Traffic for QoS, page 24-4
• Defining a QoS Policy Map, page 24-5
• Applying Rate Limiting, page 24-6
• Activating the Service Policy, page 24-7
• Applying Low Latency Queueing, page 24-8
• Configuring QoS, page 24-9
• Viewing QoS Configuration, page 24-12
• Viewing QoS Statistics, page 24-14
Overview
Have you ever participated in a long-distance phone call that involved a satellite connection? The
conversation might be interrupted with brief, but perceptible, gaps at odd intervals. Those gaps are the
time, called the latency, between the arrival of packets being transmitted over the network. Some
network traffic, such as voice and streaming video, cannot tolerate long latency times. Quality of Service
(QoS) is a network feature that lets you give priority to these types of traffic.
As the Internet community of users upgrades their access points from modems to high-speed broadband
connections like DSL and cable, the likelihood increases that at any given time, a single user might be
able to absorb most, if not all, of the available bandwidth, thus starving the other users. To prevent any
one user or site-to-site connection from consuming more than its fair share of bandwidth, QoS provides
a policing feature that regulates the maximum bandwidth that any user can use.
QoS refers to the capability of a network to provide better service to selected network traffic over various
technologies for the best overall services with limited bandwidth of the underlying technologies.
The primary goal of QoS in the security appliance is to provide rate limiting on selected network traffic
for both individual flow and VPN tunnel flow to ensure that all traffic gets its fair share of limited
bandwidth. A flow can be defined in a number of ways. In the security appliance, QoS can apply to a
combination of source and destination IP addresses, source and destination port number, and the TOS
byte of the IP header.
QoS Concepts
QoS is a traffic-management strategy that lets you allocate network resources for both mission-critical
and normal data, based on the type of network traffic and the priority you assign to that traffic. In short,
QoS ensures unimpeded priority traffic and provides the capability of rate-limiting (policing) default
traffic.
For example, video and voice over IP (VoIP) are increasingly important for interoffice communication
between geographically dispersed sites, using the infrastructure of the Internet as the transport
mechanism. Firewalls are key to securing networks by controlling access, which includes inspecting
VoIP protocols. QoS is the focal point to provide clear, uninterrupted voice and video communications,
while still providing a basic level of service for all other traffic passing through the device.
For voice and video to traverse IP networks in a secure, reliable, and toll-quality manner, QoS must be
enabled at all points of the network. Implementing QoS lets you:
• Simplify network operations by collapsing all data, voice, and video network traffic onto a single
backbone using similar technologies.
• Enable new network applications, such as integrated call center applications and video-based
training, that can help differentiate enterprises in their respective market spaces and increase
productivity.
• Control resource use by controlling which traffic receives which resources. For example, you can
ensure that the most important, time-critical traffic receives the network resources (available
bandwidth and minimum delay) it needs, and that other applications using the link get their fair share
of service without interfering with mission-critical traffic.
QoS provides maximum rate control, or policing, for tunneled traffic for each individual user tunnel and
every site-to-site tunnel. In this release, there is no minimum bandwidth guarantee.
The security appliance can police individual user traffic within a LAN-to-LAN tunnel by configuring
class-maps that are not associated with the tunnel, but whose traffic eventually passes through the
LAN-to-LAN tunnel. The traffic before the LAN-to-LAN tunnel can then be specifically policed as it
passes through the tunnel and is policed again to the aggregate rate applied to the tunnel.
The security appliance achieves QoS by allowing two types of traffic queues for each interface: a
low-latency queue (LLQ) and a default queue. Only the default traffic is subject to rate limiting.
Because QoS can consume large amounts of resources, which could degrade security appliance
performance, QoS is disabled by default.
Note You must consider that in an ever-changing network environment, QoS is not a one-time deployment,
but an ongoing, essential part of network design.
Implementing QoS
In general, provisioning QoS policies requires the following steps:
1. Specifying traffic classes.
2. Associating actions with each traffic class to formulate policies.
3. Activating the policies.
The specification of a classification policy—that is, the definition of traffic classes—is separate from the
specification of the policies that act on the results of the classification.
A traffic class is a set of traffic that is identifiable by its packet content. For example, TCP traffic with
a port value of 23 might be classified as a Telnet traffic class.
An action is a specific activity taken to protect information or resources, in this case to perform QoS
functions. An action is typically associated with a specific traffic class.
Configuring a traditional QoS policy for the security appliance consists of the following steps:
• Defining traffic classes (class-map command).
• Associating policies and actions with each class of traffic (policy-map command).
• Attaching policies to logical or physical interfaces (service-policy command).
Note For detailed configuration steps, see the “Configuring QoS” section on page 24-9.
The class-map command defines a named object representing a class of traffic, specifying the packet
matching criteria that identifies packets that belong to this class. The basic form of the command is:
class-map class-map-name-1
match match-criteria-1
class-map class-map-name-n
match match-criteria-n
The policy-map command defines a named object that represents a set of policies to be applied to a set
of traffic classes. An example of such a policy is policing the traffic class to some maximum rate. The
basic form of the command is:
policy-map policy-map-name
class class-map-name-1
policy-1
policy-n
class class-map-name-n
policy-m
policy-m+1
The service-policy command attaches a policy-map and its associated policies to a target, named
interface.
Note QoS-related policies under policy-map-name apply only to the outbound traffic, not to the inbound
traffic of the named interface.
The command also indicates whether the policies apply to packets coming from or sent to the target. For
example, an output policy (applied to packets exiting an interface) is applied as follows:
interface GigabitEthernet0/3
service-policy output policy-map-name
In addition, if you are differentiating between priority traffic and best-effort traffic, you must define a
low-latency queue (priority-queue command) on each named, physical interface transmitting
prioritized traffic.
The following example enables a default priority-queue with the default queue-limit and tx-ring-limit:
priority-queue name-interface
When a packet is matched against a class-map, the result is either a match or a no-match.
In the following example, other, more specific match criteria are used for classifying traffic for specific,
security-related tunnel groups. These specific match criteria stipulate that a match on tunnel-group (in
this case, the previously-defined Tunnel-Group-1) is required as the first match characteristic to classify
traffic for a specific tunnel, and it allows for an additional match line to classify the traffic (IP differential
services code point, expedited forwarding).
hostname(config)# class-map TG1-voice
hostname(config-cmap)# match tunnel-group Tunnel-Group-1
hostname(config-cmap)# match dscp ef
In the following example, the class-map command classifies both tunneled and non-tunneled traffic
according to the traffic type:
hostname(config)# access-list tunneled extended permit ip 10.10.34.0 255.255.255.0 20.20.10.0 255.255.255.0
hostname(config)# access-list non-tunneled extended permit tcp any any
hostname(config)# tunnel-group tunnel-grp1 type IPSec_L2L
The following example shows a way of policing a flow within a tunnel, provided the classed traffic is
not specified as a tunnel, but does go through the tunnel. In this example, 192.168.10.10 is the address
of the host machine on the private side of the remote tunnel, and the access list is named “host-over-l2l”.
By creating a class-map (named “host-specific”), you can then police the “host-specific” class before the
LAN-to-LAN connection polices the tunnel. In this example, the “host-specific” traffic is rate-limited
before the tunnel, then the tunnel is rate-limited:
The following table summarizes the match command criteria available and relevant to QoS. For the full
list of all match commands and their syntax, see Cisco Security Appliance Command Reference:
Command Description
match access-list Matches, by name or number, access list traffic within a class map.
match any Identifies traffic that matches any of the criteria in the class map.
match dscp Matches the IETF-defined DSCP value (in an IP header) in a class map. You
can specify up to 64 different dscp values, defining the class as composed of
packets that match any of the specified values.
match flow ip Enables flow-based policy actions. The criteria to define flow is the
destination-address destination IP address. All traffic going to a unique IP destination address is
considered a flow. Policy action is applied to each flow instead of the entire
class of traffic. This command always accompanies match tunnel group.
For remote-access VPNs, this command applies to each remote-access host
flow. For LAN-to-LAN VPNs, this command applies to the single
aggregated VPN flow identified by the local and remote tunnel address pair.
match port Specifies the TCP/UDP ports as the comparison criteria for packets received
on that interface.
match precedence Matches the precedence value represented by the TOS byte in the IP header.
You can specify up to 8 different precedence values, defining the class as
composed of packets that match any of the specified values.
match rtp Matches traffic that uses a specific RTP port within a specified range. The
allowed range is targeted at capturing applications likely to be using RTP.
The packet matches the defined class only if the UDP port falls within the
specified range, inclusive, and the port number is an even number.
match tunnel group Matches every tunnel within the specified tunnel group.
In addition to the user-defined classes, a system-defined class named class-default also exists. This
class-default represents all packets that do not match any of the user-defined classes, so that policies can
be defined for these packets.
TCP traffic with a port value of 23 can be classified as a Telnet traffic class. The class commands are
differentiated by their previously named and constructed class-map designations, and the associated
actions follow immediately after.
The security appliance evaluates class-maps in the order in which they were entered in the policy-map
configuration. It classifies a packet to the first class-map that matches the packet.
Note The order in which different types of actions in a policy-map are performed is independent of the order
in which the actions appear in the command descriptions in this document.
The priority command provides low-latency queuing for delay-sensitive traffic, such as voice. This
command selects all packets that match the associated class (TG1-voice in the previous example) and
sends them to the low latency queue for priority processing.
Note You can specify the drop action, but it is not functional. The action is always to transmit, except when
the rate is exceeded, and even then, the action is to throttle the traffic to the maximum allowable speed.
The police command also configures the largest single burst of traffic allowed. A burst value in the range
1000-512000000 specifies the maximum number of instantaneous bytes allowed in a sustained burst
before throttling to the conforming rate value.
Note Policing can apply in both the input and output directions.
Note When policing is specified in the default class map, class-default, the police values of class-default are
applied to the aggregated LAN-to-LAN VPN flow if there is no police command defined for
tunnel-group of LAN-to-LAN VPN. In other words, the policing values of class-default are never applied
to the individual flow of a LAN-to-LAN VPN that exists before encryption.
The following example builds on the configuration developed in the previous section. As in the previous
example, there are two named class-maps: tcp_traffic and TG1-voice. Adding a third class-map:
hostname(config)# class-map TG1-best-effort
hostname(config-cmap)# match tunnel-group Tunnel-Group-1
hostname(config-cmap)# match flow ip destination-address
provides a basis for defining a tunneled and non-tunneled QoS policy, as follows, which creates a simple
QoS policy for tunneled and non-tunneled traffic, assigning packets of the class TG1-voice to the low
latency queue and setting rate limits on the tcp_traffic and TG1-best-effort traffic flows.
Note “Best effort” does not guarantee reliable packet delivery, in that it does not use a sophisticated
acknowledgement system. It does, however, make a “best effort” to deliver packets to the destination.
In this example, the maximum rate for traffic of the tcp_traffic class is 56,000 bits/second and a
maximum burst size of 10,500 bytes per second. For the TC1-BestEffort class, the maximum rate is
200,000 bits/second, with a maximum burst of 37,500 bytes/second. Traffic in the TC1-voice class has
no policed maximum speed or burst rate because it belongs to a priority class:
hostname(config)# policy-map qos
hostname(config-pmap)# class tcp_traffic
hostname(config-pmap-c)# police output 56000 10500
Note You can have up to 256 policy-maps, and up to 256 classes in a policy map. The maximum number of
classes in all policy maps together is 256. For any class-map, you can have only one match statement
associated with it, with the exception of a tunnel class. For a tunnel class, an additional match
tunnel-group statement is allowed.
Note The class class-default always exists. It does not need to be declared.
Note The upper limit of the range of values for the queue-limit and tx-ring-limit commands is determined
dynamically at run time. To view this limit, enter help or ? on the command line. The key determinants
are the memory needed to support the queues and the memory available on the device. The range of
queue-limit values is 0 through 2048 packets. The range of tx-ring-limit values is 3 through 128 packets
on the PIX platform and 3 to 256 packets on the ASA platform.
Note You cannot enable both priority queuing and policing together. In other words, only packets with normal
priority can be policed; packets with high priority are not policed.
The following example establishes a priority queue on the interface “outside” (the GigabitEthernet0/1
interface), sets the queue-limit to 2048 packets, and sets the tx-ring-limit to 256:
hostname(config)# priority-queue outside
hostname(config-priority-queue)# queue-limit 2048
hostname(config-priority-queue)# tx-ring-limit 256
Note When priority queuing is enabled, the security appliance empties all packets in higher priority queues
before transmitting packets in lower priority queues.
Configuring QoS
The following procedure provides steps for configuring a traffic class, a policy map, and a service policy
that implement QoS policing (rate limiting) or priority queuing. In addition, for priority queuing, it
includes steps for enabling priority queues on interfaces.
The number of traffic classes, policy maps, and service policies needed to implement QoS varies
depending upon the requirements of your network. Analyze your network and determine how many
traffic classes, policy maps, and service policies needed on the security appliance you are configuring,
and then use this procedure as applicable to your QoS deployment.
To configure QoS policing and priority queuing, perform the following steps:
Step 1 Determine which traffic you want to police or mark for priority queuing. For a detailed discussion of
identifying QoS traffic, see the “Identifying Traffic for QoS” section on page 24-4.
Step 2 Create a class map or modify an existing class map to identify traffic that you want to police or to identify
as priority traffic. Use the class-map command to do so, as follows:
hostname(config)# class-map class_map_name
hostname(config-cmap)#
where class_map_name is the name of the traffic class. When you enter the class-map command, the
CLI enters class map configuration mode.
Step 3 Identify the traffic you determined in Step 1. To do so, use a match command. For a detailed discussion
of identifying QoS traffic, see the “Identifying Traffic for QoS” section on page 24-4.
If you need to identify two or more non-contiguous ports, create an access list with the access-list
extended command, add an ACE to match each port, and then use the match access-list command. The
following commands show how to use an access list to identify multiple TCP ports with an access list:
hostname(config)# access-list acl-name any any tcp eq port_number_1
hostname(config)# access-list acl-name any any tcp eq port_number_2
hostname(config)# class-map class_map_name
hostname(config-cmap)# match access-list acl-name
If you need to identify a single port, use the match port command, as follows:
hostname(config-cmap)# match port {tcp | udp} port_number
where port_number is the destination port of traffic that you want to configure the security appliance to
police or mark for priority queuing.
If you need to identify a range of contiguous ports, use match port command with the range keyword,
as follows:
hostname(config-cmap)# match port {tcp | udp} range begin_port_number end_port_number
where begin_port_number is the lowest port in the range of ports and end_port_number is the highest
port.
Step 4 Create a policy map or modify an existing policy map that you want to use to apply policing or priority
queuing to the traffic identified in Step 2. For more information about QoS policy maps, see the
“Defining a QoS Policy Map” section on page 24-5.
Use the policy-map command, as follows:
hostname(config-cmap)# policy-map policy_map_name
hostname(config-pmap)#
where policy_map_name is the name of the policy map. The CLI enters the policy map configuration
mode and the prompt changes accordingly.
Step 5 Specify the class map, created in Step 2, that identifies the traffic to be policed or marked for priority
queuing. Use the class command to do so, as follows:
hostname(config-pmap)# class class_map_name
hostname(config-pmap-c)#
where class_map_name is the name of the class map you created in Step 2. The CLI enters the policy
map class configuration mode and the prompt changes accordingly.
Step 6 Configure the action for the class. You can either mark the traffic class as priority traffic or specify rate
limiting for the traffic class. Do one of the following:
• If you want the traffic selected by the class map to be marked as priority traffic, enter the priority
command.
hostname(config-pmap-c)# priority
Note Priority queuing does not occur automatically to traffic marked as priority. To enable priority
queuing, you must complete Step 8 also, which enables the priority queues.
For details about priority queuing, see the “Applying Low Latency Queueing” section on page 24-8
and the priority command page in the Cisco Security Appliance Command Reference.
• If you want the security appliance to police the traffic selected by the class map, enter the police
command.
hostname(config-pmap-c)# police [output] conform-rate [conform-burst] [conform-action
[drop | transmit] [exceed-action {drop | transmit}]]
For details about the use of the police command, see the “Applying Rate Limiting” section on
page 24-6 and the police command page in the Cisco Security Appliance Command Reference.
Step 7 Use the service-policy command to apply the policy map globally or to a specific interface, as follows:
hostname(config-pmap-c)# service-policy policy_map_name [global | interface interface_ID]
hostname(config)#
where policy_map_name is the policy map you configured in Step 4. If you want to apply the policy map
to traffic on all the interfaces, use the global option. If you want to apply the policy map to traffic on a
specific interface, use the interface interface_ID option, where interface_ID is the name assigned to the
interface with the nameif command.
The security appliance begins policing traffic and marking traffic for priority queuing, as specified.
Step 8 If in Step 6 you entered the priority command, you must enable priority queues on interfaces before the
security appliance performs priority queuing.
For each interface on which you want the security appliance to perform priority queuing, perform the
following steps:
a. Enter the priority-queue command:
hostname(config)# priority-queue interface
hostname(config-priority-queue)#
where interface is the name assigned to the physical interface whose priority queue you want to
enable. VLAN interfaces do not support priority queuing. The CLI enters the Priority-queue
configuration mode and the prompt changes accordingly
b. (Optional) If you want to specify a non-default maximum number of priority packets that can be
queued, enter the queue-limit command, as follows:
hostname(config-priority-queue)# queue-limit number-of-packets
The following example creates class maps for high priority (voice) and best effort traffic for a previously
configured tunnel group, named “tunnel-grp1”. The “qos” policy map includes the police command for
the best effort and the default traffic classes and the priority command for the voice class. The service
policy is then applied to the outside interface and the priority queue for the outside interface is enabled.
Note This is the same command you use to view priority and police statistics.
The following example shows the output of show service-policy with the police keyword:
hostname# show service-policy police
Global policy:
Service-policy: global_fw_policy
Interface outside:
Service-policy: qos
Class-map: browse
police Interface outside:
cir 56000 bps, bc 10500 bytes
conformed 10065 packets, 12621510 bytes; actions: transmit
exceeded 499 packets, 625146 bytes; actions: drop
conformed 5600 bps, exceed 5016 bps
Class-map: cmap2
police Interface outside:
cir 200000 bps, bc 37500 bytes
conformed 17179 packets, 20614800 bytes; actions: transmit
exceeded 617 packets, 770718 bytes; actions: drop
conformed 198785 bps, exceed 2303 bps
The following example shows the output of show service-policy with the priority keyword:
hostname# show service-policy priority
Global policy:
Service-policy: global_fw_policy
Interface outside:
Service-policy: qos
Class-map: TG1-voice
Priority:
Interface outside: aggregate drop 0, aggregate transmit 9383
For the foregoing examples, the output of this command would look something like the following:
hostname# show running-config policy-map
!
policy-map test
class class-default
policy-map inbound_policy
class ftp-port
inspect ftp strict inbound_ftp
policy-map qos
class browse
police 56000 10500
class TG1-voice
priority
class TG1-BestEffort
police 200000 37500
Note This is the same command you use to view configuration of policies that include the police keyword.
For example, the following command displays service policies that include the police command and the
related statistics; for example:
hostname# show service-policy police
Global policy:
Service-policy: global_fw_policy
Interface outside:
Service-policy: qos
Class-map: browse
police Interface outside:
cir 56000 bps, bc 10500 bytes
conformed 10065 packets, 12621510 bytes; actions: transmit
exceeded 499 packets, 625146 bytes; actions: drop
conformed 5600 bps, exceed 5016 bps
Class-map: cmap2
police Interface outside:
cir 200000 bps, bc 37500 bytes
conformed 17179 packets, 20614800 bytes; actions: transmit
exceeded 617 packets, 770718 bytes; actions: drop
conformed 198785 bps, exceed 2303 bps
Note This is the same command you use to view configuration of policies that include the priority keyword.
For example, the following command displays service policies that include the priority command and
the related statistics; for example:
hostname# show service-policy priority
Global policy:
Service-policy: global_fw_policy
Interface outside:
Service-policy: qos
Class-map: TG1-voice
Priority:
Interface outside: aggregate drop 0, aggregate transmit 9383
Note “Aggregate drop” denotes the aggregated drop in this interface; “aggregate transmit” denotes the
aggregated number of transmitted packets in this interface.
Queue Type = BE
Packets Dropped = 0
Packets Transmit = 0
Packets Enqueued = 0
Current Q Length = 0
Max Q Length = 0
This chapter describes how to configure application layer protocol inspection. Inspection engines are
required for services that embed IP addressing information in the user data packet or that open secondary
channels on dynamically assigned ports. These protocols require the security appliance to do a deep
packet inspection instead of passing the packet through the fast path (see the “Stateful Inspection
Overview” section on page 1-4 for more information about the fast path). As a result, inspection engines
can affect overall throughput.
Several common inspection engines are enabled on the security appliance by default, but you might need
to enable others depending on your network. This chapter includes the following sections:
• Inspection Engine Overview, page 25-2
– When to Use Application Protocol Inspection, page 25-2
– Inspection Limitations, page 25-2
– Default Inspection Policy, page 25-3
• Configuring Application Inspection, page 25-5
• CTIQBE Inspection, page 25-9
• DCERPC Inspection, page 25-11
• DNS Inspection, page 25-13
• ESMTP Inspection, page 25-24
• FTP Inspection, page 25-25
• GTP Inspection, page 25-31
• H.323 Inspection, page 25-37
• HTTP Inspection, page 25-43
• Instant Messaging Inspection, page 25-48
• ICMP Inspection, page 25-51
• ICMP Error Inspection, page 25-51
• ILS Inspection, page 25-52
• MGCP Inspection, page 25-53
• NetBIOS Inspection, page 25-57
• PPTP Inspection, page 25-59
Inspection Limitations
See the following limitations for application protocol inspection:
• State information for multimedia sessions that require inspection are not passed over the state link
for stateful failover. The exception is GTP, which is replicated over the state link.
• Some inspection engines do not support PAT, NAT, outside NAT, or NAT between same security
interfaces. See “Default Inspection Policy” for more information about NAT support.
inspect sunrpc
inspect xdmcp
inspect sip
inspect netbios
inspect tftp
service-policy global_policy global
Step 1 To identify the traffic to which you want to apply inspections, add either a Layer 3/4 class map for
through traffic or a Layer 3/4 class map for management traffic. See the “Creating a Layer 3/4 Class Map
for Through Traffic” section on page 21-3 and “Creating a Layer 3/4 Class Map for Management
Traffic” section on page 21-5 for detailed information. The management Layer 3/4 class map can be used
only with the RADIUS accounting inspection.
The default Layer 3/4 class map for through traffic is called “inspection_default.” It matches traffic using
a special match command, match default-inspection-traffic, to match the default ports for each
application protocol.
You can specify a match access-list command along with the match default-inspection-traffic
command to narrow the matched traffic to specific IP addresses. Because the match
default-inspection-traffic command specifies the ports to match, any ports in the access list are
ignored.
If you want to match non-standard ports, then create a new class map for the non-standard ports. See the
“Default Inspection Policy” section on page 25-3 for the standard ports for each inspection engine. You
can combine multiple class maps in the same policy if desired, so you can create one class map to match
certain traffic, and another to match different traffic. However, if traffic matches a class map that
contains an inspection command, and then matches another class map that also has an inspection
command, only the first matching class is used. For example, SNMP matches the inspection_default
class. To enable SNMP inspection, enable SNMP inspection for the default class in Step 5. Do not add
another class that matches SNMP.
For example, to limit inspection to traffic from 10.1.1.0 to 192.168.1.0 using the default class map, enter
the following commands:
hostname(config)# access-list inspect extended permit ip 10.1.1.0 255.255.255.0
192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0
hostname(config)# class-map inspection_default
hostname(config-cmap)# match access-list inspect
To inspect FTP traffic on port 21 as well as 1056 (a non-standard port), create an access list that specifies
the ports, and assign it to a new class map:
hostname(config)# access-list ftp_inspect extended permit tcp any any eq 21
hostname(config)# access-list ftp_inspect extended permit tcp any any eq 1056
hostname(config)# class-map new_inspection
hostname(config-cmap)# match access-list ftp_inspect
Step 2 (Optional) Some inspection engines let you control additional parameters when you apply the inspection
to the traffic. See the following sections to configure an inspection policy map for your application:
• DCERPC—See the “Configuring a DCERPC Inspection Policy Map for Additional Inspection
Control” section on page 25-12
• DNS—See the “Configuring a DNS Inspection Policy Map for Additional Inspection Control”
section on page 25-20
• ESMTP—See the “Configuring an ESMTP Inspection Policy Map for Additional Inspection
Control” section on page 25-24
• FTP—See the “Configuring an FTP Inspection Policy Map for Additional Inspection Control”
section on page 25-27.
• GTP—See the “Configuring a GTP Inspection Policy Map for Additional Inspection Control”
section on page 25-32.
• H323—See the “Configuring an H.323 Inspection Policy Map for Additional Inspection Control”
section on page 25-38
• HTTP—See the “Configuring an HTTP Inspection Policy Map for Additional Inspection Control”
section on page 25-44.
• Instant Messaging—See the “Configuring an Instant Messaging Inspection Policy Map for
Additional Inspection Control” section on page 25-48
• MGCP—See the “Configuring an MGCP Inspection Policy Map for Additional Inspection Control”
section on page 25-55.
• NetBIOS—See the “Configuring a NetBIOS Inspection Policy Map for Additional Inspection
Control” section on page 25-57
• RADIUS Accounting—See the “Configuring a RADIUS Inspection Policy Map for Additional
Inspection Control” section on page 25-60
• SIP—See the “Configuring a SIP Inspection Policy Map for Additional Inspection Control” section
on page 25-63
• Skinny—See the “Configuring a Skinny (SCCP) Inspection Policy Map for Additional Inspection
Control” section on page 25-70
• SNMP—See the “SNMP Inspection” section on page 25-73.
Step 3 To add or edit a Layer 3/4 policy map that sets the actions to take with the class map traffic, enter the
following command:
hostname(config)# policy-map name
hostname(config-pmap)#
The default policy map is called “global_policy.” This policy map includes the default inspections listed
in the “Default Inspection Policy” section on page 25-3. If you want to modify the default policy (for
example, to add or delete an inspection, or to identify an additional class map for your actions), then
enter global_policy as the name.
Step 4 To identify the class map from Step 1 to which you want to assign an action, enter the following
command:
hostname(config-pmap)# class class_map_name
hostname(config-pmap-c)#
If you are editing the default policy map, it includes the inspection_default class map. You can edit the
actions for this class by entering inspection_default as the name. To add an additional class map to this
policy map, identify a different name. You can combine multiple class maps in the same policy if
desired, so you can create one class map to match certain traffic, and another to match different traffic.
However, if traffic matches a class map that contains an inspection command, and then matches another
class map that also has an inspection command, only the first matching class is used. For example,
SNMP matches the inspection_default class map.To enable SNMP inspection, enable SNMP inspection
for the default class in Step 5. Do not add another class that matches SNMP.
Step 5 Enable application inspection by entering the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-c)# inspect protocol
Keywords Notes
ctiqbe —
dcerpc [map_name] If you added a DCERPC inspection policy map according to
“Configuring a DCERPC Inspection Policy Map for
Additional Inspection Control” section on page 25-12,
identify the map name in this command.
dns [map_name] If you added a DNS inspection policy map according to
“Configuring a DNS Inspection Policy Map for Additional
Inspection Control” section on page 25-20, identify the map
name in this command. The default DNS inspection policy
map name is “preset_dns_map.” The default inspection
policy map sets the maximum DNS packet length to 512
bytes.
esmtp [map_name] If you added an ESMTP inspection policy map according to
“Configuring an ESMTP Inspection Policy Map for
Additional Inspection Control” section on page 25-24,
identify the map name in this command.
ftp [strict [map_name]] Use the strict keyword to increase the security of protected
networks by preventing web browsers from sending
embedded commands in FTP requests. See the “Using the
strict Option” section on page 25-26 for more information.
If you added an FTP inspection policy map according to
“Configuring an FTP Inspection Policy Map for Additional
Inspection Control” section on page 25-27, identify the map
name in this command.
gtp [map_name] If you added a GTP inspection policy map according to the
“Configuring a GTP Inspection Policy Map for Additional
Inspection Control” section on page 25-32, identify the map
name in this command.
Keywords Notes
h323 h225 [map_name] If you added an H323 inspection policy map according to
“Configuring an H.323 Inspection Policy Map for
Additional Inspection Control” section on page 25-38,
identify the map name in this command.
h323 ras [map_name] If you added an H323 inspection policy map according to
“Configuring an H.323 Inspection Policy Map for
Additional Inspection Control” section on page 25-38,
identify the map name in this command.
http [map_name] If you added an HTTP inspection policy map according to
the “Configuring an HTTP Inspection Policy Map for
Additional Inspection Control” section on page 25-44,
identify the map name in this command.
icmp —
icmp error —
ils —
im [map_name] If you added an Instant Messaging inspection policy map
according to “Configuring an Instant Messaging Inspection
Policy Map for Additional Inspection Control” section on
page 25-48, identify the map name in this command.
mgcp [map_name] If you added an MGCP inspection policy map according to
“Configuring an MGCP Inspection Policy Map for
Additional Inspection Control” section on page 25-55,
identify the map name in this command.
netbios [map_name] If you added a NetBIOS inspection policy map according to
“Configuring a NetBIOS Inspection Policy Map for
Additional Inspection Control” section on page 25-57,
identify the map name in this command.
pptp —
radius-accounting [map_name] The radius-accounting keyword is only available for a
management class map. See the “Creating a Layer 3/4 Class
Map for Management Traffic” section on page 21-5 for more
information about creating a management class map.
If you added a RADIUS accounting inspection policy map
according to “Configuring a RADIUS Inspection Policy
Map for Additional Inspection Control” section on
page 25-60, identify the map name in this command.
rsh —
rtsp —
sip [map_name] If you added a SIP inspection policy map according to
“Configuring a SIP Inspection Policy Map for Additional
Inspection Control” section on page 25-63, identify the map
name in this command.
Keywords Notes
skinny [map_name] If you added a Skinny inspection policy map according to
“Configuring a Skinny (SCCP) Inspection Policy Map for
Additional Inspection Control” section on page 25-70,
identify the map name in this command.
snmp [map_name] If you added an SNMP inspection policy map according to
“SNMP Inspection” section on page 25-73, identify the map
name in this command.
sqlnet —
sunrpc The default class map includes UDP port 111; if you want to
enable Sun RPC inspection for TCP port 111, you need to
create a new class map that matches TCP port 111, add the
class to the policy, and then apply the inspect sunrpc
command to that class.
tftp —
xdmcp —
Step 6 To activate the policy map on one or more interfaces, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# service-policy policymap_name {global | interface interface_name}
Where global applies the policy map to all interfaces, and interface applies the policy to one interface.
By default, the default policy map, “global_policy,” is applied globally. Only one global policy is
allowed. You can override the global policy on an interface by applying a service policy to that interface.
You can only apply one policy map to each interface.
CTIQBE Inspection
This section describes CTIQBE application inspection. This section includes the following topics:
• CTIQBE Inspection Overview, page 25-9
• Limitations and Restrictions, page 25-10
• Verifying and Monitoring CTIQBE Inspection, page 25-10
Total: 1
LOCAL FOREIGN STATE HEARTBEAT
---------------------------------------------------------------
1 10.0.0.99/1117 172.29.1.77/2748 1 120
----------------------------------------------
RTP/RTCP: PAT xlates: mapped to 172.29.1.99(1028 - 1029)
----------------------------------------------
MEDIA: Device ID 27 Call ID 0
Foreign 172.29.1.99 (1028 - 1029)
Local 172.29.1.88 (26822 - 26823)
----------------------------------------------
The CTI device has already registered with the CallManager. The device internal address and RTP
listening port is PATed to 172.29.1.99 UDP port 1028. Its RTCP listening port is PATed to UDP 1029.
The line beginning with RTP/RTCP: PAT xlates: appears only if an internal CTI device has registered
with an external CallManager and the CTI device address and ports are PATed to that external interface.
This line does not appear if the CallManager is located on an internal interface, or if the internal CTI
device address and ports are translated to the same external interface that is used by the CallManager.
The output indicates a call has been established between this CTI device and another phone at
172.29.1.88. The RTP and RTCP listening ports of the other phone are UDP 26822 and 26823. The other
phone locates on the same interface as the CallManager because the security appliance does not maintain
a CTIQBE session record associated with the second phone and CallManager. The active call leg on the
CTI device side can be identified with Device ID 27 and Call ID 0.
The following is sample output from the show xlate debug command for these CTIBQE connections:
hostname# show xlate debug
3 in use, 3 most used
Flags: D - DNS, d - dump, I - identity, i - inside, n - no random,
r - portmap, s - static
TCP PAT from inside:10.0.0.99/1117 to outside:172.29.1.99/1025 flags ri idle 0:00:22
timeout 0:00:30
UDP PAT from inside:10.0.0.99/16908 to outside:172.29.1.99/1028 flags ri idle 0:00:00
timeout 0:04:10
UDP PAT from inside:10.0.0.99/16909 to outside:172.29.1.99/1029 flags ri idle 0:00:23
timeout 0:04:10
The show conn state ctiqbe command displays the status of CTIQBE connections. In the output, the
media connections allocated by the CTIQBE inspection engine are denoted by a ‘C’ flag. The following
is sample output from the show conn state ctiqbe command:
hostname# show conn state ctiqbe
1 in use, 10 most used
hostname# show conn state ctiqbe detail
1 in use, 10 most used
Flags: A - awaiting inside ACK to SYN, a - awaiting outside ACK to SYN,
B - initial SYN from outside, C - CTIQBE media, D - DNS, d - dump,
E - outside back connection, F - outside FIN, f - inside FIN,
G - group, g - MGCP, H - H.323, h - H.225.0, I - inbound data,
i - incomplete, J - GTP, j - GTP data, k - Skinny media,
M - SMTP data, m - SIP media, O - outbound data, P - inside back connection,
q - SQL*Net data, R - outside acknowledged FIN,
R - UDP RPC, r - inside acknowledged FIN, S - awaiting inside SYN,
s - awaiting outside SYN, T - SIP, t - SIP transient, U - up
DCERPC Inspection
This section describes the DCERPC inspection engine. This section includes the following topics:
• DCERPC Overview, page 25-11
• Configuring a DCERPC Inspection Policy Map for Additional Inspection Control, page 25-12
DCERPC Overview
DCERPC is a protocol widely used by Microsoft distributed client and server applications that allows
software clients to execute programs on a server remotely.
This typically involves a client querying a server called the Endpoint Mapper listening on a well known
port number for the dynamically allocated network information of a required service. The client then sets
up a secondary connection to the server instance providing the service. The security appliance allows
the appropriate port number and network address and also applies NAT, if needed, for the secondary
connection.
DCERPC inspect maps inspect for native TCP communication between the EPM and client on well
known TCP port 135. Map and lookup operations of the EPM are supported for clients. Client and server
can be located in any security zone. The embedded server IP address and Port number are received from
the applicable EPM response messages. Since a client may attempt multiple connections to the server
port returned by EPM, multiple use of pinholes are allowed, which have user configurable timeouts.
Step 1 Create a DCERPC inspection policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# policy-map type inspect dcerpc policy_map_name
hostname(config-pmap)#
Where the policy_map_name is the name of the policy map. The CLI enters policy-map configuration
mode.
Step 2 (Optional) To add a description to the policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# description string
Step 3 To configure parameters that affect the inspection engine, perform the following steps:
a. To enter parameters configuration mode, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# parameters
hostname(config-pmap-p)#
b. To configure the timeout for DCERPC pinholes and override the global system pinhole timeout of
two minutes, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# timeout pinhole hh:mm:ss
Where the hh:mm:ss argument is the timeout for pinhole connections. Value is between 0:0:1 and
1193:0:0.
c. To configure options for the endpoint mapper traffic, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# endpoint-mapper [service-only] [lookup-operation
[timeout hh:mm:ss]]
Where the hh:mm:ss argument is the timeout for pinholes generated from the lookup operation. If
no timeout is configured for the lookup operation, the timeout pinhole command or the default is
used. The epm-service-only keyword enforces endpoint mapper service during binding so that only
its service traffic is processed. The lookup-operation keyword enables the lookup operation of the
endpoint mapper service.
The following example shows how to define a DCERPC inspection policy map with the timeout
configured for DCERPC pinholes.
hostname(config)# policy-map type inspect dcerpc dcerpc_map
hostname(config-pmap)# timeout pinhole 0:10:00
DNS Inspection
This section describes DNS application inspection. This section includes the following topics:
• How DNS Application Inspection Works, page 25-13
• How DNS Rewrite Works, page 25-14
• Configuring DNS Rewrite, page 25-15
• Verifying and Monitoring DNS Inspection, page 25-20
Note DNS Rewrite is not applicable for PAT because multiple PAT rules are applicable for each
A-record and the PAT rule to use is ambiguous.
• Enforces the maximum DNS message length (the default is 512 bytes and the maximum length is
65535 bytes). The security appliance performs reassembly as needed to verify that the packet length
is less than the maximum length configured. The security appliance drops the packet if it exceeds
the maximum length.
Note If you enter the inspect dns command without the maximum-length option, DNS packet size
is not checked
• Verifies the integrity of the domain-name referred to by the pointer if compression pointers are
encountered in the DNS message.
• Checks to see if a compression pointer loop exists.
A single connection is created for multiple DNS sessions, as long as they are between the same two
hosts, and the sessions have the same 5-tuple (source/destination IP address, source/destination port, and
protocol). DNS identification is tracked by app_id, and the idle timer for each app_id runs
independently.
Because the app_id expires independently, a legitimate DNS response can only pass through the security
appliance within a limited period of time and there is no resource build-up. However, if you enter the
show conn command, you will see the idle timer of a DNS connection being reset by a new DNS session.
This is due to the nature of the shared DNS connection and is by design.
DNS server
server.example.com IN A 209.165.200.5
Web server
server.example.com
192.168.100.1 ISP Internet
Security appliance
192.168.100.1IN A 209.165.200.5
132406
Web client
http://server.example.com
192.168.100.2
DNS rewrite also works if the client making the DNS request is on a DMZ network and the DNS server
is on an inside interface. For an illustration and configuration instructions for this scenario, see the “DNS
Rewrite with Three NAT Zones” section on page 25-17.
The following example specifies that the address 192.168.100.10 on the inside interface is translated into
209.165.200.5 on the outside interface:
hostname(config)# static (inside,outside) 209.165.200.225 192.168.100.10 dns
Note Using the nat command is similar to using the static command except that DNS Rewrite is based on
dynamic translation instead of a static mapping.
The following example specifies that the real address (192.168.100.10) on any interface except the
inside interface will be translated to the mapped address (209.165.200.225) on the inside interface.
Notice that the location of 192.168.100.10 is not precisely defined.
hostname(config)# alias (inside) 209.165.200.225 192.168.100.10
Note If you use the alias command to configure DNS Rewrite, proxy ARP will be performed for the mapped
address. To prevent this, disable Proxy ARP by entering the sysopt noproxyarp command after entering
the alias command.
Step 4 If DNS inspection is disabled or if you want to change the maximum DNS packet length, configure DNS
inspection. DNS application inspection is enabled by default with a maximum DNS packet length of 512
bytes. For configuration instructions, see the “Configuring Application Inspection” section on
page 25-5.
Step 5 On the public DNS server, add an A-record for the web server, such as:
domain-qualified-hostname. IN A mapped-address
The following example configures the security appliance for the scenario shown in Figure 25-1. It
assumes DNS inspection is already enabled.
hostname(config)# static (inside,outside) 209.165.200.225 192.168.100.1 netmask
255.255.255.255 dns
hostname(config)# access-list 101 permit tcp any host 209.165.200.225 eq www
hostname(config)# access-group 101 in interface outside
DNS server
erver.example.com IN A 209.165.200.5
Outside
Security Web server
appliance 192.168.100.10
DMZ
192.168.100.1
99.99.99.2
Inside 10.10.10.1
132407
Web client
10.10.10.25
In Figure 25-2, a web server, server.example.com, has the real address 192.168.100.10 on the DMZ
interface of the security appliance. A web client with the IP address 10.10.10.25 is on the inside interface
and a public DNS server is on the outside interface. The site NAT policies are as follows:
• The outside DNS server holds the authoritative address record for server.example.com.
• Hosts on the outside network can contact the web server with the domain name server.example.com
through the outside DNS server or with the IP address 209.165.200.5.
• Clients on the inside network can access the web server with the domain name server.example.com
through the outside DNS server or with the IP address 192.168.100.10.
When a host or client on any interface accesses the DMZ web server, it queries the public DNS server
for the A-record of server.example.com. The DNS server returns the A-record showing that
server.example.com binds to address 209.165.200.5.
When a web client on the outside network attempts to access http://server.example.com, the sequence of
events is as follows:
1. The host running the web client sends the DNS server a request for the IP address of
server.example.com.
2. The DNS server responds with the IP address 209.165.200.225 in the reply.
3. The web client sends its HTTP request to 209.165.200.225.
4. The packet from the outside host reaches the security appliance at the outside interface.
5. The static rule translates the address 209.165.200.225 to 192.168.100.10 and the security appliance
directs the packet to the web server on the DMZ.
When a web client on the inside network attempts to access http://server.example.com, the sequence of
events is as follows:
1. The host running the web client sends the DNS server a request for the IP address of
server.example.com.
2. The DNS server responds with the IP address 209.165.200.225 in the reply.
3. The security appliance receives the DNS reply and submits it to the DNS application inspection
engine.
4. The DNS application inspection engine does the following:
a. Searches for any NAT rule to undo the translation of the embedded A-record address
“[outside]:209.165.200.5”. In this example, it finds the following static configuration:
static (dmz,outside) 209.165.200.225 192.168.100.10 dns
b. Uses the static rule to rewrite the A-record as follows because the dns option is included:
[outside]:209.165.200.225 --> [dmz]:192.168.100.10
Note If the dns option were not included with the static command, DNS Rewrite would not
be performed and other processing for the packet continues.
c. Searches for any NAT to translate the web server address, [dmz]:192.168.100.10, when
communicating with the inside web client.
No NAT rule is applicable, so application inspection completes.
If a NAT rule (nat or static) were applicable, the dns option must also be specified. If the dns
option were not specified, the A-record rewrite in step b would be reverted and other processing
for the packet continues.
5. The security appliance sends the HTTP request to server.example.com on the DMZ interface.
Step 1 Create a static translation for the web server on the DMZ network, as follows:
hostname(config)# static (dmz,outside) mapped-address real-address dns
Step 4 If DNS inspection is disabled or if you want to change the maximum DNS packet length, configure DNS
inspection. DNS application inspection is enabled by default with a maximum DNS packet length of 512
bytes. For configuration instructions, see the “Configuring Application Inspection” section on
page 25-5.
Step 5 On the public DNS server, add an A-record for the web server, such as:
domain-qualified-hostname. IN A mapped-address
The following example configures the security appliance for the scenario shown in Figure 25-2. It
assumes DNS inspection is already enabled.
hostname(config)# static (dmz,outside) 209.165.200.225 192.168.100.10 dns
hostname(config)# access-list 101 permit tcp any host 209.165.200.225 eq www
hostname(config)# access-group 101 in interface outside
For connections using a DNS server, the source port of the connection may be replaced by the IP address
of DNS server in the show conn command output.
A single connection is created for multiple DNS sessions, as long as they are between the same two
hosts, and the sessions have the same 5-tuple (source/destination IP address, source/destination port, and
protocol). DNS identification is tracked by app_id, and the idle timer for each app_id runs
independently.
Because the app_id expires independently, a legitimate DNS response can only pass through the security
appliance within a limited period of time and there is no resource build-up. However, when you enter
the show conn command, you see the idle timer of a DNS connection being reset by a new DNS session.
This is due to the nature of the shared DNS connection and is by design.
To display the statistics for DNS application inspection, enter the show service-policy command. The
following is sample output from the show service-policy command:
hostname# show service-policy
Interface outside:
Service-policy: sample_policy
Class-map: dns_port
Inspect: dns maximum-length 1500, packet 0, drop 0, reset-drop 0
Step 1 (Optional) Add one or more regular expressions for use in traffic matching commands according to the
“Creating a Regular Expression” section on page 21-6. See the types of text you can match in the match
commands described in Step 3.
Step 2 (Optional) Create one or more regular expression class maps to group regular expressions according to
the “Creating a Regular Expression Class Map” section on page 21-8.
Step 3 (Optional) Create a DNS inspection class map by performing the following steps.
A class map groups multiple traffic matches. Traffic must match all of the match commands to match
the class map. You can alternatively identify match commands directly in the policy map. The
difference between creating a class map and defining the traffic match directly in the inspection policy
map is that the class map lets you create more complex match criteria, and you can reuse class maps.
To specify traffic that should not match the class map, use the match not command. For example, if the
match not command specifies the string “example.com,” then any traffic that includes “example.com”
does not match the class map.
For the traffic that you identify in this class map, you can specify actions such as drop, drop-connection,
reset, mask, set the rate limit, and/or log the connection in the inspection policy map.
If you want to perform different actions for each match command, you should identify the traffic
directly in the policy map.
a. Create the class map by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# class-map type inspect dns [match-all] class_map_name
hostname(config-cmap)#
Where class_map_name is the name of the class map. The match-all keyword specifies that traffic
must match all criteria to match the class map. match-all is the default and only option. The CLI
enters class-map configuration mode, where you can enter one or more match commands.
b. (Optional) To add a description to the class map, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# description string
c. (Optional) To match a specific flag that is set in the DNS header, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] header-flag [eq] {f_well_known | f_value}
Where the f_well_known argument is the DNS flag bit. The f_value argument is the 16-bit value in
hex. The eq keyword specifies an exact match.
d. (Optional) To match a DNS type, including Query type and RR type, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] dns-type {eq t_well_known | t_val} {range t_val1
t_val2}
Where the t_well_known argument is the DNS flag bit. The t_val arguments are arbitrary values in
the DNS type field (0-65535). The range keyword specifies a range and the eq keyword specifies
an exact match.
e. (Optional) To match a DNS class, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] dns-class {eq c_well_known | c_val} {range c_val1
c_val2}
Where the c_well_known argument is the DNS class. The c_val arguments are arbitrary values in
the DNS class field. The range keyword specifies a range and the eq keyword specifies an exact
match.
f. (Optional) To match a DNS question or resource record, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match {question | {resource-record answer | authority | any}}
Where the question keyword specifies the question portion of a DNS message. The
resource-record keyword specifies the resource record portion of a DNS message. The answer
keyword specifies the Answer RR section. The authority keyword specifies the Authority RR
section. The additional keyword specifies the Additional RR section.
g. (Optional) To match a DNS message domain name list, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] domain-name {regex regex_id | regex class class_id]
The regex regex_name argument is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class
regex_class_name is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2.
Step 4 Create a DNS inspection policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# policy-map type inspect dns policy_map_name
hostname(config-pmap)#
Where the policy_map_name is the name of the policy map. The CLI enters policy-map configuration
mode.
Step 5 (Optional) To add a description to the policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# description string
• Specify traffic directly in the policy map using one of the match commands described in Step 3.
If you use a match not command, then any traffic that does not match the criterion in the match
not command has the action applied.
b. Specify the action you want to perform on the matching traffic by entering the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-c)# {[drop [send-protocol-error] |
drop-connection [send-protocol-error]| mask | reset] [log] | rate-limit message_rate}
Not all options are available for each match or class command. See the CLI help or the Cisco
Security Appliance Command Reference for the exact options available.
The drop keyword drops all packets that match.
The send-protocol-error keyword sends a protocol error message.
The drop-connection keyword drops the packet and closes the connection.
The mask keyword masks out the matching portion of the packet.
The reset keyword drops the packet, closes the connection, and sends a TCP reset to the server
and/or client.
The log keyword, which you can use alone or with one of the other keywords, sends a system log
message.
The rate-limit message_rate argument limits the rate of messages.
You can specify multiple class or match commands in the policy map. For information about the order
of class and match commands, see the “Defining Actions in an Inspection Policy Map” section on
page 21-10.
Step 7 To configure parameters that affect the inspection engine, perform the following steps:
a. To enter parameters configuration mode, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# parameters
hostname(config-pmap-p)#
b. To randomize the DNS identifier for a DNS query, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# id-randomization
c. To enable logging for excessive DNS ID mismatches, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# id-mismatch [count number duration seconds] action log
Where the count string argument specifies the maximum number of mismatch instances before a
system message log is sent. The duration seconds specifies the period, in seconds, to monitor.
d. To require a TSIG resource record to be present, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# tsig enforced action {drop [log] | [log}
Where the count string argument specifies the maximum number of mismatch instances before a
system message log is sent. The duration seconds specifies the period, in seconds, to monitor.
The following example shows a how to define a DNS inspection policy map.
hostname(config)# regex domain_example “example\.com”
hostname(config)# regex domain_foo “foo\.com”
ESMTP Inspection
ESMTP inspection detects attacks, including spam, phising, malformed message attacks, buffer
overflow/underflow attacks. It also provides support for application security and protocol conformance,
which enforce the sanity of the ESMTP messages as well as detect several attacks, block
senders/receivers, and block mail relay.
Step 1 (Optional) Add one or more regular expressions for use in traffic matching commands according to the
“Creating a Regular Expression” section on page 21-6. See the types of text you can match in the match
commands described in Step 3.
Step 2 (Optional) Create one or more regular expression class maps to group regular expressions according to
the “Creating a Regular Expression Class Map” section on page 21-8.
Step 3 Create an ESMTP inspection policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# policy-map type inspect esmtp policy_map_name
hostname(config-pmap)#
Where the policy_map_name is the name of the policy map. The CLI enters policy-map configuration
mode.
Step 4 (Optional) To add a description to the policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# description string
• Specify traffic directly in the policy map using one of the match commands described in Step 3.
If you use a match not command, then any traffic that does not match the criterion in the match
not command has the action applied.
b. Specify the action you want to perform on the matching traffic by entering the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-c)# {[drop [send-protocol-error] |
drop-connection [send-protocol-error]| mask | reset] [log] | rate-limit message_rate}
Not all options are available for each match or class command. See the CLI help or the Cisco
Security Appliance Command Reference for the exact options available.
The drop keyword drops all packets that match.
The send-protocol-error keyword sends a protocol error message.
The drop-connection keyword drops the packet and closes the connection.
The mask keyword masks out the matching portion of the packet.
The reset keyword drops the packet, closes the connection, and sends a TCP reset to the server
and/or client.
The log keyword, which you can use alone or with one of the other keywords, sends a system log
message.
The rate-limit message_rate argument limits the rate of messages.
You can specify multiple class or match commands in the policy map. For information about the order
of class and match commands, see the “Defining Actions in an Inspection Policy Map” section on
page 21-10.
Step 6 To configure parameters that affect the inspection engine, perform the following steps:
a. To enter parameters configuration mode, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# parameters
hostname(config-pmap-p)#
Where the drop-connection action closes the connection. The log action sends a system log
message when this policy map matches traffic.
c. To enforce banner obfuscation, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# mask-banner
The following example shows how to define an ESMTP inspection policy map.
hostname(config)# regex user1 “[email protected]”
hostname(config)# regex user2 “[email protected]”
hostname(config)# regex user3 “[email protected]”
hostname(config)# class-map type regex senders_black_list
hostname(config-cmap)# description “Regular expressions to filter out undesired senders”
hostname(config-cmap)# match regex user1
hostname(config-cmap)# match regex user2
hostname(config-cmap)# match regex user3
FTP Inspection
This section describes the FTP inspection engine. This section includes the following topics:
• FTP Inspection Overview, page 25-26
• Using the strict Option, page 25-26
• Configuring an FTP Inspection Policy Map for Additional Inspection Control, page 25-27
• Verifying and Monitoring FTP Inspection, page 25-30
Note If you disable FTP inspection engines with the no inspect ftp command, outbound users can start
connections only in passive mode, and all inbound FTP is disabled.
Note To specify FTP commands that are not permitted to pass through the security appliance, create an FTP
map according to the “Configuring an FTP Inspection Policy Map for Additional Inspection Control”
section on page 25-27.
After you enable the strict option on an interface, FTP inspection enforces the following behavior:
• An FTP command must be acknowledged before the security appliance allows a new command.
• The security appliance drops connections that send embedded commands.
• The 227 and PORT commands are checked to ensure they do not appear in an error string.
Caution Using the strict option may cause the failure of FTP clients that are not strictly compliant with FTP
RFCs.
If the strict option is enabled, each FTP command and response sequence is tracked for the following
anomalous activity:
• Truncated command—Number of commas in the PORT and PASV reply command is checked to
see if it is five. If it is not five, then the PORT command is assumed to be truncated and the TCP
connection is closed.
• Incorrect command—Checks the FTP command to see if it ends with <CR><LF> characters, as
required by the RFC. If it does not, the connection is closed.
• Size of RETR and STOR commands—These are checked against a fixed constant. If the size is
greater, then an error message is logged and the connection is closed.
• Command spoofing—The PORT command should always be sent from the client. The TCP
connection is denied if a PORT command is sent from the server.
• Reply spoofing—PASV reply command (227) should always be sent from the server. The TCP
connection is denied if a PASV reply command is sent from the client. This prevents the security
hole when the user executes “227 xxxxx a1, a2, a3, a4, p1, p2.”
• TCP stream editing—The security appliance closes the connection if it detects TCP stream editing.
• Invalid port negotiation—The negotiated dynamic port value is checked to see if it is less than 1024.
As port numbers in the range from 1 to 1024 are reserved for well-known connections, if the
negotiated port falls in this range, then the TCP connection is freed.
• Command pipelining—The number of characters present after the port numbers in the PORT and
PASV reply command is cross checked with a constant value of 8. If it is more than 8, then the TCP
connection is closed.
• The security appliance replaces the FTP server response to the SYST command with a series of Xs.
to prevent the server from revealing its system type to FTP clients. To override this default behavior,
use the no mask-syst-reply command in the FTP map.
Step 1 (Optional) Add one or more regular expressions for use in traffic matching commands according to the
“Creating a Regular Expression” section on page 21-6. See the types of text you can match in the match
commands described in Step 3.
Step 2 (Optional) Create one or more regular expression class maps to group regular expressions according to
the “Creating a Regular Expression Class Map” section on page 21-8.
Step 3 (Optional) Create an FTP inspection class map by performing the following steps.
A class map groups multiple traffic matches. Traffic must match all of the match commands to match
the class map. You can alternatively identify match commands directly in the policy map. The
difference between creating a class map and defining the traffic match directly in the inspection policy
map is that the class map lets you create more complex match criteria, and you can reuse class maps.
To specify traffic that should not match the class map, use the match not command. For example, if the
match not command specifies the string “example.com,” then any traffic that includes “example.com”
does not match the class map.
For the traffic that you identify in this class map, you can specify actions such as drop, drop-connection,
reset, mask, set the rate limit, and/or log the connection in the inspection policy map.
If you want to perform different actions for each match command, you should identify the traffic
directly in the policy map.
a. Create the class map by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# class-map type inspect ftp [match-all] class_map_name
hostname(config-cmap)#
Where class_map_name is the name of the class map. The match-all keyword specifies that traffic
must match all criteria to match the class map. match-all is the default and only option. The CLI
enters class-map configuration mode, where you can enter one or more match commands.
b. (Optional) To add a description to the class map, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# description string
c. (Optional) To match a filename for FTP transfer, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] filename regex [regex_name |
class regex_class_name]
Where the regex_name is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class regex_class_name
is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2.
d. (Optional) To match a file type for FTP transfer,, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] filetype regex [regex_name |
class regex_class_name]
Where the regex_name is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class regex_class_name
is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2.
e. (Optional) To disallow specific FTP commands, use the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] request-command ftp_command [ftp_command...]
Where ftp_command with one or more FTP commands that you want to restrict. See Table 25-3 for
a list of the FTP commands that you can restrict.
.
Table 25-3 FTP Map request-command deny Options
Where the regex_name is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class regex_class_name
is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2.
g. (Optional) To match an FTP username, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] username regex [regex_name |
class regex_class_name]
Where the regex_name is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class regex_class_name
is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2.
Step 4 Create an FTP inspection policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# policy-map type inspect ftp policy_map_name
hostname(config-pmap)#
Where the policy_map_name is the name of the policy map. The CLI enters policy-map configuration
mode.
Step 5 (Optional) To add a description to the policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# description string
• Specify traffic directly in the policy map using one of the match commands described in Step 3.
If you use a match not command, then any traffic that does not match the criterion in the match
not command has the action applied.
b. Specify the action you want to perform on the matching traffic by entering the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-c)# {[drop [send-protocol-error] |
drop-connection [send-protocol-error]| mask | reset] [log] | rate-limit message_rate}
Not all options are available for each match or class command. See the CLI help or the Cisco
Security Appliance Command Reference for the exact options available.
The drop keyword drops all packets that match.
The send-protocol-error keyword sends a protocol error message.
The drop-connection keyword drops the packet and closes the connection.
The mask keyword masks out the matching portion of the packet.
The reset keyword drops the packet, closes the connection, and sends a TCP reset to the server
and/or client.
The log keyword, which you can use alone or with one of the other keywords, sends a system log
message.
The rate-limit message_rate argument limits the rate of messages.
You can specify multiple class or match commands in the policy map. For information about the order
of class and match commands, see the “Defining Actions in an Inspection Policy Map” section on
page 21-10.
Step 7 To configure parameters that affect the inspection engine, perform the following steps:
a. To enter parameters configuration mode, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# parameters
hostname(config-pmap-p)#
b. To mask the greeting banner from the FTP server, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# mask-banner
Before submitting a username and password, all FTP users are presented with a greeting banner. By
default, this banner includes version information useful to hackers trying to identify weaknesses in a
system. The following example shows how to mask this banner:
• Audit record 201005 is generated if the secondary dynamic channel preparation failed due to
memory shortage.
In conjunction with NAT, the FTP application inspection translates the IP address within the application
payload. This is described in detail in RFC 959.
GTP Inspection
This section describes the GTP inspection engine. This section includes the following topics:
• GTP Inspection Overview, page 25-31
• Configuring a GTP Inspection Policy Map for Additional Inspection Control, page 25-32
• Verifying and Monitoring GTP Inspection, page 25-36
Note GTP inspection requires a special license. If you enter GTP-related commands on a security appliance
without the required license, the security appliance displays an error message.
Internet
Home PLMN
MS
Gn Corporate
SGSN GGSN Gi network 2
Gp
Corporate
network 1
GRX
119935
Roaming partner
(visited PLMN)
The UMTS is the commercial convergence of fixed-line telephony, mobile, Internet and computer
technology. UTRAN is the networking protocol used for implementing wireless networks in this system.
GTP allows multi-protocol packets to be tunneled through a UMTS/GPRS backbone between a GGSN,
an SGSN and the UTRAN.
GTP does not include any inherent security or encryption of user data, but using GTP with the security
appliance helps protect your network against these risks.
The SGSN is logically connected to a GGSN using GTP. GTP allows multiprotocol packets to be
tunneled through the GPRS backbone between GSNs. GTP provides a tunnel control and management
protocol that allows the SGSN to provide GPRS network access for a mobile station by creating,
modifying, and deleting tunnels. GTP uses a tunneling mechanism to provide a service for carrying user
data packets.
Note When using GTP with failover, if a GTP connection is established and the active unit fails before data
is transmitted over the tunnel, the GTP data connection (with a “j” flag set) is not replicated to the
standby unit. This occurs because the active unit does not replicate embryonic connections to the standby
unit.
Step 1 Create a GTP inspection policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# policy-map type inspect gtp policy_map_name
hostname(config-pmap)#
Where the policy_map_name is the name of the policy map. The CLI enters policy-map configuration
mode.
Step 2 (Optional) To add a description to the policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# description string
Where the regex_name is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class regex_class_name is
the regular expression class map you created in Step 2.
Step 4 To match a message ID, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# match [not] message id [message_id | range lower_range upper_range]
Where the message_id is an alphanumeric identifier between 1 and 255. The lower_range is lower range
of message IDs. The upper_range is the upper range of message IDs.
Step 5 To match a message length, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# match [not] message length min min_length max max_length
Where the min_length and max_length are both between 1 and 65536. The length specified by this
command is the sum of the GTP header and the rest of the message, which is the payload of the UDP
packet.
Step 6 To match the version, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# match [not] version [version_id | range lower_range upper_range]
Where the version_id is between 0and 255. The lower_range is lower range of versions. The
upper_range is the upper range of versions.
Step 7 To configure parameters that affect the inspection engine, perform the following steps:
a. To enter parameters configuration mode, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# parameters
hostname(config-pmap-p)#
The mnc network_code argument is a two or three-digit value identifying the network code.
By default, the security appliance does not check for valid MCC/MNC combinations. This command
is used for IMSI Prefix filtering. The MCC and MNC in the IMSI of the received packet is compared
with the MCC/MNC configured with this command and is dropped if it does not match.
This command must be used to enable IMSI Prefix filtering. You can configure multiple instances
to specify permitted MCC and MNC combinations. By default, the security appliance does not check
the validity of MNC and MCC combinations, so you must verify the validity of the combinations
configured. To find more information about MCC and MNC codes, see the ITU E.212
recommendation, Identification Plan for Land Mobile Stations.
b. To allow invalid GTP packets or packets that otherwise would fail parsing and be dropped, enter the
following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# permit errors
By default, all invalid packets or packets that failed, during parsing, are dropped.
c. To enable support for GSN pooling, use the permit response command.
If the security appliance performs GTP inspection, by default the security appliance drops GTP
responses from GSNs that were not specified in the GTP request. This situation occurs when you
use load-balancing among a pool of GSNs to provide efficiency and scalability of GPRS.
You can enable support for GSN pooling by using the permit response command. This command
configures the security appliance to allow responses from any of a designated set of GSNs,
regardless of the GSN to which a GTP request was sent. You identify the pool of load-balancing
GSNs as a network object. Likewise, you identify the SGSN as a network object. If the GSN
responding belongs to the same object group as the GSN that the GTP request was sent to and if the
SGSN is in a object group that the responding GSN is permitted to send a GTP response to, the
security appliance permits the response.
d. To create an object to represent the pool of load-balancing GSNs, perform the following steps:
Use the object-group command to define a new network object group representing the pool of
load-balancing GSNs.
hostname(config)# object-group network GSN-pool-name
hostname(config-network)#
For example, the following command creates an object group named gsnpool32:
hostname(config)# object-group network gsnpool32
hostname(config-network)#
e. Use the network-object command to specify the load-balancing GSNs. You can do so with one
network-object command per GSN, using the host keyword. You can also using network-object
command to identify whole networks containing GSNs that perform load balancing.
hostname(config-network)# network-object host IP-address
For example, the following commands create three network objects representing individual hosts:
hostname(config-network)# network-object host 192.168.100.1
hostname(config-network)# network-object host 192.168.100.2
hostname(config-network)# network-object host 192.168.100.3
hostname(config-network)#
f. To create an object to represent the SGSN that the load-balancing GSNs are permitted to respond
to, perform the following steps:
a. Use the object-group command to define a new network object group that will represent the
SGSN that sends GTP requests to the GSN pool.
hostname(config)# object-group network SGSN-name
hostname(config-network)#
For example, the following command creates an object group named sgsn32:
hostname(config)# object-group network sgsn32
hostname(config-network)#
b. Use the network-object command with the host keyword to identify the SGSN.
hostname(config-network)# network-object host IP-address
For example, the following command creates a network objects representing the SGSN:
hostname(config-network)# network-object host 192.168.50.100
hostname(config-network)#
g. To allow GTP responses from any GSN in the network object representing the GSN pool, defined
in c., d, to the network object representing the SGSN, defined in c., f., enter the following
commands:
hostname(config)# gtp-map map_name
hostname(config-gtp-map)# permit response to-object-group SGSN-name from-object-group
GSN-pool-name
For example, the following command permits GTP responses from any host in the object group
named gsnpool32 to the host in the object group named sgsn32:
hostname(config-gtp-map)# permit response to-object-group sgsn32 from-object-group
gsnpool32
The following example shows how to support GSN pooling by defining network objects for the GSN
pool and the SGSN. An entire Class C network is defined as the GSN pool but you can identify
multiple individual IP addresses, one per network-object command, instead of identifying whole
networks. The example then modifies a GTP map to permit responses from the GSN pool to the
SGSN.
hostname(config)# object-group network gsnpool32
hostname(config-network)# network-object 192.168.100.0 255.255.255.0
hostname(config)# object-group network sgsn32
h. To specify the maximum number of GTP requests that will be queued waiting for a response, enter
the following command:
hostname(config-gtp-map)# request-queue max_requests
where the max_requests argument sets the maximum number of GTP requests that will be queued
waiting for a response, from 1 to 4294967295. The default is 200.
When the limit has been reached and a new request arrives, the request that has been in the queue
for the longest time is removed. The Error Indication, the Version Not Supported and the SGSN
Context Acknowledge messages are not considered as requests and do not enter the request queue
to wait for a response.
i. To change the inactivity timers for a GTP session, enter the following command:
hostname(config-gtp-map)# timeout {gsn | pdp-context | request | signaling | tunnel}
hh:mm:ss
where the max_tunnels argument is the maximum number of tunnels allowed, from 1 to
4294967295. The default is 500.
New requests will be dropped once the number of tunnels specified by this command is reached.
The following example shows how to limit the number of tunnels in the network:
hostname(config)# policy-map type inspect gtp gmap
hostname(config-pmap)# parameters
hostname(config-pmap-p)# tunnel-limit 3000
You can use the vertical bar (|) to filter the display. Type ?| for more display filtering options.
Use the show service-policy inspect gtp pdp-context command to display PDP context-related
information. The following is sample output from the show service-policy inspect gtp pdp-context
command:
hostname# show service-policy inspect gtp pdp-context detail
1 in use, 1 most used, timeout 0:00:00
The PDP context is identified by the tunnel ID, which is a combination of the values for IMSI and
NSAPI. A GTP tunnel is defined by two associated PDP contexts in different GSN nodes and is
identified with a Tunnel ID. A GTP tunnel is necessary to forward packets between an external packet
data network and a MS user.
You can use the vertical bar (|) to filter the display, as in the following example:
hostname# show service-policy gtp statistics | grep gsn
H.323 Inspection
This section describes the H.323 application inspection. This section includes the following topics:
• H.323 Inspection Overview, page 25-37
• How H.323 Works, page 25-37
• Limitations and Restrictions, page 25-38
• Configuring H.323 and H.225 Timeout Values, page 25-41
• Verifying and Monitoring H.323 Inspection, page 25-41
Note The security appliance does not support TCP options in the Proxy ACK for the TPKT.
Each UDP connection with a packet going through H.323 inspection is marked as an H.323 connection
and times out with the H.323 timeout as configured with the timeout command.
Step 1 (Optional) Add one or more regular expressions for use in traffic matching commands according to the
“Creating a Regular Expression” section on page 21-6. See the types of text you can match in the match
commands described in Step 3.
Step 2 (Optional) Create one or more regular expression class maps to group regular expressions according to
the “Creating a Regular Expression Class Map” section on page 21-8.s
Step 3 (Optional) Create an H.323 inspection class map by performing the following steps.
A class map groups multiple traffic matches. Traffic must match all of the match commands to match
the class map. You can alternatively identify match commands directly in the policy map. The
difference between creating a class map and defining the traffic match directly in the inspection policy
map is that the class map lets you create more complex match criteria, and you can reuse class maps.
To specify traffic that should not match the class map, use the match not command. For example, if the
match not command specifies the string “example.com,” then any traffic that includes “example.com”
does not match the class map.
For the traffic that you identify in this class map, you can specify actions such as drop-connection, reset,
and/or log the connection in the inspection policy map.
If you want to perform different actions for each match command, you should identify the traffic
directly in the policy map.
a. Create the class map by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# class-map type inspect h323 [match-all] class_map_name
hostname(config-cmap)#
Where the class_map_name is the name of the class map.The match-all keyword specifies that
traffic must match all criteria to match the class map. match-all is the default and only option. The
CLI enters class-map configuration mode, where you can enter one or more match commands.
b. (Optional) To add a description to the class map, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# description string
Where string is the description of the class map (up to 200 characters).
c. (Optional) To match a called party, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] called-party regex {class class_name | regex_name}
Where the regex regex_name argument is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class
regex_class_name is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2.
d. (Optional) To match a media type, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] media-type {audio | data | video}
Step 4 Create an H.323 inspection policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# policy-map type inspect h323 policy_map_name
hostname(config-pmap)#
Where the policy_map_name is the name of the policy map. The CLI enters policy-map configuration
mode.
Step 5 (Optional) To add a description to the policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# description string
• Specify traffic directly in the policy map using one of the match commands described in Step 3.
If you use a match not command, then any traffic that does not match the criterion in the match
not command has the action applied.
b. Specify the action you want to perform on the matching traffic by entering the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-c)# {[drop [send-protocol-error] |
drop-connection [send-protocol-error]| mask | reset] [log] | rate-limit message_rate}
Not all options are available for each match or class command. See the CLI help or the Cisco
Security Appliance Command Reference for the exact options available.
The drop keyword drops all packets that match.
The send-protocol-error keyword sends a protocol error message.
The drop-connection keyword drops the packet and closes the connection.
The mask keyword masks out the matching portion of the packet.
The reset keyword drops the packet, closes the connection, and sends a TCP reset to the server
and/or client.
The log keyword, which you can use alone or with one of the other keywords, sends a system log
message.
The rate-limit message_rate argument limits the rate of messages.
You can specify multiple class or match commands in the policy map. For information about the order
of class and match commands, see the “Defining Actions in an Inspection Policy Map” section on
page 21-10.
Step 7 To configure parameters that affect the inspection engine, perform the following steps:
a. To enter parameters configuration mode, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# parameters
hostname(config-pmap-p)#
b. To define the H.323 call duration limit, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# call-duration-limit time
Where time is the call duration limit in seconds. Range is from 0:0:0 ti 1163:0;0. A value of 0 means
never timeout.
c. To enforce call party number used ini call setup, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# call-party-number
e. To define an hsi group and enter hsi group configuration mode, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# hsi-group id
To add an hsi to the hsi group, enter the following command in hsi group configuration mode:
hostname(config-h225-map-hsi-grp)# hsi ip_address
Where ip_address is the host to add. A maximum of five hosts per hsi group are allowed.
To add an endpoint to the hsi group, enter the following command in hsi group configuration
mode:
hostname(config-h225-map-hsi-grp)# endpoint ip_address if_name
Where ip_address is the endpoint to add and if_name is the interface through which the endpoint
is connected to the security appliance. A maximum of ten endpoints per hsi group are allowed.
f. To check RTP packets flowing on the pinholes for protocol conformance, enter the following
command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# rtp-conformance [enforce-payloadtype]
Where the enforce-payloadtype keyword enforces the payload type to be audio or video based on
the signaling exchange.
g. To enable state checking validation, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# state-checking {h225 | ras}
This output indicates that there is currently 1 active H.323 call going through the security appliance
between the local endpoint 10.130.56.3 and foreign host 172.30.254.203, and for these particular
endpoints, there is 1 concurrent call between them, with a CRV for that call of 9861.
For the local endpoint 10.130.56.4 and foreign host 172.30.254.205, there are 0 concurrent calls. This
means that there is no active call between the endpoints even though the H.225 session still exists. This
could happen if, at the time of the show h225 command, the call has already ended but the H.225 session
has not yet been deleted. Alternately, it could mean that the two endpoints still have a TCP connection
opened between them because they set “maintainConnection” to TRUE, so the session is kept open until
they set it to FALSE again, or until the session times out based on the H.225 timeout value in your
configuration.
There is currently one H.245 control session active across the security appliance. The local endpoint is
10.130.56.3, and we are expecting the next packet from this endpoint to have a TPKT header because
the TPKT value is 0. The TKTP header is a 4-byte header preceding each H.225/H.245 message. It gives
the length of the message, including the 4-byte header. The foreign host endpoint is 172.30.254.203, and
we are expecting the next packet from this endpoint to have a TPKT header because the TPKT value is 0.
The media negotiated between these endpoints have an LCN of 258 with the foreign RTP IP address/port
pair of 172.30.254.203/49608 and an RTCP IP address/port of 172.30.254.203/49609 with a local RTP
IP address/port pair of 10.130.56.3/49608 and an RTCP port of 49609.
The second LCN of 259 has a foreign RTP IP address/port pair of 172.30.254.203/49606 and an RTCP
IP address/port pair of 172.30.254.203/49607 with a local RTP IP address/port pair of
10.130.56.3/49606 and RTCP port of 49607.
This output shows that there is one active registration between the gatekeeper 172.30.254.214 and its
client 10.130.56.14.
HTTP Inspection
This section describes the HTTP inspection engine. This section includes the following topics:
• HTTP Inspection Overview, page 25-43
• Configuring an HTTP Inspection Policy Map for Additional Inspection Control, page 25-44
Note The no inspect http command also disables the filter url command.
The enhanced HTTP inspection feature, which is also known as an application firewall and is available
when you configure an HTTP map (see “Configuring an HTTP Inspection Policy Map for Additional
Inspection Control”), can help prevent attackers from using HTTP messages for circumventing network
security policy. It verifies the following for all HTTP messages:
• Conformance to RFC 2616
• Use of RFC-defined methods only.
• Compliance with the additional criteria.
Note When you enable HTTP inspection with an inspection policy map, strict HTTP inspection with the action
reset and log is enabled by default. You can change the actions performed in response to inspection
failure, but you cannot disable strict inspection as long as the inspection policy map remains enabled.
Step 1 (Optional) Add one or more regular expressions for use in traffic matching commands according to the
“Creating a Regular Expression” section on page 21-6. See the types of text you can match in the match
commands described in Step 3.
Step 2 (Optional) Create one or more regular expression class maps to group regular expressions according to
the “Creating a Regular Expression Class Map” section on page 21-8.
Step 3 (Optional) Create an HTTP inspection class map by performing the following steps.
A class map groups multiple traffic matches. Traffic must match all of the match commands to match
the class map. You can alternatively identify match commands directly in the policy map. The difference
between creating a class map and defining the traffic match directly in the inspection policy map is that
the class map lets you create more complex match criteria, and you can reuse class maps.
To specify traffic that should not match the class map, use the match not command. For example, if the
match not command specifies the string “example.com,” then any traffic that includes “example.com”
does not match the class map.
For the traffic that you identify in this class map, you can specify actions such as drop, drop-connection,
reset, mask, set the rate limit, and/or log the connection in the inspection policy map.
If you want to perform different actions for each match command, you should identify the traffic directly
in the policy map.
a. Create the class map by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# class-map type inspect http [match-all] class_map_name
hostname(config-cmap)#
Where class_map_name is the name of the class map. The match-all keyword specifies that traffic
must match all criteria to match the class map. match-all is the default and only option. The CLI
enters class-map configuration mode, where you can enter one or more match commands.
b. (Optional) To add a description to the class map, enter the following command:
c. (Optional) To match traffic with a content-type field in the HTTP response that does not match the
accept field in the corresponding HTTP request message, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] req-resp content-type mismatch
d. (Optional) To match text found in the HTTP request message arguments, enter the following
command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] request args regex [regex_name | class
regex_class_name]
Where the regex_name is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class regex_class_name
is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2.
e. (Optional) To match text found in the HTTP request message body or to match traffic that exceeds
the maximum HTTP request message body length, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] request body {regex [regex_name | class
regex_class_name] | length gt max_bytes}
Where the regex regex_name argument is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class
regex_class_name is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2. The length gt
max_bytes is the maximum message body length in bytes.
f. (Optional) To match text found in the HTTP request message header, or to restrict the count or
length of the header, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] request header {[field]
[regex [regex_name | class regex_class_name]] |
[length gt max_length_bytes | count gt max_count_bytes]}
Where the field is the predefined message header keyword. The regex regex_name argument is the
regular expression you created in Step 1. The class regex_class_name is the regular expression class
map you created in Step 2. The length gt max_bytes is the maximum message body length in bytes.
The count gt max_count is the maximum number of header fields.
g. (Optional) To match text found in the HTTP request message method, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] request method {[method] |
[regex [regex_name | class regex_class_name]]
Where the method is the predefined message method keyword. The regex regex_name argument is
the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class regex_class_name is the regular expression
class map you created in Step 2.
h. (Optional) To match text found in the HTTP request message URI, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] request uri {regex [regex_name | class
regex_class_name] | length gt max_bytes}
Where the regex regex_name argument is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class
regex_class_name is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2. The length gt
max_bytes is the maximum message body length in bytes.
i. Optional) To match text found in the HTTP response message body, or to comment out Java applet
and Active X object tags in order to filter them, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] response body {[active-x] | [java-applet] |
[regex [regex_name | class regex_class_name]] | length gt max_bytes}
Where the regex regex_name argument is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class
regex_class_name is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2. The length gt
max_bytes is the maximum message body length in bytes.
j. (Optional) To match text found in the HTTP response message header, or to restrict the count or
length of the header, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] response header {[field]
[regex [regex_name | class regex_class_name]] |
[length gt max_length_bytes | count gt max_count]}
Where the field is the predefined message header keyword. The regex regex_name argument is the
regular expression you created in Step 1. The class regex_class_name is the regular expression class
map you created in Step 2. The length gt max_bytes is the maximum message body length in bytes.
The count gt max_count is the maximum number of header fields.
k. (Optional) To match text found in the HTTP response message status line, enter the following
command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] response status-line {regex [regex_name | class
regex_class_name]}
Where the regex regex_name argument is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class
regex_class_name is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2.
Step 4 Create an HTTP inspection policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# policy-map type inspect http policy_map_name
hostname(config-pmap)#
Where the policy_map_name is the name of the policy map. The CLI enters policy-map configuration
mode.
Step 5 (Optional) To add a description to the policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# description string
• Specify traffic directly in the policy map using one of the match commands described in Step 3.
If you use a match not command, then any traffic that does not match the criterion in the match
not command has the action applied.
b. Specify the action you want to perform on the matching traffic by entering the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-c)# {[drop [send-protocol-error] |
drop-connection [send-protocol-error]| mask | reset] [log] | rate-limit message_rate}
Not all options are available for each match or class command. See the CLI help or the Cisco
Security Appliance Command Reference for the exact options available.
The drop keyword drops all packets that match.
The send-protocol-error keyword sends a protocol error message.
The drop-connection keyword drops the packet and closes the connection.
The mask keyword masks out the matching portion of the packet.
The reset keyword drops the packet, closes the connection, and sends a TCP reset to the server
and/or client.
The log keyword, which you can use alone or with one of the other keywords, sends a system log
message.
The rate-limit message_rate argument limits the rate of messages.
You can specify multiple class or match commands in the policy map. For information about the order
of class and match commands, see the “Defining Actions in an Inspection Policy Map” section on
page 21-10.
Step 7 To configure parameters that affect the inspection engine, perform the following steps:
a. To enter parameters configuration mode, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# parameters
hostname(config-pmap-p)#
Where the drop-connection action closes the connection. The reset action closes the connection
and sends a TCP reset to the client. The log action sends a system log message when this policy map
matches traffic.
c. To substitute a string for the server header field, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# spoof-server string
Where the string argument is the string to substitute for the server header field. Note: WebVPN
streams are not subject to the spoof-server comand.
The following example shows how to define an HTTP inspection policy map that will allow and log any
HTTP connection that attempts to access “www\.xyz.com/.*\.asp" or "www\.xyz[0-9][0-9]\.com" with
methods "GET" or "PUT." All other URL/Method combinations will be silently allowed.
hostname(config)# class-map type regex match-any url_to_log
hostname(config-cmap)# match regex “www\.xyz.com/.*\.asp"
hostname(config-cmap)# match regex “www\.xyz[0-9][0-9]\.com”
hostname(config-cmap)# exit
IM Inspection Overview
The IM inspect engine lets you apply fine grained controls on the IM application to control the network
usage and stop leakage of confidential data, propagation of worms, and other threats to the corporate
network.
Step 1 (Optional) Add one or more regular expressions for use in traffic matching commands according to the
“Creating a Regular Expression” section on page 21-6. See the types of text you can match in the match
commands described in Step 3.
Step 2 (Optional) Create one or more regular expression class maps to group regular expressions according to
the “Creating a Regular Expression Class Map” section on page 21-8.s
Step 3 (Optional) Create an IM inspection class map by performing the following steps.
A class map groups multiple traffic matches. Traffic must match all of the match commands to match
the class map. You can alternatively identify match commands directly in the policy map. The difference
between creating a class map and defining the traffic match directly in the inspection policy map is that
the class map lets you create more complex match criteria, and you can reuse class maps.
To specify traffic that should not match the class map, use the match not command. For example, if the
match not command specifies the string “example.com,” then any traffic that includes “example.com”
does not match the class map.
For the traffic that you identify in this class map, you can specify actions such as drop-connection, reset,
and/or log the connection in the inspection policy map.
If you want to perform different actions for each match command, you should identify the traffic directly
in the policy map.
a. Create the class map by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# class-map type inspect im [match-all] class_map_name
hostname(config-cmap)#
Where the class_map_name is the name of the class map.The match-all keyword specifies that
traffic must match all criteria to match the class map. match-all is the default and only option. The
CLI enters class-map configuration mode, where you can enter one or more match commands.
b. (Optional) To add a description to the class map, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# description string
Where the string is the description of the class map (up to 200 characters).
c. (Optional) To match traffic of a specific IM protocol, such as Yahoo or MSN, enter the following
command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] protocol {im-yahoo | im-msn}
e. (Optional) To match the source login name of the IM message, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] login-name regex {class class_name | regex_name}
Where the regex regex_name argument is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class
regex_class_name is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2.
f. (Optional) To match the destination login name of the IM message, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] peer-login-name regex {class class_name |
regex_name}
Where the regex regex_name argument is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class
regex_class_name is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2.
g. (Optional) To match the source IP address of the IM message, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] ip-address ip_address ip_address_mask
Where the ip_address and the ip_address_mask is the IP address and netmask of the message source.
h. (Optional) To match the destination IP address of the IM message, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] peer-ip-address ip_address ip_address_mask
Where the ip_address and the ip_address_mask is the IP address and netmask of the message
destination.
i. (Optional) To match the version of the IM message, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] version regex {class class_name | regex_name}
Where the regex regex_name argument is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class
regex_class_name is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2.
j. (Optional) To match the filename of the IM message, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] filename regex {class class_name | regex_name}
Where the regex regex_name argument is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class
regex_class_name is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2.
Where the policy_map_name is the name of the policy map. The CLI enters policy-map configuration
mode.
Step 5 (Optional) To add a description to the policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# description string
Step 6 Specify the traffic on which you want to perform actions using one of the following methods:
• Specify the IM class map that you created in Step 3 by entering the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# class class_map_name
hostname(config-pmap-c)#
• Specify traffic directly in the policy map using one of the match commands described in Step 3. If
you use a match not command, then any traffic that does not match the criterion in the match not
command has the action applied.
You can specify multiple class or match commands in the policy map. For information about the order
of class and match commands, see the “Defining Actions in an Inspection Policy Map” section on
page 21-10.
Step 7 Specify the action you want to perform on the matching traffic by entering the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-c)# {drop-connection | reset | log}
Where the drop-connection action closes the connection. The reset action closes the connection and
sends a TCP reset to the client. The log action sends a system log message when this policy map matches
traffic.
ICMP Inspection
The ICMP inspection engine allows ICMP traffic to have a “session” so it can be inspected like TCP and
UDP traffic. Without the ICMP inspection engine, we recommend that you do not allow ICMP through
the security appliance in an access list. Without stateful inspection, ICMP can be used to attack your
network. The ICMP inspection engine ensures that there is only one response for each request, and that
the sequence number is correct.
ILS Inspection
The ILS inspection engine provides NAT support for Microsoft NetMeeting, SiteServer, and Active
Directory products that use LDAP to exchange directory information with an ILS server.
The security appliance supports NAT for ILS, which is used to register and locate endpoints in the ILS
or SiteServer Directory. PAT cannot be supported because only IP addresses are stored by an LDAP
database.
For search responses, when the LDAP server is located outside, NAT should be considered to allow
internal peers to communicate locally while registered to external LDAP servers. For such search
responses, xlates are searched first, and then DNAT entries to obtain the correct address. If both of these
searches fail, then the address is not changed. For sites using NAT 0 (no NAT) and not expecting DNAT
interaction, we recommend that the inspection engine be turned off to provide better performance.
Additional configuration may be necessary when the ILS server is located inside the security appliance
border. This would require a hole for outside clients to access the LDAP server on the specified port,
typically TCP 389.
Because ILS traffic only occurs on the secondary UDP channel, the TCP connection is disconnected after
the TCP inactivity interval. By default, this interval is 60 minutes and can be adjusted using the timeout
command.
ILS/LDAP follows a client/server model with sessions handled over a single TCP connection.
Depending on the client's actions, several of these sessions may be created.
During connection negotiation time, a BIND PDU is sent from the client to the server. Once a successful
BIND RESPONSE from the server is received, other operational messages may be exchanged (such as
ADD, DEL, SEARCH, or MODIFY) to perform operations on the ILS Directory. The ADD REQUEST
and SEARCH RESPONSE PDUs may contain IP addresses of NetMeeting peers, used by H.323 (SETUP
and CONNECT messages) to establish the NetMeeting sessions. Microsoft NetMeeting v2.X and v3.X
provides ILS support.
The ILS inspection performs the following operations:
• Decodes the LDAP REQUEST/RESPONSE PDUs using the BER decode functions
• Parses the LDAP packet
• Extracts IP addresses
• Translates IP addresses as necessary
• Encodes the PDU with translated addresses using BER encode functions
• Copies the newly encoded PDU back to the TCP packet
• Performs incremental TCP checksum and sequence number adjustment
ILS inspection has the following limitations:
• Referral requests and responses are not supported
• Users in multiple directories are not unified
• Single users having multiple identities in multiple directories cannot be recognized by NAT
Note Because H225 call signalling traffic only occurs on the secondary UDP channel, the TCP connection is
disconnected after the interval specified by the TCP timeout command. By default, this interval is set at
60 minutes.
MGCP Inspection
This section describes MGCP application inspection. This section includes the following topics:
• MGCP Inspection Overview, page 25-53
• Configuring an MGCP Inspection Policy Map for Additional Inspection Control, page 25-55
• Configuring MGCP Timeout Values, page 25-56
• Verifying and Monitoring MGCP Inspection, page 25-56
To PSTN
Cisco M Cisco
PGW 2200 H.323 M
M CallManager
209.165.201.10
209.165.201.11
209.165.201.1
Gateway is told 209.165.200.231
to send its media
to 209.165.200.231 MGCP SCCP
(public address RTP to 10.0.0.76
of the IP Phone) from 209.165.200.231
209.165.200.231
GW GW
RTP to 209.165.201.1
from 209.165.200.231
119936
IP IP IP
10.0.0.76
Branch offices
MGCP endpoints are physical or virtual sources and destinations for data. Media gateways contain
endpoints on which the call agent can create, modify and delete connections to establish and control
media sessions with other multimedia endpoints. Also, the call agent can instruct the endpoints to detect
certain events and generate signals. The endpoints automatically communicate changes in service state
to the call agent.
MGCP transactions are composed of a command and a mandatory response. There are eight types of
commands:
• CreateConnection
• ModifyConnection
• DeleteConnection
• NotificationRequest
• Notify
• AuditEndpoint
• AuditConnection
• RestartInProgress
The first four commands are sent by the call agent to the gateway. The Notify command is sent by the
gateway to the call agent. The gateway may also send a DeleteConnection. The registration of the MGCP
gateway with the call agent is achieved by the RestartInProgress command. The AuditEndpoint and the
AuditConnection commands are sent by the call agent to the gateway.
All commands are composed of a Command header, optionally followed by a session description. All
responses are composed of a Response header, optionally followed by a session description.
• The port on which the gateway receives commands from the call agent. Gateways usually listen to
UDP port 2427.
• The port on which the call agent receives commands from the gateway. Call agents usually listen to
UDP port 2727.
Note MGCP inspection does not support the use of different IP addresses for MGCP signaling and RTP data.
A common and recommended practice is to send RTP data from a resilient IP address, such as a loopback
or virtual IP address; however, the security appliance requires the RTP data to come from the same
address as MGCP signalling.
Step 1 To create an MGCP inspection policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# policy-map type inspect mgcp map_name
hostname(config-pmap)#
Where the policy_map_name is the name of the policy map. The CLI enters policy-map configuration
mode.
Step 2 (Optional) To add a description to the policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# description string
Step 3 To configure parameters that affect the inspection engine, perform the following steps:
a. To enter parameters configuration mode, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# parameters
hostname(config-pmap-p)#
b. To configure the call agents, enter the following command for each call agent:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# call-agent ip_address group_id
Use the call-agent command to specify a group of call agents that can manage one or more gateways.
The call agent group information is used to open connections for the call agents in the group (other
than the one a gateway sends a command to) so that any of the call agents can send the response.
call agents with the same group_id belong to the same group. A call agent may belong to more than
one group. The group_id option is a number from 0 to 4294967295. The ip_address option specifies
the IP address of the call agent.
Note MGCP call agents send AUEP messages to determine if MGCP end points are present. This
establishes a flow through the security appliance and allows MGCP end points to register with
the call agent.
c. To configure the gateways, enter the following command for each gateway:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# gateway ip_address group_id
Use the gateway command to specify which group of call agents are managing a particular gateway.
The IP address of the gateway is specified with the ip_address option. The group_id option is a
number from 0 to 4294967295 that must correspond with the group_id of the call agents that are
managing the gateway. A gateway may only belong to one group.
d. If you want to change the maximum number of commands allowed in the MGCP command queue,
enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# command-queue command_limit
The following is sample output from the show mgcp detail command.
hostname# show mgcp commands detail
1 in use, 1 most used, 200 maximum allowed
CRCX, idle: 0:00:10
Gateway IP host-pc-2
Transaction ID 2052
Endpoint name aaln/1
Call ID 9876543210abcdef
Connection ID
Media IP 192.168.5.7
Media port 6058
The following is sample output from the show mgcp sessions command.
hostname# show mgcp sessions
1 in use, 1 most used
Gateway IP host-pc-2, connection ID 6789af54c9, active 0:00:11
The following is sample output from the show mgcp sessions detail command.
hostname# show mgcp sessions detail
1 in use, 1 most used
Session active 0:00:14
Gateway IP host-pc-2
Call ID 9876543210abcdef
Connection ID 6789af54c9
Endpoint name aaln/1
Media lcl port 6166
Media rmt IP 192.168.5.7
Media rmt port 6058
NetBIOS Inspection
NetBIOS inspection is enabled by default. The NetBios inspection engine translates IP addresses in the
NetBios name service (NBNS) packets according to the security appliance NAT configuration.
Step 1 (Optional) Add one or more regular expressions for use in traffic matching commands according to the
“Creating a Regular Expression” section on page 21-6. See the types of text you can match in the match
commands described in Step 3.
Step 2 (Optional) Create one or more regular expression class maps to group regular expressions according to
the “Creating a Regular Expression Class Map” section on page 21-8.
Step 3 Create a NetBIOS inspection policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# policy-map type inspect netbios policy_map_name
hostname(config-pmap)#
Where the policy_map_name is the name of the policy map. The CLI enters policy-map configuration
mode.
Step 4 (Optional) To add a description to the policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# description string
• Specify traffic directly in the policy map using one of the match commands described in Step 3.
If you use a match not command, then any traffic that does not match the criterion in the match
not command has the action applied.
b. Specify the action you want to perform on the matching traffic by entering the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-c)# {[drop [send-protocol-error] |
drop-connection [send-protocol-error]| mask | reset] [log] | rate-limit message_rate}
Not all options are available for each match or class command. See the CLI help or the Cisco
Security Appliance Command Reference for the exact options available.
The drop keyword drops all packets that match.
The send-protocol-error keyword sends a protocol error message.
The drop-connection keyword drops the packet and closes the connection.
The mask keyword masks out the matching portion of the packet.
The reset keyword drops the packet, closes the connection, and sends a TCP reset to the server
and/or client.
The log keyword, which you can use alone or with one of the other keywords, sends a system log
message.
The rate-limit message_rate argument limits the rate of messages.
You can specify multiple class or match commands in the policy map. For information about the order
of class and match commands, see the “Defining Actions in an Inspection Policy Map” section on
page 21-10.
Step 6 To configure parameters that affect the inspection engine, perform the following steps:
a. To enter parameters configuration mode, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# parameters
hostname(config-pmap-p)#
Where the drop-connection action closes the connection. The reset action closes the connection
and sends a TCP reset to the client. The log action sends a system log message when this policy map
matches traffic.
The following example shows how to define a NETBIOS inspection policy map.
hostname(config)# policy-map type inspect netbios netbios_map
hostname(config-pmap)# protocol-violation drop log
PPTP Inspection
PPTP is a protocol for tunneling PPP traffic. A PPTP session is composed of one TCP channel and
usually two PPTP GRE tunnels. The TCP channel is the control channel used for negotiating and
managing the PPTP GRE tunnels. The GRE tunnels carries PPP sessions between the two hosts.
When enabled, PPTP application inspection inspects PPTP protocol packets and dynamically creates the
GRE connections and xlates necessary to permit PPTP traffic. Only Version 1, as defined in RFC 2637,
is supported.
PAT is only performed for the modified version of GRE [RFC 2637] when negotiated over the PPTP TCP
control channel. Port Address Translation is not performed for the unmodified version of GRE [RFC
1701, RFC 1702].
Specifically, the security appliance inspects the PPTP version announcements and the outgoing call
request/response sequence. Only PPTP Version 1, as defined in RFC 2637, is inspected. Further
inspection on the TCP control channel is disabled if the version announced by either side is not Version
1. In addition, the outgoing-call request and reply sequence are tracked. Connections and xlates are
dynamic allocated as necessary to permit subsequent secondary GRE data traffic.
The PPTP inspection engine must be enabled for PPTP traffic to be translated by PAT. Additionally, PAT
is only performed for a modified version of GRE (RFC2637) and only if it is negotiated over the PPTP
TCP control channel. PAT is not performed for the unmodified version of GRE (RFC 1701 and
RFC 1702).
As described in RFC 2637, the PPTP protocol is mainly used for the tunneling of PPP sessions initiated
from a modem bank PAC (PPTP Access Concentrator) to the headend PNS (PPTP Network Server).
When used this way, the PAC is the remote client and the PNS is the server.
However, when used for VPN by Windows, the interaction is inverted. The PNS is a remote single-user
PC that initiates connection to the head-end PAC to gain access to a central network.
RSH Inspection
RSH inspection is enabled by default. The RSH protocol uses a TCP connection from the RSH client to
the RSH server on TCP port 514. The client and server negotiate the TCP port number where the client
listens for the STDERR output stream. RSH inspection supports NAT of the negotiated port number if
necessary.
RTSP Inspection
This section describes RTSP application inspection. This section includes the following topics:
• RTSP Inspection Overview, page 25-60
• Using RealPlayer, page 25-61
• Restrictions and Limitations, page 25-61
Note For Cisco IP/TV, use RTSP TCP port 554 and TCP 8554.
RTSP applications use the well-known port 554 with TCP (rarely UDP) as a control channel. The
security appliance only supports TCP, in conformity with RFC 2326. This TCP control channel is used
to negotiate the data channels that is used to transmit audio/video traffic, depending on the transport
mode that is configured on the client.
The supported RDT transports are: rtp/avp, rtp/avp/udp, x-real-rdt, x-real-rdt/udp, and x-pn-tng/udp.
The security appliance parses Setup response messages with a status code of 200. If the response
message is travelling inbound, the server is outside relative to the security appliance and dynamic
channels need to be opened for connections coming inbound from the server. If the response message is
outbound, then the security appliance does not need to open dynamic channels.
Because RFC 2326 does not require that the client and server ports must be in the SETUP response
message, the security appliance keeps state and remembers the client ports in the SETUP message.
QuickTime places the client ports in the SETUP message and then the server responds with only the
server ports.
RTSP inspection does not support PAT or dual-NAT. Also, the security appliance cannot recognize HTTP
cloaking where RTSP messages are hidden in the HTTP messages.
Using RealPlayer
When using RealPlayer, it is important to properly configure transport mode. For the security appliance,
add an access-list command from the server to the client or vice versa. For RealPlayer, change transport
mode by clicking Options>Preferences>Transport>RTSP Settings.
If using TCP mode on the RealPlayer, select the Use TCP to Connect to Server and Attempt to use
TCP for all content check boxes. On the security appliance, there is no need to configure the inspection
engine.
If using UDP mode on the RealPlayer, select the Use TCP to Connect to Server and Attempt to use
UDP for static content check boxes, and for live content not available via Multicast. On the security
appliance, add an inspect rtsp port command.
• You can configure NAT for Apple QuickTime 4 or RealPlayer. Cisco IP/TV only works with NAT
if the Viewer and Content Manager are on the outside network and the server is on the inside
network.
SIP Inspection
This section describes SIP application inspection. This section includes the following topics:
• SIP Inspection Overview, page 25-62
• SIP Instant Messaging, page 25-62
• Configuring SIP Timeout Values, page 25-67
• Verifying and Monitoring SIP Inspection, page 25-67
Note Only the Chat feature is currently supported. Whiteboard, File Transfer, and Application Sharing are not
supported. RTC Client 5.0 is not supported.
SIP inspection translates the SIP text-based messages, recalculates the content length for the SDP
portion of the message, and recalculates the packet length and checksum. It dynamically opens media
connections for ports specified in the SDP portion of the SIP message as address/ports on which the
endpoint should listen.
SIP inspection has a database with indices CALL_ID/FROM/TO from the SIP payload. These indices
identify the call, the source, and the destination. This database contains the media addresses and media
ports found in the SDP media information fields and the media type. There can be multiple media
addresses and ports for a session. The security appliance opens RTP/RTCP connections between the two
endpoints using these media addresses/ports.
The well-known port 5060 must be used on the initial call setup (INVITE) message; however, subsequent
messages may not have this port number. The SIP inspection engine opens signaling connection
pinholes, and marks these connections as SIP connections. This is done for the messages to reach the
SIP application and be translated.
As a call is set up, the SIP session is in the “transient” state until the media address and media port is
received from the called endpoint in a Response message indicating the RTP port the called endpoint
listens on. If there is a failure to receive the response messages within one minute, the signaling
connection is torn down.
Once the final handshake is made, the call state is moved to active and the signaling connection remains
until a BYE message is received.
If an inside endpoint initiates a call to an outside endpoint, a media hole is opened to the outside interface
to allow RTP/RTCP UDP packets to flow to the inside endpoint media address and media port specified
in the INVITE message from the inside endpoint. Unsolicited RTP/RTCP UDP packets to an inside
interface does not traverse the security appliance, unless the security appliance configuration
specifically allows it.
Step 1 (Optional) Add one or more regular expressions for use in traffic matching commands according to the
“Creating a Regular Expression” section on page 21-6. See the types of text you can match in the match
commands described in Step 3.
Step 2 (Optional) Create one or more regular expression class maps to group regular expressions according to
the “Creating a Regular Expression Class Map” section on page 21-8.s
Step 3 (Optional) Create a SIP inspection class map by performing the following steps.
A class map groups multiple traffic matches. Traffic must match all of the match commands to match
the class map. You can alternatively identify match commands directly in the policy map. The difference
between creating a class map and defining the traffic match directly in the inspection policy map is that
the class map lets you create more complex match criteria, and you can reuse class maps.
To specify traffic that should not match the class map, use the match not command. For example, if the
match not command specifies the string “example.com,” then any traffic that includes “example.com”
does not match the class map.
For the traffic that you identify in this class map, you can specify actions such as drop-connection, reset,
and/or log the connection in the inspection policy map.
If you want to perform different actions for each match command, you should identify the traffic directly
in the policy map.
a. Create the class map by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# class-map type inspect sip [match-all] class_map_name
hostname(config-cmap)#
Where the class_map_name is the name of the class map.The match-all keyword specifies that
traffic must match all criteria to match the class map. match-all is the default and only option. The
CLI enters class-map configuration mode, where you can enter one or more match commands.
b. (Optional) To add a description to the class map, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# description string
Where string is the description of the class map (up to 200 characters).
c. (Optional) To match a called party, as specified in the To header, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] called-party regex {class class_name | regex_name}
Where the regex regex_name argument is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class
regex_class_name is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2.
d. (Optional) To match a calling party, as specified in the From header, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] calling-party regex {class class_name | regex_name}
Where the regex regex_name argument is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class
regex_class_name is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2.
e. (Optional) To match a content length in the SIP header, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] content length gt length
Where length is the number of bytes the content length is greater than. 0 to 65536.
f. (Optional) To match an SDP content type or regular expression, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] content type {sdp | regex {class class_name |
regex_name}}
Where the regex regex_name argument is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class
regex_class_name is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2.
g. (Optional) To match a SIP IM subscriber, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] im-subscriber regex {class class_name | regex_name}
Where the regex regex_name argument is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class
regex_class_name is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2.
h. (Optional) To match a SIP via header, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] message-path regex {class class_name | regex_name}
Where the regex regex_name argument is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class
regex_class_name is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2.
i. (Optional) To match a SIP request method, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] request-method method
Where method is the type of method to match (ack, bye, cancel, info, invite, message, notify,
options, prack, refer, register, subscribe, unknown, update).
j. (Optional) To match the requester of a third-party registration, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] third-party-registration regex {class class_name |
regex_name}
Where the regex regex_name argument is the regular expression you created in Step 1. The class
regex_class_name is the regular expression class map you created in Step 2.
k. (Optional) To match an URI in the SIP headers, enter the following command:
hostname(config-cmap)# match [not] uri {sip | tel} length gt length
Where length is the number of bytes the URI is greater than. 0 to 65536.
Step 4 Create a SIP inspection policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# policy-map type inspect sip policy_map_name
hostname(config-pmap)#
Where the policy_map_name is the name of the policy map. The CLI enters policy-map configuration
mode.
Step 5 (Optional) To add a description to the policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# description string
• Specify traffic directly in the policy map using one of the match commands described in Step 3.
If you use a match not command, then any traffic that does not match the criterion in the match
not command has the action applied.
b. Specify the action you want to perform on the matching traffic by entering the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-c)# {[drop [send-protocol-error] |
drop-connection [send-protocol-error]| mask | reset] [log] | rate-limit message_rate}
Not all options are available for each match or class command. See the CLI help or the Cisco
Security Appliance Command Reference for the exact options available.
The drop keyword drops all packets that match.
The send-protocol-error keyword sends a protocol error message.
The drop-connection keyword drops the packet and closes the connection.
The mask keyword masks out the matching portion of the packet.
The reset keyword drops the packet, closes the connection, and sends a TCP reset to the server
and/or client.
The log keyword, which you can use alone or with one of the other keywords, sends a system log
message.
The rate-limit message_rate argument limits the rate of messages.
You can specify multiple class or match commands in the policy map. For information about the order
of class and match commands, see the “Defining Actions in an Inspection Policy Map” section on
page 21-10.
Step 7 To configure parameters that affect the inspection engine, perform the following steps:
a. To enter parameters configuration mode, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# parameters
hostname(config-pmap-p)#
d. To enable check on Max-forwards header field being 0 (which cannot be 0 before reaching the
destination), enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# max-forwards-validation action {drop | drop-connection |
reset | log} [log]
e. To enable check on RTP packets flowing on the pinholes for protocol conformance, enter the
following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# rtp-conformance [enforce-payloadtype]
Where the enforce-payloadtype keyword enforces the payload type to be audio or video based on
the signaling exchange.
f. To identify the Server and User-Agent header fields, which expose the software version of either a
server or an endpoint, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# software-version action {mask | log} [log]
Where the mask keyword masks the software version in the SIP messages.
g. To enable state checking validation, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# state-checking action {drop | drop-connection | reset | log}
[log]
h. To enable strict verification of the header fields in the SIP messages according to RFC 3261, enter
the following command:
i. To allow non SIP traffic using the well-known SIP signaling port, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# traffic-non-sip
j. To identify the non-SIP URIs present in the Alert-Info and Call-Info header fields, enter the
following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# uri-non-sip action {mask | log} [log]
The following example shows how to disable instant messaging over SIP:
hostname(config)# policy-map type inspect sip mymap
hostname(config-pmap)# parameters
hostname(config-pmap-p)# no im
This command configures the idle timeout after which a SIP control connection is closed.
To configure the timeout for the SIP media connection, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# timeout sip_media hh:mm:ss
This command configures the idle timeout after which a SIP media connection is closed.
Note We recommend that you configure the pager command before entering the show sip command. If there
are a lot of SIP session records and the pager command is not configured, it takes a while for the show
sip command output to reach its end.
This sample shows two active SIP sessions on the security appliance (as shown in the Total field). Each
call-id represents a call.
The first session, with the call-id [email protected], is in the state Call Init,
which means the session is still in call setup. Call setup is not complete until a final response to the call
has been received. For instance, the caller has already sent the INVITE, and maybe received a 100
Response, but has not yet seen the 200 OK, so the call setup is not complete yet. Any non-1xx response
message is considered a final response. This session has been idle for 1 second.
The second session is in the state Active, in which call setup is complete and the endpoints are
exchanging media. This session has been idle for 6 seconds.
Note The security appliance supports stateful failover of SCCP calls except for calls that are in the middle of
call setup.
The output indicates that a call has been established between two internal Cisco IP Phones. The RTP
listening ports of the first and second phones are UDP 22948 and 20798 respectively.
The following is sample output from the show xlate debug command for these Skinny connections:
hostname# show xlate debug
2 in use, 2 most used
Flags: D - DNS, d - dump, I - identity, i - inside, n - no random,
r - portmap, s - static
NAT from inside:10.0.0.11 to outside:172.18.1.11 flags si idle 0:00:16 timeout 0:05:00
NAT from inside:10.0.0.22 to outside:172.18.1.22 flags si idle 0:00:14 timeout 0:05:00
Step 1 (Optional) Add one or more regular expressions for use in traffic matching commands according to the
“Creating a Regular Expression” section on page 21-6. See the types of text you can match in the match
commands described in Step 3.
Step 2 (Optional) Create one or more regular expression class maps to group regular expressions according to
the “Creating a Regular Expression Class Map” section on page 21-8.
Step 3 Create an SCCP inspection policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# policy-map type inspect skinny policy_map_name
hostname(config-pmap)#
Where the policy_map_name is the name of the policy map. The CLI enters policy-map configuration
mode.
Step 4 (Optional) To add a description to the policy map, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# description string
• Specify traffic directly in the policy map using one of the match commands described in Step 3.
If you use a match not command, then any traffic that does not match the criterion in the match
not command has the action applied.
b. Specify the action you want to perform on the matching traffic by entering the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-c)# {[drop [send-protocol-error] |
drop-connection [send-protocol-error]| mask | reset] [log] | rate-limit message_rate}
Not all options are available for each match or class command. See the CLI help or the Cisco
Security Appliance Command Reference for the exact options available.
The drop keyword drops all packets that match.
The send-protocol-error keyword sends a protocol error message.
The drop-connection keyword drops the packet and closes the connection.
The mask keyword masks out the matching portion of the packet.
The reset keyword drops the packet, closes the connection, and sends a TCP reset to the server
and/or client.
The log keyword, which you can use alone or with one of the other keywords, sends a system log
message.
The rate-limit message_rate argument limits the rate of messages.
Step 6 You can specify multiple class or match commands in the policy map. For information about the order
of class and match commands, see the “Defining Actions in an Inspection Policy Map” section on
page 21-10.To configure parameters that affect the inspection engine, perform the following steps:
a. To enter parameters configuration mode, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap)# parameters
hostname(config-pmap-p)#
b. To enforce registration before calls can be placed, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# enforce-registration
c. To set the maximum SCCP station message ID allowed, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# message-ID max hex_value
Where the enforce-payloadtype keyword enforces the payload type to be audio or video based on
the signaling exchange.
e. To set the maximum and minimum SCCP prefix length value allowed, enter the following command:
hostname(config-pmap-p)# sccp-prefix-len {max | min} value_length
The following example shows how to define an SCCP inspection policy map.
hostname(config)# policy-map type inspect skinny skinny-map
hostname(config-pmap)# parameters
hostname(config-pmap-p)# enforce-registration
hostname(config-pmap-p)# match message-id range 200 300
hostname(config-pmap-p)# drop log
hostname(config)# class-map inspection_default
hostname(config-cmap)# match default-inspection-traffic
• For unknown commands, the security appliance changes all the characters in the packet to X. In this
case, the server generates an error code to the client. Because of the change in the packed, the TCP
checksum has to be recalculated or adjusted.
• TCP stream editing.
• Command pipelining.
SNMP Inspection
SNMP application inspection lets you restrict SNMP traffic to a specific version of SNMP. Earlier
versions of SNMP are less secure; therefore, denying certain SNMP versions may be required by your
security policy. The security appliance can deny SNMP versions 1, 2, 2c, or 3. You control the versions
permitted by creating an SNMP map. You then apply the SNMP map when you enable SNMP inspection
according to the “Configuring Application Inspection” section on page 25-5.
To create an SNMP inspection policy map, perform the following steps:
where map_name is the name of the SNMP map. The CLI enters SNMP map configuration mode.
Step 2 To specify the versions of SNMP to deny, enter the following command for each version:
hostname(config-snmp-map)# deny version version
hostname(config-snmp-map)#
SQL*Net Inspection
SQL*Net inspection is enabled by default.
The SQL*Net protocol consists of different packet types that the security appliance handles to make the
data stream appear consistent to the Oracle applications on either side of the security appliance.
The default port assignment for SQL*Net is 1521. This is the value used by Oracle for SQL*Net, but
this value does not agree with IANA port assignments for Structured Query Language (SQL). Use the
class-map command to apply SQL*Net inspection to a range of port numbers.
The security appliance translates all addresses and looks in the packets for all embedded ports to open
for SQL*Net Version 1.
For SQL*Net Version 2, all DATA or REDIRECT packets that immediately follow REDIRECT packets
with a zero data length will be fixed up.
The packets that need fix-up contain embedded host/port addresses in the following format:
(ADDRESS=(PROTOCOL=tcp)(DEV=6)(HOST=a.b.c.d)(PORT=a))
SQL*Net Version 2 TNSFrame types (Connect, Accept, Refuse, Resend, and Marker) will not be
scanned for addresses to NAT nor will inspection open dynamic connections for any embedded ports in
the packet.
SQL*Net Version 2 TNSFrames, Redirect, and Data packets will be scanned for ports to open and
addresses to NAT, if preceded by a REDIRECT TNSFrame type with a zero data length for the payload.
When the Redirect message with data length zero passes through the security appliance, a flag will be
set in the connection data structure to expect the Data or Redirect message that follows to be translated
and ports to be dynamically opened. If one of the TNS frames in the preceding paragraph arrive after the
Redirect message, the flag will be reset.
The SQL*Net inspection engine will recalculate the checksum, change IP, TCP lengths, and readjust
Sequence Numbers and Acknowledgment Numbers using the delta of the length of the new and old
message.
SQL*Net Version 1 is assumed for all other cases. TNSFrame types (Connect, Accept, Refuse, Resend,
Marker, Redirect, and Data) and all packets will be scanned for ports and addresses. Addresses will be
translated and port connections will be opened.
You can use this command to specify the timeout after which the pinhole that was opened by Sun RPC
application inspection will be closed. For example, to create a timeout of 30 minutes to the Sun RPC
server with the IP address 192.168.100.2, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# sunrpc-server inside 192.168.100.2 255.255.255.255 service 100003
protocol tcp 111 timeout 00:30:00
This command specifies that the pinhole that was opened by Sun RPC application inspection will be
closed after 30 minutes. In this example, the Sun RPC server is on the inside interface using TCP port
111. You can also specify UDP, a different port number, or a range of ports. To specify a range of ports,
separate the starting and ending port numbers in the range with a hyphen (for example, 111-113).
The service type identifies the mapping between a specific service type and the port number used for the
service. To determine the service type, which in this example is 100003, use the sunrpcinfo command
at the UNIX or Linux command line on the Sun RPC server machine.
To clear the Sun RPC configuration, enter the following command.
hostname(config)# clear configure sunrpc-server
This removes the configuration performed using the sunrpc-server command. The sunrpc-server
command allows pinholes to be created with a specified timeout.
To clear the active Sun RPC services, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# clear sunrpc-server active
This clears the pinholes that are opened by Sun RPC application inspection for specific services, such
as NFS or NIS.
To display the information about the Sun RPC service table configuration, enter the show
running-config sunrpc-server command. The following is sample output from the show
running-config sunrpc-server command:
hostname(config)# show running-config sunrpc-server
sunrpc-server inside 192.168.100.2 255.255.255.255 service 100003 protocol UDP port 111
timeout 0:30:00
sunrpc-server inside 192.168.100.2 255.255.255.255 service 100005 protocol UDP port 111
timeout 0:30:00
This output shows that a timeout interval of 30 minutes is configured on UDP port 111 for the Sun RPC
server with the IP address 192.168.100.2 on the inside interface.
To display the pinholes open for Sun RPC services, enter the show sunrpc-server active command. The
following is sample output from show sunrpc-server active command:
hostname# show sunrpc-server active
LOCAL FOREIGN SERVICE TIMEOUT
-----------------------------------------------
1 209.165.200.5/0 192.168.100.2/2049 100003 0:30:00
2 209.165.200.5/0 192.168.100.2/2049 100003 0:30:00
3 209.165.200.5/0 192.168.100.2/647 100005 0:30:00
4 209.165.200.5/0 192.168.100.2/650 100005 0:30:00
The entry in the LOCAL column shows the IP address of the client or server on the inside interface, while
the value in the FOREIGN column shows the IP address of the client or server on the outside interface.
To view information about the Sun RPC services running on a Sun RPC server, enter the rpcinfo -p
command from the Linux or UNIX server command line. The following is sample output from the
rpcinfo -p command:
sunrpcserver:~ # rpcinfo -p
program vers proto port
100000 2 tcp 111 portmapper
100000 2 udp 111 portmapper
100024 1 udp 632 status
100024 1 tcp 635 status
100003 2 udp 2049 nfs
100003 3 udp 2049 nfs
100003 2 tcp 2049 nfs
100003 3 tcp 2049 nfs
100021 1 udp 32771 nlockmgr
100021 3 udp 32771 nlockmgr
100021 4 udp 32771 nlockmgr
100021 1 tcp 32852 nlockmgr
100021 3 tcp 32852 nlockmgr
100021 4 tcp 32852 nlockmgr
100005 1 udp 647 mountd
100005 1 tcp 650 mountd
100005 2 udp 647 mountd
100005 2 tcp 650 mountd
100005 3 udp 647 mountd
100005 3 tcp 650 mountd
In this output, port 647 corresponds to the mountd daemon running over UDP. The mountd process
would more commonly be using port 32780. The mountd process running over TCP uses port 650 in this
example.
TFTP Inspection
TFTP inspection is enabled by default.
TFTP, described in RFC 1350, is a simple protocol to read and write files between a TFTP server and
client.
The security appliance inspects TFTP traffic and dynamically creates connections and translations, if
necessary, to permit file transfer between a TFTP client and server. Specifically, the inspection engine
inspects TFTP read request (RRQ), write request (WRQ), and error notification (ERROR).
A dynamic secondary channel and a PAT translation, if necessary, are allocated on a reception of a valid
read (RRQ) or write (WRQ) request. This secondary channel is subsequently used by TFTP for file
transfer or error notification.
Only the TFTP server can initiate traffic over the secondary channel, and at most one incomplete
secondary channel can exist between the TFTP client and server. An error notification from the server
closes the secondary channel.
TFTP inspection must be enabled if static PAT is used to redirect TFTP traffic.
XDMCP Inspection
XDMCP inspection is enabled by default; however, the XDMCP inspection engine is dependent upon
proper configuration of the established command.
XDMCP is a protocol that uses UDP port 177 to negotiate X sessions, which use TCP when established.
For successful negotiation and start of an XWindows session, the security appliance must allow the TCP
back connection from the Xhosted computer. To permit the back connection, use the established
command on the security appliance. Once XDMCP negotiates the port to send the display, The
established command is consulted to verify if this back connection should be permitted.
During the XWindows session, the manager talks to the display Xserver on the well-known port 6000 |
n. Each display has a separate connection to the Xserver, as a result of the following terminal setting.
setenv DISPLAY Xserver:n
Note The dedicated management interface, if present, never floods packets even if this parameter
is set to flood.
ARP inspection prevents malicious users from impersonating other hosts or routers (known as ARP
spoofing). ARP spoofing can enable a “man-in-the-middle” attack. For example, a host sends an
ARP request to the gateway router; the gateway router responds with the gateway router MAC address.
The attacker, however, sends another ARP response to the host with the attacker MAC address instead
of the router MAC address. The attacker can now intercept all the host traffic before forwarding it on to
the router.
ARP inspection ensures that an attacker cannot send an ARP response with the attacker MAC address,
so long as the correct MAC address and the associated IP address are in the static ARP table.
Note The transparent firewall uses dynamic ARP entries in the ARP table for traffic to and from the security
appliance, such as management traffic.
For example, to allow ARP responses from the router at 10.1.1.1 with the MAC address 0009.7cbe.2100
on the outside interface, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# arp outside 10.1.1.1 0009.7cbe.2100
Where flood forwards non-matching ARP packets out all interfaces, and no-flood drops non-matching
packets.
Note The default setting is to flood non-matching packets. To restrict ARP through the security appliance to
only static entries, then set this command to no-flood.
For example, to enable ARP inspection on the outside interface, and to drop all non-matching ARP
packets, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# arp-inspection outside enable no-flood
To view the current settings for ARP inspection on all interfaces, enter the show arp-inspection
command.
then the security appliance drops the traffic and generates a system message. When you add a static ARP
entry (see the “Adding a Static ARP Entry” section on page 26-2), a static MAC address entry is
automatically added to the MAC address table.
To add a static MAC address to the MAC address table, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# mac-address-table static interface_name mac_address
The timeout_value (in minutes) is between 5 and 720 (12 hours). 5 minutes is the default.
The no form of this command reenables MAC address learning. The clear configure mac-learn
command reenables MAC address learning on all interfaces.
The following is sample output from the show mac-address-table command that shows the entire table:
hostname# show mac-address-table
interface mac address type Time Left
-----------------------------------------------------------------------
outside 0009.7cbe.2100 static -
inside 0010.7cbe.6101 static -
inside 0009.7cbe.5101 dynamic 10
The following is sample output from the show mac-address-table command that shows the table for the
inside interface:
hostname# show mac-address-table inside
interface mac address type Time Left
-----------------------------------------------------------------------
inside 0010.7cbe.6101 static -
Configuring VPN
C H A P T E R 27
Configuring IPSec and ISAKMP
This chapter describes how to configure the IPSec and ISAKMP standards to build Virtual Private
Networks. It includes the following sections:
• Tunneling Overview, page 27-1
• IPSec Overview, page 27-2
• Configuring ISAKMP, page 27-2
• Configuring Certificate Group Matching, page 27-9
• Configuring IPSec, page 27-11
• Clearing Security Associations, page 27-27
• Clearing Crypto Map Configurations, page 27-27
• Supporting the Nokia VPN Client, page 27-28
Tunneling Overview
Tunneling makes it possible to use a public TCP/IP network, such as the Internet, to create secure
connections between remote users and a private corporate network. Each secure connection is called a
tunnel.
The security appliance uses the ISAKMP and IPSec tunneling standards to build and manage tunnels.
ISAKMP and IPSec accomplish the following:
• Negotiate tunnel parameters
• Establish tunnels
• Authenticate users and data
• Manage security keys
• Encrypt and decrypt data
• Manage data transfer across the tunnel
• Manage data transfer inbound and outbound as a tunnel endpoint or router
The security appliance functions as a bidirectional tunnel endpoint. It can receive plain packets from the
private network, encapsulate them, create a tunnel, and send them to the other end of the tunnel where
they are unencapsulated and sent to their final destination. It can also receive encapsulated packets from
the public network, unencapsulate them, and send them to their final destination on the private network.
IPSec Overview
IPSec provides the most complete architecture for VPN tunnels, and it is perceived as the most secure
protocol. IPSec provides authentication and encryption services to prevent unauthorized viewing or
modification of data within your network or as it travels over an unprotected network, such as the public
Internet. Our implementation of the IPSec standard uses the ESP security protocol to provide
authentication, encryption, and anti-replay services.
The security appliance implements IPSec in two types of configurations:
• LAN-to-LAN configurations are between two IPSec security gateways, such as security appliance
units or other protocol-compliant VPN devices. A LAN-to-LAN VPN connects networks in different
geographic locations.
• Remote access configurations provide secure remote access for Cisco VPN clients, such as mobile
users. A remote access VPN lets remote users securely access centralized network resources.
The Cisco VPN client complies with the IPSec protocol and is specifically designed to work with
the security appliance. However, the security appliance can establish IPSec connections with many
protocol-compliant clients.
In IPSec LAN-to-LAN connections, the security appliance can function as initiator or responder. In
IPSec remote access connections, the security appliance functions only as responder. Initiators propose
SAs; responders accept, reject, or make counter-proposals—all in accordance with configured security
association (SA) parameters. To establish a connection, both entities must agree on the SAs.
In IPSec terminology, a peer is a remote-access client or another secure gateway.
Configuring ISAKMP
This section describes the Internet Key Exchange protocol which is also called the Internet Security
Association and Key Management Protocol. The security appliance IKE commands use ISAKMP as a
keyword, which this guide echoes. ISAKMP works with IPSec to make VPNs more scalable. This
section includes the following topics:
• ISAKMP Overview, page 27-2
• Configuring ISAKMP Policies, page 27-5
• Enabling ISAKMP on the Outside Interface, page 27-6
• Disabling ISAKMP in Aggressive Mode, page 27-6
• Determining an ID Method for ISAKMP Peers, page 27-6
• Enabling IPSec over NAT-T, page 27-7
• Enabling IPSec over TCP, page 27-8
• Waiting for Active Sessions to Terminate Before Rebooting, page 27-9
• Alerting Peers Before Disconnecting, page 27-9
ISAKMP Overview
IKE, also called ISAKMP, is the negotiation protocol that lets two hosts agree on how to build an IPSec
security association. ISAKMP separates negotiation into two phases: Phase 1 and Phase 2.
Phase 1 creates the first tunnel, which protects later ISAKMP negotiation messages. Phase 2 creates the
tunnel that protects data.
To set the terms of the ISAKMP negotiations, you create an ISAKMP policy, which includes the
following:
• An authentication method, to ensure the identity of the peers.
• An encryption method, to protect the data and ensure privacy.
• A Hashed Message Authentication Codes (HMAC) method to ensure the identity of the sender, and
to ensure that the message has not been modified in transit.
• A Diffie-Hellman group to determine the strength of the encryption-key-determination algorithm.
The security appliance uses this algorithm to derive the encryption and hash keys.
• A limit to the time the security appliance uses an encryption key before replacing it.
Table 27-1 provides information about the ISAKMP policy keywords and their values.
Each configuration supports a maximum of 20 ISAKMP policies, each with a different set of values.
Assign a unique priority to each policy you create. The lower the priority number, the higher the priority.
When ISAKMP negotiations begin, the peer that initiates the negotiation sends all of its policies to the
remote peer, and the remote peer tries to find a match. The remote peer checks all of the peer's policies
against each of its configured policies in priority order (highest priority first) until it discovers a match.
A match exists when both policies from the two peers contain the same encryption, hash, authentication,
and Diffie-Hellman parameter values, and when the remote peer policy specifies a lifetime less than or
equal to the lifetime in the policy the initiator sent. If the lifetimes are not identical, the security
appliance uses the shorter lifetime. If no acceptable match exists, ISAKMP refuses negotiation and the
SA is not established.
There is an implicit trade-off between security and performance when you choose a specific value for
each parameter. The level of security the default values provide is adequate for the security requirements
of most organizations. If you are interoperating with a peer that supports only one of the values for a
parameter, your choice is limited to that value.
Note If you do not specify a value for a given policy parameter, the default value applies.
Step 1 Specify the encryption algorithm. The default is Triple DES. This example sets encryption to DES.
crypto isakmp policy priority encryption [aes | aes-192 | aes-256 | des | 3des]
For example:
hostname(config)# crypto isakmp policy 2 encryption des
Step 2 Specify the hash algorithm. The default is SHA-1. This example configures MD5.
crypto isakmp policy priority hash [md5 | sha]
For example:
hostname(config)# crypto isakmp policy 2 hash md5
Step 3 Specify the authentication method. The default is preshared keys. This example configures RSA
signatures.
crypto isakmp policy priority authentication [pre-share | crack | rsa-sig]
For example:
hostname(config)# crypto isakmp policy 2 authentication rsa-sig
Step 4 Specify the Diffie-Hellman group identifier. The default is Group 2. This example configures Group 5.
crypto isakmp policy priority group [1 | 2 | 5 | 7]
For example:
hostname(config)# crypto isakmp policy 2 group 5
Step 5 Specify the SA lifetime. This examples sets a lifetime of 4 hours (14400 seconds). The default is 86400
seconds (24 hours).
crypto isakmp policy priority lifetime seconds
For example:
hostname(config)# crypto isakmp policy 2 lifetime 14400
For example:
hostname(config)# crypto isakmp enable outside
For example:
hostname(config)# crypto isakmp am-disable
If you have disabled aggressive mode, and want to revert to back to it, use the no form of the command.
For example:
hostname(config)# no crypto isakmp am-disable
Note Disabling aggressive mode prevents Cisco VPN clients from using preshared key authentication to
establish tunnels to the security appliance. However, they may use certificate-based authentication
(that is, ASA or RSA) to establish tunnels.
Address Uses the IP addresses of the hosts exchanging ISAKMP identity information.
Automatic Determines ISAKMP negotiation by connection type:
• IP address for preshared key.
• Cert Distinguished Name for certificate authentication.
Hostname Uses the fully qualified domain name of the hosts exchanging ISAKMP identity
information (default). This name comprises the hostname and the domain name.
Key ID Uses the string the remote peer uses to look up the preshared key.
The security appliance uses the Phase I ID to send to the peer. This is true for all VPN scenarios except
LAN-to-LAN connections in main mode that authenticate with preshared keys.
The default setting is hostname.
To change the peer identification method, enter the following command:
crypto isakmp identity {address | hostname | key-id id-string | auto}
For example, the following command sets the peer identification method to automatic:
hostname(config)# crypto isakmp identity auto
Using NAT-T
To use NAT-T, you must perform the following tasks:
Step 1 Enter the following command to enable IPSec over NAT-T globally on the security appliance.
Step 2 Select the “before-fragmentation” option for the IPSec fragmentation policy.
This option lets traffic travel across NAT devices that do not support IP fragmentation. It does not impede
the operation of NAT devices that do support IP fragmentation.
IPSec over TCP works with remote access clients. You enable it globally, and it works on all ISAKMP
enabled interfaces. It is a client to security appliance feature only. It does not work for LAN-to-LAN
connections.
The security appliance can simultaneously support standard IPSec, IPSec over TCP, NAT-Traversal, and
IPSec over UDP, depending on the client with which it is exchanging data. IPSec over TCP, if enabled,
takes precedence over all other connection methods.
The VPN 3002 hardware client, which supports one tunnel at a time, can connect using standard IPSec,
IPSec over TCP, NAT-Traversal, or IPSec over UDP.
You enable IPSec over TCP on both the security appliance and the client to which it connects.
You can enable IPSec over TCP for up to 10 ports that you specify. If you enter a well-known port, for
example port 80 (HTTP) or port 443 (HTTPS), the system displays a warning that the protocol associated
with that port no longer works on the public interface. The consequence is that you can no longer use a
browser to manage the security appliance through the public interface. To solve this problem,
reconfigure the HTTP/HTTPS management to different ports.
The default port is 10000.
You must configure TCP port(s) on the client as well as on the security appliance. The client
configuration must include at least one of the ports you set for the security appliance.
To enable IPSec over TCP globally on the security appliance, enter the following command:
crypto isakmp ipsec-over-tcp [port port 1...port0]
For example:
hostname(config)# crypto isakmp reload-wait
Use the reload command to reboot the security appliance. If you set the reload-wait command, you can
use the reload quick command to override the reload-wait setting. The reload and reload-wait
commands are available in privileged EXEC mode; neither includes the isakmp prefix.
For example:
hostname(config)# crypto isakmp disconnect-notify
policy Specifies the policy for deriving the tunnel group name from the certificate.
Policy can be one of the following:
ike-id—Indicates that if a tunnel-group is not determined based on a rule
lookup or taken from the ou, then the certificate-based ISAKMP sessions are
mapped to a tunnel group based on the content of the phase1 ISAKMP ID.
ou—Indicates that if a tunnel-group is not determined based on a rule lookup,
then use the value of the OU in the subject distinguished name (DN).
peer-ip—Indicates that if a tunnel-group is not determined based on a rule
lookup or taken from the ou or ike-id methods, then use the peer IP address.
rules—Indicates that the certificate-based ISAKMP sessions are mapped to a
tunnel group based on the certificate map associations configured by this
command.
rule index (Optional) Refers to parameters specified by the crypto ca certificate map
command. The values are 1 to 65535.
The following example enables mapping of certificate-based ISAKMP sessions to a tunnel group based
on the IP address of the peer:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group-map enable peer-ip
hostname(config)#
The following example enables mapping of certificate-based ISAKMP sessions based on the
organizational unit (OU) in the subject distinguished name (DN):
hostname(config)# tunnel-group-map enable ou
hostname(config)#
The following example enables mapping of certificate-based ISAKMP sessions based on established
rules:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group-map enable rules
hostname(config)#
Configuring IPSec
This section provides background information about IPSec and describes the procedures required to
configure the security appliance when using IPSec to implement a VPN. It contains the following topics:
• Understanding IPSec Tunnels, page 27-11
• Understanding Transform Sets, page 27-12
• Defining Crypto Maps, page 27-12
• Applying Crypto Maps to Interfaces, page 27-20
• Using Interface Access Lists, page 27-20
• Changing IPSec SA Lifetimes, page 27-22
• Creating a Basic IPSec Configuration, page 27-22
• Using Dynamic Crypto Maps, page 27-24
• Providing Site-to-Site Redundancy, page 27-26
• Viewing an IPSec Configuration, page 27-26
• Transform sets
• Crypto maps
• Access lists
• Tunnel groups
• Prefragmentation policies
Note If you clear or delete the only element in a transform set, the security appliance automatically removes
the crypto map references to it.
You can continue to enter this command to add crypto maps to the crypto map set. In the following
example, “mymap” is the name of the crypto map set to which you might want to add crypto maps:
crypto map mymap 10 match address 101
The sequence number (seq-num) shown in the syntax above distinguishes one crypto map from another
one with the same name. The sequence number assigned to a crypto map also determines its priority
among the other crypto maps within a crypto map set. The lower the sequence number, the higher the
priority. After you assign a crypto map set to an interface, the security appliance evaluates all IP traffic
passing through the interface against the crypto maps in the set, beginning with the crypto map with the
lowest sequence number.
The ACL assigned to a crypto map consists of all of the ACEs that have the same access-list-name, as
shown in the following command syntax:
access-list access-list-name {deny | permit} ip source source-netmask destination
destination-netmask
Each ACL consists of one or more ACEs that have the same access-list-name. You create an ACL when
you create its first ACE. The following command syntax creates or adds to an ACL:
access-list access-list-name {deny | permit} ip source source-netmask destination
destination-netmask
In the following example, the security appliance applies the IPSec protections assigned to the crypto map
to all traffic flowing from the 10.0.0.0 subnet to the 10.1.1.0 subnet.
access-list 101 permit ip 10.0.0.0 255.255.255.0 10.1.1.0 255.255.255.0
The crypto map that matches the packet determines the security settings used in the SA negotiations.
If the local security appliance initiates the negotiation, it uses the policy specified in the static crypto
map to create the offer to send to the specified peer. If the peer initiates the negotiation, the security
appliance attempts to match the policy to a static crypto map, and if that fails, any dynamic crypto maps
in the crypto map set, to decide whether to accept or reject the peer offer.
For two peers to succeed in establishing an SA, they must have at least one compatible crypto map. To
be compatible, a crypto map must meet the following criteria:
• The crypto map must contain compatible crypto ACLs (for example, mirror image ACLs). If the
responding peer uses dynamic crypto maps, so must the security appliance as a requirement to apply
IPSec.
• Each crypto map identifies the other peer (unless the responding peer uses dynamic crypto maps).
• The crypto maps have at least one transform set in common.
You can apply only one crypto map set to a single interface. Create more than one crypto map for a
particular interface on the security appliance if any of the following conditions exist:
• You want specific peers to handle different data flows.
• You want different IPSec security to apply to different types of traffic.
For example, create a crypto map and assign an ACL to identify traffic between two subnets and assign
one transform set. Create another crypto map with a different ACL to identify traffic between another
two subnets and apply a transform set with different VPN parameters.
If you create more than one crypto map for an interface, specify a sequence number (seq-num) for each
map entry to determine its priority within the crypto map set.
Each ACE contains a permit or deny statement. Table 27-2 explains the special meanings of permit and
deny ACEs in ACLs applied to crypto maps.
Table 27-2 Special Meanings of Permit and Deny in Crypto Access Lists Applied to Outbound
Traffic
ACEs containing deny statements filter out outbound traffic that does not require IPSec protection
(for example, routing protocol traffic). Therefore, insert initial deny statements to filter outbound traffic
that should not be evaluated against permit statements in a crypto access list.
For an inbound, encrypted packet, the security appliance uses the source address and ESP SPI to
determine the decryption parameters. After the security appliance decrypts the packet, it compares the
inner header of the decrypted packet to the permit ACEs in the ACL associated with the packet SA. If the
inner header fails to match the proxy, the security appliance drops the packet. It the inner header matches
the proxy, the security appliance routes the packet.
When comparing the inner header of an inbound packet that was not encrypted, the security appliance
ignores all deny rules because they would prevent the establishment of a Phase 2 SA.
Note To route inbound, unencrypted traffic as clear text, insert deny ACEs before permit ACEs.
Figure 27-1 Effect of Permit and Deny ACEs on Traffic (Conceptual Addresses)
A.3
Human Resources B.3 C.3
A B C
143514
Internet
The simple address notation shown in this figure and used in the following explanation is an abstraction.
An example with real IP addresses follows the explanation.
The objective in configuring Security Appliances A, B, and C in this example LAN-to-LAN network is
to permit tunneling of all traffic originating from one of the hosts shown in Figure 27-1 and destined for
one of the other hosts. However, because traffic from Host A.3 contains sensitive data from the Human
Resources department, it requires strong encryption and more frequent rekeying than the other traffic.
So we want to assign a special transform set for traffic from Host A.3.
To configure Security Appliance A for outbound traffic, we create two crypto maps, one for traffic from
Host A.3 and the other for traffic from the other hosts in Network A, as shown in the following example:
Crypto Map Seq_No_1
deny packets from A.3 to B
deny packets from A.3 to C
permit packets from A to B
permit packets from A to C
Crypto Map Seq_No_2
permit packets from A.3 to B
permit packets from A.3 to C
After creating the ACLs, you assign a transform set to each crypto map to apply the required IPSec to
each matching packet.
Cascading ACLs involves the insertion of deny ACEs to bypass evaluation against an ACL and resume
evaluation against a subsequent ACL in the crypto map set. Because you can associate each crypto map
with different IPSec settings, you can use deny ACEs to exclude special traffic from further evaluation
in the corresponding crypto map, and match the special traffic to permit statements in another crypto
map to provide or require different security. The sequence number assigned to the crypto ACL
determines its position in the evaluation sequence within the crypto map set.
Figure 27-2 shows the cascading ACLs created from the conceptual ACEs above. The meaning of each
symbol in the figure follows.
Packet that fits the description of one ACE. Each size ball
represents a different packet matching the respective ACE in the
figure. The differences in size merely represent differences in the
source and destination of each packet.
Redirection to the next crypto map in the crypto map set.
Crypto Map 1
Deny
A.3 B
Deny
A.3 C
Permit
AB
Permit
AC
Crypto Map 2
Permit
A.3 B
Permit
A.3 C
Security Appliance A evaluates a packet originating from Host A.3 until it matches a permit ACE and
attempts to assign the IPSec security associated with the crypto map. Whenever the packet matches a
deny ACE, the security appliance ignores the remaining ACEs in the crypto map and resumes evaluation
against the next crypto map, as determined by the sequence number assigned to it. So in the example, if
Security Appliance A receives a packet from Host A.3, it matches the packet to a deny ACE in the first
crypto map and resumes evaluation of the packet against the next crypto map. When it matches the
packet to the permit ACE in that crypto map, it applies the associated IPSec security (strong encryption
and frequent rekeying).
To complete the security appliance configuration in the example network, we assign mirror crypto maps
to Security Appliances B and C. However, because security appliances ignore deny ACEs when
evaluating inbound, encrypted traffic, we can omit the mirror equivalents of the deny A.3 B
and deny A.3 C ACEs, and therefore omit the mirror equivalents of Crypto Map 2. So the configuration
of cascading ACLs in Security Appliances B and C is unnecessary.
Table 27-3 shows the ACLs assigned to the crypto maps configured for all three security appliances in
Figure 27-1.
Table 27-3 Example Permit and Deny Statements (Conceptual)
Figure 27-3 maps the conceptual addresses shown in Figure 27-1 to real IP addresses.
Figure 27-3 Effect of Permit and Deny ACEs on Traffic (Real Addresses)
A.3
192.168.3.3 B.2 C.3
Human Resources 192.168.12.3 192.168.201.3
A B C
192.168.3.0/26 192.168.12.0/29 192.168.201.0/27
143514
Internet
The tables that follow combine the IP addresses shown in Figure 27-3 to the concepts shown in
Table 27-3. The real ACEs shown in these tables ensure that all IPSec packets under evaluation within
this network receive the proper IPSec settings.
Table 27-4 Example Permit and Deny Statements for Security Appliance A
Crypto Map
Security Sequence
Appliance No. ACE Pattern Real ACEs
A 1 deny A.3 B deny 192.168.3.3 255.255.255.192 192.168.12.0 255.255.255.248
deny A.3 C deny 192.168.3.3 255.255.255.192 192.168.201.0 255.255.255.224
permit A B permit 192.168.3.0 255.255.255.192 192.168.12.0 255.255.255.248
permit A C permit 192.168.3.0 255.255.255.192 192.168.201.0 255.255.255.224
2 permit A.3 B permit 192.168.3.3 255.255.255.192 192.168.12.0 255.255.255.248
permit A.3 C permit 192.168.3.3 255.255.255.192 192.168.201.0 255.255.255.224
B None needed permit B A permit 192.168.12.0 255.255.255.248 192.168.3.0 255.255.255.192
permit B C permit 192.168.12.0 255.255.255.248 192.168.201.0 255.255.255.224
C None needed permit C A permit 192.168.201.0 255.255.255.224 192.168.3.0 255.255.255.192
permit C B permit 192.168.201.0 255.255.255.224 192.168.12.0 255.255.255.248
You can apply the same reasoning shown in the example network to use cascading ACLs to assign
different security settings to different hosts or subnets protected by a Cisco security appliance.
Note By default, the security appliance does not support IPSec traffic destined for the same interface from
which it enters. (Names for this type of traffic include U-turn, hub-and-spoke, and hairpinning.)
However, you might want IPSec to support U-turn traffic. To do so, insert an ACE to permit traffic to
and from the network. For example, to support U-turn traffic on Security Appliance B, add a conceptual
“permit B B” ACE to ACL1. The actual ACE would be as follows:
permit 192.168.12.0 255.255.255.248 192.168.12.0 255.255.255.248
Step 2 Map the lists to one or more crypto maps, using the same crypto map name.
Step 3 Map the transform sets to the crypto maps to apply IPSec to the data flows.
Step 4 Apply the crypto maps collectively as a “crypto map set” by assigning the crypto map name they share
to the interface.
In Figure 27-4, IPSec protection applies to traffic between Host 10.0.0.1 and Host 10.2.2.2 as the data
exits the outside interface on Security Appliance A toward Host 10.2.2.2.
IPSec peers
Host
Internet 10.2.2.2
Host outside outside
10.0.0.1 Security Security
Appliance Appliance
Firewall A Firewall B
92616
Traffic exchanged between hosts 10.0.0.1 and 10.2.2.2 is protected between
Security Appliance Firewall A "outside" and Security Appliance Firewall B "outside"
Security Appliance A evaluates traffic from Host 10.0.0.1 to Host 10.2.2.2, as follows:
• source = host 10.0.0.1
• dest = host 10.2.2.2
Security Appliance A also evaluates traffic from Host 10.2.2.2 to Host 10.0.0.1, as follows:
• source = host 10.2.2.2
• dest = host 10.0.0.1
The first permit statement that matches the packet under evaluation determines the scope of the
IPSec SA.
Note If you delete the only element in an access list, the security appliance also removes the associated crypto
map.
If you modify an access list currently referenced by one or more crypto maps, use the crypto map
interface command to reinitialize the run-time SA database. See the crypto map command for more
information.
We recommend that for every crypto access list specified for a static crypto map that you define at the
local peer, you define a “mirror image” crypto access list at the remote peer. The crypto maps should
also support common transforms and refer to the other system as a peer. This ensures correct processing
of IPSec by both peers.
Note Every static crypto map must define an access list and an IPSec peer. If either is missing, the crypto map
is incomplete and the security appliance drops any traffic that it has not already matched to an earlier,
complete crypto map. Use the show conf command to ensure that every crypto map is complete. To fix
an incomplete crypto map, remove the crypto map, add the missing entries, and reapply it.
We discourage the use of the any keyword to specify source or destination addresses in crypto access
lists because they cause problems. We strongly discourage the permit any any command statement
because it does the following:
• Protects all outbound traffic, including all protected traffic sent to the peer specified in the
corresponding crypto map.
• Requires protection for all inbound traffic.
In this scenario, the security appliance silently drops all inbound packets that lack IPSec protection.
Be sure that you define which packets to protect. If you use the any keyword in a permit statement,
preface it with a series of deny statements to filter out traffic that would otherwise fall within that permit
statement that you do not want to protect.
Step 1 To create an access list to define the traffic to protect, enter the following command:
access-list access-list-name {deny | permit} ip source source-netmask destination
destination-netmask
For example:
In this example, the permit keyword causes all traffic that matches the specified conditions to be
protected by crypto.
Step 2 To configure a transform set that defines how to protect the traffic, enter the following command:
crypto ipsec transform-set transform-set-name transform1 [tcansform2, transform3]
For example:
crypto ipsec transform-set myset1 esp-des esp-sha-hmac
crypto ipsec transform-set myset2 esp-3des esp-sha-hmac
crypto ipsec transform-set aes_set esp-md5-hmac esp-aes-256
In this example, “myset1” and “myset2” and “aes_set” are the names of the transform sets.
Step 3 To create a crypto map, perform the following steps:
a. Assign an access list to a crypto map:
crypto map map-name seq-num match address access-list-name
In the following example, “mymap” is the name of the crypto map set. The map set sequence number
10, which is used to rank multiple entries within one crypto map set. The lower the sequence
number, the higher the priority.
crypto map mymap 10 match address 101
In this example, the access list named 101 is assigned to crypto map “mymap.”
b. Specify the peer to which the IPSec protected traffic can be forwarded:
crypto map map-name seq-num set peer ip-address
For example:
crypto map mymap 10 set peer 192.168.1.100
The security appliance sets up an SA with the peer assigned the IP address 192.168.1.100.
Specify multiple peers by repeating this command.
c. Specify which transform sets are allowed for this crypto map. List multiple transform sets in order
of priority (highest priority first). You can specify up to 11 transform sets in a crypto map.
crypto map map-name seq-num set transform-set transform-set-name1
[transform-set-name2, …transform-set-name6]
For example:
crypto map mymap 10 set transform-set myset1 myset2
In this example, when traffic matches access list 101, the SA can use either “myset1” (first priority)
or “myset2” (second priority) depending on which transform set matches the transform set of the
peer.
d. (Optional) Specify an SA lifetime for the crypto map if you want to override the global lifetime.
crypto map map-name seq-num set security-association lifetime {seconds seconds |
kilobytes kilobytes}
For example:
crypto map mymap 10 set security-association lifetime seconds 2700
This example shortens the timed lifetime for the crypto map “mymap 10” to 2700 seconds
(45 minutes). The traffic volume lifetime is not changed.
e. (Optional) Specify that IPSec require perfect forward secrecy when requesting new SA for this
crypto map, or require PFS in requests received from the peer:
crypto map map-name seq-num set pfs [group1 | group2 | group5 | group7]
For example:
crypto map mymap 10 set pfs group2
This example requires PFS when negotiating a new SA for the crypto map “mymap 10.”
The security appliance uses the 1024-bit Diffie-Hellman prime modulus group in the new SA.
Step 4 Apply a crypto map set to an interface for evaluating IPSec traffic:
crypto map map-name interface interface-name
For example:
crypto map mymap interface outside
In this example, the security appliance evaluates the traffic going through the outside interface against
the crypto map “mymap” to determine whether it needs to be protected.
Dynamic crypto maps can ease IPSec configuration and we recommend them for use in networks where
the peers are not always predetermined. Use dynamic crypto maps for Cisco VPN clients (such as mobile
users) and routers that obtain dynamically assigned IP addresses.
Tip Use care when using the any keyword in permit entries in dynamic crypto maps. If the traffic covered
by such a permit entry could include multicast or broadcast traffic, insert deny entries for the
appropriate address range into the access list. Remember to insert deny entries for network and subnet
broadcast traffic, and for any other traffic that IPSec should not protect.
Dynamic crypto maps work only to negotiate SAs with remote peers that initiate the connection. The
security appliance cannot use dynamic crypto maps to initiate connections to a remote peer. With a
dynamic crypto map, if outbound traffic matches a permit entry in an access list and the corresponding
SA does not yet exist, the security appliance drops the traffic.
A crypto map set may include a dynamic crypto map. Dynamic crypto map sets should be the lowest
priority crypto maps in the crypto map set (that is, they should have the highest sequence numbers) so
that the security appliance evaluates other crypto maps first. It examines the dynamic crypto map set only
when the other (static) map entries do not match.
Similar to static crypto map sets, a dynamic crypto map set consists of all of the dynamic crypto maps
with the same dynamic-map-name. The dynamic-seq-num differentiates the dynamic crypto maps in a
set. If you configure a dynamic crypto map, insert a permit ACL to identify the data flow of the IPSec
peer for the crypto access list. Otherwise the security appliance accepts any data flow identity the peer
proposes.
Caution Do not assign static (default) routes for traffic to be tunneled to a security appliance interface configured
with a dynamic crypto map set. To identify the traffic that should be tunneled, add the ACLs to the
dynamic crypto map. Use care to identify the proper address pools when configuring the ACLs
associated with remote access tunnels. Use Reverse Route Injection to install routes only after the tunnel
is up.
The procedure for using a dynamic crypto map entry is the same as the basic configuration described in
“Creating a Basic IPSec Configuration,” except that instead of creating a static crypto map, you create
a dynamic crypto map entry. You can also combine static and dynamic map entries within a single crypto
map set.
Create a crypto dynamic map entry as follows:
In this example, access list 101 is assigned to dynamic crypto map “dyn1.” The map sequence number
is 10.
Step 2 Specify which transform sets are allowed for this dynamic crypto map. List multiple transform sets in
order of priority (highest priority first).
crypto dynamic-map dynamic-map-name dynamic-seq-num set transform-set transform-set-name1,
[transform-set-name2, …transform-set-name9]
For example:
crypto dynamic-map dyn 10 set transform-set myset1 myset2
In this example, when traffic matches access list 101, the SA can use either “myset1” (first priority) or
“myset2” (second priority), depending on which transform set matches the transform sets of the peer.
Step 3 (Optional) Specify the SA lifetime for the crypto dynamic map entry if you want to override the global
lifetime value:
crypto dynamic-map dynamic-map-name dynamic-seq-num set security-association lifetime
{seconds seconds | kilobytes kilobytes}
For example:
crypto dynamic-map dyn1 10 set security-association lifetime seconds 2700
This example shortens the timed lifetime for dynamic crypto map “dyn1 10” to 2700 seconds
(45 minutes). The time volume lifetime is not changed.
Step 4 (Optional) Specify that IPSec ask for PFS when requesting new SAs for this dynamic crypto map, or
should demand PFS in requests received from the peer:
crypto dynamic-map dynamic-map-name dynamic-seq-num set pfs [group1 | group2 | group5 |
group7]
For example:
crypto dynamic-map dyn1 10 set pfs group5
Step 5 Add the dynamic crypto map set into a static crypto map set.
Be sure to set the crypto maps referencing dynamic maps to be the lowest priority entries (highest
sequence numbers) in a crypto map set.
crypto map map-name seq-num ipsec-isakmp dynamic dynamic-map-name
For example:
crypto map mymap 200 ipsec-isakmp dynamic dyn1
Command Purpose
show running-configuration crypto Displays the entire crypto configuration,
including IPSec, crypto maps, dynamic crypto
maps, and ISAKMP.
show running-config crypto ipsec Displays the complete IPSec configuration.
show running-config crypto isakmp Displays the complete ISAKMP configuration.
show running-config crypto map Displays the complete crypto map configuration.
show running-config crypto dynamic-map Displays the dynamic crypto map configuration.
show all crypto map View all of the configuration parameters,
including those with default values.
Command Purpose
clear configure crypto Removes an entire crypto configuration, including IPSec,
crypto maps, dynamic crypto maps, and ISAKMP.
clear configure crypto ca trustpoint Removes all trustpoints.
clear configure crypto dynamic-map Removes all dynamic crypto maps. Includes keywords that
let you remove specific dynamic crypto maps.
clear configure crypto map Removes all crypto maps. Includes keywords that let you
remove specific crypto maps.
clear configure crypto isakmp Removes the entire ISAKMP configuration.
clear configure crypto isakmp policy Removes all ISAKMP policies or a specific policy.
clear crypto isakmp sa Removes the entire ISAKMP SA database.
Be aware that if you enter the clear configure crypto command without arguments, you remove the
entire crypto configuration, including all certificates.
For more information, see the clear configure crypto command in the Cisco Security Appliance
Command Reference.
Internet
SSM
enrollment
gateway
Operator
mobile SSM
network management
station
Nokia SSM
Web server RADIUS or
LDAP server
SAP
database
Windows Clients/ Mobile Devices/
Laptop Policy Mobile Devices
Policy
Corporate
Telecommuters E-mail
Corporate
132777
Web services
To support the Nokia VPN Client, perform the following step on the security appliance:
• Enable CRACK authentication using the crypto isakmp policy priority authentication command
with the crack keyword in global configuration mode. For example:
hostname(config)# crypto isakmp policy 2
If you are using digital certificates for client authentication, perform the following additional steps:
Step 1 Configure the trustpoint and remove the requirement for a fully qualified domain name. The trustpoint
might be NSSM or some other CA. In this example, the trustpoint is named CompanyVPNCA:
hostname(config)# crypto ca trustpoint CompanyVPNCA
hostname(config-ca-trustpoint)# fqdn none
Step 2 To configure the identity of the ISAKMP peer, perform one of the following steps:
a. Use the crypto isakmp identity command with the hostname keyword. For example:
hostname(config)# crypto isakmp identity hostname
–or–
b. Use the crypto isakmp identity command with the auto keyword to configure the identity to be
automatically determined from the connection type. For example:
hostname(config)# crypto isakmp identity auto
Note If you use the crypto isakmp identity auto command, you must be sure that the DN attribute
order in the client certificate is CN, OU, O, C, St, L.
To learn more about the Nokia services required to support the CRACK protocol on Nokia clients, and
to ensure they are installed and configured properly, contact your local Nokia representative.
This chapter describes how to configure IPSec over L2TP on the security appliance, and includes the
following topics:
• L2TP Overview, page 28-1
• Configuring L2TP over IPSec Connections, page 28-3
• Viewing L2TP over IPSec Connection Information, page 28-5
L2TP Overview
Layer 2 Tunneling Protocol (L2TP) is a VPN tunneling protocol which allows remote clients to use the
public IP network to securely communicate with private corporate network servers. L2TP uses PPP over
UDP (port 1701) to tunnel the data.
L2TP protocol is based on the client/server model. The function is divided between the L2TP Network
Server (LNS), and the L2TP Access Concentrator (LAC). The LNS typically runs on a network gateway
such as a router, while the LAC can be a dial-up Network Access Server (NAS), or a PC with a bundled
L2TP client such as Microsoft Windows 2000.
The primary benefit of configuring L2TP with IPSec in a remote access scenario is that remote users can
access a VPN over a public IP network without a gateway or a dedicated line, enabling remote access
from virtually anyplace with POTS. An additional benefit is that the only client requirement for VPN
access is the use of Windows 2000 with Microsoft Dial-Up Networking (DUN). No additional client
software, such as Cisco VPN client software, is required.
To configure L2TP over IPSec, first configure IPSec transport mode to enable IPSec with L2TP. Then
configure L2TP with a virtual private dial-up network VPDN group.
The configuration of L2TP with IPSec supports certificates using the pre-shared keys or RSA signature
methods, and the use of dynamic (as opposed to static) crypto maps. This summary of tasks assumes
completion of IKE, as well as pre-shared keys or RSA signature configuration. See “Chapter 39,
“Certificate Configuration,”” for the steps to configure pre-shared keys, RSA, and dynamic crypto maps.
Note L2TP with IPSec on the security appliance allows the LNS to interoperate with the Windows 2000 L2TP
client. Interoperability with LACs from Cisco and other vendors is currently not supported. Only L2TP
with IPSec is supported, native L2TP itself is not supported on security appliance.
The minimum IPSec security association lifetime supported by the Windows 2000 client is 300 seconds.
If the lifetime on thesecurity appliance is set to less than 300 seconds, the Windows 2000 client ignores
it and replaces it with a 300 second lifetime.
IP HDR Data
IP HDR Data
Transport mode
Note The security appliance does not establish an L2TP/IPSec tunnel with Windows 2000 if either the Cisco
VPN Client Version 3.x or the Cisco VPN 3000 Client Version 2.5 is installed. Disable the Cisco VPN
Service for the Cisco VPN Client Version 3.x, or the ANetIKE Service for the Cisco VPN 3000 Client
Version 2.5 from the Services panel in Windows 2000 (click Start>Programs>Administrative
Tools>Services). Then restart the IPSec Policy Agent Service from the Services panel, and reboot the
machine.
Step 1 Specify IPSec to use transport mode rather than tunnel mode with the mode keyword of the
crypto ipsec transform-set command:
hostname(config)# crypto ipsec transform-set trans_name mode transport
Step 2 (Optional) Specify the local address pool used to allocate the IP address to the client using the
address-pool command in tunnel-group general-attributes mode:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group name general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# address-pool pool_name
Step 3 (Optional) Instruct the security appliance to send DNS server IP addresses to the client with the
dns value command from group policy configuration mode:
hostname(config)# group-policy group_policy_name attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# dns value [none | IP_primary [IP_secondary]]
Step 4 (Optional) Instruct the security appliance to send WINS server IP addresses to the client using the
wins-server command from group policy configuration mode:
hostname(config-group-policy)# wins-server value [none | IP_primary [IP_secondary]]
Step 5 (Optional) Generate a AAA accounting start and stop record for an L2TP session using the
accounting-server-group command from tunnel group general-attributes mode:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group name general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# accounting-server-group aaa_server_group
Step 6 Configure L2TP over IPSec as a valid VPN tunneling protocol for a group or user with the
vpn-tunnel-protocol l2tp-ipsec command:
For a group, enter group-policy attributes mode:
hostname(config)# group-policy group_policy_name attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-tunnel-protocol l2tp-ipsec
Step 7 Create a tunnel group with the tunnel-group command, and link the name of the group policy to the
tunnel group with the default-group-policy command from tunnel group general-attributes mode:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group name type ipsec-ra
hostname(config)# tunnel-group name general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# group-policy group_policy_name
Step 8 Configure the PPP authentication protocol using the authentication type command from tunnel group
ppp-attributes mode. Table 28-1 shows the types of PPP authentication, and their characteristics.
hostname(config)# tunnel-group name ppp-attributes
hostname(config-ppp)# authentication pap
Step 9 Specify a method to authenticate users attempting L2TP over IPSec connections. Use the
authentication-server-group command from tunnel-group general-attributes mode to configure the
security appliance to use an authentication server or its own local database.
Note The security appliance only supports the PPP authentications PAP and Microsoft CHAP, Versions 1 and
2, on the local database. EAP and CHAP are performed by proxy authentication servers. Therefore, if a
remote user belongs to a tunnel group configured with the authentication eap-proxy or authentication
chap commands, and the security appliance is configured to use the local database, that user will not be
able to connect.
Step 10 Create a user in the local database with the username command from global configuration mode.
If the user is an L2TP client using Microsoft CHAP, Version 1 or Version 2, and the security appliance
is configured to authenticate against the local database, you must include the mschap keyword. For
Example:
hostname(config)# username t_wmith password eu5d93h mschap
Step 11 Configure the interval (in seconds) between hello messages using the l2tp tunnel hello command in
global configuration mode:
hostname(config)# l2tp tunnel hello seconds
Step 12 (Optional) If you expect multiple L2TP clients behind a NAT device to attempt L2TP over IPSec
connections to the security appliance, you must enable NAT traversal so that ESP packets can pass
through one or more NAT devices.
To enable NAT traversal globally, check that ISAKMP is enabled (you can enable it with the crypto
isakmp enable command) in global configuration mode and then use the crypto isakmp nat-traversal
command. For example:
hostname(config)# crypto isakmp enable
hostname(config)# crypto isakmp nat-traversal 30
Username : b_smith
Index : 1
Assigned IP : 90.208.1.200 Public IP : 70.208.1.212
Protocol : L2TPOverIPSec Encryption : 3DES
Hashing : SHA1
Bytes Tx : 418464 Bytes Rx : 424440
Client Type : Client Ver :
Group Policy : DfltGrpPolicy
Tunnel Group : DefaultRAGroup
IKE Sessions: 1
IPSec Sessions: 1
L2TPOverIPSec Sessions: 1
IKE:
Session ID : 1
UDP Src Port : 500 UDP Dst Port : 500
IKE Neg Mode : Main Auth Mode : preSharedKeys
Encryption : 3DES Hashing : SHA1
Rekey Int (T): 28800 Seconds Rekey Left(T): 24643 Seconds
D/H Group : 2
IPSec:
Session ID : 2
Local Addr : 80.208.1.2/255.255.255.255/17/1701
Remote Addr : 70.208.1.212/255.255.255.255/17/1701
Encryption : 3DES Hashing : SHA1
Encapsulation: Transport
Rekey Int (T): 3600 Seconds Rekey Left(T): 2856 Seconds
Rekey Int (D): 95000 K-Bytes Rekey Left(D): 95000 K-Bytes
Idle Time Out: 30 Minutes Idle TO Left : 30 Minutes
Bytes Tx : 419064 Bytes Rx : 425040
Pkts Tx : 4201 Pkts Rx : 4227
L2TPOverIPSec:
Session ID : 3
Username : l2tp
Assigned IP : 90.208.1.200
Encryption : none Auth Mode : PAP
Idle Time Out: 30 Minutes Idle TO Left : 30 Minutes
Bytes Tx : 301386 Bytes Rx : 306480
Pkts Tx : 4198 Pkts Rx : 4224
The following example shows the details of a single L2TP over IPSec over NAT connection:
hostname# show vpn-sessiondb detail remote filter protocol L2TPOverIPSecOverNAtT
Username : v_gonzalez
Index : 2
Assigned IP : 90.208.1.202 Public IP : 70.208.1.2
Protocol : L2TPOverIPSecOverNatT Encryption : 3DES
Hashing : MD5
Bytes Tx : 1009 Bytes Rx : 2241
Client Type : Client Ver :
Group Policy : DfltGrpPolicy
Tunnel Group : l2tpcert
Login Time : 14:35:15 UTC Thu Mar 30 2006
Duration : 0h:00m:07s
Filter Name :
NAC Result : N/A
Posture Token:
IKE Sessions: 1
IPSecOverNatT Sessions: 1
L2TPOverIPSecOverNatT Sessions: 1
IKE:
Session ID : 1
UDP Src Port : 4500 UDP Dst Port : 4500
IKE Neg Mode : Main Auth Mode : rsaCertificate
Encryption : 3DES Hashing : MD5
Rekey Int (T): 300 Seconds Rekey Left(T): 294 Seconds
D/H Group : 2
IPSecOverNatT:
Session ID : 2
Local Addr : 80.208.1.2/255.255.255.255/17/1701
Remote Addr : 70.208.1.2/255.255.255.255/17/0
Encryption : 3DES Hashing : MD5
Encapsulation: Transport
Rekey Int (T): 300 Seconds Rekey Left(T): 293 Seconds
Idle Time Out: 1 Minutes Idle TO Left : 1 Minutes
Bytes Tx : 1209 Bytes Rx : 2793
Pkts Tx : 20 Pkts Rx : 32
L2TPOverIPSecOverNatT:
Session ID : 3
Username : v_gonzalez
Assigned IP : 90.208.1.202
Encryption : none Auth Mode : PAP
Idle Time Out: 1 Minutes Idle TO Left : 1 Minutes
Bytes Tx : 584 Bytes Rx : 2224
Pkts Tx : 18 Pkts Rx : 30
===================
The security appliance implementation of virtual private networking includes useful features that do not
fit neatly into categories. This chapter describes some of these features. It includes the following
sections:
• Configuring VPNs in Single, Routed Mode, page 29-1
• Configuring IPSec to Bypass ACLs, page 29-1
• Permitting Intra-Interface Traffic, page 29-2
• Setting Maximum Active IPSec VPN Sessions, page 29-3
• Using Client Update to Ensure Acceptable Client Revision Levels, page 29-3
• Understanding Load Balancing, page 29-5
• Configuring Load Balancing, page 29-9
• Configuring VPN Session Limits, page 29-11
Public web
server
Client VPN
Security laptop 2
appliance
192.168.0.0
192.168.0.11
Client VPN
laptop 1
143170
Unencrypted traffic
IPSec encrypted traffic 192.168.0.10
To configure this feature, use the same-security-traffic command in global configuration mode with its
intra-interface argument.
The command syntax is same-security-traffic permit {inter-interface | intra-interface}.
The following example shows how to enable intra-interface traffic:
hostname(config)# same-security-traffic permit intra-interface
hostname(config)#
Note You use the same-security-traffic command, but with the inter-interface argument, to permit
communication between interfaces that have the same security level. This feature is not specific to IPSec
connections. For more information, see the “Configuring Interface Parameters” chapter of this guide.
To use hairpinning, you must apply the proper NAT rules to the security appliance interface, as discussed
in the following section.
When the security appliance sends encrypted VPN traffic back out this same interface, however, NAT is
optional. The VPN-to-VPN hairpinning works with or without NAT. To apply NAT to all outgoing
traffic, implement only the commands above. To exempt the VPN-to-VPN traffic from NAT, add
commands (to the example above) that implement NAT exemption for VPN-to-VPN traffic, such as:
hostname(config)# access-list nonat permit ip 192.168.0.0 255.255.255.0 192.168.0.0
255.255.255.0
hostname(config)# nat (outside) 0 access-list nonat
For more information on NAT rules, see the “Applying NAT” chapter of this guide.
To perform client update, enter the client-update command in either general configuration mode or
tunnel-group ipsec-attributes configuration mode. If the client is already running a software version on
the list of revision numbers, it does not need to update its software. If the client is not running a software
version on the list, it should update. The following procedure tells how to perform a client-update:
Step 1 In global configuration mode, enable client update by entering the command:
hostname(config)# client-update enable
hostname(config)#
Step 2 In global configuration mode, specify the parameters for the client update that you want to apply to all
clients of a particular type. That is, specify the type of client, the URL or IP address from which to get
the updated image, and the acceptable revision number or numbers for that client. You can specify up to
four revision numbers, separated by commas.
If the user’s client revision number matches one of the specified revision numbers, there is no need to
update the client. This command specifies the client-update values for all clients of the specified type
across the entire security appliance
The syntax of the command to do this is:
hostname(config)# client-update type type url url-string rev-nums rev-numbers
hostname(config)#
The available client types are win9X (includes Windows 95, Windows 98 and Windows ME platforms),
winnt (includes Windows NT 4.0, Windows 2000 and Windows XP platforms), windows (Includes all
Windows based platforms), and vpn3002 (VPN 3002 hardware client).
If the client is already running a software version on the list of revision numbers, it does not need to
update its software. If the client is not running a software version on the list, it should update. You can
specify up to three of these client update entries. The keyword windows covers all of the allowable
Windows platforms. If you specify windows, do not specify the individual Windows client types.
Note For all Windows clients, you must use the protocol http:// or https:// as the prefix for the URL. For the
VPN 3002 hardware client, you must specify protocol tftp:// instead.
The following example configures client update parameters for the remote-access tunnel-group. It
designates the revision number, 4.6.1 and the URL for retrieving the update, which is
https://support/updates:
hostname(config)# client-update type windows url https://support/updates/ rev-nums 4.6.1
hostname(config)#
Alternatively, you can configure client update just for individual tunnel-groups, rather than for all clients
of a particular type. (See Step 3.)
VPN 3002 clients update without user intervention and users receive no notification message. The
following example applies only to VPN 3002 Hardware Clients. Entered in tunnel-group ipsec-attributes
configuration mode, it configures client update parameters for the IPSec remote-access tunnel-group
“salesgrp”. It designates the revision number, 4.7 and uses the TFTP protocol for retrieving the updated
software from the site with the IP address 192.168.1.1:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group salesgrp type ipsec-ra
hostname(config)# tunnel-group salesgrp ipsec-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# client-update type vpn3002 url tftp:192.168.1.1 rev-nums
4.7
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
Note You can have the browser automatically start an application by including the application name at the end
of the URL; for example: https://support/updates/vpnclient.exe.
Step 3 To define a set of client-update parameters for a particular ipsec-ra tunnel group, do the following. In
tunnel-group ipsec-attributes mode, specify the tunnel-group name and its type, the URL or IP address
from which to get the updated image, and a revision number. If the user’s client’s revision number
matches one of the specified revision numbers, there is no need to update the client; for example, for a
Windows client:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group remotegrp type ipsec-ra
hostname(config)# tunnel-group remotegrp ipsec-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# client-update type windows url https://support/updates/
rev-nums 4.6.1
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
Step 4 Optionally, you can send a notice to active users with outdated Windows clients that their client needs
updating. For these users, a pop-up window appears, offering them the opportunity to launch a browser
and download the updated software from the site that you specified in the URL. The only part of this
message that you can configure is the URL. (See Step 2 or 3.) Users who are not active get a notification
message the next time they log on. You can send this notice to all active clients on all tunnel groups, or
you can send it to clients on a particular tunnel group. For example, to notify all active clients on all
tunnel groups, you would enter the following command in privileged EXEC mode:
hostname# client-update all
hostname#
If the user’s client’s revision number matches one of the specified revision numbers, there is no need to
update the client, and no notification message is sent to the user. VPN 3002 clients update without user
intervention and users receive no notification message.
Note If you specify the client-update type as windows (specifying all Windows-based platforms) and later
want to enter a client-update type of win9x or winnt for the same entity, you must first remove the
windows client type with the no form of the command, then use new client-update commands to specify
the new client types.
tied to a physical device; it can shift among devices. For example, if the current virtual cluster master
fails, one of the secondary devices in the cluster takes over that role and immediately becomes the new
virtual cluster master.
Note The output of a show command might show the secondary devices in the cluster as backup devices.
The virtual cluster appears to outside clients as a single virtual cluster IP address. This IP address is not
tied to a specific physical device. It belongs to the current virtual cluster master; hence, it is virtual. A
VPN Client attempting to establish a connection connects first to this virtual cluster IP address. The
virtual cluster master then sends back to the client the public IP address of the least-loaded available host
in the cluster. In a second transaction (transparent to the user), the client connects directly to that host.
In this way, the virtual cluster master directs traffic evenly and efficiently across resources.
Note All clients other than the Cisco VPN Client or the Cisco 3002 Hardware Client should connect directly
to the security appliance as usual; they do not use the virtual cluster IP address.
If a machine in the cluster fails, the terminated sessions can immediately reconnect to the virtual cluster
IP address. The virtual cluster master then directs these connections to another active device in the
cluster. Should the virtual cluster master itself fail, a secondary device in the cluster immediately and
automatically takes over as the new virtual session master. Even if several devices in the cluster fail,
users can continue to connect to the cluster as long as any one device in the cluster is up and available.
Note VPN load balancing requires an active 3DES/AES license. The security appliance checks for the
existence of this crypto license before enabling load balancing. If it does not detect an active 3DES or
AES license, the security appliance prevents the enabling of load balancing and also prevents internal
configuration of 3DES by the load balancing system unless the license permits this usage.
Prerequisites
Load balancing is disabled by default. You must explicitly enable load balancing.
You must have first configured the public (outside) and private (inside) interfaces and also have
previously configured the the interface to which the virtual cluster IP address refers. You can use the
interface and nameif commands to configure different names for these interfaces. Subsequent
references in this section use the names outside and inside.
All devices that participate in a cluster must share the same cluster-specific values: IP address,
encryption settings, encryption key, and port.
Eligible Platforms
A load-balancing cluster can include security appliance models ASA 5520 and above. You can also
include VPN 3000 Series Concentrators in the cluster. While mixed configurations are possible,
administration is generally simpler if the cluster is homogeneous.
Eligible Clients
Load balancing is effective only on remote sessions initiated with the following clients:
• Cisco VPN Client (Release 3.0 and later)
• Cisco VPN 3002 Hardware Client (Release 3.5 or later)
• Cisco PIX 501/506E when acting as an Easy VPN client.
Load balancing works with both IPSec clients and WebVPN sessions. All other clients, including
LAN-to-LAN connections, can connect to a security appliance on which load balancing is enabled, but
they cannot participate in load balancing.
Note You can configure the number of IPSec and WebVPN sessions to allow, up to the maximum allowed by
your configuration and license. See Configuring VPN Session Limits, page 29-11 for a description of
how to set these limits.
Note All participants in the cluster must have an identical cluster configuration, except for the device priority
within the cluster.
Step 1 Configure the public interface on the security appliance by entering the interface command with the
lbpublic keyword in vpn-load-balancing configuration mode. This command specifies the name or IP
address of the public interface for load balancing for this device:
hostname(config)# vpn load-balancing
hostname(config-load-balancing)# interface lbpublic outside
hostname(config-load-balancing)#
Step 2 Configure the private interface on the security appliance by entering the interface command with the
lbprivate keyword in vpn-load-balancing configuration mode. This command specifies the name or IP
address of the private interface for load balancing for this device:
hostname(config-load-balancing)# interface lbprivate inside
hostname(config-load-balancing)#
Step 3 Set the priority to assign to this device within the cluster. The range is from 1 to 10. The priority indicates
the likelihood of this device becoming the virtual cluster master, either at start-up or when an existing
master fails. The higher you set the priority (for example, 10), the more likely it is that this device
becomes the virtual cluster master.
hostname(config-load-balancing)# priority number
hostname(config-load-balancing)#
For example, to assign this device a priority of 6 within the cluster, enter the following command:
hostname(config-load-balancing)# priority 6
hostname(config-load-balancing)#
Step 4 If you want to apply network address translation for this device, enter the nat command with the NAT
assigned address for the device:
hostname(config-load-balancing)# nat ip_address
hostname(config-load-balancing)#
For example, to assign this device a NAT address of 192.168.30.3, enter the following command:
hostname(config-load-balancing)# nat 192.168.30.3
hostname(config-load-balancing)#
Step 1 Set up VPN load balancing by entering the vpn load-balancing command in global configuration mode:
hostname(config)# vpn load-balancing
hostname(config-load-balancing)#
This enters vpn-load-balancing configuration mode, in which you can configure the remaining
load-balancing attributes.
Step 2 Configure the IP address of the cluster to which this device belongs. This command specifies the single
IP address that represents the entire virtual cluster. Choose an IP address that is within the public subnet
address range shared by all the security appliances in the virtual cluster
hostname(config-load-balancing)# cluster ip address ip_address
hostname(config-load-balancing)#
For example, to set the cluster IP address to 192.168.10.10, enter the following command:
hostname(config-load-balancing)# cluster ip address 192.168.10.10
hostname(config-load-balancing)#
Step 3 Configure the cluster port.This command specifies the UDP port for the virtual cluster in which this
device is participating. The default value is 9023. If another application is using this port, enter the UDP
destination port number you want to use for load balancing.
hostname(config-load-balancing)# cluster port port_number
hostname(config-load-balancing)#
For example, to set the cluster port to 4444, enter the following command:
hostname(config-load-balancing)# cluster port 4444
hostname(config-load-balancing)#
Step 4 Optionally, enable IPSec encryption for the cluster. The default is no encryption. This command enables
or disables IPSec encryption. If you configure this check attribute, you must first specify and verify a
shared secret.The security appliances in the virtual cluster communicate via LAN-to-LAN tunnels using
IPSec. To ensure that all load-balancing information communicated between the devices is encrypted,
enable this attribute.
hostname(config-load-balancing)# cluster encryption
hostname(config-load-balancing)#
Note When using encryption, you must have previously configured the load-balancing inside
interface. If that interface is not enabled on the load-balancing inside interface, you get an error
message when you try to configure cluster encryption.
If the load-balancing inside interface was enabled when you configured cluster encryption, but
was disabled before you configured the participation of the device in the virtual cluster, you get
an error message when you enter the participate command (or, in ASDM, select the Participate
in Load Balancing Cluster check box), and encryption is not enabled for the cluster.
To use cluster encryption, you musts enable isakmp on the inside interface, using the crypto
isakmp enable command with the inside interface specified.
Step 5 If you enable cluster encryption, you must also specify the IPSec shared secret by entering the cluster
key command. This command specifies the shared secret to between IPSec peers when you have enabled
IPSec encryption. The value you enter in the box appears as consecutive asterisk characters
hostname(config-load-balancing)# cluster key shared_secret
hostname(config-load-balancing)#
For example, to set the shared secret to 123456789, enter the following command:
hostname(config-load-balancing)# cluster key 123456789
hostname(config-load-balancing)#
Step 6 Enable this device’s participation in the cluster by entering the participate command:
hostname(config-load-balancing)# participate
hostname(config-load-balancing)#
To limit the maximum number of active IPSec VPN sessions to a lower value than the security appliance
allows, enter the vpn-sessiondb max-session-limit command in global configuration mode. This limit
affects the calculated load percentage for VPN Load Balancing.
hostname(config)# vpn-sessiondb max-session-limit number_of_sessions
hostname(config)#
For example, if the security appliance license allows 750 IPSec sessions, and you want to limit the
number of IPSec sessions to 500, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# vpn-sessiondb max-session-limit 500
hostname(config)#
To limit WebVPN sessions to a lower value than the security appliance allows, use the vpn-sessiondb
max-webvpn-session-limit command in global configuration mode. To remove the session limit, use the
no version of this command.
hostname(config)# vpn-sessiondb max-webvpn-session-limit number_of_sessions
hostname(config)#
For example, if the security appliance license allows 500 WebVPN sessions, and you want to limit the
number of WebVPN sessions to 250, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# vpn-sessiondb max-webvpn-session-limit 250
hostname(config)#
For a complete description of the features available with each license, see Appendix A, Feature Licenses
and Specifications.
This chapter describes how to configure VPN tunnel groups, group policies, and users. This chapter
includes the following sections.
• Overview of Tunnel Groups, Group Policies, and Users, page 30-1
• Configuring Tunnel Groups, page 30-5
• Group Policies, page 30-30
• Configuring User Attributes, page 30-69
In summary, you first configure tunnel groups to set the values for the connection. Then you configure
group policies. These set values for users in the aggregate. Then you configure users, which can inherit
values from groups and configure certain values on an individual user basis. This chapter describes how
and why to configure these entities.
Note The security appliance also includes the concept of object groups, which are a superset of network lists.
Object groups let you define VPN access to ports as well as networks. Object groups relate to ACLs
rather than to group policies and tunnel groups. For more information about using object groups, see
Chapter 16, “Identifying Traffic with Access Lists.”
Tunnel Groups
A tunnel group consists of a set of records that determines tunnel connection policies. These records
identify the servers to which the tunnel user is authenticated, as well as the accounting servers, if any, to
which connection information is sent. They also identify a default group policy for the connection, and
they contain protocol-specific connection parameters. Tunnel groups include a small number of
attributes that pertain to creating the tunnel itself. Tunnel groups include a pointer to a group policy that
defines user-oriented attributes.
The security appliance provides the following default tunnel groups: DefaultL2Lgroup for LAN-to-LAN
connections, DefaultRAgroup for remote access connections, and DefaultWEBVPNGroup for WebVPN
connections. You can modify these default tunnel groups, but you cannot delete them. You can also
create one or more tunnel groups specific to your environment. Tunnel groups are local to the security
appliance and are not configurable on external servers.
Tunnel groups specify the following attributes:
• General Tunnel-Group Connection Parameters, page 30-2
• IPSec Tunnel-Group Connection Parameters, page 30-3
• WebVPN Tunnel-Group Connection Parameters, page 30-4
• Default group policy for the connection—A group policy is a set of user-oriented attributes. The
default group policy is the group policy whose attributes the security appliance uses as defaults
when authenticating or authorizing a tunnel user.
• Client address assignment method—This method includes values for one or more DHCP servers or
address pools that the security appliance assigns to clients.
• Override account disabled—This parameter lets you override the “account-disabled” indicator
received from a AAA server.
• Password management—This parameter lets you warn a user that the current password is due to
expire in a specified number of days (the default is 14 days), then offer the user the opportunity to
change the password.
• Strip group and strip realm—These parameters direct the way the security appliance processes the
usernames it receives. They apply only to usernames received in the form user@realm. A realm is
an administrative domain appended to a username with the @ delimiter (user@abc).
When you specify the strip-group command, the security appliance selects the tunnel group for user
connections by obtaining the group name from the username presented by the VPN client. The
security appliance then sends only the user part of the username for authorization/authentication.
Otherwise (if disabled), the security appliance sends the entire username, including the realm.
Strip-realm processing removes the realm from the username when sending the username to the
authentication or authorization server. If the command is enabled, the security appliance sends only
the user part of the username authorization/authentication. Otherwise, the security appliance sends
the entire username.
• Authorization required—This parameter lets you require authorization before a user can connect, or
turn off that requirement.
• Authorization DN attributes—This parameter specifies which Distinguished Name attributes to use
when performing authorization.
Note To reduce connectivity costs, disable IKE keepalives if this group includes any clients
connecting via ISDN lines. ISDN connections normally disconnect if idle, but the IKE keepalive
mechanism prevents connections from idling and therefore from disconnecting.
If you do disable IKE keepalives, the client disconnects only when either its IKE or IPSec keys
expire. Failed traffic does not disconnect the tunnel with the Peer Timeout Profile values as it
does when IKE keepalives are enabled.
Note If you have a LAN-to-LAN configuration using IKE main mode, make sure that the two peers
have the same IKE keepalive configuration. Both peers must have IKE keepalives enabled or
both peers must have it disabled.
• If you configure authentication using digital certificates, you can specify whether to send the entire
certificate chain (which sends the peer the identity certificate and all issuing certificates) or just the
issuing certificates (including the root certificate and any subordinate CA certificates).
• You can notify users who are using outdated versions of Windows client software that they need to
update their client, and you can provide a mechanism for them to get the updated client version. For
VPN 3002 hardware client users, you can trigger an automatic update. You can configure and change
the client-update, either for all tunnel groups or for particular tunnel groups.
• If you configure authentication using digital certificates, you can specify the name of the trustpoint
that identifies the certificate to send to the IKE peer.
• One or more group aliases; these are alternate names by which the server can refer to a tunnel group.
At login, the user selects the group name from a dropdown menu.
• One or more group URLs. If you configure this parameter, users coming in on a specified URL need
not select a group at login.
• A group policy that grants a WebVPN user access rights that are different from the default group
policy.
• The name of the NetBIOS Name Service server (nbns-server) to use for CIFS name resolution.
Specifying a Name and Type for the IPSec Remote Access Tunnel Group
Create the tunnel group, specifying its name and type, by entering the tunnel-group command. For an
IPSec remote-access tunnel, the type is ipsec-ra
hostname(config)# tunnel-group tunnel_group_name type ipsec-ra
hostname(config)#
For example, to create an IPSec remote-access tunnel-group named TunnelGroup1, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group TunnelGroup1 type ipsec-ra
hostname(config)#
Step 1 To configure the general attributes, enter tunnel-group general-attributes command, which enters
tunnel-group general-attributes configuration mode. The prompt changes to indicate the change in mode.
hostname(config)# tunnel-group tunnel_group_name general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
Step 2 Specify the name of the authentication-server group, if any, to use. If you want to use the LOCAL
database for authentication if the specified server group fails, append the keyword LOCAL:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authentication-server-group [(interface_name)] groupname
[LOCAL]
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
You can optionally configure interface-specific authentication by including the name of an interface after
the group name. The interface name, which specifies where the IPSec tunnel terminates, must be
enclosed in parentheses. The following command configures interface-specific authentication for the
interface named test using the server named servergroup1 for authentication:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authentication-server-group (test) servergroup1
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
Step 3 Specify the name of the authorization-server group, if any, to use. When you configure this value, users
must exist in the authorization database to connect:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-server-group groupname
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
For example, the following command specifies the use of the authorization-server group FinGroup:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-server-group FinGroup
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
For example, the following command specifies the use of the accounting-server group named
comptroller:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# accounting-server-group comptroller
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
The following example sets DfltGrpPolicy as the name of the default group policy:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# default-group-policy DfltGrpPolicy
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
Step 6 Specify the names or IP addresses of the DHCP server (up to 10 servers), and the names of the DHCP
address pools (up to 6 pools). The defaults are no DHCP server and no address pool.
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# dhcp-server server1 [...server10]
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# address-pool [(interface name)] address_pool1
[...address_pool6]
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
You configure address pools with the ip local pool command in global configuration mode.
Step 7 Specify the name of the NAC authentication server group, if you are using Network Admission Control,
to identify the group of authentication servers to be used for Network Admission Control posture
validation. Configure at least one Access Control Server to support NAC. Use the aaa-server command
to name the ACS group. Then use the nac-authentication-server-group command, using the same name
for the server group.
The following example identifies acs-group1 as the authentication server group to be used for NAC
posture validation:
hostname(config-group-policy)# nac-authentication-server-group acs-group1
hostname(config-group-policy)
The following example inherits the authentication server group from the default remote access group.
hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac-authentication-server-group
hostname(config-group-policy)
Step 8 Specify whether to strip the group or the realm from the username before passing it on to the AAA server.
The default is not to strip either the group name or the realm.
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# strip-group
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# strip-realm
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
A realm is an administrative domain. If you strip the realm, the security appliance uses the username and
the group (if present) authentication. If you strip the group, the security appliance uses the username and
the realm (if present) for authentication.Enter the strip-realm command to remove the realm qualifier,
and use the strip-group command to remove the group qualilfier from the username during
authentication. If you remove both qualifiers, authentication is based on the username alone. Otherwise,
authentication is based on the full username@realm or username<delimiter> group string. You must
specify strip-realm if your server is unable to parse delimiters.
Step 9 Optionally, if your server is a RADIUS, RADIUS with NT, or LDAP server, you can enable password
management.
Note If you are using an LDAP directory server for authentication, password management is supported with
the Sun Microsystems JAVA System Directory Server (formerly named the Sun ONE Directory Server)
and the Microsoft Active Directory.
• Sun—The DN configured on the security appliance to access a Sun directory server must be able to
access the default password policy on that server. We recommend using the directory administrator,
or a user with directory administrator privileges, as the DN. Alternatively, you can place an ACI on
the default password policy.
• Microsoft—You must configure LDAP over SSL to enable password management with Microsoft
Active Directory.
See the “Setting the LDAP Server Type” section on page 13-7 for more information.
This feature, which is enabled by default, warns a user when the current password is about to expire. The
default is to begin warning the user 14 days before expiration:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# password-management
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
If the server is an LDAP server, you can specify the number of days (0 through 180) before expiration
to begin warning the user about the pending expiration:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# password-management [password-expire in days n]
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
When you configure this command, the security appliance notifies the remote user at login that the user’s
current password is about to expire or has expired. The security appliance then offers the user the
opportunity to change the password. If the current password has not yet expired, the user can still log in
using that password. The security appliance ignores this command if RADIUS or LDAP authentication
has not been configured.
Note that this does not change the number of days before the password expires, but rather, the number
of days ahead of expiration that the security appliance starts warning the user that the password is about
to expire.
If you do specify the password-expire-in-days keyword, you must also specify the number of days.
Specifying this command with the number of days set to 0 disables this command. The security appliance
does not notify the user of the pending expiration, but the user can change the password after it expires.
See Configuring Microsoft Active Directory Settings for Password Management, page 30-24 for more
information.
Step 10 Optionally, configure the ability to override an account-disabled indicator from a AAA server, by
entering the override-account-disable command:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# override-account-disable
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
Step 11 Specify the attribute or attributes to use in deriving a name for an authorization query from a certificate.
This attribute specifies what part of the subject DN field to use as the username for authorization:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-dn-attributes {primary-attribute
[secondary-attribute] | use-entire-name}
For example, the following command specifies the use of the CN attribute as the username for
authorization:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-dn-attributes CN
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
Step 1 To specify the attributes of an IPSec remote-access tunnel-group, enter tunnel-group ipsec-attributes
mode by entering the following command. The prompt changes to indicate the mode change:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group tunnel-group-name ipsec-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
This command enters tunnel-group ipsec-attributes configuration mode, in which you configure the
remote-access tunnel-group IPSec attributes.
For example, the following command designates that the tunnel-group ipsec-attributes mode commands
that follow pertain to the tunnel group named TG1. Notice that the prompt changes to indicate that you
are now in tunnel-group ipsec-attributes mode:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group TG1 type ipsec-ra
hostname(config)# tunnel-group TG1 ipsec-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
Step 2 Specify the preshared key to support IKE connections based on preshared keys. For example, the
following command specifies the preshared key xyzx to support IKE connections for an IPSec remote
access tunnel group:
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# pre-shared-key xyzx
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
Step 3 Specify whether to validate the identity of the peer using the peer’s certificate:
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# peer-id-validate option
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
The available options are req (required), cert (if supported by certificate), and nocheck (do not check).
The default is req.
For example, the following command specifies that peer-id validation is required:
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# peer-id-validate req
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# chain
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
The following command specifies mytrustpoint as the name of the certificate to be sent to the IKE peer:
hostname(config-ipsec)# trust-point mytrustpoint
Step 7 Specify the ISAKMP (IKE) keepalive threshold and the number of retries allowed.
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# isakmp keepalive threshold <number> retry <number>
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
The threshold parameter specifies the number of seconds (10 through 3600) that the peer is allowed to
idle before beginning keepalive monitoring. The retry parameter is the interval (2 through 10 seconds)
between retries after a keepalive response has not been received. IKE keepalives are enabled by default.
To disable IKE keepalives, enter the no form of the isakmp command:
For example, the following command sets the IKE keepalive threshold value to 15 seconds and sets the
retry interval to 10 seconds:
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# isakmp keepalive threshold 15 retry 10
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
The default value for the threshold parameter is 300 for remote-access and 10 for LAN-to-LAN, and the
default value for the retry parameter is 2.
To specify that the central site (“head end”) should never initiate ISAKMP monitoring, enter the
following command:
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# isakmp keepalive threshold infinite
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
Step 8 Specify the ISAKMP hybrid authentication method, XAUTH or hybrid XAUTH.
You use isakmp ikev1-user-authentication command to implement hybrid XAUTH authentication
when you need to use digital certificates for security appliance authentication and a different, legacy
method for remote VPN user authentication, such as RADIUS, TACACS+ or SecurID. Hybrid XAUTH
breaks phase 1 of IKE down into the following two steps, together called hybrid authentication:
a. The security appliance authenticates to the remote VPN user with standard public key techniques.
This establishes an IKE security association that is unidirectionally authenticated.
b. An XAUTH exchange then authenticates the remote VPN user. This extended authentication can use
one of the supported legacy authentication methods.
Note Before the authentication type can be set to hybrid, you must configure the authentication server,
create a preshared key, and configure a trustpoint.
You can use the isakmp ikev1-user-authentication command with the optional interface parameter to
specify a particular interface. When you omit the interface parameter, the command applies to all the
interfaces and serves as a back-up when the per-interface command is not specified. When there are two
isakmp ikev1-user-authentication commands specified for a tunnel group, and one uses the interface
parameter and one does not, the one specifying the interface takes precedence for that particular
interface.
For example, the following commands enable hybrid XAUTH on the inside interface for a tunnel group
called example-group:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group example-group type ipsec-ra
hostname(config)# tunnel-group example-group ipsec-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# isakmp ikev1-user-authentication (inside) hybrid
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
Step 1 Enter tunnel-group ppp-attributes configuration mode, in which you configure the remote-access
tunnel-group PPP attributes, by entering the following command. The prompt changes to indicate the
mode change:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group tunnel-group-name type ipsec-ra
hostname(config)# tunnel-group tunnel-group-name ppp-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)#
For example, the following command designates that the tunnel-group ppp-attributes mode commands
that follow pertain to the tunnel group named TG1. Notice that the prompt changes to indicate that you
are now in tunnel-group ppp-attributes mode:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group TG1 type ipsec-ra
hostname(config)# tunnel-group TG1 ppp-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)#
Step 2 Specify whether to enable authentication using specific protocols for the PPP connection. The protocol
value can be:
• pap—Enables the use of Password Authentication Protocol for the PPP connection.
• chap—Enables the use of Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol for the PPP connection.
• ms-chap-v1 or ms-chap-v2—Enables the use of Microsoft Challenge Handshake Authentication
Protocol, version 1 or version 2 for the PPP connection.
• eap—Enables the use of Extensible Authentication protocol for the PPP connection.
CHAP and MSCHAPv1 are enabled by default.
The syntax of this command is:
hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)# authentication protocol
hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)#
To disable authentication for a specific protocol, use the no form of the command:
hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)# no authentication protocol
hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)#
For example, the following command enables the use of the PAP protocol for a PPP connection.
hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)# authentication pap
hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)#
The following command enables the use of the MS-CHAP, version 2 protocol for a PPP connection:
The following command enables the use of the EAP-PROXY protocol for a PPP connection:
hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)# authentication pap
hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)#
The following command disables the use of the MS-CHAP, version 1 protocol for a PPP connection:
hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)# no authentication ms-chap-v1
hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)#
LAN-to-LAN tunnel groups have fewer parameters than remote-access tunnel groups, and most of these
are the same for both groups. For your convenience in configuring the connection, they are listed
separately here. Any parameters that you do not explicitly configure inherit their values from the default
tunnel group.
For a LAN-to-LAN tunnel, the type is ipsec-l2l.; for example, to create the LAN-to-LAN tunnel group
named docs, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group docs type ipsec-l2l
hostname(config)#
The prompt changes to indicate that you are now in config-general mode, in which you configure the
tunnel-group general attributes.
For example, for the tunnel group named docs, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group_docs general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
For example, the following command specifies the use of the accounting-server group acctgserv1:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# accounting-server-group acctgserv1
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
For example, the following command specifies that the name of the default group policy is MyPolicy:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# default-group-policy MyPolicy
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
Step 1 To configure the tunnel-group IPSec attributes, enter tunnel-group ipsec-attributes configuration mode
by entering the tunnel-group command with the IPSec-attributes keyword.
hostname(config)# tunnel-group tunnel-group-name ipsec-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
For example, the following command enters config-ipsec mode so you can configure the parameters for
the tunnel group named TG1:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group TG1 ipsec-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
The prompt changes to indicate that you are now in tunnel-group ipsec-attributes configuration mode.
Step 2 Specify the preshared key to support IKE connections based on preshared keys.
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# pre-shared-key key
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
For example, the following command specifies the preshared key XYZX to support IKE connections for
an IPSec LAN-to-LAN tunnel group:
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# pre-shared-key xyzx
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
Step 3 Specify whether to validate the identity of the peer using the peer’s certificate:
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# peer-id-validate option
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
The available options are req (required), cert (if supported by certificate), and nocheck (do not check).
The default is req. For example, the following command sets the peer-id-validate option to nocheck:
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# peer-id-validate nocheck
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
Step 4 Specify whether to enable sending of a certificate chain. This action includes the root certificate and any
subordinate CA certificates in the transmission:
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# chain
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
For example, the following command sets the trustpoint name to mytrustpoint:
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# trust-point mytrustpoint
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
For example, the following command sets the ISAKMP keepalive threshold to 15 seconds and sets the
retry interval to 10 seconds.:
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# isakmp keepalive threshold 15 retry 10
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
The default value for the threshold parameter for LAN-to-LAN is 10, and the default value for the retry
parameter is 2.
To specify that the central site (“head end”) should never initiate ISAKMP monitoring, enter the
following command:
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# isakmp keepalive threshold infinite
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
Step 7 Specify the ISAKMP hybrid authentication method, XAUTH or hybrid XAUTH.
Note Before the authentication type can be set to hybrid, you must configure the authentication server,
create a preshared key, and configure a trustpoint.
You can use the isakmp ikev1-user-authentication command with the optional interface parameter to
specify a particular interface. When you omit the interface parameter, the command applies to all the
interfaces and serves as a back-up when the per-interface command is not specified. When there are two
isakmp ikev1-user-authentication commands specified for a tunnel group, and one uses the interface
parameter and one does not, the one specifying the interface takes precedence for that particular
interface.
For example, the following commands enable hybrid XAUTH on the inside interface for a tunnel group
called example-group:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group example-group type ipsec-ra
hostname(config)# tunnel-group example-group ipsec-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# isakmp ikev1-user-authentication (inside) hybrid
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
For example, to create a WebVPN tunnel-group named TunnelGroup3, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group TunnelGroup3 type webvpn
hostname(config)#
Step 1 To configure the general attributes, enter tunnel-group general-attributes command, which enters
tunnel-group general-attributes configuration mode. Note that the prompt changes:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group tunnel_group_name general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
To configure the general attributes for TunnelGroup3, created in the previous section, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group TunnelGroup3 general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
Step 2 Specify the name of the authentication-server group, if any, to use. If you want to use the LOCAL
database for authentication if the specified server group fails, append the keyword LOCAL:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authentication-server-group groupname [LOCAL]
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
For example, to configure the authentication server group named test, and to provide fallback to the
LOCAL server if the authentication server group fails, enter the following command:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authentication-server-group test LOCAL
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
Step 3 Optionally, specify the name of the authorization-server group, if any, to use. If you are not using
authorization, go to Step 6. When you configure this value, users must exist in the authorization database
to connect:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-server-group groupname
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
Use the aaa-server command to configure authorization servers. The maximum length of the group tag
is 16 characters.
For example, the following command specifies the use of the authorization-server group FinGroup:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-server-group FinGroup
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
Step 4 Specify whether to require a successful authorization before allowing a user to connect. The default is
not to require authorization.
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-required
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
Step 5 Specify the attribute or attributes to use in deriving a name for an authorization query from a certificate.
This attribute specifies what part of the subject DN field to use as the username for authorization:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-dn-attributes {primary-attribute
[secondary-attribute] | use-entire-name}
For example, the following command specifies the use of the CN attribute as the username for
authorization:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-dn-attributes CN
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
For example, the following command specifies the use of the accounting-server group comptroller:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# accounting-server-group comptroller
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
Step 7 Optionally, specify the name of the default group policy. The default value is DfltGrpPolicy:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# default-group-policy policyname
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
The following example sets MyDfltGrpPolicy as the name of the default group policy:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# default-group-policy MyDfltGrpPolicy
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
Step 8 Optionally, specify the name or IP address of the DHCP server (up to 10 servers), and the names of the
DHCP address pools (up to 6 pools). Separate the list items with spaces. The defaults are no DHCP
server and no address pool.
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# dhcp-server server1 [...server10]
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# address-pool [(interface name)] address_pool1
[...address_pool6]
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
You configure address pools with the ip local pool command in global configuration mode. See
Chapter 31, “Configuring IP Addresses for VPNs” for information about configuring address pools.
Step 9 Optionally, if your server is a RADIUS, RADIUS with NT, or LDAP server, you can enable password
management.
Note If you are using an LDAP directory server for authentication, password management is supported with
the Sun Microsystems JAVA System Directory Server (formerly named the Sun ONE Directory Server)
and the Microsoft Active Directory.
• Sun—The DN configured on the security appliance to access a Sun directory server must be able to
access the default password policy on that server. We recommend using the directory administrator,
or a user with directory administrator privileges, as the DN. Alternatively, you can place an ACI on
the default password policy.
• Microsoft—You must configure LDAP over SSL to enable password management with Microsoft
Active Directory.
See the “Setting the LDAP Server Type” section on page 13-7 for more information.
This feature, which is enabled by default, warns a user when the current password is about to expire. The
default is to begin warning the user 14 days before expiration:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# password-management
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
If the server is an LDAP server, you can specify the number of days (0 through 180) before expiration
to begin warning the user about the pending expiration:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# password-management [password-expire in days n]
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
When you configure this command, the security appliance notifies the remote user at login that the user’s
current password is about to expire or has expired. The security appliance then offers the user the
opportunity to change the password. If the current password has not yet expired, the user can still log in
using that password. The security appliance ignores this command if RADIUS or LDAP authentication
has not been configured.
Note that this does not change the number of days before the password expires, but rather, the number
of days ahead of expiration that the security appliance starts warning the user that the password is about
to expire.
If you do specify the password-expire-in-days keyword, you must also specify the number of days.
See Configuring Microsoft Active Directory Settings for Password Management, page 30-24 for more
information.
Step 10 Specifying this command with the number of days set to 0 disables this command. The security appliance
does not notify the user of the pending expiration, but the user can change the password after it
expires.Optionally, configure the ability to override an account-disabled indicator from the AAA server,
by entering the override-account-disable command:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# override-account-disable
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
Step 1 To specify the attributes of a WebVPN tunnel-group, enter tunnel-group webvpn-attributes mode by
entering the following command. The prompt changes to indicate the mode change:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group tunnel-group-name webvpn-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#
For example, to specify the webvpn-attributes for the WebVPN tunnel-group named sales, enter the
following command:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group sales webvpn-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#
Step 2 To specify the authentication method to use: AAA, digital certificates, or both, enter the authentication
command. You can specify either aaa or certificate or both, in any order.
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# authentication authentication_method
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#
For example, The following command allows both AAA and certificate authentication:
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# authentication aaa certificate
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#
Applying Customization
Customizations determine the appearance of the windows that the user sees upon login. You configure
the customization parameters as part of configuring WebVPN.
To apply a previously defined web-page customization to change the look-and-feel of the web page that
the user sees at login, enter the customization command in username webvpn configuration mode:
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# customization {none | value customization_name}
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
For example, to use the customization named blueborder, enter the following command:
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# customization value blueborder
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
You configure the customization itself by entering the customization command in WebVPN mode.
The following example shows a command sequence that first establishes a WebVPN customization
named “123” that defines a password prompt. The example then defines a WebVPN tunnel-group named
“test” and uses the customization command to specifies the use of the WebVPN customization named
“123”:
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# customization 123
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# password-prompt Enter password
hostname(config-webvpn)# exit
Step 3 The security appliance queries NetBIOS name servers to map NetBIOS names to IP addresses. WebVPN
requires NetBIOS to access or share files on remote systems. WebVPN uses NetBIOS and the CIFS
protocol to access or share files on remote systems. When you attempt a file-sharing connection to a
Windows computer by using its computer name, the file server you specify corresponds to a specific
NetBIOS name that identifies a resource on the network.
To make the NBNS function operational, you must configure at least one NetBIOS server (host). You
can configure up to three NBNS servers for redundancy. The security appliance uses the first server on
the list for NetBIOS/CIFS name resolution. If the query fails, it uses the next server.
To specify the name of the NBNS (NetBIOS Name Service) server to use for CIFS name resolution, use
the nbns-server command. You can enter up to three server entries. The first server you configure is the
primary server, and the others are backups, for redundancy. You can also specify whether this is a master
browser (rather than just a WINS server), the timeout interval, and the number of retries. A WINS server
or a master browser is typically on the same network as the security appliance, or reachable from that
network. You must specify the timeout interval before the number of retries:
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# nbns-server {host-name | IP_address} [master]
[timeout seconds] [retry number]
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#
For example, to configure the server named nbnsprimary as the primary server and the server
192.168.2.2 as the secondary server, each allowing three retries and having a 5-second timeout, enter the
following command:
hostname(config)# name 192.168.2.1 nbnsprimary
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# nbns-server nbnsprimary master timeout 5 retry 3
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# nbns-server 192.168.2.2 timeout 5 retry 3
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#
The timeout interval can range from 1 through 30 seconds (default 2), and the number of retries can be
in the range 0 through 10 (default 2).
The nbns-server command in tunnel-group webvpn-attributes configuration mode replaces the
deprecated nbns-server command in webvpn configuration mode.
Step 4 To specify alternative names for the group, use the group-alias command. Specifying the group alias
creates one or more alternate names by which the user can refer to a tunnel-group. The group alias that
you specify here appears in the drop-down list on the user’s login page. Each group can have multiple
aliases or no alias, each specified in separate commands. This feature is useful when the same group is
known by several common names, such as “Devtest” and “QA”.
For each group alias, enter a group-alias command. Each alias is enabled by default. You can optionally
explicitly enable or disable each alias:
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# group-alias alias [enable | disable]
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#
For example, to enable the aliases QA and Devtest for a tunnel-group named QA, enter the following
commands:
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# group-alias QA enable
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# group-alias Devtest enable
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#
Note The WebVPN tunnel-group-list must be enabled for the (dropdown) group list to appear.
Step 5 To specify incoming URLs or IP addresses for the group, use the group-url command. Specifying a
group URL or IP address eliminates the need for the user to select a group at login. When a user logs in,
the security appliance looks for the user’s incoming URL or address in the tunnel-group-policy table. If
it finds the URL or address and if group-url is enabled in the tunnel group, then the security appliance
automatically selects the associated tunnel group and presents the user with only the username and
password fields in the login window. This simplifies the user interface and has the added advantage of
never exposing the list of groups to the user. The login window that the user sees uses the customizations
configured for that tunnel group.
If the URL or address is disabled and group-alias is configured, then the dropdown list of groups is also
displayed, and the user must make a selection.
You can configure multiple URLs or addresses (or none) for a group. Each URL or address can be
enabled or disabled individually. You must use a separate group-url command for each URL or address
specified. You must specify the entire URL or address, including either the http or https protocol.
You cannot associate the same URL or address with multiple groups. The security appliance verifies the
uniqueness of the URL or address before accepting the URL or address for a tunnel group.
For each group URL or address, enter a group-URL command. You can optionally explicitly enable (the
default) or disable each URL or alias:
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# group-url url [enable | disable]
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#
For example, to enable the group URLs http://www.cisco.com and http://192.168.10.10 for the
tunnel-group named RadiusServer, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group RadiusServer type webvpn
hostname(config)# tunnel-group RadiusServer general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authentication server-group RADIUS
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# accounting-server-group RADIUS
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# tunnel-group RadiusServer webvpn-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# group-alias “Cisco Remote Access” enable
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# group-url http://www.cisco.com enable
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# group-url http://192.168.10.10 enable
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#
For a more extensive example, see Customizing Login Windows for WebVPN Users, page 30-23.
Step 6 To specify the DNS server to use for a WebVPN tunnel group, enter the dns-group command. The
default value is DefaultDNS:
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# dns-group {hostname | ip_address}
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#
The dns-group command resolves the hostname to the appropriate DNS server for the tunnel group. For
example, to specify the use of the DNS server named server1, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# name 10.10.10.1 server1
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# dns-group server1
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#
Step 7 (Optional) To specify a VPN feature policy if you use the Cisco Secure Desktop Manager to set the
Group-Based Policy attribute to “Use Failure Group-Policy” or “Use Success Group-Policy, if criteria
match,” use the hic-fail-group-policy command. The default value is DfltGrpPolicy.
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# hic-fail-group-policy name
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#
Name is the name of a group policy created for a WebVPN tunnel group.
This policy is an alternative group policy to differentiate access rights for the following CSD clients:
• Clients that match a CSD location entry set to “Use Failure Group-Policy.”
• Clients that match a CSD location entry set to “Use Success Group-Policy, if criteria match,” and
then fail to match the configured Group-Based Policy criteria. For more information, see the Cisco
Secure Desktop Configuration Guide for Cisco ASA 5500 Series Administrators.
The following example specifies an alternative group policy named group2:
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# hic-fail-group-policy group2
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#
Note The security appliance does not use this attribute if you set the VPN feature policy to “Always
use Success Group-Policy.”
For more information, see the Cisco Secure Desktop Configuration Guide for Cisco ASA 5500 Series
Administration Guide.
Step 1 In webvpn mode, define a WebVPN customization, in this case named salesgui and change the default
logo to mycompanylogo.gif. You must have previously loaded mycompanylogo.gif onto the flash
memory of the security appliance and saved the configuration. See the WebVPN chapter for details.
hostname# webvpn
hostname (config-webvpn)# customization value salesgui
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# logo file disk0:\mycompanylogo.gif
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)#
Step 2 In global configuration mode, set up a username and associate with it the WebVPN customization you’ve
just defined:
hostname# username seller attributes
hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# customization value salesgui
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# exit
hostname(config-username)# exit
hostname#
Step 4 Specify that you want to use the salesgui customization for this tunnel group:
hostname# tunnel-group sales webvpn-attributes
Step 5 Set the group URL to the address that the user enters into the browser to log in to the security appliance;
for example, if the security appliance has the IP address 192.168.3.3, set the group URL to
https://192.168.3.3:
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# group-url https://192.168.3.3.
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#
If a port number is required for a successful login, include the port number, preceded by a colon. The
security appliance maps this URL to the sales tunnel group and applies the salesgui customization profile
to the login screen that the user sees upon logging in to https://192.168.3.3.
Note If you are using an LDAP directory server for authentication, password management is supported with
the Sun Microsystems JAVA System Directory Server (formerly named the Sun ONE Directory Server)
and the Microsoft Active Directory.
• Sun—The DN configured on the security appliance to access a Sun directory server must be able to
access the default password policy on that server. We recommend using the directory administrator,
or a user with directory administrator privileges, as the DN. Alternatively, you can place an ACI on
the default password policy.
• Microsoft—You must configure LDAP over SSL to enable password management with Microsoft
Active Directory.
See the “Setting the LDAP Server Type” section on page 13-7 for more information.
To use password management with Microsoft Active Directory, you must set certain Active Directory
parameters as well as configuring password management on the security appliance. This section
describes the Active Directory settings associated with various password management actions. These
descriptions assume that you have also enabled password management on the security appliance and
configured the corresponding password management attributes. The specific steps in the following
sections refer to Active Directory terminology under Windows 2000.
• Using Active Directory to Force the User to Change Password at Next Logon, page 30-24.
• Using Active Directory to Specify Maximum Password Age, page 30-26.
• Using Active Directory to Override an Account Disabled AAA Indicator, page 30-27
• Using Active Directory to Enforce Password Complexity, page 30-29.
The following sections assume that you are using an LDAP directory server for authentication.
Using Active Directory to Force the User to Change Password at Next Logon
To force a user to change the user password at the next logon, specify the password-management
command in tunnel-group general-attributes configuration mode on the security appliance and do the
following steps under Active Directory:
Step 1 Select to Start > Programs > Administrative Tools > Active Directory Users and Computers
(Figure 30-1).
The next time this user logs on, the security appliance displays the following prompt: “New password
required. Password change required. You must enter a new password with a minimum length n to
continue.” You can set the minimum required password length, n, as part of the Active Directory
configuration at Start > Programs > Administrative Tools > Domain Security Policy > Windows
Settings > Security Settings > Account Policies > Password Policy. Select Minimum password length.
Step 1 Select Start > Programs > Administrative Tools > Domain Security Policy > Windows Settings >
Security Settings > Account Policies > Password Policy.
Step 2 Double-click Maximum password age. This opens the Security Policy Setting dialog box.
Step 3 Check the Define this policy setting check box and specify the maximum password age, in days, that you
want to allow.
Step 1 Select Start > Programs > Administrative Tools > Active Directory Users and Computers.
Step 2 Right-click Username > Properties > Account and select Disable Account from the menu.
The user should be able to log on successfully, even though a AAA server provides an account-disabled
indicator.
Step 1 Select Start > Programs > Administrative Tools > Domain Security Policy.
Step 2 Select Windows Settings > Security Settings > Account Policies > Password Policy.
Step 3 Double-click Minimum Password Length. This opens the Security Policy Setting dialog box.
Step 4 Check the Define this policy setting check box and specify the minimum number of characters that the
password must contain.
Step 1 Select Start > Programs > Administrative Tools > Domain Security Policy. Select Windows Settings >
Security Settings > Account Policies > Password Policy.
Step 2 Double-click Password must meet complexity requirements to open the Security Policy Setting dialog
box.
Step 3 Check the Define this policy setting check box and select Enable.
Enforcing password complexity takes effect only when the user changes passwords; for example, when
you have configured Enforce password change at next login or Password expires in n days. At login, the
user receives a prompt to enter a new password, and the system will accept only a complex password.
Group Policies
This section describes group policies and how to configure them. It includes the following sections:
• Default Group Policy, page 30-31
• Configuring Group Policies, page 30-33
A group policy is a set of user-oriented attribute/value pairs for IPSec connections that are stored either
internally (locally) on the device or externally on a RADIUS server. The tunnel group uses a group policy
that sets terms for user connections after the tunnel is established. Group policies let you apply whole
sets of attributes to a user or a group of users, rather than having to specify each attribute individually
for each user.
Enter the group-policy commands in global configuration mode to assign a group policy to users or to
modify a group policy for specific users.
The security appliance includes a default group policy. In addition to the default group policy, which you
can modify but not delete, you can create one or more group policies specific to your environment.
You can configure internal and external group policies. Internal groups are configured on the security
appliance’s internal database. External groups are configured on an external authentication server, such
as RADIUS. Group policies include the following attributes:
• Identity
• Server definitions
Note The default group policy is always internal. Despite the fact that the command syntax is
hostname(config)# group-policy DfltGrpPolicy { internal | external}, you cannot change the type
to external.
To change any of the attributes of the default group policy, use the group-policy attributes command
to enter attributes mode, then specify the commands to change whatever attributes that you want to
modify:
hostname(config)# group-policy DfltGrpPolicy attributes
The default group policy, DfltGrpPolicy, that the security appliance provides is as follows:
group-policy DfltGrpPolicy internal
group-policy DfltGrpPolicy attributes
banner none
wins-server none
dns-server none
dhcp-network-scope none
vpn-access-hours none
vpn-simultaneous-logins 2000
vpn-idle-timeout none
vpn-session-timeout none
vpn-filter none
You can modify the default group policy, and you can also create one or more group policies specific to
your environment.
Note External group names on the security appliance refer to user names on the RADIUS server. In other
words, if you configure external group X on the security appliance, the RADIUS server sees the query
as an authentication request for user X. So external groups are really just user accounts on the RADIUS
server that have special meaning to the security appliance. If your external group attributes exist in the
same RADIUS server as the users that you plan to authenticate, there must be no name duplication
between them.
The security appliance supports user authorization on an external LDAP or RADIUS server. Before you
configure the security appliance to use an external server, you must configure the server with the correct
security appliance authorization attributes and, from a subset of these attributes, assign specific
permissions to individual users. Follow the instructions in Appendix E, “Configuring an External Server
for Authorization and Authentication” to configure your external server.
To configure an external group policy, do the following steps specify a name and type for the group
policy, along with the server-group name and a password:
hostname(config)# group-policy group_policy_name type server-group server_group_name
password server_password
hostname(config)#
Note For an external group policy, RADIUS is the only supported AAA server type.
For example, the following command creates an external group policy named ExtGroup that gets its
attributes from an external RADIUS server named ExtRAD and specifies that the password to use when
retrieving the attributes is newpassword:
hostname(config)# group-policy ExtGroup external server-group ExtRAD password newpassword
hostname(config)#
Note You can configure several vendor-specific attributes (VSAs), as described in Appendix E, “Configuring
an External Server for Authorization and Authentication”. If a RADIUS server is configured to return
the Class attribute (#25), the security appliance uses that attribute to authenticate the Group Name. On
the RADIUS server, the attribute must be formatted as: OU=groupname; where groupname is identical
to the Group Name configured on the security appliance—for example, OU=Finance.
For example, the following command creates the internal group policy named GroupPolicy1:
hostname(config)# group-policy GroupPolicy1 internal
hostname(config)#
The prompt changes to indicate the mode change. The group-policy-attributes mode lets you configure
attribute-value pairs for a specified group policy. In group-policy-attributes mode, explicitly configure
the attribute-value pairs that you do not want to inherit from the default group. The commands to do this
are described in the following sections.
The first IP address specified is that of the primary WINS server. The second (optional) IP address is
that of the secondary WINS server. Specifying the none keyword instead of an IP address sets WINS
servers to a null value, which allows no WINS servers and prevents inheriting a value from a default or
specified group policy.
Every time that you enter the wins-server command, you overwrite the existing setting. For example, if
you configure WINS server x.x.x.x and then configure WINS server y.y.y.y, the second command
overwrites the first, and y.y.y.y becomes the sole WINS server. The same is true for multiple servers. To
add a WINS server rather than overwrite previously configured servers, include the IP addresses of all
WINS servers when you enter this command.
The following example shows how to configure WINS servers with the IP addresses 10.10.10.15 and
10.10.10.30 for the group policy named FirstGroup:
The first IP address specified is that of the primary DNS server. The second (optional) IP address is that
of the secondary DNS server. Specifying the none keyword instead of an IP address sets DNS servers to
a null value, which allows no DNS servers and prevents inheriting a value from a default or specified
group policy.
Every time that you enter the dns-server command you overwrite the existing setting. For example, if
you configure DNS server x.x.x.x and then configure DNS server y.y.y.y, the second command
overwrites the first, and y.y.y.y becomes the sole DNS server. The same is true for multiple servers. To
add a DNS server rather than overwrite previously configured servers, include the IP addresses of all
DNS servers when you enter this command.
The following example shows how to configure DNS servers with the IP addresses 10.10.10.15, and
10.10.10.30 for the group policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# dns-server value 10.10.10.15 10.10.10.30
hostname(config-group-policy)#
DHCP scope specifies the range of IP addresses (that is, a subnetwork) that the security appliance DHCP
server should use to assign addresses to users of this group policy.
The following example shows how to set an IP subnetwork of 10.10.85.0 (specifying the address range
of 10.10.85.0 through 10.10.85.255) for the group policy named First Group:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# dhcp-network-scope 10.10.85.0
Step 1 Set the VPN access hours. To do this, you associate a group policy with a configured time-range policy,
using the vpn-access-hours command in group-policy configuration mode.
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-access-hours value {time-range | none}
A group policy can inherit a time-range value from a default or specified group policy. To prevent this
inheritance, enter the none keyword instead of the name of a time-range in this command. This keyword
sets VPN access hours to a null value, which allows no time-range policy.
The time-range variable is the name of a set of access hours defined in global configuration mode using
the time-range command. The following example shows how to associate the group policy named
FirstGroup with a time-range policy called 824:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-access-hours value 824
Step 2 Specify the number of simultaneous logins allowed for any user, using the vpn-simultaneous-logins
command in group-policy configuration mode.
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-simultaneous-logins integer
The default value is 3. The range is an integer in the range 0 through 2147483647. A group policy can
inherit this value from another group policy. Enter 0 to disable login and prevent user access. The
following example shows how to allow a maximum of 4 simultaneous logins for the group policy named
FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-simultaneous-logins 4
hostname(config-group-policy)#
Note While the maximum limit for the number of simultaneous logins is very large, allowing several
could compromise security and affect performance.
Step 3 Configure the user timeout period by entering the vpn-idle-timeout command in group-policy
configuration mode or in username configuration mode:
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-idle-timeout {minutes | none}
hostname(config-group-policy)#
The minimum time is 1 minute, and the maximum time is 35791394 minutes. The default is 30 minutes.
If there is no communication activity on the connection in this period, the security appliance terminates
the connection.
A group policy can inherit this value from another group policy. To prevent inheriting a value, enter the
none keyword instead of specifying a number of minutes with this command. The none keyword also
permits an unlimited idle timeout period. It sets the idle timeout to a null value, thereby disallowing an
idle timeout.
The following example shows how to set a VPN idle timeout of 15 minutes for the group policy named
FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-idle-timeout 15
hostname(config-group-policy)#
Step 4 Configure a maximum amount of time for VPN connections, using the vpn-session-timeout command
in group-policy configuration mode or in username configuration mode.
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-session-timeout {minutes | none}
hostname(config-group-policy)#
The minimum time is 1 minute, and the maximum time is 35791394 minutes. There is no default value.
At the end of this period of time, the security appliance terminates the connection.
A group policy can inherit this value from another group policy. To prevent inheriting a value, enter the
none keyword instead of specifying a number of minutes with this command. Specifying the none
keyword permits an unlimited session timeout period and sets session timeout with a null value, which
disallows a session timeout.
The following example shows how to set a VPN session timeout of 180 minutes for the group policy
named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-session-timeout 180
hostname(config-group-policy)#
Step 5 Specify the name of the ACL to use for VPN connections, using the vpn-filter command in group policy
mode. (You can also configure this attribute in username mode, in which case the value configured under
username supersedes the group-policy value.)
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-filter {value ACL name | none}
hostname(config-group-policy)#
You configure ACLs to permit or deny various types of traffic for this group policy. You then enter the
vpn-filter command to apply those ACLs.
To remove the ACL, including a null value created by entering the vpn-filter none command, enter the
no form of this command. The no option allows inheritance of a value from another group policy.
A group policy can inherit this value from another group policy. To prevent inheriting a value, enter the
none keyword instead of specifying an ACL name. The none keyword indicates that there is no access
list and sets a null value, thereby disallowing an access list.
The following example shows how to set a filter that invokes an access list named acl_vpn for the group
policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-filter acl_vpn
hostname(config-group-policy)#
Step 6 Specify the VPN tunnel type (IPSec or WebVPN) for this group policy.
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-tunnel-protocol {webvpn | IPSec | l2tp-ipsec}
hostname(config-group-policy)#
The default is IPSec. To remove the attribute from the running configuration, enter the no form of this
command.
hostname(config-group-policy)# no vpn-tunnel-protocol [webvpn | IPSec | l2tp-ipsec]
hostname(config-group-policy)#
Step 1 Specify whether to let users store their login passwords on the client system, using the
password-storage command with the enable keyword in group-policy configuration mode. To disable
password storage, use the password-storage command with the disable keyword.
hostname(config-group-policy)# password-storage {enable | disable}
hostname(config-group-policy)#
For security reasons, password storage is disabled by default. Enable password storage only on systems
that you know to be in secure sites.
To remove the password-storage attribute from the running configuration, enter the no form of this
command:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no password-storage
hostname(config-group-policy)#
Specifying the no form enables inheritance of a value for password-storage from another group policy.
This command does not apply to interactive hardware client authentication or individual user
authentication for hardware clients.
The following example shows how to enable password storage for the group policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# password-storage enable
hostname(config-group-policy)#
To enable LZS IP compression, enter the ip-comp command with the enable keyword in group-policy
configuration mode. To disable IP compression, enter the ip-comp command with the disable keyword.
To remove the ip-comp attribute from the running configuration, enter the no form of this command.
This enables inheritance of a value from another group policy.
hostname(config-group-policy)# no ip-comp
hostname(config-group-policy)#
Enabling data compression might speed up data transmission rates for remote dial-in users connecting
with modems.
Caution Data compression increases the memory requirement and CPU usage for each user session and
consequently decreases the overall throughput of the security appliance. For this reason, we recommend
that you enable data compression only for remote users connecting with a modem. Design a group policy
specific to modem users, and enable compression only for them.
Step 3 Specify whether to require that users reauthenticate on IKE rekey by using the re-xauth command with
the enable keyword in group-policy configuration mode. If you enable reauthentication on IKE rekey,
the security appliance prompts the user to enter a username and password during initial Phase 1 IKE
negotiation and also prompts for user authentication whenever an IKE rekey occurs. Reauthentication
provides additional security.
If the configured rekey interval is very short, users might find the repeated authorization requests
inconvenient. To avoid repeated authorization requests, disable reauthentication. To check the
configured rekey interval, in monitoring mode, enter the show crypto ipsec sa command to view the
security association lifetime in seconds and lifetime in kilobytes of data. To disable user reauthentication
on IKE rekey, enter the disable keyword. Reauthentication on IKE rekey is disabled by default.
hostname(config-group-policy)# re-xauth {enable | disable}
hostname(config-group-policy)#
To enable inheritance of a value for reauthentication on IKE rekey from another group policy, remove
the re-xauth attribute from the running configuration by entering the no form of this command.
hostname(config-group-policy)# no re-xauth
hostname(config-group-policy)#
Note Reauthentication fails if there is no user at the other end of the connection.
Step 4 Specify whether to restrict remote users to access only through the tunnel group, using the group-lock
command in group-policy configuration mode.
hostname(config-group-policy)# group-lock {value tunnel-grp-name | none}
hostname(config-group-policy)# no group-lock
hostname(config-group-policy)#
The tunnel-grp-name variable specifies the name of an existing tunnel group that the security appliance
requires for the user to connect. Group-lock restricts users by checking if the group configured in the
VPN client is the same as the tunnel group to which the user is assigned. If it is not, the security appliance
prevents the user from connecting. If you do not configure group-lock, the security appliance
authenticates users without regard to the assigned group. Group locking is disabled by default.
To remove the group-lock attribute from the running configuration, enter the no form of this command.
This option allows inheritance of a value from another group policy.
To disable group-lock, enter the group-lock command with the none keyword. The none keyword sets
group-lock to a null value, thereby allowing no group-lock restriction. It also prevents inheriting a
group-lock value from a default or specified group policy
Step 5 Specify whether to enable perfect forward secrecy. In IPSec negotiations, perfect forward secrecy
ensures that each new cryptographic key is unrelated to any previous key. A group policy can inherit a
value for perfect forward secrecy from another group policy. Perfect forward secrecy is disabled by
default. To enable perfect forward secrecy, use the pfs command with the enable keyword in
group-policy configuration mode.
hostname(config-group-policy)# pfs {enable | disable}
hostname(config-group-policy)#
To disable perfect forward secrecy, enter the pfs command with the disable keyword.
To remove the perfect forward secrecy attribute from the running configuration and prevent inheriting a
value, enter the no form of this command.
hostname(config-group-policy)# no pfs
hostname(config-group-policy)#
To delete a banner, enter the no form of this command. Be aware that using the no version of the
command deletes all banners for the group policy.
A group policy can inherit this value from another group policy. To prevent inheriting a value, enter the
none keyword instead of specifying a value for the banner string, as follows:
hostname(config-group-policy)# banner {value banner_string | none}
The following example shows how to create a banner for the group policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# banner value Welcome to Cisco Systems 7.0.
To use IPSec over UDP, you must also configure the ipsec-udp-port command, as described below.
To disable IPSec over UDP, enter the disable keyword. To remove the IPSec over UDP attribute from
the running configuration, enter the no form of this command. This enables inheritance of a value for
IPSec over UDP from another group policy.
The Cisco VPN client must also be configured to use IPSec over UDP (it is configured to use it by
default). The VPN 3002 requires no configuration to use IPSec over UDP.
The following example shows how to set IPSec over UDP for the group policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# ipsec-udp enable
If you enabled IPSec over UDP, you must also configure the ipsec-udp-port command in group-policy
configuration mode. This command sets a UDP port number for IPSec over UDP. In IPSec negotiations,
the security appliance listens on the configured port and forwards UDP traffic for that port even if other
filter rules drop UDP traffic. The port numbers can range from 4001 through 49151. The default port
value is 10000.
To disable the UDP port, enter the no form of this command. This enables inheritance of a value for the
IPSec over UDP port from another group policy.
The following example shows how to set an IPSec UDP port to port 4025 for the group policy named
FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# ipsec-udp-port 4025
Set the rules for tunneling traffic by specifying the split-tunneling policy:
hostname(config-group-policy)# split-tunnel-policy {tunnelall | tunnelspecified |
excludespecified}
hostname(config-group-policy)# no split-tunnel-policy
The default is to tunnel all traffic. To set a split tunneling policy, enter the split-tunnel-policy command
in group-policy configuration mode. To remove the split-tunnel-policy attribute from the running
configuration, enter the no form of this command. This enables inheritance of a value for split tunneling
from another group policy.
The excludespecified keyword defines a list of networks to which traffic goes in the clear. This feature
is useful for remote users who want to access devices on their local network, such as printers, while they
are connected to the corporate network through a tunnel. This option applies only to the Cisco VPN
client.
The tunnelall keyword specifies that no traffic goes in the clear or to any other destination than the
security appliance. This, in effect, disables split tunneling. Remote users reach Internet networks
through the corporate network and do not have access to local networks. This is the default option.
The tunnelspecified keyword tunnels all traffic from or to the specified networks. This option enables
split tunneling. It lets you create a network list of addresses to tunnel. Data to all other addresses travels
in the clear and is routed by the remote user’s Internet service provider.
Note Split tunneling is primarily a traffic management feature, not a security feature. For optimum security,
we recommend that you do not enable split tunneling.
The following example shows how to set a split tunneling policy of tunneling only specified networks
for the group policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# split-tunnel-policy tunnelspecified
Create a network list for split tunneling using the split-tunnel-network-list command in group-policy
configuration mode.
Split tunneling network lists distinguish networks that require traffic to travel across the tunnel from
those that do not require tunneling. The security appliance makes split tunneling decisions on the basis
of a network list, which is an ACL that consists of a list of addresses on the private network. Only
standard-type ACLs are allowed.
The value access-list name parameter identifies an access list that enumerates the networks to tunnel or
not tunnel.
The none keyword indicates that there is no network list for split tunneling; the security appliance
tunnels all traffic. Specifying the none keyword sets a split tunneling network list with a null value,
thereby disallowing split tunneling. It also prevents inheriting a default split tunneling network list from
a default or specified group policy.
To delete a network list, enter the no form of this command. To delete all split tunneling network lists,
enter the no split-tunnel-network-list command without arguments. This command deletes all
configured network lists, including a null list if you created one by entering the none keyword.
When there are no split tunneling network lists, users inherit any network lists that exist in the default
or specified group policy. To prevent users from inheriting such network lists, enter the
split-tunnel-network-list none command.
The following example shows how to set a network list called FirstList for the group policy named
FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# split-tunnel-network-list FirstList
The security appliance passes the default domain name to the IPSec client to append to DNS queries that
omit the domain field. When there are no default domain names, users inherit the default domain name
in the default group policy. To specify the default domain name for users of the group policy, enter the
default-domain command in group-policy configuration mode. To delete a domain name, enter the no
form of this command.
hostname(config-group-policy)# default-domain {value domain-name | none}
hostname(config-group-policy)# no default-domain [domain-name]
The value domain-name parameter identifies the default domain name for the group. To specify that
there is no default domain name, enter the none keyword. This command sets a default domain name
with a null value, which disallows a default domain name and prevents inheriting a default domain name
from a default or specified group policy.
To delete all default domain names, enter the no default-domain command without arguments. This
command deletes all configured default domain names, including a null list if you created one by
entering the default-domain command with the none keyword. The no form allows inheriting a domain
name.
The following example shows how to set a default domain name of FirstDomain for the group policy
named FirstGroup:
Enter a list of domains to be resolved through the split tunnel. Enter the split-dns command in
group-policy configuration mode. To delete a list, enter the no form of this command.
When there are no split tunneling domain lists, users inherit any that exist in the default group policy.
To prevent users from inheriting such split tunneling domain lists, enter the split-dns command with the
none keyword.
To delete all split tunneling domain lists, enter the no split-dns command without arguments. This
deletes all configured split tunneling domain lists, including a null list created by issuing the split-dns
command with the none keyword.
The parameter value domain-name provides a domain name that the security appliance resolves through
the split tunnel. The none keyword indicates that there is no split DNS list. It also sets a split DNS list
with a null value, thereby disallowing a split DNS list, and prevents inheriting a split DNS list from a
default or specified group policy. The syntax of the command is as follows:
hostname(config-group-policy)# split-dns {value domain-name1 [domain-name2...
domain-nameN] | none}
hostname(config-group-policy)# no split-dns [domain-name domain-name2 domain-nameN]
Enter a single space to separate each entry in the list of domains. There is no limit on the number of
entries, but the entire string can be no longer than 255 characters. You can use only alphanumeric
characters, hyphens (-), and periods (.). If the default domain name is to be resolved through the tunnel,
you must explicitly include that name in this list.
The following example shows how to configure the domains Domain1, Domain2, Domain3, and
Domain4 to be resolved through split tunneling for the group policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# split-dns value Domain1 Domain2 Domain3 Domain4
A Microsoft XP anomaly results in the corruption of domain names if split tunnel options exceed 255
bytes. To avoid this problem, the security appliance limits the number of routes it sends to 27 to 40
routes, with the number of routes dependent on the classes of the routes.
DHCP Intercept lets Microsoft Windows XP clients use split-tunneling with the security appliance. The
security appliance replies directly to the Microsoft Windows XP client DHCP Inform message,
providing that client with the subnet mask, domain name, and classless static routes for the tunnel IP
address. For Windows clients prior to Windows XP, DHCP Intercept provides the domain name and
subnet mask. This is useful in environments in which using a DHCP server is not advantageous.
The intercept-dhcp command enables or disables DHCP intercept. The syntax of this command is as
follows:
[no] intercept-dhcp
The netmask variable provides the subnet mask for the tunnel IP address. The no version of the command
removes the DHCP intercept from the configuration.
The following example shows how to set DHCP Intercepts for the group policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# intercept-dhcp enable
Secure unit authentication provides additional security by requiring VPN hardware clients to
authenticate with a username and password each time that the client initiates a tunnel. With this feature
enabled, the hardware client does not have a saved username and password. Secure unit authentication
is disabled by default.
Note With this feature enabled, to bring up a VPN tunnel, a user must be present to enter the username and
password.
Secure unit authentication requires that you have an authentication server group configured for the
tunnel group the hardware client(s) use. If you require secure unit authentication on the primary security
appliance, be sure to configure it on any backup servers as well.
Specify whether to enable secure unit authentication by entering the secure-unit-authentication
command with the enable keyword in group-policy configuration mode.
hostname(config-group-policy)# secure-unit-authentication {enable | disable}
hostname(config-group-policy)# no secure-unit-authentication
To disable secure unit authentication, enter the disable keyword. To remove the secure unit
authentication attribute from the running configuration, enter the no form of this command. This option
allows inheritance of a value for secure unit authentication from another group policy.
The following example shows how to enable secure unit authentication for the group policy named
FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# secure-unit-authentication enable
User authentication is disabled by default. When enabled, user authentication requires that individual
users behind a hardware client authenticate to gain access to the network across the tunnel. Individual
users authenticate according to the order of authentication servers that you configure.
Specify whether to enable user authentication by entering the user-authentication command with the
enable keyword in group-policy configuration mode.
hostname(config-group-policy)# user-authentication {enable | disable}
hostname(config-group-policy)# no user-authentication
To disable user authentication, enter the disable keyword. To remove the user authentication attribute
from the running configuration, enter the no form of this command. This option allows inheritance of a
value for user authentication from another group policy.
If you require user authentication on the primary security appliance, be sure to configure it on any
backup servers as well.
The following example shows how to enable user authentication for the group policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# user-authentication enable
Set an idle timeout for individual users behind hardware clients by entering the
user-authentication-idle-timeout command in group-policy configuration mode. If there is no
communication activity by a user behind a hardware client in the idle timeout period, the security
appliance terminates the client’s access:
hostname(config-group-policy)# user-authentication-idle-timeout {minutes | none}
hostname(config-group-policy)# no user-authentication-idle-timeout
Note The user-authentication-idle-timeout command terminates only the client’s access through the VPN
tunnel, not the VPN tunnel itself.
The minutes parameter specifies the number of minutes in the idle timeout period. The minimum is 1
minute, the default is 30 minutes, and the maximum is 35791394 minutes.
To delete the idle timeout value, enter the no form of this command. This option allows inheritance of
an idle timeout value from another group policy.
To prevent inheriting an idle timeout value, enter the user-authentication-idle-timeout command with
the none keyword. This command sets the idle timeout with a null value, which disallows an idle timeout
and prevents inheriting an user authentication idle timeout value from a default or specified group policy.
The following example shows how to set an idle timeout value of 45 minutes for the group policy named
FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# user-authentication-idle-timeout 45
You can allow Cisco IP phones to bypass individual user authentication behind a hardware client. To
enable IP Phone Bypass, enter the ip-phone-bypass command with the enable keyword in group-policy
configuration mode. IP Phone Bypass lets IP phones behind hardware clients connect without
undergoing user authentication processes. IP Phone Bypass is disabled by default. If enabled, secure unit
authentication remains in effect.
To disable IP Phone Bypass, enter the disable keyword. To remove the IP phone Bypass attribute from
the running configuration, enter the no form of this command. This option allows inheritance of a value
for IP Phone Bypass from another group policy:
hostname(config-group-policy)# ip-phone-bypass {enable | disable}
hostname(config-group-policy)# no ip-phone-bypass
When LEAP Bypass is enabled, LEAP packets from wireless devices behind a VPN 3002 hardware
client travel across a VPN tunnel prior to user authentication. This action lets workstations using Cisco
wireless access point devices establish LEAP authentication and then authenticate again per user
authentication. LEAP Bypass is disabled by default.
To allow LEAP packets from Cisco wireless access points to bypass individual users authentication,
enter the leap-bypass command with the enable keyword in group-policy configuration mode. To
disable LEAP Bypass, enter the disable keyword. To remove the LEAP Bypass attribute from the
running configuration, enter the no form of this command. This option allows inheritance of a value for
LEAP Bypass from another group policy:
hostname(config-group-policy)# leap-bypass {enable | disable}
hostname(config-group-policy)# no leap-bypass
Note IEEE 802.1X is a standard for authentication on wired and wireless networks. It provides wireless LANs
with strong mutual authentication between clients and authentication servers, which can provide
dynamic per-user, per session wireless encryption privacy (WEP) keys, removing administrative burdens
and security issues that are present with static WEP keys.
Cisco Systems has developed an 802.1X wireless authentication type called Cisco LEAP. LEAP
(Lightweight Extensible Authentication Protocol) implements mutual authentication between a wireless
client on one side of a connection and a RADIUS server on the other side. The credentials used for
authentication, including a password, are always encrypted before they are transmitted over the wireless
medium.
Cisco LEAP authenticates wireless clients to RADIUS servers. It does not include RADIUS accounting
services.
This feature does not work as intended if you enable interactive hardware client authentication.
Caution There might be security risks to your network in allowing any unauthenticated traffic to traverse the
tunnel.
The following example shows how to set LEAP Bypass for the group policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# leap-bypass enable
Network extension mode lets hardware clients present a single, routable network to the remote private
network over the VPN tunnel. IPSec encapsulates all traffic from the private network behind the
hardware client to networks behind the security appliance. PAT does not apply. Therefore, devices
behind the security appliance have direct access to devices on the private network behind the hardware
client over the tunnel, and only over the tunnel, and vice versa. The hardware client must initiate the
tunnel, but after the tunnel is up, either side can initiate data exchange.
Enable network extension mode for hardware clients by entering the nem command with the enable
keyword in group-policy configuration mode:
hostname(config-group-policy)# nem {enable | disable}
hostname(config-group-policy)# no nem
To disable NEM, enter the disable keyword. To remove the NEM attribute from the running
configuration, enter the no form of this command. This option allows inheritance of a value from another
group policy.
The following example shows how to set NEM for the group policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# nem enable
Note If you are using hostnames, it is wise to have backup DNS and WINS servers on a separate network from
that of the primary DNS and WINS servers. Otherwise, if clients behind a hardware client obtain DNS
and WINS information from the hardware client via DHCP, and the connection to the primary server is
lost, and the backup servers have different DNS and WINS information, clients cannot be updated until
the DHCP lease expires. In addition, if you use hostnames and the DNS server is unavailable, significant
delays can occur.
To configure backup servers, enter the backup-servers command in group-policy configuration mode:
hostname(config-group-policy)# backup-servers {server1 server2... server10 |
clear-client-config | keep-client-config}
To remove a backup server, enter the no form of this command with the backup server specified. To
remove the backup-servers attribute from the running configuration and enable inheritance of a value for
backup-servers from another group policy, enter the no form of this command without arguments.
hostname(config-group-policy)# no backup-servers [server1 server2... server10 |
clear-client-config | keep-client-config]
The clear-client-config keyword specifies that the client uses no backup servers. The security appliance
pushes a null server list.
The keep-client-config keyword specifies that the security appliance sends no backup server
information to the client. The client uses its own backup server list, if configured. This is the default.
The server1 server 2.... server10 parameter list is a space-delimited, priority-ordered list of servers for
the VPN client to use when the primary security appliance is unavailable. This list identifies servers by
IP address or hostname. The list can be 500 characters long, and it can contain up to10 entries.
The following example shows how to configure backup servers with IP addresses 10.10.10.1 and
192.168.10.14, for the group policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# backup-servers 10.10.10.1 192.168.10.14
Step 1 Configure a Microsoft Internet Explorer browser proxy server and port for a client PC by entering the
msie-proxy server command in group-policy configuration mode:
hostname(config-group-policy)# msie-proxy server {value server[:port] | none}
hostname(config-group-policy)#
The default value is none. To remove the attribute from the configuration, use the no form of the
command.
hostname(config-group-policy)# no msie-proxy server
hostname(config-group-policy)#
The line containing the proxy server IP address or hostname and the port number must be less than 100
characters long.
The following example shows how to configure the IP address 192.168.10.1 as a Microsoft Internet
Explorer proxy server, using port 880, for the group policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# msie-proxy server value 192.168.21.1:880
hostname(config-group-policy)#
Step 2 Configure the Microsoft Internet Explorer browser proxy actions (“methods”) for a client PC by entering
the msie-proxy method command in group-policy configuration mode.
hostname(config-group-policy)# msie-proxy method [auto-detect | no-modify | no-proxy |
use-server]
hostname(config-group-policy)#
The default value is use-server. To remove the attribute from the configuration, use the no form of the
command.
hostname(config-group-policy)# no msie-proxy method [auto-detect | no-modify | no-proxy |
use-server]
hostname(config-group-policy)#
The following example configures the Microsoft Internet Explorer proxy setting for the group policy
named FirstGroup to use the server QAserver, port 1001 as the server for the client PC:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# msie-proxy server QAserver:port 1001
hostname(config-group-policy)# msie-proxy method use-server
hostname(config-group-policy)#
Step 3 Configure Microsoft Internet Explorer browser proxy exception list settings for a local bypass on the
client PC by entering the msie-proxy except-list command in group-policy configuration mode. These
addresses are not accessed by a proxy server. This list corresponds to the Exceptions box in the Proxy
Settings dialog box in Internet Explorer.
hostname(config-group-policy)# msie-proxy except-list {value server[:port] | none}
hostname(config-group-policy)#
To remove the attribute from the configuration, use the no form of the command.
hostname(config-group-policy)# no msie-proxy except-list
hostname(config-group-policy)#
• value server:port—Specifies the IP address or name of an MSIE server and port that is applied for
this client PC. The port number is optional.
• none—Indicates that there is no IP address/hostname or port and prevents inheriting an exception
list.
By default, msie-proxy except-list is disabled.
The line containing the proxy server IP address or hostname and the port number must be less than 100
characters long.
The following example shows how to set a Microsoft Internet Explorer proxy exception list, consisting
of the server at IP address 192.168.20.1, using port 880, for the group policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# msie-proxy except-list value 192.168.20.1:880
hostname(config-group-policy)#
Step 4 Enable or disable Microsoft Internet Explorer browser proxy local-bypass settings for a client PC by
entering the msie-proxy local-bypass command in group-policy configuration mode.
hostname(config-group-policy)# msie-proxy local-bypass {enable | disable}
hostname(config-group-policy)#
To remove the attribute from the configuration, use the no form of the command.
hostname(config-group-policy)# no msie-proxy local-bypass {enable | disable}
hostname(config-group-policy)#
Step 1 (Optional) Configure the status query timer period. The security appliance starts the status query timer
after each successful posture validation and status query response. The expiration of this timer triggers
a query for changes in the host posture, referred to as a status query. Enter the number of seconds in the
range 30 through 1800. The default setting is 300.
To specify the interval between each successful posture validation in a Network Admission Control
session and the next query for changes in the host posture, use the nac-sq-period command in
group-policy configuration mode:
hostname(config-group-policy)# nac-sq-period seconds
hostname(config-group-policy)#
To inherit the value of the status query timer from the default group policy, access the alternative group
policy from which to inherit it, then use the no form of this command:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac-sq-period [seconds]
hostname(config-group-policy)#
The following example changes the value of the status query timer to 1800 seconds:
hostname(config-group-policy)# nac-sq-period 1800
hostname(config-group-policy)
The following example inherits the value of the status query timer from the default group policy:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac-sq-period
hostname(config-group-policy)#
Step 2 (Optional) Configure the NAC revalidation period. The security appliance starts the revalidation timer
after each successful posture validation. The expiration of this timer triggers the next unconditional
posture validation. The security appliance maintains posture validation during revalidation. The default
group policy becomes effective if the Access Control Server is unavailable during posture validation or
revalidation. Enter the interval in seconds between each successful posture validation. The range is 300
through 86400. The default setting is 36000.
To specify the interval between each successful posture validation in a Network Admission Control
session, use the nac-reval-period command in group-policy configuration mode:
hostname(config-group-policy)# nac-reval-period seconds
hostname(config-group-policy)#
To inherit the value of the Revalidation Timer from the default group policy, access the alternative group
policy from which to inherit it, then use the no form of this command:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac-reval-period [seconds]
hostname(config-group-policy)#
The following example inherits the value of the revalidation timer from the default group policy:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac-reval-period
hostname(config-group-policy)#
Step 3 (Optional) Configure the default ACL for NAC. The security appliance applies the security policy
associated with the selected ACL if posture validation fails. Specify none or an extended ACL. The
default setting is none. If the setting is none and posture validation fails, the security appliance applies
the default group policy.
To specify the ACL to be used as the default ACL for Network Admission Control sessions that fail
posture validation, use the nac-default-acl command in group-policy configuration mode:
hostname(config-group-policy)# nac-default-acl {acl-name | none}
hostname(config-group-policy)#
To inherit the ACL from the default group policy, access the alternative group policy from which to
inherit it, then use the no form of this command:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac-default-acl [acl-name | none]
hostname(config-group-policy)#
The following example inherits the ACL from the default group policy:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac-default-acl
hostname(config-group-policy)
The following example disables inheritance of the ACL from the default group policy and does not apply
an ACL to NAC sessions that fail posture validation:
hostname(config-group-policy)# nac-default-acl none
hostname(config-group-policy)#
Step 4 Configure NAC exemptions for VPN. By default, the exemption list is empty.The default value of the
filter attribute is none. Enter the vpn-nac-exempt once for each operating system (and ACL) to be
matched to exempt remote hosts from posture validation.
To add an entry to the list of remote computer types that are exempt from posture validation, use the
vpn-nac-exempt command in group-policy configuration mode.
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-nac-exempt os "os name" [filter {acl-name | none}]
[disable]
hostname(config-group-policy)#
To disable inheritance and specify that all hosts are subject to posture validation, use the none keyword
immediately following vpn-nac-exempt.
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-nac-exempt none
hostname(config-group-policy)#
To remove an entry from the exemption list, use the no form of this command and name the operating
system (and ACL) in the entry to be removed.
hostname(config-group-policy)# no vpn-nac-exempt [os "os name"] [filter {acl-name | none}]
[disable]
hostname(config-group-policy)#
To remove all entries from the exemption list associated with this group policy and inherit the list from
the default group policy, use the no form of this command without specifying additional keywords.
hostname(config-group-policy)# no vpn-nac-exempt
hostname(config-group-policy)#
The following example exempts all hosts running Windows 98 that match an ACE in the ACL named
acl-1:
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-nac-exempt os "Windows 98" filter acl-1
hostname(config-group-policy)
The following example adds the same entry to the exemption list, but disables it:
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-nac-exempt os "Windows 98" filter acl-1 disable
hostname(config-group-policy)
The following example removes the same entry from the exemption list, regardless of whether it is
disabled:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no vpn-nac-exempt os "Windows 98" filter acl-1
hostname(config-group-policy)
The following example disables inheritance and specifies that all hosts will be subject to posture
validation:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no vpn-nac-exempt none
hostname(config-group-policy)
The following example removes all entries from the exemption list:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no vpn-nac-exempt
hostname(config-group-policy)
Step 5 Enable or disable Network Admission Control by entering the following command:
hostname(config-group-policy)# nac {enable | disable}
hostname(config-group-policy)#
To inherit the NAC setting from the default group policy, access the alternative group policy from which
to inherit it, then use the no form of this command:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac [enable | disable]
hostname(config-group-policy)#
By default, NAC is disabled. Enabling NAC requires posture validation for remote access. If the remote
computer passes the validation checks, the ACS server downloads the access policy for the security
appliance to enforce. NAC is disabled by default.
An Access Control Server must be present on the network.
The following example enables NAC for the group policy:
hostname(config-group-policy)# nac enable
hostname(config-group-policy)#
The address-pools settings in this command override the local pool settings in the group. You can specify
a list of up to six local address pools to use for local address allocation.
The order in which you specify the pools is significant. The security appliance allocates addresses from
these pools in the order in which the pools appear in this command.
To remove the attribute from the group policy and enable inheritance from other sources of group policy,
use the no form of this command:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no address-pools value address_pool1 [...address_pool6]
hostname(config-group-policy)#
The command address-pools none disables this attribute from being inherited from other sources of
policy, such as the DefaultGrpPolicy:
hostname(config-group-policy)# address-pools none
hostname(config-group-policy)#
The command no address pools none removes the address-pools none command from the
configuration, restoring the default value, which is to allow inheritance.
hostname(config-group-policy)# no address-pools none
hostname(config-group-policy)#
Note Only VPN clients running Microsoft Windows can use these firewall features. They are currently not
available to hardware clients or other (non-Windows) software clients.
In the first scenario, a remote user has a personal firewall installed on the PC. The VPN client enforces
firewall policy defined on the local firewall, and it monitors that firewall to make sure it is running. If
the firewall stops running, the VPN client drops the connection to the security appliance. (This firewall
enforcement mechanism is called Are You There (AYT), because the VPN client monitors the firewall by
sending it periodic “are you there?” messages; if no reply comes, the VPN client knows the firewall is
down and terminates its connection to the security appliance.) The network administrator might
configure these PC firewalls originally, but with this approach, each user can customize his or her own
configuration.
In the second scenario, you might prefer to enforce a centralized firewall policy for personal firewalls
on VPN client PCs. A common example would be to block Internet traffic to remote PCs in a group using
split tunneling. This approach protects the PCs, and therefore the central site, from intrusions from the
Internet while tunnels are established. This firewall scenario is called push policy or Central Protection
Policy (CPP). On the security appliance, you create a set of traffic management rules to enforce on the
VPN client, associate those rules with a filter, and designate that filter as the firewall policy. The security
appliance pushes this policy down to the VPN client. The VPN client then in turn passes the policy to
the local firewall, which enforces it.
Enter the following commands to set the appropriate client firewall parameters. You can configure only
one instance of this command. Table 30-1, following this set of commands, explains the syntax elements
of these commands:
No Firewall
hostname(config-group-policy)# client-firewall none
Custom Firewall
hostname(config-group-policy)# client-firewall {opt | req} custom vendor-id num product-id
num policy {AYT | CPP acl-in ACL acl-out ACL} [description string]
Note When the firewall type is zonelabs-integrity, do not include arguments. The Zone Labs Integrity Server
determines the policies.
client-firewall {opt | req} zonelabs-zonealarmpro policy {AYT | CPP acl-in ACL acl-out
ACL}
Parameter Description
acl-in ACL Provides the policy the client uses for inbound traffic.
acl-out ACL Provides the policy the client uses for outbound traffic.
AYT Specifies that the client PC firewall application controls the firewall
policy. The security appliance checks to make sure that the firewall
is running. It asks, “Are You There?” If there is no response, the
security appliance tears down the tunnel.
cisco-integrated Specifies Cisco Integrated firewall type.
cisco-security-agent Specifies Cisco Intrusion Prevention Security Agent firewall type.
CPP Specifies Policy Pushed as source of the VPN client firewall policy.
custom Specifies Custom firewall type.
description string Describes the firewall.
networkice-blackice Specifies Network ICE Black ICE firewall type.
none Indicates that there is no client firewall policy. Sets a firewall policy
with a null value, thereby disallowing a firewall policy. Prevents
inheriting a firewall policy from a default or specified group policy.
opt Indicates an optional firewall type.
product-id Identifies the firewall product.
req Indicates a required firewall type.
sygate-personal Specifies Sygate Personal firewall type.
sygate-personal-pro Specifies Sygate Personal Pro firewall type.
sygate-security-agent Specifies Sygate Security Agent firewall type.
vendor-id Identifies the firewall vendor.
zonelabs-integrity Specifies Zone Labs Integrity Server firewall type.
zonelabs-zonealarm Specifies Zone Labs Zone Alarm firewall type.
zonelabs-zonealarmorpro Specifies Zone Labs Zone Alarm or Pro firewall type.
policy
zonelabs-zonealarmpro policy Specifies Zone Labs Zone Alarm Pro firewall type.
The following example shows how to set a client firewall policy that requires Cisco Intrusion Prevention
Security Agent for the group policy named FirstGroup:
To delete all rules, enter the no client-access-rule command without arguments. This deletes all
configured rules, including a null rule if you created one by issuing the client-access-rule command with
the none keyword.
By default, there are no access rules. When there are no client access rules, users inherit any rules that
exist in the default group policy.
To prevent users from inheriting client access rules, enter the client-access-rule command with the none
keyword. The result of this command is that all client types and versions can connect.
hostname(config-group-policy)# client-access rule priority {permit | deny} type type
version {version | none}
Table 30-2 explains the meaning of the keywords and parameters in these commands.
Parameter Description
deny Denies connections for devices of a particular type and/or version.
none Allows no client access rules. Sets client-access-rule to a null value, thereby
allowing no restriction. Prevents inheriting a value from a default or
specified group policy.
The following example shows how to create client access rules for the group policy named FirstGroup.
These rules permit Cisco VPN clients running software version 4.x, while denying all Windows NT
clients:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# client-access-rule 1 deny type WinNT version *
hostname(config-group-policy)# client-access-rule 2 permit “Cisco VPN Client” version 4.*
Note The “type” field is a free-form string that allows any value, but that value must match the fixed
value that the client sends to the security appliance at connect time.
Note The webvpn mode that you enter from global configuration mode lets you configure global settings for
WebVPN. The webvpn mode described in this section, which you enter from group-policy configuration
mode, lets you customize a WebVPN configuration for specific group policies.
In group-policy webvpn configuration mode, you can specify whether to inherit the settings for all the
functions or customize the following parameters, each of which is described in the subsequent sections:
• functions
• customizations
• html-content-filter
• homepage
• filter
• url-list
• port-forward
• port-forward-name
• sso server (single-signon server)
• auto-signon
• deny message
• SSL VPN Client (SVC)
• keep-alive ignore
• HTTP compression
In many instances, you define the WebVPN attributes as part of configuring WebVPN, then you apply
those definitions to specific groups when you configure the group-policy webvpn attributes. Enter
group-policy webvpn configuration mode by using the webvpn command in group-policy configuration
mode. WebVPN commands for group policies define access to files, MAPI proxy, URLs and TCP
applications over WebVPN. They also identify ACLs and types of traffic to filter. WebVPN is disabled
by default. See the description of WebVPN in Cisco Security Appliance Command Line Configuration
Guide and Cisco Security Appliance Command Reference for more information about configuring the
WebVPN attributes.
To remove all commands entered in group-policy webvpn configuration mode, enter the no form of this
command. These webvpn commands apply to the username or group policy from which you configure
them.
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-policy)# no webvpn
Configure the WebVPN functions that you want to enable. To configure file access and file browsing,
HTTP Proxy, MAPI Proxy, and URL entry over WebVPN for this group policy, enter the functions
command in webvpn mode. These functions are disabled by default.
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# functions {auto-download | citrix | file-access |
file-browsing | file-entry | filter | http-proxy | mapi | none | port-forward | url-entry}
To remove a configured function, enter the no form of this command. The no option allows inheritance
of a value from another group policy. To prevent inheriting function values, enter the functions none
command.
To remove all configured functions, including a null value created by issuing the functions none
command, enter the no form of this command without arguments.
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no functions [auto-download | citrix | file-access |
file-browsing | file-entry | filter | http-proxy | mapi | none | port-forward | url-entry]
Table 30-3 describes the meaning of the keywords used in this command.
Keyword Meaning
auto-download Automatically downloads the port forwarding applet
citrix Enables Citrix
file-access Enables or disables file access. When enabled, the WebVPN home page lists
file servers in the server list. You must enable file access to enable file
browsing and/or file entry.
file-browsing Enables or disables browsing for file servers and shares. You must enable
file browsing to allow user entry of a file server.
file-entry Enables of disables user ability to enter names of file servers.
filter Applies a webtype access-list
http-proxy Enables or disables the forwarding of an HTTP applet proxy to the client.
The proxy is useful for technologies that interfere with proper mangling,
such as Java, ActiveX, and Flash. It bypasses mangling while ensuring the
continued use of the security appliance. The forwarded proxy modifies the
browser’s old proxy configuration automatically and redirects all HTTP and
HTTPS requests to the new proxy configuration. It supports virtually all
client side technologies, including HTML, CSS, JavaScript, VBScript,
ActiveX, and Java. The only browser it supports is Microsoft Internet
Explorer.
mapi Enables or disables Microsoft Outlook/Exchange port forwarding.
none Sets a null value for all WebVPN functions. Prevents inheriting functions
from a default or specified group policy
port-forward Enables port forwarding
url-entry Enables or disables user entry of URLs. When enabled, the security
appliance still restricts URLs with any configured URL or network ACLs.
When URL entry is disabled, the security appliance restricts WebVPN users
to the URLs on the home page.
The following example shows how to configure file access, file browsing, and MAPI Proxy for the group
policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# functions file-access file-browsing MAPI
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
Applying Customization
Customizations determine the appearance of the windows that the user sees upon login. You configure
the customization parameters as part of configuring WebVPN. To apply a previously defined web-page
customization to change the look-and-feel of the web page that the user sees at login, enter the
customization command in group-policy webvpn configuration mode:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# customization customization_name
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
For example, to use the customization named blueborder, enter the following command:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# customization blueborder
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
You configure the customization itself by entering the customization command in WebVPN mode.
The following example shows a command sequence that first establishes a WebVPN customization
named 123 that defines a password prompt. The example then defines a WebVPN group policy named
testpolicy and uses the customization command to specifies the use of the WebVPN customization
named 123:
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# customization 123
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# password-prompt Enter password
hostname(config-webvpn)# exit
hostname(config)# group-policy testpolicy nopassword
hostname(config)# group-policy testpolicy attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# customization value 123
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
You can specify the message delivered to a remote user who logs into WebVPN successfully, but has no
VPN privileges by entering the deny-message command in group-policy webvpn configuration mode:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# deny-message value "message"
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no deny-message value "message"
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# deny-message none
The no deny-message value command removes the message string, so that the remote user does not
receive a message.
The no deny-message none command removes the attribute from the tunnel group policy configuration.
The policy inherits the attribute value.
The message can be up to 491 alphanumeric characters long, including special characters, spaces, and
punctuation, but not counting the enclosing quotation marks. The text appears on the remote user’s
browser upon login. When typing the string in the deny-message value command, continue typing even
if the command wraps.
The default deny message is: “Login was successful, but because certain criteria have not been met or
due to some specific group policy, you do not have permission to use any of the VPN features. Contact
your IT administrator for more information.”
The first command in the following example creates an internal group policy named group2. The
subsequent commands modify the attributes, including the webvpn deny message associated with that
policy.
hostname(config)# group-policy group2 internal
hostname(config)# group-policy group2 attributes
hostname(config-group)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# deny-message value "Your login credentials are OK. However,
you have not been granted rights to use the VPN features. Contact your administrator for
more information."
hostname(config-group-webvpn)
Specify whether to filter Java, ActiveX, images, scripts, and cookies for WebVPN sessions for this group
policy by using the html-content-filter command in webvpn mode. HTML filtering is disabled by
default.
To remove a content filter, enter the no form of this command. To remove all content filters, including a
null value created by issuing the html-content-filter command with the none keyword, enter the no
form of this command without arguments. The no option allows inheritance of a value from another
group policy. To prevent inheriting an html content filter, enter the html-content-filter command with
the none keyword.
Using the command a second time overrides the previous setting.
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# html-content-filter {java | images | scripts | cookies |
none}
Table 30-4 describes the meaning of the keywords used in this command.
Keyword Meaning
cookies Removes cookies from images, providing limited ad filtering and privacy.
images Removes references to images (removes <IMG> tags).
java Removes references to Java and ActiveX (removes <EMBED>,
<APPLET>, and <OBJECT> tags).
none Indicates that there is no filtering. Sets a null value, thereby disallowing
filtering. Prevents inheriting filtering values.
scripts Removes references to scripting (removes <SCRIPT> tags).
The following example shows how to set filtering of JAVA and ActiveX, cookies, and images for the
group policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# html-content-filter java cookies images
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
Specify a URL for the web page that displays when a user in this group logs in by using the homepage
command in group-policy webvpn configuration mode. There is no default home page.
To remove a configured home page, including a null value created by issuing the homepage none
command, enter the no form of this command. The no option allows inheritance of a value from another
group policy. To prevent inheriting a home page, enter the homepage none command.
The none keyword indicates that there is no WebVPN home page. It sets a null value, thereby
disallowing a home page and prevents inheriting an home page.
The url-string variable following the keyword value provides a URL for the home page. The string must
begin with either http:// or https://.
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# homepage {value url-string | none}
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no homepage
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
Configuring Auto-Signon
The auto-signon command is a single sign-on method for WebVPN users. It passes the WebVPN login
credentials (username and password) to internal servers for authentication using NTLM authentication,
basic authentication, or both. Multiple auto-signon commands can be entered and are processed
according to the input order (early commands take precedence).
You can use the auto-signon feature in three modes: webvpn configuration, webvpn group configuration,
or webvpn username configuration mode. The typical precedence behavior applies where username
supersedes group, and group supersedes global. The mode you choose depends upon the desired scope
of authentication.
To disable auto-signon for a particular user to a particular server, use the no form of the command with
the original specification of IP block or URI. To disable authentication to all servers, use the no form
without arguments. The no option allows inheritance of a value from the group policy.
The following example, entered in group-policy webvpn configuration mode, configures auto-signon for
the user named anyuser, using basic authentication, to servers with IP addresses ranging from 10.1.1.0
to 10.1.1.255:
The following example commands configure auto-signon for WebVPN users ExamplePolicy group
policy, using either basic or NTLM authentication, to servers defined by the URI mask
https://*.example.com/*:
The following example commands configure auto-signon for WebVPN users ExamplePolicy2 group
policy, using either basic or NTLM authentication, to the server with the IP address
10.1.1.0, using subnet mask 255.255.255.0:
Specify the name of the access list to use for WebVPN connections for this group policy or username by
using the filter command in webvpn mode. WebVPN access lists do not apply until you enter the filter
command to specify them.
To remove the access list, including a null value created by issuing the filter none command, enter the
no form of this command. The no option allows inheritance of a value from another group policy. To
prevent inheriting filter values, enter the filter value none command.
WebVPN access lists do not apply until you enter the filter command to specify them.
You configure ACLs to permit or deny various types of traffic for this group policy. You then enter the
filter command to apply those ACLs for WebVPN traffic.
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# filter {value ACLname | none}
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no filter
The none keyword indicates that there is no webvpntype access list. It sets a null value, thereby
disallowing an access list and prevents inheriting an access list from another group policy.
The ACLname string following the keyword value provides the name of the previously configured access
list.
Note You must have filter selected in the functions command. WebVPN does not use ACLs defined in the
vpn-filter command.
The following example shows how to set a filter that invokes an access list named acl_in for the group
policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# filter acl_in
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
You can specify a list of URLs to appear on the WebVPN home page for a group policy. First, you must
create one or more named lists by entering the url-list command in global configuration mode. To apply
a list of WebVPN servers and URLs to a particular group policy, allowing access to the URLs in a list
for a specific group policy, use the name of the list or lists you create there with the url-list command
in group-policy webvpn configuration mode. There is no default URL list.
To remove a list, including a null value created by using the url-list none command, use the no form of
this command. The no option allows inheritance of a value from another group policy. To prevent
inheriting a URL list, use the url-list none command. Using the command a second time overrides the
previous setting:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# url-list {value name | none} [index]
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no url-list
Table 30-5 shows the url-list command parameters and their meanings.
Parameter Meaning
index Indicates the display priority on the home page.
none Sets a null value for url lists. Prevents inheriting a list from a default or
specified group policy.
value name Specifies the name of a previously configured list of urls. To configure such
a list, use the url-list command in global configuration mode.
The following example sets a URL list called FirstGroupURLs for the group policy named FirstGroup
and specifies that this should be the first URL list displayed on the homepage:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# url-list value FirstGroupURLs 1
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
To enable WebVPN application access for this group policy, enter the port-forward command in
group-policy webvpn configuration mode. Port forwarding is disabled by default.
Before you can enter the port-forward command in group-policy webvpn configuration mode to enable
application access, you must define a list of applications that you want users to be able to use in a
WebVPN connection. Enter the port-forward command in global configuration mode to define this list.
To remove the port forwarding attribute from the group-policy configuration, including a null value
created by issuing the port-forward none command, enter the no form of this command. The no option
allows inheritance of a list from another group policy. To prevent inheriting a port forwarding list, enter
the port-forward command with the none keyword. The none keyword indicates that there is no
filtering. It sets a null value, thereby disallowing a filtering, and prevents inheriting filtering values.
The syntax of the command is as follows:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# port-forward {value listname | none}
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no port-forward
The listname string following the keyword value identifies the list of applications WebVPN users can
access. Enter the port-forward command in webvpn configuration mode to define the list.
Using the command a second time overrides the previous setting.
The following example shows how to set a port-forwarding list called ports1 for the internal group policy
named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup internal attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# port-forward value ports1
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
Configure the display name that identifies TCP port forwarding to end users for a particular user or group
policy by using the port-forward-name command in group-policy webvpn configuration mode. To
delete the display name, including a null value created by using the port-forward-name none command,
enter the no form of the command. The no option restores the default name, Application Access. To
prevent a display name, enter the port-forward none command. The syntax of the command is as
follows:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# port-forward-name {value name | none}
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no port-forward-name
The following example shows how to set the name, Remote Access TCP Applications, for the internal
group policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup internal attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# port-forward-name value Remote Access TCP Applications
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
Configuring the Maximum Object Size to Ignore for Updating the Session Timer
Network devices exchange short keepalive messages to ensure that the virtual circuit between them is
still active. The length of these messages can vary. The keep-alive-ignore command lets you tell the
security appliance to consider all messages that are less than or equal to the specified size as keepalive
messages and not as traffic when updating the session timer. The range is 0 through 900 KB. The default
is 4 KB.
To specify the upper limit of the HTTP/HTTPS traffic, per transaction, to ignore, use the
keep-alive-ignore command in group-policy attributes webvpn configuration mode:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# keep-alive-ignore size
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
The no form of the command removes this specification from the configuration:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no keep-alive-ignore
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
The following example sets the maximum size of objects to ignore as 5 KB:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# keep-alive-ignore 5
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
Enable compression of http data over a WebVPN connection for a specific group or user by entering the
http-comp command in the group policy webvpn mode.
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# http-comp {gzip | none}
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
To remove the command from the configuration and cause the value to be inherited, use the no form of
the command:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no http-comp {gzip | none}
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
Single sign-on support, available only for WebVPN, lets users access different secure services on
different servers without reentering a username and password more than once. The sso-server value
command, when entered in group-policy-webvpn mode, lets you assign an SSO server to a group policy.
To assign an SSO server to a group policy, use the sso-server value command in group-policy-webvpn
configuration mode. This command requires that your configuration include CA SiteMinder command.
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# sso-server value server_name
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
To remove the assignment and use the default policy, use the no form of this command. To prevent
inheriting the default policy, use the sso-server none command.
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# sso-server {value server_name | none}
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# [no] sso-server value server_name
Configuring SVC
The SSL VPN Client (SVC) is a VPN tunneling technology that gives remote users the benefits of an
IPSec VPN client without the need for network administrators to install and configure IPSec VPN clients
on remote computers. The SVC uses the SSL encryption that is already present on the remote computer
as well as the WebVPN login and authentication of the security appliance.
To establish an SVC session, the remote user enters the IP address of a WebVPN interface of the security
appliance in the browser, and the browser connects to that interface and displays the WebVPN login
screen. If the user satisfies the login and authentication, and the security appliance identifies the user as
requiring the SVC, the security appliance downloads the SVC to the remote computer. If the security
appliance identifies the user as having the option to use the SVC, the security appliance downloads the
SVC to the remote computer while presenting a link on the user screen to skip the SVC installation.
After downloading, the SVC installs and configures itself, and then the SVC either remains or uninstalls
itself (depending on the configuration) from the remote computer when the connection terminates.
The security appliance might have several unique SVC images residing in cache memory for different
remote computer operating systems. When the user attempts to connect, the security appliance can
consecutively download portions of these images to the remote computer until the image and operating
system match, at which point it downloads the entire SVC. You can order the SVC images to minimize
connection setup time, with the first image downloaded representing the most commonly-encountered
remote computer operating system. For complete information about installing and using SVC, see
Chapter 38, “Configuring SSL VPN Client”.
After enabling SVC, as described in Chapter 38, “Configuring SSL VPN Client”, you can enable or
require SVC features for a specific group. This feature is disabled by default. If you enable or require
SVC, you can then enable a succession of svc commands, described in this section. To enable SVC and
its related svc commands, do the following steps in group-policy webvpn configuration mode:
Step 1 To enable the security appliance to download SVC files to remote computers, enter the svc enable
command. By default, this command is disabled. The security appliance does not download SVC files.
To remove the svc enable command from the configuration, use the no form of this command.
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# svc {none | enable | required}
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
Note Entering the no svc enable command does not terminate active SVC sessions.
Step 2 To enable compression of HTTP data over an SVC connection, for a specific group, enter the svc
compression command. By default, SVC compression is set to deflate (enabled). To disable compression
for a specific group, use the none keyword. To remove the svc compression command and cause the
value to be inherited, use the no form of the command:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# svc compression {deflate | none}
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
The following example disables SVC compression for the group policy named sales:
hostname(config)# group-policy sales attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# svc compression none
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
Step 3 To enable dead-peer-detection (DPD) on the security appliance and to set the frequency with which
either the SVC or the security appliance performs DPD, use the svc dpd-interval command. To remove
the svc dpd-interval command from the configuration, use the no form of the command. To disable SVC
DPD for this group, use the none keyword:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# svc dpd-interval {[gateway {seconds | none}] | [client
{seconds | none}]}
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
Step 4 You can adjust the frequency of keepalive messages (specified by seconds), to ensure that an SVC
connection through a proxy, firewall, or NAT device remains open, even if the device limits the time that
the connection can be idle.
Adjusting the frequency also ensures that the SVC does not disconnect and reconnect when the remote
user is not actively running a socket-based application, such as Microsoft Outlook or Microsoft Internet
Explorer.
To configure the frequency (15 through 600 seconds) which an SVC on a remote computer sends
keepalive messages to the security appliance, use the svc keepalive command. Use the no form of the
command to remove the command from the configuration and cause the value to be inherited:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# svc keepalive {none | seconds}
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no svc keepalive {none | seconds}
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
SVC keepalives are disabled by default. Using the keyword none disables SVC keepalive messages.
The following example configures the security appliance to enable the SVC to send keepalive messages,
with a frequency of 300 seconds (5 minutes):
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# svc keepalive 300
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
Step 5 To enable the permanent installation of an SVC onto a remote computer, use the svc keep-installer
command with the installed keyword. To remove the command from the configuration, use the no form
of this command:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# svc keep-installer {installed | none}
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no svc keep-installer {installed | none}
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
The default is that permanent installation of the SVC is disabled. The SVC uninstalls from the remote
computer at the end of the SVC session.
The following example configures the security appliance to keep the SVC installed on the remote
computer for this group:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# svc keep-installer installed
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
Step 6 To enable the SVC to perform a rekey on an SVC session, use the svc rekey command. To disable rekey
and remove the command from the configuration, use the no form of this command:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# svc rekey {method {ssl | new-tunnel} | time minutes |
none}}
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no svc rekey {method {ssl | new-tunnel} | time minutes |
none}}
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
but the current method is ssl, then the command fails, because the values don't match.
In the following example, the user configures the SVC to renegotiate with SSL during rekey and
configures the rekey to occur 30 minutes after the session begins:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# svc rekey method ssl
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# svc rekey time 30
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
This displays the encrypted password and the privilege level. for all users, or, if you supply a username,
for that specific user. If you omit the all keyword, only explicitly configured values appear in this list.
The following example displays the output of this command for the user named testuser:
hostname# show running-config all username testuser
username testuser password 12RsxXQnphyr/I9Z encrypted privilege 15
Table 30-6 describes the meaning of the keywords and variables used in this command.
Keyword/Variable Meaning
encrypted Indicates that the password is encrypted.
name Provides the name of the user.
nopassword Indicates that this user needs no password.
password password Indicates that this user has a password, and provides the password.
privilege priv_level Sets a privilege level for this user. The range is from 0 to 15, with lower
numbers having less ability to use commands and administer the security
appliance. The default privilege level is 2. The typical privilege level for a
system administrator is 15.
By default, VPN users that you add with this command have no attributes or group policy association.
You must explicitly configure all values.
The following example shows how to configure a user named anyuser with an encrypted password of
pw_12345678 and a privilege level of 12:
hostname(config)# username anyuser password pw_12345678 encrypted privilege 12
hostname(config)#
The prompt changes to indicate the new mode. You can now configure the attributes.
Configuring Inheritance
You can let users inherit from the group policy the values of attributes that you have not configured at
the username level. To specify the name of the group policy from which this user inherits attributes, enter
the vpn-group-policy command. By default, VPN users have no group-policy association:
hostname(config-username)# vpn-group-policy group-policy-name
hostname(config-username)# no vpn-group-policy group-policy-name
For an attribute that is available in username mode, you can override the value of an attribute in a group
policy for a particular user by configuring it in username mode.
The following example shows how to configure a user named anyuser to use attributes from the group
policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# vpn-group-policy FirstGroup
hostname(config-username)#
Associate the hours that this user is allowed to access the system by specifying the name of a configured
time-range policy:
To remove the attribute from the running configuration, enter the no form of this command. This option
allows inheritance of a time-range value from another group policy. To prevent inheriting a value, enter
the vpn-access-hours none command. The default is unrestricted access.
hostname(config-username)# vpn-access-hours value {time-range | none}
hostname(config-username)# vpn-access-hours value none
hostname(config)#
The following example shows how to associate the user named anyuser with a time-range policy called
824:
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# vpn-access-hours 824
hostname(config-username)#
Specify the maximum number of simultaneous logins allowed for this user. The range is 0 through
2147483647. The default is 3 simultaneous logins. To remove the attribute from the running
configuration, enter the no form of this command. Enter 0 to disable login and prevent user access.
hostname(config-username)# vpn-simultaneous-logins integer
hostname(config-username)# no vpn-simultaneous-logins
hostname(config-username)#
Note While the maximum limit for the number of simultaneous logins is very large, allowing several could
compromise security and affect performance.
The following example shows how to allow a maximum of 4 simultaneous logins for the user named
anyuser:
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# vpn-simultaneous-logins 4
hostname(config-username)#
Specify the idle timeout period in minutes, or enter none to disable the idle timeout. If there is no
communication activity on the connection in this period, the security appliance terminates the
connection.
The range is 1 through 35791394 minutes. The default is 30 minutes. To allow an unlimited timeout
period, and thus prevent inheriting a timeout value, enter the vpn-idle-timeout command with the none
keyword. To remove the attribute from the running configuration, enter the no form of this command.
hostname(config-username)# vpn-idle-timeout {minutes | none}
hostname(config-username)# no vpn-idle-timeout
hostname(config-username)#
The following example shows how to set a VPN idle timeout of 15 minutes for the user named anyuser:
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# vpn-idle-timeout 30
hostname(config-username)#
Specify the maximum user connection time in minutes, or enter none to allow unlimited connection time
and prevent inheriting a value for this attribute. At the end of this period of time, the security appliance
terminates the connection.
The range is 1 through 35791394 minutes. There is no default timeout. To allow an unlimited timeout
period, and thus prevent inheriting a timeout value, enter the vpn-session-timeout command with the
none keyword. To remove the attribute from the running configuration, enter the no form of this
command.
hostname(config-username)# vpn-session-timeout {minutes | none}
hostname(config-username)# no vpn-session-timeout
hostname(config-username)#
The following example shows how to set a VPN session timeout of 180 minutes for the user named
anyuser:
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# vpn-session-timeout 180
hostname(config-username)#
Specify the name of a previously-configured, user-specific ACL to use as a filter for VPN connections.
To disallow an access list and prevent inheriting an access list from the group policy, enter the vpn-filter
command with the none keyword. To remove the ACL, including a null value created by issuing the
vpn-filter none command, enter the no form of this command. The no option allows inheritance of a
value from the group policy. There are no default behaviors or values for this command.
You configure ACLs to permit or deny various types of traffic for this user. You then use the vpn-filter
command to apply those ACLs.
hostname(config-username)# vpn-filter {value ACL_name | none}
hostname(config-username)# no vpn-filter
hostname(config-username)#
Note You must have filter selected in the functions command. WebVPN does not use ACLs defined in the
vpn-filter command.
The following example shows how to set a filter that invokes an access list named acl_vpn for the user
named anyuser:
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# vpn-filter value acl_vpn
hostname(config-username)#
Specify the IP address and netmask to assign to a particular user. To remove the IP address, enter the no
form of this command.
hostname(config-username)# vpn-framed-ip-address {ip_address}
hostname(config-username)# no vpn-framed-ip-address
hostname(config-username)
The following example shows how to set an IP address of 10.92.166.7 for a user named anyuser:
Specify the network mask to use with the IP address specified in the previous step. If you used the
no vpn-framed-ip-address command, do not specify a network mask. To remove the subnet mask, enter
the no form of this command. There is no default behavior or value.
hostname(config-username)# vpn-framed-ip-netmask {netmask}
hostname(config-username)# no vpn-framed-ip-netmask
hostname(config-username)
The following example shows how to set a subnet mask of 255.255.255. 254 for a user named anyuser:
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# vpn-framed-ip-netmask 255.255.255.254
hostname(config-username)
Specify the VPN tunnel types (IPSec or WebVPN) that this user can use. The default is taken from the
default group policy, the default for which is IPSec. To remove the attribute from the running
configuration, enter the no form of this command.
hostname(config-username)# vpn-tunnel-protocol {webvpn | IPSec}
hostname(config-username)# no vpn-tunnel-protocol [webvpn | IPSec]
hostname(config-username)
Configure the group-lock attribute with the value keyword to restrict remote users to access only
through the specified, preexisting tunnel group. Group-lock restricts users by checking whether the
group configured in the VPN client is the same as the tunnel group to which the user is assigned. If it is
not, the security appliance prevents the user from connecting. If you do not configure group-lock, the
security appliance authenticates users without regard to the assigned group.
To remove the group-lock attribute from the running configuration, enter the no form of this command.
This option allows inheritance of a value from the group policy. To disable group-lock, and to prevent
inheriting a group-lock value from a default or specified group policy, enter the group-lock command
with the none keyword.
The following example shows how to set group lock for the user named anyuser:
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# group-lock value tunnel-group-name
hostname(config-username)
Specify whether to let users store their login passwords on the client system. Password storage is
disabled by default. Enable password storage only on systems that you know to be in secure sites. To
disable password storage, enter the password-storage command with the disable keyword. To remove
the password-storage attribute from the running configuration, enter the no form of this command. This
enables inheritance of a value for password-storage from the group policy.
hostname(config-username)# password-storage {enable | disable}
hostname(config-username)# no password-storage
hostname(config-username)
This command has no bearing on interactive hardware client authentication or individual user
authentication for hardware clients.
The following example shows how to enable password storage for the user named anyuser:
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# password-storage enable
hostname(config-username)
To remove all commands entered in username webvpn configuration mode, use the no form of this
command:
hostname(config-username)# no webvpn
hostname(config-username)#
Note The webvpn mode that you enter from global configuration mode lets you configure global settings for
WebVPN. The username webvpn configuration mode described in this section, which you enter from
username mode, lets you customize a WebVPN configuration for specific users.
In username webvpn configuration mode, you can customize the following parameters, each of which is
described in the subsequent steps:
• functions
• customizations
• deny message
• html-content-filter
• homepage
• filter
• url-list
• port-forward
• port-forward-name
• sso server (single-signon server)
• auto-signon
• SSL VPN Client (SVC)
• keep-alive ignore
• HTTP compression
The following example shows how to enter username webvpn configuration mode for the username
anyuser attributes:
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
To configure the WebVPN functions file access and file browsing, HTTP Proxy, MAPI Proxy, and URL
entry over WebVPN for this user, enter the functions command in username webvpn configuration
mode. To remove a configured function, enter the no form of this command. These functions are disabled
by default.
To remove all configured functions, including a null value created by issuing the functions none
command, enter the no form of this command without arguments. The no option allows inheritance of a
value from another group policy. To prevent inheriting function values, enter the functions none
command.
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# functions {auto-download | citrix | file-access |
file-browsing | file-entry | filter | http-proxy | mapi | none | port-forward | url-entry}
Table 30-7 describes the meaning of the keywords used in this command.
Keyword Meaning
auto-download Automatically downloads the port forwarding applet
citrix Enables Citrix
file-access Enables or disables file access. When enabled, the WebVPN home page lists
file servers in the server list. You must enable file access to enable file
browsing and/or file entry.
file-browsing Enables or disables browsing for file servers and shares. You must enable
file browsing to allow user entry of a file server.
file-entry Enables of disables user ability to enter names of file servers.
filter Applies a webtype access-list
http-proxy Enables or disables the forwarding of an HTTP applet proxy to the client.
The proxy is useful for technologies that interfere with proper mangling,
such as Java, ActiveX, and Flash. It bypasses mangling while ensuring the
continued use of the security appliance. The forwarded proxy modifies the
browser’s old proxy configuration automatically and redirects all HTTP and
HTTPS requests to the new proxy configuration. It supports virtually all
client side technologies, including HTML, CSS, JavaScript, VBScript,
ActiveX, and Java. The only browser it supports is Microsoft Internet
Explorer.
mapi Enables or disables Microsoft Outlook/Exchange port forwarding.
none Sets a null value for all WebVPN functions. Prevents inheriting functions
from a default or specified group policy
port-forward Enables port forwarding
url-entry Enables or disables user entry of URLs. When enabled, the security
appliance still restricts URLs with any configured URL or network ACLs.
When URL entry is disabled, the security appliance restricts WebVPN users
to the URLs on the home page.
• none—Sets a null value for all WebVPN functions. Prevents inheriting functions from a default or
specified group policy
• url-entry—Enables or disables user entry of URLs. When enabled, the security appliance still
restricts URLs with any configured URL or network ACLs. When URL entry is disabled, the
security appliance restricts WebVPN users to the URLs on the home page.
The following example shows how to configure file access, file browsing, HTTP Proxy, and MAPI Proxy
for the user named anyuser:
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# functions file-access file-browsing MAPI
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
To filter Java, ActiveX, images, scripts, and cookies for WebVPN sessions for this user, enter the
html-content-filter command in username webvpn configuration mode. To remove a content filter, enter
the no form of this command. To remove all content filters, including a null value created by issuing the
html-content-filter none command, enter the no form of this command without arguments. The no
option allows inheritance of a value from the group policy. To prevent inheriting an HTML content filter,
enter the html-content-filter none command. HTML filtering is disabled by default.
Using the command a second time overrides the previous setting.
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# html-content-filter {java | images | scripts | cookies |
none}
The following example shows how to set filtering of JAVA and ActiveX, cookies, and images for the user
named anyuser:
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# html-content-filter java cookies images
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
To specify a URL for the web page that displays when this WebVPN user logs in, enter the homepage
command in username webvpn configuration mode. To remove a configured home page, including a null
value created by issuing the homepage none command, enter the no form of this command. The no
option allows inheritance of a value from the group policy. To prevent inheriting a home page, enter the
homepage none command.
The none keyword indicates that there is no WebVPN home page. It sets a null value, thereby
disallowing a home page and prevents inheriting a home page.
The url-string variable following the keyword value provides a URL for the home page. The string must
begin with either http:// or https://.
There is no default home page.
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# homepage {value url-string | none}
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# no homepage
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
The following example shows how to specify www.example.com as the home page for the user named
anyuser:
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# homepage value www.example.com
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
Applying Customization
Customizations determine the appearance of the windows that the user sees upon login. You configure
the customization parameters as part of configuring WebVPN. To apply a previously defined web-page
customization to change the look-and-feel of the web page that the user sees at login, enter the
customization command in username webvpn configuration mode:
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# customization {none | value customization_name}
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
For example, to use the customization named blueborder, enter the following command:
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# customization value blueborder
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
You configure the customization itself by entering the customization command in WebVPN mode.
The following example shows a command sequence that first establishes a WebVPN customization
named 123 that defines a password prompt. The example then defines a WebVPN tunnel-group named
test and uses the customization command to specifies the use of the WebVPN customization named 123:
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# customization 123
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# password-prompt Enter password
hostname(config-webvpn)# exit
hostname(config)# username testuser nopassword
hostname(config)# username testuser attributes
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# customization value 123
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
You can specify the message delivered to a remote user who logs into WebVPN successfully, but has no
VPN privileges by entering the deny-message command in username webvpn configuration mode:
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# deny-message value "message"
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# no deny-message value "message"
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# deny-message none
The no deny-message value command removes the message string, so that the remote user does not
receive a message.
The no deny-message none command removes the attribute from the tunnel group policy configuration.
The policy inherits the attribute value.
The message can be up to 491 alphanumeric characters long, including special characters, spaces, and
punctuation, but not counting the enclosing quotation marks. The text appears on the remote user’s
browser upon login. When typing the string in the deny-message value command, continue typing even
if the command wraps.
The default deny message is: “Login was successful, but because certain criteria have not been met or
due to some specific group policy, you do not have permission to use any of the VPN features. Contact
your IT administrator for more information.”
The first command in the following example enters username mode and configures the attributes for the
user named anyuser. The subsequent commands enter username webvpn configuration mode and modify
the deny message associated with that user.
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# deny-message value "Your login credentials are OK.
However, you have not been granted rights to use the VPN features. Contact your
administrator for more information."
hostname(config-username-webvpn)
To specify the name of the access list to use for WebVPN connections for this user, enter the filter
command in username webvpn configuration mode. To remove the access list, including a null value
created by issuing the filter none command, enter the no form of this command. The no option allows
inheritance of a value from the group policy. To prevent inheriting filter values, enter the filter value
none command.
WebVPN access lists do not apply until you enter the filter command to specify them.
You configure ACLs to permit or deny various types of traffic for this user. You then enter the filter
command to apply those ACLs for WebVPN traffic.
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# filter {value ACLname | none}
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# no filter
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
The none keyword indicates that there is no webvpntype access list. It sets a null value, thereby
disallowing an access list and prevents inheriting an access list from another group policy.
The ACLname string following the keyword value provides the name of the previously configured access
list.
Note WebVPN does not use ACLs defined in the vpn-filter command.
The following example shows how to set a filter that invokes an access list named acl_in for the user
named anyuser:
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# filter acl_in
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
You can specify a list of URLs to appear on the WebVPN home page for a user. First, you must create
one or more named lists by entering the url-list command in global configuration mode. To apply a list
of WebVPN servers and URLs to a particular user, enter the url-list command in username webvpn
configuration mode.
To remove a list, including a null value created by using the url-list none command, enter the no form
of this command. The no option allows inheritance of a value from the group policy. To prevent
inheriting a url list, enter the url-list none command.
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# url-list {listname displayname url | none}
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# no url-list
To enable WebVPN application access for this user, enter the port-forward command in username
webvpn configuration mode. Port forwarding is disabled by default.
To remove the port forwarding attribute from the configuration, including a null value created by issuing
the port-forward none command, enter the no form of this command. The no option allows inheritance
of a list from the group policy. To disallow filtering and prevent inheriting a port forwarding list, enter
the port-forward command with the none keyword.
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# port-forward {value listname | none}
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# no port-forward
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
The listname string following the keyword value identifies the list of applications WebVPN users can
access. Enter the port-forward command in configuration mode to define the list.
Configure the display name that identifies TCP port forwarding to end users for a particular user by using
the port-forward-name command in username webvpn configuration mode. To delete the display name,
including a null value created by using the port-forward-name none command, enter the no form of
the command. The no option restores the default name, Application Access. To prevent a display name,
enter the port-forward none command.
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# port-forward-name {value name | none}
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# no port-forward-name
The following example shows how to configure the port-forward name test:
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# port-forward-name value test
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
Configuring the Maximum Object Size to Ignore for Updating the Session Timer
Network devices exchange short keepalive messages to ensure that the virtual circuit between them is
still active. The length of these messages can vary. The keep-alive-ignore command lets you tell the
security appliance to consider all messages that are less than or equal to the specified size as keepalive
messages and not as traffic when updating the session timer. The range is 0 through 900 KB. The default
is 4 KB.
To specify the upper limit of the HTTP/HTTPS traffic, per transaction, to ignore, use the
keep-alive-ignore command in group-policy attributes webvpn configuration mode:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# keep-alive-ignore size
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
The no form of the command removes this specification from the configuration:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no keep-alive-ignore
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
The following example sets the maximum size of objects to ignore as 5 KB:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# keep-alive-ignore 5
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
Configuring Auto-Signon
To automatically submit the WebVPN login credentials of a particular WebVPN user to internal servers
using NTLM, basic HTTP authentication or both, use the auto-signon command in username webvpn
configuration mode.
The auto-signon command is a single sign-on method for WebVPN users. It passes the WebVPN login
credentials (username and password) to internal servers for authentication using NTLM authentication,
basic authentication, or both. Multiple auto-signon commands can be entered and are processed
according to the input order (early commands take precedence).
You can use the auto-signon feature in three modes: webvpn configuration, webvpn group configuration,
or webvpn username configuration mode. The typical precedence behavior applies where username
supersedes group, and group supersedes global. The mode you choose will depend upon the desired
scope of authentication.
To disable auto-signon for a particular user to a particular server, use the no form of the command with
the original specification of IP block or URI. To disable authentication to all servers, use the no form
without arguments. The no option allows inheritance of a value from the group policy.
The following example commands configure auto-signon for a WebVPN user named anyuser,
using either basic or NTLM authentication, to servers defined by the URI mask
https://*.example.com/*:
The following example commands configure auto-signon for the WebVPN user named anyuser,
using either basic or NTLM authentication, to the server with the IP address 10.1.1.0,
using subnet mask 255.255.255.0:
Enable compression of http data over a WebVPN connection for a specific user by entering the
http-comp command in the username webvpn configuration mode.
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# http-comp {gzip | none}
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
To remove the command from the configuration and cause the value to be inherited, use the no form of
the command:
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# no http-comp {gzip | none}
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
Single sign-on support, available only for WebVPN, lets users access different secure services on
different servers without reentering a username and password more than once. The sso-server value
command, when entered in username-webvpn mode, lets you assign an SSO server to a user.
To assign an SSO server to a user, use the sso-server value command in username-webvpn configuration
mode. This command requires that your configuration include CA SiteMinder command.
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# sso-server value server_name
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
To remove the assignment and use the default policy, use the no form of this command. To prevent
inheriting the default policy, use the sso-server none command.
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# sso-server {value server_name | none}
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# [no] sso-server value server_name
Configuring SVC
The SSL VPN Client (SVC) is a VPN tunneling technology that gives remote users the benefits of an
IPSec VPN client without the need for network administrators to install and configure IPSec VPN clients
on remote computers. The SVC uses the SSL encryption that is already present on the remote computer
as well as the WebVPN login and authentication of the security appliance.
To establish an SVC session, the remote user enters the IP address of a WebVPN interface of the security
appliance in the browser, and the browser connects to that interface and displays the WebVPN login
screen. If the user satisfies the login and authentication, and the security appliance identifies the user as
requiring the SVC, the security appliance downloads the SVC to the remote computer. If the security
appliance identifies the user as having the option to use the SVC, the security appliance downloads the
SVC to the remote computer while presenting a link on the user screen to skip the SVC installation.
After downloading, the SVC installs and configures itself, and then the SVC either remains or uninstalls
itself (depending on the configuration) from the remote computer when the connection terminates.
The security appliance might have several unique SVC images residing in cache memory for different
remote computer operating systems. When the user attempts to connect, the security appliance can
consecutively download portions of these images to the remote computer until the image and operating
system match, at which point it downloads the entire SVC. You can order the SVC images to minimize
connection setup time, with the first image downloaded representing the most commonly-encountered
remote computer operating system. For complete information about installing and using SVC, see
Chapter 38, “Configuring SSL VPN Client”.
After enabling SVC, as described in Chapter 38, “Configuring SSL VPN Client”, you can enable or
require SVC features for a specific user. This feature is disabled by default. If you enable or require SVC,
you can then enable a succession of svc commands, described in this section. To enable SVC and its
related svc commands, do the following steps in username webvpn configuration mode:
Step 1 To enable the security appliance to download SVC files to remote computers, enter the svc enable
command. By default, this command is disabled. The security appliance does not download SVC files.
To remove the svc enable command from the configuration, use the no form of this command.
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# svc {none | enable | required}
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
Note Entering the no svc enable command does not terminate active SVC sessions.
Step 2 To enable compression of HTTP data over an SVC connection, for a specific user, enter the svc
compression command. By default, SVC compression is set to deflate (enabled). To disable compression
for a specific user, use the none keyword. To remove the svc compression command and cause the value
to be inherited, use the no form of the command:
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# svc compression {deflate | none}
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
The following example disables SVC compression for the user named sales:
hostname(config)# username sales attributes
hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# svc compression none
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
Step 3 To enable dead-peer-detection (DPD) on the security appliance and to set the frequency with which
either the SVC or the security appliance performs DPD, use the svc dpd-interval command. To remove
the svc dpd-interval command from the configuration, use the no form of the command. To disable SVC
DPD for this user, use the none keyword:
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# svc dpd-interval {[gateway {seconds | none}] | [client
{seconds | none}]}
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
Step 4 You can adjust the frequency of keepalive messages (specified by seconds), to ensure that an SVC
connection through a proxy, firewall, or NAT device remains open, even if the device limits the time
that the connection can be idle.
Adjusting the frequency also ensures that the SVC does not disconnect and reconnect when the remote
user is not actively running a socket-based application, such as Microsoft Outlook or Microsoft Internet
Explorer.
To configure the frequency (15 through 600 seconds) which an SVC on a remote computer sends
keepalive messages to the security appliance, use the svc keepalive command. Use the no form of the
command to remove the command from the configuration and cause the value to be inherited:
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# svc keepalive {none | seconds}
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# no svc keepalive {none | seconds}
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
SVC keepalives are disabled by default. Using the keyword none disables SVC keepalive messages.
In the following example, the user configures the security appliance to enable the SVC to send keepalive
messages, with a frequency of 300 seconds (5 minutes):
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# svc keepalive 300
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
Step 5 To enable the permanent installation of an SVC onto a remote computer, use the svc keep-installer
command with the installed keyword. To remove the command from the configuration, use the no form
of this command:
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# svc keep-installer {installed | none}
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# no svc keep-installer {installed | none}
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
The default is that permanent installation of the SVC is disabled. The SVC uninstalls from the remote
computer at the end of the SVC session.
The following example configures the security appliance to keep the SVC installed on the remote
computer for this user:
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# svc keep-installer installed
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
Step 6 To enable the SVC to perform a rekey on an SVC session, use the svc rekey command:
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# svc rekey {method {ssl | new-tunnel} | time minutes |
none}}
To disable rekey and remove the command from the configuration, use the no form of this command:
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# no svc rekey [method {ssl | new-tunnel} | time minutes |
none}]
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
and the current method is ssl, then the command fails, because the values don't match.
In the following example, the user configures the SVC to renegotiate with SSL during rekey and
configures the rekey to occur 30 minutes after the session begins:
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# svc rekey method ssl
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# svc rekey time 30
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#
Step 1 To configure IP address pools as the address assignment method, enter the vpn-addr-assign command
with the local argument:
hostname(config)# vpn-addr-assign local
hostname(config)#
Step 2 To configure an address pool, enter the ip local pool command. The syntax is ip local pool poolname
first-address—last-address mask mask.
The following example configures an IP address pool named firstpool. The starting address is
10.20.30.40 and the ending address is 10.20.30.50. The network mask is 255.255.255.0.
hostname(config)# ip local pool firstpool 10.20.30.40-10.20.30.50 mask 255.255.255.0
hostname(config)
Step 1 To configure AAA as the address assignment method, enter the vpn-addr-assign command with the aaa
argument:
hostname(config)# vpn-addr-assign aaa
hostname(config)#
Step 2 To establish the tunnel group called firstgroup as a remote access or LAN-to-LAN tunnel group, enter
the tunnel-group command with the type keyword. The following example configures a remote access
tunnel group.
hostname(config)# tunnel-group firstgroup type ipsec-ra
hostname(config)#
Step 3 To enter general-attributes configuration mode, which lets you define a AAA server group for the tunnel
group called firstgroup, enter the tunnel-group command with the general-attributes argument.
hostname(config)# tunnel-group firstgroup general-attributes
hostname(config-general)#
Step 4 To specify the AAA server group to use for authentication, enter the authentication-server-group
command.
hostname(config-general)# authentication-server-group RAD2
hostname(config-general)#
This command has more arguments that this example includes. For more information, see the Cisco
Security Appliance Command Reference.
Step 1 To configure DHCP as the address assignment method, enter the vpn-addr-assign command with the
dhcp argument:
hostname(config)# vpn-addr-assign dhcp
hostname(config)#
Step 2 To establish the tunnel group called firstgroup as a remote access or LAN-to-LAN tunnel group, enter
the tunnel-group command with the type keyword. The following example configures a remote access
tunnel group.
hostname(config)# tunnel-group firstgroup type ipsec-ra
hostname(config)#
Step 3 To enter general-attributes configuration mode, which lets you configure a DHCP server, enter the
tunnel-group command with the general-attributes argument.
hostname(config)# tunnel-group firstgroup general-attributes
hostname(config)#
Step 4 To define the DHCP server, enter the dhcp-server command. The following example configures a DHCP
server at IP address 172.33.44.19.
hostname(config-general)# dhcp-server 172.33.44.19
hostname(config-general)#
Step 6 To define the group policy called remotegroup as an internally or externally configured group, enter the
group-policy command with the internal or external argument. The following example configures an
internal group.
hostname(config)# group-policy remotegroup internal
hostname(config)#
Step 7 (Optional) To enter group-policy attributes configuration mode, which lets you configure a subnetwork
of IP addresses for the DHCP server to use, enter the group-policy command with the attributes
keyword.
hostname(config)# group-policy remotegroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)#
Step 8 (Optional) To specify the range of IP addresses the DHCP server should use to assign addresses to users
of the group policy called remotegroup, enter the dhcp-network-scope command. The following example
configures at network scope of 192.86.0.0.
hostname(config-group-policy)# dhcp-network-scope 192.86.0.0
hostname(config-group-policy)#
Remote access VPNs let single users connect to a central site through a secure connection over a TCP/IP
network such as the Internet.
This chapter describes how to build a remote access VPN connection. It includes the following sections:
• Summary of the Configuration, page 32-1
• Configuring Interfaces, page 32-2
• Configuring ISAKMP Policy and Enabling ISAKMP on the Outside Interface, page 32-3
• Configuring an Address Pool, page 32-4
• Adding a User, page 32-4
• Creating a Transform Set, page 32-4
• Defining a Tunnel Group, page 32-5
• Creating a Dynamic Crypto Map, page 32-6
• Creating a Crypto Map Entry to Use the Dynamic Crypto Map, page 32-7
Configuring Interfaces
A security appliance has at least two interfaces, referred to here as outside and inside. Typically, the
outside interface is connected to the public Internet, while the inside interface is connected to a private
network and is protected from public access.
To begin, configure and enable two interfaces on the security appliance. Then assign a name, IP address
and subnet mask. Optionally, configure its security level, speed and duplex operation on the security
appliance.
To configure interfaces, perform the following steps, using the command syntax in the examples:
Step 1 To enter Interface configuration mode, in global configuration mode enter the interface command with
the default name of the interface to configure. In the following example the interface is ethernet0.
hostname(config)# interface ethernet0
hostname(config-if)#
Step 2 To set the IP address and subnet mask for the interface, enter the ip address command. In the following
example the IP address is 10.10.4.100 and the subnet mask is 255.255.0.0.
hostname(config-if)# ip address 10.10.4.200 255.255.0.0
hostname(config-if)#
Step 3 To name the interface, enter the nameif command, maximum of 48 characters. You cannot change this
name after you set it. In the following example the name of the ethernet0 interface is outside.
hostname(config-if)# nameif outside
hostname(config-if)##
Step 4 To enable the interface, enter the no version of the shutdown command. By default, interfaces are
disabled.
hostname(config-if)# no shutdown
hostname(config-if)#
Step 1 Set the authentication method. The following example configures preshared key. The priority is 1 in this
and all following steps.
hostname(config)# isakmp policy 1 authentication pre-share
hostname(config)#
Step 2 Set the encryption method. The following example configures 3DES.
hostname(config)# isakmp policy 1 encryption 3des
hostname(config)#
Step 3 Set the HMAC method. The following example configures SHA-1.
hostname(config)# isakmp policy 1 hash sha
hostname(config)#
Step 4 Set the Diffie-Hellman group. The following example configures Group 2.
hostname(config)# isakmp policy 1 group 2
hostname(config)#
Step 5 Set the encryption key lifetime. The following example configures 43,200 seconds (12 hours).
hostname(config)# isakmp policy 1 lifetime 43200
hostname(config)#
Step 1 To configure an address pool, enter the ip local pool command. The syntax is
ip local pool poolname first_address-last_address. In the following example the pool name is testpool.
hostname(config)# ip local pool testpool 192.168.0.10-192.168.0.15
hostname(config)#
Step 2 Save your changes.
hostname(config)# write memory
hostname(config)#
Adding a User
To identify remote access users to the security appliance, configure usernames and passwords.
Step 1 To add users, enter the username command. The syntax is username username password password. In
the following example the username is testuser and the password is 12345678.
hostname(config)# username testuser password 12345678
hostname(config)#
Step 2 Repeat Step 1 for each additional user.
Step 1 To configure a transform set, in global configuration mode enter the crypto ipsec transform-set
command. The syntax is:
crypto ipsec transform-set transform-set-name encryption-method authentication-method
The following example configures a transform set with the name FirstSet, esp-3des encryption, and
esp-md5-hmac authentication:
hostname(config)# crypto ipsec transform set FirstSet esp-3des esp-md5-hmac
hostname(config)#
Step 1 To set the connection type to IPSec remote access, enter the tunnel-group command. The command
syntax is tunnel-group name type type, where name is the name you assign to the tunnel group, and type
is the type of tunnel. The tunnel types as you enter them in the CLI include the following:
• ipsec-ra (IPSec remote access)
• ipsec-l2l (IPSec LAN to LAN)
In the following example the name of the tunnel group is testgroup.
hostname(config)# tunnel-group testgroup type ipsec-ra
hostname(config)#
Step 2 To configure an authentication method for the tunnel group, enter the general-attributes mode and then
enter the address-pool command to create the address pool. In the following example the name of the
group is testgroup and the name of the address pool is testpool.
hostname(config)# tunnel-group testgroup general-attributes
hostname(config-general)# address-pool testpool
Step 3 To configure the authentication method, enter the ipsec-attributes mode and then enter the
pre-shared-key command to create the preshared key. You need to use the same preshared key on both
the security appliance and the client.
Note The preshared key must be no larger than that used by the VPN client. If a Cisco VPN Client with a
different preshared key size tries to connect to a security appliance, the client logs an error message
indicating it failed to authenticate the peer.
The key is an alphanumeric string of 1-128 characters. In the following example the preshared key is
44kkaol59636jnfx.
hostname(config)# tunnel-group testgroup ipsec-attributes
hostname(config-ipsec)# pre-shared-key 44kkaol59636jnfx
Step 1 To specify a transform set for a dynamic crypto map entry, enter the crypto dynamic-map set
transform-set command.
The syntax is crypto dynamic -map dynamic-map-name seq-num set transform-set
transform-set-name. In the following example the name of the dynamic map is dyn1, the sequence
number is 1, and the transform set name is FirstSet.
hostname(config)# crypto dynamic-map dyn1 1 set transform-set FirstSet
hostname(config)#
Step 2 To enable RRI for any connection based on this crypto map entry, enter the crypto dynamic-map set
reverse route command.
hostname(config)# crypto dynamic-map dyn1 1 set reverse-route
hostname(config)#
Step 1 To create a crypto map entry that uses a dynamic crypto map, enter the crypto map command. The
syntax is crypto map map-name seq-num ipsec-isakmp dynamic dynamic-map-name.
hostname(config)# crypto map mymap 1 ipsec-isakmp dynamic dyn1
hostname(config)#
Step 2 To apply the crypto map to the outside interface, enter the crypto map interface command.
The syntax is crypto map map-name interface interface-name
hostname(config)# crypto map mymap interface outside
hostname(config)#
Note When configured to support NAC, the security appliance functions as a client of a Cisco Secure Access
Control Server, requiring that you install a minimum of one Access Control Server on the network to
provide NAC authentication services.
Following the configuration of one or more Access Control Servers on the network, you must use the
aaa-server command to name the Access Control Server group. Then follow the instructions in
Configuring Basic Settings, page 33-2 to configure NAC.
ASA support for NAC is limited to remote access IPSec and L2TP over IPSec sessions. NAC on the ASA
does not support WebVPN, non-VPN traffic, IPv6, and multimode.
Note See Uses, Requirements, and Limitations, page 33-1 before following these instructions.
nac-authentication-server-group server-group
server-group must match the server-tag variable specified in the aaa-server host command.
For example, enter the following command to specify acs-group1 as the authentication server group to
be used for NAC posture validation:
hostname(config-group-policy)# nac-authentication-server-group acs-group1
hostname(config-group-policy)
To inherit the authentication server group from the default remote access group, access the alternative
group policy from which to inherit it, then enter the following command:
no nac-authentication-server-group
For example:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac-authentication-server-group
hostname(config-group-policy)
Enabling NAC
To enable or disable NAC for a group policy, enter the following command in group-policy configuration
mode:
To inherit the NAC setting from the default group policy, access the alternative group policy from which
to inherit it, then issue the following command:
no nac
For example:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac
hostname(config-group-policy)#
Note Because NAC is disabled by default, VPN traffic traversing the security appliance is not subject to the
NAC Default ACL until NAC is enabled.
Enter the following command in group-policy configuration mode to specify the ACL to be used as the
default ACL for NAC sessions:
acl-name is the name of the posture validation server group, as configured on the security appliance
using the aaa-server host command. The name must match the server-tag variable specified in that
command.
For example, enter the following command to specify acl-1 as the NAC default ACL:
hostname(config-group-policy)# nac-default-acl value acl-1
hostname(config-group-policy)
To inherit the ACL from the default group policy, access the alternative group policy from which to
inherit it and enter the following command.
no nac-default-acl
For example:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac-default-acl
hostname(config-group-policy)
You also have the option of disinheriting the ACL from the default group policy and specifying no NAC
default ACL. To do so, enter the following command:
nac-default-acl none
For example:
hostname(config-group-policy)# nac-default-acl none
hostname(config-group-policy)
Note This command does not overwrite the previously added entry to the exception list; enter the command
once for each operating system and ACL you want to exempt.
os name is the operating system name. Use quotation marks if the name includes a space (for example,
“Windows XP”).
For example, enter the following command to add all hosts running Windows XP to the list of computers
that are exempt from posture validation:
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-nac-exempt os "Windows XP"
hostname(config-group-policy)
The following example shows how to add the same entry to the exemption list, but disable it:
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-nac-exempt os "Windows 98" filter acl-1 disable
hostname(config-group-policy)
To disable inheritance and specify that all hosts are subject to posture validation, enter the following
command:
vpn-nac-exempt none
For example:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no vpn-nac-exempt none
hostname(config-group-policy)
To remove an entry from the exemption list, enter the following command, naming the operating system
(and ACL) in the exemption to be removed.
For example, enter the following command to remove the entry with Windows 98 and acl-1 from the
exemption list, regardless of whether it is disabled:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no vpn-nac-exempt os "Windows 98" filter acl-1
hostname(config-group-policy)
To remove all entries from the exemption list associated with this group policy and inherit the list from
the default group policy, enter the following command without specifying additional keywords:
no vpn-nac-exempt
For example:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no vpn-nac-exempt
hostname(config-group-policy)
For example:
hostname(config)# eou allow clientless
hostname(config)#
Enter the following command in global configuration mode to disable clientless authentication:
For example:
hostname(config)# no eou allow clientless
hostname(config)#
username must match the username configured on the Access Control Server to support clientless hosts.
Enter 1 to 64 ASCII characters, excluding leading and trailing spaces, pound signs (#), question marks
(?), quotation marks ("), asterisks (*), and angle brackets (< and >).
Enter the following command in global configuration mode to change the password used for clientless
authentication:
password must match the password configured on the Access Control Server to support clientless hosts.
Enter 4 – 32 ASCII characters.
You can specify only the username, only the password, or both. For example, enter the following
commands to change the username and password for clientless authentication to sherlock and
221B-baker, respectively:
hostname(config)# eou clientless username sherlock
hostname(config)# eou clientless password 221B-baker
hostname(config)#
To change the username to its default value, enter the following command:
For example:
hostname(config)# no eou clientless username
hostname(config)#
To change the password to its default value, enter the following command:
For example:
hostname(config)# no eou clientless password
hostname(config)#
port_number must match the port number configured on the CTA. Enter a value in the range 1024
to 65535.
For example, enter the following command to change the port number for EAP over UDP
communication to 62445:
hostname(config)# eou port 62445
hostname(config)#
To change the port number to its default value, use the no form of this command, as follows:
no eou port
For example:
hostname(config)# no eou port
hostname(config)#
To change the retransmission retry timer to its default value, use the no form of this command, as
follows:
For example:
hostname(config)# no eou timeout retransmit
hostname(config)#
• Retransmission retries
When the security appliance sends an EAP over UDP message to the remote host, it waits for a
response. If it fails to receive a response, it resends the EAP over UDP message. By default, it retries
up to 3 times. To change this value, enter the following command in global configuration mode:
To change the maximum number of retransmission retries to its default value, use the no form of
this command, as follows:
no eou max-retry
For example:
hostname(config)# no eou max-retry
hostname(config)#
To change the session reinitialization to its default value, use the no form of this command, as
follows:
For example:
hostname(config)# no eou timeout hold-period
hostname(config)#
nac-sq-period seconds
To inherit the value of the status query timer from the default group policy, access the alternative group
policy from which to inherit it, then enter the following command.
no nac-sq-period [seconds]
For example:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac-sq-period
hostname(config-group-policy)
nac-reval-period seconds
To inherit the value of the revalidation timer from the default group policy, access the alternative group
policy from which to inherit it, then enter the following command.
no nac-reval-period
For example:
hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac-reval-period
hostname(config-group-policy)
This chapter describes how to configure the ASA 5505 as an Easy VPN hardware client. This chapter
assumes you have configured the switch ports and VLAN interfaces of the ASA 5505 (see Chapter 4,
“Configuring Switch Ports and VLAN Interfaces for the Cisco ASA 5505 Adaptive Security
Appliance”).
Note The Easy VPN hardware client configuration specifies the IP address of its primary and secondary
(backup) Easy VPN servers. Any ASA, including another ASA 5505 configured as a headend, a VPN
3000 Series Concentrator, an IOS-based router, or a firewall can act as an Easy VPN server. An ASA
5505 cannot, however function as both a client and a server simultaneously. To configure an ASA 5505
as a server, see “Specifying the Client/Server Role of the Cisco ASA 5505” section on page 34-2. Then
configure the ASA 5505 as you would any other ASA, beginning with the “Getting Started” section on
page 2-1 of this guide.
The CLI responds with an error message indicating that you must remove certain data elements if you
switch from server to hardware client, depending on whether the elements are present in the
configuration. Table 0-1 lists the data elements that are permitted in both client and server
configurations, and not permitted in client configurations.
An ASA 5505 configured as an Easy VPN hardware client retains the commands listed in the first
column within its configuration, however, some have no function in the client role.
The following example shows how to specify the ASA 5505 as an Easy VPN server:
hostname(config)# no vpnclient enable
hostname(config)#
After entering the no version of this command, configure the ASA 5505 as you would any other ASA,
beginning with “Getting Started” section on page 2-1 of this guide.
Note If the Easy VPN hardware client is using NEM and has connections to secondary servers, use the crypto
map set reverse-route command on each headend device to configure dynamic announcements of the
remote network using Reverse Route Injection (RRI).
To specify the mode for Easy VPN Clients, enter the following command in configuration mode:
To remove the username and password from the running configuration, enter the following command:
no vpnclient username
For example:
hostname(config)# no vpnclient username
hostname(config)#
The Easy VPN hardware client uses port 10000 if the command does not specify a port number.
If you configure an ASA 5505 to use TCP-encapsulated IPSec, enter the following command to let it
send large packets over the outside interface:
hostname(config)# crypto ipsec df-bit clear-df outside
hostname(config)#
This command clears the Don't Fragment (DF) bit from the encapsulated header. A DF bit is a bit within
the IP header that determines whether the packet can be fragmented. This command lets the Easy VPN
hardware client send packets that are larger than the MTU size.
The following example shows how to configure the Easy VPN hardware client to use TCP-encapsulated
IPSec, using the default port 10000, and to let it send large packets over the outside interface:
hostname(config)# vpnclient ipsec-over-tcp
hostname(config)# crypto ipsec df-bit clear-df outside
hostname(config)#
The next example shows how to configure the Easy VPN hardware client to use TCP-encapsulated
IPSec, using the port 10501, and to let it send large packets over the outside interface:
hostname(config)# vpnclient ipsec-over-tcp port 10501
hostname(config)# crypto ipsec df-bit clear-df outside
hostname(config)#
To remove the attribute from the running configuration, use the no form of this command, as follows:
no vpnclient ipsec-over-tcp
For example:
hostname(config)# no vpnclient ipsec-over-tcp
hostname(config)#
Caution Cisco does not support the use of the vpnclient management command if a NAT device is
present between the client and the Internet.
• Use of the vpnclient mode command to specify one of the following modes of operation:
– client to use Port Address Translation (PAT) mode to isolate the addresses of the inside hosts,
relative to the client, from the enterprise network.
Figure 34-1 Easy VPN Hardware Client Tunneling Options for the Cisco ASA 5505
2) Management
a) clear N/A N/A
3) Inside to Inside
a) NEM Mode NEM Network Any or ST-List (*3)
Configuration factors:
1. Certs or Preshare Keys (Phase 1- main mode or aggressive mode)
2. Mode: Client or NEM
3. All-or-nothing or Split-tunneling
153780
4. Management Tunnels
* Only for ASA or VPN3000 Headends
5. IUA to VPN3000 or ASA headend
The term “All-Or-Nothing” refers to the presence or absence of an access list for split tunneling. The
access list (“ST-list”) distinguishes networks that require tunneling from those that do not.
group_name is the name of the VPN tunnel group configured on the Easy VPN server. You must
configure this tunnel group on the server before establishing a connection.
preshared_key is the IKE pre-shared key used for authentication on the Easy VPN server.
For example, enter the following command to identify the VPN tunnel group named TestGroup1 and the
IKE preshared key my_key123.
hostname(config)# vpnclient vpngroup TestGroup1 password my_key123
hostname(config)#
To remove the attribute from the running configuration, enter the following command:
no vpnclient vpngroup
If the configuration of the ASA 5505 running as an Easy VPN client does not specify a tunnel group, the
client attempts to use an RSA certificate.
For example:
hostname(config)# no vpnclient vpngroup
hostname(config)#
trustpoint_name names the trustpoint identifying the RSA certificate to use for authentication.
(Optional) chain sends the entire certificate chain.
For example, enter the following command to specify the identity certificate named central and send the
entire certificate chain:
hostname(config)# crypto ca trustpoint central
hostname(config)# vpnclient trustpoint central chain
hostname(config)#
To remove the attribute from the running configuration, enter the following command:
no vpnclient trustpoint
For example:
hostname(config)# no vpnclient trustpoint
hostname(config)#
The next example provides greater security but less flexibility because it exempts one specific Cisco IP
phone:
hostname(config)# vpnclient mac-exempt 0003.6b54.b213 ffff.ffff.ffff
hostname(config)#
Caution Do not configure a management tunnel on a Cisco ASA 5505 configured as an Easy VPN
hardware client if a NAT device is operating between the Easy VPN hardware client and the
Internet. In that configuration, use the vpnclient management clear command.
Use the vpnclient management tunnel command in global configuration mode if you want to automate
the creation of IPSec tunnels to provide management access from the corporate network to the outside
interface of the ASA 5505. The Easy VPN hardware client and server create the tunnels automatically
after the execution of the vpnclient server command. The syntax of the vpnclient management tunnel
command follows:
For example, enter the following command to automate the creation of an IPSec tunnel to provide
management access to the host with IP address 192.168.10.10:
hostname(config)# vpnclient management tunnel 192.198.10.10 255.255.255.0
hostname(config)#
The no form of this command sets up IPSec for management tunnels in accordance with the
split-tunnel-policy and split-tunnel-network-list commands.
no vpnclient management
For example:
hostname(config)# no vpnclient management
hostname(config)#
Note This section serves only as a reference. For complete instructions on configuring group policies and
users, see Configuring Tunnel Groups, Group Policies, and Users, page 30-1.
Use Table 34-2 as a guide for determining which commands to enter to modify the group policy or user
attributes.
Table 34-2 Group Policy and User Attributes Pushed to the Cisco ASA 5505 Configured as an
EasyVPN Hardware Client
Command Description
backup-servers Sets up backup servers on the client in case the primary server fails to
respond.
banner Sends a banner to the client after establishing a tunnel.
client-access-rule Applies access rules.
client-firewall Sets up the firewall parameters on the VPN client.
default-domain Sends a domain name to the client.
dns-server Specifies the IP address of the primary and secondary DNS servers, or
prohibits the use of DNS servers.
dhcp-network-scope Specifies the IP subnetwork to which the DHCP server assigns address to
users within this group.
group-lock Specifies a tunnel group to ensure that users connect to that group.
ipsec-udp Uses UDP encapsulation for the IPSec tunnels.
ipsec-udp-port Specifies the port number for IPSec over UDP.
nem Enables or disables network extension mode.
password-storage Lets the VPN user save a password in the user profile.
pfs Commands the VPN client to use perfect forward secrecy.
re-xauth Requires XAUTH authentication when IKE rekeys.
Note: Disable re-xauth if secure unit authentication is enabled.
secure-unit-authentication Enables interactive authentication for VPN hardware clients.
split-dns Pushes a list of domains for name resolution.
Table 34-2 Group Policy and User Attributes Pushed to the Cisco ASA 5505 Configured as an
EasyVPN Hardware Client (continued)
Command Description
split-tunnel-network-list Specifies one of the following:
• No access list exists for split tunneling. All traffic travels across the
tunnel.
• Identifies the access list the security appliance uses to distinguish
networks that require tunneling and those that do not.
Split tunneling lets a remote-access IPSec client conditionally direct
packets over an IPSec tunnel in encrypted form, or to a network interface
in cleartext form. With split-tunneling enabled, packets not bound for
destinations on the other side of the IPSec tunnel do not have to be
encrypted, sent across the tunnel, decrypted, and then routed to a final
destination.
split-tunnel-policy Lets a remote-access IPSec client conditionally direct packets over an
IPSec tunnel in encrypted form, or to a network interface in cleartext form.
Options include the following:
• split-tunnel-policy—Indicates that you are setting rules for tunneling
traffic.
• excludespecified—Defines a list of networks to which traffic goes in
the clear.
• tunnelall—Specifies that no traffic goes in the clear or to any other
destination than the Easy VPN server. Remote users reach Internet
networks through the corporate network and do not have access to
local networks.
• tunnelspecified—Tunnels all traffic from or to the specified networks.
This option enables split tunneling. It lets you create a network list of
addresses to tunnel. Data to all other addresses travels in the clear, and
is routed by the remote user’s internet service provider.
user-authentication Enables individual user authentication for hardware-based VPN clients.
vpn-access-hours Restricts VPN access hours.
vpn-filter Applies a filter to VPN traffic.
vpn-idle-timeout Specifies the number of minutes a session can be idle before it times out.
vpn-session-timeout Specifies the maximum number of minutes for VPN connections.
vpn-simultaneous-logins Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous logins.
vpn-tunnel-protocol Specifies the permitted tunneling protocols.
wins-server Specifies the IP address of the primary and secondary WINS servers, or
prohibits the use of WINS servers.
Note IPSec NAT-T connections are the only IPSec connection types supported on the home VLAN of a Cisco
ASA 5505. IPSec over TCP and native IPSec connections are not supported.
Authentication Options
The ASA 5505 supports the following authentication mechanisms, which it obtains from the group
policy stored on the Easy VPN Server. The following list identifies the authentication options supported
by the Easy VPN hardware client, however, you must configure them on the Easy VPN server:
• Secure unit authentication (SUA, also called Interactive unit authentication)
Ignores the vpnclient username Xauth command (described in “Configuring Automatic Xauth
Authentication” section on page 34-4) and requires the user to authenticate the ASA 5505 by
entering a password. By default, SUA is disabled. You can use the secure-unit-authentication
enable command in group-policy configuration mode to enable SUA. See Configuring Secure Unit
Authentication, page 30-44.
• Individual user authentication
Requires users behind the ASA 5505 to authenticate before granting them access to the enterprise
VPN network. By default, IUA is disabled.
Caution Do not use IUA if the client might have a NAT device.
You can use the user-authentication enable command in group-policy configuration mode to
enable IUA. See Configuring User Authentication, page 30-44.
Caution Do not configure IUA on a Cisco ASA 5505 configured as an Easy VPN server if a NAT device
is operating between the server and the Easy VPN hardware client.
Use the user-authentication-idle-timeout command to set or remove the idle timeout period after
which the Easy VPN Server terminates the client’s access. See Configuring an Idle Timeout, page
30-45.
• Authentication by HTTP redirection
The Cisco Easy VPN server intercepts HTTP traffic and redirects the user to a login page if one of
the following is true:
– SUA or the username and password are not configured on the Easy VPN hardware client.
– IAU is enabled.
HTTP redirection is automatic and does not require configuration on the Easy VPN Server.
• Preshared keys, digital certificates, tokens and no authentication
The ASA 5505 supports preshared keys, token-based (e.g., SDI one-time passwords), and “no user
authentication” for user authentication. NOTE: The Cisco Easy VPN server can use the digital
certificate as part of user authorization. See Chapter 27, “Configuring IPSec and ISAKMP” for
instructions.
This section describes how to configure the PPPoE client provided with the security appliance. It
includes the following topics:
• PPPoE Client Overview, page 35-1
• Configuring the PPPoE Client Username and Password, page 35-2
• Enabling PPPoE, page 35-3
• Using PPPoE with a Fixed IP Address, page 35-3
• Monitoring and Debugging the PPPoE Client, page 35-4
• Using Related Commands, page 35-5
At system initialization, the PPPoE client establishes a session with the access concentrator by
exchanging a series of packets. Once the session is established, a PPP link is set up, which includes
authentication using Password Authentication protocol (PAP). Once the PPP session is established, each
packet is encapsulated in the PPPoE and PPP headers.
Note PPPoE is not supported when failover is configured on the security appliance, or in multiple context or
transparent mode. PPPoE is only supported in single, routed mode, without failover.
Step 1 Define the VPDN group to be used for PPPoE using the following command:
hostname(config)# vpdn group group_name request dialout pppoe
In this command, replace group_name with a descriptive name for the group, such as “pppoe-sbc.”
Step 2 If your ISP requires authentication, select an authentication protocol by entering the following
command:
hostname(config)# vpdn group group_name ppp authentication {chap | mschap | pap}
Replace group_name with the same group name you defined in the previous step. Enter the appropriate
keyword for the type of authentication used by your ISP:
• CHAP—Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol
• MS-CHAP—Microsoft Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol Version 1
• PAP—Password Authentication Protocol
Note When using CHAP or MS-CHAP, the username may be referred to as the remote system name,
while the password may be referred to as the CHAP secret.
Step 3 Associate the username assigned by your ISP to the VPDN group by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# vpdn group group_name localname username
Replace group_name with the VPDN group name and username with the username assigned by your ISP.
Step 4 Create a username and password pair for the PPPoE connection by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# vpdn username username password password [store-local]
Replace username with the username and password with the password assigned by your ISP.
Note The store-local option stores the username and password in a special location of NVRAM on
the security appliance. If an Auto Update Server sends a clear config command to the security
appliance and the connection is then interrupted, the security appliance can read the username
and password from NVRAM and re-authenticate to the Access Concentrator.
Enabling PPPoE
Note You must complete the configuration using the vpdn command, described in “Configuring the PPPoE
Client Username and Password,” before enabling PPPoE.
The PPPoE client functionality is turned off by default. To enable PPPoE, perform the following steps:
Step 1 Enable the PPPoE client by entering the following command from interface configuration mode:
hostname(config-if)# ip address pppoe [setroute]
The setroute option sets the default routes when the PPPoE client has not yet established a connection.
When using the setroute option, you cannot have a statically defined route in the configuration.
PPPoE is not supported in conjunction with DHCP because with PPPoE the IP address is assigned by
PPP. The setroute option causes a default route to be created if no default route exists. The default router
is the address of the access concentrator. The maximum transmission unit (MTU) size is automatically
set to 1492 bytes, which is the correct value to allow PPPoE transmission within an Ethernet frame.
Reenter this command to reset the DHCP lease and request a new lease.
Note If PPPoE is enabled on two interfaces (such as a primary and backup interface), and you do not
configure dual ISP support (see the “Configuring Static Route Tracking” section on page 9-3),
then the security appliance can only send traffic through the first interface to acquire an
IP address.
For example:
hostname(config)# interface gigabitethernet 0/0
hostname(config-if)# ip address pppoe
Step 2 Specify a VPDN group for the PPPoE client to use with the following command from interface
configuration mode (optional):
hostname(config-if)# pppoe client vpdn group grpname
Note If you have multiple VPDN groups configured, and you do not specify a group with the pppoe client
vpdn group command, the security appliance may randomly choose a VPDN group. To avoid this,
specify a VPDN group.
This command causes the security appliance to use the specified address instead of negotiating with the
PPPoE server to assign an address dynamically. Replace ipaddress and mask with the IP address and
subnet mask assigned to your security appliance.
For example:
hostname(config-if)# ip address outside 201.n.n.n 255.255.255.0 pppoe
Note The setroute option is an option of the ip address command that you can use to allow the access
concentrator to set the default routes when the PPPoE client has not yet established a connection. When
using the setroute option, you cannot have a statically defined route in the configuration.
Use the following command to enable or disable debugging for the PPPoE client:
hostname# [no] debug pppoe {event | error | packet}
To remove all vpdn username commands, use the clear configure vpdn username command:
hostname(config)# clear configure vpdn username
Entering either of these commands has no affect upon active PPPoE connections.
This command is only required if the service provider provides this information as described in
RFC 1877. The client_ifx_name parameter identifies the interface supported by the DHCP auto_config
option. At this time, this keyword is not required because the PPPoE client is only supported on a single
outside interface.
LAN-to-LAN VPN configurations are between two IPSec security gateways, such as security appliances
or other protocol-compliant VPN devices. A LAN-to-LAN VPN connects networks in different
geographic locations.
This chapter describes how to build a LAN-to-LAN VPN connection. It includes the following sections:
• Summary of the Configuration, page 36-1
• Configuring Interfaces, page 36-2
• Configuring ISAKMP Policy and Enabling ISAKMP on the Outside Interface, page 36-2
• Creating a Transform Set, page 36-4
• Configuring an ACL, page 36-4
• Defining a Tunnel Group, page 36-5
• Creating a Crypto Map and Applying It To an Interface, page 36-6
Configuring Interfaces
A security appliance has at least two interfaces, referred to here as outside and inside. Typically, the
outside interface is connected to the public Internet, while the inside interface is connected to a private
network and is protected from public access.
To begin, configure and enable two interfaces on the security appliance. Then, assign a name, IP address
and subnet mask. Optionally, configure its security level, speed, and duplex operation on the security
appliance.
To configure interfaces, perform the following steps, using the command syntax in the examples:
Step 1 To enter Interface configuration mode, in global configuration mode enter the interface command with
the default name of the interface to configure. In the following example the interface is ethernet0.
hostname(config)# interface ethernet0
hostname(config-if)#
Step 2 To set the IP address and subnet mask for the interface, enter the ip address command. In the following
example the IP address is 10.10.4.100 and the subnet mask is 255.255.0.0.
hostname(config-if)# ip address 10.10.4.100 255.255.0.0
hostname(config-if)#
Step 3 To name the interface, enter the nameif command, maximum of 48 characters. You cannot change this
name after you set it. In the following example the name of the ethernet0 interface is outside.
hostname(config-if)# nameif outside
hostname(config-if)##
Step 4 To enable the interface, enter the no version of the shutdown command. By default, interfaces are
disabled.
hostname(config-if)# no shutdown
hostname(config-if)#
Step 1 Set the authentication method. The following example configures a preshared key. The priority is 1 in
this and all following steps.
hostname(config)# isakmp policy 1 authentication pre-share
hostname(config)#
Step 2 Set the encryption method. The following example configures 3DES.
hostname(config)# isakmp policy 1 encryption 3des
hostname(config)#
Step 3 Set the HMAC method. The following example configures SHA-1.
hostname(config)# isakmp policy 1 hash sha
hostname(config)#
Step 4 Set the Diffie-Hellman group. The following example configures Group 2.
hostname(config)# isakmp policy 1 group 2
hostname(config)#
Step 5 Set the encryption key lifetime. The following example configures 43,200 seconds (12 hours).
hostname(config)# isakmp policy 1 lifetime 43200
hostname(config)#
Tunnel Mode is the usual way to implement IPSec between two security appliances that are connected
over an untrusted network, such as the public Internet. Tunnel mode is the default and requires no
configuration.
To configure a transform set, perform the following steps:
Step 1 In global configuration mode enter the crypto ipsec transform-set command. The following example
configures a transform set with the name FirstSet, esp-3des encryption, and esp-md5-hmac
authentication. The syntax is as follows:
crypto ipsec transform-set transform-set-name encryption-method authentication-method
hostname(config)# crypto ipsec transform-set FirstSet esp-3des esp-md5-hmac
hostname(config)#
Configuring an ACL
The security appliance uses access control lists to control network access. By default, the security
appliance denies all traffic. You need to configure an ACL that permits traffic.
The ACLs that you configure for this LAN-to-LAN VPN control connections are based on the source
and destination IP addresses. Configure ACLs that mirror each other on both sides of the connection.
To configure an ACL, perform the following steps:
Step 1 Enter the access-list extended command. The following example configures an ACL named l2l_list that
lets traffic from IP addresses in the 192.168.0.0 network travel to the 150.150.0.0 network. The syntax
is access-list listname extended permit ip source-ipaddress source-netmask destination-ipaddress
destination-netmask.
hostname(config)# access-list l2l_list extended permit ip 192.168.0.0 255.255.0.0
150.150.0.0 255.255.0.0
hostname(config)#
Step 2 Configure an ACL for the security appliance on the other side of the connection that mirrors the ACL
above. In the following example the prompt for the peer is hostname2.
hostname2(config)# access-list l2l_list extended permit ip 150.150.0.0 255.255.0.0
192.168.0.0 255.255.0.0
hostname(config)#
Step 1 To set the connection type to IPSec LAN-to-LAN, enter the tunnel-group command. The syntax is
tunnel-group name type type, where name is the name you assign to the tunnel group, and type is the
type of tunnel. The tunnel types as you enter them in the CLI are:
• ipsec-ra (IPSec remote access)
• ipsec-l2l (IPSec LAN to LAN)
In the following example the name of the tunnel group is the IP address of the LAN-to-LAN peer,
10.10.4.108.
hostname(config)# tunnel-group 10.10.4.108 type ipsec-l2l
hostname(config)#
Step 2 To set the authentication method to preshared key, enter the ipsec-attributes mode and then enter the
pre-shared-key command to create the preshared key. You need to use the same preshared key on both
security appliances for this LAN-to-LAN connection.
The key is an alphanumeric string of 1-128 characters. In the following example the preshared key is
44kkaol59636jnfx.
hostname(config)# tunnel-group 10.10.4.108 ipsec-attributes
Step 1 To assign an access list to a crypto map entry, enter the crypto map match address command.
The syntax is crypto map map-name seq-num match address aclname. In the following example the
map name is abcmap, the sequence number is 1, and the access list name is l2l_list.
hostname(config)# crypto map abcmap 1 match address l2l_list
hostname(config)#
Step 2 To identify the peer (s) for the IPSec connection, enter the crypto map set peer command.
The syntax is crypto map map-name seq-num set peer {ip_address1 | hostname1}[... ip_address10 |
hostname10]. In the following example the peer name is 10.10.4.108.
hostname(config)# crypto map abcmap 1 set peer 10.10.4.108
hostname(config)#
Step 3 To specify a transform set for a crypto map entry, enter the crypto map set transform-set command.
The syntax is crypto map map-name seq-num set transform-set transform-set-name. In the following
example the transform set name is FirstSet.
hostname(config)# crypto map abcmap 1 set transform-set FirstSet
hostname(config)#
Step 1 To apply the configured crypto map to the outside interface, enter the crypto map interface command.
The syntax is crypto map map-name interface interface-name.
hostname(config)# crypto map abcmap interface outside
hostname(config)#
WebVPN uses Secure Sockets Layer Protocol and its successor, Transport Layer Security to provide the
secure connection between remote users and specific, supported internal resources that you configure at
a central site. The security appliance recognizes connections that need to be proxied, and the HTTP
server interacts with the authentication subsystem to authenticate users.
The network administrator provides access to WebVPN resources to users on a group basis. Users have
no direct access to resources on the internal network.
The following sections address getting started with the configuration of WebVPN access:
• Observing WebVPN Security Precautions
• Understanding Features Not Supported for WebVPN
• Using SSL to Access the Central Site
• Authenticating with Digital Certificates
• Enabling Cookies on Browsers for WebVPN
• Managing Passwords
• Using Single Sign-on with WebVPN
• Authenticating with Digital Certificates
Step 1 In global configuration mode, enter the webvpn command to enter webvpn mode.
Step 2 Enter the enable command with the name of the interface that you want to use for WebVPN sessions.
For example, to enable WebVPN sessions on the interface called outside, enter the following:
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# enable outside
To specify a port for HTTPS, use the port argument of the http server enable command. The following
example specifies that HTTPS ASDM sessions use port 444 on the outside interface. WebVPN is also
enabled on the outside interface and uses the default port (443). With this configuration, remote users
initiate ASDM sessions by entering https://<outside_ip>:444 in the browser.
hostname(config)# http server enable 444
hostname(config)# http 192.168.3.0 255.255.255.0 outside
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# enable outside
To specify a port for WebVPN, use the port command from webvpn configuration mode. The next
example enables WebVPN on port 444 of the outside interface. HTTPS for ASDM is also configured on
the outside interface and uses the default port (443). With this configuration, remote users initiating
WebVPN sessions enter https://<outside_ip>:444 in the browser.
hostname(config)# http server enable
hostname(config)# http 192.168.3.0 255.255.255.0 outside
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# port 444
hostname(config-webvpn)# enable outside
Managing Passwords
You can configure the security appliance to warn end users when their passwords are about to expire.
To do this, you specify the password-management command in tunnel-group general-attributes mode.
When you configure this command, the security appliance notifies the remote user at login that the user’s
current password is about to expire or has expired. The security appliance then offers the user the
opportunity to change the password. If the current password has not yet expired, the user can still log in
using that password. This command is valid for AAA servers that support such notification; that is,
RADIUS, RADIUS with an NT server, and LDAP servers. The security appliance ignores this command
if RADIUS or LDAP authentication has not been configured.
Note that this does not change the number of days before the password expires, but rather specifies the
number of days ahead of expiration that the security appliance starts warning the user that the password
is about to expire. The default value is 14 days.
For LDAP server authentication only, you can use the password-expire-in-days keyword to specify a
specific number of days. If you specify the password-expire-in-days keyword, you must also specify
the number of days.
Specifying this command with the number of days set to 0 disables this command. The security appliance
then does not notify the user of the pending expiration, but the user can change the password after it
expires.
The following example sets the days before password expiration to begin warning the user of the pending
expiration to 90 for the tunnel group “testgroup”:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group testgroup type webvpn
hostname(config)# tunnel-group testgroup general-attributes
Mode Scope
Webvpn configuration All WebVPN users globally
Webvpn group configuration A subset of WebVPN users defined by a group policy
Webvpn username configuration An individual WebVPN user
The following example commands present various possible combinations of modes and arguments.
To configure auto-signon for all WebVPN users to servers with IP addresses ranging from 10.1.1.0 to
10.1.1.255 using NTLM authentication, for example, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# auto-signon allow ip 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.0 auth-type ntlm
To configure auto-signon for all WebVPN users, using basic HTTP authentication, to servers defined
by the URI mask https://*.example.com/*, for example, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# auto-signon allow uri https://*.example.com/* auth-type basic
To configure auto-signon for a user named Anyuser to servers with IP addresses ranging from 10.1.1.0
to 10.1.1.255 using HTTP Basic authentication, for example, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# username Anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# auto-signon allow ip 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.0 auth-type
basic
This section presents an overview of the tasks necessary to configure SSO with SiteMinder SSO. These
tasks are:
• Specifying the SSO server.
• Specifying the URL of the SSO server to which the security appliance makes SSO authentication
requests.
• Specifying a secret key to secure the communication between the security appliance and the SSO
server. This key is similar to a password: you create it, save it, and enter it on both the security
appliance and the SiteMinder Policy Server using the Cisco Java plug-in authentication scheme.
In addition to these required tasks, you can optionally do the following configuration tasks:
• Configuring the authentication request timeout.
This section presents specific steps for configuring the security appliance to support SSO authentication
with CA SiteMinder. To configure SSO with SiteMinder, perform the following steps:
Step 1 In webvpn configuration mode, enter the sso-server command with the type option to create an SSO
server. For example, to create an SSO server named Example of type siteminder, enter the following:
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# sso-server Example type siteminder
hostname(config-webvpn-sso-siteminder)#
Note The security appliance currently supports only the SSO server type siteminder.
Step 2 Enter the web-agent-url command in webvpn-sso-siteminder configuration mode to specify the
authentication URL of the SSO server. For example, to send authentication requests to the URL
http://www.Example.com/webvpn, enter the following:
hostname(config-webvpn-sso-siteminder)# web-agent-url http://www.Example.com/webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn-sso-siteminder)#
Step 3 Specify a secret key to secure the authentication communications between the security appliance and
SiteMinder using the policy-server-secret command in webvpn-sso-siteminder configuration mode.
You can create a key of any length using any regular or shifted alphanumeric character, but you must
enter the same key on both the security appliance and the SSO server.
For example, to create the secret key AtaL8rD8!, enter the following:
hostname(config-webvpn-sso-siteminder)# policy-server-secret AtaL8rD8!
hostname(config-webvpn-sso-siteminder)#
Step 4 Optionally, you can configure the number of seconds before a failed SSO authentication attempt times
out using the request-timeout command in webvpn-sso-siteminder configuration mode. The default
number of seconds is 5 seconds and the possible range is 1 to 30 seconds. To change the number of
seconds before a request times out to 8, for example, enter the following:
hostname(config-webvpn-sso-siteminder)# request-timeout 8
hostname(config-webvpn-sso-siteminder)#
Step 5 Optionally, you can configure the number of times the security appliance retries a failed SSO
authentication attempt before the authentication times-out using the max-retry-attempts command in
webvpn-sso-siteminder configuration mode. The default is 3 retry attempts and the possible range is 1
to 5 attempts. To configure the number of retries to be 4, for example, enter the following:
hostname(config-webvpn-sso-siteminder)# max-retry-attempts 4
hostname(config-webvpn-sso-siteminder)#
Step 6 After you configure the SSO server, you must specify SSO authentication for either a group or user. To
specify SSO for a group, assign an SSO server to a group policy using the sso-server value command
in group-policy-webvpn configuration mode. To specify SSO for a user, assign an SSO server to a user
policy using the same command, sso-server value, but in username-webvpn configuration mode. For
example, to assign the SSO server named Example to the user named Anyuser, enter the following:
hostname(config)# username Anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# webvpn
Step 7 Finally, you can test the SSO server configuration using the test sso-server command in privileged
EXEC mode. For example, to test the SSO server named Example using the username Anyuser, enter
the following:
hostname# test sso-server Example username Anyuser
INFO: Attempting authentication request to sso-server Example for user Anyuser
INFO: STATUS: Success
hostname#
Besides configuring the security appliance for SSO with SiteMinder, you must also configure your CA
SiteMinder Policy Server with the Cisco authentication scheme, provided as a Java plug-in.
Note • Configuring the SiteMinder Policy Server requires experience with SiteMinder.
• This section presents general tasks, not a complete procedure.
• Refer to the CA SiteMinder documentation for the complete procedure for adding a custom
authentication scheme.
To configure the Cisco authentication scheme on your SiteMinder Policy Server, perform these
following tasks:
Step 1 With the Siteminder Administration utility, create a custom authentication scheme being sure to use the
following specific arguments:
• In the Library field, enter smjavaapi.
• In the Secret field, enter the same secret configured on the security appliance.
You configure this on the security appliance with either the policy-server-secret command at the
command line interface or in the Secret Key field of the Add SSO Server dialog in ASDM.
• In the Parameter field, enter CiscoAuthAPI.
Step 2 Using your Cisco.com login, download the file cisco_vpn_auth.jar from
http://www.cisco.com/cgi-bin/tablebuild.pl/asa and copy it to the default library directory for the
SiteMinder server.
Note To configure SSO with the HTTP protocol correctly, you must have a thorough working knowledge of
authentication and HTTP protocol exchanges.
The security appliance again serves as a proxy for WebVPN users to an authenticating web server but,
in this case, it uses HTTP Form protocol and the POST method for requests. You must configure the
security appliance to send and receive form data. Figure 37-1 illustrates the following SSO
authentication steps:
1. A WebVPN user first enters a username and password to log into the WebVPN server on the security
appliance.
2. The WebVPN server acts as a proxy for the user and forwards the form data (username and
password) to an authenticating web server using a POST authentication request.
3. If the authenticating web server approves the user data, it returns an authentication cookie to the
WebVPN server where it is stored on behalf of the user.
4. The WebVPN server establishes a tunnel to the user.
5. The user can now access other websites within the protected SSO environment without reentering a
username and password.
1 2
Auth Web
server
4 3
Other protected
web server
While you would expect to configure form parameters that let the security appliance include POST data
such as the username and password, you initially might not be aware of additional hidden parameters
that the web server requires. Some authentication applications expect hidden data which is neither
visible to nor entered by the user. You can, however, discover hidden parameters the authenticating web
server expects by making a direct authentication request to the web server from your browser without
the security appliance in the middle acting as a proxy. Analyzing the web server response using an HTTP
header analyzer reveals hidden parameters in a format similar to the following:
<param name>=<URL encoded value>&<param name>=<URL encoded>
Some hidden parameters are mandatory and some are optional. If the web server requires data for a
hidden parameter, it rejects any authentication POST request that omits that data. Because a header
analyzer does not tell you if a hidden parameter is mandatory or not, we recommend that you include all
hidden parameters until you determine which are mandatory.
This section describes:
• Gathering HTTP Form Data
• Task Overview: Configuring SSO with HTTP Form Protocol
• Detailed Tasks: Configuring SSO with HTTP Form Protocol
This section presents the steps for discovering and gathering necessary HTTP Form data. If you do not
know what parameters the authenticating web server requires, you can gather parameter data by
analyzing an authentication exchange using the following steps:
Step 1 Start your browser and HTTP header analyzer, and connect directly to the web server login page without
going through the security appliance.
Step 2 After the web server login page has loaded in your browser, examine the login sequence to determine if
a cookie is being set during the exchange. If the web server has loaded a cookie with the login page,
configure this login page URL as the start-URL.
Step 3 Enter the username and password to log in to the web server, and press Enter. This action generates the
authentication POST request that you examine using the HTTP header analyzer.
An example POST request—with host HTTP header and body—follows:
POST
/emco/myemco/authc/forms/MCOlogin.fcc?TYPE=33554433&REALMOID=06-000430e1-7443-125c-ac05-83
846dc90034&GUID=&SMAUTHREASON=0&METHOD=GET&SMAGENTNAME=$SM$5FZmjnk3DRNwNjk2KcqVCFbIrNT9%2b
J0H0KPshFtg6rB1UV2PxkHqLw%3d%3d&TARGET=https%3A%2F%2Fwww.example.com%2Femco%2Fmyemco%2F
HTTP/1.1
Host: www.example.com
(BODY)
SMENC=ISO-8859-1&SMLOCALE=US-EN&USERID=Anyuser&USER_PASSWORD=XXXXXX&target=https%3A%2F%2Fw
ww.example.com%2Femco%2Fmyemco%2F&smauthreason=0
Step 4 Examine the POST request and copy the protocol, host, and the complete URL to configure the
action-uri parameter.
Step 5 Examine the POST request body and copy the following:
a. Username parameter. In the preceding example, this parameter is USERID, not the value anyuser.
b. Password parameter. In the preceding example, this parameter is USER_PASSWORD.
c. Hidden parameter. This parameter is everything in the POST body except the username and
password parameters. In the preceding example, the hidden parameter is:
SMENC=ISO-8859-1&SMLOCALE=US-EN&target=https%3A%2F%2Fwww.example.com%2Fe
mco%2Fmyemco%2F&smauthreason=0
Figure 37-2 highlights the action URI, hidden, username and password parameters within sample output
from an HTTP analyzer. This is only an example; output varies widely across different websites.
148849
3
Step 6 If you successfully log in to the web server, examine the server response with the HTTP header analyzer
to locate the name of the session cookie set by the server in your browser. This is the auth-cookie-name
parameter.
In the following server response header, the name of the session cookie is SMSESSION. You just need
the name, not the value.
Set-Cookie:
SMSESSION=yN4Yp5hHVNDgs4FT8dn7+Rwev41hsE49XlKc+1twie0gqnjbhkTkUnR8XWP3hvDH6PZPbHIHtWLDKTa8
ngDB/lbYTjIxrbDx8WPWwaG3CxVa3adOxHFR8yjD55GevK3ZF4ujgU1lhO6fta0dSSOSepWvnsCb7IFxCw+MGiw0o8
8uHa2t4l+SillqfJvcpuXfiIAO06D/gtDF40Ow5YKHEl2KhDEvv+yQzxwfEz2cl7Ef5iMr8LgGcDK7qvMcvrgUqx68
JQOK2+RSwtHQ15bCZmsDU5vQVCvSQWC8OMHNGwpS253XwRLvd/h6S/tM0k98QMv+i3N8oOdj1V7flBqecH7+kVrU01
F6oFzr0zM1kMyLr5HhlVDh7B0k9wp0dUFZiAzaf43jupD5f6CEkuLeudYW1xgNzsR8eqtPK6t1gFJyOn0s7QdNQ7q9
knsPJsekRAH9hrLBhWBLTU/3B1QS94wEGD2YTuiW36TiP14hYwOlCAYRj2/bY3+lYzVu7EmzMQ+UefYxh4cF2gYD8R
ZL2RwmP9JV5l48I3XBFPNUw/3V5jf7nRuLr/CdfK3OO8+Pa3V6/nNhokErSgyxjzMd88DVzM41LxxaUDhbcmkoHT9I
mzBvKzJX0J+o7FoUDFOxEdIqlAN4GNqk49cpi2sXDbIarALp6Bl3+tbB4MlHGH+0CPscZXqoi/kon9YmGauHyRs+0m
6wthdlAmCnvlJCDfDoXtn8DpabgiW6VDTrvl3SGPyQtUv7Wdahuq5SxbUzjY2JxQnrUtwB977NCzYu2sOtN+dsEReW
J6ueyJBbMzKyzUB4L3i5uSYN50B4PCv1w5KdRKa5p3N0Nfq6RM6dfipMEJw0Ny1sZ7ohz3fbvQ/YZ7lw/k7ods/8Vb
aR15ivkE8dSCzuf/AInHtCzuQ6wApzEp9CUoG8/dapWriHjNoi4llJOgCst33wEhxFxcWy2UWxs4EZSjsI5GyBnefS
QTPVfma5dc/emWor9vWr0HnTQaHP5rg5dTNqunkDEdMIHfbeP3F90cZejVzihM6igiS6P/CEJAjE;Domain=.examp
le.com;Path=/
Figure 37-3 shows an example of authorization cookies in HTTP analyzer output. This is only an
example; output varies widely across different websites.
148848
1
1 Authorization cookies
Step 7 In some cases, the server may set the same cookie regardless of whether the authentication was
successful or not, and such a cookie is unacceptable for SSO purposes. To confirm that the cookies are
different, repeat Step 1 through Step 6 using invalid login credentials and then compare the “failure”
cookie with the “success” cookie.
You now have the necessary parameter data to configure the security appliance for SSO with HTTP
Form protocol.
This section presents an overview of configuring SSO with the HTTP Form protocol.To enable SSO
using HTTP Forms, perform the following tasks:
• Configure the uniform resource identifier on the authenticating web server to receive and process
the form data (action-uri).
• Configure the username parameter (user-parameter).
• Configure the user password parameter (password-parameter).
You might also need to do the following tasks depending upon the requirements of authenticating web
server:
• Configure a starting URL if the authenticating web server requires a pre-login cookie exchange
(start-url).
• Configure any hidden authentication parameters required by the authenticating web server
(hidden-parameter).
• Configure the name of an authentication cookie set by the authenticating web server
(auth-cookie-name).
This section presents the detailed tasks required to configure SSO with the HTTP Form protocol.
Perform the following steps to configure the security appliance to use HTTP Form protocol for SSO:
Step 1 If the authenticating web server requires it, enter the start-url command in aaa-server-host
configuration mode to specify the URL from which to retrieve a pre-login cookie from the authenticating
web server. For example, to specify the authenticating web server URL
http://example.com/east/Area.do?Page-Grp1 in the testgrp1 server group with an IP address of 10.0.0.2,
enter the following:
hostname(config)# aaa-server testgrp1 host 10.0.0.2
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# start-url http://example.com/east/Area.do?Page-Grp1
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)#
Step 2 To specify a URI for an authentication program on the authenticating web server, enter the action-uri
command in aaa-server- host configuration mode. A URI can be entered on multiple, sequential lines.
The maximum number of characters per line is 255. The maximum number of characters for a complete
URI is 2048. An example action URI follows:
http://www.example.com/auth/index.html/appdir/authc/forms/MCOlogin.fcc?TYPE=33554433&REA
LMOID=06-000a1311-a828-1185-ab41-8333b16a0008&GUID=&SMAUTHREASON=0&METHOD
=GET&SMAGENTNAME=$SM$5FZmjnk3DRNwNjk2KcqVCFbIrNT9%2bJ0H0KPshFtg6rB1UV2P
xkHqLw%3d%3d&TARGET=https%3A%2F%2Fauth.example.com
To specify this action URI, enter the following commands:
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# action-uri http://www.example.com/auth/index.htm
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# action-uri l/appdir/authc/forms/MCOlogin.fcc?TYP
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# action-uri 554433&REALMOID=06-000a1311-a828-1185
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# action-uri -ab41-8333b16a0008&GUID=&SMAUTHREASON
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# action-uri =0&METHOD=GET&SMAGENTNAME=$SM$5FZmjnk
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# action-uri 3DRNwNjk2KcqVCFbIrNT9%2bJ0H0KPshFtg6r
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# action-uri B1UV2PxkHqLw%3d%3d&TARGET=https%3A%2F
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# action-uri %2Fauth.example.com
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)#
Note You must include the hostname and protocol in the action URI. In the preceding example, these appear
at the start of the URI in http://www.example.com.
Step 3 To configure a username parameter for the HTTP POST request, enter the user-parameter command in
aaa-server-host configuration mode. For example, the following command configures the username
parameter userid:
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# user-parameter userid
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)#
Step 4 To configure a user password parameter for the HTTP POST request, use the password-parameter
command in aaa-server-host configuration mode. For example, the following command configures a
user password parameter named user_password:
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# password-parameter user_password
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)#
Step 5 To specify hidden parameters for exchange with the authenticating web server, use the
hidden-parameter command in aaa-server-host configuration mode. An example hidden parameter
excerpted from a POST request follows:
SMENC=ISO-8859-1&SMLOCALE=US-EN&target=https%3A%2F%2Fwww.example.com%2Femco
%2Fappdir%2FAreaRoot.do%3FEMCOPageCode%3DENG&smauthreason=0
This hidden parameter includes four form entries and their values, separated by &. The four entries and
their values are:
• SMENC with a value of ISO-8859-1
Step 6 To specify the name for the authentication cookie, enter the auth-cookie-name command in
aaa-server-host configuration mode. This command is optional. The following example specifies the
authentication cookie name of SsoAuthCookie:
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# auth-cookie-name SsoAuthCookie
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)#
Creating Port Forwarding, URL, and Access Lists in Global Configuration Mode
Use the port forward, url-list, and access-list commands in global configuration mode to configure the
lists of ports to forward and URLs to present to WebVPN users, and their level of access. See
Step 1 Authenticate the user with RADIUS and use the Class attribute to assign that user to a particular group
policy.
Step 2 Set the class attribute to the group policy name in the format OU=group_name
For example, to set a WebVPN user to the SSL_VPN group, set the RADIUS Class Attribute to a value
of OU=SSL_VPN; (Do not omit the semicolon.)
Command Function
authentication Sets the authentication method.
customization Identifies the name of a previously defined customization to apply.
nbns-server Identifies the name of the NetBIOS Name Service server (nbns-server) to use
for CIFS name resolution.
group-alias Specifies the alternate names by which the server can refer to a tunnel group
group-url Identifies one or more group URLs. If you configure this attribute, users
coming in on a specified URL need not select a group at login
dns-group Identifies the DNS server group that specifies the DNS server name, domain
name, name server, number of retries, and timeout values
hic-fail-group-policy Specifies a VPN feature policy if you use the Cisco Secure Desktop Manager
to set the Group-Based Policy attribute to “Use Failure Group-Policy” or “Use
Success Group-Policy, if criteria match.”
Command Function
auto-signon Sets values for auto signon, which requires only that s user enter username and
password credentials only once for a WebVPN connection.
customization Assigns a customization object to a group-policy or user.
deny-message Specifies the message delivered to a remote user who logs into WebVPN
successfully, but has no VPN privileges.
filter Sets the name of the webtype access list.
functions Enables some or all of these WebVPN features: auto-download, Citrix, file
access, file browsing, file entry, filter, http-proxy, URL entry, MAPI proxy,
port forwarding.
homepage Sets the URL of the web page that displays upon login.
html-content-filter Configures the content and objects to filter from the HTML for this group
policy.
http-comp Configures compression.
keep-alive-ignore Sets the maximum object size to ignore for updating the session timer.
port-forward Applies a list of WebVPN TCP ports to forward. The user interface displays
the applications on this list.
port-forward-name Configures the name of the port forwarding applet.
sso-server Sets the name of the SSO server.
Command Function
svc Configures SSL VPN Client attributes.
url-list Applies a list of WebVPN servers and URLs that the user interface displays
for end user access.
Note Before you configure the auto-download feature, you must first enable an application that uses the
applet: port forwarding, Outlook/Exchange proxy, or HTTP proxy.
• The applications themselves might be disabled or might malfunction, even when you are running
them locally.
These errors can result from terminating the Application Access window in any improper way. For
example:
• Your browser crashes while you are using Application Access.
• A power outage or system shutdown occurs while you are using Application Access.
• You minimize the Application Access window while you are working, then shut down your
computer with the window active (but minimized).
This section includes the following topics:
• Understanding the hosts File
• Stopping Application Access Improperly
• Reconfiguring a hosts File
Note Microsoft anti-spyware software blocks changes that the port forwarding JAVA applet makes to the
hosts file. See www.microsoft.com for information on how to allow hosts file changes when using
anti-spyware software.
• If you are able to connect to your remote access server, follow the steps in the section
“Reconfiguring a hosts File Automatically Using WebVPN.”
• If you are unable to connect to your remote access server from your current location or if you have
made custom edits to the hosts file, follow the steps in the section “Reconfiguring hosts File
Manually.”
If you are able to connect to your remote access server, follow these steps to reconfigure the hosts file
and reenable both Application Access and the applications.
Step 1 Start WebVPN and log in. The home page opens.
Step 2 Click the Applications Access link. A Backup HOSTS File Found message appears. (See Figure 37-4.)
If you are not able to connect to your remote access server from your current location, or if you have
customized the hosts file and do not want to lose your edits, follow these steps to reconfigure the hosts
file and reenable both Application Access and the applications.
Step 1 Locate and edit your hosts file. The most common location is c:\windows\sysem32\drivers\etc\hosts.
Step 2 Check to see if any lines contain the string: # added by WebVpnPortForward
If any lines contain this string, your hosts file is WebVPN-customized. If your hosts file is
WebVPN-customized, it looks similar to the following example:
123.0.0.3 server1 # added by WebVpnPortForward
123.0.0.3 server1.example.com vpn3000.com # added by WebVpnPortForward
123.0.0.4 server2 # added by WebVpnPortForward
123.0.0.4 server2.example.com.vpn3000.com # added by WebVpnPortForward
123.0.0.5 server3 # added by WebVpnPortForward
123.0.0.5 server3.example.com vpn3000.com # added by WebVpnPortForward
123.0.0.1 localhost
Step 3 Delete the lines that contain the string: # added by WebVpnPortForward
When a user requests a list of files, WebVPN queries the server designated as the master browser for the
IP address of the server containing the list. The security appliance gets the list and delivers it to the
remote user on a portal page.
WebVPN lets the user invoke the following CIFS functions, depending on user authentication
requirements and file properties:
• Navigate and list domains and workgroups, servers within a domain or workgroup, shares within a
server, and files within a share or directory
• Create directories
• Download, upload, rename, move, and delete files
The security appliance requires a master browser or WINS server, typically on the same network as the
security appliance or reachable from that network, to query the network for a list of servers when the
remote user clicks Browse Networks on the WebVPN home page or toolbar (Figure 37-5).
Figure 37-5 Browse Networks on the WebVPN Home Page and Floating Toolbar
The master browser provides the CIFS client on the security appliance with a list of the resources on the
network, which WebVPN serves to the remote user. You cannot use a DNS server for a master browser.
WebVPN supports file access in an Active Native Directory environment using a WINS server, but not
a Dynamic DNS server.
Step 1 of the following procedure describes how to specify the master browser and WINS servers. As an
alternative to following the instructions Step 1, you can use the url-list command in global configuration
mode or in webvpn mode, which you enter from group-policy or username mode, to configure a server
share in the File Folder Bookmarks. For example:
Using this method (adding a share) does not require a master browser or a WINS server, however, it does
not provide support for the Browse Networks link. You can use a hostname or an IP address to refer to
ServerA when entering this command. If you use a hostname, the security appliance requires a DNS
server to resolve it to an IP address.
Note Before configuring file access, you must configure the shares on the servers for user access.
Step 1 Use the nbns-server command in tunnel-group webvpn configuration mode once for each NetBIOS
Name Server (NBNS).
master is the computer designated as the master browser. The master browser maintains the list of
computers and shared resources. Any NBNS server you identify with this command without entering the
master portion of the command must be a Windows Internet Naming Server (WINS). Specify the master
browser first, then specify the WINS servers. You can specify up to three servers, including the master
browser, for a tunnel group.
retries is the number of times to retry queries to the NBNS server. The security appliance recycles
through the list of servers this number of times before sending an error message. The default value is 2;
the range is 1 through 10.
timeout is the number of seconds the security appliance waits before sending the query again, to the same
server if it is the only one, or another server if there are more than one. The default timeout is 2 seconds;
the range is 1 to 30 seconds.
For example,
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# nbns-server 192.168.1.20 master
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# nbns-server 192.168.1.41
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# nbns-server 192.168.1.47
Note Use the tunnel-group webvpn-attributes command if you want to display the NBNS servers already
present in the tunnel group configuration.
Step 2 (Optional) Use the character-encoding command to specify the character set to encode in WebVPN
portal pages to be delivered to remote users. By default, the encoding type set on the remote browser
determines the character set for WebVPN portal pages, so you need to set the character encoding only
if it is necessary to ensure proper encoding on the browser.
character-encoding charset
Charset is a string consisting of up to 40 characters, and equal to one of the valid character sets identified
in http://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets. You can use either the name or the alias of a
character set listed on that page. Examples include iso-8859-1, shift_jis, and ibm850.
Note The character-encoding and file-encoding values do not exclude the font family to be used by the
browser. You need to complement the setting of one these values with the page style command in
webvpn customization command mode to replace the font family if you are using Japanese Shift_JIS
character encoding, as shown in the following example, or enter the no page style command in webvpn
customization command mode to remove the font family.
The following example sets the character-encoding attribute to support Japanese Shift_JIS characters,
removes the font family, and retains the default background color:
hostname(config-webvpn)# character-encoding shift_jis
Step 3 (Optional) Use the file-encoding command to specify the encoding for WebVPN portal pages from
specific CIFS servers. Thus, you can use different file-encoding values for CIFS servers that require
different character encodings.
The following example sets the file-encoding attribute of the CIFS server 10.86.5.174 to support
IBM860 (alias “CP860”) characters:
hostname(config-webvpn)# file-encoding 10.86.5.174 cp860
hostname(config-webvpn)
Step 4 To configure security appliance support for file access, file browsing, and file server entry, use the
functions command in webvpn mode, which you enter from group-policy or username mode.
For example:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# functions file-access file-browsing file-entry
hostname(config-group-policy)#
For a complete description of these commands, see the Cisco Security Appliance Command Reference.
Step 1 Configure the Citrix Web Interface software to operate in a mode that does not use the secure gateway.
Step 2 Install an SSL certificate onto the security appliance interface to which remote users use a fully-qualified
domain name (FQDN) to connect.
Note Do not specify an IP address as the common name (CN) for the SSL certificate. The remote user
attempts to use the FQDN to communicate with the security appliance. The remote PC must be
able to use DNS or an entry in the System32\drivers\etc\hosts file to resolve the FQDN.
Step 3 Use the functions citrix command once for each group policy or user for which you want to enable
Citrix support.
The following example shows how to configure Citrix for a group policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup internal
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# functions citrix
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
Configuring MAPI
MAPI, also called MS Outlook Exchange proxy, has the following requirements:
• Provide the Exchange server NetBIOS name. The Exchange server must be on the same domain as
the security appliance DNS server. For example:
hostname(config)# domain domain_name
hostname(config)#
Note An open MS Outlook client connected via MS Outlook Exchange Mail Proxy checks continually for mail
on the Exchange Server, which keeps the connection open. As long as Outlook is open, the connection
never times out, regardless of the settings.
Configuring Caching
Caching enhances WebVPN performance. It stores frequently reused objects in the system cache, which
reduces the need to perform repeated rewriting and compressing of content. It reduces traffic between
WebVPN and the remote servers, with the result that many applications run much more efficiently.
By default, caching is enabled. You can customize the way caching works for your environment by using
the caching commands in cache mode, which you enter from webvpn mode, as in the following example.
hostname(config)#
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# cache
hostname(config-webvpn-cache)#
This example shows how to enable an APCF profile named apcf2.xml, located on an https server called
myserver, port 1440 with the path being /apcf.
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# apcf https://myserver:1440/apcf/apcf2.xml
hostname(config-webvpn)#
APCF Syntax
The following sections describe APCF syntax.
Caution Misuse of an APCF profile can result in reduced performance and undesired rendering of content. In
most cases, Cisco Engineering supplies APCF profiles to solve specific application rendering issues.
APCF profiles use XML format, and sed script syntax, with the XML tags in Table 37-4
Table 37-4 APCF XML Tags
Tag Use
<APCF>...</APCF> The mandatory root element that opens any APCF XML
file.
<version>1.0</version> The mandatory tag that specifies the APCF
implementation version. Currently the only version is
1.0.
<application>...</application> The mandatory tag that wraps the body of the XML
description.
<id> text </id> The mandatory tag that describes this particular APCF
functionality.
<apcf-entities>...</apcf-entities> The mandatory tag that wraps a single or multiple APCF
entities.
<js-object>…</js-object> One of theses tags specifying type of content or the stage
at which the APCF processing should take place is
<html-object>…</html-object>
required.
<process-request-header>...</preprocess-request-header>
<process-response-header>...</preprocess-response-header>
<preprocess-request-body>...</preprocess-request-body>
<postprocess-request-body>...</postprocess-request-body>
<preprocess-response-body>...</preprocess-response-body>
<postprocess-response-body>...</postprocess-response-body>
Tag Use
<conditions>… </conditions> A child element of the pre/post-process tags that specifies
criteria for processing such as:
http-version (such as 1.1, 1.0, 0.9)
http-method (get, put, post, webdav)
http-scheme (http, https, other)
server-regexp regular expression containing ("a".."z" |
"A".."Z" | "0".."9" | ".-_*[]?"))
server-fnmatch (regular expression containing ("a".."z" |
"A".."Z" | "0".."9" | ".-_*[]?+()\{},")),
user-agent-regexp
user-agent-fnmatch
request-uri-regexp
request-uri-fnmatch
If more than one of condition tags are present, the
security appliance performs a logical AND for all tags.
<action> … </action> Wraps one or more actions to perform on the content
under specified conditions; define each of these actions
with the following <do> tag or the <sed-script> tag.
<do>…</do> Defines one of the following actions:
<no-rewrite/>
<no-toolbar/>
<no-gzip/>
<force-cache/>
<force-no-cache/>
<sed-script> TEXT </sed-script> The child element of the action tag. The TEXT must be a
valid Sed script. The <sed-script> applies to the
<conditions> tag defined before it.
APCF Example
An example of an APCF profile follows:
<APCF>
<version>1.0</version>
<application>
<id>Do not compress content from notsogood.com</id>
<apcf-entities>
<process-request-header>
<conditions>
<server-fnmatch>*.notsogood.com</server-fnmatch>
</conditions>
<action>
<do><no-gzip/></do>
</action>
</process-request-header>
</apcf-entities>
</application>
</APCF>
The home page displays all of the WebVPN features you have configured, and its appearance reflects
the logo, text, and colors you have selected. This sample home page includes all available WebVPN
features with the exception of identifying specific file shares. It lets users browse the network, enter
URLs, access specific websites, and use port forwarding to access TCP applications.
This window displays the TCP applications configured for this WebVPN connection. To use an
application with this panel open, the user starts the application in the normal way.
• The toolbar lets you enter URLs, browse file locations, and choose preconfigured web connections
without interfering with the main browser window.
• If you configure your browser to block popups, the floating toolbar cannot display.
• If you close the toolbar, the security appliance prompts you to confirm that you want to end the
WebVPN session.
See Table 37-6 on page 37-46 for detailed information about using WebVPN.
Note To easily customize the WebVPN pages, we recommend that you use ASDM, which has convenient
features for configuring style elements, including color swatches and preview capabilities.
148904
page style value
The following procedure guides you through customizing every element of the WebVPN Login page
using CLI commands and includes examples of the commands:
Step 1 Enter WebVPN customization mode using the customization command from webvpn mode:
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# customization cisco
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)#
Step 2 Change the CSS style of the WebVPN Login page using the page style command:
[no] page style value
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# page style font-size:large
Step 4 Change the logo with a logo residing in flash memory using the logo command:
[no] logo {none | file {path value}}
To disallow a logo and prevent inheriting a logo, use the none option to set a null value.
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)#logo file disk0:cisco_logo.gif
Step 5 Change the title of the Login box using the login-title command:
[no] login-title {text | style} value
Step 6 Change the message of the Login box using the login-message command:
[no] login-message {text | style} value
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# login-message text username and password
Step 7 Change the username prompt of the Login box using the username-prompt command:
[no] username-prompt {text | style} value
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# username-prompt text Corporate Username:
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# username-prompt style font-weight:bolder
Step 8 Change the password prompt of the Login box using the password-prompt command:
[no] password-prompt {text | style} value
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# password-prompt text Corporate Username:
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# password-prompt style font-weight:bolder
Step 9 Change the group prompt of the Login box using the group-prompt command:
[no] group-prompt {text | style} value
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# group-prompt text Corporate Group:
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# group-prompt style font-weight:bolder
Step 10 Change the content or appearance of the Login button of the Login box using the login-button
command:
[no] login-button {text | style} value
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# login-button text OK
Step 11 Change the content or appearance of the Clear button of the Login box using the clear-button command:
[no] clear-button {text | style} value
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# clear-button background-color:blue
148906
The following procedure guides you through customizing the WebVPN Logout page using CLI
commands and includes examples of the commands:
Step 1 Enter WebVPN customization mode using the customization command from webvpn mode:
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# customization cisco
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)#
Step 2 Change the title of the Logout box using the logout-title command:
[no] logout-title {text | style} value
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# logout-title style background-color: rgb(51,51,255);color:
rgb(51,51,255); font-family: Algerian; font-size: 12pt; font-style: italic; font-weight:
bold
Step 3 Change the message of the Logout box using the logout-message command:
[no] logout-message {text | style} value
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# login-title style background-color: rgb(51,51,255);color:
rgb(51,51,255); font-family: Algerian; font-size: 12pt; font-style: italic; font-weight:
bold
148905
The following procedure guides you through customizing every element of the WebVPN Home page
using CLI commands and includes examples of the commands:
Step 1 Enter WebVPN customization mode using the customization command from webvpn mode:
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# customization cisco
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)#
Step 2 Change the border of the WebVPN page using the border style command and CSS parameters:
[no] border style value
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# border style background-color:66FFFF
Step 3 Change the appearance of the Web Applications box using the web-applications command:
[no] web-applications {title | message | dropdown} {text | style} value
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# web-applications title text WWW Applications
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# web-applications title style color:blue
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# web-applications message text Enter URL
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# web-applications message style color:blue
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# web-applications dropdown text URLs to Browse
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# web-applications dropdown style color:red
Step 4 Change the appearance of the Application Access box using the application-access command:
[no] application-access {title | message} {text | style} value
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# application-access title text Applications
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# application-access title style color:blue
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# application-access message text Start Application
Step 5 Change the appearance of the Browse Networks box using the browse-networks command:
[no] browse-networks {title | message | dropdown} {text | style} value
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# browse-networks title text Corporate Nets
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# browse-networks title style color:blue
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# browse-networks message text Enter URL
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# browse-networks message style color:blue
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# browse-networks dropdown text URLs to Browse
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# browse-networks dropdown style color:red
Step 6 Change the Web Bookmarks title or links using the web-bookmarks command:
[no] web-bookmarks {link {style value} | title {style value | text value}}
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# web-bookmarks link style color:black
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# web-bookmarks title style color:black
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# web-bookmarks title text Corporate Web Bookmarks
Step 7 Change the File Bookmarks title or the File Bookmarks links using the file-bookmarks command:
[no] file-bookmarks {link {style value} | title {style value | text value}}
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# file-bookmarks link style color:blue
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# file-bookmarks title style color:blue
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# file-bookmarks title text Corporate File Bookmarks
148906
The following procedure guides you through customizing the Application Access window using CLI
commands and includes examples of the commands:
Step 1 Enter WebVPN customization mode using the customization command from webvpn mode:
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# customization cisco
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)#
Step 2 Change the Application Access window using the application-access window command:
[no] application-access window {text | style} value
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# application-access window text URLs to Browse
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# application-access window style color:red
Step 3 Enable or disable the Hiding of application details displayed in the WebVPN Applications Access
window using the application-access hide-details command:
[no] application-access hide-details {enable | disable}
The default is disabled. Application details are not hidden—they display in the Application Access
window.
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# application-access hide-details enable
148963
dialog message style value
The following procedure customizes every element of the dialog message and includes examples of the
commands:
Step 1 Enter WebVPN customization mode using the customization command from webvpn mode:
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# customization cisco
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)#
Step 2 Customize the border of the dialog messages with the dialog border command:
[no] dialog border style value
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# dialog border style color:blue
Step 3 Change the appearance of the title using the dialog title command:
[no] dialog title style value
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# dialog title style font:bolder
Step 4 Change the appearance of the message using the dialog message command:
[no] dialog message style value
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# dialog message style font:italic
To apply a customization to a tunnel group, use the customization command from tunnel group webvpn
mode:
[no] customization name
name is the name of a customization to apply to the tunnel group.
To remove the command from the configuration, and remove a customization from the tunnel group, use
the no form of the command.
Enter the customization command followed by a question mark (?) to view a list of existing
customizations.
In the following example, the user enters tunnel group webvpn mode and enables the customization cisco
for the tunnel group cisco_telecommuters:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group cisco_telecommuters webvpn-attributes
hostname(tunnel-group-webvpn)# customization cisco
To apply a customization to a group or user, use the customization command from group policy webvpn
mode or username webvpn mode. In these modes, the none and value options are included:
[no] customization {none | value name}
none disables the customization for the group or user, prevents the value from being inherited, and
displays the default WebVPN pages.
value name is the name of a customization to apply to the group or user.
To remove the command from the configuration, and cause the value to be inherited, use the no form of
the command.
Enter the customization value command followed by a question mark (?) to view a list of existing
customizations.
In the following example, the user enters group policy webvpn mode, queries the security appliance for
a list of customizations, and enables the customization cisco for the group policy cisco_sales:
hostname(config)# group-policy cisco_sales attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# customization value ?
In the next example, the user enters username webvpn mode and enables the customization cisco for the
user cisco_employee:
hostname(config)# username cisco_employee attributes
hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# customization value cisco
Login Username/
Password Type Purpose Entered When
Computer Access the computer Starting the computer
Internet Service Provider Access the Internet Connecting to an Internet service provider
WebVPN Access remote network Starting WebVPN
File Server Access remote file server Using the WebVPN file browsing feature to access
a remote file server
Corporate Application Login Access firewall-protected internal server Using the WebVPN web browsing feature to access
an internal protected website
Mail Server Access remote mail server via WebVPN Sending or receiving e-mail messages
It is possible you have configured user accounts differently and that different WebVPN features are
available to each user. Table 37-6 organizes information by feature, so you can skip over the information
for unavailable features.
Table 37-6 WebVPN Remote System Configuration and End User Requirements
Table 37-6 WebVPN Remote System Configuration and End User Requirements (continued)
Web Browsing Usernames and passwords for protected Using WebVPN does not ensure that
websites communication with every site is secure. See
“Communicating Security Tips.”
The look and feel of web browsing with WebVPN
might be different from what users are
accustomed to. For example:
• The WebVPN title bar appears above each web
page
• You access websites by:
– Entering the URL in the Enter Web
Address field on the WebVPN Home page
– Clicking on a preconfigured website link
on the WebVPN Home page
– Clicking a link on a webpage accessed via
one of the previous two methods
Also, depending on how you configured a
particular account, it might be that:
• Some websites are blocked
• Only the websites that appear as links on the
WebVPN Home page are available
Table 37-6 WebVPN Remote System Configuration and End User Requirements (continued)
Table 37-6 WebVPN Remote System Configuration and End User Requirements (continued)
Caution Users should always close the Application Access window when they finish using
applications by clicking the Close icon. Failure to quit the window properly can cause
Application Access or the applications themselves to be disabled. See Recovering from
hosts File Errors When Using Application Access for details.
Table 37-6 WebVPN Remote System Configuration and End User Requirements (continued)
Note Enabling WebVPN capture affects the performance of the security appliance. Be sure to disable the
capture after you generate the capture files needed for troubleshooting.
Step 1 To start the WebVPN capture utility, use the capture command from privileged EXEC mode.
capture capture_name type webvpn user webvpn_username
where:
• capture_name is a name you assign to the capture, which is also prepended to the name of the
capture files.
• webvpn_user is the username to match for capture.
The capture utility starts.
Step 2 A WebVPN user logs in to begin a WebVPN session. The capture utility is capturing packets.
Stop the capture by using the no version of the command.
no capture capture_name
The capture utility creates a capture_name.zip file, which is encrypted with the password koleso.
Step 3 Send the .zip file to Cisco Systems, or attach it to a Cisco TAC service request.
Step 4 To look at the contents of the .zip file, unzip it using the password koleso.
The following example creates a capture named hr, which captures WebVPN traffic for user2 to a file:
hostname# capture hr type webvpn user user2
WebVPN capture started.
capture name hr
user name user2
hostname# no capture hr
Step 1 To start the WebVPN capture utility, use the capture command from privileged EXEC mode.
capture capture_name type webvpn user webvpn_username
where:
• capture_name is a name you assign to the capture, which is also prepended to the name of the
capture files.
• webvpn_user is the username to match for capture.
The capture utility starts.
Step 2 A WebVPN user logs in to begin a WebVPN session. The capture utility is capturing packets.
Stop the capture by using the no version of the command.
Step 3 Open a browser and in the address box enter
https://IP_address or hostname of the security appliance/webvpn_capture.html
The SSL VPN Client (SVC) is a VPN tunneling technology that gives remote users the benefits of an
IPSec VPN client without the need for network administrators to install and configure IPSec VPN clients
on remote computers. The SVC uses the SSL encryption that is already present on the remote computer
as well as the WebVPN login and authentication of the security appliance.
To establish an SVC session, the remote user enters the IP address of a WebVPN interface of the security
appliance in the browser, and the browser connects to that interface and displays the WebVPN login
screen. If the user satisfies the login and authentication, and the security appliance identifies the user as
requiring the SVC, the security appliance downloads the SVC to the remote computer. If the security
appliance identifies the user as having the option to use the SVC, the security appliance downloads the
SVC to the remote computer while presenting a link on the user screen to skip the SVC installation.
After downloading, the SVC installs and configures itself, and then the SVC either remains or uninstalls
itself (depending on the configuration) from the remote computer when the connection terminates.
This section covers the following topics:
• Installing SVC, page 38-1
• Enabling SVC, page 38-3
• Enabling Permanent SVC Installation, page 38-4
• Enabling Rekey, page 38-5
• Enabling and Adjusting Dead Peer Detection, page 38-5
• Enabling Keepalive, page 38-6
• Using SVC Compression, page 38-6
• Viewing SVC Sessions, page 38-7
• Logging Off SVC Sessions, page 38-8
• Updating SVCs, page 38-8
Installing SVC
This section presents the platform requirements and the procedure for installing SVC.
Platform Requirements
The SVC requires Windows 2000 or Windows XP on the remote computer.
Step 1 Copy the SVC images to the security appliance using the copy command from privileged EXEC mode,
or using another method. In this example, the images are copied from a tftp server using the
copy tftp comand:
hostname# copy tftp flash
Address or name of remote host []? 209.165.200.226
Source filename []? sslclient-win-1.0.2.127.pkg
Destination filename []? sslclient-win-1.0.2.127.pkg
Accessing tftp://209.165.200.226/sslclient-win-1.0.2.127.pkg...!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
Writing file
disk0:/cdisk71...!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
319662 bytes copied in 3.695 secs (86511 bytes/sec)
Step 2 Assign an order to the SVC images using the svc image command from webvpn mode:
svc image filename order
Numbering of the SVC images establishes the order in which the security appliance downloads them to
the remote computer. It downloads the SVC image with the lowest number first. Therefore, you should
assign the lowest number to the image used by the most commonly-encountered operating system.
In the following example, the output of the show webvpn svc command indicates that the windows.pkg
image has an order number of 1, and the windows2.pkg image has an order number of 2. When a remote
computer attempts to establish an SVC connection, the windows.pkg image downloads first. If the image
does not match the operating system, the windows2.pkg image downloads:
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# show webvpn svc
1. disk0:/windows.pkg 1
CISCO STC win2k+ 1.0.0
1,0,2,132
Thu 08/25/2005 21:51:30.43
2. disk0:/windows2.pkg 2
CISCO STC win2k+ 1.0.0
1,0,0,164
Thu 02/17/2005 20:09:22.43
Then the SVC archive images are re-ordered using the svc image command, with the windows2.pkg
image as the first image downloaded to the remote PC, and the windows.pkg image downloaded second:
hostname(config-webvpn)# no svc image
hostname(config-webvpn)# svc image windows2.pkg 1
hostname(config-webvpn)# svc image windows.pkg 2
Reentering the show webvpn svc command shows the new order of the images:
2. disk0:/windows.pkg 2
CISCO STC win2k+ 1.0.0
1,0,0,164
Thu 02/17/2005 20:09:22.43
Enabling SVC
After installing SVC, you can enable SVC by performing the following steps:
Step 1 Enable WebVPN on an interface using the enable command from webvpn mode:
enable interface
For example:
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# enable outside
Step 2 From webvpn mode, enter the svc enable command to enable the security appliance to download SVC
images to remote computers:
svc enable
For example:
hostname(config-webvpn)# svc enable
Step 3 Configure a method of address assignment. You can use DHCP, and/or user-assigned addressing. You
can also create a local IP address pool using the ip local pool command from webvpn mode:
ip local pool poolname startaddr-endaddr mask mask
The following example creates the local IP address pool vpn_users:
hostname(config-webvpn)# ip local pool vpn_users 209.165.200.225-209.165.200.254
mask 255.255.255.224
Step 4 Assign IP addresses to a tunnel group. One method you can use to do this is to configure a local IP
address pool with the address-pool command from general-attributes mode:
address-pool poolname
To do this, first enter the tunnel-group name general-attributes command to enter general-attributes
mode. Then specify the local IP address pool using the address-pool command.
In the following example, the user configures the existing tunnel group telecommuters to use the address
pool vpn_users created in step 3:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group telecommuters general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# address-pool vpn_users
Step 5 Assign a default group policy to the tunnel group with the default-group-policy command from tunnel
group general attributes mode:
default-group-policy name
In the following example, the user assigns the group policy sales to the tunnel group telecommuters:
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# default-group-policy sales
Step 6 Create and enable a group alias that displays in the group list on the WebVPN Login page using the
group-alias command from tunnel group webvpn attributes mode:
group-alias name enable
First exit to global configuration mode, and then enter the tunnel-group name webvpn-attributes
command to enter tunnel group webvpn attributes mode.
In the following example, the user enters webvpn attributes configuration mode for the tunnel group
telecommuters, and creates the group alias sales_department:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group telecommuters webvpn-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# group-alias sales_department enable
Step 7 Enable the display of the tunnel-group list on the WebVPN Login page from webvpn mode:
tunnel-group-list enable
First exit to global configuration mode, and then enter webvpn mode.
In the following example, the enters webvpn mode, and then enables the tunnel group list:
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# tunnel-group-list enable
Step 8 Identify WebVPN as a permitted VPN tunneling protocol for the group or user with the
vpn-tunnel-protocol webvpn command in group-policy mode or username mode:
vpn-tunnel-protocol webvpn
To do this, first exit to global configuration mode, enter the group-policy name attributes command to
enter group-policy mode, or the username name attributes command to enter username mode, and then
enter the webvpn command to enter webvpn mode and change the WebVPN settings for the group or
user.
The following example identifies WebVPN as a permitted tunneling protocol for the group-policy sales:
hostname(config)# group-policy sales attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# vpn-tunnel-protocol webvpn
Step 9 Enable or require an SVC for a specific group or user by using the svc command from either
group-policy webvpn mode or username webvpn mode:
svc {none | enable | required}
The following example sets the SVC to required for the existing group-policy sales:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# svc required
For more information about assigning users to group policies, see Chapter 30, “Configuring Tunnel
Groups, Group Policies, and Users”.
none specifies the SVC is removed from the remote computer after the active SVC connection
terminates.
The default is that permanent installation of the SVC is disabled. The SVC on the remote computer
uninstalls at the end of every SVC session.
The following example configures the existing group-policy sales to keep the SVC installed on the
remote computer:
hostname(config)# group-policy sales attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-policy)# svc keep-installer installed
Enabling Rekey
When the security appliance and the SVC perform a rekey, they renegotiate the crypto keys and
initialization vectors, increasing the security of the connection.
To enable the SVC to perform a rekey on an SVC session for a specific group or user, use the svc rekey
command from group-policy and username webvpn modes.
svc rekey {method {new-tunnel | none | ssl} | time minutes}
no svc rekey {method {new-tunnel | none | ssl} | time minutes}
Where:
method new-tunnel specifies that the SVC establishes a new tunnel during SVC rekey.
method none disables SVC rekey.
method ssl specifies that SSL renegotiation takes place during SVC rekey.
time minutes specifies the number of minutes from the start of the session until the rekey takes place,
from 1 to 10080 (1 week).
In the following example, the SVC is configured to renegotiate with SSL during rekey, which takes place
30 minutes after the session begins, for the existing group-policy sales:
hostname(config)# group-policy sales attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-policy)# svc rekey method ssl
hostname(config-group-policy)# svc rekey time 30
Enabling Keepalive
You can adjust the frequency of keepalive messages to ensure that an SVC connection through a proxy,
firewall, or NAT device remains open, even if the device limits the time that the connection can be idle.
Adjusting the frequency also ensures that the SVC does not disconnect and reconnect when the remote
user is not actively running a socket-based application, such as Microsoft Outlook or Microsoft Internet
Explorer.
To set the frequency of keepalive messages, use the svc keepalive command from group-policy or
username webvpn modes:
svc keepalive {none | seconds}
no svc keepalive {none | seconds}
Where:
none disables SVC keepalive messages.
seconds enables the SVC to send keepalive messages, and specifies the frequency of the messages in the
range of 15 to 600 seconds.
The default is keepalive messages are disabled.
Use the no form of the command to remove the command from the configuration and cause the value to
be inherited:
In the following example, the security appliance is configured to enable the SVC to send keepalive
messages with a frequency of 300 seconds (5 minutes), for the existing group-policy sales:
hostname(config)# group-policy sales attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# svc keepalive 300
Note The compression svc command configured from global configuration mode overrides the
svc compression command configured in group-policy and username webvpn modes.
Username : lee
Index : 1 IP Addr : 161.44.128.249
Protocol : SSL VPN Client Encryption : 3DES
Hashing : SHA1 Auth Mode : userPassword
TCP Dst Port : 443 TCP Src Port : 54230
Bytes Tx : 20178 Bytes Rx : 8662
Pkts Tx : 27 Pkts Rx : 19
Client Ver : Cisco STC 1.1.0.117
Client Type : Mozilla/4.0 (compatible; MSIE 6.0; Windows NT 5.0; Q312461)
Group : DfltGrpPolicy
Login Time : 14:32:03 UTC Wed Apr 20 2005
Duration : 0h:00m:04s
Filter Name :
You can log off individual SVC sessions using either the name option, or the index option:
vpn-session-db logoff name name
vpn-session-db logoff index index
You can find both the username and the index number (established by the order of the SVC images) in
the output of the show vpn-sessiondb svc command. The following example shows the username lee
and index number 1.
hostname# show vpn-sessiondb svc
Username : lee
Index : 1 IP Addr : 161.44.128.249
Protocol : SSL VPN Client Encryption : 3DES
Hashing : SHA1 Auth Mode : userPassword
TCP Dst Port : 443 TCP Src Port : 54230
Bytes Tx : 20178 Bytes Rx : 8662
Pkts Tx : 27 Pkts Rx : 19
Client Ver : Cisco STC 1.1.0.117
Client Type : Mozilla/4.0 (compatible; MSIE 6.0; Windows NT 5.0; Q312461)
Group : DfltGrpPolicy
Login Time : 14:32:03 UTC Wed Apr 20 2005
Duration : 0h:00m:04s
Filter Name :
The following example terminates the session using the name option of the vpn-session-db logoff
command:
hostname# vpn-session-db logoff name lee
INFO: Number of sessions with name "lee" logged off : 1
Updating SVCs
You can update the SVC images on the security appliance at any time using the following procedure:
Step 1 Copy the new SVC images to the security appliance using the copy command from privileged EXEC
mode, or using another method.
Step 2 If the new SVC image files have the same filenames as the files already loaded, reenter the svc image
command that is in the configuration. If the new filenames are different, uninstall the old files using the
no svc image command. Then use the svc image command to assign an order to the SVC images and
cause the security appliance to load the new SVC images.
This chapter describes how to configure certificates. CAs are responsible for managing certificate
requests and issuing digital certificates. A digital certificate contains information that identifies a user
or device. Some of this information can include a name, serial number, company, department, or IP
address. A digital certificate also contains a copy of the public key for the user or device. A CA can be
a trusted third party, such as VeriSign, or a private (in-house) CA that you establish within your
organization.
This chapter includes the following sections:
• Public Key Cryptography, page 39-1
• Certificate Configuration, page 39-5
Obtaining the public key of a sender is normally handled out-of-band or through an operation done at
installation. For instance, most web browsers are configured with the root certificates of several CAs by
default. For VPN, the IKE protocol, a component of IPSec, can use digital signatures to authenticate peer
devices before setting up security associations.
Certificate Scalability
Without digital certificates, you must manually configure each IPSec peer for every peer with which it
communicates, and every new peer you add to a network would thus require a configuration change on
every peer with which you need it to communicate securely.
When you use digital certificates, each peer is enrolled with a CA. When two peers attempt to
communicate, they exchange certificates and digitally sign data to authenticate each other. When a new
peer is added to the network, you enroll that peer with a CA and none of the other peers need
modification. When the new peer attempts an IPSec connection, certificates are automatically exchanged
and the peer can be authenticated.
With a CA, a peer authenticates itself to the remote peer by sending a certificate to the remote peer and
performing some public key cryptography. Each peer sends its unique certificate which was issued by
the CA. This process works because each certificate encapsulates the public key for the associated peer
and each certificate is authenticated by the CA, and all participating peers recognize the CA as an
authenticating authority. This is called IKE with an RSA signature.
The peer can continue sending its certificate for multiple IPSec sessions, and to multiple IPSec peers,
until the certificate expires. When its certificate expires, the peer administrator must obtain a new one
from the CA.
CAs can also revoke certificates for peers that no longer participate in IPSec. Revoked certificates are
not recognized as valid by other peers. Revoked certificates are listed in a CRL, which each peer may
check before accepting a certificate from another peer.
Some CAs have an RA as part of their implementation. An RA is a server that acts as a proxy for the CA
so that CA functions can continue when the CA is unavailable.
About Trustpoints
Trustpoints let you manage and track CAs and certificates. A trustpoint is a representation of a CA or
identity pair. A trustpoint contains the identity of the CA, CA-specific configuration parameters, and an
association with one enrolled identity certificate.
After you have defined a trustpoint, you can reference it by name in commands requiring that you specify
a CA. You can configure many trustpoints.
Note If a security appliance has multiple trustpoints that share the same CA, only one of these trustpoints
sharing the CA can be used to validate user certificates. Use the support-user-cert-validation command
to control which trustpoint sharing a CA is used for validation of user certificates issued by that CA.
For automatic enrollment, a trustpoint must be configured with an enrollment URL and the CA that the
trustpoint represents must be available on the network and must support SCEP.
You can export and import the keypair and issued certificates associated with a trustpoint in PKCS12
format. This is useful if you wish to manually duplicate a trustpoint configuration on a different security
appliance.
About CRLs
Certificate Revocation Lists provide the security appliance with one means of determining whether a
certificate that is within its valid time range has been revoked by its issuing CA. CRL configuration is a
part of the configuration of a trustpoint.
You can configure the security appliance to make CRL checks mandatory when authenticating a
certificate (revocation-check crl command). You can also make the CRL check optional by adding the
none argument (revocation-check crl none command), which allows the certificate authentication to
succeed when the CA is unavailable to provide updated CRL data.
The security appliance can retrieve CRLs from CAs using HTTP, SCEP, or LDAP. CRLs retrieved for
each trustpoint are cached for a length of time configurable for each trustpoint.
When the security appliance has cached a CRL for more than the length of time it is configured to cache
CRLs, the security appliance considers the CRL too old to be reliable, or “stale”. The security appliance
attempts to retrieve a newer version of the CRL the next time a certificate authentication requires
checking the stale CRL.
The security appliance caches CRLs for a length of time determined by the following two factors:
• The number of minutes specified with the cache-time command. The default value is 60 minutes.
• The NextUpdate field in the CRLs retrieved, which may be absent from CRLs. You control whether
the security appliance requires and uses the NextUpdate field with the enforcenextupdate
command.
The security appliance uses these two factors as follows:
• If the NextUpdate field is not required, the security appliance marks CRLs as stale after the length
of time defined by the cache-time command.
• If the NextUpdate field is required, the security appliance marks CRLs as stale at the sooner of the
two times specified by the cache-time command and the NextUpdate field. For example, if the
cache-time command is set to 100 minutes and the NextUpdate field specifies that the next update
is 70 minutes away, the security appliance marks CRLs as stale in 70 minutes.
If the security appliance has insufficient memory to store all CRLs cached for a given trustpoint, it
deletes the least recently used CRL to make room for a newly retrieved CRL.
For information about configuring CRL behavior for a trustpoint, see the “Configuring CRLs for a
Trustpoint” section on page 39-13.
About OCSP
Online Certificate Status Protocol provides the security appliance with a means of determining whether
a certificate that is within its valid time range has been revoked by its issuing CA. OCSP configuration
is a part of the configuration of a trustpoint.
OCSP localizes certificate status on a Validation Authority (an OCSP server, also called the responder)
which the security appliance queries for the status of a specific certificate. It provides better scalability
and more up-to-date revocation status than does CRL checking. It helps organizations with large PKI
installations deploy and expand secure networks.
You can configure the security appliance to make OCSP checks mandatory when authenticating a
certificate (revocation-check ocsp command). You can also make the OCSP check optional by adding
the none argument (revocation-check ocsp none command), which allows the certificate authentication
to succeed when the Validation Authority is unavailable to provide updated OCSP data.
Our implementation of OCSp provides three ways to define the OCSP server URL. The security
appliance uses these servers in the following order:
1. The OCSP URL defined in a match certificate override rule (match certificate command).
2. The OCSP URL configured in the ocsp url command.
3. The AIA field of the client certificate.
Note To configure a trustpoint to validate a self-signed OCSP responder certificate, you import the self-signed
responder certificate into its own trustpoint as a trusted CA certificate. Then you configure the match
certificate command in the client certificate validating trustpoint to use the trustpoint that contains the
self-signed OCSP responder certificate to validate the responder certificate. The same applies for
configuring validating responder certificates external to the validation path of the client certificate.
The OCSP server (responder) certificate typically signs the OCSP response. After receiving the
response, the security appliance tries to verify the responder certificate. The CA normally sets the
lifetime of its OCSP responder certificate to a relatively short period to minimize the chance of it being
compromised.The CA typically also includes an ocsp-no-check extension in the responder certificate
indicating that this certificate does not need revocation status checking. But if this extension is not
present, the security appliance tries to check its revocation status using the same method specified in the
trustpoint. If the responder certificate is not verifiable, revocation checks fails. To avoid this possibility,
configure revocation-check none in the responder certificate validating trustpoint, while configuring
revocation-check ocsp for the client certificate.
Supported CA Servers
The security appliance supports the following CA servers:
• Cisco IOS CS
• Baltimore Technologies
• Entrust
• Microsoft Certificate Services
• Netscape CMS
• RSA Keon
• VeriSign
Certificate Configuration
This section describes how to configure the security appliance with certificates and other procedures
related to certificate use and management.
This section includes the following topics:
• Preparing for Certificates, page 39-5
• Configuring Key Pairs, page 39-6
• Configuring Trustpoints, page 39-7
• Obtaining Certificates, page 39-9
• Configuring CRLs for a Trustpoint, page 39-13
• Exporting and Importing Trustpoints, page 39-14
• Configuring CA Certificate Map Rules, page 39-15
Step 1 Ensure that the hostname and domain name of the security appliance are configured correctly. You can
use the show running-config command to view the hostname and domain name as currently configured.
For information about configuring the hostname, see the “Setting the Hostname” section on page 8-2.
For information about configuring the domain name, see the “Setting the Domain Name” section on
page 8-2.
Step 2 Be sure that the security appliance clock is set accurately before configuring the CA. Certificates have
a date and time that they become valid and that they expire. When the security appliance enrolls with a
CA and gets a certificate, the security appliance checks that the current time is within the valid range for
the certificate. If it is outside that range, enrollment fails.
For information about setting the clock, see the “Setting the Date and Time” section on page 8-2.
Step 1 Generate the types of key pairs needed for your PKI implementation. To do so, perform the following
steps, as applicable:
a. If you want to generate RSA key pairs, use the crypto key generate rsa command.
hostname/contexta(config)# crypto key generate rsa
If you do not use additional keywords this command generates one general purpose RSA key pair.
Because the key modulus is not specified, the default key modulus of 1024 is used. You can specify
other modulus sizes with the modulus keyword. You can also assign a label to each key pair using
the label keyword. The label is referenced by the trustpoint that uses the key pair. If you do not
assign a label, the key pair is automatically labeled <Default-RSA-Key>.
hostname/contexta(config)# crypto key generate rsa label key-pair-label
Step 2 (Optional) Use the show crypto key mypubkey command to view key pair(s). The following example
shows an RSA general-purpose key:
hostname/contexta(config)# show crypto key mypubkey
Key pair was generated at: 16:39:47 central Feb 10 2005
Key name: <Default-RSA-Key>
Usage: General Purpose Key
Modulus Size (bits): 1024
Key Data:
Step 3 Save the key pair you have generated. To do so, save the running configuration by entering the write
memory command.
Configuring Trustpoints
For information about trustpoints, see the “About Trustpoints” section on page 39-3.
To configure a trustpoint, perform the following steps:
Step 1 Create a trustpoint corresponding to the CA from which the security appliance needs to receive its
certificate.
hostname/contexta(config)# crypto ca trustpoint trustpoint
Upon entering this command, you enter the Crypto ca trustpoint configuration mode.
Step 2 Specify the enrollment method to be used with this trustpoint.
To specify the enrollment method, do one of the following items:
• To specify SCEP enrollment, use the enrollment url command to configure the URL to be used for
SCEP enrollment with the trustpoint you declared. For example, if the security appliance requests
certificates from trustpoint Main using the URL http://10.29.67.142:80/certsrv/mscep/mscep.dll,
then the command would be as follows:
hostname/contexta(config-ca-trustpoint)# enrollment url
http://10.29.67.142:80/certsrv/mscep/mscep.dll
• To specify manual enrollment, use the enrollment terminal command to indicate that you will paste
the certificate received from the CA into the terminal.
Step 3 As needed, specify other characteristics for the trustpoint. The characteristics you need to define depend
upon your CA and its configuration. You can specify characteristics for the trustpoint using the following
commands. Refer to the Cisco Security Appliance Command Reference for complete descriptions and
usage guidelines of these commands.
• accept-subordinates—Indicates whether CA certificates subordinate to the CA associated with the
trustpoint are accepted if delivered during phase one IKE exchange when not previously installed
on the device.
• crl required | optional | nocheck—Specifies CRL configuration options. When you enter the crl
command with the optional keyword included within the command statement, certificates from
peers can still be accepted by your security appliance even if the CRL is not accessible to your
security appliance.
Note If you chose to enable required or optional CRL checking, be sure you configure the
trustpoint for CRL managemen2t, which should be completed after you have obtained
certificates. For details about configuring CRL management for a trustpoint, see the
“Configuring CRLs for a Trustpoint” section on page 39-13.
• revocation-check—Sets one or more methods for revocation checking: CRL, OCSP, and none.
• subject-name X.500 name—During enrollment, asks the CA to include the specified subject DN in
the certificate.
• serial-number—During enrollment, asks the CA to include the security appliance serial number in
the certificate.
• support-user-cert-validation—If enabled, the configuration settings to validate a remote user
certificate can be taken from this trustpoint, provided that this trustpoint is authenticated to the CA
that issued the remote certificate.
• exit—Leaves the mode.
Step 4 Save the trustpoint configuration. To do so, save the running configuration by entering the write
memory command.
Obtaining Certificates
The security appliance needs a CA certificate for each trustpoint and one or two certificates for itself,
depending upon the configuration of the keys used by the trustpoint. If the trustpoint uses separate RSA
keys for signing and encryption, the security appliance needs two certificates, one for each purpose. In
other key configurations, only one certificate is needed.
The security appliance supports enrollment with SCEP and with manual enrollment, which lets you paste
a base-64-encoded certificate directly into the terminal. For site-to-site VPNs, you must enroll each
security appliance. For remote access VPNs, you must enroll each security appliance and each remote
access VPN client.
This section includes the following topics:
• Obtaining Certificates with SCEP, page 39-9
• Obtaining Certificates Manually, page 39-11
Note Whether a trustpoint uses SCEP for obtaining certificates is determined by the use of the enrollment url
command when you configure the trustpoint (see the “Configuring Trustpoints” section on page 39-7).
For example, using trustpoint named Main, which represents a subordinate CA:
Step 2 Enroll the security appliance with the trustpoint. This process retrieves a certificate for signing data and,
depending upon the type of keys you configured, for encrypting data.
Step 3 To perform enrollment, use the crypto ca enroll command. Before entering this command, contact your
CA administrator because the administrator may need to authenticate your enrollment request manually
before the CA grants its certificates.
hostname(config)# crypto ca enroll trustpoint
If the security appliance does not receive a certificate from the CA within 1 minute (the default) of
sending a certificate request, it resends the certificate request. The security appliance continues sending
a certificate request every 1 minute until a certificate is received.
Note If the fully qualified domain name configured for the trustpoint is not identical to the fully
qualified domain name of the security appliance, including the case of the characters, a warning
appears. If needed, you can exit the enrollment process, make any necessary corrections, and
enter the crypto ca enroll command again.
The following enrollment example performs enrollment with the trustpoint named Main:
hostname(config)# crypto ca enroll Main
%
% Start certificate enrollment ..
% Create a challenge password. You will need to verbally provide this
% password to the CA Administrator in order to revoke your certificate.
% For security reasons your password will not be saved in the configuration.
% Please make a note of it.
Password: 2b0rn0t2b
Re-enter password: 2b0rn0t2b
% The subject name in the certificate will be: securityappliance.example.com
% The fully-qualified domain name in the certificate will be:
securityappliance.example.com
% Include the device serial number in the subject name? [yes/no]: no
Request certificate from CA [yes/no]: yes
% Certificate request sent to Certificate authority.
Note The password is required if the certificate for the security appliance needs to be revoked, so it is
crucial that you remember this password. Note it and store it in a safe place.
You must enter the crypto ca enroll command for each trustpoint with which the security appliance
needs to enroll.
Note If your security appliance reboots after you issued the crypto ca enroll command but before you
received the certificate, reissue the crypto ca enroll command and notify the CA administrator.
Step 4 Verify that the enrollment process was successful using the show crypto ca certificate command. For
example, to show the certificate received from trustpoint Main:
hostname/contexta(config)# show crypto ca certificate Main
The output of this command shows the details of the certificate issued for the security appliance and the
CA certificate for the trustpoint.
Step 5 Save the configuration using the write memory command:
hostname/contexta(config)# write memory
Note Whether a trustpoint requires that you manually obtain certificates is determined by the use of the
enrollment terminal command when you configure the trustpoint (see the “Configuring Trustpoints”
section on page 39-7).
Step 1 Obtain a base-64 encoded CA certificate from the CA represented by the trustpoint.
Step 2 Import the CA certificate. To do so, use the crypto ca authenticate command. The following example
shows a CA certificate request for the trustpoint Main.
hostname (config)# crypto ca authenticate Main
Enter the base 64 encoded CA certificate.
End with a blank line or the word "quit" on a line by itself
MIIDRTCCAu+gAwIBAgIQKVcqP/KW74VP0NZzL+JbRTANBgkqhkiG9w0BAQUFADCB
[ certificate data omitted ]
/7QEM8izy0EOTSErKu7Nd76jwf5e4qttkQ==
quit
Step 3 Generate a certificate request. To do so, use the crypto ca enroll command. The following example
shows a certificate and encryption key request for the trustpoint Main, which is configured to use manual
enrollment and general-purpose RSA keys for signing and encryption.
hostname (config)# crypto ca enroll Main
% Start certificate enrollment ..
MIIBoDCCAQkCAQAwIzEhMB8GCSqGSIb3DQEJAhYSRmVyYWxQaXguY2lzY28uY29t
[ certificate request data omitted ]
jF4waw68eOxQxVmdgMWeQ+RbIOYmvt8g6hnBTrd0GdqjjVLt
Note If you use separate RSA keys for signing and encryption, the crypto ca enroll command
displays two certificate requests, one for each key. To complete enrollment, acquire a certificate
for all certificate requests generated by the crypto ca enroll command.
Step 4 For each request generated by the crypto ca enroll command, obtain a certificate from the CA
represented by the applicable trustpoint. Be sure the certificate is in base-64 format.
Step 5 For each certificate you receive from the CA, use the crypto ca import certificate command. The
security appliance prompts you to paste the certificate to the terminal in base-64 format.
Note If you use separate RSA key pairs for signing and encryption, perform this step for each
certificate separately. The security appliance determines automatically whether the certificate is
for the signing or encryption key pair. The order in which you import the two certificates is
irrelevant.
The following example manually imports a certificate for the trustpoint Main:
hostname (config)# crypto ca import Main certificate
% The fully-qualified domain name in the certificate will be:
securityappliance.example.com
Step 6 Verify that the enrollment process was successful using the show crypto ca certificate command. For
example, to show the certificate received from trustpoint Main:
hostname/contexta(config)# show crypto ca certificate Main
The output of this command shows the details of the certificate issued for the security appliance and the
CA certificate for the trustpoint.
Step 7 Save the configuration using the write memory command:
hostname/contexta(config)# write memory
Step 1 Enter Crypto ca trustpoint configuration mode for the trustpoint whose CRL configuration you want to
modify. To do so, enter the crypto ca trustpoint command.
Step 2 If you have not already enabled CRLs, you can do so now by using the crl command with either the
required or optional keyword. If you specify the required keyword, certificate authentication with this
trustpoint cannot succeed if the CRL is unavailable.
Step 3 Enter the crl configure command.
hostname/contexta(config-ca-trustpoint)# crl configure
hostname/contexta(config-ca-crl)#
Upon entering this command, you enter the crl configuration mode for the current trustpoint.
Tip To set all CRL configuration options to their default values, use the default command. At any
time while performing CRL configuration, if you want to start over, enter this command and
restart this procedure.
Step 4 Configure the retrieval policy with the policy command. The following keywords for this command
determine the policy.
• cdp—CRLs are retrieved only from the CRL distribution points specified in authenticated
certificates.
where n is the rank assigned to the URL. To remove a URL, use the no url n command.
Step 6 Configure the retrieval method with the protocol command. The following keywords for this command
determine the retrieval method.
• http—Specifies HTTP as the CRL retrieval method.
• ldap—Specifies LDAP as the CRL retrieval method.
• scep—Specifies SCEP as the CRL retrieval method.
Step 7 Configure how long the security appliance caches CRLs for the current trustpoint. To specify the number
of minutes the security appliance waits before considering a CRL stale, enter the following command.
hostname/contexta(config-ca-crl)# cache-time n
where n is the number of minutes. For example, to specify that CRLs should be cached for seven hours,
enter the following command.
hostname/contexta(config-ca-crl)# cache-time 420
Step 8 Configure whether the security appliance requires the NextUpdate field in CRLs. For more information
about how the security appliance uses the NextUpdate field, see the “About CRLs” section on page 39-3.
Do one of the following:
• To require the NextUpdate field, enter the enforcenextupdate command. This is the default setting.
• To allow the NextUpdate field to be absent in CRLs, enter the no enforcenextupdate command.
Step 9 If you specified LDAP as the retrieval protocol, perform the following steps:
a. Enter the following command to identify the LDAP server to the security appliance:
hostname/contexta(config-ca-crl)# ldap-defaults server
You can specify the server by DNS hostname or by IP address. You can also provide a port number
if the server listens for LDAP queries on a port other than the default of 389. For example, the
following command configures the security appliance to retrieve CRLs from an LDAP server whose
hostname is ldap1.
hostname/contexta(config-ca-crl)# ldap-defaults ldap1
Note If you use a hostname rather than an IP address to specify the LDAP server, be sure you have
configured the security appliance to use DNS. For information about configuring DNS, see
the dns commands in the Cisco Security Appliance Command Reference.
b. If LDAP server requires credentials to permit CRL retrieval, enter the following command:
hostname/contexta(config-ca-crl)# ldap-dn admin-DN password
For example:
hostname/contexta(config-ca-crl)# ldap-dn cn=admin,ou=devtest,o=engineering c00lRunZ
Step 10 To test CRL configuration for the current trustpoint, use the crypto ca crl request command. This
command retrieves the current CRL from the CA represented by the trustpoint you specify.
Step 11 Save the running configuration. Enter the write memory command.
hostname (config)#
Note If a security appliance has trustpoints that share the same CA, only one of the trustpoints sharing the CA
can be used to validate user certificates. The crypto ca import pkcs12 command can create this
situation. Use the support-user-cert-validation command to control which trustpoint sharing a CA is
used for validation of user certificates issued by that CA.
The following example manually imports PKCS12 data to the trustpoint Main with the passphrase
Wh0zits:
hostname (config)# crypto ca import Main pkcs12 Wh0zits
Step 1 Enter CA certificate map configuration mode for the rule you want to configure. To do so, enter the
crypto ca certificate map command and specify the rule index number. The following example
enters CA certificate map mode for the rule with index number 1.
hostname(config)# crypto ca certificate map 1
hostname(config-ca-cert-map)#
Step 2 Use the issuer-name and subject-name commands to configure the rule. These commands specify tests
that the security appliance can apply to values found in the Issuer or Subject fields of certificates. The
tests can apply to specific attributes or to the whole of the Issuer or Subject fields. You can configure
many tests per rule, and all the tests you specify with these commands must be true for a rule to match
a certificate. Valid operators in the issuer-name and subject-name commands are as follows.
Operator Meaning
eq The field or attribute must be identical to the value given.
ne The field or attribute cannot be identical to the value given.
co Part or all of the field or attribute must match the value given.
nc No part of the field or attribute can match the value given.
For more information about the issuer-name and subject-name commands, see the Cisco Security
Appliance Command Reference.
The following example specifies that any attribute within the Issuer field must contain the string cisco.
hostname(config-ca-cert-map)# issuer-name co cisco
hostname(config-ca-cert-map)#
The following example specifies that within the Subject field an Organizational Unit attribute must
exactly match the string Engineering.
hostname(config-ca-cert-map)# subject-name attr ou eq Engineering
hostname(config-ca-cert-map)#
Step 3 When you have finished configuring the map rule, save your work. Enter the write memory command.
System Administration
C H A P T E R 40
Managing System Access
This chapter describes how to access the security appliance for system management through Telnet,
SSH, and HTTPS. It also describes how to authenticate and authorize users and how to create login
banners.
This chapter includes the following sections:
• Allowing Telnet Access, page 40-1
• Allowing SSH Access, page 40-2
• Allowing HTTPS Access for ASDM, page 40-3
• Configuring ASDM and WebVPN on the Same Interface, page 40-4
• Configuring AAA for System Administrators, page 40-5
• Configuring a Login Banner, page 40-16
Note To access the security appliance interface for management access, you do not also need an access list
allowing the host IP address. You only need to configure management access according to the sections
in this chapter.
Step 1 To identify the IP addresses from which the security appliance accepts connections, enter the following
command for each address or subnet:
hostname(config)# telnet source_IP_address mask source_interface
If there is only one interface, you can configure Telnet to access that interface as long as the interface
has a security level of 100.
Step 2 (Optional) To set the duration for how long a Telnet session can be idle before the security appliance
disconnects the session, enter the following command:
Set the timeout from 1 to 1440 minutes. The default is 5 minutes. The default duration is too short in
most cases and should be increased until all pre-production testing and troubleshooting has been
completed.
For example, to let a host on the inside interface with an address of 192.168.1.2 access the security
appliance, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# telnet 192.168.1.2 255.255.255.255 inside
hostname(config)# telnet timeout 30
To allow all users on the 192.168.3.0 network to access the security appliance on the inside interface,
enter the following command:
hostname(config)# telnet 192.168.3.0 255.255.255.0 inside
Note XML management over SSL and SSH are not supported.
Step 1 To generate an RSA key pair, which is required for SSH, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# crypto key generate rsa modulus modulus_size
The modulus (in bits) is 512, 768, 1024, or 2048. The larger the key modulus size you specify, the longer
it takes to generate an RSA. We recommend a value of 1024.
Step 2 To save the RSA keys to persistent Flash memory, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# write mem
Step 3 To identify the IP addresses from which the security appliance accepts connections, enter the following
command for each address or subnet:
The security appliance accepts SSH connections from all interfaces, including the one with the lowest
security level.
Step 4 (Optional) To set the duration for how long an SSH session can be idle before the security appliance
disconnects the session, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# ssh timeout minutes
Set the timeout from 1 to 60 minutes. The default is 5 minutes. The default duration is too short in most
cases and should be increased until all pre-production testing and troubleshooting has been completed.
For example, to generate RSA keys and let a host on the inside interface with an address of 192.168.1.2
access the security appliance, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# crypto key generate rsa modulus 1024
hostname(config)# write mem
hostname(config)# ssh 192.168.1.2 255.255.255.255 inside
hostname(config)# ssh 192.168.1.2 255.255.255.255 inside
hostname(config)# ssh timeout 30
To allow all users on the 192.168.3.0 network to access the security appliance on the inside interface,
the following command:
hostname(config)# ssh 192.168.3.0 255.255.255.0 inside
By default SSH allows both version one and version two. To specify the version number enter the
following command:
hostname(config)# ssh version version_number
The display of the dot does not affect the functionality of SSH. The dot appears at the console when
generating a server key or decrypting a message using private keys during SSH key exchange before user
authentication occurs. These tasks can take up to two minutes or longer. The dot is a progress indicator
that verifies that the security appliance is busy and has not hung.
The security appliance allows a maximum of 5 concurrent ASDM instances per context, if available,
with a maximum of 32 ASDM instances between all contexts.
To configure ASDM access, follow these steps:
Step 1 To identify the IP addresses from which the security appliance accepts HTTPS connections, enter the
following command for each address or subnet:
hostname(config)# http source_IP_address mask source_interface
Step 3 To specify the location of the ASDM image, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# asdm image disk0:/asdmfile
For example, to enable the HTTPS server and let a host on the inside interface with an address of
192.168.1.2 access ASDM, enter the following commands:
hostname(config)# crypto key generate rsa modulus 1024
hostname(config)# write mem
hostname(config)# http server enable
hostname(config)# http 192.168.1.2 255.255.255.255 inside
To allow all users on the 192.168.3.0 network to access ASDM on the inside interface, enter the
following command:
hostname(config)# http 192.168.3.0 255.255.255.0 inside
To specify a port for WebVPN, use the port command from webvpn configuration mode. The next
example enables WebVPN on port 444 of the outside interface. HTTPS for ASDM is also configured on
the outside interface and uses the default port (443). With this configuration, remote users initiating
WebVPN sessions enter https://<outside_ip>:444 in the browser.
hostname(config)# http server enable
hostname(config)# http 192.168.3.0 255.255.255.0 outside
hostname(config)# webvpn
Note Before the security appliance can authenticate a Telnet, SSH, or HTTP user, you must first configure
access to the security appliance using the telnet, ssh, and http commands. These commands identify the
IP addresses that are allowed to communicate with the security appliance.
To authenticate users who access the CLI, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# aaa authentication {telnet | ssh | http | serial} console {LOCAL |
server_group [LOCAL]}
The http keyword authenticates the ASDM client that accesses the security appliance using HTTPS.
You only need to configure HTTP authentication if you want to use a AAA server. By default, ASDM
uses the local database for authentication even if you do not configure this command. HTTP
management authentication does not support the SDI protocol for a AAA server group.
If you use a AAA server group for authentication, you can configure the security appliance to use the
local database as a fallback method if the AAA server is unavailable. Specify the server group name
followed by LOCAL (LOCAL is case sensitive). We recommend that you use the same username and
password in the local database as the AAA server because the security appliance prompt does not give
any indication which method is being used.
You can alternatively use the local database as your main method of authentication (with no fallback)
by entering LOCAL alone.
Caution If you add users to the local database who can gain access to the CLI and whom you do not want to enter
privileged EXEC mode, you should configure command authorization. Without command authorization,
users can access privileged EXEC mode (and all commands) at the CLI using their own password if their
privilege level is 2 or greater (2 is the default). Alternatively, you can use a AAA server for
authentication, or you can set all local users to level 1 so you can control who can use the system enable
password to access privileged EXEC mode.
To log in as a user from the local database, enter the following command:
hostname> login
The security appliance prompts for your username and password. After you enter your password, the
security appliance places you in the privilege level that the local database specifies.
Note You can use local command authorization without any users in the local database and without
CLI or enable authentication. Instead, when you enter the enable command, you enter the
system enable password, and the security appliance places you in level 15. You can then create
enable passwords for every level, so that when you enter enable n (2 to 15), the security
appliance places you in level n. These levels are not used unless you turn on local command
authorization (see “Configuring Local Command Authorization” below). (See the Cisco Security
Appliance Command Reference for more information about enable.)
• TACACS+ server—On the TACACS+ server, configure the commands that a user or group can use
after they authenticate for CLI access. Every command that a user enters at the CLI is checked with
the TACACS+ server.
By default, the following commands are assigned to privilege level 0. All other commands are at
level 15.
• show checksum
• show curpriv
• enable (enable mode)
• help
• show history
• login
• logout
• pager
• show pager
• clear pager
• quit
• show version
If you move any configure mode commands to a lower level than 15, be sure to move the configure
command to that level as well, otherwise, the user will not be able to enter configuration mode.
To view all privilege levels, see the “Viewing Command Privilege Levels” section on page 40-10.
To assign a command to a new privilege level, and enable authorization, follow these steps:
Even if you set command privilege levels, command authorization does not take place unless you enable
command authorization with this command.
Alternatively, you can set all filter commands to the same level:
hostname(config)# privilege level 5 command filter
The following example shows the use of the mode keyword. The enable command must be entered from
user EXEC mode, while the enable password command, which is accessible in configuration mode,
requires the highest privilege level.
hostname(config)# privilege cmd level 0 mode enable command enable
hostname(config)# privilege cmd level 15 mode cmd command enable
hostname(config)# privilege show level 15 mode cmd command enable
This example shows an additional command, the configure command, that uses the mode keyword:
hostname(config)# privilege show level 5 mode cmd command configure
hostname(config)# privilege clear level 15 mode cmd command configure
hostname(config)# privilege cmd level 15 mode cmd command configure
hostname(config)# privilege cmd level 15 mode enable command configure
The following commands let you view privilege levels for commands.
• To show all commands, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# show running-config all privilege all
For example, for the show running-config all privilege all command, the system displays the current
assignment of each CLI command to a privilege level. The following is sample output from the
command.
hostname(config)# show running-config all privilege all
privilege show level 15 command aaa
privilege clear level 15 command aaa
privilege configure level 15 command aaa
privilege show level 15 command aaa-server
privilege clear level 15 command aaa-server
privilege configure level 15 command aaa-server
privilege show level 15 command access-group
privilege clear level 15 command access-group
privilege configure level 15 command access-group
privilege show level 15 command access-list
privilege clear level 15 command access-list
privilege configure level 15 command access-list
privilege show level 15 command activation-key
privilege configure level 15 command activation-key
....
The following command displays the command assignments for privilege level 10:
hostname(config)# show running-config privilege level 10
privilege show level 10 command aaa
The following command displays the command assignment for the access-list command:
hostname(config)# show running-config privilege command access-list
You can configure commands on a Cisco Secure Access Control Server (ACS) TACACS+ server as a
shared profile component, for a group, or for individual users. For third-party TACACS+ servers, see
your server documentation for more information about command authorization support.
See the following guidelines for configuring commands in Cisco Secure ACS Version 3.1; many of these
guidelines also apply to third-party servers:
• The security appliance sends the commands to be authorized as “shell” commands, so configure the
commands on the TACACS+ server as shell commands.
Note Cisco Secure ACS might include a command type called “pix-shell.” Do not use this type for
security appliance command authorization.
• The first word of the command is considered to be the main command. All additional words are
considered to be arguments, which need to be preceded by permit or deny.
For example, to allow the show running-configuration aaa-server command, add show
running-configuration to the command box, and type permit aaa-server in the arguments box.
• You can permit all arguments of a command that you do not explicitly deny by selecting the Permit
Unmatched Args check box.
For example, you can configure just the show command, and then all the show commands are
allowed. We recommend using this method so that you do not have to anticipate every variant of a
command, including abbreviations and ?, which shows CLI usage (see Figure 40-1).
• For commands that are a single word, you must permit unmatched arguments, even if there are no
arguments for the command, for example enable or help (see Figure 40-2).
• When you abbreviate a command at the command line, the security appliance expands the prefix and
main command to the full text, but it sends additional arguments to the TACACS+ server as you
enter them.
For example, if you enter sh log, then the security appliance sends the entire command to the
TACACS+ server, show logging. However, if you enter sh log mess, then the security appliance
sends show logging mess to the TACACS+ server, and not the expanded command show logging
message. You can configure multiple spellings of the same argument to anticipate abbreviations
(see Figure 40-4).
• We recommend that you allow the following basic commands for all users:
– show checksum
– show curpriv
– enable
– help
– show history
– login
– logout
– pager
– show pager
– clear pager
– quit
– show version
Before you enable TACACS+ command authorization, be sure that you are logged into the security
appliance as a user that is defined on the TACACS+ server, and that you have the necessary command
authorization to continue configuring the security appliance. For example, you should log in as an admin
user with all commands authorized. Otherwise, you could become unintentionally locked out.
To perform command authorization using a TACACS+ server, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# aaa authorization command tacacs+_server_group [LOCAL]
You can configure the security appliance to use the local database as a fallback method if the TACACS+
server is unavailable. To enable fallback, specify the server group name followed by LOCAL (LOCAL
is case sensitive). We recommend that you use the same username and password in the local database as
the TACACS+ server because the security appliance prompt does not give any indication which method
is being used. Be sure to configure users in the local database (see the “Configuring Command
Authorization” section on page 40-7) and command privilege levels (see the “Configuring Local
Command Authorization” section on page 40-8).
Where level is the minimum privilege level and server-tag is the name of the TACACS+ server group
that to which the security appliance should send command accounting messages. The TACACS+ server
group configuration must already exist. For information about configuring a AAA server group, see the
“Identifying AAA Server Groups and Servers” section on page 13-12.
See the following sample show curpriv command output. A description of each field follows.
hostname# show curpriv
Username : admin
Current privilege level : 15
Current Mode/s : P_PRIV
Field Description
Username Username. If you are logged in as the default user, the name is enable_1 (user
EXEC) or enable_15 (privileged EXEC).
Current privilege level Level from 0 to 15. Unless you configure local command authorization and
assign commands to intermediate privilege levels, levels 0 and 15 are the only
levels that are used.
Current Mode/s Shows the access modes:
• P_UNPR—User EXEC mode (levels 0 and 1)
• P_PRIV—Privileged EXEC mode (levels 2 to 15)
• P_CONF—Configuration mode
Feature Lockout Condition Description Workaround: Single Mode Workaround: Multiple Mode
Local CLI No users in the If you have no users in Log in and reset the Session into the security
authentication local database the local database, you passwords and aaa appliance from the switch.
cannot log in, and you commands. From the system execution
cannot add any users. space, you can change to the
context and add a user.
TACACS+ Server down or If the server is 1. Log in and reset the 1. If the server is
command unreachable and unreachable, then you passwords and AAA unreachable because the
authorization you do not have cannot log in or enter commands. network configuration
TACACS+ CLI the fallback any commands. 2. Configure the local is incorrect on the
authentication method database as a fallback security appliance,
configured method so you do not session into the security
RADIUS CLI appliance from the
get locked out when the
authentication switch. From the system
server is down.
execution space, you
can change to the
context and reconfigure
your network settings.
2. Configure the local
database as a fallback
method so you do not
get locked out when the
server is down.
Table 40-2 CLI Authentication and Command Authorization Lockout Scenarios (continued)
Feature Lockout Condition Description Workaround: Single Mode Workaround: Multiple Mode
TACACS+ You are logged in You enable command Fix the TACACS+ server Session into the security
command as a user without authorization, but then user account. appliance from the switch.
authorization enough privileges find that the user If you do not have access to From the system execution
or as a user that cannot enter any more the TACACS+ server and space, you can change to the
does not exist commands. you need to configure the context and complete the
security appliance configuration changes. You
immediately, then log into can also disable command
the maintenance partition authorization until you fix
and reset the passwords and the TACACS+
aaa commands. configuration.
Local command You are logged in You enable command Log in and reset the Session into the security
authorization as a user without authorization, but then passwords and aaa appliance from the switch.
enough privileges find that the user commands. From the system execution
cannot enter any more space, you can change to the
commands. context and change the user
level.
Adds a banner to display at one of three times: when a user first connects (message-of-the-day (motd)),
when a user logs in (login), and when a user accesses privileged EXEC mode (exec). When a user
connects to the security appliance, the message-of-the-day banner appears first, followed by the login
banner and prompts. After the user successfully logs in to the security appliance, the exec banner
displays.
For the banner text, spaces are allowed but tabs cannot be entered using the CLI. You can dynamically
add the hostname or domain name of the security appliance by including the strings $(hostname) and
$(domain). If you configure a banner in the system configuration, you can use that banner text within a
context by using the $(system) string in the context configuration.
To add more than one line, precede each line by the banner command.
For example, to add a message-of-the-day banner, enter:
hostname(config)# banner motd Welcome to $(hostname).
hostname(config)# banner motd Contact me at [email protected] for any
hostname(config)# banner motd issues.
This chapter contains information about managing the security appliance software, licenses, and
configurations, and includes the following sections:
• Managing Licenses, page 41-1
• Viewing Files in Flash Memory, page 41-2
• Downloading Software or Configuration Files to Flash Memory, page 41-3
• Configuring the Application Image and ASDM Image to Boot, page 41-5
• Configuring the File to Boot as the Startup Configuration, page 41-5
• Performing Zero Downtime Upgrades for Failover Pairs, page 41-6
• Backing Up Configuration Files, page 41-8
• Configuring Auto Update Support, page 41-9
Managing Licenses
When you install the software, the existing activation key is extracted from the original image and stored
in a file in the security appliance file system.
Step 1 Obtain the serial number for your security appliance by entering the following command:
hostname> show version | include Number
Step 2 Connect a web browser to one of the following websites (the URLs are case-sensitive):
Use the following website if you are a registered user of Cisco.com:
http://www.cisco.com/go/license
Use the following website if you are not a registered user of Cisco.com:
http://www.cisco.com/go/license/public
The key is a four or five-element hexadecimal string with one space between each element. For example,
a key in the correct form might look like the following key:
0xe02888da 0x4ba7bed6 0xf1c123ae 0xffd8624e
The leading 0x specifier is optional; all values are assumed to be hexadecimal.
If you are already in multiple context mode, enter this command in the system execution space.
Before entering the activation key, ensure that the image in Flash memory and the running image are the
same. You can do this by rebooting the security appliance before entering the new activation key.
Note The activation key is not stored in your configuration file. The key is tied to the serial number of the
device.
You must reboot the security appliance after entering the new activation key for the change to take effect
in the running image.
This example shows how to change the activation key on the security appliance:
hostname(config)# activation-key 0xe02888da 0x4ba7bed6 0xf1c123ae 0xffd8624e
The flash: keyword represents the internal Flash memory on the PIX 500 series security appliance.
You can enter flash: or disk0: for the internal Flash memory on the ASA 5500 series adaptive
security appliance. The disk1: keyword represents the external Flash memory on the ASA. The
internal Flash memory is the default.
For example:
hostname# dir
Directory of disk0:/
500 -rw- 4958208 22:56:20 Nov 29 2004 cdisk.bin
2513 -rw- 4634 19:32:48 Sep 17 2004 first-backup
2788 -rw- 21601 20:51:46 Nov 23 2004 backup.cfg
2927 -rw- 8670632 20:42:48 Dec 08 2004 asdmfile.bin
• To view extended information about a specific file, enter the following command:
hostname# show file information [path:/]filename
The default path is the root directory of the internal Flash memory (flash:/ or disk0:/).
For example:
hostname# show file information cdisk.bin
disk0:/cdisk.bin:
type is image (XXX) []
file size is 4976640 bytes version 7.0(1)
Note To successfully copy ASDM Version 5.0(5) to Flash memory, you must be running Version 7.0.
To configure the security appliance to use a specific configuration as the startup configuration, see the
“Configuring the File to Boot as the Startup Configuration” section on page 41-5.
For multiple context mode, you must be in the system execution space.
To download a file to Flash memory, see the following commands for each download server type:
• To copy from a TFTP server, enter the following command:
hostname# copy tftp://server[/path]/filename {flash:/ | disk0:/ |
disk1:/}[path/]filename
The flash:/ keyword represents the internal Flash memory on the PIX 500 series security appliance.
You can enter flash:/ or disk0:/ for the internal Flash memory on the ASA 5500 series adaptive
security appliance. The disk1:/ keyword represents the external Flash memory on the ASA.
• To copy from an FTP server, enter the following command:
hostname# copy ftp://[user[:password]@]server[/path]/filename {flash:/ | disk0:/ |
disk1:/}[path/]filename
• To use secure copy, first enable SSH, then enter the following command:
hostname# ssh scopy enable
The -v is for verbose, and if -pw is not specified you will be prompted for a password.
Note When you copy a configuration to the running configuration, you merge the two configurations. A merge
adds any new commands from the new configuration to the running configuration. If the configurations
are the same, no changes occur. If commands conflict or if commands affect the running of the context,
then the effect of the merge depends on the command. You might get errors, or you might have
unexpected results.
For example, to copy the configuration from a TFTP server, enter the following command:
hostname# copy tftp://209.165.200.226/configs/startup.cfg startup-config
To copy the configuration from an FTP server, enter the following command:
hostname# copy ftp://admin:[email protected]/configs/startup.cfg startup-config
To copy the configuration from an HTTP server, enter the following command:
hostname# copy http://209.165.200.228/configs/startup.cfg startup-config
The flash:/ keyword represents the internal Flash memory on the PIX 500 series security appliance. You
can enter flash:/ or disk0:/ for the internal Flash memory on the ASA 5500 series adaptive security
appliance. The disk1:/ keyword represents the external Flash memory on the ASA.
For more details about upgrading the software on a failover pair, refer to the following topics:
• Upgrading an Active/Standby Failover Configuration, page 41-6
• Upgrading and Active/Active Failover Configuration, page 41-7
Step 1 Download the new software to both units, and specify the new image to load with the boot system
command (see the “Configuring the Application Image and ASDM Image to Boot” section on
page 41-5).
Step 2 Reload the standby unit to boot the new image by entering the following command on the active unit:
active# failover reload-standby
Step 3 When the standby unit has finished reloading, and is in the Standby Ready state, force the active unit to
fail over to the standby unit by entering the following command on the active unit.
Note Use the show failover command to verify that the standby unit is in the Standby Ready state.
Step 4 Reload the former active unit (now the new standby unit) by entering the following command:
newstandby# reload
Step 5 When the new standby unit has finished reloading, and is in the Standby Ready state, return the original
active unit to active status by entering the following command:
newstandby# failover active
Step 1 Download the new software to both units, and specify the new image to load with the boot system
command (see the “Configuring the Application Image and ASDM Image to Boot” section on
page 41-5).
Step 2 Make both failover groups active on the primary unit by entering the following command in the system
execution space of the primary unit:
primary# failover active
Step 3 Reload the secondary unit to boot the new image by entering the following command in the system
execution space of the primary unit:
primary# failover reload-standby
Step 4 When the secondary unit has finished reloading, and both failover groups are in the Standby Ready state
on that unit, make both failover groups active on the secondary unit using the following command in the
system execution space of the primary unit:
Note Use the show failover command to verify that both failover groups are in the Standby Ready
state on the secondary unit.
Step 5 Make sure both failover groups are in the Standby Ready state on the primary unit, and then reload the
primary unit using the following command:
primary# reload
Step 6 If the failover groups are configured with the preempt command, they will automatically become active
on their designated unit after the preempt delay has passed. If the failover groups are not configured with
the preempt command, you can return them to active status on their designated units using the failover
active group command.
Be sure the destination directory exists. If it does not exist, first create the directory using the mkdir
command.
Be sure the destination directory exists. If it does not exist, first create the directory using the mkdir
command.
• To copy the running configuration to a TFTP server connected to the context network, enter the
following command:
hostname/contexta# copy running-config tftp:/server[/path]/filename
Copy the output from this command, then paste the configuration in to a text file.
Step 1 To specify the URL of the AUS, use the following command:
hostname(config)# auto-update server url [source interface] [verify-certificate]
SSL is used when https is specified. The user and password arguments of the URL are used for Basic
Authentication when logging in to the server. If you use the write terminal, show configuration or
show tech-support commands to view the configuration, the user and password are replaced with
‘********’.
The default port is 80 for HTTP and 443 for HTTPS.
The source interface argument specifies which interface to use when sending requests to the AUS. If you
specify the same interface specified by the management-access command, the Auto Update requests
travel over the same IPSec VPN tunnel used for management access.
The verify-certificate keyword verifies the certificate returned by the AUS.
Step 2 (Optional) To identify the device ID to send when communicating with the AUS, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# auto-update device-id {hardware-serial | hostname | ipaddress [if-name]
| mac-address [if-name] | string text}
The poll-period argument specifies how often (in minutes) to check for an update. The default is 720
minutes (12 hours).
The retry-count argument specifies how many times to try reconnecting to the server if the first attempt
fails. The default is 0.
The retry-period argument specifies how long to wait (in minutes) between retries. The default is 5.
Step 4 (Optional) To schedule a specific time for the security appliance to poll the Auto Update server, use the
following command:
hostname(config)# auto-update poll-at days-of-the-week time [randomize minutes] [retry_count
[retry_period ]]
days-of-the-week is any single day or combination of days: Monday, Tuesday, Wednesday, Thursday,
Friday, Saturday and Sunday. Other possible values are daily (Monday through Sunday), weekdays
(Monday through Friday) and weekend (Saturday and Sunday).
time specifies the time in the format HH:MM at which to start the poll. For example, 8:00 is 8:00 AM
and 20:00 is 8:00 PM
randomize minutes specifies the period to randomize the poll time following the specified start time.
The range is from 1 to 1439 minutes.
retry_count specifies how many times to try reconnecting to the Auto Update Server if the first attempt
fails. The default is 0.
retry_period specifies how long to wait between connection attempts. The default is 5 minutes. The
range is from 1 and 35791 minutes.
Step 5 (Optional) If the Auto Update Server has not been contacted for a certain period of time, the following
command will cause it to cease passing traffic:
hostname(config)# auto-update timeout period
Where period specifies the timeout period in minutes between 1 and 35791. The default is to never time
out (0). To restore the default, enter the no form of this command.
Use this command to ensure that the security appliance has the most recent image and configuration.
This condition is reported with system log message 201008.
In the following example, a security appliance is configured to poll an AUS with IP address
209.165.200.224, at port number 1742, from the outside interface, with certificate verification.
It is also configured to use the hostname of the security appliance as the device ID. It is configured to
poll every Friday and Saturday night at a random time between 10:00 p.m. and 11:00 p.m. On a failed
polling attempt, it will try to reconnect to the AUS 10 times, and wait 3 minutes between attempts at
reconnecting.
hostname(config)# auto-update server
https://jcrichton:[email protected]:1742/management source outside
verify-certificate
hostname(config)# auto-update device-id hostname
hostname(config)# auto-update poll-at Friday Saturday 22:00 randomize 60 2 10
Step 1 In global configuration mode, enable client update by entering the command:
hostname(config)# client-update enable
hostname(config)#
Step 2 Configure the parameters for the client update that you want to apply for the security appliances using
the client-update command:
component {asdm | image} specifies the software component, either ASDM or the boot image of the
security appliance.
device-id dev_string specifies a unique string that the Auto Update client uses to identify itself. The
maximum length is 63 characters.
family family_name specifies the family name that the Auto Update client uses to identify itself. It can
be asa, pix, or a text string with a maximum length of 7 characters.
rev-nums rev-nums specifies the software or firmware images for this client. Enter up to 4, in any order,
separated by commas.
type type specifies the type of clients to notify of a client update. Because this command is also used to
update Windows clients, the list of clients includes several Windows operating systems. The security
appliances in the list include the following:
• pix-515: Cisco PIX 515 Firewall
• pix-515e: Cisco PIX 515E Firewall
• pix-525: Cisco PIX 525 Firewall
• pix-535: Cisco PIX 535 Firewall
• asa5505: Cisco 5505 Adaptive Security Appliance
• asa5510: Cisco 5510 Adaptive Security Appliance
• asa5520: Cisco 5520 Adaptive Security Appliance
• asa5540: Cisco Adaptive Security Appliance
url url-string specifies the URL for the software/firmware image. This URL must point to a file
appropriate for this client. For all Auto Update clients, you must use the protocol “http://” or “https://”
as the prefix for the URL.
Configure the parameters for the client update that you want to apply to all security appliances of a
particular type. That is, specify the type of security appliance and the URL or IP address from which to
get the updated image. In addition, you must specify a revision number. If the revision number of the
remote security appliance matches one of the specified revision numbers, there is no need to update—the
client ignores the update.
The following example configures a client update for Cisco 5520 Adaptive Security Appliances:
hostname(config)# client-update type asa5520 component asdm url
http://192.168.1.114/aus/asdm501.bin rev-nums 7.2(1)
This chapter describes how to monitor the security appliance, and includes the following sections:
• Using SNMP, page 42-1
• Configuring and Managing Logs, page 42-5
Using SNMP
This section describes how to use SNMP and includes the following topics:
• SNMP Overview, page 42-1
• Enabling SNMP, page 42-3
SNMP Overview
The security appliance provides support for network monitoring using SNMP V1 and V2c. The security
appliance supports traps and SNMP read access, but does not support SNMP write access.
You can configure the security appliance to send traps (event notifications) to a network management
station (NMS), or you can use the NMS to browse the MIBs on the security appliance. MIBs are a
collection of definitions, and the security appliance maintains a database of values for each definition.
Browsing a MIB entails issuing an SNMP get request from the NMS. Use CiscoWorks for Windows or
any other SNMP V1, MIB-II compliant browser to receive SNMP traps and browse a MIB.
Table 42-1 lists supported MIBs and traps for the security appliance and, in multiple mode, for each
context. You can download Cisco MIBs from the following website.
http://www.cisco.com/public/sw-center/netmgmt/cmtk/mibs.shtml
After you download the MIBs, compile them for your NMS.
Enabling SNMP
The SNMP agent that runs on the security appliance performs two functions:
• Replies to SNMP requests from NMSs.
• Sends traps (event notifications) to NMSs.
To enable the SNMP agent and identify an NMS that can connect to the security appliance, follow these
steps:
Step 1 Ensure that the SNMP server on the security appliance is enabled by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# snmp-server enable
Specify trap or poll if you want to limit the NMS to receiving traps only or browsing (polling) only. By
default, the NMS can use both functions.
SNMP traps are sent on UDP port 162 by default. You can change the port number using the udp-port
keyword.
Step 3 To specify the community string, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# snmp-server community key
The SNMP community string is a shared secret between the security appliance and the NMS. The key is
a case-sensitive value up to 32 characters in length. Spaces are not permitted.
Step 4 (Optional) To set the SNMP server location or contact information, enter the following command:
Step 5 To enable the security appliance to send traps to the NMS, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# snmp-server enable traps [all | syslog | snmp [trap] [...] |
entity [trap] [...] | ipsec [trap] [...] | remote-access [trap]]
Enter this command for each feature type to enable individual traps or sets of traps, or enter the all
keyword to enable all traps.
The default configuration has all snmp traps enabled (snmp-server enable traps snmp authentication
linkup linkdown coldstart). You can disable these traps using the no form of this command with the
snmp keyword. However, the clear configure snmp-server command restores the default enabling of
SNMP traps.
If you enter this command and do not specify a trap type, then the default is syslog. (The default snmp
traps continue to be enabled along with the syslog trap.)
Traps for snmp include:
• authentication
• linkup
• linkdown
• coldstart
Traps for entity include:
• config-change
• fru-insert
• fru-remove
Traps for ipsec include:
• start
• stop
Traps for remote-access include:
• session-threshold-exceeded
Step 6 To enable system messages to be sent as traps to the NMS, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# logging history level
You must also enable syslog traps using the preceding snmp-server enable traps command.
Step 7 To enable logging, so system messages are generated and can then be sent to an NMS, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# logging enable
The following example sets the security appliance to receive requests from host 192.168.3.2 on the inside
interface.
hostname(config)# snmp-server host 192.168.3.2
hostname(config)# snmp-server location building 42
hostname(config)# snmp-server contact Pat lee
hostname(config)# snmp-server community ohwhatakeyisthee
Logging Overview
The security appliance system logs provide you with information for monitoring and troubleshooting the
security appliance. Using the logging feature, you can do the following:
• Specify which system log messages should be logged.
• Disable or change the severity level of a system log message.
• Specify one or more locations where system log messages should be sent, including an internal
buffer, one or more syslog servers, ASDM, an SNMP management station, specified e-mail
addresses, or to Telnet and SSH sessions.
• Configure and manage system log messages in groups, such as by severity level or class of message.
• Specify what happens to the contents of the internal buffer when the buffer becomes full: overwrite
the buffer, send the buffer contents to an FTP server, or save the contents to internal Flash memory.
You can choose to send all system log messages, or subsets of system log messages, to any or all output
locations. You can filter which system log messages are sent to which locations by the severity of the
system log message, the class of the system log message, or by creating a custom log message list.
Note To start logging to a syslog server you define in this procedure, be sure to enable logging for all output
locations. See the “Enabling Logging to All Configured Output Destinations” section on page 42-6. To
disable logging, see the “Disabling Logging to All Configured Output Destinations” section on
page 42-6.
To configure the security appliance to send system log messages to a syslog server, perform the
following steps:
Step 1 To designate a syslog server to receive the logs, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# logging host interface_name ip_address [tcp[/port] | udp[/port]]
[format emblem]
Where the format emblem keyword enables EMBLEM format logging for the syslog server. (UDP
only).
The interface_name argument specifies the interface through which you access the syslog server.
The ip_address argument specifies the IP address of the syslog server.
The tcp[/port] or udp[/port] argument specifies that the security appliance should use TCP or UDP to
send system log messages to the syslog server. The default protocol is UDP. You can configure the
security appliance to send data to a syslog server using either UDP or TCP, but not both. If you specify
TCP, the security appliance discovers when the syslog server fails and discontinues sending logs. If you
specify UDP, the security appliance continues to send logs regardless of whether the syslog server is
operational. The port argument specifies the port that the syslog server listens to for system log
messages. Valid port values are 1025 through 65535, for either protocol. The default UDP port is 514.
The default TCP port is 1470.
For example:
hostname(config)# logging host dmz1 192.168.1.5
If you want to designate more than one syslog server as an output destination, enter a new command for
each syslog server.
Step 2 To specify which system log messages should be sent to the syslog server, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# logging trap {severity_level | message_list}
Where the severity_level argument specifies the severity levels of messages to be sent to the syslog
server. You can specify the severity level number (0 through 7) or name. For severity level names, see
the “Severity Levels” section on page 42-23. For example, if you set the level to 3, then the security
appliance sends system log messages for level 3, 2, 1, and 0.
The message_list argumentspecifies a customized message list that identifies the system log messages
to send to the syslog server. For information about creating custom message lists, see the “Filtering
System Log Messages with Custom Message Lists” section on page 42-17.
The following example specifies that the security appliance should send to the syslog server all system
log messages with a severity level of level 3 (errors) and higher. The security appliance will send
messages with the severity of 3, 2, and 1.
hostname(config)# logging trap errors
Step 3 (Optional) If needed, set the logging facility to a value other than its default of 20 by entering the
following command:
hostname(config)# logging facility number
Most UNIX systems expect the system log messages to arrive at facility 20.
Note To start logging to the console port as defined in this procedure, be sure to enable logging for all output
locations. See the “Enabling Logging to All Configured Output Destinations” section on page 42-6. To
disable logging, see the “Disabling Logging to All Configured Output Destinations” section on
page 42-6.
To specify which system log messages should be sent to the console port , enter the following command:
hostname(config)# logging console {severity_level | message_list}
Where the severity_level argument specifies the severity levels of messages to be sent to the console port.
You can specify the severity level number (0 through 7) or name. For severity level names, see the
“Severity Levels” section on page 42-23. For example, if you set the level to 3, then the security
appliance sends system log messages for level 3, 2, 1, and 0.
The message_list argumentspecifies a customized message list that identifies the system log messages
to send to the console port. For information about creating custom message lists, see the “Filtering
System Log Messages with Custom Message Lists” section on page 42-17.
The following example specifies that the security appliance should send to the syslog server all system
log messages with a severity level of level 3 (errors) and higher. The security appliance will send
messages with the severity of 3, 2, and 1.
hostname(config)# logging console errors
Note To start logging to an e-mail address you define in this procedure, be sure to enable logging for all output
locations. See the “Enabling Logging to All Configured Output Destinations” section on page 42-6. To
disable logging, see the “Disabling Logging to All Configured Output Destinations” section on
page 42-6.
Step 1 To specify the system log messages to be sent to one or more e-mail addresses, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# logging mail {severity_level | message_list}
Where the severity_level argument specifies the severity levels of messages to be sent to the e-mail
address. You can specify the severity level number (0 through 7) or name. For severity level names, see
the “Severity Levels” section on page 42-23. For example, if you set the level to 3, then the security
appliance sends system log messages for level 3, 2, 1, and 0.
The message_list argumentspecifies a customized message list that identifies the system log messages
to send to the e-mail address. For information about creating custom message lists, see the “Filtering
System Log Messages with Custom Message Lists” section on page 42-17.
The following example uses a message_list with the name “high-priority,” previously set up with the
logging list command:
hostname(config)# logging mail high-priority
Step 2 To specify the source e-mail address to be used when sending system log messages to an e-mail address,
enter the following command:
hostname(config)# logging from-address email_address
For example:
hostname(config)# logging from-address [email protected]
Step 3 Specify the recipient e-mail address to be used when sending system log messages to an e-mail
destination. You can configure up to five recipient addresses. You must enter each recipient separately.
To specify a recipient address, enter the following command:
If a severity level is not specified, the default severity level is used (error condition, severity level 3).
For example:
hostname(config)# logging recipient-address [email protected]
Step 4 To specify the SMTP server to be used when sending system log messages to an e-mail destination, enter
the following command:
hostname(config)# smtp-server ip_address
For example:
hostname(config)# smtp-server 10.1.1.1
Note To start logging to ASDM as defined in this procedure, be sure to enable logging for all output locations.
See the “Enabling Logging to All Configured Output Destinations” section on page 42-6. To disable
logging, see the “Disabling Logging to All Configured Output Destinations” section on page 42-6.
Step 1 To specify which system log messages should go to ASDM, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# logging asdm {severity_level | message_list}
Where the severity_level argument specifies the severity levels of messages to be sent to ASDM. You
can specify the severity level number (0 through 7) or name. For severity level names, see the “Severity
Levels” section on page 42-23. For example, if you set the level to 3, then the security appliance sends
system log messages for level 3, 2, 1, and 0.
The message_list argumentspecifies a customized message list that identifies the system log messages
to send to ASDM. For information about creating custom message lists, see the “Filtering System Log
Messages with Custom Message Lists” section on page 42-17.
The following example shows how enable logging and send to the ASDM log buffer system log messages
of severity levels 0, 1, and 2.
hostname(config)# logging asdm 2
Step 2 To specify the number of system log messages retained in the ASDM log buffer, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# logging asdm-buffer-size num_of_msgs
Where num_of_msgs specifies the number of system log messages that the security appliance retains in
the ASDM log buffer.
The following example shows how to set the ASDM log buffer size to 200 system log messages.
hostname(config)# logging asdm-buffer-size 200
To erase the current contents of the ASDM log buffer, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# clear logging asdm
Note To start logging to a Telnet or SSH session as defined in this procedure, be sure to enable logging for all
output locations. See the “Enabling Logging to All Configured Output Destinations” section on
page 42-6. To disable logging, see the “Disabling Logging to All Configured Output Destinations”
section on page 42-6.
To specify which messages should be sent to Telnet or SSH sessions, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# logging monitor {severity_level | message_list}
Where the severity_level argument specifies the severity levels of messages to be sent to the session. You
can specify the severity level number (0 through 7) or name. For severity level names, see the “Severity
Levels” section on page 42-23. For example, if you set the level to 3, then the security appliance sends
system log messages for level 3, 2, 1, and 0.
The message_list argumentspecifies a customized message list that identifies the system log messages
to send to the session. For information about creating custom message lists, see the “Filtering System
Log Messages with Custom Message Lists” section on page 42-17.
Step 1 After you log in to the security appliance, enable logging to the current session by entering the following
command:
hostname# terminal monitor
This command enables logging only for the current session. If you log out, and then log in again, you
need to reenter this command.
Step 2 To disable logging to the current session, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# terminal no monitor
Note To start logging to the buffer as defined in this procedure, be sure to enable logging for all output
locations. See the “Enabling Logging to All Configured Output Destinations” section on page 42-6. To
disable logging, see the “Disabling Logging to All Configured Output Destinations” section on
page 42-6.
To enable the log buffer as a log output destination, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# logging buffered {severity_level | message_list}
Where the severity_level argument specifies the severity levels of messages to be sent to the buffer. You
can specify the severity level number (0 through 7) or name. For severity level names, see the “Severity
Levels” section on page 42-23. For example, if you set the level to 3, then the security appliance sends
system log messages for level 3, 2, 1, and 0.
The message_list argumentspecifies a customized message list that identifies the system log messages
to send to the buffer. For information about creating custom message lists, see the “Filtering System Log
Messages with Custom Message Lists” section on page 42-17.
For example, to specify that messages with severity levels 1 and 2 should be saved in the log buffer, enter
one of the following commands:
or
hostname(config)# logging buffered level 2
For the message_list option, specify the name of a message list containing criteria for selecting messages
to be saved in the log buffer.
hostname(config)# logging buffered notif-list
By default, the log buffer size is 4 KB. To change the size of the log buffer, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# logging buffer-size bytes
Where the bytes argument sets the amount of memory used for the log buffer, in bytes. For example, if
you specify 8192, the security appliance uses 8 KB of memory for the log buffer.
The following example specifies that the security appliance uses 16 KB of memory for the log buffer:
hostname(config)# logging buffer-size 16384
Unless configured otherwise, the security appliance address messages to the log buffer on a continuing
basis, overwriting old messages when the buffer is full. If you want to keep a history of logs, you can
configure the security appliance to send the buffer contents to another output location each time the
buffer fills. Buffer contents can be saved either to internal Flash memory or to an FTP server.
When saving the buffer content to another location, the security appliance creates log files with names
that use a default time-stamp format, as follows:
LOG-YYYY-MM-DD-HHMMSS.TXT
where YYYY is the year, MM is the month, DD is the day of the month, and HHMMSS is the time in hours,
minutes, and seconds.
While the security appliance writes the log buffer contents to internal Flash memory or an FTP server,
it continues saving new messages to the log buffer.
To specify that messages in the log buffer should be saved to internal Flash memory each time the buffer
wraps, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# logging flash-bufferwrap
See the “Saving the Current Contents of the Log Buffer to Internal Flash Memory” section for more
information about saving the buffer.
To specify that messages in the log buffer should be saved to an FTP server each time the buffer wraps,
perform the following steps.
Step 1 To enable the security appliance to send the log buffer contents to an FTP server every time the buffer
wraps, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# logging ftp-bufferwrap
Where the server argument specifies the IP address of the external FTP server
The path argument specifies the directory path on the FTP server where the log buffer data is to be saved.
This path is relative to the FTP root directory.
The username argument specifies a username that is valid for logging into the FTP server.
The password argument specifies the password for the username specified.
For example:
hostname(config)# logging ftp-server 10.1.1.1 /syslogs logsupervisor 1luvMy10gs
Saving the Current Contents of the Log Buffer to Internal Flash Memory
At any time, you can save the contents of the buffer to internal Flash memory. To save the current
contents of the log buffer to internal Flash memory, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# logging savelog [savefile]
For example, the following example saves the contents of the log buffer to internal Flash memory using
the file name latest-logfile.txt:
hostname(config)# logging savelog latest-logfile.txt
To erase the contents of the log buffer, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# clear logging buffer
With logging classes, you can specify an output location for an entire category of system log messages
with a single command.
You can use system log message classes in two ways:
• Issue the logging class command to specify an output location for an entire category of system log
messages.
• Create a message list using the logging list command that specifies the message class. See the
“Filtering System Log Messages with Custom Message Lists” section on page 42-17 for this
method.
All system log messages in a particular class share the same initial 3 digits in their system log message
ID numbers. For example, all system log message IDs that begin with the digits 611 are associated with
the vpnc (VPN client) class. System log messages associated with the VPN client feature range from
611101 to 611323.
When you configure all messages in a class to go to a type of output destination, this configuration
overrides the configuration in the specific output destination command. For example, if you specify that
messages at level 7 should go to the log buffer, and you also specify that ha class messages at level 3
should go to the buffer, then the latter configuration takes precedence.
To configure the security appliance to send an entire system log message class to a configured output
destination, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# logging class message_class {buffered | console | history | mail |
monitor | trap} [severity_level]
Where the message_class argument specifies a class of system log messages to be sent to the specified
output destination. See Table 42-2 for a list of system log message classes.
The buffered, history, mail, monitor, and trap keywords specify the output destination to which system
log messages in this class should be sent. The history keyword enables SNMP logging. The monitor
keyword enables Telnet and SSH logging. The trap keyword enables syslog server logging. Select one
destination per command line entry. If you want to specify that a class should go to more than one
destination, enter a new command for each output destination.
The severity_level argument further restricts the system log messages to be sent to the output destination
by specifying a severity level. For more information about message severity levels, see the “Severity
Levels” section on page 42-23.
The following example specifies that all system log messages related to the class ha (high availability,
also known as failover) with a severity level of 1 (alerts) should be sent to the internal logging buffer.
hostname(config)# logging class ha buffered alerts
Table 42-2 lists the system log message classes and the ranges of system log message IDs associated with
each class.
Table 42-2 System Log Message Classes and Associated Message ID Numbers
Table 42-2 System Log Message Classes and Associated Message ID Numbers
Step 1 Create a message list containing criteria for selecting messages by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# logging list name {level level [class message_class] |
message start_id[-end_id]}
Where the name argument specifies the name of the list. Do not use the names of severity levels as the
name of a system log message list. Prohibited names include “emergencies,” “alert,” “critical,” “error,”
“warning,” “notification,” “informational,” and “debugging.” Similarly, do not use the first three
characters of these words at the beginning of a file name. For example, do not use a filename that starts
with the characters “err.”
The level level argument specifies the severity level. You can specify the severity level number (0
through 7) or name. For severity level names, see the “Severity Levels” section on page 42-23. For
example, if you set the level to 3, then the security appliance sends system log messages for level 3, 2,
1, and 0.
The class message_class argument specifies a particular message class. See Table 42-2 on page 42-16
for a list of class names.
The message start_id[-end_id] argument specifies an individual system log message ID number or a
range of numbers.
The following example creates a message list named notif-list that specifies messages with a severity
level of 3 or higher should be saved in the log buffer:
hostname(config)# logging list notif-list level 3
Step 2 (Optional) If you want to add more criteria for message selection to the list, enter the same command as
in the previous step specifying the name of the existing message list and the additional criterion. Enter
a new command for each criterion you want to add to the list.
The following example adds criteria to the message list: a range of message ID numbers, and the message
class ha (high availability or failover).
hostname(config)# logging list notif-list 104024-105999
hostname(config)# logging list notif-list level critical
hostname(config)# logging list notif-list level warning class ha
The preceding example states that system log messages that match the criteria specified will be sent to
the output destination. The specified criteria for system log messages to be included in the list are:
• System log message IDs that fall in the range of 104024 to 105999
• All system log messages with critical level or higher (emergency, alert, or critical)
• All ha class system log messages with warning level or higher (emergency, alert, critical, error, or
warning)
A system log message is logged if it satisfies any of these conditions. If a system log satisfies more than
one of the conditions, the message is logged only once.
Where the message_count variable specifies the number of system log messages that can remain in the
system log message queue while awaiting processing. The default is 512 system log messages. A setting
of 0 (zero) indicates unlimited system log messages, that is, the queue size is limited only by block
memory availability.
To view the queue and queue statistics, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# show logging queue
You can specify only one type of device ID for the system log messages.
The context-name keyword indicates that the name of the current context should be used as the device
ID (applies to multiple context mode only). If you enable the logging device ID for the admin context in
multiple context mode, messages that originate in the system execution space use a device ID of system,
and messages that originate in the admin context use the name of the admin context as the device ID.
The hostname keyword specifies that the hostname of the security appliance should be used as the
device ID.
The ipaddress interface_name argument specifies that the IP address of the interface specified as
interface_name should be used as the device ID. If you use the ipaddress keyword, the device ID
becomes the specified security appliance interface IP address, regardless of the interface from which the
system log message is sent. This keyword provides a single, consistent device ID for all system log
messages that are sent from the device.
The string text argument specifies that the text string should be used as the device ID. The string can
contain as many as 16 characters. You cannot use blank spaces or any of the following characters:
• & (ampersand)
• ' (single quote)
Note If enabled, the device ID does not appear in EMBLEM-formatted system log messages or SNMP traps.
The following example enables the logging device ID for the FWSM:
hostname(config)# logging device-id hostname
The following example enables the logging device ID for a security context on the FWSM:
hostname(config)# logging device-id context-name
• To use the EMBLEM format for system log messages sent to a syslog server over UDP, specify the
format emblem option when you configure the syslog server as a n output destination. See the
“Sending System Log Messages to a Syslog Server” section on page 42-7 for more information
about syslog servers. Enter the following command:
hostname(config)# logging host interface_name ip_address {tcp[/port] | udp[/port]]
[format emblem]
Where the interface_name and IP_address specifies the syslog server to receive the system log
messages, tcp[/port] and udp[/port] indicate the protocol and port that should be used, and
format emblem enables EMBLEM formatting for messages sent to the syslog server.
The Cisco ASA can send system log messages using either the UDP or TCP protocol; however, you
can enable the EMBLEM format only for messages sent over UDP. The default protocol and port
are UDP/514.
For example:
hostname(config)# logging host interface_1 122.243.006.123 udp format emblem
For example:
hostname(config)# no logging message 113019
For example:
hostname(config)# logging message 113019
• To see a list of disabled system log messages, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# show logging message
• To reenable logging of all disabled system log messages, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# clear config logging disabled
The following example modifies the severity level of system log message ID 113019 from 4
(warnings) to 5 (notifications):
hostname(config)# logging message 113019 level 5
• To reset the logging level of a system log message to its default level, enter the following command.
hostname(config)# no logging message message_ID level current_severity_level
The following example modifies the severity level of system log message ID 113019 to its default
value of 4 (warnings).
hostname(config)# no logging message 113019 level 5
• To see the severity level of a specific message, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# show logging message message_ID
• To see a list of system log messages with modified severity levels, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# show logging message
• To reset the severity level of all modified system log messages back to their defaults, enter the
following command:
hostname(config)# clear configure logging level
The series of commands in the following example illustrates the use of the logging message command
to control both whether a system log message is enabled and the severity level of the system log message.
hostname(config)# show logging message 403503
syslog 403503: default-level errors (enabled)
Step 1 To specify the maximum amount of internal Flash memory available for saving log files, enter the
following command:
hostname(config)# logging flash-maximum-allocation kbytes
Where kbytes specifies the maximum amount of internal Flash memory, in kilobytes, that can be used
for saving log files.
The following example sets the maximum amount of internal Flash memory that can be used for log files
to approximately 1.2 MB:
hostname(config)# logging flash-maximum-allocation 1200
Step 2 To specify the minimum amount of internal Flash memory that must be free for the security appliance
to save a log file, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# logging flash-minimum-free kbytes
Where kbytes specifies the minimum amount of internal Flash memory, in kilobytes, that must be
available before the security appliance saves a new log file.
The following example specifies that the minimum amount of free internal Flash memory must be 4000
KB before the security appliance can save a new log file:
hostname(config)# logging flash-minimum-free 4000
Severity Levels
Table 42-3 lists the system log message severity levels.
Level
Number Level Keyword Description
0 emergencies System unusable.
1 alert Immediate action needed.
2 critical Critical condition.
3 error Error condition.
4 warning Warning condition.
5 notification Normal but significant condition.
6 informational Informational message only.
7 debugging Appears during debugging only.
Note The security appliance does not generate system log messages with a severity level of 0 (emergencies).
This level is provided in the logging command for compatibility with the UNIX system log feature, but
is not used by the Cisco ASA .
This chapter describes how to troubleshoot the security appliance, and includes the following sections:
• Testing Your Configuration, page 43-1
• Reloading the Security Appliance, page 43-6
• Performing Password Recovery, page 43-6
• Other Troubleshooting Tools, page 43-10
• Common Problems, page 43-10
Step 1 To show ICMP packet information for pings to the security appliance interfaces, enter the following
command:
hostname(config)# debug icmp trace
Step 2 To set system messages to be sent to Telnet or SSH sessions, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# logging monitor debug
You can alternately use logging buffer debug to send messages to a buffer, and then view them later
using the show logging command.
Step 3 To send the system messages to your Telnet or SSH session, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# terminal monitor
The following example shows a successful ping from an external host (209.165.201.2) to the security
appliance outside interface (209.165.201.1):
hostname(config)# debug icmp trace
Inbound ICMP echo reply (len 32 id 1 seq 256) 209.165.201.1 > 209.165.201.2
Outbound ICMP echo request (len 32 id 1 seq 512) 209.165.201.2 > 209.165.201.1
Inbound ICMP echo reply (len 32 id 1 seq 512) 209.165.201.1 > 209.165.201.2
Outbound ICMP echo request (len 32 id 1 seq 768) 209.165.201.2 > 209.165.201.1
Inbound ICMP echo reply (len 32 id 1 seq 768) 209.165.201.1 > 209.165.201.2
Outbound ICMP echo request (len 32 id 1 seq 1024) 209.165.201.2 > 209.165.201.1
Inbound ICMP echo reply (len 32 id 1 seq 1024) 209.165.201.1 > 209.165.201.2
The preceding example shows the ICMP packet length (32 bytes), the ICMP packet identifier (1), and
the ICMP sequence number (the ICMP sequence number starts at 0 and is incremented each time a
request is sent).
Step 1 Create a sketch of your single mode security appliance or security context showing the interface names,
security levels, and IP addresses.
Note Although this procedure uses IP addresses, the ping command also supports DNS names and names
assigned to a local IP address with the name command.
The sketch should also include any directly connected routers, and a host on the other side of the router
from which you will ping the security appliance. You will use this information for this procedure as well
as the procedure in the “Pinging Through the Security Appliance” section on page 43-4. For example:
126692
10.1.2.90 10.1.0.34 10.1.4.67 10.1.1.5
Host Host Host Host
Step 2 Ping each security appliance interface from the directly connected routers. For transparent mode, ping
the management IP address.
This test ensures that the security appliance interfaces are active and that the interface configuration is
correct.
A ping might fail if the security appliance interface is not active, the interface configuration is incorrect,
or if a switch between the security appliance and router is down (see Figure 43-2). In this case, no debug
messages or system messages appear on the security appliance, because the packet never reaches it.
Ping
126695
Router Security
Appliance
If the ping reaches the security appliance, and the security appliance responds, you see debug messages
like the following:
ICMP echo reply (len 32 id 1 seq 256) 209.165.201.1 > 209.165.201.2
ICMP echo request (len 32 id 1 seq 512) 209.165.201.2 > 209.165.201.1
If the ping reply does not return to the router, then you might have a switch loop or redundant IP
addresses (see Figure 43-3).
Ping
192.168.1.2 192.168.1.1
Router Security
192.168.1.2 Appliance
126696
Host
Step 3 Ping each security appliance interface from a remote host. For transparent mode, ping the management
IP address.
This test checks that the directly connected router can route the packet between the host and the security
appliance, and that the security appliance can correctly route the packet back to the host.
A ping might fail if the security appliance does not have a route back to the host through the intermediate
router (see Figure 43-4). In this case, the debug messages show that the ping was successful, but you see
system message 110001 indicating a routing failure.
Figure 43-4 Ping Failure Because the Security Appliance has no Route
Ping ?
126693
Host Router Security
Appliance
Step 1 To add an access list allowing ICMP from any source host, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# access-list ICMPACL extended permit icmp any any
By default, when hosts access a lower security interface, all traffic is allowed through. However, to
access a higher security interface, you need the preceding access list.
Step 2 To assign the access list to each source interface, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# access-group ICMPACL in interface interface_name
Alternatively, you can also apply the ICMPACL access list to the destination interface to allow ICMP
traffic back through the security appliance.
Step 4 Ping from the host or router through the source interface to another host or router on another interface.
Repeat this step for as many interface pairs as you want to check.
If the ping succeeds, you see a system message confirming the address translation for routed mode
(305009 or 305011) and that an ICMP connection was established (302020). You can also enter the
show xlate and show conns commands to view this information.
If the ping fails for transparent mode, contact Cisco TAC.
For routed mode, the ping might fail because NAT is not configured correctly (see Figure 43-5). This is
more likely if you enable NAT control. In this case, you see a system message showing that the NAT
translation failed (305005 or 305006). If the ping is from an outside host to an inside host, and you do
not have a static translation (which is required with NAT control), you see message 106010: deny
inbound icmp.
Note The security appliance only shows ICMP debug messages for pings to the security appliance interfaces,
and not for pings through the security appliance to other hosts.
Figure 43-5 Ping Failure Because the Security Appliance is not Translating Addresses
Ping
126694
Host Router Security Router Host
Appliance
Step 3 To remove the ICMPACL access list, and also delete the related access-group commands, enter the
following command:
Step 4 (Optional) To disable the ICMP inspection engine, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# no service-policy ICMP-POLICY
Traceroute
You can trace the route of a packet using the traceroute feature, which is accessed with the traceroute
command. A traceroute works by sending UDP packets to a destination on an invalid port. Because the
port is not valid, the routers along the way to the destination will respond with an ICMP Time Exceeded
Message, and report that error back to the security appliance.
Packet Tracer
In addition to capturing packets and the traceroute feature, it is possible to trace the lifespan of a packet
through the security appliance to see if it is behaving as expected with the packet tracer tool. The packet
tracer tool lets you do the following:
• Debug all packet drops in production network.
• Verify the configuration is working as intended.
• Show all rules applicable to a packet along with the CLI lines which caused the rule addition.
• Show a time line of packet changes in a data path.
• Inject tracer packets into the data path.
The packet-tracer command provides detailed information about the packets and how they are
processed by the security appliance. In the instance that a command from the configuration did not cause
the packet to drop, the packet-tracer command will provide information about the cause in an easily
readable manner. For example if a packet was dropped because of an invalid header validation, a
message is displayed that says, “packet dropped due to bad ip header (reason).”
• Password Recovery for the PIX 500 Series Security Appliance, page 43-8
• Disabling Password Recovery, page 43-9
Performing Password Recovery for the ASA 5500 Series Adaptive Security
Appliance
To recover from the loss of passwords, perform the following steps:
Step 1 Connect to the security appliance console port according to the “Accessing the Command-Line
Interface” section on page 2-4.
Step 2 Power off the security appliance, and then power it on.
Step 3 During the startup messages, press the Escape key when prompted to enter ROMMON.
Step 4 To set the security appliance to ignore the startup configuration at reload, enter the following command:
rommon #1> confreg
The security appliance displays the current configuration register value, and asks if you want to change
the value:
Current Configuration Register: 0x00000011
Configuration Summary:
boot TFTP image, boot default image from Flash on netboot failure
Do you wish to change this configuration? y/n [n]:
Step 5 Record your current configuration register value, so you can restore it later.
Step 6 At the prompt, enter Y to change the value.
The security appliance prompts you for new values.
Step 7 Accept the default values for all settings, except for the “disable system configuration?” value; at that
prompt, enter Y.
Step 8 Reload the security appliance by entering the following command:
rommon #2> boot
The security appliance loads a default configuration instead of the startup configuration.
Step 9 Enter privileged EXEC mode by entering the following command:
hostname> enable
Step 13 Change the passwords in the configuration by entering the following commands, as necessary:
hostname(config)# password password
hostname(config)# enable password password
hostname(config)# username name password password
Step 14 Change the configuration register to load the startup configuration at the next reload by entering the
following command:
hostname(config)# config-register value
Where value is the configuration register value you noted in Step 5. 0x1 is the default configuration
register. For more information about the configuration register, see the Cisco Security Appliance
Command Reference.
Step 15 Save the new passwords to the startup configuration by entering the following command:
hostname(config)# copy running-config startup-config
Step 1 Download the PIX password tool from Cisco.com to a TFTP server accessible from the security
appliance. See the link in the “Password Recovery Procedure for the PIX” document at the following
URL:
http://www.cisco.com/en/US/products/hw/vpndevc/ps2030/products_password_recovery09186a0080
09478b.shtml
Step 2 Connect to the security appliance console port according to the “Accessing the Command-Line
Interface” section on page 2-4.
Step 3 Power off the security appliance, and then power it on.
Step 4 Immediately after the startup messages appear, press the Escape key to enter monitor mode.
Step 5 Configure the network settings for the interface that accesses the TFTP server by entering the following
commands:
monitor> interface interface_id
monitor> address interface_ip
monitor> server tftp_ip
monitor> file pw_tool_name
monitor> gateway gateway_ip
Step 6 Download the PIX password tool from the TFTP server by entering the following command:
monitor> tftp
If you have trouble reaching the server, you can enter the ping address command to test the connection.
Step 7 At the “Do you wish to erase the passwords?” prompt, enter Y.
You can now log in with the default login password of “cisco” and the blank enable password.
The following example shows the PIX password recovery with the TFTP server on the outside interface:
monitor> interface 0
0: i8255X @ PCI(bus:0 dev:13 irq:10)
1: i8255X @ PCI(bus:0 dev:14 irq:7 )
Cisco PIX password tool (4.0) #0: Tue Aug 22 23:22:19 PDT 2005
Flash=i28F640J5 @ 0x300
BIOS Flash=AT29C257 @ 0xd8000
Rebooting....
On the ASA 5500 series adaptive security appliance, the no service password-recovery command
prevents a user from entering ROMMON with the configuration intact. When a user enters ROMMON,
the security appliance prompts the user to erase all Flash file systems. The user cannot enter ROMMON
without first performing this erasure. If a user chooses not to erase the Flash file system, the security
appliance reloads. Because password recovery depends on using ROMMON and maintaining the
existing configuration, this erasure prevents you from recovering a password. However, disabling
password recovery prevents unauthorized users from viewing the configuration or inserting different
passwords. In this case, to recover the system to an operating state, load a new image and a backup
configuration file, if available. The service password-recovery command appears in the configuration
file for informational purposes only; when you enter the command at the CLI prompt, the setting is saved
in NVRAM. The only way to change the setting is to enter the command at the CLI prompt. Loading a
new configuration with a different version of the command does not change the setting. If you disable
password recovery when the security appliance is configured to ignore the startup configuration at
startup (in preparation for password recovery), then the security appliance changes the setting to boot
the startup configuration as usual. If you use failover, and the standby unit is configured to ignore the
startup configuration, then the same change is made to the configuration register when the no service
password recovery command replicates to the standby unit.
On the PIX 500 series security appliance, the no service password-recovery command forces the PIX
password tool to prompt the user to erase all Flash file systems. The user cannot use the PIX password
tool without first performing this erasure. If a user chooses not to erase the Flash file system, the security
appliance reloads. Because password recovery depends on maintaining the existing configuration, this
erasure prevents you from recovering a password. However, disabling password recovery prevents
unauthorized users from viewing the configuration or inserting different passwords. In this case, to
recover the system to an operating state, load a new image and a backup configuration file, if available.
Capturing Packets
Capturing packets is sometimes useful when troubleshooting connectivity problems or monitoring
suspicious activity. We recommend contacting Cisco TAC if you want to use the packet capture feature.
See the capture command in the Cisco Security Appliance Command Reference.
Common Problems
This section describes common problems with the security appliance, and how you might resolve them.
Symptom The context configuration was not saved, and was lost when you reloaded.
Possible Cause You did not save each context within the context execution space. If you are
configuring contexts at the command line, you did not save the context before you changed to the
next context.
Recommended Action Save each context within the context execution space using the copy run start
command. You cannot save contexts from the system execution space.
Symptom You cannot make a Telnet connection or SSH to the security appliance interface.
Possible Cause You did not enable Telnet or SSH to the security appliance.
Recommended Action Enable Telnet or SSH to the security appliance according to the “Allowing
Telnet Access” section on page 40-1 or the “Allowing SSH Access” section on page 40-2.
Recommended Action Enable ICMP to the security appliance for your IP address using the icmp
command.
Symptom You cannot ping through the security appliance, even though the access list allows it.
Possible Cause You did not enable the ICMP inspection engine or apply access lists on both the
ingress and egress interfaces.
Recommended Action Because ICMP is a connectionless protocol, the security appliance does not
automatically allow returning traffic through. In addition to an access list on the ingress interface,
you either need to apply an access list to egress interface to allow replying traffic, or enable the
ICMP inspection engine, which treats ICMP connections as stateful connections.
Symptom Traffic does not pass between two interfaces on the same security level.
Possible Cause You did not enable the feature that allows traffic to pass between interfaces on the
same security level.
Recommended Action Enable this feature according to the “Allowing Communication Between
Interfaces on the Same Security Level” section on page 7-6.
Reference
A P P E N D I X A
Feature Licenses and Specifications
This appendix describes the feature licenses and specifications. This appendix includes the following
sections:
• Supported Platforms and Feature Licenses, page A-1
• Security Services Module Support, page A-10
• VPN Specifications, page A-11
Note Items that are in italics are separate, optional licenses that you can replace the base license. You can mix
and match licenses, for example, the 10 security context license plus the Strong Encryption license; or
the 500 WebVPN license plus the GTP/GPRS license; or all four licenses together.
2. The concurrent firewall connections are based on a traffic mix of 80% TCP and 20% UDP, with 1 host and 1 dynamic translation for every 4 connections.
1. Although the maximum IPSec and WebVPN sessions add up to more than the maximum VPN sessions, the combined sessions should not exceed the VPN
session limit. If you exceed the maximum VPN sessions, you can overload the security appliance, so be sure to size your network appropriately.
2. The concurrent firewall connections are based on a traffic mix of 80% TCP and 20% UDP, with 1 host and 1 dynamic translation for every 4 connections.
Table A-4 ASA 5540 Adaptive Security Appliance License Features (continued)
Table A-5 ASA 5550 Adaptive Security Appliance License Features (continued)
1. The CSC SSM licenses support up to 1000 users while the Cisco ASA 5540 Series appliance can support significantly more
users. If you deploy CSC SSM with an ASA 5540 adaptive security appliance, be sure to configure the security appliance to
send the CSC SSM only the traffic that should be scanned. For more information, see the “Determining What Traffic to Scan”
section on page 22-9 for more information.
VPN Specifications
This section describes the VPN specifications for the security appliance. This section includes the
following topics:
• Cisco VPN Client Support, page A-11
• Cisco Secure Desktop Support, page A-11
• Site-to-Site VPN Compatibility, page A-12
• Cryptographic Standards, page A-12
Cryptographic Standards
The security appliance supports numerous cryptographic standards and related third-party products and
services, including those shown in Table A-12.
Type Description
Asymmetric (public key) encryption algorithms RSA public/private key pairs, 512 bits to 4096 bits
DSA public/private key pairs, 512 bits to 1024 bits
Symmetric encryption algorithms AES—128, 192, and 256 bits
DES—56 bits
3DES—168 bits
RC4—40, 56, 64, and 128 bits
Perfect forward secrecy (Diffie-Hellman key Group 1— 768 bits
negotiation)
Group 2—1024 bits
Group 5— 1536 bits
Group 7—163 bits (Elliptic Curve Diffie-Hellman)
Hash algorithms MD5—128 bits
SHA-1—160 bits
Type Description
X.509 certificate authorities Cisco IOS software
Baltimore UniCERT
Entrust Authority
iPlanet/Netscape CMS
Microsoft Certificate Services
RSA Keon
VeriSign OnSite
X.509 certificate enrollment methods SCEP
PKCS #7 and #10
This appendix illustrates and describes a number of common ways to implement the security appliance,
and includes the following topics:
• Example 1: Multiple Mode Firewall With Outside Access, page B-1
• Example 2: Single Mode Firewall Using Same Security Level, page B-6
• Example 3: Shared Resources for Multiple Contexts, page B-8
• Example 4: Multiple Mode, Transparent Firewall with Outside Access, page B-12
• Example 5: WebVPN Configuration, page B-16
• Example 6: IPv6 Configuration, page B-18
• Example 7: Cable-Based Active/Standby Failover (Routed Mode), page B-20
• Example 8: LAN-Based Active/Standby Failover (Routed Mode), page B-21
• Example 9: LAN-Based Active/Active Failover (Routed Mode), page B-22
• Example 10: Cable-Based Active/Standby Failover (Transparent Mode), page B-26
• Example 11: LAN-Based Active/Standby Failover (Transparent Mode), page B-28
• Example 12: LAN-Based Active/Active Failover (Transparent Mode), page B-30
• Example 14: Dual ISP Support Using Static Route Tracking, page B-33
• Example 14: ASA 5505 Base License, page B-34
• Example 15: ASA 5505 Security Plus License with Failover and Dual-ISP Backup, page B-36
Internet
209.165.201.1
Websense
inside inside inside inside 192.168.2.2
10.1.1.1 10.1.2.1 10.1.3.1 10.1.4.1
10.1.2.2
126978
customerA
Network 2
See the following sections for the configurations for this scenario:
• Example 1: System Configuration, page B-2
• Example 1: Admin Context Configuration, page B-4
• Example 1: Customer A Context Configuration, page B-4
• Example 1: Customer B Context Configuration, page B-4
• Example 1: Customer C Context Configuration, page B-5
no shutdown
interface gigabitethernet 0/1.6
nameif inside
security-level 100
ip address 10.1.3.1 255.255.255.0
no shutdown
passwd tenac10us
enable password defen$e
route outside 0 0 209.165.201.1 1
nat (inside) 1 10.1.3.0 255.255.255.0
! This context uses dynamic PAT for inside users that access the outside
global (outside) 1 209.165.201.9 netmask 255.255.255.255
access-list INTERNET remark Inside users only access HTTP and HTTPS servers on the outside
access-list INTERNET extended permit tcp any any eq http
access-list INTERNET extended permit tcp any any eq https
access-group INTERNET in interface inside
Management Host
209.165.200.225
Internet
209.165.201.1
outside
209.165.201.3
dept1 DMZ
10.1.1.1 192.168.2.1
Department 1
Syslog Server
dept2 192.168.2.2
10.1.2.1
Department 2
10.1.2.2
192.168.1.1
126979
Department 2
Network 2
passwd g00fba11
enable password gen1u$
hostname Buster
asdm image disk0:/asdm.bin
boot system disk0:/image.bin
interface gigabitethernet 0/0
nameif outside
security-level 0
! System messages are sent to the syslog server on the DMZ network
logging host dmz 192.168.2.2
logging enable
Internet
209.165.201.2
Shared
Network
126980
See the following sections for the configurations for this scenario:
• Example 3: System Configuration, page B-9
• Example 3: Admin Context Configuration, page B-9
security-level 100
ip address 10.1.0.1 255.255.255.0
no shutdown
interface gigabitethernet 0/0.300
nameif shared
security-level 50
ip address 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.0
no shutdown
passwd v00d00
enable password d011
route outside 0 0 209.165.201.2 1
nat (inside) 1 10.1.0.0 255.255.255.0
! This context uses PAT for inside users that access the outside
global (outside) 1 209.165.201.6 netmask 255.255.255.255
! This context uses PAT for inside users that access the shared network
global (shared) 1 10.1.1.30
! Because this host can access the web server in the Department 1 context, it requires a
! static translation
static (inside,outside) 209.165.201.7 10.1.0.15 netmask 255.255.255.255
! Because this host has management access to the servers on the Shared interface, it
! requires a static translation to be used in an access list
static (inside,shared) 10.1.1.78 10.1.0.15 netmask 255.255.255.255
access-list SHARED remark -Allows only mail traffic from inside to exit shared interface
access-list SHARED remark -but allows the admin host to access any server.
access-list SHARED extended permit ip host 10.1.1.78 any
access-list SHARED extended permit tcp host 10.1.1.30 host 10.1.1.7 eq smtp
! Note that the translated addresses are used.
access-group SHARED out interface shared
! Allows 10.1.0.15 to access the admin context using Telnet. From the admin context, you
! can access all other contexts.
telnet 10.1.0.15 255.255.255.255 inside
aaa-server AAA-SERVER protocol tacacs+
aaa-server AAA-SERVER (shared) host 10.1.1.6
key TheUauthKey
server-port 16
! The host at 10.1.0.15 must authenticate with the AAA server to log in
aaa authentication telnet console AAA-SERVER
aaa authorization command AAA-SERVER LOCAL
aaa accounting command AAA-SERVER
logging trap 6
! System messages are sent to the syslog server on the Shared network
logging host shared 10.1.1.8
logging enable
passwd cugel
enable password rhialto
nat (inside) 1 10.1.2.0 255.255.255.0
! The inside network uses PAT when accessing the outside
global (outside) 1 209.165.201.8 netmask 255.255.255.255
! The inside network uses dynamic NAT when accessing the shared network
global (shared) 1 10.1.1.31-10.1.1.37
! The web server can be accessed from outside and requires a static translation
static (inside,outside) 209.165.201.9 10.1.2.3 netmask 255.255.255.255
access-list WEBSERVER remark -Allows the management host (its translated address) on the
access-list WEBSERVER remark -admin context to access the web server for management
access-list WEBSERVER remark -it can use any IP protocol
access-list WEBSERVER extended permit ip host 209.165.201.7 host 209.165.201.9
access-list WEBSERVER remark -Allows any outside address to access the web server
access-list WEBSERVER extended permit tcp any eq http host 209.165.201.9 eq http
access-group WEBSERVER in interface outside
access-list MAIL remark -Allows only mail traffic from inside to exit out the shared int
! Note that the translated addresses are used.
access-list MAIL extended permit tcp host 10.1.1.31 eq smtp host 10.1.1.7 eq smtp
access-list MAIL extended permit tcp host 10.1.1.32 eq smtp host 10.1.1.7 eq smtp
access-list MAIL extended permit tcp host 10.1.1.33 eq smtp host 10.1.1.7 eq smtp
access-list MAIL extended permit tcp host 10.1.1.34 eq smtp host 10.1.1.7 eq smtp
access-list MAIL extended permit tcp host 10.1.1.35 eq smtp host 10.1.1.7 eq smtp
access-list MAIL extended permit tcp host 10.1.1.36 eq smtp host 10.1.1.7 eq smtp
access-list MAIL extended permit tcp host 10.1.1.37 eq smtp host 10.1.1.7 eq smtp
access-group MAIL out interface shared
aaa-server AAA-SERVER protocol tacacs+
aaa-server AAA-SERVER (shared) host 10.1.1.6
key TheUauthKey
server-port 16
! All traffic matching the WEBSERVER access list must authenticate with the AAA server
aaa authentication match WEBSERVER outside AAA-SERVER
logging trap 4
! System messages are sent to the syslog server on the Shared network
logging host shared 10.1.1.8
logging enable
Internet
10.1.n.2
126981
Network 2 Network 2 Network 2 Network 2
See the following sections for the configurations for this scenario:
• Example 4: System Configuration, page B-13
• Example 4: Admin Context Configuration, page B-14
• Example 4: Customer A Context Configuration, page B-15
• Example 4: Customer B Context Configuration, page B-15
• Example 4: Customer C Context Configuration, page B-16
no shutdown
interface gigabitethernet 0/0.150
vlan 150
no shutdown
interface gigabitethernet 0/0.151
vlan 151
no shutdown
interface gigabitethernet 0/0.152
vlan 152
no shutdown
interface gigabitethernet 0/0.153
vlan 153
no shutdown
interface gigabitethernet 0/1
shutdown
interface gigabitethernet 0/1.4
vlan 4
no shutdown
interface gigabitethernet 0/1.5
vlan 5
no shutdown
interface gigabitethernet 0/1.6
vlan 6
no shutdown
interface gigabitethernet 0/1.7
vlan 7
no shutdown
interface management 0/0
no shutdown
context admin
allocate-interface gigabitethernet 0/0.150
allocate-interface gigabitethernet 0/1.4
allocate-interface management 0/0
config-url disk0://admin.cfg
context customerA
description This is the context for customer A
allocate-interface gigabitethernet 0/0.151
allocate-interface gigabitethernet 0/1.5
config-url disk0://contexta.cfg
context customerB
description This is the context for customer B
allocate-interface gigabitethernet 0/0.152
allocate-interface gigabitethernet 0/1.6
config-url disk0://contextb.cfg
context customerC
description This is the context for customer C
allocate-interface gigabitethernet 0/0.153
allocate-interface gigabitethernet 0/1.7
config-url disk0://contextc.cfg
Step 2 You must enable WebVPN access lists to be enforced on a group-policy or user policy. The access lists
are defined with the filter value and functions commands in the group or user configuration.
access-list maia2 remark -deny access to url and send a syslog every 300 seconds
access-list maia2 remark -containing the hit-count (how many times the url was accessed)
access-list maia2 webtype deny url https://sales.example.com log informational interval
300
access-list maia2 remark -Permits access to the URL.
access-list maia2 webtype permit url http://employee-connection.example.com
Step 3 You can configure a list of pre-configured URLs presented on the WebVPN user’s home page after login,
which are defined per user or per group.
url-list HomeURL "Sales" https://sales.example.com
url-list HomeURL "VPN3000-1" http://vpn3k-1.example.com
url-list HomeURL "OWA-2000" http://10.160.105.2/exchange
url-list HomeURL "Exchange5.5" http://10.86.195.113/exchange
url-list HomeURL " Employee Benefits" http://benefits.example.com
url-list HomeURL "Calendar" http://http://eng.example.com/cal.html
Step 4 Configure a list of non-web TCP applications that will be port-forwarded over WebVPN and enforced
per user or per group-policy. These are defined globally but can be enforced per user or per group-policy.
port-forward Apps1 4001 10.148.1.81 telnet term-servr
port-forward Apps1 4008 router1-example.com ssh
port-forward Apps1 10143 flask.example.com imap4
port-forward Apps1 10110 flask.example.com pop3
port-forward Apps1 10025 flask.example.com smtp
port-forward Apps1 11533 sametime-im.example.com 1533
port-forward Apps1 10022 secure-term.example.com ssh
port-forward Apps1 21666 tuscan.example.com 1666 perforce-f1
port-forward Apps1 1030 sales.example.com https
Step 5 Configure the policy attributes enforced for users of the SSLVPNusers group-policy.
group-policy SSLVPNusers internal
group-policy SSLVPNusers attributes
banner value Welcome to Web Services !!!
vpn-idle-timeout 2
vpn-tunnel-protocol IPSec webvpn
webvpn
functions url-entry file-access file-entry file-browsing port-forward filter
url-list value HomeURL
port-forward value Apps1
Step 6 Next, configure the interface(s) where ASDM and WebVPN HTTPS sessions will terminate. Note that
simultaneous ASDM/WebVPN use on the same interface is not supported.
! Enables the HTTP server to allow ASDM and WebVPN HTTPS sessions.
http server enable
! Allows ASDM session(s) from host 10.20.30.47 on the inside interface ; WebVPN sessions
! are not allowed on this interface.
http 10.10.10.45 inside
! Allows WebVPN sessions on outside interfce using HTTP to be re-directed to HTTPS.
! ASDM session is not allowed on this interface.
http redirect outside 80
! Allows WebVPN sessions on dmz1 interfce using HTTP to be re-directed to HTTPS.
! ASDM session is not allowed on this interface.
http redirect dmz161 80
Step 7 Next, allow HTTPS ASDM and WebVPN sessions to terminate on the security appliance using the
3DES-sha1 cipher. Requires that a proper 3DES activation-key be previously installed.
ssl encryption 3des-sha1
IPv4
Network
10.142.10.1
IPv6
2001:400:3:1::1 2001:400:6:1::1 Network
10.142.10.100
2001:400:3:1::100
10.140.10.100
2001:400:1:1::100
153155
IPv4/IPv6
Network
Internet
209.165.201.4
Switch
Primary Unit
209.165.201.1 outside Secondary Unit
PAT: 209.165.201.3 209.165.201.2
Serial Failover Cable
192.168.2.1 192.168.2.2
inside
Switch
Web Server
126995
192.168.2.5
Static: 209.165.201.5
interface Ethernet3
description STATE Failover Interface
telnet 192.168.2.45 255.255.255.255 inside
access-list acl_in permit tcp any host 209.165.201.5 eq 80
access-group acl_in in interface outside
failover
failover link state Ethernet3
failover interface ip state 192.168.253.1 255.255.255.252 standby 192.168.253.2
global (outside) 1 209.165.201.3 netmask 255.255.255.224
nat (inside) 1 0.0.0.0 0.0.0.0
static (inside,outside) 209.165.201.5 192.168.2.5 netmask 255.255.255.255 0 0
route outside 0.0.0.0 0.0.0.0 209.165.201.4 1
Internet
209.165.201.4
Switch
Primary Unit
209.165.201.1 outside Secondary Unit
Switch
PAT: 209.165.201.3 209.165.201.2
192.168.254.1 failover 192.168.254.2
Web Server
126667
192.168.2.5
Static: 209.165.201.5
See the following sections for the configurations for this scenario:
• Example 8: Primary Unit Configuration, page B-21
• Example 8: Secondary Unit Configuration, page B-22
password mypassword
interface Ethernet0
nameif outside
ip address 209.165.201.1 255.255.255.224 standby 209.165.201.2
no shutdown
interface Ethernet1
nameif inside
ip address 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0 standby 192.168.2.2
no shutdown
interface Ethernet2
description LAN Failover Interface
no shutdown
interface ethernet3
description STATE Failover Interface
telnet 192.168.2.45 255.255.255.255 inside
access-list acl_out permit tcp any host 209.165.201.5 eq 80
failover
failover lan unit primary
failover lan interface failover Ethernet2
failover lan enable
! The failover lan enable command is required on the PIX security appliance only.
failover polltime unit msec 200 holdtime msec 800
failover key key1
failover link state Ethernet3
failover interface ip failover 192.168.254.1 255.255.255.0 standby 192.168.254.2
failover interface ip state 192.168.253.1 255.255.255.0 standby 192.168.253.2
global (outside) 1 209.165.201.3 netmask 255.255.255.224
nat (inside) 1 0.0.0.0 0.0.0.0
static (inside,outside) 209.165.201.5 192.168.2.5 netmask 255.255.255.255 0 0
access-group acl_out in interface outside
route outside 0.0.0.0 0.0.0.0 209.165.201.4 1
Internet
192.168.5.1 192.168.10.71
Switch Switch
126669
See the following sections for the configurations for this scenario:
• Example 9: Primary Unit Configuration
• Example 9: Secondary Unit Configuration
Internet
209.164.201.4
Switch
inside
Switch
Web Server
153888
209.164.201.5
The following are the typical commands in a cable-based, transparent firewall failover configuration.
enable password myenablepassword
passwd mypassword
hostname pixfirewall
asdm image flash:/asdm.bin
boot system flash:/image.bin
firewall transparent
interface Ethernet0
speed 100
duplex full
nameif outside
security-level 0
no shutdown
interface Ethernet1
speed 100
duplex full
nameif inside
security-level 100
no shutdown
interface Ethernet3
description STATE Failover Interface
telnet 192.168.2.45 255.255.255.255 mgmt
access-list acl_in permit tcp any host 209.165.201.5 eq 80
access-group acl_in in interface outside
Internet
209.164.201.4
Switch
Switch
Inside
Web Server
153889
209.164.201.5
See the following sections for the configurations for this scenario:
• Example 8: Primary Unit Configuration, page B-21
• Example 8: Secondary Unit Configuration, page B-22
Internet
192.168.5.1 192.168.10.1
Switch Switch
153890
192.168.5.81 192.168.10.81
See the following sections for the configurations for this scenario:
• Example 9: Primary Unit Configuration
• Example 9: Secondary Unit Configuration
hostname admin
interface Ethernet1
nameif outside
security-level 0
interface Ethernet2
nameif inside
security-level 100
ip address 192.168.5.31 255.255.255.0 standby 192.168.5.32
monitor-interface outside
monitor-interface inside
route outside 0.0.0.0 0.0.0.0 192.168.5.1 1
ssh 192.168.5.72 255.255.255.255 inside
10.2.1.2
Primary ISP 10.1.1.1 10.1.1.2
Inside
Network
172.16.2.2
Main Office
Network 54
.2.1 2
72 .16
172.20.1.2 .0.0 1
172.16.2.1 0.0
Backup ISP .0.0
0.0
153924
p
k upis
te bac
rou
passwd password1
enable password password2
hostname myfirewall
asdm image disk0:/asdm.bin
boot system disk0:/image.bin
!
interface gigabitethernet 0/0
nameif outside
security-level 0
ip address 10.1.1.2 255.255.255.0
no shutdown
!
interface gigabitethernet 0/1
description backup isp link
nameif backupisp
security-level 100
ip address 172.16.2.2 255.255.255.0
no shutdown
!
sla monitor 123
type echo protocol ipIcmpEcho 10.2.1.2 interface outside
num-packets 3
timeout 1000
frequency 3
sla monitor schedule 123 life forever start-time now
!
track 1 rtr 123 reachability
!
route outside 0.0.0.0 0.0.0.0 10.1.1.1 track 1
! The above route is used while the tracked object, router 10.2.1.2
! is available. It is removed when the router becomes unavailable.
!
route backupisp 0.0.0.0 0.0.0.0 172.16.2.1 254
Internet
VLAN 2
Outside
(IP via DHCP) VLAN 3 Video Game
Home
ASA 5505 192.168.2.1/24
with Base License Printer
VLAN 1
Inside
192.168.1.1/24 Host
153835
IP IP
Host Host IP Phone IP Phone
passwd g00fba11
enable password gen1u$
hostname Buster
asdm image disk0:/asdm.bin
boot system disk0:/image.bin
interface vlan 2
nameif outside
security-level 0
ip address dhcp setroute
no shutdown
interface vlan 1
nameif inside
security-level 100
ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0
no shutdown
interface vlan 3
! This interface cannot communicate with the inside interface. This is required using
! the Base license
no forward interface vlan 1
nameif home
security-level 50
ip address 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0
no shutdown
Example 15: ASA 5505 Security Plus License with Failover and
Dual-ISP Backup
This configuration creates five VLANs: inside, outside, dmz, backup-isp and faillink (see Figure B-13).
VLAN 4
Backup ISP
VLAN 2
Primary ISP
Web Server
192.168.2.2
VLAN 1
Inside
153836
See the following sections for the configurations for this scenario:
• Example 15: Primary Unit Configuration
• Example 15: Secondary Unit Configuration
hostname Buster
asdm image disk0:/asdm.bin
boot system disk0:/image.bin
interface vlan 2
description Primary ISP interface
nameif outside
security-level 0
ip address 209.165.200.224 standby 209.165.200.225
backup interface vlan 4
no shutdown
interface vlan 1
nameif inside
security-level 100
ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0
no shutdown
interface vlan 3
nameif dmz
security-level 50
ip address 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0
no shutdown
interface vlan 4
description Backup ISP interface
nameif backup-isp
security-level 0
ip address 209.168.202.128 standby 209.168.202.129
no shutdown
interface vlan 5
description LAN Failover Interface
interface ethernet 0/0
switchport access vlan 2
no shutdown
interface ethernet 0/1
switchport access vlan 4
no shutdown
interface ethernet 0/2
switchport access vlan 1
no shutdown
interface ethernet 0/3
switchport access vlan 3
no shutdown
interface ethernet 0/4
switchport access vlan 5
no shutdown
failover
failover lan unit primary
failover lan interface faillink vlan5
failover lan faillink vlan5
failover polltime unit 3 holdtime 10
failover key key1
failover interface ip faillink 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.0 standby 10.1.1.2
nat (inside) 1 0 0
nat (home) 1 0 0
global (outside) 1 interface
! The previous NAT statements match all addresses on inside and home, so you need to
! also perform NAT when hosts access the inside or home networks (as well as the outside).
! Or you can exempt hosts from NAT for inside <--> home traffic, as effected by the
! following:
access-list natexmpt-inside extended permit ip any 192.168.2.0 255.255.255.0
access-list natexmpt-home extended permit ip any 192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0
nat (inside) 0 access-list natexmpt-inside
nat (home) 0 access-list natexmpt-home
sla monitor 123
type echo protocol ipIcmpEcho 209.165.200.234 interface outside
num-packets 2
frequency 5
sla monitor schedule 123 life forever start-time now
track 1 rtr 123 reachability
route outside 0 0 209.165.200.234 1 track 1
! This route is for the primary ISP.
route backup-isp 0 0 209.165.202.154 2
! If the link goes down for the primary ISP, either due to a hardware failure
! or unplugged cable, then this route will be used.
http server enable
http 192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0 inside
dhcpd address 192.168.1.2-192.168.1.254 inside
dhcpd auto_config outside
dhcpd enable inside
logging asdm informational
ssh 192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0 inside
This appendix describes how to use the CLI on the security appliance, and includes the following
sections:
• Firewall Mode and Security Context Mode, page C-1
• Command Modes and Prompts, page C-2
• Syntax Formatting, page C-3
• Abbreviating Commands, page C-3
• Command-Line Editing, page C-3
• Command Completion, page C-4
• Command Help, page C-4
• Filtering show Command Output, page C-4
• Command Output Paging, page C-5
• Adding Comments, page C-6
• Text Configuration Files, page C-6
Note The CLI uses similar syntax and other conventions to the Cisco IOS CLI, but the security appliance
operating system is not a version of Cisco IOS software. Do not assume that a Cisco IOS CLI command
works with or has the same function on the security appliance.
Note The various types of prompts are all default prompts and when configured, they can be different.
• When you are in the system configuration or in single context mode, the prompt begins with the
hostname:
hostname
• When printing the prompt string, the prompt configuration is parsed and the configured keyword
values are printed in the order in which you have set the prompt command. The keyword arguments
can be any of the following and in any order: hostname, domain, context, priority, state.
asa(config)# prompt hostname context priority state
• When you are within a context, the prompt begins with the hostname followed by the context name:
hostname/context
hostname/context>
hostname/context#
hostname/context(config)#
From global configuration mode, some commands enter a command-specific configuration mode.
All user EXEC, privileged EXEC, global configuration, and command-specific configuration
commands are available in this mode. For example, the interface command enters interface
configuration mode. The prompt changes to the following:
hostname(config-if)#
hostname/context(config-if)#
Syntax Formatting
Command syntax descriptions use the following conventions:
Convention Description
bold Bold text indicates commands and keywords that you enter literally as shown.
italics Italic text indicates arguments for which you supply values.
[x] Square brackets enclose an optional element (keyword or argument).
| A vertical bar indicates a choice within an optional or required set of keywords or
arguments.
[x | y] Square brackets enclosing keywords or arguments separated by a vertical bar indicate
an optional choice.
{x | y} Braces enclosing keywords or arguments separated by a vertical bar indicate a required
choice.
[x {y | z}] Nested sets of square brackets or braces indicate optional or required choices within
optional or required elements. Braces and a vertical bar within square brackets indicate
a required choice within an optional element.
Abbreviating Commands
You can abbreviate most commands down to the fewest unique characters for a command; for example,
you can enter wr t to view the configuration instead of entering the full command write terminal, or
you can enter en to start privileged mode and conf t to start configuration mode. In addition, you can
enter 0 to represent 0.0.0.0.
Command-Line Editing
The security appliance uses the same command-line editing conventions as Cisco IOS software. You can
view all previously entered commands with the show history command or individually with the up arrow
or ^p command. Once you have examined a previously entered command, you can move forward in the
list with the down arrow or ^n command. When you reach a command you wish to reuse, you can edit
it or press the Enter key to start it. You can also delete the word to the left of the cursor with ^w, or erase
the line with ^u.
The security appliance permits up to 512 characters in a command; additional characters are ignored.
Command Completion
To complete a command or keyword after entering a partial string, press the Tab key. The security
appliance only completes the command or keyword if the partial string matches only one command or
keyword. For example, if you enter s and press the Tab key, the security appliance does not complete the
command because it matches more than one command. However, if you enter dis, the Tab key completes
the command disable.
Command Help
Help information is available from the command line by entering the following commands:
• help command_name
Shows help for the specific command.
• command_name ?
Shows a list of arguments available.
• string? (no space)
Lists the possible commands that start with the string.
• ? and +?
Lists all commands available. If you enter ?, the security appliance shows only commands available
for the current mode. To show all commands available, including those for lower modes, enter +?.
Note If you want to include a question mark (?) in a command string, you must press Ctrl-V before typing the
question mark so you do not inadvertently invoke CLI help.
In this command string, the first vertical bar (|) is the operator and must be included in the command.
This operator directs the output of the show command to the filter. In the syntax diagram, the other
vertical bars (|) indicate alternative options and are not part of the command.
The include option includes all output lines that match the regular expression. The grep option without
-v has the same effect. The exclude option excludes all output lines that match the regular expression.
The grep option with -v has the same effect. The begin option shows all the output lines starting with
the line that matches the regular expression.
Replace regexp with any Cisco IOS regular expression. See The regular expression is not enclosed in quotes
or double-quotes, so be careful with trailing white spaces, which will be taken as part of the regular
expression.
When creating regular expressions, you can use any letter or number that you want to match. In addition,
certain keyboard characters have special meaning when used in regular expressions. Table C-2 lists the
keyboard characters that have special meaning.
To use these special characters as single-character patterns, remove the special meaning by preceding
each character with a backslash (\).
The More prompt uses syntax similar to the UNIX more command:
• To view another screen, press the Space bar.
• To view the next line, press the Enter key.
• To return to the command line, press the q key.
Adding Comments
You can precede a line with a colon ( : ) to create a comment. However, the comment only appears in the
command history buffer and not in the configuration. Therefore, you can view the comment with the
show history command or by pressing an arrow key to retrieve a previous command, but because the
comment is not in the configuration, the write terminal command does not display it.
In the text configuration file you are not prompted to enter commands, so the prompt is omitted:
context a
Line Order
For the most part, commands can be in any order in the file. However, some lines, such as ACEs, are
processed in the order they appear, and the order can affect the function of the access list. Other
commands might also have order requirements. For example, you must enter the nameif command for
an interface first because many subsequent commands use the name of the interface. Also, commands in
a command-specific configuration mode must directly follow the main command.
Passwords
The login, enable, and user passwords are automatically encrypted before they are stored in the
configuration. For example, the encrypted form of the password “cisco” might look like
jMorNbK0514fadBh. You can copy the configuration passwords to another security appliance in their
encrypted form, but you cannot unencrypt the passwords yourself.
If you enter an unencrypted password in a text file, the security appliance does not automatically encrypt
them when you copy the configuration to the security appliance. The security appliance only encrypts
them when you save the running configuration from the command line using the copy running-config
startup-config or write memory command.
This appendix provides a quick reference for IP addresses, protocols, and applications. This appendix
includes the following sections:
• IPv4 Addresses and Subnet Masks, page D-1
• IPv6 Addresses, page D-5
• Protocols and Applications, page D-11
• TCP and UDP Ports, page D-11
• Local Ports and Protocols, page D-14
• ICMP Types, page D-15
Classes
IP host addresses are divided into three different address classes: Class A, Class B, and Class C. Each
class fixes the boundary between the network prefix and the host number at a different point within the
32-bit address. Class D addresses are reserved for multicast IP.
• Class A addresses (1.xxx.xxx.xxx through 126.xxx.xxx.xxx) use only the first octet as the network
prefix.
• Class B addresses (128.0.xxx.xxx through 191.255.xxx.xxx) use the first two octets as the network
prefix.
• Class C addresses (192.0.0.xxx through 223.255.255.xxx) use the first three octets as the network
prefix.
Because Class A addresses have 16,777,214 host addresses, and Class B addresses 65,534 hosts, you can
use subnet masking to break these huge networks into smaller subnets.
Private Networks
If you need large numbers of addresses on your network, and they do not need to be routed on the
Internet, you can use private IP addresses that the Internet Assigned Numbers Authority (IANA)
recommends (see RFC 1918). The following address ranges are designated as private networks that
should not be advertised:
• 10.0.0.0 through 10.255.255.255
• 172.16.0.0 through 172.31.255.255
• 192.168.0.0 through 192.168.255.255
Subnet Masks
A subnet mask lets you convert a single Class A, B, or C network into multiple networks. With a subnet
mask, you can create an extended network prefix that adds bits from the host number to the network
prefix. For example, a Class C network prefix always consists of the first three octets of the IP address.
But a Class C extended network prefix uses part of the fourth octet as well.
Subnet masking is easy to understand if you use binary notation instead of dotted decimal. The bits in
the subnet mask have a one-to-one correspondence with the Internet address:
• The bits are set to 1 if the corresponding bit in the IP address is part of the extended network prefix.
• The bits are set to 0 if the bit is part of the host number.
Example 1: If you have the Class B address 129.10.0.0 and you want to use the entire third octet as part
of the extended network prefix instead of the host number, you must specify a subnet mask of
11111111.11111111.11111111.00000000. This subnet mask converts the Class B address into the
equivalent of a Class C address, where the host number consists of the last octet only.
Example 2: If you want to use only part of the third octet for the extended network prefix, then you must
specify a subnet mask like 11111111.11111111.11111000.00000000, which uses only 5 bits of the third
octet for the extended network prefix.
You can write a subnet mask as a dotted-decimal mask or as a /bits (“slash bits”) mask. In Example 1,
for a dotted-decimal mask, you convert each binary octet into a decimal number: 255.255.255.0. For a
/bits mask, you add the number of 1s: /24. In Example 2, the decimal number is 255.255.248.0 and the
/bits is /21.
You can also supernet multiple Class C networks into a larger network by using part of the third octet
for the extended network prefix. For example, 192.168.0.0/20.
This section includes the following topics:
• Determining the Subnet Mask, page D-3
• Determining the Address to Use with the Subnet Mask, page D-3
For a network between 2 and 254 hosts, the fourth octet falls on a multiple of the number of host
addresses, starting with 0. For example, the 8-host subnets (/29) of 192.168.0.x are as follows:
To determine the network address to use with the subnet mask for a network with between 254 and
65,534 hosts, you need to determine the value of the third octet for each possible extended network
prefix. For example, you might want to subnet an address like 10.1.x.0, where the first two octets are
fixed because they are used in the extended network prefix, and the fourth octet is 0 because all bits are
used for the host number.
To determine the value of the third octet, follow these steps:
Step 1 Calculate how many subnets you can make from the network by dividing 65,536 (the total number of
addresses using the third and fourth octet) by the number of host addresses you want.
For example, 65,536 divided by 4096 hosts equals 16.
Therefore, there are 16 subnets of 4096 addresses each in a Class B-size network.
Step 2 Determine the multiple of the third octet value by dividing 256 (the number of values for the third octet)
by the number of subnets:
In this example, 256/16 = 16.
The third octet falls on a multiple of 16, starting with 0.
Therefore, the 16 subnets of the network 10.1 are as follows:
IPv6 Addresses
IPv6 is the next generation of the Internet Protocol after IPv4. It provides an expanded address space, a
simplified header format, improved support for extensions and options, flow labeling capability, and
authentication and privacy capabilities. IPv6 is described in RFC 2460. The IPv6 addressing architecture
is described in RFC 3513.
This section describes the IPv6 address format and architecture and includes the following topics:
• IPv6 Address Format, page D-5
• IPv6 Address Types, page D-6
• IPv6 Address Prefixes, page D-10
Note This section describes the IPv6 address format, the types, and prefixes. For information about
configuring the security appliance to use IPv6, see Chapter 7, “Configuring Interface Parameters.”
It is not necessary to include the leading zeros in an individual field of the address. But each field must
contain at least one digit. So the example address 2001:0DB8:0000:0000:0008:0800:200C:417A can be
shortened to 2001:0DB8:0:0:8:800:200C:417A by removing the leading zeros from the third through
sixth fields from the left. The fields that contained all zeros (the third and fourth fields from the left)
were shortened to a single zero. The fifth field from the left had the three leading zeros removed, leaving
a single 8 in that field, and the sixth field from the left had the one leading zero removed, leaving 800 in
that field.
It is common for IPv6 addresses to contain several consecutive hexadecimal fields of zeros. You can use
two colons (::) to compress consecutive fields of zeros at the beginning, middle, or end of an IPv6
address (the colons represent the successive hexadecimal fields of zeros). Table D-2 shows several
examples of address compression for different types of IPv6 address.
Note Two colons (::) can be used only once in an IPv6 address to represent successive fields of zeros.
An alternative form of the IPv6 format is often used when dealing with an environment that contains
both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. This alternative has the format x:x:x:x:x:x:y.y.y.y, where x represent the
hexadecimal values for the six high-order parts of the IPv6 address and y represent decimal values for
the 32-bit IPv4 part of the address (which takes the place of the remaining two 16-bit parts of the IPv6
address). For example, the IPv4 address 192.168.1.1 could be represented as the IPv6 address
0:0:0:0:0:0:FFFF:192.168.1.1, or ::FFFF:192.168.1.1.
Note There are no broadcast addresses in IPv6. Multicast addresses provide the broadcast functionality.
Unicast Addresses
This section describes IPv6 unicast addresses. Unicast addresses identify an interface on a network node.
This section includes the following topics:
• Global Address, page D-7
• Site-Local Address, page D-7
• Link-Local Address, page D-7
• IPv4-Compatible IPv6 Addresses, page D-7
• Unspecified Address, page D-8
• Loopback Address, page D-8
• Interface Identifiers, page D-8
Global Address
The general format of an IPv6 global unicast address is a global routing prefix followed by a subnet ID
followed by an interface ID. The global routing prefix can be any prefix not reserved by another IPv6
address type (see IPv6 Address Prefixes, page D-10, for information about the IPv6 address type
prefixes).
All global unicast addresses, other than those that start with binary 000, have a 64-bit interface ID in the
Modified EUI-64 format. See Interface Identifiers, page D-8, for more information about the Modified
EUI-64 format for interface identifiers.
Global unicast address that start with the binary 000 do not have any constraints on the size or structure
of the interface ID portion of the address. One example of this type of address is an IPv6 address with
an embedded IPv4 address (see IPv4-Compatible IPv6 Addresses, page D-7).
Site-Local Address
Site-local addresses are used for addressing within a site. They can be use to address an entire site
without using a globally unique prefix. Site-local addresses have the prefix FEC0::/10, followed by a
54-bit subnet ID, and end with a 64-bit interface ID in the modified EUI-64 format.
Site-local Routers do not forward any packets that have a site-local address for a source or destination
outside of the site. Therefore, site-local addresses can be considered private addresses.
Link-Local Address
All interfaces are required to have at least one link-local address. You can configure multiple IPv6
addresses per interfaces, but only one link-local address.
A link-local address is an IPv6 unicast address that can be automatically configured on any interface
using the link-local prefix FE80::/10 and the interface identifier in modified EUI-64 format. Link-local
addresses are used in the neighbor discovery protocol and the stateless autoconfiguration process. Nodes
with a link-local address can communicate; they do not need a site-local or globally unique address to
communicate.
Routers do not forward any packets that have a link-local address for a source or destination. Therefore,
link-local addresses can be considered private addresses.
There are two types of IPv6 addresses that can contain IPv4 addresses.
The first type is the “IPv4-compatibly IPv6 address.” The IPv6 transition mechanisms include a
technique for hosts and routers to dynamically tunnel IPv6 packets over IPv4 routing infrastructure. IPv6
nodes that use this technique are assigned special IPv6 unicast addresses that carry a global IPv4 address
in the low-order 32 bits. This type of address is termed an “IPv4-compatible IPv6 address” and has the
format ::y.y.y.y, where y.y.y.y is an IPv4 unicast address.
Note The IPv4 address used in the “IPv4-compatible IPv6 address” must be a globally-unique IPv4 unicast
address.
The second type of IPv6 address which holds an embedded IPv4 address is called the “IPv4-mapped
IPv6 address.” This address type is used to represent the addresses of IPv4 nodes as IPv6 addresses. This
type of address has the format ::FFFF:y.y.y.y, where y.y.y.y is an IPv4 unicast address.
Unspecified Address
The unspecified address, 0:0:0:0:0:0:0:0, indicates the absence of an IPv6 address. For example, a newly
initialized node on an IPv6 network may use the unspecified address as the source address in its packets
until it receives its IPv6 address.
Note The IPv6 unspecified address cannot be assigned to an interface. The unspecified IPv6 addresses must
not be used as destination addresses in IPv6 packets or the IPv6 routing header.
Loopback Address
The loopback address, 0:0:0:0:0:0:0:1, may be used by a node to send an IPv6 packet to itself. The
loopback address in IPv6 functions the same as the loopback address in IPv4 (127.0.0.1).
Note The IPv6 loopback address cannot be assigned to a physical interface. A packet that has the IPv6
loopback address as its source or destination address must remain within the node that created the packet.
IPv6 routers do not forward packets that have the IPv6 loopback address as their source or destination
address.
Interface Identifiers
Interface identifiers in IPv6 unicast addresses are used to identify the interfaces on a link. They need to
be unique within a subnet prefix. In many cases, the interface identifier is derived from the interface
link-layer address. The same interface identifier may be used on multiple interfaces of a single node, as
long as those interfaces are attached to different subnets.
For all unicast addresses, except those that start with the binary 000, the interface identifier is required
to be 64 bits long and to be constructed in the Modified EUI-64 format. The Modified EUI-64 format is
created from the 48-bit MAC address by inverting the universal/local bit in the address and by inserting
the hexadecimal number FFFE between the upper three bytes and lower three bytes of the of the MAC
address.
For example, and interface with the MAC address of 00E0.b601.3B7A would have a 64-bit interface ID
of 02E0:B6FF:FE01:3B7A.
Multicast Address
An IPv6 multicast address is an identifier for a group of interfaces, typically on different nodes. A packet
sent to a multicast address is delivered to all interfaces identified by the multicast address. An interface
may belong to any number of multicast groups.
An IPv6 multicast address has a prefix of FF00::/8 (1111 1111). The octet following the prefix defines
the type and scope of the multicast address. A permanently assigned (“well known”) multicast address
has a flag parameter equal to 0; a temporary (“transient”) multicast address has a flag parameter equal
to 1. A multicast address that has the scope of a node, link, site, or organization, or a global scope has a
scope parameter of 1, 2, 5, 8, or E, respectively. For example, a multicast address with the prefix
FF02::/16 is a permanent multicast address with a link scope. Figure D-1 shows the format of the IPv6
multicast address.
128 bits
0 Interface ID
4 bits 4 bits
1111 1111
0 if permanent
F F Flag Scope Flag =
1 if temporary
1 = node
8 bits 8 bits 2 = link
Scope = 4 = admin
5 = site
92617
8 = organization
E = global
IPv6 nodes (hosts and routers) are required to join the following multicast groups:
• The All Nodes multicast addresses:
– FF01:: (interface-local)
– FF02:: (link-local)
• The Solicited-Node Address for each IPv6 unicast and anycast address on the node:
FF02:0:0:0:0:1:FFXX:XXXX/104, where XX:XXXX is the low-order 24-bits of the unicast or
anycast address.
Note There are no broadcast addresses in IPv6. IPv6 multicast addresses are used instead of broadcast
addresses.
Anycast Address
The IPv6 anycast address is a unicast address that is assigned to more than one interface (typically
belonging to different nodes). A packet that is routed to an anycast address is routed to the nearest
interface having that address, the nearness being determined by the routing protocol in effect.
Anycast addresses are allocated from the unicast address space. An anycast address is simply a unicast
address that has been assigned to more than one interface, and the interfaces must be configured to
recognize the address as an anycast address.
The following restrictions apply to anycast addresses:
• An anycast address cannot be used as the source address for an IPv6 packet.
• An anycast address cannot be assigned to an IPv6 host; it can only be assigned to an IPv6 router.
Required Addresses
IPv6 hosts must, at a minimum, be configured with the following addresses (either automatically or
manually):
• A link-local address for each interface.
• The loopback address.
• The All-Nodes multicast addresses
• A Solicited-Node multicast address for each unicast or anycast address.
IPv6 routers must, at a minimum, be configured with the following addresses (either automatically or
manually):
• The required host addresses.
• The Subnet-Router anycast addresses for all interfaces for which it is configured to act as a router.
• The All-Routers multicast addresses.
• The security appliance listens for RADIUS on ports 1645 and 1646. If your RADIUS server uses
the standard ports 1812 and 1813, you can configure the security appliance to listen to those ports
using the authentication-port and accounting-port commands.
• To assign a port for DNS access, use the domain literal value, not dns. If you use dns, the security
appliance assumes you meant to use the dnsix literal value.
Port numbers can be viewed online at the IANA website:
http://www.iana.org/assignments/port-numbers
Table D-6 Protocols and Ports Opened by Features and Services (continued)
ICMP Types
Table D-7 lists the ICMP type numbers and names that you can enter in security appliance commands:
This appendix describes how to configure an external LDAP or RADIUS server to support the
authentication and authorization of security appliance, VPN3000, and PIX users. Authentication
determines who the user is and authorization determines what the user can do. Before you configure the
security appliance to use an external server, you must configure the server with the correct security
appliance authorization attributes and, from a subset of these attributes, assign specific permissions to
individual users.
This appendix includes the following sections:
• Selecting LDAP, RADIUS, or Local Authentication and Authorization
• Understanding Policy Enforcement of Permissions and Attributes
• Configuring an External LDAP Server
• Configuring an External RADIUS Server
Supported on PIX, VPN 3000, and the security appliance. The RADIUS server retrieves/searches
the username and enforces any defined attributes.
• Local Authentication
Supported on PIX, VPN 3000, and the security appliance. The Local/Internal server
retrieves/searches the username and enforces any defined attributes as part of the authorization
function.
• Local Authorization
Supported on PIX 7.1.x and the security appliance only. The Local/Internal server retrieves/searches
the username and enforces any defined attributes.
This section describes the structure, schema, and attributes of an LDAP server. It includes the following
topics:
• Reviewing the LDAP Directory Structure and Configuration Procedure
• Organizing the Security Appliance LDAP Schema
• Defining the Security Appliance LDAP Schema
148997
cn=terry cn=robin cn=bobbie cn=lynn Users
Search Naming
# LDAP Base DN Scope Attribute Result
1 group= Engineering,ou=People,dc=ExampleCorporation, One Level cn=Terry Quicker search
dc=com
2 dc=ExampleCorporation,dc=com Subtree cn=Terry Longer search
Note • All LDAP attributes for all three appliances begin with the letters cVPN3000; for example:
cVPN3000-Access-Hours.
• The appliances enforce the LDAP attributes based on attribute name, not numeric ID. RADIUS
attributes, on the other hand, are enforced by numeric ID, not by name.
• Authorization refers to the process of enforcing permissions or attributes. An LDAP server defined
as an authentication or authorization server will enforce permissions or attributes if they are
configured.
For a complete list of attributes for the security appliance, the PIX Firewall and the VPN 3000, see
Table E-2.
All strings are case-sensitive and you must use an attribute name as capitalized in the table even if it
conflicts with how a term is typically written. For example, use cVPN3000-IETF-Radius-Class, not
cVPN3000-IETF-RADIUS-Class.
Single
or
Attribute Name/ VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
OID (Object Identifier) 3000 ASA PIX OID1 Type Valued Possible Values
cVPN3000-Access-Hours Y Y Y 1 String Single Name of the time-range (i.e.,
Business-Hours)
cVPN3000-Simultaneous-Logins Y Y Y 2 Integer Single 0-2147483647
cVPN3000-Primary-DNS Y Y Y 3 String Single An IP address
cVPN3000-Secondary-DNS Y Y Y 4 String Single An IP address
cVPN3000-Primary-WINS Y Y Y 5 String Single An IP address
cVPN3000-Secondary-WINS Y Y Y 6 String Single An IP address
cVPN3000-SEP-Card-Assignment 7 Integer Single Not used
cVPN3000-Tunneling-Protocols Y Y Y 8 Integer Single 1 = PPTP
2 = L2TP
4 = IPSec
8 = L2TP/IPSec
16 = WebVPN.
8 and 4 are mutually exclusive
(0 - 11, 16 - 27 are legal
values)
cVPN3000-IPSec-Sec-Association Y 9 String Single Name of the security
association
cVPN3000-IPSec-Authentication Y 10 Integer Single 0 = None
1 = RADIUS
2 = LDAP (authorization only)
3 = NT Domain
4 = SDI
5 = Internal
6 = RADIUS with Expiry
7 = Kerberos/Active Directory
cVPN3000-IPSec-Banner1 Y Y Y 11 String Single Banner string
cVPN3000-IPSec-Allow-Passwd-Store Y Y Y 12 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-Use-Client-Address Y 13 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Table E-2 Security Appliance Supported LDAP Cisco Schema Attributes (continued)
Single
or
Attribute Name/ VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
OID (Object Identifier) 3000 ASA PIX OID1 Type Valued Possible Values
cVPN3000-PPTP-Encryption Y 14 Integer Single Bitmap:
1 = Encryption required
2 = 40 bits
4 = 128 bits
8 = Stateless-Required
Example: 15 =
40/128-Encr/Stateless-Req
cVPN3000-L2TP-Encryption Y 15 Integer Single Bitmap:
1 = Encryption required
2 = 40 bit
4 = 128 bits
8 = Stateless-Req
15 =
40/128-Encr/Stateless-Req
cVPN3000-IPSec-Split-Tunnel-List Y Y Y 16 String Single Specifies the name of the
network or access list that
describes the split tunnel
inclusion list.
cVPN3000-IPSec-Default-Domain Y Y Y 17 String Single Specifies the single default
domain name to send to the
client (1-255 characters).
cVPN3000-IPSec-Split-DNS-Name Y Y Y 18 String Single Specifies the list of secondary
domain names to send to the
client (1-255 characters).
cVPN3000-IPSec-Tunnel-Type Y Y Y 19 Integer Single 1 = LAN-to-LAN
2 = Remote access
cVPN3000-IPSec-Mode-Config Y Y Y 20 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-IPSec-User-Group-Lock Y 21 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-IPSec-Over-UDP Y Y Y 22 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-IPSec-Over-UDP-Port Y Y Y 23 Integer Single 4001 - 49151, default = 10000
cVPN3000-IPSec-Banner2 Y Y Y 24 String Single Banner string
cVPN3000-PPTP-MPPC-Compression Y 25 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Table E-2 Security Appliance Supported LDAP Cisco Schema Attributes (continued)
Single
or
Attribute Name/ VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
OID (Object Identifier) 3000 ASA PIX OID1 Type Valued Possible Values
cVPN3000-L2TP-MPPC-Compression Y 26 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-IPSec-IP-Compression Y Y Y 27 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-IPSec-IKE-Peer-ID-Check Y Y Y 28 Integer Single 1 = Required
2 = If supported by peer
certificate
3 = Do not check
cVPN3000-IKE-Keep-Alives Y Y Y 29 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-IPSec-Auth-On-Rekey Y Y Y 30 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-Required-Client- Y Y Y 31 Integer Single 1 = Cisco Systems (with Cisco
Firewall-Vendor-Code Integrated Client)
2 = Zone Labs
3 = NetworkICE
4 = Sygate
5 = Cisco Systems (with Cisco
Intrusion Prevention Security
Agent)
Table E-2 Security Appliance Supported LDAP Cisco Schema Attributes (continued)
Single
or
Attribute Name/ VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
OID (Object Identifier) 3000 ASA PIX OID1 Type Valued Possible Values
cVPN3000-Required-Client-Firewall- Y Y Y 32 Integer Single Cisco Systems Products:
Product-Code 1 = Cisco Intrusion
Prevention Security Agent
or Cisco Integrated Client
(CIC)
Zone Labs Products:
1 = Zone Alarm
2 = Zone AlarmPro
3 = Zone Labs Integrity
NetworkICE Product:
1 = BlackIce
Defender/Agent
Sygate Products:
1 = Personal Firewall
2 = Personal Firewall Pro
3 = Security Agent
cVPN3000-Required-Client-Firewall- Y Y Y 33 String Single String
Description
cVPN3000-Require-Individual-User-Auth Y Y Y 34 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-Require-HW-Client-Auth Y Y Y 35 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-Authenticated-User-Idle- Y Y Y 36 Integer Single 1 - 35791394 minutes
Timeout
cVPN3000-Cisco-IP-Phone-Bypass Y Y Y 37 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-IPSec-Split-Tunneling-Policy Y Y Y 38 Integer Single 0 = Tunnel everything
1 = Split tunneling
2 = Local LAN permitted
cVPN3000-IPSec-Required-Client-Firewall- Y Y Y 39 Integer Single 0 = None
Capability
1 = Policy defined by remote
FW Are-You-There (AYT)
2 = Policy pushed CPP
4 = Policy from server
Table E-2 Security Appliance Supported LDAP Cisco Schema Attributes (continued)
Single
or
Attribute Name/ VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
OID (Object Identifier) 3000 ASA PIX OID1 Type Valued Possible Values
cVPN3000-IPSec-Client-Firewall-Filter- Y 40 String Single Specifies the name of the filter
Name to be pushed to the client as
firewall policy.
cVPN3000-IPSec-Client-Firewall-Filter- Y Y Y 41 Integer Single 0 = Required
Optional
1 = Optional
cVPN3000-IPSec-Backup-Servers Y Y Y 42 String Single 1 = Use Client-Configured list
2 = Disabled and clear client
list
3 = Use Backup Server list
cVPN3000-IPSec-Backup-Server-List Y Y Y 43 String Single Server Addresses (space
delimited)
cVPN3000-Client-Intercept-DHCP- Y Y Y 44 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
Configure-Msg 1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-MS-Client-Subnet-Mask Y Y Y 45 String Single An IP address
cVPN3000-Allow-Network-Extension- Y Y Y 46 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
Mode
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-Strip-Realm Y Y Y 47 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-Cisco-AV-Pair Y Y Y 48 String Multi An octet string in the following
format:
[Prefix] [Action] [Protocol]
[Source] [Source Wildcard
Mask] [Destination]
[Destination Wildcard Mask]
[Established] [Log] [Operator]
[Port]
For more information, see
“Cisco -AV-Pair Attribute
Syntax.”
cVPN3000-User-Auth-Server-Name Y 49 String Single IP address or hostname
cVPN3000-User-Auth-Server-Port Y 50 Integer Single Port number for server protocol
cVPN3000-User-Auth-Server-Secret Y 51 String Single Server password
cVPN3000-Confidence-Interval Y Y Y 52 Integer Single 10 - 300 seconds
cVPN3000-Cisco-LEAP-Bypass Y Y Y 53 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-DHCP-Network-Scope Y Y Y 54 String Single IP address
Table E-2 Security Appliance Supported LDAP Cisco Schema Attributes (continued)
Single
or
Attribute Name/ VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
OID (Object Identifier) 3000 ASA PIX OID1 Type Valued Possible Values
cVPN3000-Client-Type-Version-Limiting Y Y Y 55 String Single IPsec VPN client version
number string
cVPN3000-WebVPN-Content-Filter- Y Y 56 Integer Single 1 = Java & ActiveX
Parameters
2 = Java scripts
4 = Images
8 = Cookies in images
Add the values to filter multiple
parameters. For example: enter
10 to filter both Java scripts and
cookies. (10 = 2 + 8)
cVPN3000-WebVPN-Enable-functions 57 Integer Single Not used - deprecated
cVPN3000-WebVPN-Exchange-Server- 58 String Single Not used - deprecated
Address
cVPN3000-WebVPN-Exchange-Server- 59 String Single Not used - deprecated
NETBIOS-Name
cVPN3000-Port-Forwarding-Name Y Y 60 String Single Name string (for example,
"Corporate-Apps")
cVPN3000-IETF-Radius-Framed-IP- Y Y Y 61 String Single An IP address
Address
cVPN3000-IETF-Radius-Framed-IP- Y Y Y 62 String Single An IP address
Netmask
cVPN3000-IETF-Radius-Session-Timeout Y Y Y 63 Integer Single 1-35791394 minutes
0 = Unlimited
cVPN3000-IETF-Radius-Idle-Timeout Y Y Y 64 Integer Single 1-35791394 minutes
0 = Unlimited
cVPN3000-IETF-Radius-Class Y Y Y 65 String Single Group name string. Use any of
the these three formats:
OU=Engineering
OU=Engineering;
Engineering
cVPN3000-IETF-Radius-Filter-Id Y Y Y 66 String Single An access-list
cVPN3000-Authorization-Required Y 67 Integer Single 0 = No
1 = Yes
cVPN3000-Authorization-Type Y 68 Integer Single 0 = None
1 = RADIUS
2 = LDAP
Table E-2 Security Appliance Supported LDAP Cisco Schema Attributes (continued)
Single
or
Attribute Name/ VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
OID (Object Identifier) 3000 ASA PIX OID1 Type Valued Possible Values
cVPN3000-DN-Field Y Y Y 69 String Single Possible values: UID, OU, O,
CN, L, SP, C, EA, T, N, GN,
SN, I, GENQ, DNQ, SER,
use-entire-name.
cVPN3000-WebVPN-URL-List Y 70 String Single URL-list name
cVPN3000-WebVPN-Forwarded-Ports Y 71 String Single Port-Forward list name
cVPN3000-WebVPN-ACL-Filters Y 72 String Single Access-List name
cVPN3000-WebVPN-Homepage Y Y 73 String Single A url such as
http://example-portal.com.
cVPN3000-WebVPN-Single-Sign-On- Y 74 String Single Name of the SSO Server (1 - 31
Server-Name chars)
cVPN3000-WebVPN-URL-Entry-Enable Y Y 75 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-WebVPN-File-Access-Enable Y Y 76 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-WebVPN-File-Server-Entry- Y Y 77 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
Enable
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-WebVPN-File-Server-Browsing- Y Y 78 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
Enable
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-WebVPN-Port-Forwarding- Y Y 79 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
Enable
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-WebVPN-Port-Forwarding- Y Y 80 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
Exchange-Proxy-Enable 1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-WebVPN-Port-Forwarding- Y Y 81 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
HTTP-Proxy-Enable 1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-WebVPN-Port-Forwarding- Y Y 82 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
Auto-Download-Enable
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-WebVPN-Citrix-Support-Enable Y Y 83 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-WebVPN-Apply-ACL-Enable Y Y 84 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-WebVPN-SVC-Enable Y Y 85 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-WebVPN-SVC-Required-Enable Y Y 86 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Table E-2 Security Appliance Supported LDAP Cisco Schema Attributes (continued)
Single
or
Attribute Name/ VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
OID (Object Identifier) 3000 ASA PIX OID1 Type Valued Possible Values
cVPN3000-WebVPN-SVC-Keep-Enable Y Y 87 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
cVPN3000-IE-Proxy-Server Y 88 String Single IP address
cVPN3000-IE-Proxy-Method Y 89 Integer Single 1 = No Modify
2 = No Proxy
3 = Auto Detect
4 = Other
cVPN3000-IE-Proxy-Exception-List Y 90 String Single newline (\n)-separated list of
DNS domains
cVPN3000-IE-Proxy-Bypass-Local Y 91 Integer Single 0 = None
1 = Local
cVPN3000-Tunnel-Group-Lock Y Y 92 String Single Name of the tunnel group or
“none”
cVPN3000-Firewall-ACL-In Y Y 93 String Single Access list ID
cVPN3000-Firewall-ACL-Out Y Y 94 String Single Access list ID
cVPN3000-PFS-Required Y Y Y 95 Boolean Single 0 = No
1 = Yes
cVPN3000-WebVPN-SVC-Keepalive Y Y 96 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
n = Keepalive value in seconds
(15 - 600)
cVPN3000-WebVPN-SVC-Client-DPD Y Y 97 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
n = Dead Peer Detection value
in seconds (30 - 3600)
cVPN3000-WebVPN-SVC-Gateway-DPD Y Y 98 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
n = Dead Peer Detection value
in seconds (30 - 3600)
cVPN3000-WebVPN-SVC-Rekey-Period Y Y 99 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
n = Retry period in minutes (4 -
10080)
cVPN3000-WebVPN-SVC-Rekey-Method Y Y 100 Integer Single 0 = None
1 = SSL
2 = New tunnel
3 = Any (sets to SSL)
cVPN3000-WebVPN-SVC-Compression Y Y 101 Integer Single 0 = None
1 = Deflate Compression
1. To get the complete Object Identifier of each attribute, append the number in the column to the end of 1.2.840.113556.8000.795.2. Thus, the OID of the
first attribute in the table, cVPN3000-Access-Hours, is 1.2.840.113556.8000.795.2.1. Likewise, the OID of the last attribute in the table,
cVPN3000-WebVPN-SVC-Compression, is 1.2.840.113556.8000.795.2.115.
Field Description
Prefix A unique identifier for the AV pair. For example: ip:inacl#1= (used for
standard ACLs) or webvpn:inacl# (used for WebVPN ACLs). This field
only appears when the filter has been sent as an AV pair.
Source Wildcard Mask The wildcard mask applied to the source address.
Log Generates a FILTER log message. You must use this keyword to generate
events of severity level 9.
Operator Logic operators: greater than, less than, equal to, not equal to.
For example:
ip:inacl#1=deny ip 10.155.10.0 0.0.0.255 10.159.2.0 0.0.0.255 log
ip:inacl#2=permit TCP any host 10.160.0.1 eq 80 log
Note • Use Cisco-AV pair entries with the ip:inacl# prefix to enforce ACLs for remote IPsec and SSL VPN
Client (SVC) tunnels.
• Use Cisco-AV pair entries with the webvpn:inacl# prefix to enforce ACLs for WebVPN clientless
(browser-mode) tunnels.
Schema 3k_schema.ldif
dn:
CN=cVPN3000-Access-Hours,CN=Schema,CN=Configuration,OU=People,DC=ExampleCorporation,DC=com
changetype: add
adminDisplayName: cVPN3000-Access-Hours
attributeID: 1.2.840.113556.1.8000.795.2.1
attributeSyntax: 2.5.5.3
cn: cVPN3000-Access-Hours
instanceType: 4
isSingleValued: TRUE
lDAPDisplayName: cVPN3000-Access-Hours
distinguishedName:
CN=cVPN3000-Access-Hours,CN=Schema,CN=Configuration,OU=People,DC=ExampleCorporation,DC=com
objectCategory:
CN=Attribute-Schema,CN=Schema,CN=Configuration,OU=People,DC=ExampleCorporation,DC=com
objectClass: attributeSchema
oMSyntax: 27
name: cVPN3000-Access-Hours
showInAdvancedViewOnly: TRUE
.....
.... (define subsequent security appliance authorization attributes here)
....
dn:
CN=cVPN3000-Primary-DNS,CN=Schema,CN=Configuration,OU=People,DC=ExampleCorporation,DC=com
changetype: add
adminDisplayName: cVPN3000-Primary-DNS
attributeID: 1.2.840.113556.1.8000.795.2.3
attributeSyntax: 2.5.5.3
cn: cVPN3000-Primary-DNS
instanceType: 4
isSingleValued: TRUE
lDAPDisplayName: cVPN3000-Primary-DNS
distinguishedName:
CN=cVPN3000-Primary-DNS,CN=Schema,CN=Configuration,OU=People,DC=ExampleCorporation,DC=com
objectCategory:
CN=Attribute-Schema,CN=Schema,CN=Configuration,OU=People,DC=ExampleCorporation,DC=com
objectClass: attributeSchema
oMSyntax: 27
name: cVPN3000-Primary-DNS
showInAdvancedViewOnly: TRUE
.....
.... (define subsequent security appliance authorization attributes here)
....
dn:
CN=cVPN3000-Confidence-Interval,CN=Schema,CN=Configuration,OU=People,DC=ExampleCorporation
,DC=com
changetype: add
adminDisplayName: cVPN3000-Confidence-Interval
attributeID: 1.2.840.113556.1.8000.795.2.52
attributeSyntax: 2.5.5.9
cn: cVPN3000-Confidence-Interval
instanceType: 4
isSingleValued: TRUE
lDAPDisplayName: cVPN3000-Confidence-Interval
distinguishedName:
CN=cVPN3000-Confidence-Interval,CN=Schema,CN=Configuration,OU=People,DC=ExampleCorporation
,DC=com
objectCategory:
DN:
changetype: modify
add: schemaUpdateNow
schemaUpdateNow: 1
-
dn:
CN=cVPN3000-User-Authorization,CN=Schema,CN=Configuration,OU=People,DC=ExampleCorporation,
DC=com
changetype: add
adminDisplayName: cVPN3000-User-Authorization
adminDescription: Cisco Class Schema
cn: cVPN3000-User-Authorization
defaultObjectCategory:
CN=cVPN3000-User-Authorization,CN=Schema,CN=Configuration,OU=People,DC=ExampleCorporation,
DC=com
defaultSecurityDescriptor:
D:(A;;RPWPCRCCDCLCLOLORCWOWDSDDTDTSW;;;DA)(A;;RPWPCRCCDCLCLORCWOWDSDDTSW;;;SY)
(A;;RPLCLORC;;;AU)
governsID: 1.2.840.113556.1.8000.795.1.1
instanceType: 4
lDAPDisplayName: cVPN3000-User-Authorization
mustContain: cn
mayContain: cVPN3000-Access-Hours
mayContain: cVPN3000-Simultaneous-Logins
mayContain: cVPN3000-Primary-DNS
...
mayContain: cVPN3000-Confidence-Interval
mayContain: cVPN3000-Cisco-LEAP-Bypass
distinguishedName:
CN=cVPN3000-User-Authorization,CN=Schema,CN=Configuration,OU=People,DC=ExampleCorporation,
DC=com
objectCategory:
CN=Class-Schema,CN=Schema,CN=Configuration,OU=People,DC=ExampleCorporation,DC=com
objectClass: classSchema
objectClassCategory: 1
possSuperiors: organizationalUnit
name: cVPN3000-User-Authorization
rDNAttID: cn
showInAdvancedViewOnly: TRUE
subClassOf: top
systemOnly: FALSE
DN:
changetype: modify
add: schemaUpdateNow
schemaUpdateNow: 1
-
systemOnly: FALSE
DN:
changetype: modify
add: schemaUpdateNow
schemaUpdateNow: 1
-
Note The directions in this section are specific to the Microsoft Active Directory LDAP server. If you have a
different type of server, refer to your server documentation for information on loading a schema.
To load the schema on the LDAP server, enter the following command from the directory where the
schema file resides: ldifde -i -f Schema Name. For example: ldifde -i -f 3k_schema.ldif
Note The directions in this section are specific to the Microsoft Active Directory LDAP server. If you have a
different type of server, see your server documentation to define and load user attributes.
For each user authorizing to your LDAP server, define a user file. A user file defines all the security
appliance attributes and values associated with a particular user. Each user is an object of the class
cVPN3000-User-Authorization. To define the user file, use any text editor. The file must have the
extension .ldif. (For an example user file, see Robin.ldif.)
To load the user file on the LDAP server, enter the following command on the directory where your
version of the ldap_user.ldif file resides: ldifde -i -f ldap_user.ldif. For example: ldifde -i
-f Robin.ldif
After you have created and loaded both the schema and the user file, your LDAP server is ready to
process security appliance authorization requests.
Robin.ldif
dn: cn=Robin,OU=People,DC=ExampleCorporation,DC=com
changetype: add
cn: Robin
CVPN3000-Access-Hours: Corporate_time
cVPN3000-Simultaneous-Logins: 2
cVPN3000-IPSec-Over-UDP: TRUE
CVPN3000-IPSec-Over-UDP-Port: 12125
cVPN3000-IPSec-Banner1: Welcome to the Example Corporation!!!
cVPN3000-IPSec-Banner2: Unauthorized access is prohibited!!!!!
cVPN3000-Primary-DNS: 10.10.4.5
CVPN3000-Secondary-DNS: 10.11.12.7
CVPN3000-Primary-WINS: 10.20.1.44
CVPN3000-SEP-Card-Assignment: 1
CVPN3000-IPSec-Tunnel-Type: 2
CVPN3000-Tunneling-Protocols: 7
cVPN3000-Confidence-Interval: 300
cVPN3000-IPSec-Allow-Passwd-Store: TRUE
objectClass: cVPN3000-User-Authorization
Step 1 Using LDIF files, create the cVPN3000-User-Authorization record on the Microsoft AD database. This
record contains the Cisco VPN authorization attributes for the user.
Note Contact Cisco TAC to obtain the Microsoft AD LDAP schema for Cisco VPN attributes.
Step 2 To confirm the new record, choose Start > Settings > Control Panel > Administrative Tools > Active
Directory Users and Computers.
The Active Directory Users and Computers window appears as shown in Figure E-2.
Step 3 On the security appliance, create a aaa-server record for the LDAP server. For this example, these
authorization records are stored in the Franklin-Altiga folder. The necessary steps are shown in the
following commands:
hostname(config)# aaa-server ldap-authorize-grp protocol ldap
hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# aaa-server ldap-authorize-grp host 10.1.1.4
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-base-dn ou=Franklin-Altiga,dc=frdevtestad, dc=local
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-scope subtree
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-naming-attribute cn
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-login-password anypassword
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-login-dn cn=Administrator,cn=Users,
dc=frdevtestad,dc=local
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-attribute-map LdapSvrName
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)#
Step 4 Create a tunnel group that specifies SDI Authentication and LDAP authorization, as shown in the
following example commands:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group ipsec-tunnelgroup type ipsec-ra
hostname(config)# tunnel-group ipsec-tunnelgroup general-attributes
hostname(config)# authentication-server-group sdi-group
hostname(config)# authorization-server-group ldap-authorize-group
hostname(config)#
Note This example does not show the configuration for sdi-group.
Figure E-3 Active Directory Users and Computers Window Showing User Folder
Review specific user attributes and values by right-clicking the username and clicking Properties. The
Username Properties dialog box appears as shown in Figure E-4.
Note The department attribute is configured under the Organization tab in the Active Directory Users and
Computers window.
To configure this example, perform the following steps on the security appliance:
Step 1 Create a aaa-server record for the LDAP authentication server and use the ldap-base-dn to specify the
search location for the Active Directory user records as shown in the following example commands:
hostname(config)# aaa-server ldap-authenticate-grp protocol ldap
hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# aaa-server ldap-authenticate-grp host 10.1.1.4
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-base-dn cn=Users,dc=frdevtestad,dc=local
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-scope subtree
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-naming-attribute cn
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-login-password anypassword
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-login-dn cn=Administrator,cn=Users,
dc=frdevtestad,dc=local
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)#
Step 2 Create an LDAP mapping table entry to map the AD attribute department to the Cisco attribute
cVPN3000-IETF-Radius-Class as shown in the following example commands:
hostname(config)# ldap attribute-map ActiveDirectoryMapTable
Step 3 Configure the name of the LDAP attribute map as shown in the following example command:
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-attribute-map ActiveDirectoryMapTable
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)#
Step 5 Create an external group policy that associates the group-name with the RADIUS server. In this example,
the user is assigned to the group Engineering as shown in the following example command:
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# group-policy Engineering external server-group
radius-group password anypassword
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)#
Step 6 Create a tunnel group that specifies LDAP authentication as shown in the following example commands:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group ipsec-tunnelgroup type ipsec-ra
hostname(config)# tunnel-group ipsec-tunnelgroup general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authentication-server-group ldap-authenticate-grp
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
Example 3: LDAP Authentication and LDAP Authorization with Microsoft Active Directory
This example presents the procedure for configuring both authentication and authorization using LDAP
and Microsoft Active Directory. In the Microsoft user record, the department attribute is interpreted as
the group-name for the user. The authorization attributes for this group-name are retrieved from the
Active Directory server.
The department attribute is configured under the Organization tab in the Active Directory Users and
Computers dialog box as shown in Figure E-5.
Figure E-5 The Organization Tab of the Active Directory Users and Computer Dialog
To configure this example, perform the following steps on the security appliance:
Step 1 Create an LDAP mapping table entry to map the Active Directory attribute department to the Cisco
attribute cVPN3000-IETF-Radius-Class as shown in the following example commands:
hostname(config)# ldap attribute-map ActiveDirectoryMapTable
hostname(config-ldap-attribute-map)# map-name department cVPN3000-IETF-Radius-Class
Step 2 Create a aaa-server record for the LDAP authentication server and use the ldap-base-dn to specify the
search location for the Active Directory user records as shown in the following example commands:
hostname(config)# aaa-server ldap-authenticate protocol ldap
hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# aaa-server ldap-authenticate host 10.1.1.4
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-base-dn cn=Users,dc=frdevtestad,dc=local
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-scope subtree
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-naming-attribute cn
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-login-password anypassword
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-login-dn cn=Administrator,cn=Users,
dc=frdevtestad,dc=local
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)#
Step 3 Configure the name of the LDAP attribute map as shown in the following example command:
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-attribute-map ActiveDirectoryMapTable
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)#
Step 5 Create an aaa-server record to configure the LDAP authorization server and use the ldap-base-dn to
specify the search location for the Cisco cVPN3000-User-Authorization records as shown in the
following example commands:
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# aaa-server ldap-authorize protocol ldap
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# aaa-server ldap-authorize host 10.1.1.4
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-base-dn ou=Franklin-Altiga,dc=frdevtestad, dc=local
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-scope subtree
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-naming-attribute cn
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-login-password anypassword
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-login-dn cn=Administrator,cn=Users,
dc=frdevtestad,dc=local
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)#
Step 6 Create an external group policy that associates the group-name with the LDAP authorization server. In
this example, the user is assigned to the group Engineering as shown in the following command:
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# group-policy engineering external server-group
ldap-authorize
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)#
Step 7 Create a tunnel group that specifies LDAP authentication as shown in the following example commands:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group ipsec-tunnelgroup type ipsec-ra
hostname(config)# tunnel-group ipsec-tunnelgroup general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authentication-server-group ldap-authenticate
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#
Step 1 Load the security appliance attributes into the RADIUS server. The method you use to load the attributes
depends on which type of RADIUS server you are using:
• If you are using Cisco ACS: the server already has these attributes integrated. You can skip this step.
• If you are using a FUNK RADIUS server: Cisco supplies a dictionary file that contains all the
security appliance attributes. Obtain this dictionary file, cisco3k.dct, from Software Center on
CCO or from the security appliance CD-ROM. Load the dictionary file on your server.
• For other vendors’ RADIUS servers (for example, Microsoft Internet Authentication Service): you
must manually define each security appliance attribute. To define an attribute, use the attribute name
or number, type, value, and vendor code (3076). For a list of security appliance RADIUS
authorization attributes and values, see Table E-4.
Step 2 Set up the users or groups with the permissions and attributes to send during IPSec/WebVPN tunnel
establishment. The permissions or attributes might include access hours, primary DNS, banner, and so
forth.
Note Authorization refers to the process of enforcing permissions or attributes. A RADIUS server defined as
an authentication server enforces permissions or attributes if they are configured.
Table E-4 lists all the possible security appliance supported attributes that can be used for user
authorization.
Single
or
VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
Attribute Name 3000 ASA PIX # Type Valued Description or Value
Access-Hours Y Y Y 1 String Single Name of the time range, for
example, Business-hours
Simultaneous-Logins Y Y Y 2 Integer Single An integer 0 to 2147483647
Primary-DNS Y Y Y 5 String Single An IP address
Secondary-DNS Y Y Y 6 String Single An IP address
Primary-WINS Y Y Y 7 String Single An IP address
Secondary-WINS Y Y Y 8 String Single An IP address
SEP-Card-Assignment 9 Integer Single Not used
Tunneling-Protocols Y Y Y 11 Integer Single 1 = PPTP
2 = L2TP
4 = IPSec
8 = L2TP/IPSec
16 = WebVPN
4 and 8 are mutually exclusive;
0-11 and 16-27 are legal
values.
IPSec-Sec-Association Y 12 String Single Name of the security
association
Table E-4 Security Appliance Supported RADIUS Attributes and Values (continued)
Single
or
VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
Attribute Name 3000 ASA PIX # Type Valued Description or Value
IPSec-Authentication Y 13 Integer Single 0 = None
1 = RADIUS
2 = LDAP (authorization only)
3 = NT Domain
4 = SDI
5 = Internal
6 = RADIUS with Expiry
7 = Kerberos/Active Directory
Banner1 Y Y Y 15 String Single Banner string
IPSec-Allow-Passwd-Store Y Y Y 16 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Use-Client-Address Y 17 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
PPTP-Encryption Y 20 Integer Single Bitmap:
1 = Encryption required
2 = 40 bits
4 = 128 bits
8 = Stateless-Required
15 =
40/128-Encr/Stateless-Req
L2TP-Encryption Y 21 Integer Single Bitmap:
1 = Encryption required
2 = 40 bit
4 = 128 bits
8 = Stateless-Req
15 =
40/128-Encr/Stateless-Req
IPSec-Split-Tunnel-List Y Y Y 27 String Single Specifies the name of the
network/access list that
describes the split tunnel
inclusion list
IPSec-Default-Domain Y Y Y 28 String Single Specifies the single default
domain name to send to the
client (1-255 characters)
Table E-4 Security Appliance Supported RADIUS Attributes and Values (continued)
Single
or
VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
Attribute Name 3000 ASA PIX # Type Valued Description or Value
IPSec-Split-DNS-Names Y Y Y 29 String Single Specifies the list of secondary
domain names to send to the
client (1-255 characters)
IPSec-Tunnel-Type Y Y Y 30 Integer Single 1 = LAN-to-LAN
2 = Remote access
IPSec-Mode-Config Y Y Y 31 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
IPSec-User-Group-Lock Y 33 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
IPSec-Over-UDP Y Y Y 34 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
IPSec-Over-UDP-Port Y Y Y 35 Integer Single 4001 - 49151, default = 10000
Banner2 Y Y Y 36 String Single A banner string. Banner2 string
is concatenated to Banner1
string if configured.
PPTP-MPPC-Compression Y 37 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
L2TP-MPPC-Compression Y 38 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
IPSec-IP-Compression Y Y Y 39 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
IPSec-IKE-Peer-ID-Check Y Y Y 40 Integer Single 1 = Required
2 = If supported by peer
certificate
3 = Do not check
IKE-Keep-Alives Y Y Y 41 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
IPSec-Auth-On-Rekey Y Y Y 42 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Table E-4 Security Appliance Supported RADIUS Attributes and Values (continued)
Single
or
VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
Attribute Name 3000 ASA PIX # Type Valued Description or Value
Required-Client- Firewall-Vendor-Code Y Y Y 45 Integer Single 1 = Cisco Systems (with Cisco
Integrated Client)
2 = Zone Labs
3 = NetworkICE
4 = Sygate
5 = Cisco Systems (with Cisco
Intrusion Prevention Security
Agent)
Required-Client-Firewall-Product-Code Y Y Y 46 Integer Single Cisco Systems Products:
1 = Cisco Intrusion
Prevention Security Agent
or Cisco Integrated Client
(CIC)
Zone Labs Products:
1 = Zone Alarm
2 = Zone AlarmPro
3 = Zone Labs Integrity
NetworkICE Product:
1 = BlackIce
Defender/Agent
Sygate Products:
1 = Personal Firewall
2 = Personal Firewall Pro
3 = Security Agent
Required-Client-Firewall-Description Y Y Y 47 String Single String
Require-HW-Client-Auth Y Y Y 48 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Required-Individual-User-Auth Y Y Y 49 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Authenticated-User-Idle-Timeout Y Y Y 50 Integer Single 1-35791394 minutes
Cisco-IP-Phone-Bypass Y Y Y 51 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
IPSec-Split-Tunneling-Policy Y Y Y 55 Integer Single 0 = No split tunneling
1 = Split tunneling
2 = Local LAN permitted
Table E-4 Security Appliance Supported RADIUS Attributes and Values (continued)
Single
or
VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
Attribute Name 3000 ASA PIX # Type Valued Description or Value
IPSec-Required-Client-Firewall-Capability Y Y Y 56 Integer Single 0 = None
1 = Policy defined by remote
FW Are-You-There (AYT)
2 = Policy pushed CPP
4 = Policy from server
IPSec-Client-Firewall-Filter-Name Y 57 String Single Specifies the name of the filter
to be pushed to the client as
firewall policy
IPSec-Client-Firewall-Filter-Optional Y Y Y 58 Integer Single 0 = Required
1 = Optional
IPSec-Backup-Servers Y Y Y 59 String Single 1 = Use Client-Configured list
2 = Disable and clear client list
3 = Use Backup Server list
IPSec-Backup-Server-List Y Y Y 60 String Single Server Addresses (space
delimited)
DHCP-Network-Scope Y Y Y 61 String Single IP Address
Intercept-DHCP-Configure-Msg Y Y Y 62 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
MS-Client-Subnet-Mask Y Y Y 63 Boolean Single An IP address
Allow-Network-Extension-Mode Y Y Y 64 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Authorization-Type Y Y Y 65 Integer Single 0 = None
1 = RADIUS
2 = LDAP
Authorization-Required Y 66 Integer Single 0 = No
1 = Yes
Authorization-DN-Field Y Y Y 67 String Single Possible values: UID, OU, O,
CN, L, SP, C, EA, T, N, GN,
SN, I, GENQ, DNQ, SER,
use-entire-name
IKE-KeepAlive-Confidence-Interval Y Y Y 68 Integer Single 10-300 seconds
WebVPN-Content-Filter-Parameters Y Y 69 Integer Single 1 = Java ActiveX
2 = Java Script
4 = Image
8 = Cookies in images
Table E-4 Security Appliance Supported RADIUS Attributes and Values (continued)
Single
or
VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
Attribute Name 3000 ASA PIX # Type Valued Description or Value
WebVPN-URL-List Y 71 String Single URL-List name
WebVPN-Port-Forward-List Y 72 String Single Port-Forward list name
WebVPN-Access-List Y 73 String Single Access-List name
Cisco-LEAP-Bypass Y Y Y 75 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-Homepage Y Y 76 String Single A URL such as
http://example-portal.com
Client-Type-Version-Limiting Y Y Y 77 String Single IPsec VPN version number
string
WebVPN-Port-Forwarding-Name Y Y 79 String Single String name (example,
“Corporate-Apps”).
This text replaces the default
string, “Application Access,”
on the WebVPN home page.
IE-Proxy-Server Y 80 String Single IP address
IE-Proxy-Server-Policy Y 81 Integer Single 1 = No Modify
2 = No Proxy
3 = Auto detect
4 = Use Concentrator Setting
IE-Proxy-Exception-List Y 82 String Single newline (\n) separated list of
DNS domains
IE-Proxy-Bypass-Local Y 83 Integer Single 0 = None
1 = Local
IKE-Keepalive-Retry-Interval Y Y Y 84 Integer Single 2 - 10 seconds
Tunnel-Group-Lock Y Y 85 String Single Name of the tunnel group or
“none”
Access-List-Inbound Y Y 86 String Single Access list ID
Access-List-Outbound Y Y 87 String Single Access list ID
Perfect-Forward-Secrecy-Enable Y Y Y 88 Boolean Single 0 = No
1 = Yes
NAC-Enable Y 89 Integer 0 = No
1 = Yes
NAC-Status-Query-Timer Y 90 Integer 30 - 1800 seconds
NAC-Revalidation-Timer Y 91 Integer 300 - 86400 seconds
NAC-Default-ACL Y 92 String Access list
Table E-4 Security Appliance Supported RADIUS Attributes and Values (continued)
Single
or
VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
Attribute Name 3000 ASA PIX # Type Valued Description or Value
WebVPN-URL-Entry-Enable Y Y 93 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-File-Access-Enable Y Y 94 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-File-Server-Entry-Enable Y Y 95 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-File-Server-Browsing-Enable Y Y 96 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-Port-Forwarding-Enable Y Y 97 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-Outlook-Exchange-Proxy-Enable Y Y 98 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-Port-Forwarding-HTTP-Proxy Y Y 99 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-Auto-Applet-Download-Enable Y Y 100 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-Citrix-Metaframe-Enable Y Y 101 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-Apply-ACL Y Y 102 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-SSL-VPN-Client-Enable Y Y 103 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-SSL-VPN-Client-Required Y Y 104 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-SSL-VPN-Client-Keep- Y Y 105 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
Installation 1 = Enabled
Strip-Realm Y Y Y 135 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Note RADIUS attribute names do not contain the cVPN3000 prefix to better reflect support for all three
security appliances (VPN 3000, PIX, and the ASA). Cisco Secure ACS 4.x supports this new
nomenclature, but attribute names in pre-4.0 ACS releases still include the cVPN3000 prefix. The
appliances enforce the RADIUS attributes based on attribute numeric ID, not attribute name. LDAP
attributes are enforced by their name, not by the ID.
Step 1 Load the security appliance attributes into the RADIUS server. The method you use to load the attributes
depends on which type of RADIUS server you are using:
• If you are using Cisco ACS: the server already has these attributes integrated. You can skip this step.
• If you are using a FUNK RADIUS server: Cisco supplies a dictionary file that contains all the
security appliance attributes. Obtain this dictionary file, cisco3k.dct, from Software Center on
CCO or from the security appliance CD-ROM. Load the dictionary file on your server.
• For other vendors’ RADIUS servers (for example, Microsoft Internet Authentication Service): you
must manually define each security appliance attribute. To define an attribute, use the attribute name
or number, type, value, and vendor code (3076). For a list of security appliance RADIUS
authorization attributes and values, see Table E-4.
Step 2 Set up the users or groups with the permissions and attributes to send during IPSec/WebVPN tunnel
establishment.
Note Authorization refers to the process of enforcing permissions or attributes. A RADIUS server defined as
an authentication server enforces permissions or attributes if they are configured.
Table E-4 lists all the possible security appliance supported RADIUS attributes that can be used for user
authorization.
Single
or
VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
Attribute Name 3000 ASA PIX # Type Valued Description or Value
Access-Hours Y Y Y 1 String Single Name of the time range, for
example, Business-hours
Simultaneous-Logins Y Y Y 2 Integer Single An integer from 0 to
2147483647
Primary-DNS Y Y Y 5 String Single An IP address
Secondary-DNS Y Y Y 6 String Single An IP address
Primary-WINS Y Y Y 7 String Single An IP address
Secondary-WINS Y Y Y 8 String Single An IP address
SEP-Card-Assignment 9 Integer Single Not used
Tunneling-Protocols Y Y Y 11 Integer Single 1 = PPTP
2 = L2TP
4 = IPSec
8 = L2TP/IPSec
16 = WebVPN
4 and 8 are mutually exclusive;
0-11 and 16-27 are legal values.
IPSec-Sec-Association Y 12 String Single Name of the security
association
IPSec-Authentication Y 13 Integer Single 0 = None
1 = RADIUS
2 = LDAP (authorization only)
3 = NT Domain
4 = SDI
5 = Internal
6 = RADIUS with Expiry
7 = Kerberos/Active Directory
Banner1 Y Y Y 15 String Single Banner string
IPSec-Allow-Passwd-Store Y Y Y 16 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Use-Client-Address Y 17 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Table E-5 Security Appliance Supported RADIUS Attributes and Values (continued)
Single
or
VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
Attribute Name 3000 ASA PIX # Type Valued Description or Value
PPTP-Encryption Y 20 Integer Single Bitmap:
1 = Encryption required
2 = 40 bits
4 = 128 bits
8 = Stateless-Required
15 =
40/128-Encr/Stateless-Req
L2TP-Encryption Y 21 Integer Single Bitmap:
1 = Encryption required
2 = 40 bit
4 = 128 bits
8 = Stateless-Req
15 =
40/128-Encr/Stateless-Req
IPSec-Split-Tunnel-List Y Y Y 27 String Single Specifies the name of the
network or access list that
describes the split tunnel
inclusion list
IPSec-Default-Domain Y Y Y 28 String Single Specifies the single default
domain name to send to the
client (1-255 characters)
IPSec-Split-DNS-Names Y Y Y 29 String Single Specifies the list of secondary
domain names to send to the
client (1-255 characters)
IPSec-Tunnel-Type Y Y Y 30 Integer Single 1 = LAN-to-LAN
2 = Remote access
IPSec-Mode-Config Y Y Y 31 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
IPSec-User-Group-Lock Y 33 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
IPSec-Over-UDP Y Y Y 34 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
IPSec-Over-UDP-Port Y Y Y 35 Integer Single 4001-49151; default = 10000
Banner2 Y Y Y 36 String Single A banner string. Banner2 string
is concatenated to Banner1
string if configured.
Table E-5 Security Appliance Supported RADIUS Attributes and Values (continued)
Single
or
VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
Attribute Name 3000 ASA PIX # Type Valued Description or Value
PPTP-MPPC-Compression Y 37 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
L2TP-MPPC-Compression Y 38 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
IPSec-IP-Compression Y Y Y 39 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
IPSec-IKE-Peer-ID-Check Y Y Y 40 Integer Single 1 = Required
2 = If supported by peer
certificate
3 = Do not check
IKE-Keep-Alives Y Y Y 41 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
IPSec-Auth-On-Rekey Y Y Y 42 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Required-Client- Firewall-Vendor-Code Y Y Y 45 Integer Single 1 = Cisco Systems (with Cisco
Integrated Client)
2 = Zone Labs
3 = NetworkICE
4 = Sygate
5 = Cisco Systems (with Cisco
Intrusion Prevention Security
Agent)
Table E-5 Security Appliance Supported RADIUS Attributes and Values (continued)
Single
or
VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
Attribute Name 3000 ASA PIX # Type Valued Description or Value
Required-Client-Firewall-Product-Code Y Y Y 46 Integer Single Cisco Systems Products:
1 = Cisco Intrusion
Prevention Security Agent
or Cisco Integrated Client
(CIC)
Zone Labs Products:
1 = Zone Alarm
2 = Zone AlarmPro
3 = Zone Labs Integrity
NetworkICE Product:
1 = BlackIce
Defender/Agent
Sygate Products:
1 = Personal Firewall
2 = Personal Firewall Pro
3 = Security Agent
Required-Client-Firewall-Description Y Y Y 47 String Single String
Require-HW-Client-Auth Y Y Y 48 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Required-Individual-User-Auth Y Y Y 49 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Authenticated-User-Idle-Timeout Y Y Y 50 Integer Single 1-35791394 minutes
Cisco-IP-Phone-Bypass Y Y Y 51 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
IPSec-Split-Tunneling-Policy Y Y Y 55 Integer Single 0 = No split tunneling
1 = Split tunneling
2 = Local LAN permitted
IPSec-Required-Client-Firewall-Capability Y Y Y 56 Integer Single 0 = None
1 = Policy defined by remote
FW Are-You-There (AYT)
2 = Policy pushed CPP
4 = Policy from server
IPSec-Client-Firewall-Filter-Name Y 57 String Single Specifies the name of the filter
to be pushed to the client as
firewall policy
Table E-5 Security Appliance Supported RADIUS Attributes and Values (continued)
Single
or
VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
Attribute Name 3000 ASA PIX # Type Valued Description or Value
IPSec-Client-Firewall-Filter-Optional Y Y Y 58 Integer Single 0 = Required
1 = Optional
IPSec-Backup-Servers Y Y Y 59 String Single 1 = Use Client-Configured list
2 = Disable and clear client list
3 = Use Backup Server list
IPSec-Backup-Server-List Y Y Y 60 String Single Server Addresses (space
delimited)
DHCP-Network-Scope Y Y Y 61 String Single IP Address
Intercept-DHCP-Configure-Msg Y Y Y 62 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
MS-Client-Subnet-Mask Y Y Y 63 Boolean Single An IP address
Allow-Network-Extension-Mode Y Y Y 64 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Authorization-Type Y Y Y 65 Integer Single 0 = None
1 = RADIUS
2 = LDAP
Authorization-Required Y 66 Integer Single 0 = No
1 = Yes
Authorization-DN-Field Y Y Y 67 String Single Possible values: UID, OU, O,
CN, L, SP, C, EA, T, N, GN,
SN, I, GENQ, DNQ, SER,
use-entire-name
IKE-KeepAlive-Confidence-Interval Y Y Y 68 Integer Single 10-300 seconds
WebVPN-Content-Filter-Parameters Y Y 69 Integer Single 1 = Java ActiveX
2 = Java Script
4 = Image
8 = Cookies in images
WebVPN-URL-List Y 71 String Single URL-List name
WebVPN-Port-Forward-List Y 72 String Single Port-Forward list name
WebVPN-Access-List Y 73 String Single Access-List name
Cisco-LEAP-Bypass Y Y Y 75 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-Homepage Y Y 76 String Single A URL such as
http://example-portal.com
Table E-5 Security Appliance Supported RADIUS Attributes and Values (continued)
Single
or
VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
Attribute Name 3000 ASA PIX # Type Valued Description or Value
Client-Type-Version-Limiting Y Y Y 77 String Single IPsec VPN version number
string
WebVPN-Port-Forwarding-Name Y Y 79 String Single String name (example,
“Corporate-Apps”).
This text replaces the default
string, “Application Access,”
on the WebVPN home page.
IE-Proxy-Server Y 80 String Single IP address
IE-Proxy-Server-Policy Y 81 Integer Single 1 = No Modify
2 = No Proxy
3 = Auto detect
4 = Use Concentrator Setting
IE-Proxy-Exception-List Y 82 String Single newline (\n) separated list of
DNS domains
IE-Proxy-Bypass-Local Y 83 Integer Single 0 = None
1 = Local
IKE-Keepalive-Retry-Interval Y Y Y 84 Integer Single 2 - 10 seconds
Tunnel-Group-Lock Y Y 85 String Single Name of the tunnel group or
“none”
Access-List-Inbound Y Y 86 String Single Access list ID
Access-List-Outbound Y Y 87 String Single Access list ID
Perfect-Forward-Secrecy-Enable Y Y Y 88 Boolean Single 0 = No
1 = Yes
NAC-Enable Y 89 Integer 0 = No
1 = Yes
NAC-Status-Query-Timer Y 90 Integer 30-1800 seconds
NAC-Revalidation-Timer Y 91 Integer 300-86400 seconds
NAC-Default-ACL Y 92 String Access list
WebVPN-URL-Entry-Enable Y Y 93 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-File-Access-Enable Y Y 94 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-File-Server-Entry-Enable Y Y 95 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Table E-5 Security Appliance Supported RADIUS Attributes and Values (continued)
Single
or
VPN Attr. Syntax/ Multi-
Attribute Name 3000 ASA PIX # Type Valued Description or Value
WebVPN-File-Server-Browsing-Enable Y Y 96 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-Port-Forwarding-Enable Y Y 97 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-Outlook-Exchange-Proxy-Enable Y Y 98 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-Port-Forwarding-HTTP-Proxy Y Y 99 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-Auto-Applet-Download-Enable Y Y 100 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-Citrix-Metaframe-Enable Y Y 101 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-Apply-ACL Y Y 102 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-SSL-VPN-Client-Enable Y Y 103 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-SSL-VPN-Client-Required Y Y 104 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
WebVPN-SSL-VPN-Client-Keep- Y Y 105 Integer Single 0 = Disabled
Installation
1 = Enabled
Strip-Realm Y Y Y 135 Boolean Single 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Note RADIUS attribute names do not contain the cVPN3000 prefix to better reflect support for all three
security appliances (VPN 3000, PIX, and the ASA). Cisco Secure ACS 4.x supports this new
nomenclature, but attribute names in pre-4.0 ACS releases still include the cVPN3000 prefix. The
appliances enforce the RADIUS attributes based on attribute numeric ID, not attribute name. LDAP
attributes are enforced by their name, not by the ID.
Note To use TACACS+ attributes, make sure you have enabled AAA services on the NAS.
Table E-6 lists supported TACACS+ authorization response attributes for cut-through-proxy
connections. Table E-7 lists supported TACACS+ accounting attributes.
Attribute Description
acl Identifies a locally configured access list to be applied to the connection.
idletime Indicates the amount of inactivity in minutes that is allowed before the
authenticated user session is terminated.
timeout Specifies the absolute amount of time in minutes that authentication credentials
remain active before the authenticated user session is terminated.
.
Table E-7 Supported TACACS+ Accounting Attributes
Attribute Description
bytes_in Specifies the number of input bytes transferred during this connection (stop
records only).
bytes_out Specifies the number of output bytes transferred during this connection (stop
records only).
cmd Defines the command executed (command accounting only).
disc-cause Indicates the numeric code that identifies the reason for disconnecting (stop
records only).
elapsed_time Defines the elapsed time in seconds for the connection (stop records only).
foreign_ip Specifies the IP address of the client for tunnel connections. Defines the address
on the lowest security interface for cut-through-proxy connections.
local_ip Specifies the IP address that the client connected to for tunnel connections. Defines
the address on the highest security interface for cut-through-proxy connections.
NAS port Contains a session ID for the connection.
packs_in Specifies the number of input packets transferred during this connection.
packs_out Specifies the number of output packets transferred during this connection.
priv-level Set to the user’s privilege level for command accounting requests or to 1 otherwise.
rem_iddr Indicates the IP address of the client.
service Specifies the service used. Always set to “shell” for command accounting only.
task_id Specifies a unique task ID for the accounting transaction.
username Indicates the name of the user.
Numerics | A | B | C | D | E | F | G | H | I | J | K | L | M | N | O | P | Q | R | S | T | U | V | W | X
Numerics
3DES See DES.
A
AAA Authentication, authorization, and accounting. See also TACACS+ and RADIUS.
ABR Area Border Router. In OSPF, a router with interfaces in multiple areas.
ACE Access Control Entry. Information entered into the configuration that lets you specify what type of
traffic to permit or deny on an interface. By default, traffic that is not explicitly permitted is denied.
Access Modes The security appliance CLI uses several command modes. The commands available in each mode vary.
See also user EXEC mode, privileged EXEC mode, global configuration mode, command-specific
configuration mode.
ACL Access Control List. A collection of ACEs. An ACL lets you specify what type of traffic to allow on
an interface. By default, traffic that is not explicitly permitted is denied. ACLs are usually applied to
the interface which is the source of inbound traffic. See also rule, outbound ACL.
ActiveX A set of object-oriented programming technologies and tools used to create mobile or portable
programs. An ActiveX program is roughly equivalent to a Java applet.
address translation The translation of a network address and/or port to another network address/or port. See also IP address,
interface PAT, NAT, PAT, Static PAT, xlate.
AES Advanced Encryption Standard. A symmetric block cipher that can encrypt and decrypt information.
The AES algorithm is capable of using cryptographic keys of 128, 192 and 256 bits to encrypt and
decrypt data in blocks of 128 bits. See also DES.
AH Authentication Header. An IP protocol (type 51) that can ensure data integrity, authentication, and
replay detection. AH is embedded in the data to be protected (a full IP datagram, for example). AH can
be used either by itself or with ESP. This is an older IPSec protocol that is less important in most
networks than ESP. AH provides authentication services but does not provide encryption services. It is
provided to ensure compatibility with IPSec peers that do not support ESP, which provides both
authentication and encryption. See also encryption and VPN. Refer to the RFC 2402.
A record address “A” stands for address, and refers to name-to-address mapped records in DNS.
APCF Application Profile Customization Framework. Lets the security appliance handle non-standard
applications so that they render correctly over a WebVPN connection.
ARP Address Resolution Protocol. A low-level TCP/IP protocol that maps a hardware address, or MAC
address, to an IP address. An example hardware address is 00:00:a6:00:01:ba. The first three groups of
characters (00:00:a6) identify the manufacturer; the rest of the characters (00:01:ba) identify the
system card. ARP is defined in RFC 826.
ASA Adaptive Security Algorithm. Used by the security appliance to perform inspections. ASA allows
one-way (inside to outside) connections without an explicit configuration for each internal system and
application. See also inspection engine.
ASDM Adaptive Security Device Manager. An application for managing and configuring a single security
appliance.
asymmetric Also called public key systems, asymmetric encryption allows anyone to obtain access to the public
encryption key of anyone else. Once the public key is accessed, one can send an encrypted message to that person
using the public key. See also encryption, public key.
authentication Cryptographic protocols and services that verify the identity of users and the integrity of data. One of
the functions of the IPSec framework. Authentication establishes the integrity of datastream and
ensures that it is not tampered with in transit. It also provides confirmation about the origin of the
datastream. See also AAA, encryption, and VPN.
Auto Applet Automatically downloads the WebVPN port-forwarding applet when the user first logs in to WebVPN.
Download
auto-signon This command provides a single sign-on method for WebVPN users. It passes the WebVPN login
credentials (username and password) to internal servers for authentication using NTLM authentication,
basic authentication, or both.
B
Backup Server IPSec backup servers let a VPN client connect to the central site when the primary security appliance
is unavailable.
BGP Border Gateway Protocol. BGP performs interdomain routing in TCP/IP networks. BGP is an Exterior
Gateway Protocol, which means that it performs routing between multiple autonomous systems or
domains and exchanges routing and access information with other BGP systems. The security
appliance does not support BGP. See also EGP.
BLT stream Bandwidth Limited Traffic stream. Stream or flow of packets whose bandwidth is constrained.
BOOTP Bootstrap Protocol. Lets diskless workstations boot over the network as is described in RFC 951 and
RFC 1542.
BPDU Bridge Protocol Data Unit. Spanning-Tree Protocol hello packet that is sent out at configurable
intervals to exchange information among bridges in the network. Protocol data unit is the OSI term for
packet.
C
CA Certificate Authority, Certification Authority. A third-party entity that is responsible for issuing and
revoking certificates. Each device with the public key of the CA can authenticate a device that has a
certificate issued by the CA. The term CA also refers to software that provides CA services. See also
certificate, CRL, public key, RA.
cache A temporary repository of information accumulated from previous task executions that can be reused,
decreasing the time required to perform the tasks. Caching stores frequently reused objects in the system
cache, which reduces the need to perform repeated rewriting and compressing of content.
CBC Cipher Block Chaining. A cryptographic technique that increases the encryption strength of an
algorithm. CBC requires an initialization vector (IV) to start encryption. The IV is explicitly given in
the IPSec packet.
certificate A signed cryptographic object that contains the identity of a user or device and the public key of the
CA that issued the certificate. Certificates have an expiration date and may also be placed on a CRL if
known to be compromised. Certificates also establish non-repudiation for IKE negotiation, which
means that you can prove to a third party that IKE negotiation was completed with a specific peer.
CIFS Common Internet File System. It is a platform-independent file sharing system that provides users with
network access to files, printers, and other machine resources. Microsoft implemented CIFS for
networks of Windows computers, however, open source implementations of CIFS provide file access
to servers running other operating systems, such as Linux, UNIX, and Mac OS X.
Citrix An application that virtualizes client-server applications and optimizes web applications.
CLI command line interface. The primary interface for entering configuration and monitoring commands to
the security appliance.
client/server Distributed computing (processing) network systems in which transaction responsibilities are divided
computing into two parts: client (front end) and server (back end). Also called distributed computing. See also
RPC.
Client update Lets you update revisions of clients to which the update applies; provide a URL or IP address from
which to get the update; and, in the case of Windows clients, optionally notify users that they should
update their VPN client version.
command-specific From global configuration mode, some commands enter a command-specific configuration mode. All
configuration mode user EXEC, privileged EXEC, global configuration, and command-specific configuration commands
are available in this mode. See also global configuration mode, privileged EXEC mode, user EXEC
mode.
Compression The process of encoding information using fewer bits or other information-bearing units than an
unencoded representation would use. Compression can reduce the size of transferring packets and
increase communication performance.
configuration, A file on the security appliance that represents the equivalent of settings, preferences, and properties
config, config file administered by ASDM or the CLI.
Content Interprets and modifies applications so that they render correctly over a WebVPN connection.
Rewriting/Transfor
mation
cookie A cookie is a object stored by a browser. Cookies contain information, such as user preferences, to
persistent storage.
CRC Cyclical Redundancy Check. Error-checking technique in which the frame recipient calculates a
remainder by dividing frame contents by a prime binary divisor and compares the calculated remainder
to a value stored in the frame by the sending node.
CRL Certificate Revocation List. A digitally signed message that lists all of the current but revoked
certificates listed by a given CA. This is analogous to a book of stolen charge card numbers that allow
stores to reject bad credit cards. When certificates are revoked, they are added to a CRL. When you
implement authentication using certificates, you can choose to use CRLs or not. Using CRLs lets you
easily revoke certificates before they expire, but the CRL is generally only maintained by the CA or an
RA. If you are using CRLs and the connection to the CA or RA is not available when authentication is
requested, the authentication request will fail. See also CA, certificate, public key, RA.
CRV Call Reference Value. Used by H.225.0 to distinguish call legs signalled between two entities.
cryptography Encryption, authentication, integrity, keys and other services used for secure communication over
networks. See also VPN and IPSec.
crypto map A data structure with a unique name and sequence number that is used for configuring VPNs on the
security appliance. A crypto map selects data flows that need security processing and defines the policy
for these flows and the crypto peer that traffic needs to go to. A crypto map is applied to an interface.
Crypto maps contain the ACLs, encryption standards, peers, and other parameters necessary to specify
security policies for VPNs using IKE and IPSec. See also VPN.
CTIQBE Computer Telephony Interface Quick Buffer Encoding. A protocol used in IP telephony between the
Cisco CallManager and CTI TAPI and JTAPI applications. CTIQBE is used by the TAPI/JTAPI
protocol inspection module and supports NAT, PAT, and bi-directional NAT. This enables Cisco IP
SoftPhone and other Cisco TAPI/JTAPI applications to communicate with Cisco CallManager for call
setup and voice traffic across the security appliance.
cut-through proxy Enables the security appliance to provide faster traffic flow after user authentication. The cut-through
proxy challenges a user initially at the application layer. After the security appliance authenticates the
user, it shifts the session flow and all traffic flows directly and quickly between the source and
destination while maintaining session state information.
D
data confidentiality Describes any method that manipulates data so that no attacker can read it. This is commonly achieved
by data encryption and keys that are only available to the parties involved in the communication.
data integrity Describes mechanisms that, through the use of encryption based on secret key or public key
algorithms, allow the recipient of a piece of protected data to verify that the data has not been modified
in transit.
data origin A security service where the receiver can verify that protected data could have originated only from
authentication the sender. This service requires a data integrity service plus a key distribution mechanism, where a
secret key is shared only between the sender and receiver.
decryption Application of a specific algorithm or cipher to encrypted data so as to render the data comprehensible
to those who are authorized to see the information. See also encryption.
DES Data encryption standard. DES was published in 1977 by the National Bureau of Standards and is a
secret key encryption scheme based on the Lucifer algorithm from IBM. Cisco uses DES in classic
crypto (40-bit and 56-bit key lengths), IPSec crypto (56-bit key), and 3DES (triple DES), which
performs encryption three times using a 56-bit key. 3DES is more secure than DES but requires more
processing for encryption and decryption. See also AES, ESP.
DHCP Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol. Provides a mechanism for allocating IP addresses to hosts
dynamically, so that addresses can be reused when hosts no longer need them and so that mobile
computers, such as laptops, receive an IP address applicable to the LAN to which it is connected.
Diffie-Hellman A public key cryptography protocol that allows two parties to establish a shared secret over insecure
communications channels. Diffie-Hellman is used within IKE to establish session keys.
Diffie-Hellman is a component of Oakley key exchange.
Diffie-Hellman Diffie-Hellman refers to a type of public key cryptography using asymmetric encryption based on
Group 1, Group 2, large prime numbers to establish both Phase 1 and Phase 2 SAs. Group 1 provides a smaller prime
Group 5, Group 7 number than Group 2 but may be the only version supported by some IPSec peers. Diffe-Hellman
Group 5 uses a 1536-bit prime number, is the most secure, and is recommended for use with AES.
Group 7 has an elliptical curve field size of 163 bits and is for use with the Movian VPN client, but
works with any peer that supports Group 7 (ECC). See also VPN and encryption.
DN Distinguished Name. Global, authoritative name of an entry in the OSI Directory (X.500).
DNS Domain Name System (or Service). An Internet service that translates domain names into IP
addresses.
DoS Denial of Service. A type of network attack in which the goal is to render a network service
unavailable.
DSL digital subscriber line. Public network technology that delivers high bandwidth over conventional
copper wiring at limited distances. DSL is provisioned via modem pairs, with one modem located at
a central office and the other at the customer site. Because most DSL technologies do not use the
whole bandwidth of the twisted pair, there is room remaining for a voice channel.
DSP digital signal processor. A DSP segments a voice signal into frames and stores them in voice packets.
DSS Digital Signature Standard. A digital signature algorithm designed by The US National Institute of
Standards and Technology and based on public-key cryptography. DSS does not do user datagram
encryption. DSS is a component in classic crypto, as well as the Redcreek IPSec card, but not in IPSec
implemented in Cisco IOS software.
Dynamic PAT Dynamic Port Address Translation. Dynamic PAT lets multiple outbound sessions appear to originate
from a single IP address. With PAT enabled, the security appliance chooses a unique port number from
the PAT IP address for each outbound translation slot (xlate). This feature is valuable when an ISP
cannot allocate enough unique IP addresses for your outbound connections. The global pool addresses
always come first, before a PAT address is used. See also NAT, Static PAT, and xlate.
E
ECHO See Ping, ICMP. See also inspection engine.
EGP Exterior Gateway Protocol. Replaced by BGP. The security appliance does not support EGP. See also
BGP.
EIGRP Enhanced Interior Gateway Routing Protocol. The security appliance does not support EIGRP.
encryption Application of a specific algorithm or cipher to data so as to render the data incomprehensible to those
unauthorized to see the information. See also decryption.
ESMTP Extended SMTP. Extended version of SMTP that includes additional functionality, such as delivery
notification and session delivery. ESMTP is described in RFC 1869, SMTP Service Extensions.
ESP Encapsulating Security Payload. An IPSec protocol, ESP provides authentication and encryption
services for establishing a secure tunnel over an insecure network. For more information, refer to
RFCs 2406 and 1827.
F
failover, failover Failover lets you configure two security appliances so that one will take over operation if the other
mode one fails. The security appliance supports two failover configurations, Active/Active failover and
Active/Standby failover. Each failover configuration has its own method for determining and
performing failover. With Active/Active failover, both units can pass network traffic. This lets you
configure load balancing on your network. Active/Active failover is only available on units running
in multiple context mode. With Active/Standby failover, only one unit passes traffic while the other
unit waits in a standby state. Active/Standby failover is available on units running in either single or
multiple context mode.
Flash, Flash A nonvolatile storage device used to store the configuration file when the security appliance is
memory powered down.
FQDN/IP Fully qualified domain name/IP address. IPSec parameter that identifies peers that are security
gateways.
FragGuard Provides IP fragment protection and performs full reassembly of all ICMP error messages and virtual
reassembly of the remaining IP fragments that are routed through the security appliance.
FTP File Transfer Protocol. Part of the TCP/IP protocol stack, used for transferring files between hosts.
G
GGSN gateway GPRS support node. A wireless gateway that allows mobile cell phone users to access the
public data network or specified private IP networks.
global Global configuration mode lets you to change the security appliance configuration. All user EXEC,
configuration mode privileged EXEC, and global configuration commands are available in this mode. See also user EXEC
mode, privileged EXEC mode, command-specific configuration mode.
GMT Greenwich Mean Time. Replaced by UTC (Coordinated Universal Time) in 1967 as the world time
standard.
GPRS general packet radio service. A service defined and standardized by the European Telecommunication
Standards Institute. GPRS is an IP-packet-based extension of GSM networks and provides mobile,
wireless, data communications
GRE Generic Routing Encapsulation described in RFCs 1701 and 1702. GRE is a tunneling protocol that
can encapsulate a wide variety of protocol packet types inside IP tunnels, creating a virtual
point-to-point link to routers at remote points over an IP network. By connecting multiprotocol
subnetworks in a single-protocol backbone environment, IP tunneling using GRE allows network
expansion across a single protocol backbone environment.
GSM Global System for Mobile Communication. A digital, mobile, radio standard developed for mobile,
wireless, voice communications.
GTP GPRS tunneling protocol. GTP handles the flow of user packet data and signaling information
between the SGSN and GGSN in a GPRS network. GTP is defined on both the Gn and Gp interfaces
of a GPRS network.
H
H.225 A protocol used for TCP signalling in applications such as video conferencing. See also H.323 and
inspection engine.
H.225.0 An ITU standard that governs H.225.0 session establishment and packetization. H.225.0 actually
describes several different protocols: RAS, use of Q.931, and use of RTP.
H.320 Suite of ITU-T standard specifications for video conferencing over circuit-switched media, such as
ISDN, fractional T-1, and switched-56 lines. Extensions of ITU-T standard H.320 enable video
conferencing over LANs and other packet-switched networks, as well as video over the Internet.
H.323 Allows dissimilar communication devices to communicate with each other by using a standardized
communication protocol. H.323 defines a common set of CODECs, call setup and negotiating
procedures, and basic data transport methods.
H.323 RAS Registration, admission, and status signaling protocol. Enables devices to perform registration,
admissions, bandwidth changes, and status and disengage procedures between VoIP gateway and the
gatekeeper.
Hash, Hash A hash algorithm is a one way function that operates on a message of arbitrary length to create a
Algorithm fixed-length message digest used by cryptographic services to ensure its data integrity. MD5 has a
smaller digest and is considered to be slightly faster than SHA-1. Cisco uses both SHA-1 and MD5
hashes within our implementation of the IPSec framework. See also encryption, HMAC, and VPN.
headend A firewall, concentrator, or other host that serves as the entry point into a private network for VPN
client connections over the public network. See also ISP and VPN.
HMAC A mechanism for message authentication using cryptographic hashes such as SHA-1 and MD5.
host The name for any device on a TCP/IP network that has an IP address. See also network and node.
host/network An IP address and netmask used with other information to identify a single host or network subnet for
security appliance configuration, such as an address translation (xlate) or ACE.
HTTP Hypertext Transfer Protocol. A protocol used by browsers and web servers to transfer files. When a
user views a web page, the browser can use HTTP to request and receive the files used by the web
page. HTTP transmissions are not encrypted.
I
IANA Internet Assigned Number Authority. Assigns all port and protocol numbers for use on the Internet.
ICMP Internet Control Message Protocol. Network-layer Internet protocol that reports errors and provides
other information relevant to IP packet processing.
IDS Intrusion Detection System. A method of detecting malicious network activity by signatures and then
implementing a policy for that signature.
IETF The Internet Engineering Task Force. A technical standards organization that develops RFC
documents defining protocols for the Internet.
IGMP Internet Group Management Protocol. IGMP is a protocol used by IPv4 systems to report IP multicast
memberships to neighboring multicast routers.
IKE Internet Key Exchange. IKE establishes a shared security policy and authenticates keys for services
(such as IPSec) that require keys. Before any IPSec traffic can be passed, each security appliance must
verify the identity of its peer. This can be done by manually entering preshared keys into both hosts
or by a CA service. IKE is a hybrid protocol that uses part Oakley and part of another protocol suite
called SKEME inside ISAKMP framework. This is the protocol formerly known as ISAKMP/Oakley,
and is defined in RFC 2409.
IKE Extended IKE Extended Authenticate (Xauth) is implemented per the IETF draft-ietf-ipsec-isakmp-xauth-04.txt
Authentication (“extended authentication” draft). This protocol provides the capability of authenticating a user within
IKE using TACACS+ or RADIUS.
IKE Mode IKE Mode Configuration is implemented per the IETF draft-ietf-ipsec-isakmp-mode-cfg-04.txt. IKE
Configuration Mode Configuration provides a method for a security gateway to download an IP address (and other
network level configuration) to the VPN client as part of an IKE negotiation.
ILS Internet Locator Service. ILS is based on LDAP and is ILSv2 compliant. ILS was developed by
Microsoft for use with its NetMeeting, SiteServer, and Active Directory products.
IMAP Internet Message Access Protocol. Method of accessing e-mail or bulletin board messages kept on a
mail server that can be shared. IMAP permits client e-mail applications to access remote message
stores as if they were local without actually transferring the message.
implicit rule An access rule automatically created by the security appliance based on default rules or as a result of
user-defined rules.
IMSI International Mobile Subscriber Identity. One of two components of a GTP tunnel ID, the other being
the NSAPI. See also NSAPI.
inside The first interface, usually port 1, that connects your internal, “trusted” network protected by the
security appliance. See also interface, interface names.
inspection engine The security appliance inspects certain application-level protocols to identify the location of
embedded addressing information in traffic. This allows NAT to translate these embedded addresses
and to update any checksum or other fields that are affected by the translation. Because many
protocols open secondary TCP or UDP ports, each application inspection engine also monitors
sessions to determine the port numbers for secondary channels. The initial session on a well-known
port is used to negotiate dynamically assigned port numbers. The application inspection engine
monitors these sessions, identifies the dynamic port assignments, and permits data exchange on these
ports for the duration of the specific session. Some of the protocols that the security appliance can
inspect are CTIQBE, FTP, H.323, HTTP, MGCP, SMTP, and SNMP.
interface The physical connection between a particular network and a security appliance.
interface ip_address The IP address of a security appliance network interface. Each interface IP address must be unique.
Two or more interfaces must not be given the same IP address or IP addresses that are on the same IP
network.
interface names Human readable name assigned to a security appliance network interface. The inside interface default
name is “inside” and the outside interface default name is “outside.” Any perimeter interface default
names are “intfn”, such as intf2 for the first perimeter interface, intf3 for the second perimeter
interface, and so on to the last interface. The numbers in the intf string corresponds to the position of
the interface card in the security appliance. You can use the default names or, if you are an experienced
user, give each interface a more meaningful name. See also inside, intfn, outside.
intfn Any interface, usually beginning with port 2, that connects to a subset network of your design that you
can custom name and configure.
interface PAT The use of PAT where the PAT IP address is also the IP address of the outside interface. See Dynamic
PAT, Static PAT.
Internet The global network that uses IP. Not a LAN. See also intranet.
intranet Intranetwork. A LAN that uses IP. See also network and Internet.
IP Internet Protocol. IP protocols are the most popular nonproprietary protocols because they can be used
to communicate across any set of interconnected networks and are equally well suited for LAN and
WAN communications.
IPS Intrusion Prevention Service. An in-line, deep-packet inspection-based solution that helps mitigate a
wide range of network attacks.
IP address An IP protocol address. A security appliance interface ip_address. IP version 4 addresses are 32 bits
in length. This address space is used to designate the network number, optional subnetwork number,
and a host number. The 32 bits are grouped into four octets (8 binary bits), represented by 4 decimal
numbers separated by periods, or dots. The meaning of each of the four octets is determined by their
use in a particular network.
IP pool A range of local IP addresses specified by a name, and a range with a starting IP address and an ending
address. IP Pools are used by DHCP and VPNs to assign local IP addresses to clients on the inside
interface.
IPSec IP Security. A framework of open standards that provides data confidentiality, data integrity, and data
authentication between participating peers. IPSec provides these security services at the IP layer.
IPSec uses IKE to handle the negotiation of protocols and algorithms based on local policy and to
generate the encryption and authentication keys to be used by IPSec. IPSec can protect one or more
data flows between a pair of hosts, between a pair of security gateways, or between a security gateway
and a host.
IPSec Phase 1 The first phase of negotiating IPSec, includes the key exchange and the ISAKMP portions of IPSec.
IPSec Phase 2 The second phase of negotiating IPSec. Phase two determines the type of encryption rules used for
payload, the source and destination that will be used for encryption, the definition of interesting traffic
according to access lists, and the IPSec peer. IPSec is applied to the interface in Phase 2.
IPSec transform set A transform set specifies the IPSec protocol, encryption algorithm, and hash algorithm to use on traffic
matching the IPSec policy. A transform describes a security protocol (AH or ESP) with its
corresponding algorithms. The IPSec protocol used in almost all transform sets is ESP with the DES
algorithm and HMAC-SHA for authentication.
ISAKMP Internet Security Association and Key Management Protocol. A protocol framework that defines
payload formats, the mechanics of implementing a key exchange protocol, and the negotiation of a
security association. See IKE.
ISP Internet Service Provider. An organization that provides connection to the Internet via their services,
such as modem dial in over telephone voice lines or DSL.
J
JTAPI Java Telephony Application Programming Interface. A Java-based API supporting telephony
functions. See also TAPI.
K
key A data object used for encryption, decryption, or authentication.
L
LAN Local area network. A network residing in one location, such as a single building or campus. See also
Internet, intranet, and network.
layer, layers Networking models implement layers with which different protocols are associated. The most
common networking model is the OSI model, which consists of the following 7 layers, in order:
physical, data link, network, transport, session, presentation, and application.
LDAP Lightweight Directory Access Protocol. LDAP provides management and browser applications with
access to X.500 directories.
M
mask A 32-bit mask that shows how an Internet address is divided into network, subnet, and host parts. The
mask has ones in the bit positions to be used for the network and subnet parts, and zeros for the host
part. The mask should contain at least the standard network portion, and the subnet field should be
contiguous with the network portion.
MC router Multicast (MC) routers route multicast data transmissions to the hosts on each LAN in an internetwork
that are registered to receive specific multimedia or other broadcasts. See also multicast.
MD5 Message Digest 5. A one-way hashing algorithm that produces a 128-bit hash. Both MD5 and SHA-1
are variations on MD4 and are designed to strengthen the security of the MD4 hashing algorithm.
SHA-1 is more secure than MD4 and MD5. Cisco uses hashes for authentication within the IPSec
framework. Also used for message authentication in SNMP v.2. MD5 verifies the integrity of the
communication, authenticates the origin, and checks for timeliness. MD5 has a smaller digest and is
considered to be slightly faster than SHA-1.
Message Digest A message digest is created by a hash algorithm, such as MD5 or SHA-1, that is used for ensuring
message integrity.
MGCP Media Gateway Control Protocol. Media Gateway Control Protocol is a protocol for the control of
VoIP calls by external call-control elements known as media gateway controllers or call agents. MGCP
merges the IPDC and SGCP protocols.
Modular Policy Modular Policy Framework. A means of configuring security appliance features in a manner to similar
Framework to Cisco IOS software Modular QoS CLI.
MS mobile station. Refers generically to any mobile device, such as a mobile handset or computer, that is
used to access network services. GPRS networks support three classes of MS, which describe the type
of operation supported within the GPRS and the GSM mobile wireless networks. For example, a Class
A MS supports simultaneous operation of GPRS and GSM services.
MTU Maximum transmission unit, the maximum number of bytes in a packet that can flow efficiently across
the network with best response time. For Ethernet, the default MTU is 1500 bytes, but each network
can have different values, with serial connections having the smallest values. The MTU is described
in RFC 1191.
multicast Multicast refers to a network addressing method in which the source transmits a packet to multiple
destinations, a multicast group, simultaneously. See also PIM, SMR.
N
N2H2 A third-party, policy-oriented filtering application that works with the security appliance to control
user web access. N2H2 can filter HTTP requests based on destination host name, destination IP
address, and username and password. The N2H2 corporation was acquired by Secure Computing in
October, 2003.
NAT Network Address Translation. Mechanism for reducing the need for globally unique IP addresses.
NAT allows an organization with addresses that are not globally unique to connect to the Internet by
translating those addresses into a globally routable address space.
NEM Network Extension Mode. Lets VPN hardware clients present a single, routable network to the remote
private network over the VPN tunnel.
NetBIOS Network Basic Input/Output System. A Microsoft protocol that supports Windows host name
registration, session management, and data transfer. The security appliance supports NetBIOS by
performing NAT of the packets for NBNS UDP port 137 and NBDS UDP port 138.
network In the context of security appliance configuration, a network is a group of computing devices that
share part of an IP address space and not a single host. A network consists of multiple nodes or hosts.
See also host, Internet, intranet, IP, LAN, and node.
NMS network management system. System responsible for managing at least part of a network. An NMS is
generally a reasonably powerful and well-equipped computer, such as an engineering workstation.
NMSs communicate with agents to help keep track of network statistics and resources.
node Devices such as routers and printers that would not normally be called hosts. See also host, network.
nonvolatile storage, Storage or memory that, unlike RAM, retains its contents without power. Data in a nonvolatile storage
memory device survives a power-off, power-on cycle or reboot.
NSAPI Network service access point identifier. One of two components of a GTP tunnel ID, the other
component being the IMSI. See also IMSI.
NSSA Not-so-stubby-area. An OSPF feature described by RFC 1587. NSSA was first introduced in Cisco
IOS software release 11.2. It is a non-proprietary extension of the existing stub area feature that allows
the injection of external routes in a limited fashion into the stub area.
O
Oakley A key exchange protocol that defines how to acquire authenticated keying material. The basic
mechanism for Oakley is the Diffie-Hellman key exchange algorithm. Oakley is defined in RFC 2412.
object grouping Simplifies access control by letting you apply access control statements to groups of network objects,
such as protocol, services, hosts, and networks.
OSPF Open Shortest Path First. OSPF is a routing protocol for IP networks. OSPF is a routing protocol
widely deployed in large networks because of its efficient use of network bandwidth and its rapid
convergence after changes in topology. The security appliance supports OSPF.
outbound Refers to traffic whose destination is on an interface with lower security than the source interface.
outside The first interface, usually port 0, that connects to other “untrusted” networks outside the security
appliance; the Internet. See also interface, interface names, outbound.
P
PAC PPTP Access Concentrator. A device attached to one or more PSTN or ISDN lines capable of PPP
operation and of handling the PPTP protocol. The PAC need only implement TCP/IP to pass traffic to
one or more PNSs. It may also tunnel non-IP protocols.
Perfmon The security appliance feature that gathers and reports a wide variety of feature statistics, such as
connections/second, xlates/second, etc.
PFS Perfect Forwarding Secrecy. PFS enhances security by using different security key for the IPSec Phase
1 and Phase 2 SAs. Without PFS, the same security key is used to establish SAs in both phases. PFS
ensures that a given IPSec SA key was not derived from any other secret (like some other keys). In
other words, if someone were to break a key, PFS ensures that the attacker would not be able to derive
any other key. If PFS were not enabled, someone could hypothetically break the IKE SA secret key,
copy all the IPSec protected data, and then use knowledge of the IKE SA secret to compromise the
IPSec SA setup by this IKE SA. With PFS, breaking IKE would not give an attacker immediate access
to IPSec. The attacker would have to break each IPSec SA individually.
PIM Protocol Independent Multicast. PIM provides a scalable method for determining the best paths for
distributing a specific multicast transmission to a group of hosts. Each host has registered using IGMP
to receive the transmission. See also PIM-SM.
PIM-SM Protocol Independent Multicast-Sparse Mode. With PIM-SM, which is the default for Cisco routers,
when the source of a multicast transmission begins broadcasting, the traffic is forwarded from one MC
router to the next, until the packets reach every registered host. See also PIM.
PIX Private Internet eXchange. The Cisco PIX 500-series security appliances range from compact,
plug-and-play desktop models for small/home offices to carrier-class gigabit models for the most
demanding enterprise and service provider environments. Cisco PIX security appliances provide
robust, enterprise-class integrated network security services to create a strong multilayered defense
for fast changing network environments.
PKCS12 A standard for the transfer of PKI-related data, such as private keys, certificates, and other data.
Devices supporting this standard let administrators maintain a single set of personal identity
information.
Policy NAT Lets you identify local traffic for address translation by specifying the source and destination
addresses (or ports) in an access list.
POP Post Office Protocol. Protocol that client e-mail applications use to retrieve mail from a mail server.
Port A field in the packet headers of TCP and UDP protocols that identifies the higher level service which
is the source or destination of the packet.
PPP Point-to-Point Protocol. Developed for dial-up ISP access using analog phone lines and modems.
PPTP Point-to-Point Tunneling Protocol. PPTP was introduced by Microsoft to provide secure remote
access to Windows networks; however, because it is vulnerable to attack, PPTP is commonly used
only when stronger security methods are not available or are not required. PPTP Ports are pptp,
1723/tcp, 1723/udp, and pptp. For more information about PPTP, see RFC 2637. See also PAC, PPTP
GRE, PPTP GRE tunnel, PNS, PPTP session, and PPTP TCP.
PPTP GRE tunnel A tunnel defined by a PNS-PAC pair. The tunnel protocol is defined by a modified version of GRE.
The tunnel carries PPP datagrams between the PAC and the PNS. Many sessions are multiplexed on a
single tunnel. A control connection operating over TCP controls the establishment, release, and
maintenance of sessions and of the tunnel itself.
PPTP session PPTP is connection-oriented. The PNS and PAC maintain state for each user that is attached to a PAC.
A session is created when end-to-end PPP connection is attempted between a dial user and the PNS.
The datagrams related to a session are sent over the tunnel between the PAC and PNS.
PPTP TCP Standard TCP session over which PPTP call control and management information is passed. The
control session is logically associated with, but separate from, the sessions being tunneled through a
PPTP tunnel.
preshared key A preshared key provides a method of IKE authentication that is suitable for networks with a limited,
static number of IPSec peers. This method is limited in scalability because the key must be configured
for each pair of IPSec peers. When a new IPSec peer is added to the network, the preshared key must
be configured for every IPSec peer with which it communicates. Using certificates and CAs provides
a more scalable method of IKE authentication.
primary, primary The security appliance normally operating when two units, a primary and secondary, are operating in
unit failover mode.
privileged EXEC Privileged EXEC mode lets you to change current settings. Any user EXEC mode command will work
mode in privileged EXEC mode. See also command-specific configuration mode, global configuration mode,
user EXEC mode.
protocol, protocol A standard that defines the exchange of packets between network nodes for communication. Protocols
literals work together in layers. Protocols are specified in a security appliance configuration as part of
defining a security policy by their literal values or port numbers. Possible security appliance protocol
literal values are ahp, eigrp, esp, gre, icmp, igmp, igrp, ip, ipinip, ipsec, nos, ospf, pcp, snp, tcp, and
udp.
Proxy-ARP Enables the security appliance to reply to an ARP request for IP addresses in the global pool. See also
ARP.
public key A public key is one of a pair of keys that are generated by devices involved in public key infrastructure.
Data encrypted with a public key can only be decrypted using the associated private key. When a
private key is used to produce a digital signature, the receiver can use the public key of the sender to
verify that the message was signed by the sender. These characteristics of key pairs provide a scalable
and secure method of authentication over an insecure media, such as the Internet.
Q
QoS quality of service. Measure of performance for a transmission system that reflects its transmission
quality and service availability.
R
RA Registration Authority. An authorized proxy for a CA. RAs can perform certificate enrollment and can
issue CRLs. See also CA, certificate, public key.
RADIUS Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service. RADIUS is a distributed client/server system that
secures networks against unauthorized access. RFC 2058 and RFC 2059 define the RADIUS protocol
standard. See also AAA and TACACS+.
Refresh Retrieve the running configuration from the security appliance and update the screen. The icon and
the button perform the same function.
replay-detection A security service where the receiver can reject old or duplicate packets to defeat replay attacks.
Replay attacks rely on the attacker sending out older or duplicate packets to the receiver and the
receiver thinking that the bogus traffic is legitimate. Replay-detection is done by using sequence
numbers combined with authentication, and is a standard feature of IPSec.
RFC Request for Comments. RFC documents define protocols and standards for communications over the
Internet. RFCs are developed and published by IETF.
RIP Routing Information Protocol. Interior gateway protocol (IGP) supplied with UNIX BSD systems.
The most common IGP in the Internet. RIP uses hop count as a routing metric.
RLLA Reserved Link Local Address. Multicast addresses range from 224.0.0.0 to 239.255.255.255, however
only the range 224.0.1.0 to 239.255.255.255 is available to us. The first part of the multicast address
range, 224.0.0.0 to 224.0.0.255, is reserved and referred to as the RLLA. These addresses are
unavailable. We can exclude the RLLA range by specifying: 224.0.1.0 to 239.255.255.255. 224.0.0.0
to 239.255.255.255 excluding 224.0.0.0 to 224.0.0.255. This is the same as specifying: 224.0.1.0 to
239.255.255.255.
routed firewall In routed firewall mode, the security appliance is counted as a router hop in the network. It performs
mode NAT between connected networks and can use OSPF or RIP. See also transparent firewall mode.
RPC Remote Procedure Call. RPCs are procedure calls that are built or specified by clients and executed
on servers, with the results returned over the network to the clients.
RSA A public key cryptographic algorithm (named after its inventors, Rivest, Shamir, and Adelman) with
a variable key length. The main weakness of RSA is that it is significantly slow to compute compared
to popular secret-key algorithms, such as DES. The Cisco implementation of IKE uses a
Diffie-Hellman exchange to get the secret keys. This exchange can be authenticated with RSA (or
preshared keys). With the Diffie-Hellman exchange, the DES key never crosses the network (not even
in encrypted form), which is not the case with the RSA encrypt and sign technique. RSA is not public
domain, and must be licensed from RSA Data Security.
RSH Remote Shell. A protocol that allows a user to execute commands on a remote system without having
to log in to the system. For example, RSH can be used to remotely examine the status of a number of
access servers without connecting to each communication server, executing the command, and then
disconnecting from the communication server.
RTCP RTP Control Protocol. Protocol that monitors the QoS of an IPv6 RTP connection and conveys
information about the on-going session. See also RTP.
RTP Real-Time Transport Protocol. Commonly used with IP networks. RTP is designed to provide
end-to-end network transport functions for applications transmitting real-time data, such as audio,
video, or simulation data, over multicast or unicast network services. RTP provides such services as
payload type identification, sequence numbering, timestamping, and delivery monitoring to real-time
applications.
RTSP Real Time Streaming Protocol. Enables the controlled delivery of real-time data, such as audio and
video. RTSP is designed to work with established protocols, such as RTP and HTTP.
rule Conditional statements added to the security appliance configuration to define security policy for a
particular situation. See also ACE, ACL, NAT.
running The configuration currently running in RAM on the security appliance. The configuration that
configuration determines the operational characteristics of the security appliance.
S
SA security association. An instance of security policy and keying material applied to a data flow. SAs
are established in pairs by IPSec peers during both phases of IPSec. SAs specify the encryption
algorithms and other security parameters used to create a secure tunnel. Phase 1 SAs (IKE SAs)
establish a secure tunnel for negotiating Phase 2 SAs. Phase 2 SAs (IPSec SAs) establish the secure
tunnel used for sending user data. Both IKE and IPSec use SAs, although SAs are independent of one
another. IPSec SAs are unidirectional and they are unique in each security protocol. A set of SAs are
needed for a protected data pipe, one per direction per protocol. For example, if you have a pipe that
supports ESP between peers, one ESP SA is required for each direction. SAs are uniquely identified
by destination (IPSec endpoint) address, security protocol (AH or ESP), and Security Parameter Index.
IKE negotiates and establishes SAs on behalf of IPSec. A user can also establish IPSec SAs manually.
An IKE SA is used by IKE only, and unlike the IPSec SA, it is bidirectional.
SCCP Skinny Client Control Protocol. A Cisco-proprietary protocol used between Cisco Call Manager and
Cisco VoIP phones.
SCEP Simple Certificate Enrollment Protocol. A method of requesting and receiving (also known as
enrolling) certificates from CAs.
SDP Session Definition Protocol. An IETF protocol for the definition of Multimedia Services. SDP
messages can be part of SGCP and MGCP messages.
secondary unit The backup security appliance when two are operating in failover mode.
secret key A secret key is a key shared only between the sender and receiver. See key, public key.
security context You can partition a single security appliance into multiple virtual firewalls, known as security
contexts. Each context is an independent firewall, with its own security policy, interfaces, and
administrators. Multiple contexts are similar to having multiple stand-alone firewalls.
serial transmission A method of data transmission in which the bits of a data character are transmitted sequentially over
a single channel.
SGCP Simple Gateway Control Protocol. Controls VoIP gateways by an external call control element (called
a call-agent).
SGSN Serving GPRS Support Node. The SGSN ensures mobility management, session management and
packet relaying functions.
SHA-1 Secure Hash Algorithm 1. SHA-1 [NIS94c] is a revision to SHA that was published in 1994. SHA is
closely modeled after MD4 and produces a 160-bit digest. Because SHA produces a 160-bit digest, it
is more resistant to brute-force attacks than 128-bit hashes (such as MD5), but it is slower. Secure
Hash Algorithm 1 is a joint creation of the National Institute of Standards and Technology and the
National Security Agency. This algorithm, like other hash algorithms, is used to generate a hash value,
also known as a message digest, that acts like a CRC used in lower-layer protocols to ensure that
message contents are not changed during transmission. SHA-1 is generally considered more secure
than MD5.
SIP Session Initiation Protocol. Enables call handling sessions, particularly two-party audio conferences,
or “calls.” SIP works with SDP for call signaling. SDP specifies the ports for the media stream. Using
SIP, the security appliance can support any SIP VoIP gateways and VoIP proxy servers.
site-to-site VPN A site-to-site VPN is established between two IPSec peers that connect remote networks into a single
VPN. In this type of VPN, neither IPSec peer is the destination or source of user traffic. Instead, each
IPSec peer provides encryption and authentication services for hosts on the LANs connected to each
IPSec peer. The hosts on each LAN send and receive data through the secure tunnel established by the
pair of IPSec peers.
SKEME A key exchange protocol that defines how to derive authenticated keying material, with rapid key
refreshment.
SMR Stub Multicast Routing. SMR allows the security appliance to function as a “stub router.” A stub
router is a device that acts as an IGMP proxy agent. IGMP is used to dynamically register specific
hosts in a multicast group on a particular LAN with a multicast router. Multicast routers route
multicast data transmissions to hosts that are registered to receive specific multimedia or other
broadcasts. A stub router forwards IGMP messages between hosts and MC routers.
SMTP Simple Mail Transfer Protocol. SMTP is an Internet protocol that supports email services.
SNMP Simple Network Management Protocol. A standard method for managing network devices using data
structures called Management Information Bases.
split tunneling Allows a remote VPN client simultaneous encrypted access to a private network and clear unencrypted
access to the Internet. If you do not enable split tunneling, all traffic between the VPN client and the
security appliance is sent through an IPSec tunnel. All traffic originating from the VPN client is sent
to the outside interface through a tunnel, and client access to the Internet from its remote site is denied.
spoofing A type of attack designed to foil network security mechanisms such as filters and access lists. A
spoofing attack sends a packet that claims to be from an address from which it was not actually sent.
SQL*Net Structured Query Language Protocol. An Oracle protocol used to communicate between client and
server processes.
SSH Secure Shell. An application running on top of a reliable transport layer, such as TCP/IP, that provides
strong authentication and encryption capabilities.
SSL Secure Sockets Layer. A protocol that resides between the application layer and TCP/IP to provide
transparent encryption of data traffic.
stateful inspection Network protocols maintain certain data, called state information, at each end of a network connection
between two hosts. State information is necessary to implement the features of a protocol, such as
guaranteed packet delivery, data sequencing, flow control, and transaction or session IDs. Some of the
protocol state information is sent in each packet while each protocol is being used. For example, a
browser connected to a web server uses HTTP and supporting TCP/IP protocols. Each protocol layer
maintains state information in the packets it sends and receives. The security appliance and some other
firewalls inspect the state information in each packet to verify that it is current and valid for every
protocol it contains. This is called stateful inspection and is designed to create a powerful barrier to
certain types of computer security threats.
Static PAT Static Port Address Translation. Static PAT is a static address that also maps a local port to a global
port. See also Dynamic PAT, NAT.
T
TACACS+ Terminal Access Controller Access Control System Plus. A client-server protocol that supports AAA
services, including command authorization. See also AAA, RADIUS.
TAPI Telephony Application Programming Interface. A programming interface in Microsoft Windows that
supports telephony functions.
TCP Transmission Control Protocol. Connection-oriented transport layer protocol that provides reliable
full-duplex data transmission.
TCP Intercept With the TCP intercept feature, once the optional embryonic connection limit is reached, and until the
embryonic connection count falls below this threshold, every SYN bound for the effected server is
intercepted. For each SYN, the security appliance responds on behalf of the server with an empty
SYN/ACK segment. The security appliance retains pertinent state information, drops the packet, and
waits for the client acknowledgment. If the ACK is received, then a copy of the client SYN segment
is sent to the server and the TCP three-way handshake is performed between the security appliance
and the server. If this three-way handshake completes, may the connection resume as normal. If the
client does not respond during any part of the connection phase, then the security appliance
retransmits the necessary segment using exponential back-offs.
TDP Tag Distribution Protocol. TDP is used by tag switching devices to distribute, request, and release tag
binding information for multiple network layer protocols in a tag switching network. TDP does not
replace routing protocols. Instead, it uses information learned from routing protocols to create tag
bindings. TDP is also used to open, monitor, and close TDP sessions and to indicate errors that occur
during those sessions. TDP operates over a connection-oriented transport layer protocol with
guaranteed sequential delivery (such as TCP). The use of TDP does not preclude the use of other
mechanisms to distribute tag binding information, such as piggybacking information on other
protocols.
Telnet A terminal emulation protocol for TCP/IP networks such as the Internet. Telnet is a common way to
control web servers remotely; however, its security vulnerabilities have led to its replacement by SSH.
TFTP Trivial File Transfer Protocol. TFTP is a simple protocol used to transfer files. It runs on UDP and is
explained in depth in RFC 1350.
traffic policing The traffic policing feature ensures that no traffic exceeds the maximum rate (bits per second) that you
configure, thus ensuring that no one traffic flow can take over the entire resource.
transparent firewall A mode in which the security appliance is not a router hop. You can use transparent firewall mode to
mode simplify your network configuration or to make the security appliance invisible to attackers. You can
also use transparent firewall mode to allow traffic through that would otherwise be blocked in routed
firewall mode. See also routed firewall mode.
transport mode An IPSec encryption mode that encrypts only the data portion (payload) of each packet, but leaves the
header untouched. Transport mode is less secure than tunnel mode.
tunnel mode An IPSec encryption mode that encrypts both the header and data portion (payload) of each packet.
Tunnel mode is more secure than transport mode.
tunnel A method of transporting data in one protocol by encapsulating it in another protocol. Tunneling is
used for reasons of incompatibility, implementation simplification, or security. For example, a tunnel
lets a remote VPN client have encrypted access to a private network.
Turbo ACL Increases ACL lookup speeds by compiling them into a set of lookup tables. Packet headers are used
to access the tables in a small, fixed number of lookups, independent of the existing number of ACL
entries.
U
UDP User Datagram Protocol. A connectionless transport layer protocol in the IP protocol stack. UDP is a
simple protocol that exchanges datagrams without acknowledgments or guaranteed delivery, which
requires other protocols to handle error processing and retransmission. UDP is defined in RFC 768.
UMTS Universal Mobile Telecommunication System. An extension of GPRS networks that moves toward an
all-IP network by delivering broadband information, including commerce and entertainment services,
to mobile users via fixed, wireless, and satellite networks
Unicast RPF Unicast Reverse Path Forwarding. Unicast RPF guards against spoofing by ensuring that packets have
a source IP address that matches the correct source interface according to the routing table.
URL Uniform Resource Locator. A standardized addressing scheme for accessing hypertext documents and
other services using a browser. For example, http://www.cisco.com.
user EXEC mode User EXEC mode lets you to see the security appliance settings. The user EXEC mode prompt appears
as follows when you first access the security appliance. See also command-specific configuration
mode, global configuration mode, and privileged EXEC mode.
UTC Coordinated Universal Time. The time zone at zero degrees longitude, previously called Greenwich
Mean Time (GMT) and Zulu time. UTC replaced GMT in 1967 as the world time standard. UTC is
based on an atomic time scale rather than an astronomical time scale.
UTRAN Universal Terrestrial Radio Access Network. Networking protocol used for implementing wireless
networks in UMTS. GTP allows multi-protocol packets to be tunneled through a UMTS/GPRS
backbone between a GGSN, an SGSN and the UTRAN.
UUIE User-User Information Element. An element of an H.225 packet that identifies the users implicated in
the message.
V
VLAN Virtual LAN. A group of devices on one or more LANs that are configured (using management
software) so that they can communicate as if they were attached to the same physical network cable,
when in fact they are located on a number of different LAN segments. Because VLANs are based on
logical instead of physical connections, they are extremely flexible.
VoIP Voice over IP. VoIP carries normal voice traffic, such as telephone calls and faxes, over an IP-based
network. DSP segments the voice signal into frames, which then are coupled in groups of two and
stored in voice packets. These voice packets are transported using IP in compliance with ITU-T
specification H.323.
VPN Virtual Private Network. A network connection between two peers over the public network that is
made private by strict authentication of users and the encryption of all data traffic. You can establish
VPNs between clients, such as PCs, or a headend, such as the security appliance.
VSA Vendor-specific attribute. An attribute in a RADIUS packet that is defined by a vendor rather than by
RADIUS RFCs. The RADIUS protocol uses IANA-assigned vendor numbers to help identify VSAs.
This lets different vendors have VSAs of the same number. The combination of a vendor number and
a VSA number makes a VSA unique. For example, the cisco-av-pair VSA is attribute 1 in the set of
VSAs related to vendor number 9. Each vendor can define up to 256 VSAs. A RADIUS packet
contains any VSAs attribute 26, named Vendor-specific. VSAs are sometimes referred to as
subattributes.
W
WAN wide-area network. Data communications network that serves users across a broad geographic area
and often uses transmission devices provided by common carriers.
WCCP Web Cache Communication Protocol. Transparently redirects selected types of traffic to a group of
web cache engines to optimize resource usage and lower response times.
Websense A content filtering solution that manages employee access to the Internet. Websense uses a policy
engine and a URL database to control user access to websites.
WEP Wired Equivalent Privacy. A security protocol for wireless LANs, defined in the IEEE 802.11b
standard.
WINS Windows Internet Naming Service. A Windows system that determines the IP address associated with
a particular network device, also known as “name resolution.” WINS uses a distributed database that
is automatically updated with the NetBIOS names of network devices currently available and the IP
address assigned to each one.WINS provides a distributed database for registering and querying
dynamic NetBIOS names to IP address mapping in a routed network environment. It is the best choice
for NetBIOS name resolution in such a routed network because it is designed to solve the problems
that occur with name resolution in complex networks.
X
X.509 A widely used standard for defining digital certificates. X.509 is actually an ITU recommendation,
which means that it has not yet been officially defined or approved for standardized usage.
xlate An xlate, also referred to as a translation entry, represents the mapping of one IP address to another,
or the mapping of one IP address/port pair to another.
adding 13-12
Symbols
types 13-2
/bits subnet masks D-3 support summary 13-3
? web clients 19-5
command string C-4 abbreviating commands C-3
help C-4 Access Control Server 33-1, 33-2, 33-5
access hours, username attribute 30-71
accessing the security appliance using SSL 37-3
Numerics
accessing the security appliance using TKS1 37-3
4GE SSM access list filter, username attribute 30-73
connector types 5-1 access lists
fiber 5-3 about 16-1
SFP 5-3 ACE logging, configuring 16-19
support A-10 comments 16-17
802.1Q tagging 4-11 deny flows, managing 16-21
downloadable 19-7
EtherType, adding 16-8
A
exemptions from posture validation 33-4
AAA extended
about 13-1 about 16-5
accounting 19-12 adding 16-6
addressing, configuring 31-2 group policy WebVPN filter 30-63
authentication implicit deny 16-3
CLI access 40-5 inbound 18-1
network access 19-1 interface, applying 18-4
privileged EXEC mode 40-6 IP address guidelines 16-3
authorization IPSec 27-20
command 40-7 logging 16-19
downloadable access lists 19-7 NAT guidelines 16-3
network access 19-5 Network Admission Control, default 33-3
local database support 13-9 object groups 16-17
performance 19-1 outbound 18-1
server remarks 16-17
certificate validation, not done in WebVPN 37-2 classifying traffic for QoS 24-4
relay 10-5
D
server 10-1, 10-2
data flow transparent firewall 16-6
routed firewall 15-2 DHCP Intercept, configuring 30-43
transparent firewall 15-12 Diffie-Hellman
DDNS 10-6 Group 5 27-4
debugging IPSec 28-8 groups supported 27-4
debug messages 43-10 digital certificates
default authenticating WebVPN users 37-15
class 6-3 SSL 37-5
DefaultL2Lgroup 30-1 WebVPN authentication restrictions 37-5
DefaultRAgroup 30-1 directory hierarchy search E-4
domain name, group policy 30-42 disabling content rewrite 37-29
group policy 30-1, 30-30 disabling messages, specific message IDs 42-20
LAN-to-LAN tunnel group 30-13 DMZ, definition 1-1
queue 24-2 DNS
remote access tunnel group, configuring 30-5 configuring for WebVPN 37-16
routes, defining equal cost routes 9-3 dynamic 10-6
tunnel group 27-11, 30-2 inspection
default configuration about 25-13
commands 2-1 managing 25-13
restoring 2-2 rewrite, about 25-14
default policy 21-2 rewrite, configuring 25-15
default routes NAT effect on 17-14
about 9-3 server, configuring 30-34
configuring 9-3 domain attributes, group policy 30-42
deny flows, logging 16-21 domain name 8-2
deny in a crypto map 27-15 dotted decimal subnet masks D-3
deny-message downloadable access lists
group policy WebVPN attribute 30-61 configuring 19-7
username WebVPN attribute 30-80 converting netmask expressions 19-11
DES, IKE policy keywords (table) 27-3 dual IP stack, configuring 12-4
device ID, including in messages 42-19 dual-ISP support 9-3
device pass-through, ASA 5505 as Easy VPN client 34-8 duplex, configuring 5-1
DfltGrpPolicy 30-31 dynamic crypto map 27-24
DHCP creating 32-6
addressing, configuring 31-3 See also crypto map
Cisco IP Phones 10-4 Dynamic DNS 10-6
options 10-3 dynamic NAT
windows, customizing for WebVPN users 30-23 MD5, IKE policy keywords (table) 27-3